Multiple Feeder Protection System: Grid Solutions

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 696

GE

Grid Solutions

F35
Multiple Feeder Protection
System

Instruction Manual
Product version: 7.7x
GE publication code: 1601-0106-AG2 (GEK-131037A)

E83849
S T ER
GI
ED
RE

ISO 9001
LISTED
G

E
IN

M U LT I L
IND.CONT. EQ.
52TL

1601-0106-AG2
Copyright © 2018 GE Multilin Inc. All rights reserved.
F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System Instruction Manual for version 7.7x.
F35, FlexLogic, FlexElement, FlexCurve, FlexAnalog, FlexInteger, FlexState, EnerVista,
CyberSentry, HardFiber, Multilin, and GE Multilin are trademarks or registered trademarks
of GE Multilin Inc.
The contents of this manual are the property of GE Multilin Inc. This documentation is
furnished on license and may not be reproduced in whole or in part without the permission
of GE Multilin. The content of this manual is for informational use only and is subject to
change without notice.
Part number: 1601-0106-AG2 (May 2018)
F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Table of contents

1 INTRODUCTION 1.1 Safety symbols and definitions ........................................................................... 1-1


1.1.1 General cautions and warnings .................................................................................... 1-1
1.2 For further assistance........................................................................................... 1-2

2 PRODUCT 2.1 Product description ............................................................................................... 2-1


DESCRIPTION 2.2 Security .................................................................................................................... 2-3
2.3 Order codes............................................................................................................. 2-7
2.3.1 Order codes with enhanced CT/VT modules........................................................... 2-7
2.3.2 Order codes with process bus modules ..................................................................2-11
2.3.3 Replacement modules .....................................................................................................2-14
2.4 Signal processing ................................................................................................. 2-17
2.4.1 UR signal processing ........................................................................................................2-17
2.5 Specifications........................................................................................................ 2-19
2.5.1 Protection elements ..........................................................................................................2-19
2.5.2 User-programmable elements ....................................................................................2-22
2.5.3 Monitoring..............................................................................................................................2-24
2.5.4 Metering..................................................................................................................................2-25
2.5.5 Inputs .......................................................................................................................................2-26
2.5.6 Power supply ........................................................................................................................2-27
2.5.7 Outputs....................................................................................................................................2-28
2.5.8 Communications ................................................................................................................2-30
2.5.9 Inter-relay communications..........................................................................................2-31
2.5.10 CyberSentry security.........................................................................................................2-32
2.5.11 Graphical front panel........................................................................................................2-32
2.5.12 Environmental......................................................................................................................2-33
2.5.13 Type tests ...............................................................................................................................2-34
2.5.14 Production tests ..................................................................................................................2-34
2.5.15 Approvals ...............................................................................................................................2-35
2.5.16 Maintenance.........................................................................................................................2-35

3 INSTALLATION 3.1 Unpack and inspect ............................................................................................... 3-1


3.2 Panel cutouts .......................................................................................................... 3-2
3.2.1 Horizontal units ..................................................................................................................... 3-2
3.2.2 Vertical units ........................................................................................................................... 3-6

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL iii


TABLE OF CONTENTS

3.2.3 Rear terminal layout......................................................................................................... 3-10


3.3 Wiring .....................................................................................................................3-14
3.3.1 Typical wiring ....................................................................................................................... 3-14
3.3.2 Dielectric strength ............................................................................................................. 3-15
3.3.3 Control power ...................................................................................................................... 3-15
3.3.4 CT/VT modules .................................................................................................................... 3-16
3.3.5 Process bus modules ....................................................................................................... 3-18
3.3.6 Contact inputs and outputs .......................................................................................... 3-19
3.3.7 Transducer inputs and outputs................................................................................... 3-31
3.3.8 RS232 port............................................................................................................................. 3-33
3.3.9 CPU communication ports ............................................................................................ 3-34
3.3.10 IRIG-B....................................................................................................................................... 3-36
3.4 Direct input and output communications .......................................................3-37
3.4.1 Description ............................................................................................................................ 3-37
3.4.2 Fiber: LED and ELED transmitters............................................................................... 3-39
3.4.3 Fiber laser transmitters................................................................................................... 3-39
3.4.4 G.703 interface.................................................................................................................... 3-40
3.4.5 RS422 interface................................................................................................................... 3-44
3.4.6 RS422 and fiber interface .............................................................................................. 3-46
3.4.7 G.703 and fiber interface................................................................................................ 3-47
3.4.8 IEEE C37.94 interface ....................................................................................................... 3-47
3.4.9 C37.94SM interface........................................................................................................... 3-50
3.5 Activate relay ........................................................................................................3-53
3.6 Install software .....................................................................................................3-54
3.6.1 EnerVista communication overview ......................................................................... 3-54
3.6.2 System requirements....................................................................................................... 3-55
3.6.3 Install software.................................................................................................................... 3-56
3.7 Add device to software........................................................................................3-57
3.7.1 Set IP address in UR.......................................................................................................... 3-58
3.7.2 Configure serial connection.......................................................................................... 3-64
3.7.3 Configure Ethernet connection ................................................................................... 3-65
3.7.4 Configure modem connection.....................................................................................3-66
3.7.5 Automatic discovery of UR devices........................................................................... 3-67
3.8 Connect to the F35 ...............................................................................................3-68
3.8.1 Connect to the F35 in EnerVista.................................................................................. 3-68
3.8.2 Use Quick Connect via front RS232 port................................................................. 3-69
3.8.3 Use Quick Connect via front USB port ..................................................................... 3-70
3.8.4 Use Quick Connect via a rear Ethernet port.......................................................... 3-70
3.9 Set up CyberSentry and change default password........................................3-71
3.10 Import settings .....................................................................................................3-72
3.11 Connect to D400 gateway...................................................................................3-73
3.11.1 Oscillography files.............................................................................................................. 3-73
3.11.2 Event records ....................................................................................................................... 3-73
3.11.3 Log files................................................................................................................................... 3-73
3.11.4 Setting files............................................................................................................................ 3-74

4 INTERFACES 4.1 EnerVista software interface................................................................................4-1


4.1.1 Introduction .............................................................................................................................4-1
4.1.2 Settings files ............................................................................................................................4-1
4.1.3 Event viewing..........................................................................................................................4-2
4.1.4 File support ..............................................................................................................................4-3
4.1.5 EnerVista main window .....................................................................................................4-3
4.1.6 Protection summary window..........................................................................................4-4
4.1.7 Settings templates................................................................................................................4-5
4.1.8 Secure and lock FlexLogic equations ..........................................................................4-9

iv F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


TABLE OF CONTENTS

4.1.9 Settings file traceability ...................................................................................................4-12


4.2 Front panel interface........................................................................................... 4-15
4.2.1 Front panel ............................................................................................................................4-15
4.2.2 Front panel display ............................................................................................................4-17
4.2.3 Front panel navigation keys..........................................................................................4-37
4.2.4 LED indicators ......................................................................................................................4-38
4.2.5 Front panel labelling .........................................................................................................4-43
4.2.6 Menu navigation.................................................................................................................4-49
4.2.7 Change settings ..................................................................................................................4-51
4.2.8 View actual values.............................................................................................................4-56
4.2.9 Breaker control....................................................................................................................4-57
4.2.10 Change passwords............................................................................................................4-58
4.2.11 Invalid password entry ....................................................................................................4-59
4.3 Logic diagrams ..................................................................................................... 4-60
4.4 FlexLogic design using Engineer ....................................................................... 4-61
4.4.1 Design logic...........................................................................................................................4-63
4.4.2 Send file to and from device .........................................................................................4-73
4.4.3 Monitor logic.........................................................................................................................4-74
4.4.4 View front panel and print labels................................................................................4-75
4.4.5 Generate connectivity report........................................................................................4-76
4.4.6 Preferences ...........................................................................................................................4-76
4.4.7 Toolbars ..................................................................................................................................4-80

5 SETTINGS 5.1 Settings menu......................................................................................................... 5-1


5.2 Overview.................................................................................................................. 5-4
5.2.1 Introduction to elements .................................................................................................. 5-4
5.2.2 Introduction to AC sources .............................................................................................. 5-6
5.3 Product setup.......................................................................................................... 5-7
5.3.1 Security .................................................................................................................................... 5-7
5.3.2 Display properties ..............................................................................................................5-26
5.3.3 Graphical front panel........................................................................................................5-28
5.3.4 Clear relay records.............................................................................................................5-40
5.3.5 Communications ................................................................................................................5-41
5.3.6 Modbus user map ........................................................................................................... 5-147
5.3.7 Real time clock..................................................................................................................5-148
5.3.8 Fault reports ......................................................................................................................5-153
5.3.9 Oscillography.....................................................................................................................5-155
5.3.10 Data logger ........................................................................................................................5-157
5.3.11 Demand ...............................................................................................................................5-158
5.3.12 User-programmable LEDs ..........................................................................................5-160
5.3.13 User-programmable self-tests .................................................................................5-164
5.3.14 Control pushbuttons ...................................................................................................... 5-165
5.3.15 User-programmable pushbuttons ..........................................................................5-166
5.3.16 Flex state parameters ...................................................................................................5-172
5.3.17 User-definable displays................................................................................................5-173
5.3.18 Direct inputs and outputs............................................................................................5-175
5.3.19 Teleprotection ...................................................................................................................5-181
5.3.20 Installation ..........................................................................................................................5-182
5.4 Remote resources ..............................................................................................5-183
5.4.1 Remote resources configuration .............................................................................5-183
5.5 System setup.......................................................................................................5-184
5.5.1 AC inputs .............................................................................................................................5-184
5.5.2 Power system....................................................................................................................5-185
5.5.3 Signal sources...................................................................................................................5-186
5.5.4 Breakers...............................................................................................................................5-189

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL v


TABLE OF CONTENTS

5.5.5 Disconnect switch control .......................................................................................... 5-194


5.5.6 FlexCurves .......................................................................................................................... 5-199
5.6 FlexLogic.............................................................................................................. 5-206
5.6.1 FlexLogic operands........................................................................................................ 5-206
5.6.2 FlexLogic rules.................................................................................................................. 5-218
5.6.3 FlexLogic evaluation...................................................................................................... 5-219
5.6.4 FlexLogic example.......................................................................................................... 5-219
5.6.5 FlexLogic equation editor............................................................................................ 5-224
5.6.6 FlexLogic timers............................................................................................................... 5-224
5.6.7 FlexElements ..................................................................................................................... 5-224
5.6.8 Non-volatile latches....................................................................................................... 5-229
5.7 Grouped elements ............................................................................................. 5-230
5.7.1 Overview ............................................................................................................................. 5-230
5.7.2 Setting group 1................................................................................................................. 5-230
5.7.3 Phase current ................................................................................................................... 5-231
5.7.4 Neutral current................................................................................................................. 5-240
5.7.5 Wattmetric ground fault.............................................................................................. 5-243
5.7.6 Ground current ................................................................................................................ 5-247
5.7.7 Negative sequence current........................................................................................ 5-250
5.7.8 Voltage elements ............................................................................................................ 5-252
5.8 Control elements ............................................................................................... 5-259
5.8.1 Overview ............................................................................................................................. 5-259
5.8.2 Trip bus ................................................................................................................................ 5-259
5.8.3 Setting groups .................................................................................................................. 5-261
5.8.4 Selector switch................................................................................................................. 5-262
5.8.5 Underfrequency (ANSI 81U)........................................................................................ 5-269
5.8.6 Autoreclose (ANSI 79) .................................................................................................... 5-270
5.8.7 Digital elements............................................................................................................... 5-277
5.8.8 Digital counters................................................................................................................ 5-280
5.8.9 8-bit switches.................................................................................................................... 5-282
5.8.10 Monitoring elements ..................................................................................................... 5-284
5.8.11 Cold load pickup .............................................................................................................. 5-307
5.8.12 PID regulator ..................................................................................................................... 5-308
5.9 Inputs/outputs ................................................................................................... 5-311
5.9.1 Contact inputs .................................................................................................................. 5-311
5.9.2 Virtual inputs ..................................................................................................................... 5-313
5.9.3 Contact outputs............................................................................................................... 5-314
5.9.4 Virtual outputs.................................................................................................................. 5-317
5.9.5 Resetting ............................................................................................................................. 5-317
5.9.6 Direct inputs and outputs ........................................................................................... 5-318
5.9.7 Teleprotection................................................................................................................... 5-322
5.10 Transducer inputs/outputs.............................................................................. 5-324
5.10.1 DCmA inputs...................................................................................................................... 5-324
5.10.2 RTD inputs .......................................................................................................................... 5-325
5.10.3 DCmA outputs .................................................................................................................. 5-326
5.11 Testing ................................................................................................................. 5-330
5.11.1 Test mode function ........................................................................................................ 5-330
5.11.2 Test mode forcing........................................................................................................... 5-330
5.11.3 Force contact inputs ..................................................................................................... 5-331
5.11.4 Force contact outputs .................................................................................................. 5-331
5.12 Simulation ........................................................................................................... 5-332
5.12.1 GOOSE .................................................................................................................................. 5-332

6 ACTUAL VALUES 6.1 Actual Values menu ...............................................................................................6-1


6.2 Front panel...............................................................................................................6-3

vi F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


TABLE OF CONTENTS

6.2.1 Enhanced and basic front panels................................................................................. 6-3


6.2.2 Graphical front panel.......................................................................................................... 6-4
6.3 Status ....................................................................................................................... 6-5
6.3.1 Contact inputs ....................................................................................................................... 6-5
6.3.2 Virtual inputs........................................................................................................................... 6-5
6.3.3 RxGOOSE boolean inputs.................................................................................................. 6-5
6.3.4 RxGOOSE DPS inputs .......................................................................................................... 6-5
6.3.5 Teleprotection inputs.......................................................................................................... 6-6
6.3.6 Contact outputs .................................................................................................................... 6-6
6.3.7 Virtual outputs ....................................................................................................................... 6-6
6.3.8 Autoreclose ............................................................................................................................. 6-7
6.3.9 RxGOOSE status .................................................................................................................... 6-7
6.3.10 RxGOOSE statistics .............................................................................................................. 6-7
6.3.11 Digital counters ..................................................................................................................... 6-8
6.3.12 Selector switches.................................................................................................................. 6-8
6.3.13 FlexStates................................................................................................................................. 6-8
6.3.14 Ethernet .................................................................................................................................... 6-8
6.3.15 Real time clock synchronizing........................................................................................ 6-9
6.3.16 Direct inputs............................................................................................................................ 6-9
6.3.17 Direct devices status ........................................................................................................6-10
6.3.18 EGD protocol status ..........................................................................................................6-10
6.3.19 Teleprotection channel tests ........................................................................................6-11
6.3.20 Incipient fault detector ....................................................................................................6-11
6.3.21 Remaining connection status.......................................................................................6-12
6.3.22 Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)...........................................................................6-12
6.3.23 TxGOOSE status ..................................................................................................................6-13
6.3.24 Protocol...................................................................................................................................6-13
6.4 Metering................................................................................................................. 6-13
6.4.1 Metering conventions.......................................................................................................6-13
6.4.2 Sources....................................................................................................................................6-17
6.4.3 Tracking frequency............................................................................................................6-23
6.4.4 FlexElements.........................................................................................................................6-23
6.4.5 RxGOOSE analogs ..............................................................................................................6-23
6.4.6 Wattmetric ground fault .................................................................................................6-24
6.4.7 Transducer inputs/outputs ............................................................................................6-24
6.5 Records .................................................................................................................. 6-24
6.5.1 Fault reports .........................................................................................................................6-24
6.5.2 Event records .......................................................................................................................6-25
6.5.3 Oscillography........................................................................................................................6-27
6.5.4 Data logger ...........................................................................................................................6-27
6.5.5 Breaker maintenance.......................................................................................................6-28
6.6 Product information ............................................................................................ 6-29
6.6.1 Model information..............................................................................................................6-29
6.6.2 Firmware revisions ............................................................................................................6-29

7 COMMANDS AND 7.1 Commands menu ................................................................................................... 7-1


TARGETS 7.1.1 Virtual inputs........................................................................................................................... 7-2
7.1.2 Clear records .......................................................................................................................... 7-2
7.1.3 Set date and time................................................................................................................. 7-3
7.1.4 Relay maintenance.............................................................................................................. 7-3
7.1.5 Security ..................................................................................................................................... 7-4
7.2 Targets ..................................................................................................................... 7-5
7.2.1 Target messages .................................................................................................................. 7-5
7.2.2 Relay self-tests ...................................................................................................................... 7-6

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL vii


TABLE OF CONTENTS

8 COMMISSIONING 8.1 Testing ......................................................................................................................8-1


8.1.1 Testing underfrequency elements................................................................................8-1

9 THEORY OF 9.1 Fault locator ............................................................................................................9-1


OPERATION 9.1.1 Fault type determination...................................................................................................9-1

10 MAINTENANCE 10.1 Monitoring .............................................................................................................10-1


10.1.1 Devices with Site Targets ............................................................................................... 10-1
10.1.2 Data with Modbus Analyzer.......................................................................................... 10-1
10.2 General maintenance ..........................................................................................10-3
10.2.1 In-service maintenance.................................................................................................. 10-3
10.2.2 Out-of-service maintenance ........................................................................................ 10-3
10.2.3 Unscheduled maintenance (system interruption) .............................................. 10-3
10.3 Retrieve files ..........................................................................................................10-3
10.3.1 CyberSentry security event files.................................................................................. 10-4
10.4 Convert device settings.......................................................................................10-5
10.5 Copy settings to other device ............................................................................10-7
10.6 Compare settings .................................................................................................10-7
10.6.1 Compare against defaults ............................................................................................. 10-7
10.6.2 Compare two devices ...................................................................................................... 10-8
10.7 Back up and restore settings .............................................................................10-8
10.7.1 Back up settings .................................................................................................................10-8
10.7.2 Restore settings ............................................................................................................... 10-11
10.8 Upgrade software.............................................................................................. 10-13
10.9 Upgrade firmware ............................................................................................. 10-14
10.10 Replace front panel ........................................................................................... 10-15
10.11 Replace module ................................................................................................. 10-23
10.12 Battery................................................................................................................. 10-25
10.12.1 Replace battery................................................................................................................ 10-25
10.12.2 Dispose of battery .......................................................................................................... 10-26
10.13 Clear files and data after uninstall ................................................................ 10-29
10.14 Repairs................................................................................................................. 10-30
10.15 Storage ................................................................................................................ 10-30
10.16 Disposal............................................................................................................... 10-31

A FLEXANALOG A.1 FlexAnalog items ................................................................................................... A-1


OPERANDS

B RADIUS SERVER B.1 RADIUS server configuration ................................................................................B-1


CONFIGURATION

C COMMAND LINE C.1 Command line interface ....................................................................................... C-1


INTERFACE

D MISCELLANEOUS D.1 Warranty ................................................................................................................. D-1


D.2 Revision history ..................................................................................................... D-1

ABBREVIATIONS

viii F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


TABLE OF CONTENTS

INDEX

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL ix


TABLE OF CONTENTS

x F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 1: Introduction

Introduction

This chapter outlines safety and technical support information.

1.1 Safety symbols and definitions


Before attempting to install or use the device, review all safety indicators in this document to help prevent injury,
equipment damage, or downtime.
The following safety and equipment symbols are used in this document.

Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.

Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.

Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.

Indicates practices not related to personal injury.

1.1.1 General cautions and warnings


The following general safety precautions and warnings apply.

Ensure that all connections to the product are correct so as to avoid accidental risk of shock
and/or fire, for example such as can arise from high voltage connected to low voltage terminals.
Follow the requirements of this manual, including adequate wiring size and type, terminal torque settings, voltage,
current magnitudes applied, and adequate isolation/clearance in external wiring from high to low voltage circuits.
Use the device only for its intended purpose and application.
Ensure that all ground paths are uncompromised for safety purposes during device operation and service.
Ensure that the control power applied to the device, the alternating current (AC), and voltage input match the ratings
specified on the relay nameplate. Do not apply current or voltage in excess of the specified limits.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 1-1


FOR FURTHER ASSISTANCE CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION

Only qualified personnel are to operate the device. Such personnel must be thoroughly familiar with all safety
cautions and warnings in this manual and with applicable country, regional, utility, and plant safety regulations.
1 Hazardous voltages can exist in the power supply and at the device connection to current transformers, voltage
transformers, control, and test circuit terminals. Make sure all sources of such voltages are isolated prior to
attempting work on the device.
Hazardous voltages can exist when opening the secondary circuits of live current transformers. Make sure that
current transformer secondary circuits are shorted out before making or removing any connection to the current
transformer (CT) input terminals of the device.
For tests with secondary test equipment, ensure that no other sources of voltages or currents are connected to such
equipment and that trip and close commands to the circuit breakers or other switching apparatus are isolated,
unless this is required by the test procedure and is specified by appropriate utility/plant procedure.
When the device is used to control primary equipment, such as circuit breakers, isolators, and other switching
apparatus, all control circuits from the device to the primary equipment must be isolated while personnel are working
on or around this primary equipment to prevent any inadvertent command from this device.
Use an external disconnect to isolate the mains voltage supply.
Personal safety can be affected if the product is physically modified by the end user. Modifications to the product
outside of recommended wiring configuration, hardware, or programming boundaries is not recommended end-use
practice. Product disassembly and repairs are not permitted. All service needs to be conducted by the factory.

LED transmitters are classified as IEC 60825-1 Accessible Emission Limit (AEL) Class 1M. Class 1M
devices are considered safe to the unaided eye. Do not view directly with optical instruments.

This product is rated to Class A emissions levels and is to be used in Utility, Substation Industrial
environments. Not to be used near electronic devices rated for Class B levels.

1.2 For further assistance


For product support, contact the information and call center as follows:
GE Grid Solutions
650 Markland Street
Markham, Ontario
Canada L6C 0M1
Worldwide telephone: +1 905 927 7070
Europe/Middle East/Africa telephone: +34 94 485 88 54
North America toll-free: 1 800 547 8629
Fax: +1 905 927 5098
Worldwide e-mail: [email protected]
Europe e-mail: [email protected]
Website: http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin
When contacting GE by e-mail, optionally include a device information file, which is generated in the EnerVista software by
clicking the Service Report button. The service report also can be generated in the field, for example with a USB cable
connected between the graphical front panel and a computer, and the Device Setup configured for the USB connection.

1-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION FOR FURTHER ASSISTANCE

Figure 1-1: Generate service report in EnerVista software

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 1-3


FOR FURTHER ASSISTANCE CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION

1-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 2: Product description

Product description

This chapter outlines the product, order codes, and specifications.

2.1 Product description


The F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System is part of the Universal Relay (UR) series of products. It is a microprocessor-
based relay that protects up to five feeders with busbar voltage measurement or up to six feeders without busbar voltage.
Overcurrent and undervoltage protection, breaker recloser, underfrequency, fault diagnostics, and remote terminal unit
(RTU) functions are provided. The F35 provides phase, neutral/ground, instantaneous and time overcurrent protection. The
time overcurrent function provides multiple curve shapes or FlexCurve™ for optimum co-ordination.
Voltage, current, and power metering are built into the relay as standard features. Current parameters are available as
total waveform root mean square (RMS) magnitude, or as fundamental frequency only RMS magnitude and angle (phasor).
Voltage harmonics and total harmonic distortion (THD) metering are also included with the relay.
Diagnostic features include a sequence of records capable of storing 1024 time-tagged events. The internal clock used for
time-tagging can be synchronized with an IRIG-B signal, using the Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) over the Ethernet
port, or using the Precision Time Protocol (PTP). This precise time stamping allows the sequence of events to be determined
throughout the system. Events can also be programmed (via FlexLogic™ equations) to trigger oscillography data capture
that can be set to record the measured parameters before and after the event for viewing on a computer. These tools
significantly reduce troubleshooting time and simplify report generation in the event of a system fault.
Several options are available for communication. An RS232 port (USB port with the graphical front panel) can be used to
connect to a computer for the programming of settings and the monitoring of actual values. The rear RS485 port allows
independent access by operating and engineering staff. It can be connected to system computers with baud rates up to
115.2 kbps. All serial ports use the Modbus RTU protocol. The IEC 60870-5-103 protocol is supported on the RS485
interface. IEC 60870-5-103, DNP, and Modbus cannot be enabled simultaneously on this interface. Also only one of the
DNP, IEC 60870-5-103, and IEC 60870-5-104 protocols can be enabled at any time on the relay. When the IEC 60870-5-103
protocol is chosen, the RS485 port has a fixed even parity and the baud rate can be either 9.6 kbps or 19.2 kbps. The
100Base-FX or 100Base-TX Ethernet interface provides fast, reliable communications in noisy environments. The Ethernet
port supports IEC 61850, Modbus/TCP, TFTP, and PTP (according to IEEE Std. 1588-2008 or IEC 61588), and it allows access
to the relay via any standard web browser (F35 web pages). The IEC 60870-5-104 protocol is supported on the Ethernet
port. The Ethernet port also supports the Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) of IEC 62439-3 (clause 4, 2012) when
purchased as an option.
Secure Routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE) is supported with software options.
Settings and actual values can be accessed from the front panel or EnerVista software.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-1


PRODUCT DESCRIPTION CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

The F35 uses flash memory technology that allows field upgrading as new features are added. Firmware and software are
upgradable.
The following single-line diagram illustrates the relay functionality using American National Standards Institute (ANSI)
device numbers.
Table 2-1: ANSI device numbers and functions supported
Device number Function Device number Function

2 27P
27X
Phase undervoltage
Auxiliary undervoltage
51N
51P
Neutral time overcurrent
Phase time overcurrent
32N Wattmetric zero-sequence directional 51_2 Negative-sequence time overcurrent
49 Thermal overload protection 52 AC circuit breaker
50DD Disturbance detector 59N Neutral overvoltage
50G Ground instantaneous overcurrent 59P Phase overvoltage
50N Neutral instantaneous overcurrent 59X Auxiliary overvoltage
50P Phase instantaneous overcurrent 79 Autoreclose
50_2 Negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent 81U Underfrequency
51G Ground time overcurrent

Figure 2-1: Single-line diagram

52 2 3 4 5

79
Same functions as breaker 1
CLOSE TRIP
Monitoring

50P 50_2 51P 51_2 49 50N 51N For breaker 1

32N 27X 27P 81U 59N 59P 59X

50G 51G Metering

Transducer
FlexElementsTM inputs

F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System


832783A1.CDR

Table 2-2: Other device functions


Function Function Function
2
Breaker arcing current (I t) Disconnect switches Non-volatile selector switch
Breaker control DNP 3.0 or IEC 60870-5-104 Oscillography
communications
Breaker flashover Ethernet Global Data protocol Setting groups (6)
Breaker restrike Event recorder Teleprotection inputs and outputs
Cold load pickup Fault detector and fault report Time synchronization over IRIG-B or IEEE
1588
Contact inputs (up to 120) FlexElements™ (16) Time synchronization over SNTP
Contact outputs (up to 72) FlexLogic equations Transducer inputs and outputs
Control pushbuttons IEC 60870-5-103 communications User-definable displays
CyberSentry™ security IEC 61850 communications User-programmable LEDs
Data logger IEC 62351-9 data and communications User-programmable pushbuttons
security

2-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SECURITY

Function Function Function


Demand Incipient cable fault detection User-programmable self-tests
Digital counters (8) Metering: current, voltage, power, energy, Virtual inputs (64)
frequency, harmonics, THD
Digital elements (48) Modbus user map Virtual outputs (96)
Direct inputs and outputs (32) Non-volatile latches VT fuse failure

2
2.2 Security
The following security features are available:
• Password security — Basic security present by default
• EnerVista security — Role-based access to various EnerVista software screens and configuration elements. The
feature is present by default in the EnerVista software.
• CyberSentry security — Advanced security available using a software option. When purchased, the option is enabled
automatically, and the default Password security and EnerVista security are disabled.

2.2.0.1 EnerVista security


The EnerVista security management system is a role-based access control (RBAC) system that allows an administrator to
manage the privileges of multiple users. This allows for access control of UR devices by multiple personnel within a
substation and conforms to the principles of RBAC as defined in ANSI INCITS 359-2004. The EnerVista security
management system is disabled by default to allow the administrator direct access to the EnerVista software after
installation. It is recommended that security be enabled before placing the device in service.
Basic password or enhanced CyberSentry security applies, depending on purchase.

2.2.0.2 Password security


Password security is a basic security feature present by default.
Two levels of password security are provided: command and setting. Use of a password for each level controls whether all
users can enter commands and/or change settings.
Two types of connection security are provided: password entry from local or remote connection. Local access is defined as
access to settings or commands via the front panel interface. This includes both keypad entry and the through a front
panel port. Remote access is defined as access to settings or commands via any rear communications port. This includes
both Ethernet and RS485 connections. These two settings are on by default and apply to all users.
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the
corresponding connection password. If the connection is to the back of the F35, the remote password is used. If the
connection is to a front panel port, the local password applies. (These two local and remote password settings are not
shown the figure.)
Password access events are logged in the Event Recorder.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-3


SECURITY CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Figure 2-2: Access control by passwords and connection type

2.2.0.3 CyberSentry security


CyberSentry security is available using software options that provide advanced security. When the option is purchased, the
basic password security is disabled automatically.
CyberSentry provides security through the following features:
• An Authentication, Authorization, Accounting (AAA) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) client that is
managed centrally, enables user attribution, provides accounting of all user activities, and uses secure standards-
based strong cryptography for authentication and credential protection. In other words, this option uses a RADIUS
server for user authentication.
• A Role-Based Access Control (RBAC) system that provides a permission model that allows access to UR device
operations and configurations based on specific roles and individual user accounts configured on the AAA server.
That is, Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator, and Observer roles are used.
• Security event reporting through the Syslog protocol for supporting Security Information Event Management (SIEM)
systems for centralized cybersecurity monitoring
• Strong encryption of all access and configuration network messages between the EnerVista software and UR devices
using the Secure Shell (SSH) protocol, the Advanced Encryption Standard (AES), and 128-bit keys in Galois Counter
Mode (GCM) as specified in the U.S. National Security Agency Suite B extension for SSH and approved by the National
Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) FIPS-140-2 standards for cryptographic systems

CyberSentry user roles


CyberSentry user roles (Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator, Observer) limit the levels of access to various UR
functions. This means that the EnerVista software allows for access to functionality based on the user’s logged in role.
Example: Administrative functions can be segmented from common operator functions, or engineering type access, all of
which are defined by separate roles so that access of UR devices by multiple personnel within a substation is allowed.
One role of one type is allowed to be logged in at a time. For example, one Operator can be logged in but not a second
Operator at the same time. This prevents subsets of settings from being changed at the same time.

2-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SECURITY

Figure 2-3: CyberSentry user roles

Administrator

Engineer

Operator

Observer Supervisor 2

842838A2.CDR

The table lists user roles and permissions.

Table 2-3: Permissions by user role with CyberSentry


Administrator Engineer Operator Supervisor Observer
Summary Complete access Complete access Command Authorizes Default role
except for menu writing
CyberSentry
Security
Device Definition R R R R R
Settings
|---------- Product Setup
|--------------- Security RW R R R R
(CyberSentry)
|--------------- Supervisory See table notes R R See table R
notes
|--------------- Display Properties RW RW R R R
|--------------- Clear Relay Records RW RW R R R
(settings)
|--------------- Communications RW RW R R R
|--------------- Modbus User Map RW RW R R R
|--------------- Real Time Clock RW RW R R R
|--------------- Oscillography RW RW R R R
|--------------- Data Logger RW RW R R R
|--------------- Demand RW RW R R R
|--------------- User-Programmable RW RW R R R
LEDs
|--------------- User-Programmable RW RW R R R
Self Tests
|--------------- Control Pushbuttons RW RW R R R
|--------------- User-Programmable RW RW R R R
Pushbuttons
|--------------- Flex state RW RW R R R
Parameters
|--------------- User-Definable RW RW R R R
Displays
|--------------- Direct I/O RW RW R R R
|--------------- Teleprotection RW RW R R R
|--------------- Installation RW RW R R R
|---------- System Setup RW RW R R R

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-5


SECURITY CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Administrator Engineer Operator Supervisor Observer


|---------- FlexLogic RW RW R R R
|---------- Grouped Elements RW RW R R R
|---------- Control Elements RW RW R R R
|---------- Inputs / Outputs RW RW R R R
|--------------- Contact Inputs RW RW R R R
|--------------- Contact Input RW RW R R R
2 threshold
|--------------- Virtual Inputs RW RW R R R
|--------------- Contact Outputs RW RW R R R
|--------------- Virtual Outputs RW RW R R R
|--------------- Resetting RW RW R R R
|--------------- Direct Inputs RW RW R R R
|--------------- Direct Outputs RW RW R R R
|--------------- Teleprotection RW RW R R R
|--------------- Direct Analogs RW RW R R R
|--------------- Direct Integers RW RW R R R
|---------- Transducer I/O RW RW R R R
|---------- Testing RW RW R R R
|---------- Front Panel Label Designer NA NA NA NA NA
|---------- Protection Summary NA NA NA NA NA
Commands RW RW RW R R
|---------- Virtual Inputs RW RW RW R R
|---------- Clear Records RW RW RW R R
|---------- Set Date and Time RW RW RW R R
User Displays R R R R R
Targets R R R R R
Actual Values R R R R R
|---------- Front Panel R R R R R
|---------- Status R R R R R
|---------- Metering R R R R R
|---------- Transducer I/O R R R R R
|---------- Records R R R R R
|---------- Product Info R R R R R
Maintenance RW RW R R R
|---------- Modbus Analyzer NA NA NA NA NA
|---------- Change front panel RW RW RW R R
|---------- Update firmware Yes No No No No
|---------- Retrieve file Yes No No No No

Table Notes:
RW = read and write access
R = read access
Supervisor = RW (default), Administrator = R (default), Administrator = RW (only if Supervisor role is disabled)
NA = the permission is not enforced by CyberSentry security

CyberSentry user authentication


The following types of authentication are supported by CyberSentry to access the UR device:

2-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ORDER CODES

• Device Authentication (local UR device authenticates)


• Server Authentication (RADIUS server authenticates)
The EnerVista software allows access to functionality that is determined by the user role, which comes either from the local
UR device or the RADIUS server.
The EnerVista software has a device authentication option on the login screen for accessing the UR device. When the
"Device" button is selected, the UR uses its local authentication database and not the RADIUS server to authenticate the
user. In this case, it uses its built-in roles (Administrator, Engineer, Supervisor, Observer, Operator, or Administrator and
Supervisor when Device Authentication is disabled) as login names and the associated passwords are stored on the UR
device. As such, when using the local accounts, access is not user-attributable.
2
In cases where user-attributable access is required especially to facilitate auditable processes for compliance reasons, use
RADIUS authentication.
When the "Server" Authentication Type option is selected, the UR uses the RADIUS server and not its local authentication
database to authenticate the user.
No password or security information is displayed in plain text by the EnerVista software or UR device, nor is such
information ever transmitted without cryptographic protection.

CyberSentry server authentication


The UR has been designed to direct automatically the authentication requests based on user names. In this respect, local
account names on the UR are considered as reserved and not used on a RADIUS server.
The UR detects automatically whether an authentication request is to be handled remotely or locally. As there are five local
accounts possible on the UR, if the user ID credential does not match one of the five local accounts, the UR forwards
automatically the request to a RADIUS server when one is provided.
If a RADIUS server is provided, but is unreachable over the network, server authentication requests are denied. In this
situation, use local UR accounts to gain access to the UR system.

2.3 Order codes


The order code is on the product label and indicates the product options applicable.
The F35 is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount or reduced-size (¾) vertical unit. It consists of the following
modules: power supply, CPU, CT/VT, contact input and output, transducer input and output, and inter-relay
communications. Module options are specified at the time of ordering.
The order codes shown here are subject to change without notice. See the web page for the product for the latest options.
The order code depends on the mounting option (horizontal or vertical) and the type of CT/VT modules (enhanced
diagnostic CT/VT modules or HardFiberTM process bus module). The process bus module provides an interface to
HardFiber Bricks.

The R-GOOSE protocol described in IEC 61850-8-1 is available through the IEC 61850 software option. R-GOOSE
security requires the CyberSentry software option.
For Japanese, the settings display in Japanese on the graphical front panel, while the keys printed on the panel are
in English.

2.3.1 Order codes with enhanced CT/VT modules


Table 2-4: F35 order codes for horizontal units
F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P ** - U ** - W/X ** Full Size Horizontal Mount
BASE UNIT F35 | | | | | | | | | | | Base Unit
CPU T | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and Three Multi-mode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC)
U | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and Two Multi-mode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC), One 10/100Base-TX
(SFP with RJ45)
V | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and Three 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
W | | | | | | | | | | RS485 with Two 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode ST + 10/100Base-TX Ethernet,
RJ-45

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-7


ORDER CODES CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P ** - U ** - W/X ** Full Size Horizontal Mount


SOFTWARE OPTIONS 00 | | | | | | | | | No Software Options
01 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
03 | | | | | | | | | IEC 61850
04 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850
A0 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1
A1 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
A3 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
A4 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
AW | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
B0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588
B1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
B3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850
B4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)

2
BW | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
D0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1
C0 | | | | | | | | | Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
C1 | | | | | | | | | PRP and Ethernet Global Data
C3 | | | | | | | | | PRP and IEC 61850
C4 | | | | | | | | | PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
CW | | | | | | | | | PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
D1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
D3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
D4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
DW | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
E0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and PRP
E1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, and Ethernet Global Data
E3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, and IEC 61850
E4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
EW | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
F0 | | | | | | | | | PRP and CyberSentry Lvl 1
F1 | | | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
F3 | | | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
F4 | | | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
FW | | | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
G0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and PRP
G1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
G3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
G4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
GW | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
J0 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103
J1 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
J3 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
J4 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
JW | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + PID controller + IEC 61850
K0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
K1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
K3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
K4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
KW | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + PID controller + IEC 61850
L0 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
L1 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD
L3 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
L4 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD + IEC 61850
LW | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + PID controller + IEC 61850
MOUNT/COATING H | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack)
A | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack) with harsh environmental coating
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE C | | | | | | | English display
D | | | | | | | French display
R | | | | | | | Russian display
A | | | | | | | Chinese display
P | | | | | | | English display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
G | | | | | | | French display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
S | | | | | | | Russian display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
B | | | | | | | Chinese display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
K | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
W | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Y | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
I | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display
J | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
H | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Polish display
O | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Polish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
E | | | | | | | 7" Graphical front panel display in multiple languages with USB front port and user-
programmable pushbuttons (English, French, Chinese, Russian, Turkish, German,
Polish, Japanese)
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
(redundant supply must H | | | | | RH 125 / 250 V AC/DC with redundant 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
be same type as main supply) L | | | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
L | | | | | RL 24 to 48 V (DC only) with redundant 24 to 48 V DC power supply
ENHANCED DIAGNOSTICS CT/VT | | XX | XX | No DSP module (rear slots M and U only)
DSP 8L | 8L | 8L | Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
(requires all DSP to be enhanced 8M | 8M | 8M | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
diagnostic) 8N | 8N | 8N | Standard 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
8R | 8R | 8R | Sensitive Ground 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
8V | | | | | Standard 8VT with enhanced diagnostics (only one module supported)

2-8 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ORDER CODES

F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P ** - U ** - W/X ** Full Size Horizontal Mount


CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX XX XX No Module
4A 4A 4A 4A 4A 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4B 4B 4B 4B 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4C 4C 4C 4C 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 4D 4D 4D 4D 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a case)
4L 4L 4L 4L 4L 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 67 67 67 67 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 6A 6A 6A 6A 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6B 6B 6B 6B 6B 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6C 6C 6C 6C 6C 8 Form-C outputs
6D 6D 6D 6D 6D 16 Contact inputs
6E 6E 6E 6E 6E 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6F 6F 6F 6F 6F 8 Fast Form-C outputs

2
6G 6G 6G 6G 6G 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6H 6H 6H 6H 6H 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6K 6K 6K 6K 6K 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 6L 6L 6L 6L 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6M 6M 6M 6M 6M 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6N 6N 6N 6N 6N 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6P 6P 6P 6P 6P 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6R 6R 6R 6R 6R 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6S 6S 6S 6S 6S 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6T 6T 6T 6T 6T 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6U 6U 6U 6U 6U 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6V 6V 6V 6V 6V 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8
contact inputs
6W 6W 6W 6W 6W 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
6X 6X 6X 6X 6X 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS 5A 5A 5A 5A 5A 4 DCmA inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
(select a maximum of 3 per unit) 5C 5C 5C 5C 5C 8 RTD inputs
5D 5D 5D 5D 5D 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
5E 5E 5E 5E 5E 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA inputs
5F 5F 5F 5F 5F 8 DCmA inputs
INTER-RELAY 2A C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
COMMUNICATIONS 2B C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2E Bi-phase, single channel
2F Bi-phase, dual channel
2G IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
2I Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode,
Laser
2J Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode,
Laser
72 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
74 Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
75 Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode Laser
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
7E Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
7L Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode, LED
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels

Table 2-5: F35 order codes for reduced-size vertical units


F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
BASE UNIT F35 | | | | | | | | | Base Unit
CPU T | | | | | | | | RS485 and Three Multi-mode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC)
U | | | | | | | | RS485 and Two Multi-mode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC), One 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
V | | | | | | | | RS485 and Three 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
W | | | | | | | | RS485 with Two 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode ST + 10/100Base-TX Ethernet, RJ-45
SOFTWARE OPTIONS 00 | | | | | | | No Software Options
01 | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
03 | | | | | | | IEC 61850
04 | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850
A0 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1
A1 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
A3 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
A4 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
AW | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
B0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588
B1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
B3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850
B4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
BW | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
C0 | | | | | | | Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
C1 | | | | | | | PRP and Ethernet Global Data
C3 | | | | | | | PRP and IEC 61850
C4 | | | | | | | PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
CW | | | | | | | PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-9


ORDER CODES CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
D0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1
D1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
D3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
D4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
DW | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
E0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and PRP
E1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, and Ethernet Global Data
E3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, and IEC 61850
E4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
EW | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
F0 | | | | | | | PRP and CyberSentry Lvl 1
F1 | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
F3 | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850

2
F4 | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
FW | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
G0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and PRP
G1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
G3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
G4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
GW | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
J0 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103
J1 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
J3 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
J4 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
JW | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + PID controller + IEC 61850
K0 | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
K1 | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
K3 | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
K4 | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
KW | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + PID controller + IEC 61850
L0 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
L1 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD
L3 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
L4 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD + IEC 61850
LW | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + PID controller + IEC 61850
MOUNT/COATING V | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack)
B | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack) with harsh environmental coating
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE F | | | | | English display
D | | | | | French display
R | | | | | Russian display
A | | | | | Chinese display
K | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
W | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Y | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
I | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display
J | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
L | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
ENHANCED DIAGNOSTICS CT/VT DSP XX | XX | No DSP module (rear slots M and U only)
(requires all DSP to be enhanced 8L | 8L | Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
diagnostic) 8M | 8M | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
8N | 8N | Standard 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
8R | 8R | Sensitive Ground 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
8V | | | Standard 8VT with enhanced diagnostics (only one module supported)
CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX No Module
4A 4A 4A 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4B 4B 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4C 4C 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 4D 4D 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a case)
4L 4L 4L 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 67 67 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 6A 6A 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6B 6B 6B 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6C 6C 6C 8 Form-C outputs
6D 6D 6D 16 Contact inputs
6E 6E 6E 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6F 6F 6F 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 6G 6G 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6H 6H 6H 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6K 6K 6K 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 6L 6L 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6M 6M 6M 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6N 6N 6N 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6P 6P 6P 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6R 6R 6R 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6S 6S 6S 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6T 6T 6T 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6U 6U 6U 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6V 6V 6V 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8 contact inputs
6W 6W 6W 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
6X 6X 6X 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS 5A 5A 5A 4 DCmA inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
(select a maximum of 3 per unit) 5C 5C 5C 8 RTD inputs
5D 5D 5D 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
5E 5E 5E 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA inputs
5F 5F 5F 8 DCmA inputs
INTER-RELAY 2A C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
COMMUNICATIONS 2B C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2E Bi-phase, single channel
For the last module, rear slot P is used for digital and transducer 2F Bi-phase, dual channel
2G IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
input/output modules; rear slot R is used for inter-relay 2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
communications modules. 2I Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
2J Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
72 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel

2-10 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ORDER CODES

F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
74 Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
75 Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode Laser
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
7E Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels

2
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
7L Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode, LED
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels

2.3.2 Order codes with process bus modules


Table 2-6: F35 order codes for horizontal units with process bus
F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P ** - U ** - W/X ** Full Size Horizontal Mount
BASE UNIT F35 | | | | | | | | | | | Base Unit
CPU T | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and Three Multi-mode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC)
U | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and Two Multi-mode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC), One 10/100Base-TX
(SFP with RJ45)
V | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and Three 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
W | | | | | | | | | | RS485 with Two 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode ST + 10/100Base-TX Ethernet,
RJ-45
SOFTWARE OPTIONS 00 | | | | | | | | | No Software Options
01 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
03 | | | | | | | | | IEC 61850
04 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850
A0 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1
A1 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
A3 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
A4 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
AW | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
B0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588
B1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
B3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850
B4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
BW | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
C0 | | | | | | | | | Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
C1 | | | | | | | | | PRP and Ethernet Global Data
C3 | | | | | | | | | PRP and IEC 61850
C4 | | | | | | | | | PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
CW | | | | | | | | | PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
D0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1
D1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
D3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
D4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
DW | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
E0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and PRP
E1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, and Ethernet Global Data
E3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, and IEC 61850
E4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
EW | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
F0 | | | | | | | | | PRP and CyberSentry Lvl 1
F1 | | | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
F3 | | | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
F4 | | | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
FW | | | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
G0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and PRP
G1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
G3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
G4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
GW | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
J0 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103
J1 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
J3 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
J4 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
JW | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + PID controller + IEC 61850
K0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
K1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
K3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
K4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
KW | | | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + PID controller + IEC 61850
L0 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
L1 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD
L3 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
L4 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD + IEC 61850
LW | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + PID controller + IEC 61850

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-11


ORDER CODES CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P ** - U ** - W/X ** Full Size Horizontal Mount


MOUNT/COATING H | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack)
A | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack) with harsh environmental coating
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE C | | | | | | | English display
D | | | | | | | French display
R | | | | | | | Russian display
A | | | | | | | Chinese display
P | | | | | | | English display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
G | | | | | | | French display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
S | | | | | | | Russian display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
B | | | | | | | Chinese display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
K | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display

2
U | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
W | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Y | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
I | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display
J | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
H | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Polish display
O | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Polish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
E | | | | | | | 7" Graphical front panel display in multiple languages with USB front port and
user-programmable pushbuttons (English, French, Chinese, Russian, Turkish,
German, Polish, Japanese)
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
(redundant supply must H | | | | | RH 125 / 250 V AC/DC with redundant 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
be same type as main supply) L | | | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
L | | | | | RL 24 to 48 V (DC only) with redundant 24 to 48 V DC power supply
PROCESS BUS MODULE | 81 | | | | Eight-port digital process bus module
CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX XX XX No Module
4A 4A | 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4B | 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4C | 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 4D | 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a case)
4L 4L | 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 67 | 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 6A | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6B 6B | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6C 6C | 8 Form-C outputs
6D 6D | 16 Contact inputs
6E 6E | 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6F 6F | 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 6G | 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6H 6H | 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6K 6K | 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 6L | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6M 6M | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6N 6N | 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6P 6P | 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6R 6R | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6S 6S | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6T 6T | 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6U 6U | 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6V 6V | 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8
contact inputs
6W 6W | 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
6X 6X | 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
INTER-RELAY 2A C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
COMMUNICATIONS 2B C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2E Bi-phase, single channel
2F Bi-phase, dual channel
2G IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
2I Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode,
Laser
2J Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode,
Laser
72 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
74 Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
75 Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode Laser
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
7E Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
7L Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode, LED
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels

2-12 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ORDER CODES

Table 2-7: F35 order codes for reduced-size vertical units with process bus
F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
BASE UNIT F35 | | | | | | | | | Base Unit
CPU T | | | | | | | | RS485 and Three Multi-mode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC)
U | | | | | | | | RS485 and Two Multi-mode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC), One 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
V | | | | | | | | RS485 and Three 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
W | | | | | | | | RS485 with Two 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode ST + 10/100Base-TX Ethernet, RJ-45
SOFTWARE OPTIONS 00 | | | | | | | No Software Options
01 | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
03 | | | | | | | IEC 61850
04 | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850
A0 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1
A1 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)

2
A3 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
A4 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
AW | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
B0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588
B1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
B3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850
B4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
BW | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
C0 | | | | | | | Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
C1 | | | | | | | PRP and Ethernet Global Data
C3 | | | | | | | PRP and IEC 61850
C4 | | | | | | | PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
CW | | | | | | | PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
D0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1
D1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
D3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
D4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
DW | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850 and PID controller
E0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and PRP
E1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, and Ethernet Global Data
E3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, and IEC 61850
E4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
EW | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
F0 | | | | | | | PRP and CyberSentry Lvl 1
F1 | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
F3 | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
F4 | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
FW | | | | | | | PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
G0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 and PRP
G1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
G3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
G4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
GW | | | | | | | IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
J0 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103
J1 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
J3 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
J4 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
JW | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + PID controller + IEC 61850
K0 | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
K1 | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
K3 | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
K4 | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
KW | | | | | | | IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + PID controller + IEC 61850
L0 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
L1 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD
L3 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
L4 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD + IEC 61850
LW | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + PID controller + IEC 61850
MOUNT/COATING V | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack)
B | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack) with harsh environmental coating
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE F | | | | | English display
D | | | | | French display
R | | | | | Russian display
A | | | | | Chinese display
K | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
W | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Y | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
I | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display
J | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-13


ORDER CODES CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

F35 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
L | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
CT/VT MODULES | 81 | | Eight-port digital process bus module
CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX No Module
4A 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a case)
4L 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6B 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6C 8 Form-C outputs

2
6D 16 Contact inputs
6E 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6F 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6H 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6K 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6M 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6N 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6P 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6R 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6S 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6T 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6U 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6V 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8 contact inputs
6W 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
6X 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
INTER-RELAY 2A C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
COMMUNICATIONS 2B C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2E Bi-phase, single channel
For the last module, rear slot P is used for digital and transducer 2F Bi-phase, dual channel
2G IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
input/output modules; rear slot R is used for inter-relay 2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
communications modules. 2I Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
2J Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
72 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
74 Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
75 Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode Laser
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
7E Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
7L Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode, LED
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels

2.3.3 Replacement modules


Replacement modules can be ordered separately. When ordering a replacement CPU module or front panel, provide the
serial number of your existing unit.
Not all replacement modules apply to the F35 relay. The modules specified in the order codes for the F35 are available as
replacement modules for the F35.
The order codes shown here are subject to change without notice. See the web page for the product for the latest options.
Table 2-8: UR order codes for replacement modules, horizontal units
UR - ** - *
POWER SUPPLY | SH A| 125 / 300 V AC/DC
redundant supply only available in horizontal | SL H| 24 to 48 V (DC only)
units and must be same type as main supply
CPU | T | RS485 with 3 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode, SFP with LC
| U | RS485 with 1 100Base-TX Ethernet, SFP RJ-45 + 2 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode, SFP with LC
| V | RS485 with 3 100Base-TX Ethernet, SFP with RJ-45
| W | RS485 with 2 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode ST + 10/100Base-TX Ethernet, RJ-45

2-14 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ORDER CODES

UR - ** - *
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE | 3C | Horizontal front panel with keypad and English display
| 3D | Horizontal front panel with keypad and French display
| 3R | Horizontal front panel with keypad and Russian display
| 3A | Horizontal front panel with keypad and Chinese display
| 3P | Horizontal front panel with keypad, user-programmable pushbuttons, and English display
| 3G | Horizontal front panel with keypad, user-programmable pushbuttons, and French display
| 3S | Horizontal front panel with keypad, user-programmable pushbuttons, and Russian display
| 3B | Horizontal front panel with keypad, user-programmable pushbuttons, and Chinese display
| 3K | Enhanced front panel with English display
| 3M | Enhanced front panel with French display
| 3Q | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
| 3U | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
| 3L | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons

2
| 3N | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3T | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3V | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3I | Enhanced front panel with German display
| 3J | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3H | Enhanced front panel with Polish display
| 3O | Enhanced front panel with Polish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3Z | Enhanced front panel with Japanese display
| 3X | Enhanced front panel with Japanese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3E | 7" Graphical front panel display in multiple languages with USB front port and user-programmable pushbuttons
CONTACT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS | 4A | 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
| 4B | 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
| 4C | 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
| 4D | 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing
| 4L | 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
| 67 | 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
| 6A | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6B | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6C | 8 Form-C outputs
| 6D | 16 Contact inputs
| 6E | 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6F | 8 Fast Form-C outputs
| 6G | 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6H | 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6K | 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
| 6L | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6M | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6N | 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6P | 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6R | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6S | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6T | 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6U | 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6V | 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6W | 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
| 6X | 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
CT/VT MODULES | 8L | Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
(not available for the C30) | 8N | Standard 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8M | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8R | Sensitive Ground 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8V | Standard 8VT with enhanced diagnostics (only one module supported)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS | 2A | C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
| 2B | C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
| 2E | Bi-phase, single channel
| 2F | Bi-phase, dual channel
| 2G | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 2H | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 2I | Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, multimode, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 2J | Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, multimode, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 72 | 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
| 73 | 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
| 74 | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 75 | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode Laser
| 76 | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 77 | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7A | 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 7B | 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 7C | 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
| 7D | 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
| 7E | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode
| 7F | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
| 7G | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
| 7H | 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7I | 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7J | 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
| 7K | 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
| 7L | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode, LED
| 7M | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
| 7N | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
| 7P | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 7Q | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
| 7R | G.703, 1 Channel
| 7S | G.703, 2 Channels
| 7T | RS422, 1 Channel
| 7W | RS422, 2 Channels
TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS | 5A | 4 DCmA inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
| 5C | 8 RTD inputs
| 5D | 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
| 5E | 4 DCmA inputs, 4 RTD inputs
| 5F | 8 DCmA inputs

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-15


ORDER CODES CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Table 2-9: UR order codes for replacement modules, vertical units


UR - ** - *
POWER SUPPLY | SH B| 125 / 300 V AC/DC
| SL V| 24 to 48 V (DC only)
CPU | T | RS485 with 3 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode, SFP with LC
| U | RS485 with 1 100Base-TX Ethernet, SFP RJ-45 + 2 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode, SFP with LC
| V | RS485 with 3 100Base-TX Ethernet, SFP with RJ-45
| W | RS485 with 2 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode ST + 10/100Base-TX Ethernet, RJ-45
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE | 3F | Vertical front panel with keypad and English display
| 3D | Vertical front panel with keypad and French display
| 3R | Vertical front panel with keypad and Russian display
| 3A | Vertical front panel with keypad and Chinese display
| 3K | Enhanced front panel with English display

2
| 3M | Enhanced front panel with French display
| 3Q | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
| 3U | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
| 3L | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3N | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3T | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3V | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3I | Enhanced front panel with German display
| 3J | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS | 4A | 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
| 4B | 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
| 4C | 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
| 4D | 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing
| 4L | 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
| 67 | 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
| 6A | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6B | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6C | 8 Form-C outputs
| 6D | 16 Contact inputs
| 6E | 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6F | 8 Fast Form-C outputs
| 6G | 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6H | 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6K | 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
| 6L | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6M | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6N | 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6P | 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6R | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6S | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6T | 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6U | 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6V | 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6W | 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
| 6X | 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
CT/VT MODULES | 8L | Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
(not available for the C30) | 8N | Standard 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8M | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8R | Sensitive Ground 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8V | Standard 8VT with enhanced diagnostics
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS | 2A | C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
| 2B | C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
| 2E | Bi-phase, single channel
| 2F | Bi-phase, dual channel
| 2G | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 2H | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 2I | Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, multimode, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 2J | Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, multimode, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 72 | 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
| 73 | 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
| 74 | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 75 | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode Laser
| 76 | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 77 | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7A | 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 7B | 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 7C | 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
| 7D | 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
| 7E | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode
| 7F | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
| 7G | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
| 7H | 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7I | 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7J | 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
| 7K | 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
| 7L | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode, LED
| 7M | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
| 7N | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
| 7P | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 7Q | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
| 7R | G.703, 1 Channel
| 7S | G.703, 2 Channels
| 7T | RS422, 1 Channel
| 7W | RS422, 2 Channels
TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS | 5A | 4 DCmA inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
| 5C | 8 RTD inputs
| 5D | 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
| 5E | 4 DCmA inputs, 4 RTD inputs
| 5F | 8 DCmA inputs

2-16 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SIGNAL PROCESSING

2.4 Signal processing


2.4.1 UR signal processing
The URs are microprocessor-based protective relays that are designed to measure power system conditions directly via CT
and VT inputs and via other sources of information, such as analog inputs, communications inputs, and contact inputs. The
following figure shows the overall signal processing in URs.
An analog low pass anti-aliasing filter with a 3 dB corner frequency is set at 2.4 kHz and is used for current and voltage
2
analog filtering as well as signal conditioning. The same filtering is applied for phase, ground currents, phase-to-phase
(when applicable), and auxiliary voltages. The 2.4 kHz cut-off frequency applies to both 50 and 60 Hz applications and fixed
in the hardware, and thus is not dependent on the system nominal frequency setting.
Figure 2-4: UR signal processing

Analog low- Analog-to- Digital band- Phasor


Analog Inputs Digital estimation
pass filter pass filter
Converter
½ cycle Fundamen
U A Fourier tal freq.
Phasors,
From 1 cycle Seq. com-
CT/VT Fourier ponents
I Frequency
D
T
RMS
values
Synchro-
Sampling phasors Analog Outputs
DSP module frequency filtering
module

Tracking
HMI frequency Events
Protection
Ethernet selection,
algorithms Control
ports estimation Comtrade, data
I> elements,
Communi-
monitoring logger
Serial cation Z<

Serial
ports protocols U< elements,
FlexLogic, DNP, Modbus,
IEC60870
IRIG-B
Accurate
IEEE Real-Time Time stamping PMU (IEEE C37.118,

Ethernet
1588 clock Synchrophasors Aggregation, IEC 61850-90-5)
SNTP calculations post-filtering IEC 61850 (GOOSE,
CPU module MMS Server)
Contact Inputs

Analog Inputs

Inter-relay
Inter-relay

comms
module

module

module
comms

module
Ddebounce Channel A
filtering monitoring
CRC check D Contact Outputs
module

G.703, RS-422,
Optoisolated C37.94, direct fiber DCmA, RTD
859740A1.vsd

The UR samples its AC signals at 64 samples per cycle, that is, at 3840 Hz in 60 Hz systems, and 3200 Hz in 50 Hz systems.
The sampling rate is adjusted dynamically to the actual system frequency by an accurate and fast frequency tracking
system.
The analog/digital converter has the following ranges of AC signals:

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-17


SIGNAL PROCESSING CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Voltages:

Eq. 2-1

Currents:

Eq. 2-2

2 Current harmonics are estimated based on raw samples with the use of the full-cycle Fourier filter. Harmonics 2nd through
25th are estimated.
True RMS value for the current is calculated on a per-phase basis. The true RMS can be used for demand recording or as an
input signal to Time Overcurrent function, if the latter is intended for thermal protection. The true RMS is calculated as per
the widely accepted definition:

Eq. 2-3

RMS values include harmonics, inter-harmonics, DC components, and so on, along with fundamental frequency values.
The true RMS value reflects thermal effects of the current and is used for the thermal related monitoring and protection
functions.
Protection and control functions respond to phasors of the fundamental and/or harmonic frequency components
(magnitudes and angles), with an exception for some functions that have an option for RMS or fundamental
measurements, or some function responding to RMS only. This type of response is explained typically in each element's
section in this instruction manual.
Currents are pre-filtered using a Finite Impulse Response (FIR) digital filter. The filter is designed to reject DC components
and low-frequency distortions, without amplifying high-frequency noise. This filter is referred to as a modified MIMIC filter,
which provides excellent filtering and overall balance between speed and accuracy of filtering. The filter is cascaded with
the full-cycle Fourier filter for the current phasor estimation.
Voltages are pre-filtered using a patented FIR digital filter. The filter has been optimized to reject voltage-transformer-
specific distortions, such as Capacitive Voltage Transformer (CVT) noise and high-frequency oscillatory components. The
filter is cascaded with the half-cycle Fourier filter for the voltage phasor estimation.
The URs measure power system frequency using the Clarke transformation by estimating the period of the waveform from
two consecutive zero-crossings in the same direction (negative-to-positive). Voltage or current samples are pre-filtered
using a Finite Impulse Response (FIR) digital filter to remove high frequency noise contained in the signal. The period is
used after several security conditions are met, such as true RMS signal must be above 6% nominal for a certain time. If
these security conditions are not met, the last valid measurement is used for a specific time after which the UR reverts to
nominal system frequency.
Synchrophasors are calculated using a patented convolution integral algorithm. This algorithm allows use of the same
time-stamped samples, which are used for protection and taken at the same sampling frequency. This allows URs to use
one sampling clock for both protection algorithms and synchrophasors.
Synchrophasors on firmware versions 7.23 and up have been tested and certified to meet IEEE C37.118-2011 and
C37.118.1a-2014 standards for both metering and protection classes with outputs available up to 60 synchrophasors per
second for the metering class and 120 synchrophasors per second for the protection class. Synchrophasors measurement
is also available via IEC 61850-90-5 protocol.
The contact inputs threshold is settable in the firmware with 17, 33, 84, and 166 V DC settings available. Inputs are scanned
every 0.5 ms and can be conditioned for the critical applications, using debounce time timer, settable from 0.0 to 16.0 ms.
Contact inputs with auto-burnishing are available as well, when external contacts are exposed to the contamination in a
harsh industrial environment.
All measured values are available in the UR metering section on the front panel and via communications protocols.
Measured analog values and binary signals can be captured in COMTRADE format with sampling rates from 8 to 64
samples per power cycle. Analog values can be captured with the Data Logger, allowing much slower rates extended over
a long period of time.

2-18 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

Other advanced UR order code options are available to support IEC 61850 (including fast GOOSE, ICD/CID/IID files, and so
on), IEEE 1588 (IEEE C37.238 power profile) based time synchronization, CyberSentry (advanced cyber security), the Parallel
Redundancy Protocol (PRP), IEC 60870-5-103, and so on.

2.5 Specifications
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
2
2.5.1 Protection elements
The operating times include the activation time of a trip rated form-A output contact unless otherwise indicated. FlexLogic
operands of a given element are 4 ms faster. Take this into account when using FlexLogic to interconnect with other
protection or control elements of the relay, building FlexLogic equations, or interfacing with other intelligent electronic
devices (IEDs) or power system devices via communications or different output contacts. If not specified, the operate times
given here are for a 60 Hz system at nominal system frequency. Operate times for a 50 Hz system are 1.2 times longer.

PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND TOC
Current: Phasor or RMS
Pickup level: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97% to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy:
0.1 to 2.0  CT: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated (whichever is greater)
> 2.0  CT: ±1.5% of reading > 2.0  CT rating
Curve shapes: IEEE Moderately/Very/Extremely Inverse; IEC (and BS) A/B/C and Short Inverse; GE IAC Inverse,
Short/Very/ Extremely Inverse; I2t; FlexCurves™ (programmable); Definite Time (0.01 s base
curve)
Curve multiplier: Time Dial = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01
Reset type: Instantaneous/Timed (per IEEE)
Curve timing accuracy at 1.03 to 20 x pickup:
±3.5% of operate time or ±½ cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Voltage restraint: Modifies pickup current for voltage in the range of 0.1 < V < 0.9 VT Nominal in a fixed linear rela-
tionship

PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND IOC
Pickup level: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy:
0.1 to 2.0  CT rating: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated (whichever is greater)
> 2.0  CT rating: ±1.5% of reading
Overreach: <2%
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Operate time: <16 ms at 3  pickup at 60 Hz (Phase/Ground IOC)
<20 ms at 3  pickup at 60 Hz (Neutral IOC)
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is greater)

NEGATIVE SEQUENCE TOC


Pickup level: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97% to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated (whichever is greater)
from 0.1 to 2.0 x CT rating
±1.5% of reading > 2.0 x CT rating

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-19


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Curve shapes: IEEE Moderately/Very/Extremely Inverse; IEC (and BS) A/B/C and Short Inverse; GE IAC Inverse,
Short/Very/ Extremely Inverse; I2t; FlexCurves™ (programmable); Definite Time (0.01 s base
curve)
Curve multiplier (Time dial): 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01
Reset type: Instantaneous/Timed (per IEEE) and Linear
Curve timing accuracy
at 1.03 to 20 x pickup: ±3.5% of operate time or ±½ cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate

2 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE IOC


Pickup level: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: 0.1 to 2.0  CT rating: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated (whichever is greater); >2.0  CT rating:
±1.5% of reading
Overreach: <2%
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Operate time: <20 ms at 3  pickup at 60 Hz
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is greater)

WATTMETRIC ZERO-SEQUENCE DIRECTIONAL


Measured power: zero-sequence
Number of elements: 4
Characteristic angle: 0 to 360° in steps of 1
Minimum power: 0.001 to 1.200 pu in steps of 0.001
Pickup level accuracy: ±1% or ±0.0025 pu, whichever is greater
Hysteresis: 3% or 0.001 pu, whichever is greater
Pickup delay: definite time (0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01), inverse time, or FlexCurve
Inverse time multiplier: 0.01 to 2.00 s in steps of 0.01
Curve timing accuracy: ±3.5% of operate time or ±1 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Operate time: <30 ms at 60 Hz

PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 102 to 103% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Curve shapes: GE IAV Inverse;
Definite Time (0.1 s base curve)
Curve multiplier: Time dial = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01
Curve timing accuracy at <0.90 x pickup:
±3.5% of operate time or ±1/2 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Operate time: <30 ms at 0.9 pickup at 60 Hz for Definite Time mode

AUXILIARY UNDERVOLTAGE
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 102 to 103% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Curve shapes: GE IAV Inverse, Definite Time
Curve multiplier: Time Dial = 0 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01
Curve timing accuracy at <0.90 x pickup:
±3.5% of operate time or ±1/2 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Operate time: <30 ms at 0.9 pickup at 60 Hz for Definite Time mode

PHASE OVERVOLTAGE
Voltage: Phasor only
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s

2-20 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

Operate time: <30 ms at 1.10  pickup at 60 Hz


Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is greater)

NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01 (definite time) or user-defined curve
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Curve timing accuracy at >1.1 pickup: ±3.5% of operate time or ±1 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate 2
Operate time: <30 ms at 1.10 pickup at 60 Hz

AUXILIARY OVERVOLTAGE
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Pickup delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is greater)
Operate time: <30 ms at 1.10  pickup at 60 Hz

UNDERFREQUENCY
Minimum signal: 0.10 to 1.25 pu in steps of 0.01
Pickup level: 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01
Dropout level: pickup + 0.03 Hz
Level accuracy: ±0.001 Hz
Time delay: 0 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is greater)
Operate time: typically 4 cycles at 0.1 Hz/s change
typically 3.5 cycles at 0.3 Hz/s change
typically 3 cycles at 0.5 Hz/s change
Typical times are average operate times including variables, such as frequency change instance, and test method, and can vary by ±0.5
cycles.

BREAKER ARCING CURRENT


Principle: accumulates breaker duty (I2t) and measures fault duration
Initiation: programmable per phase from any FlexLogic operand
Compensation for auxiliary relays: 0 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Alarm threshold: 0 to 50000 kA2-cycle in steps of 1
Fault duration accuracy: 0.25 of a power cycle
Availability: 1 per CT bank with a minimum of 2

BREAKER FLASHOVER
Operating quantity: phase current, voltage, and voltage difference
Pickup level voltage: 0.004 to 1.500 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level voltage: 97 to 98% of pickup
Pickup level current: 0.020 to 1.500 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level current: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% or ±0.1% of rated, whichever is greater
Pickup delay: 0 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±42 ms, whichever is greater
Operate time: <42 ms at 1.10  pickup at 60 Hz

BREAKER RESTRIKE
Principle: detection of high-frequency overcurrent condition ¼ cycle after breaker opens
Availability: one per digital signal processor (DSP)
Pickup level: 0.1 to 2.00 pu in steps of 0.01

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-21


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Reset delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001

INCIPIENT CABLE FAULT DETECTION


Principle: detection of ½ cycle or less overcurrent condition during normal load
Availability: two per CT/VT module (not including 8Z modules)
Pickup level: 0.1 to 10.00 pu in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Operating mode: number of counts, counts per time window

2 AUTORECLOSURE
Single breaker applications, 3-pole tripping schemes
Up to four reclose attempts before lockout
Independent dead time setting before each shot
Possibility of changing protection settings after each shot with FlexLogic

THERMAL OVERLOAD PROTECTION


Thermal overload curves: IEC 255-8 curve
Base current: 0.20 to 3.00 pu in steps of 0.01
Overload (k) factor: 1.00 to 1.20 pu in steps of 0.05
Trip time constant: 0 to 1000 min. in steps of 1
Reset time constant: 0 to 1000 min. in steps of 1
Minimum reset time: 0 to 1000 min. in steps of 1
Timer accuracy (cold curve): ±100 ms or 2%, whichever is greater
Timer accuracy (hot curve): ±500 ms or 2%, whichever is greater for Ip < 0.9 × k × Ib and I / (k × Ib) > 1.1

TRIP BUS (TRIP WITHOUT FLEXLOGIC)


Number of elements: 6
Number of inputs: 16
Operate time: <2 ms at 60 Hz
Timer accuracy: ±3% or 10 ms, whichever is greater

2.5.2 User-programmable elements


FLEXLOGIC
Programming language: Reverse Polish Notation with graphical visualization (keypad programmable)
Lines of code: 1024
Internal variables: 64
Supported operations: NOT, XOR, OR (2 to 16 inputs), AND (2 to 16 inputs), NOR (2 to 16 inputs), NAND (2 to 16 inputs),
latch (reset-dominant), edge detectors, timers
Inputs: any logical variable, contact, or virtual input
Number of timers: 32
Pickup delay: 0 to 60000 (ms, sec., min.) in steps of 1
Dropout delay: 0 to 60000 (ms, sec., min.) in steps of 1

FLEXCURVES™
Number: 4 (A through D)
Reset points: 40 (0 through 1 of pickup)
Operate points: 80 (1 through 20 of pickup)
Time delay: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1

FLEX STATES
Number: up to 256 logical variables grouped under 16 Modbus addresses
Programmability: any logical variable, contact, or virtual input

FLEXELEMENTS™
Number of elements: 16
Operating signal: any analog actual value, or two values in differential mode

2-22 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

Operating signal mode: signed or absolute value


Operating mode: level, delta
Comparator direction: over, under
Pickup Level: –90.000 to 90.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Hysteresis: 0.1 to 50.0% in steps of 0.1
Delta dt: 20 ms to 60 days
Pickup and dropout delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001

NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
Type: set-dominant or reset-dominant 2
Number: 16 (individually programmed)
Output: stored in non-volatile memory
Execution sequence: as input prior to protection, control, and FlexLogic

USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDs (Enhanced and basic front panels)


Number: 48 plus trip and alarm
Programmability: from any logical variable, contact, or virtual input
Reset mode: self-reset or latched

LED TEST
Initiation: from any contact input or user-programmable condition
Number of tests: 3, interruptible at any time
Duration of full test: approximately 3 minutes
Test sequence 1: all LEDs on
Test sequence 2: all LEDs off, one LED at a time on for 1 s
Test sequence 3: all LEDs on, one LED at a time off for 1 s

USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS (Enhanced and basic front panels)


Number of displays: 16
Lines of display: 2  20 alphanumeric characters
Parameters: up to 5, any Modbus register addresses
Invoking and scrolling: keypad, or any user-programmable condition, including pushbuttons

CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS (Enhanced and basic front panels)


Number of pushbuttons: 7
Operation: drive FlexLogic operands

USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS (Optional)


Number of pushbuttons: 12 on basic front panel
16 on enhanced horizontal front panel
6 on enhanced vertical front panel
16 on graphical front panel (8 physical pushbuttons, 8 graphical interface pushbuttons)
Mode: self-reset, latched
Display message: 2 lines of 20 characters each
Drop-out timer: 0.00 to 60.00 s in steps of 0.05
Autoreset timer: 0.2 to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1
Hold timer: 0.0 to 10.0 s in steps of 0.1

SELECTOR SWITCH
Number of elements: 2
Upper position limit: 1 to 7 in steps of 1
Selecting mode: time-out or acknowledge
Time-out timer: 3.0 to 60.0 s in steps of 0.1
Control inputs: step-up and 3-bit
Power-up mode: restore from non-volatile memory or synchronize to a 3-bit control input or synch/restore mode

8-BIT SWITCH
Number of elements: 6

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-23


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Input signals: two 8-bit integers via FlexLogic operands


Control signal: any FlexLogic operand
Response time: < 8 ms at 60 Hz, < 10 ms at 50 Hz

DIGITAL ELEMENTS
Number of elements: 48
Operating signal: any FlexLogic operand
Pickup delay: 0.000 to 999999.999 s in steps of 0.001

2 Dropout delay:
Timing accuracy:
0.000 to 999999.999 s in steps of 0.001
±3% or ±4 ms, whichever is greater

2.5.3 Monitoring
OSCILLOGRAPHY
Maximum records: 64
Sampling rate: 64 samples per power cycle
Triggers: any element pickup, dropout, or operate; contact input change of state; contact output change
of state; FlexLogic equation
Data: AC input channels; element state; contact input state; contact output state
Data storage: in non-volatile memory

EVENT RECORDER
Capacity: 1024 events
Time-tag: to 1 microsecond
Triggers: any element pickup, dropout, or operate; contact input change of state; contact output change
of state; self-test events
Data storage: in non-volatile memory

DATA LOGGER
Number of channels: 1 to 16
Parameters: any available analog actual value
Sampling rate: 15 to 3600000 ms in steps of 1
Trigger: any FlexLogic operand
Mode: continuous or triggered
Storage capacity: (NN is dependent on memory)
1-second rate:
01 channel for NN days
16 channels for NN days

60-minute rate:
01 channel for NN days
16 channels for NN days

FAULT LOCATOR
Number of independent fault locators: 1 per CT bank (to a maximum of 5)
Method: single-ended
Voltage source: wye-connected VTs, delta-connected VTs and neutral voltage, delta-connected VTs and zero-
sequence current (approximation)
Maximum accuracy if: fault resistance is zero or fault currents from all line terminals are in phase
Relay accuracy: ±1.5% (V > 10 V, I > 0.1 pu)
Worst-case accuracy:
VT%error + user data
CT%error + user data
ZLine%error + user data
RELAY ACCURACY%error + 1.5%

2-24 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.4 Metering
RMS CURRENT: PHASE, NEUTRAL, AND GROUND
Accuracy at
0.1 to 2.0  CT rating: ±0.25% of reading or ±0.1% of rated (whichever is greater)
2.0  CT rating: ±1.0% of reading

RMS VOLTAGE
Accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V 2
REAL POWER (WATTS)
Accuracy at 0.1 to 1.5 x CT rating and 0.8 to 1.2 x VT rating:
±1.0% of reading at –1.0  PF < –0.8 and 0.8 < PF 10

REACTIVE POWER (VARS)


Accuracy at 0.1 to 1.5 x CT rating and 0.8 to 1.2 x VT rating:
±1.0% of reading at –0.2  PF  0.2

APPARENT POWER (VA)


Accuracy at 0.1 to 1.5 x CT rating and 0.8 to 1.2 x VT rating:
±1.0% of reading

WATT-HOURS (POSITIVE AND NEGATIVE)


Accuracy: ±2.0% of reading
Range: ±0 to 1  106 MWh
Parameters: three-phase only
Update rate: 50 ms

VAR-HOURS (POSITIVE AND NEGATIVE)


Accuracy: ±2.0% of reading
Range: ±0 to 1  106 Mvarh
Parameters: three-phase only
Update rate: 50 ms

CURRENT HARMONICS
Harmonics: 2nd to 25th harmonic: per phase, displayed as a % of f1 (fundamental frequency phasor)
THD: per phase, displayed as a % of f1
Accuracy:
HARMONICS: 1. f1 > 0.4pu: (0.20% + 0.035% / harmonic) of reading or 0.15% of 100%, whichever is greater
2. f1 < 0.4pu: as above plus %error of f1
THD: 1. f1 > 0.4pu: (0.25% + 0.035% / harmonic) of reading or 0.20% of 100%, whichever is greater
2. f1 < 0.4pu: as above plus %error of f1

VOLTAGE HARMONICS
Harmonics: 2nd to 25th harmonic: per phase, displayed as a % of f1 (fundamental frequency phasor)
THD: per phase, displayed as a % of f1
Accuracy:
HARMONICS: 1. f1 > 0.4pu: (0.20% + 0.035% / harmonic) of reading or 0.15% of 100%, whichever is greater
2. f1 < 0.4pu: as above plus %error of f1
THD: 1. f1 > 0.4pu: (0.25% + 0.035% / harmonic) of reading or 0.20% of 100%, whichever is greater
2. f1 < 0.4pu: as above plus %error of f1

FREQUENCY
Accuracy at
V = 0.8 to 1.2 pu: ±0.001 Hz (when voltage signal is used for frequency measurement)
I = 0.1 to 0.25 pu: ±0.005 Hz
I > 0.25 pu: ±0.02 Hz (when current signal is used for frequency measurement)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-25


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

DEMAND
Measurements: Phases A, B, and C present and maximum measured currents
3-Phase Power (P, Q, and S) present and maximum measured currents
Accuracy: ±2.0%

2.5.5 Inputs

2 AC CURRENT
CT rated primary: 1 to 50000 A
CT rated secondary: 1 or 5 A by connection
Relay burden: < 0.2 VA at rated secondary
Conversion range:
Standard CT: 0.02 to 46  CT rating RMS symmetrical
Sensitive Ground CT module: 0.002 to 4.6  CT rating RMS symmetrical
Current withstand: 20 ms at 250 times rated
1 sec at 100 times rated
continuous 4xInom
Short circuit rating: 150000 RMS symmetrical amperes, 250 V maximum (primary current to external CT)

AC VOLTAGE
VT rated secondary: 50.0 to 240.0 V
VT ratio: 1.00 to 24000.00
Relay burden: < 0.25 VA at 120 V
Conversion range: 1 to 275 V
Voltage withstand: continuous at 260 V to neutral
1 min/hr at 420 V to neutral

FREQUENCY
Nominal frequency setting: 25 to 60 Hz
Sampling frequency: 64 samples per power cycle
Tracking frequency range: 20 to 70 Hz

CONTACT INPUTS
Dry contacts: 1000  maximum
Wet contacts: 300 V DC maximum
Selectable thresholds: 17 V, 33 V, 84 V, 166 V
Tolerance: ±10%
Contacts per common return: 4
Recognition time: < 1 ms
Debounce time: 0.0 to 16.0 ms in steps of 0.5
Continuous current draw: 4 mA (when energized)

CONTACT INPUTS WITH AUTO-BURNISHING


Dry contacts: 1000  maximum
Wet contacts: 300 V DC maximum
Selectable thresholds: 17 V, 33 V, 84 V, 166 V
Tolerance: ±10%
Contacts per common return: 2
Recognition time: < 1 ms
Debounce time: 0.0 to 16.0 ms in steps of 0.5
Continuous current draw: 4 mA (when energized)
Auto-burnish impulse current: 50 to 70 mA
Duration of auto-burnish impulse: 25 to 50 ms

DCMA INPUTS
Current input (mA DC): 0 to –1, 0 to +1, –1 to +1, 0 to 5, 0 to 10, 0 to 20, 4 to 20 (programmable)
Input impedance: 379  ±10%

2-26 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

Conversion range: –1 to + 20 mA DC
Accuracy: ±0.2% of full scale
Type: Passive

RTD INPUTS
Types (3-wire): 100  Platinum, 100 and 120  Nickel, 10  Copper
Sensing current: 5 mA
Range: –50 to +250°C
Accuracy:
Isolation:
±2°C
36 V pk-pk 2
IRIG-B INPUT
IRIG formats accepted: B000…B007, B120…B127
IRIG control bits: IEEE Std C37.118.1-2011
Amplitude modulation: 1 to 10 V pk-pk
DC shift: TTL–Compatible
Input impedance: 50 k
Isolation: 2 kV

DIRECT INPUTS
Input points: 32
Remote devices: 16
Default states on loss of comms.: On, Off, Latest/Off, Latest/On
Ring configuration: Yes, No
Data rate: 64 or 128 kbps
CRC: 32-bit
CRC alarm:
Responding to: Rate of messages failing the CRC
Monitoring message count: 10 to 10000 in steps of 1
Alarm threshold: 1 to 1000 in steps of 1
Unreturned message alarm:
Responding to: Rate of unreturned messages in the ring configuration
Monitoring message count: 10 to 10000 in steps of 1
Alarm threshold: 1 to 1000 in steps of 1

TELEPROTECTION
Input points: 16
Remote devices: 3
Default states on loss of comms.: On, Off, Latest/Off, Latest/On
Ring configuration: No
Data rate: 64 or 128 kbps
CRC: 32-bit

2.5.6 Power supply


LOW RANGE
Nominal DC voltage: 24 to 48 V
Minimum DC voltage: 20 V
Maximum DC voltage: 75 V for SL power supply module
Voltage loss hold-up: 200 ms duration at maximum load
NOTE: Low range is DC only.

HIGH RANGE
Nominal DC voltage: 125 to 250 V
Minimum DC voltage: 88 V
Maximum DC voltage: 300 V
Nominal AC voltage: 100 to 240 V at 50/60 Hz

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-27


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Minimum AC voltage: 88 V at 25 to 100 Hz


Maximum AC voltage: 265 V at 25 to 100 Hz
Voltage loss hold-up: 200 ms duration at maximum load

ALL RANGES
Volt withstand: 2  Highest Nominal Voltage for 10 ms
Power consumption: typical = 15 to 20 W/VA
maximum = 45 W/VA

2 contact factory for exact order code consumption

INTERNAL FUSE
Ratings:
Low range power supply: 8 A / 250 V
High range power supply: 4 A / 250 V
Interrupting capacity:
AC: 100 000 A RMS symmetrical
DC: 10 000 A

2.5.7 Outputs
FORM-A RELAY
Make and carry for 0.2 s: 30 A as per ANSI C37.90
Carry continuous: 6A
Break (DC inductive, L/R = 40 ms):

Voltage Current
24 V 1A
48 V 0.5 A
125 V 0.3 A
250 V 0.2 A

Operate time: < 4 ms


Contact material: silver alloy

LATCHING RELAY
Make and carry for 0.2 s: 30 A as per ANSI C37.90
Carry continuous: 6 A as per IEEE C37.90
Break (DC resistive as per IEC61810-1):

Voltage Current
24 V 6A
48 V 1.6 A
125 V 0.4 A
250 V 0.2 A

Operate time: < 4 ms


Contact material: silver alloy
Control: separate operate and reset inputs
Control mode: operate-dominant or reset-dominant

FORM-A VOLTAGE MONITOR


Applicable voltage: approx. 15 to 250 V DC
Trickle current: approx. 1 to 2.5 mA

FORM-A CURRENT MONITOR


Threshold current: approx. 80 to 100 mA

2-28 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

FORM-C AND CRITICAL FAILURE RELAY


Make and carry for 0.2 s: 30 A as per ANSI C37.90
Carry continuous: 8A
Break (DC inductive, L/R = 40 ms):

Voltage Current
24 V 1A
48 V 0.5 A
125 V
250 V
0.3 A
0.2 A
2
Operate time: < 8 ms
Contact material: silver alloy

FAST FORM-C RELAY


Make and carry: 0.1 A max. (resistive load)
Minimum load impedance:

Input voltage Impedance


2 W Resistor 1 W Resistor
250 V DC 20 K 50 K
120 V DC 5 K 2 K
48 V DC 2 K 2 K
24 V DC 2 K 2 K
Note: values for 24 V and 48 V are the same due to a
required 95% voltage drop across the load
impedance.

Operate time: < 0.6 ms


Internal Limiting Resistor: 100  2 W

SOLID-STATE OUTPUT RELAY


Operate and release time: <100 µs
Maximum voltage: 265 V DC
Maximum leakage current in off state
(excluding voltage monitor circuit current): 100 µA
Maximum continuous current: 5 A at 45°C; 4 A at 65°C
Make and carry:
for 0.2 s: 30 A as per ANSI C37.90
for 0.03 s: 300 A
Breaking capacity:

Specification UL 508 Utility application Industrial application


(autoreclose scheme)
Operations per 5000 operations, 5 operations 10000 operations
interval 1 second on, 0.2 seconds on 0.2 seconds on
9 seconds off 0.2 seconds off 30 seconds off
within 1 minute
1000 operations
0.5 seconds on,
0.5 seconds off
Break capability 3.2 A at L/R = 10 ms 10 A at L/R = 40 ms 10 A at L/R = 40 ms
(0 to 250 V DC)
1.6 A at L/R = 20 ms
0.8 A
L/R = 40 ms

CONTROL POWER EXTERNAL OUTPUT (For dry contact input)


Capacity: 100 mA DC at 48 V DC
Isolation: ±300 Vpk

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-29


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

DIRECT OUTPUTS
Output points: 32

DCMA OUTPUTS
Range: –1 to 1 mA, 0 to 1 mA, 4 to 20 mA
Max. load resistance: 12 k for –1 to 1 mA range
12 k for 0 to 1 mA range
600  for 4 to 20 mA range

2 Accuracy: ±0.75% of full-scale for 0 to 1 mA range


±0.5% of full-scale for –1 to 1 mA range
±0.75% of full-scale for 0 to 20 mA range
99% Settling time to a step change: 100 ms
Isolation: 1.5 kV
Driving signal: any FlexAnalog quantity
Upper and lower limit for the driving signal: –90 to 90 pu in steps of 0.001

2.5.8 Communications
IEC 61850
IEC 61850: Supports IEC 61850 Editions 1.0 and 2.0. See the UR Family Communications Guide and its con-
formance statements.

RS232 (Enhanced and basic front panels)


Front port: 19.2 kbps, Modbus RTU

USB (Graphical front panel)


Front port: USB 2.0 type B

RS485
1 rear port: up to 115 kbps, Modbus RTU, DNP 3, IEC 60870-5-103
Typical distance: 1200 m
Isolation: 2 kV, isolated together at 36 Vpk

FIBER ETHERNET PORT


Parameter Fiber type
100 Mb multimode
Wavelength 1310 nm
Connector LC
Transmit power –20 dBm
Receiver sensitivity –30 dBm
Power budget 10 dB
Maximum input power –14 dBm
Typical distance 2 km
Full duplex yes
Redundancy yes

ETHERNET (10/100 MB TWISTED PAIR)


Modes: 10 Mb, 10/100 Mb (auto-detect)
Connector: RJ45

SIMPLE NETWORK TIME PROTOCOL (SNTP)


Clock synchronization error: <10 ms (typical)

PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL (PTP)


PTP IEEE Std 1588 2008 (version 2)

2-30 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

Power Profile (PP) per IEEE Standard PC37.238TM2011


Slave-only ordinary clock
Peer delay measurement mechanism

PARALLEL REDUNDANCY PROTOCOL (PRP)


(IEC 62439-3 CLAUSE 4, 2012)
Ethernet ports used: 2 and 3
Networks supported: 10/100 Mb Ethernet

OTHER 2
TFTP, SFTP, HTTP, IEC 60870-5-104, Ethernet Global Data (EGD), IEEE C37.118

2.5.9 Inter-relay communications


SHIELDED TWISTED-PAIR INTERFACE OPTIONS
Interface type Typical distance
RS422 1200 m
G.703 100 m

RS422 distance is based on transmitter power and does not take into consideration the clock source provided by
the user.

LINK POWER BUDGET AND MAXIMUM OPTICAL INPUT POWER


The following specifications apply to filter interface modules manufactured from January 2012.

Emitter, fiber type Cable type Transmit power Received Power budget Maximum
sensitivity optical input
power
820 nm, Multimode 62.5/125 μm -16 dBm -32 dBm 16 dBm -8 dBm
50/125 μm -20 dBm 12 dBm
1300 nm, Multimode 62.5/125 μm -16 dBm -32 dBm 16 dBm -8 dBm
50/125 μm -20 dBm 12 dBm
1300 nm, Single 9/125 μm -15 dBm -32 dBm 17 dBm -8 dBm
mode
1300 nm Laser, 9/125 μm 0 dBm -34 dBm 34 dBm -8 dBm
Single mode
1550 nm Laser, 9/125 μm 5 dBm -34 dBm 39 dBm -10 dBm
Single mode

The following specifications apply to filter interface modules implemented before January 2012.

Emitter, fiber type Transmit Received Power budget Maximum optical


power sensitivity input power
820 nm LED, Multimode –20 dBm –30 dBm 10 dB –7.6 dBm
1300 nm LED, Multimode –21 dBm –30 dBm 9 dB –11 dBm
1300 nm ELED, Single mode –23 dBm –32 dBm 9 dB –14 dBm
1300 nm Laser, Single mode –1 dBm –30 dBm 29 dB –14 dBm
1550 nm Laser, Single mode +5 dBm –30 dBm 35 dB –14 dBm

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-31


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

The power budgets are calculated from the manufacturer’s worst-case transmitter power and worst case receiver
sensitivity.
The power budgets for the 1300 nm ELED are calculated from the manufacturer's transmitter power and receiver
sensitivity at ambient temperature. At extreme temperatures these values deviate based on component tolerance.
On average, the output power decreases as the temperature is increased by a factor of 1 dB / 5 °C.

TYPICAL LINK DISTANCE


2 Emitter, fiber type Cable type Connector Typical distance
type
Before From
January January
2012 2012
820 nm LED, 62.5/125 μm ST 1.65 km 2 km
multimode
50/125 μm ST 1.65 km 2 km
1300 nm LED, 62.5/125 μm ST 4 km 5 km
multimode
50/125 μm ST 4 km 5 km
1300 nm ELED, 9/125 μm ST 11.4 km 20 km
single mode
1300 nm Laser, 9/125 μm ST 64 km 65 km
single mode
1550 nm Laser, 9/125 μm ST 105 km 125 km
single mode

Typical distances listed are based on the following assumptions for system loss. As actual losses vary from one
installation to another, the distance covered by your system can vary.

CONNECTOR LOSSES (Total of both ends)


ST connector: 0.7 dB (each)

FIBER LOSSES
820 nm multimode: 3 dB/km
1300 nm multimode: 1 dB/km
1300 nm single mode: 0.35 dB/km
1550 nm single mode: 0.25 dB/km
Splice losses: one splice every 2 km at 0.05 dB loss per splice

SYSTEM MARGIN
3 dB additional loss added to calculations to compensate for all other losses.

Compensated difference in transmitting and receiving (channel asymmetry) channel delays using GPS satellite clock: 10 ms

2.5.10 CyberSentry security


OPTIONS
Software options: Level 1

2.5.11 Graphical front panel


DISPLAY
Type: color graphical back-lit LCD display
Size: 7 inches (17.8 cm)
Resolution: 800 by 480 pixels

2-32 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

Pages: 5 single-line diagram pages with controls, status, and metering values
up to 8 annunciator pages with total of 96 annunciator windows
1 phasor metering page for each AC Source
5 tabular metering pages with dynamic metering and status
event records page with dynamic update
product information page
settings, actual values, error messages (targets)

LED INDICATORS
Functions: 5 device status indicators
9 event cause indicators
2
8 user-programmable pushbutton indicators

PUSHBUTTONS
Type: membrane
Functions: 5 bottom Tab pushbuttons and 1 Home pushbutton for page recall
4 directional, 1 ENTER, and 1 ESCAPE pushbutton element selection
10 side pushbuttons for power system element control
RESET pushbutton
8 physical user-programmable pushbuttons, 8 graphical interface pushbuttons

INGRESS PROTECTION
IP code: IP54 front, IP10 back (IP20 back with IP20 cover accessory)

2.5.12 Environmental
AMBIENT TEMPERATURES
Storage temperature: –40 to 85°C
Operating temperature: –40 to 60°C; the LCD contrast can be impaired at temperatures less than –20°C

HUMIDITY
Humidity: operating up to 95% (non-condensing) at 55°C (as per IEC60068-2-30 variant 1, 6 days)

OTHER
Altitude: 2000 m (maximum)
Pollution degree: II
Overvoltage category: II
Ingress protection: IP20 front, IP10 back (basic front panel and Rev. 1 enhanced front panel)
IP40 front, IP10 back (Rev. 2 enhanced front panel)
IP54 front with IP54 mounting collar accessory (Rev. 2 enhanced front panel)
Ingress protection with IP20 cover accessory:
IP20 back
Noise: 0 dB

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-33


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2.5.13 Type tests


F35 TYPE TESTS
Test Reference standard Test level
1
Dielectric voltage withstand EN 60255-5 2.2 kV
Impulse voltage withstand EN 60255-51 5 kV

2 Damped oscillatory
Electrostatic discharge
IEC 61000-4-18 / IEC 60255-22-1
EN 61000-4-2 / IEC 60255-22-2
2.5 kV CM, 1 kV DM
Level 3
RF immunity EN 61000-4-3 / IEC 60255-22-3 Level 3
Fast transient disturbance EN 61000-4-4 / IEC 60255-22-4 Class A and B
Surge immunity EN 61000-4-5 / IEC 60255-22-5 Level 3 and 4
Conducted RF immunity EN 61000-4-6 / IEC 60255-22-6 Level 3
1
Power frequency immunity EN 61000-4-7 / IEC 60255-22-7 Class A and B
Voltage interruption and ripple DC IEC 60255-11 12% ripple, 200 ms interrupts
Radiated and conducted emissions CISPR11 / CISPR22 / IEC 60255-25 Class A
Sinusoidal vibration IEC 60255-21-1 Class 1
Shock and bump IEC 60255-21-2 Class 1
Seismic IEC 60255-21-3 Class 1
Power magnetic immunity IEC 61000-4-8 Level 5
Pulse magnetic immunity IEC 61000-4-9 Level 4
Damped magnetic immunity IEC 61000-4-10 Level 4
Voltage dip and interruption IEC 61000-4-11 0, 40, 70, 80% dips; 250 / 300 cycle interrupts
Damped oscillatory IEC 61000-4-121 2.5 kV CM, 1 kV DM
Conducted RF immunity, 0 to 150 kHz IEC 61000-4-16 Level 4
Voltage ripple IEC 61000-4-17 15% ripple
1
Ingress protection IEC 60529 IP20 front, IP10 back
Cold IEC 60068-2-1 –40°C for 16 hours
Hot IEC 60068-2-2 85°C for 16 hours
Humidity IEC 60068-2-30 6 days, variant 1
Damped oscillatory IEEE/ANSI C37.90.1 2.5 kV, 1 MHz
RF immunity IEEE/ANSI C37.90.2 20 V/m, 80 MHz to 1 GHz
Safety UL 508 e83849 NKCR
Section 43 - Temperature test
Energization of Contact Inputs and/or Contact
Outputs for continuous duty is not to exceed a
total of 31 W of power
Safety UL C22.2-14 e83849 NKCR7
Safety UL 1053 e83849 NKCR
Safety IEC 60255-27 Insulation: class 1, Pollution degree: 2, Over
voltage cat II

1 Not tested by third party.

2.5.14 Production tests


THERMAL
Products go through an environmental test based upon an Accepted Quality Level (AQL) sampling process.

2-34 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS

2.5.15 Approvals
APPROVALS
Compliance Applicable council directive According to
CE Low voltage directive EN 60255-5
EMC directive EN 60255-26 / EN 50263
EN 61000-6-5
C-UL-US --- UL 508
UL 1053
2
C22.2 No. 14

2.5.16 Maintenance
MOUNTING
Attach mounting brackets using 20 inch-pounds (±2 inch-pounds) of torque.

CLEANING
Normally, cleaning is not required. When dust has accumulated on the front panel display, wipe with a dry cloth.

To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored in a de-energized
state once per year, for one hour continuously.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 2-35


SPECIFICATIONS CHAPTER 2: PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

2-36 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 3: Installation

Installation

This chapter outlines installation of hardware and software. You unpack, mount, wire the unit, turn on power, then install
the software and configure settings.

3.1 Unpack and inspect


To unpack and inspect the unit:
1. Open the relay package and check that the following items have been delivered:
– F35
– Mounting screws
– GE EnerVista™ DVD (software and documentation)
– F35 Instruction Manual (soft copy on DVD; printed copy if ordered)
– UR Family Communications Guide (soft copy on DVD; printed copy if Instruction Manual ordered)
– Certificate of Calibration
– Test Report
– EC Declaration of Conformity
– Front panel label package
2. Inspect the unit for physical damage.
3. View the rear nameplate and verify that the correct model has been delivered. The model number is at the top right.

Model: F35D00HCHF8AH6AM6BP8BX7A
RATINGS:

F35
Mods: NONE
Wiring Diagram: See manual
Multiple Feeder Management Relay Control Power: 125-250 V — 0.7A/100-240, 50/60Hz, 0.7A
Contact Inputs: 300 V ---- Max 10mA Inst. Manual: 1601-0106
Serial Number: AAIC07000515
Contact Outputs: Refer to Instruction Manual Firmware: A09MA521.000
GE Multilin E83849 Mfg. Date: NOV 12, 2012
PO Num: 600001234.56
Item Num:
® LISTED
® IND.CONT. EQ.
52TL

832772A3.CDR

4. Any protective plastic film on the front panel is normally peeled off, but also can be left on.
5. For any issues, contact GE as outlined in the For Further Assistance section in chapter 1.
6. Check that you have the latest copy of the F35 Instruction Manual and the UR Family Communications Guide, for the
applicable firmware version, at http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/manuals/index.htm

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-1


PANEL CUTOUTS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

The Instruction Manual outlines how to install, configure, and use the unit. The Communications Guide is for advanced use
with communication protocols. The warranty is included at the end of this instruction manual and on the GE Grid Solutions
website.

3.2 Panel cutouts


This section does not apply to the HardFiber Brick; see its instruction manual.
Install the relay in an indoor environment within the environmental specifications. The relay complies with Pollution
Category II, which means installation in an office, laboratory, or testing environment.

3.2.1 Horizontal units


3 The F35 is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount unit with a removable front panel. The front panel is specified as
enhanced, basic, or graphical at the time of ordering. The enhanced and graphical front panels have additional user-
programmable pushbuttons and LED indicators, while the basic front panel has additional user-programmable
pushbuttons.
The modular design allows the relay to be upgraded and repaired by qualified service personnel. The front panel is hinged
to allow access to the modules. The front panel is itself removable to allow mounting on doors with limited rear depth and
for upgrading.
In November 2017, GE began transitioning to Rev. 2 of the enhanced horizontal front panel. This panel can be identified by
the use of a screw instead of a knob to close the panel. It can conform to an IP54 rating with the IP54 mounting collar
purchased separately. The IP54 mounting collar can be used in panel-mount installations, not 19-inch rack-mount
installations. The IP54 mounting collar cannot be used with Rev. 1 enhanced front panels.
The case dimensions are shown in the following figures, along with panel cutout details for panel mounting. When
planning the location of your panel cutout, ensure that provision is made for the front panel to swing open without
interference to or from adjacent equipment.
Mount the relay such that the front panel sits semi-flush with the panel or switchgear door, allowing the operator access to
the keypad and the front communications port.

3-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION PANEL CUTOUTS

Figure 3-1: Horizontal dimensions (Rev. 1 enhanced front panel)

11.016”
[279,81 mm]
9.687”
[246,05 mm]

17.56”
[446,02 mm]
3

7.460”
[189,48 mm]
6.995” 6.960”
[177,67 mm] [176,78 mm]

19.040”
[483,62 mm] 842807A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-3


PANEL CUTOUTS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-2: Horizontal dimensions (Rev. 2 enhanced front panel)

9.687”
[24.605 cm] 10.97”
[27.86 cm]

3 17.59” [44.68 cm]

6.995” 6.96”
[17.767 cm] [17.68 cm]

18.974” [48.194 cm]


842496A1.cdr

Figure 3-3: Horizontal mounting (enhanced and graphical front panels)


18.370”
[466,60 mm]
0.280”
[7,11 mm]
Typ. x 4
CUT-OUT

7.13” 4.000”
[181.1 mm] [101,60 mm]

17.750”
[450,85 mm] 842808A2.CDR

3-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION PANEL CUTOUTS

Figure 3-4: Horizontal dimensions and mounting (basic front panel)


HORIZONTAL TOP VIEW (19” 4RU) REMOTE MOUNTING
VIEW FROM REAR OF PANEL

BEZEL OUTLINE
8x0.156”

(9.5 mm)
0.375”
(3.962 mm)

(47.6 mm)
10.90”

1.875”
8.97”
(227.8 mm) (276.8 mm)

9.80”
(248.9 mm) 6.960”

(9.5 mm)
0.375”
(176.8 mm)

(121.5 mm)
4.785”
0.375”
17.52” Brackets repositioned (9.5 mm)
(445.0 mm) for switchgear mounting 5.000” 0.375”
(127.0 mm)
9.520” (9.5 mm)
14.520” (241.8 mm)

HORIZONTAL PANEL MOUNTING


4x0.28”
(368.8 mm)
17.720”
(450.1 mm)
3
18.37” (7.1 mm
(466.6 mm) diameter)
HORIZONTAL FRONT VIEW

CUTOUT
7.13” 4.00”
(181.1 mm) (101.6 mm) 7.00”
(177.8 mm)

17.75” 19.00”
(450.8 mm) (482.6 mm)
827704B5.cdr

Figure 3-5: Horizontal dimensions (graphical front panel)

11.093”
[281,76 mm]

9.687 “
[246,05 mm]

6.995” 6.960”
[177,67 mm] [176,78 mm]

18.974”
[481,94 mm]
862700A1.cdr

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-5


PANEL CUTOUTS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-6: Horizontal dimensions (IP54 mounting collar)

MOUNTING PANEL

1.3” [3.3 cm]

3 16.00” [40.64 cm]


Ø 0.200
6 PLACES

8.34”
[21.18 cm]

7.65”
[19.43 cm]

20.19” [51.28 cm]

IP54 COLLAR

NOTES
1. INSPECT THE COLLAR BEFORE INSTALLATION, VERIFY GASKET IS ADHERED TO THE METAL ON ALL SIDES
2. MAKE SURE THE RELAY IS POSITIONED CENTER TO THE CUT OUT
3. INSTALL IP-54 COLLAR, CONFIRM THE GASKET PROPERLY MATES WITH THE PANEL ON ALL SIDES
SECURE USING #8-32 HEX NUT AT 6 PLACES. 842497A1.cdr

3.2.2 Vertical units


The F35 is available as a reduced size (¾) vertical mount unit, with a removable front panel. The front panel is specified as
enhanced or basic at the time of ordering. The enhanced front panel contains additional user-programmable pushbuttons
and LED indicators, while the basic front panel has additional user-programmable pushbuttons.
The modular design allows the relay to be upgraded and repaired by qualified service personnel. The front panel is hinged
to allow easy access to the modules. The front panel is itself removable to allow mounting on doors with limited rear depth
and for upgrading.
The case dimensions are shown in the following figures, along with panel cutout details for panel mounting. When
planning the location of your panel cutout, ensure that provision is made for the front panel to swing open without
interference to or from adjacent equipment.
Mount the relay such that the front panel sits semi-flush with the panel or switchgear door, allowing the operator access to
the keypad and the RS232 communications port.

3-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION PANEL CUTOUTS

Figure 3-7: Vertical dimensions and mounting (enhanced front panel)


Mounting Bracket Front of Panel
7.48”
(190.0 mm)

Front
Bezel

13.56”
15.00” (344.4 mm)
(381.0 mm)
3

Vertical Enhanced Side View


Front of Panel
Vertical Enhanced Front View 7.10”
(180.2 mm)
1.55” 4.00”
(39.3 mm) (101.6 mm) 0.20”
7.00” (5.1 mm)
(177.7 mm)
Terminal Blocks

14.03”
9.58” (356.2 mm) CUTOUT
(243.4 mm)
Front of Panel
Reference only 13.66”
(347.0 mm)

1.38”
(35.2 mm)
Mounting Bracket
Vertical Enhanced Top View

0.213” (5.41 mm)


4 Places Vertical Enhanced Mounting Panel
843809A2.cdr

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-7


PANEL CUTOUTS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-8: Vertical dimensions and mounting (basic front panel)


7.00"
Front of (177.8 mm)
panel Panel
Mounting bracket

Front
bezel

13.72" 13.50"
(348.5 mm) (342.9 mm)

Vertical side view


Vertical front view

7.13”
(181.1 mm)
1.85" 4.00
(47.0 mm) (101.6)
1.57” 0.46”
(39.9 mm) (11.7 mm)

Panel shown for


reference only

9.00"
(228.6 mm) Mounting bracket
(365.8 mm)

(346.7 mm)
14.40”

13.65”

Terminal blocks
7.00"
(177.8 mm)

Vertical bottom view

0.213" (5.4 mm),


4 places

843755A4.CDR Vertical panel mounting

For side-mounting F35 devices with the enhanced front panel, see the following documents available on the UR DVD and
the GE Grid Solutions website:
• GEK-113180 — UR-Series UR-V Side-Mounting Front Panel Assembly Instructions
• GEK-113181 — Connecting a Remote UR-V Enhanced Front Panel to a Vertical UR Device Instruction Sheet
• GEK-113182 — Connecting a Remote UR-V Enhanced Front Panel to a Vertically-Mounted Horizontal UR Device
Instruction Sheet

3-8 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


STEP 1 - CREATE THE HOLES AND CUT-OUT INTO THE PANEL
AS PER DRAWING 843753. PLUG THE DISPLAY CABLE INTO
THE FRONT BEZEL
#8-3/8" PAN PHILIPS HEAD
BEFORE MOUNTING THE
CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

BLACK OXIDE SCREW


UNIT ON THE PANEL
P/N: 1408-0306
#8-3/8" 8 PLACES TO MOUNT THE UNIT
PAN PHILIPS HEAD
BLACK OXIDE
#8 LOCKWASHER
SCREW
EXTERNAL TOOTH
UR 19" P/N: 1435-0002
MOUNTING #6x1/2" PAN PHILIPS 8 PLACES TO MOUNT
BRACKET HEAD
BLACK OXIDE
PLASTITE SCREW

DISPLAY CABLE

GROUND CABLE
ATTACH CABLE TO
FRONT BEZEL
BEFORE MOUNTING

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


FRONT BEZEL ON
THE
PANEL

#10-32 NYLOCK
NUT
For side-mounting F35 devices with the basic front panel, use the following figures.

P/N: 1422-1032
4 PLACES SIDE MOUNT COVER
#10-3/8" PAN PHILIPS HEAD P/N: 1004-0018
ZINC
P/N: 1410-0006 UR-V FRONT BEZEL
4 PLACES TO MOUNT THE ASSEMBLY UR-V UNIT
BRACKETS PANEL
Figure 3-9: Vertical side-mounting installation (basic front panel)

STEP 2 STEP 3 STEP 4


MOUNT BRACKETS TO MOUNT FRONT BEZEL TO ASSEMBLE UR-V UNIT
PANEL PANEL TO MOUNTING BRACKETS
843757A2.cdr

3-9
PANEL CUTOUTS

3
PANEL CUTOUTS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-10: Vertical side-mounting rear dimensions (basic front panel)

6.66"
(169.2)
5.33"
(135.4)

INCHES
(MILLIMETERS) 2.83"
1.00"
(71.9)
(25.4)
PANEL SHOWN FOR
0.68" 0.04" 1.33" REFERENCE ONLY
(17.3) (1.0) (33.9) (VIEWED FROM FRONT)

3 'X' 'X'
1.00"
(25.4)

OUT
T-
CU
5.27"
(133.8)

0.159" DIA. (6 PLACES)


(4.0)
10.05"
(255.3)

12.20"
(309.9)

'X' 'X'

0.213" DIA. (5.4) 843753A3.cdr


(4 PLACES)
SEE HOLES MARKED 'X'

3.2.3 Rear terminal layout


The rear terminals depend on order code. An example is shown.

3-10 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION PANEL CUTOUTS

Ground
Model: F35D00HCHF8AH6AM6BP8BX7A
RATINGS:

F35
Mods: NONE
Wiring Diagram: See manual
Multiple Feeder Management Relay Control Power: 125-250 V — 0.7A/100-240, 50/60Hz, 0.7A
Contact Inputs: 300 V ---- Max 10mA Inst. Manual: 1601-0106
Serial Number: AAIC07000515
Contact Outputs: Refer to Instruction Manual Firmware: A09MA521.000
GE Multilin E83849 Mfg. Date: NOV 12, 2012
PO Num: 600001234.56
Item Num:
® LISTED
® IND.CONT. EQ.
52TL

X W V U T S R P N M L K J H G F D B

c b a c b a c b a c b a

b a
LK1
Tx1 1
1
2
Rx1 2
ACT1
3
LK2
3
Tx1
4
4
5
Tx2 b a
ACT2 5
1 6

3
1
2 LK3
2 6
3
Rx2 3 7
4
4 7
8
Tx2 8
ACT3

IN

Optional Optional Optional Optional CT/VT CPU module Power


direct contact CT/VT or contact module (T module shown) supply
input/output input/output contact input/output module
module module input/output module
module
832781A3.CDR

Do not touch any rear terminals while the relay is energized, else death or serious injury can
result from electrical shock.

Small form-factor pluggable ports (SFPs) are pluggable transceivers. They transmit, receive, and
convert electrical signals to optical signals and vice-versa. Supplied with the device, they are inserted
into the Ethernet ports on the CPU module. A photo in the Maintenance chapter shows this plug-in
device. Do not use non-validated transceivers or install validated transceivers in the wrong Ethernet
slot, else damage can occur.
Terminal number assignments are three characters long and assigned by module slot position, row number, and column
letter. Two-slot wide modules take their slot designation from the first slot position (nearest to CPU module), indicated by
an arrow on the terminal block. The figure shows an example of rear terminal assignments.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-11


PANEL CUTOUTS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-11: Example of modules in F and H slots

J H G F Slot position

c b a c b a Column letter
Torque 9 inch-pounds

1 H1c H1b H1a F1c F1b F1a 1 Row number


Torque 19 ±1 inch-pounds
2 H2c H2b H2a F2c F2b F2a 2

3 H3c H3b H3a F3c F3b F3a 3

4 H4c H4b H4a F4c F4b F4a 4

5 H5c H5b H5a F5c F5b F5a 5

3 6 H6c H6b H6a F6c F6b F6a 6

7 H7c H7b H7a F7c F7b F7a 7

8 H8c H8b H8a F8c F8b F8a 8

842761A2.CDR

The torque used to connect the screws that connect the terminal blocks (top screws a, b, c) and the metal plates over
empty slots to the chassis is 9 inch-pounds. For the screws used to wire the terminal blocks (rows 1 to 8), use 19±1 inch-
pounds.
The CPU module type depends on order code. During manufacturing, the power supply and CPU modules are installed in
slots B and D of the chassis with 13 inch-pounds of torque on the screws at the top and bottom of the modules. Wire
connections to these two modules at 13 inch-pounds.
Figure 3-12: CPU modules and power supply

RS485 Ethernet (3) RS485 Ethernet (3) RS485 Ethernet (3) RS485 Ethernet (3) Power

b a
LK1 LK1 LK1
RJ-45 1
LC copper 1
fiber 2
2
ACT1 ACT1 ACT1 Link, 3
LK2 LK2 LK2 Activity 3
4
4
5
b a
ACT2
b a
ACT2
b a
ACT2
b a 5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 6
2 LK3 2 LK3 2 LK3 2
2 2 2 2 6
3 3 3 3
3 3 3 3 7
4 4 4 4
7
BNC
4 4 4 4
ST 8
for ACT3 ACT3 ACT3 fiber 8

IRIG-B
IN IN IN IN

T CPU module U CPU module V CPU module W CPU module Power supply
module
859758A1.CDR

The following figure shows the optical connectors for CPU modules.

3-12 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION PANEL CUTOUTS

Figure 3-13: LC fiber connector (left) and ST fiber connector (right)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-13


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

3.3 Wiring
3.3.1 Typical wiring
Figure 3-14: Typical wiring diagram (T module shown for CPU)
Typical configuration.
The AC signal path is configurable. Positive watts

H1a IA5 F1a

6H
I
Voltage and A B C
H1b H1 IA F1b
current supervision V
TC1 H1c
IA1 F1c
H2a I
H2b H2 IB5 F2a
V
Voltage supervision H2c F35 IB F2b
TC2 H3a I Multiple Feeder IB1 F2c
Protection System 1
H3b H3
V IC5 F3a
H3c

3
H4a I IC F3b
H4b H4 IC1 F3c

Type 8H/8J CT/VT module


V
H4c IG5 F4a
H5a

Current inputs
IG
I
F4b
H5b H5
V IG1 F4c

Contact input/output modules


H5c
H6a I IA5 F5a
H6b H6 IA F5b
Wet V
H6c IA1 F5c
H7a Contact input H7a
IB5 F6a
H7c Contact input H7c
H8a Contact input H8a IB F6b
H8c Contact input H8c IB1 F6c 2
H7b Common H7b IC5 F7a
H8b Surge IC F7b
IC1 F7c
P1a
6A

I
P1b P1 IG5 F8a
V
P1c IG F8b
P2a I IG1 F8c
P2b P2 IA5 M1a
V
P2c
IA M1b
P3a
P3b P3 IA1 M1c
( DC only )

P3c IB5 M2a


P4a IB M2b
P4b P4
Dry IB1 M2c 3
P4c
P5a Contact input P5a IC5 M3a
P5c Contact input P5c IC M3b
Contact input/output modules

P6a Contact input P6a IC1 M3c


Type 8H/8J CT/VT module

P6c Contact input P6c


IG5 M4a
P5b Common P5b
Current inputs

IG M4b
P7a Contact input P7a
IG1 M4c
P7c Contact input P7c
P8a Contact input P8a IA5 M5a
P8c Contact input P8c IA M5b
P7b Common P7b IA1 M5c
P8b Surge IB5 M6a
IB M6b
B1b IB1 M6c
B1a Critical failure 4
B2b IC5 M7a
DC B3a IC M7b
48 V DC output
B3b IC1 M7c
B5b HI
Power supply

IG5 M8a
AC or DC B6b LO Control power
IG M8b
B6a
B8a Surge IG1 M8c
B8b Filter IA5 U1a
Fibre IA U1b
Tx1100BaseFX
optic Port 1 IA1 U1c
T

Rx1

Tx2100BaseFX IB5 U2a


Rx2
Port 2
Current inputs

IB U2b
Shielded Tx3100BaseFX
Ground at Port 3 IB1 U2c 5
twisted pairs Rx3
remote IC5 U3a
D1a
Type 8F/8G CT/VT module

device
D2a RS485 COM 2 IC U3b
D3a COM IC1 U3c
D4b
IG5 U4a
D4a
IRIG-B input IG U4b
CPU

Co-axial cable BNC


IG1 U4c
VA U5a
VA U5c
Voltage inputs

VB U6a
VB U6c
VC U7a
Contacts shown
No. 10AWG with no VC U7c
Modules must be
minimum control power VX U8a Connection
grounded if terminal
is provided VX U8c as required
Ground bus
832778A2.CDR

3-14 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

3.3.2 Dielectric strength


Dielectric strength is the maximum electric strength that can be sustained without breakdown. It is measured in volts.
The table shows the dielectric strength of the UR-series module hardware.
Table 3-1: Dielectric strength of UR modules
Module type Module function Terminals Dielectric strength
From To
1 Power supply High (+); Low (+); (–) Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
1 Power supply 48 V DC (+) and (–) Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
1 Power supply Relay terminals Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
2 Reserved N/A N/A N/A
3
4
Reserved
Digital contact inputs/
N/A
All
N/A
Chassis
N/A
2000 V AC for 1 minute 3
outputs
5 Analog inputs/outputs All except 8b Chassis < 50 V DC
6 Digital contact inputs/ All Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
outputs
7 G.703 All except 2b, 3a, 7b, 8a Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
RS422 All except 6a, 7b, 8a Chassis < 50 V DC
8 CT/VT All Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
9 CPU All Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute

Filter networks and transient protection clamps are used in the hardware to prevent damage caused
by high peak voltage transients, radio frequency interference (RFI), and electromagnetic interference
(EMI). These protective components can be damaged by application of the ANSI/IEEE C37.90
specified test voltage for longer than the specified minute.

3.3.3 Control power

Power supplied to the relay must be connected to the matching power supply range of the relay. If
incorrect voltage is applied or voltage is applied to the wrong terminals, damage can occur.
The F35, like almost all electronic relays, contains electrolytic capacitors. These capacitors are well-
known to deteriorate over time if voltage is not applied periodically. Deterioration can be avoided by
powering up the relay at least once a year.
The power supply module is ordered with one of two possible voltage ranges, and the F35 can be ordered with or without a
redundant power supply module option. Each range has a dedicated input connection for proper operation. The ranges
are as follows (see the Specifications section of chapter 2 for details):
• Low (LO) range — 24 to 48 V (DC only) nominal
• High (HI) range — 125 to 250 V nominal
The power supply module provides power to the relay and supplies power for dry contact input connections.
The power supply module provides 48 V DC power for dry contact input connections and a critical failure relay (see the
Typical Wiring Diagram earlier). The critical failure relay is a form-C device that is energized once control power is applied
and the relay has successfully booted up with no critical self-test failures. If ongoing self-test diagnostic checks detect a
critical failure (see the Self-Test Errors section in chapter 7) or control power is lost, the relay de-energizes.

Connect all wires at be back of a UR before connecting to power, else death or serious injury can
result from electrical shock.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-15


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

To connect power to the relay:


1. On the power supply module in the first slot, slot B, on the back of the device, connect the three wires to the terminals,
or connect two to the terminals and the third to the ground screw. 14 gauge stranded wire with disconnect devices is
recommended. Use 13 inch-pounds torque. Connect all wires to the relay before turning on power.
For high-reliability systems, the F35 has a redundant option in which two F35 power supplies are placed in parallel on the
bus. If one of the power supplies becomes faulted, the second power supply assumes the full load of the relay without any
interruptions. Each power supply has a green LED on the front of the module to indicate that it is functional. The critical fail
relay of the module also indicates a faulted power supply.
An LED on the front of the control power module shows the status of the power supply, as outlined in the table.
Table 3-2: Power supply LED on module
LED indication Power supply

3 Continuous on
On/off cycling
OK
Failure
Off Failure or no power

Figure 3-15: Control power connection

NOTE:
AC or DC 14 gauge stranded
wire with suitable
disconnect devices
is recommended.
Heavy copper conductor
or braided wire

B8b B8a B6a B6b B5b


+ +
– LOW HIGH
FILTER SURGE
CONTROL
POWER
Switchgear UR-series
ground bus protection system

827247A1.CDR

3.3.3.1 Non-volatile data storage


Non-volatile data is temporary data required after a power cycle for relay state, such as latch status before reboot. The
relay saves this data in non-volatile storage every two minutes or when a state change occurs.
If a state change occurs just before a power down (less than two minutes) and the relay power is cycled, some temporary
data can be saved and the prior state is retained at power up. Otherwise, a two-minute powered on period after a state
change ensures that all temporary state changes required after reboot have been saved. A command also is available to
initiate saving of data in the compact flash memory using Commands > Relay Maintenance > Save Volatile Data.

3.3.4 CT/VT modules


The CT and VT inputs are analog current transformer and voltage transformer signals used to monitor AC power lines. The
UR-series relays support 1 A and 5 A CTs.
A CT/VT module can have current or voltage inputs on channels 1 through 4 inclusive, or channels 5 through 8 inclusive.
Channels 1 and 5 are intended for connection to phase A, and are labelled as such in the relay. Likewise, channels 2 and 6
are intended for connection to phase B, and channels 3 and 7 are intended for connection to phase C.

3-16 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

Channels 4 and 8 are intended for connection to a single-phase source. For voltage inputs, these channels are labelled as
auxiliary voltage (VX). For current inputs, these channels are intended for connection to a CT between system neutral and
ground, and are labelled as ground current (IG).

Verify that the connection made to the relay terminals for nominal current of 1 A or 5 A matches the
secondary rating of the connected CTs. Unmatched CTs can result in equipment damage or
inadequate protection.
To connect to the module, size 12 American Wire Gauge (AWG) is used commonly; the maximum size is 10 AWG.
CT/VT modules can be ordered with a standard ground current input that is the same as the phase current input. Each AC
current input has an isolating transformer and an automatic shorting mechanism that shorts the input when the module is
withdrawn from the chassis. There are no internal ground connections on the current inputs. Current transformers with 1
to 50000 A primaries and 1 A or 5 A secondaries can be used.
CT/VT modules with a sensitive ground input are also available. The ground CT input of the sensitive ground modules is 10
times more sensitive than the ground CT input of standard CT/VT modules. However, the phase CT inputs and phase VT 3
inputs are the same as those of regular CT/VT modules.
These modules have enhanced diagnostics that can detect automatically CT/VT hardware failure and take the relay out of
service.
CT connections for both ABC and ACB phase rotations are identical, as shown in the Typical Wiring Diagram.
The exact placement of a zero-sequence core balance CT to detect ground fault current is shown as follows. Twisted-pair
cabling on the zero-sequence CT is recommended.
Figure 3-16: Zero-sequence core balance CT installation
UNSHIELDED CABLE SHIELDED CABLE
Ground connection to neutral
Stress cone
Source must be on the source side Source shields
A B C N G A B C

Ground
outside CT

To ground;
LOAD must be on
load side

LOAD 996630A6.CDR

The phase voltage channels are used for most metering and protection purposes. The auxiliary voltage channel is used as
input for the synchrocheck and volts-per-hertz features, which are optional features for some UR models.

Substitute the tilde “~” symbol with the slot position of the module in the following figure.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-17


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-17: CT/VT module wiring

IA5 ~ 1a

IA ~ 1b

IA1 ~ 1c

IB5 ~ 2a

IA5 ~1a IB ~ 2b

IA ~1b IB1 ~ 2c

IA1 ~1c IC5 ~ 3a

IB5 ~2a IC ~ 3b

3 IB ~2b IC1 ~ 3c VA ~1a


Current inputs

IB1 ~2c 8H, 8J, 8N, and 8R modules (8 CTs) IG5 ~ 4a VA ~1c
8F, 8G, 8L, and 8M modules (4 CTs and 4 VTs)

IC5 ~3a IG ~ 4b VB ~2a


Current inputs

IC ~3b IG1 ~ 4c VB ~2c

IC1 ~3c IA5 ~ 5a VC ~3a

IG5 ~4a IA ~ 5b VC ~3c

8V modules (8 VTs)
IG ~4b IA1 ~ 5c VX ~4a

Voltage inputs
IG1 ~4c IB5 ~ 6a VX ~4c

VA ~5a IB ~ 6b VA ~5a

VA ~5c IB1 ~ 6c VA ~5c

VB ~6a IC5 ~ 7a VB ~6a


Voltage inputs

VB ~6c IC ~ 7b VB ~6c

~
VC ~7a IC1 ~ 7c VC ~7a

VC ~7c IG5 ~ 8a VC ~7c

VX ~8a IG ~ 8b VX ~8a

VX ~8c IG1 ~ 8c VX ~8c

842809A2.CDR

3.3.5 Process bus modules


The F35 can be ordered with a process bus interface module. The module interfaces with the HardFiber Process Bus
System, or HardFiber Brick, allowing bidirectional IEC 61850 fiber-optic communications with up to eight HardFiber Bricks.
The HardFiber system integrates seamlessly with the existing UR-series applications, including protection functions,
FlexLogic, metering, and communications.
This process bus system offers the following benefits:
• Reduces labor associated with design, installation, and testing of protection and control applications using the UR by
reducing the number of individual copper terminations
• Integrates seamlessly with existing UR applications, since the IEC 61850 process bus interface module replaces the
traditional CT/VT modules
• Communicates using open standard IEC 61850 messaging
For details on the HardFiber system, see its Instruction Manual.

3-18 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

3.3.6 Contact inputs and outputs


Nearly all contact input/output modules have 24 terminal connections. The connections are arranged typically as three
terminals per row, with eight rows in total. A given row of three terminals can be used for the outputs of one relay. For
example, for form-C relay outputs, the terminals connect to the normally open (NO), normally closed (NC), and common
contacts of the relay. For a form-A output, there are options of using current or voltage detection for feature supervision,
depending on the module ordered. The terminal configuration for contact inputs is different for the two applications.
The contact inputs are grouped with a common return. The input/output modules have three versions of grouping: four
inputs per common return, five inputs per common return on a high-density module, and two inputs per common return.
When a contact input/output module is ordered, four inputs per common is used. If the inputs must be isolated per row,
then two inputs per common return are selected (4D module). If the space limitation in the relay requires use of a high-
density input module (6W), five inputs share one common return and the module has six banks of inputs.
The tables and diagrams that follow illustrate the module types (6A and so on) and contact arrangements that can be
ordered for the relay. Since an entire row is used for a single contact output, the name is assigned using the module slot
position and row number. However, since there are two contact inputs per row, these names are assigned by module slot
3
position, row number, and column position.
Some form-A / solid-state relay outputs include circuits to monitor the DC voltage across the output contact when it is
open, and the DC current through the output contact when it is closed. Each of the monitors contains a level detector
whose output is set to logic “On = 1” when the current in the circuit is above the threshold setting. The voltage monitor is
set to “On = 1” when there is a voltage across open contact (the detector allows a current of about 1 to 2.5 mA), and the
current monitor is set to “On = 1” when the current flowing through the closed contact exceeds about 80 to 100 mA. The
voltage monitor is intended to check the health of the overall trip circuit, and the current monitor can be used to seal-in
the output contact until an external contact has interrupted current flow. If enabled, the current monitoring can be used as
a seal-in signal to ensure that the form-A contact does not attempt to break the energized inductive coil circuit and weld
the output contacts.
Block diagrams are shown as follows for form-A and solid-state relay outputs with optional voltage monitor, optional
current monitor, and with no monitoring. The actual values shown for contact output 1 are the same for all contact
outputs. Form-A contact output with or without a current or voltage monitoring option is not polarity sensitive. The polarity
shown in the figure is required for solid-state contact output connection.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-19


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-18: Form-A and solid-state contact outputs with voltage and current monitoring

~#a ~#a
I I
~#b ~#b Load
V Load V
~#c + ~#c +
a) Voltage with optional
Voltage monitoring only Both voltage and current monitoring
current monitoring

~#a ~#a
V V

3 I ~#b

Load
I ~#b Load

~#c + ~#c +
b) Current with optional
Current monitoring only Both voltage and current monitoring
voltage monitoring
(external jumper a-b is required)

~#a

~#b

Load
~#c +
c) No monitoring
827862A5.CDR

The operation of voltage and current monitors is reflected with the corresponding FlexLogic operands (CONT OP # VON, CONT
OP # VOFF, and CONT OP # ION) that can be used in protection, control, and alarm logic. The typical application of the voltage
monitor is breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring; a typical application of the current monitor is seal-in of the control
command.
See the Digital Elements section of chapter 5 for an example of how form-A and solid-state relay contacts can be applied
for breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring.

Consider relay contacts unsafe to touch when the unit is energized. Death or serious injury can
result from touching live relay contacts.

USE OF FORM-A AND SOLID-STATE RELAY OUTPUTS IN HIGH-IMPEDANCE CIRCUITS


For form-A and solid-state relay output contacts internally equipped with a voltage measuring circuit across the
contact, the circuit has an impedance that can cause a problem when used in conjunction with external high-input
impedance monitoring equipment, such as modern relay test set trigger circuits. These monitoring circuits can
continue to read the form-A contact as being closed after it has closed and subsequently opened, when measured
as an impedance.
The solution is to use the voltage measuring trigger input of the relay test set, and connect the form-A contact
through a voltage-dropping resistor to a DC voltage source. If the 48 V DC output of the power supply is used as a
source, a 500 Ω, 10 W resistor is appropriate. In this configuration, the voltage across either the form-A contact or
the resistor can be used to monitor the state of the output.

Where a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute the slot position of the module. Where a number sign “#” appears,
substitute the contact number.

3-20 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

When current monitoring is used to seal-in the form-A and solid-state relay contact outputs, give the
FlexLogic operand driving the contact output a reset delay of 10 ms to prevent damage of the output
contact (in situations when the element initiating the contact output is bouncing, at values in the
region of the pickup value).
For high-density input/output modules 6W and 6X, use the following guidelines to connect. The new I/O modules use pin
type terminal blocks instead of the current ring type. The new terminals are required to achieve higher I/O count per
module.
• 12 to 24 AWG (3.3 mm2 to 0.2 mm2), single wire termination
• 16 to 24 AWG (1.31 mm2 to 0.2 mm2), multiple wire termination with matching wire sizes and stranding. Two wires
maximum per circuit.
• Suggested wiring screw tightening torque is a minimum 4.43 in-lb (0.5 Nm) and maximum 5.31 in-lb (0.6 Nm)


Minimum suggested temperature rating for the conductors is 75°C
Wire type: copper
3
Table 3-3: Contact input and output module assignments
~6A module ~6B module ~6C module ~6D module
Terminal Output or Terminal Output or Terminal Output Terminal Output
assignment input assignment input assignment assignment
~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-C ~1a, ~1c 2 Inputs
~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-C ~2a, ~2c 2 Inputs
~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3a, ~3c 2 Inputs
~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4a, ~4c 2 Inputs
~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Form-C ~5 Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs
~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Form-C ~6 Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7 Form-C ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8 Form-C ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs

~6E module ~6F module ~6G module ~6H module


Terminal Output or Terminal Output Terminal Output or Terminal Output or
assignment input assignment assignment input assignment input
~1 Form-C ~1 Fast Form-C ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A
~2 Form-C ~2 Fast Form-C ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A
~3 Form-C ~3 Fast Form-C ~3 Form-A ~3 Form-A
~4 Form-C ~4 Fast Form-C ~4 Form-A ~4 Form-A
~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Fast Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Form-A
~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Fast Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Form-A
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7 Fast Form-C ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8 Fast Form-C ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs

~6K module ~6L module ~6M module ~6N module


Terminal Output Terminal Output or Terminal Output or Terminal Output or
assignment assignment input assignment input assignment input
~1 Form-C ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A
~2 Form-C ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A
~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3 Form-A
~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-A
~5 Fast Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-21


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

~6K module ~6L module ~6M module ~6N module


Terminal Output Terminal Output or Terminal Output or Terminal Output or
assignment assignment input assignment input assignment input
~6 Fast Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs
~7 Fast Form-C ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs
~8 Fast Form-C ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs

~6P module ~6R module ~6S module ~6T module


Terminal Output or Terminal Output or Terminal Output or Terminal Output or
assignment input assignment input assignment input assignment input
~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A

3 ~2
~3
Form-A
Form-A
~2
~3
Form-A
Form-C
~2
~3
Form-A
Form-C
~2
~3
Form-A
Form-A
~4 Form-A ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-A
~5 Form-A ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs
~6 Form-A ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs

~6U module ~6V module ~6W module 6X module


Terminal Output or Terminal Output or Terminal Output or Terminal Output or
assignment input assignment input assignment input assignment input
~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1a - ~2a Output ~1a, ~1b 2 Inputs
~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A ~3a - ~4a Output ~2a, ~2b 2 Inputs
~3 Form-A ~3 Form-C ~5a - ~6a Output ~3a, ~3b 2 Inputs
~4 Form-A ~4 2 Outputs ~7a - ~8a Output ~4a, ~4b 2 Inputs
~5 Form-A ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~9a - ~10a Output ~5a, ~5b 2 Inputs
~6 Form-A ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~11a - ~12a Output ~7a, ~7b 2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~13a - ~14a Output ~8a, ~8b 2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~15a - ~16a Output ~9a, ~9b 2 Inputs
--- --- --- --- ~17a - ~18a Output ~10a, ~10b 2 Inputs
--- --- --- --- ~1b - ~2b Output ~11a, ~11b 2 Inputs
--- --- --- --- ~3b - ~4b Output ~13a, ~13b 2 Inputs
--- --- --- --- ~5b - ~6b Output ~14a, ~14b 2 Inputs
--- --- --- --- ~7b - ~8b Output ~15a, ~15b 2 Inputs
--- --- --- --- ~9b - ~10b Output ~16a, ~16b 2 Inputs
--- --- --- --- ~11b - ~12b Output ~17a, ~17b 2 Inputs
--- --- --- --- ~13b - ~14b Output --- ---
--- --- --- --- ~15b - ~16b Output --- ---
--- --- --- --- ~17b - ~18b Output --- ---

~67 module ~4A module ~4B module ~4C module


Terminal Output Terminal Output Terminal Output Terminal Output
assignment assignment assignment assignment
~1 Form-A ~1 Not Used ~1 Not Used ~1 Not Used
~2 Form-A ~2 Solid-State ~2 Solid-State ~2 Solid-State

3-22 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

~67 module ~4A module ~4B module ~4C module


Terminal Output Terminal Output Terminal Output Terminal Output
assignment assignment assignment assignment
~3 Form-A ~3 Not Used ~3 Not Used ~3 Not Used
~4 Form-A ~4 Solid-State ~4 Solid-State ~4 Solid-State
~5 Form-A ~5 Not Used ~5 Not Used ~5 Not Used
~6 Form-A ~6 Solid-State ~6 Solid-State ~6 Solid-State
~7 Form-A ~7 Not Used ~7 Not Used ~7 Not Used
~8 Form-A ~8 Solid-State ~8 Solid-State ~8 Solid-State

~4D module ~4L module


Terminal
assignment
Output Terminal
assignment
Output
3
~1a, ~1c 2 Inputs ~1 2 Outputs
~2a, ~2c 2 Inputs ~2 2 Outputs
~3a, ~3c 2 Inputs ~3 2 Outputs
~4a, ~4c 2 Inputs ~4 2 Outputs
~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 2 Outputs
~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 2 Outputs
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7 2 Outputs
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8 Not Used

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-23


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-19: Contact input and output module wiring (Sheet 1 of 3)

842762A4.CDR

3-24 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

Figure 3-20: Contact input and output module wiring (Sheet 2 of 3)


~ 1a ~ 5a CONTACT IN ~ 5a DIGITAL I/O 6L V ~ 1a ~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a DIGITAL I/O 6M V ~ 1a

6K
I I
~ 1b ~1 ~ 5c CONTACT IN ~ 5c ~1 ~ 1b ~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c ~1 ~ 1b
~ 1c ~ 6a CONTACT IN ~ 6a ~ 1c ~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a ~ 1c
~ 2a ~ 6c CONTACT IN ~ 6c V ~ 2a ~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c V ~ 2a
I I
~ 2b ~2 ~ 5b COMMON ~ 5b ~2 ~ 2b ~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b ~2 ~ 2b
~ 2c ~ 2c ~ 2c
~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a ~ 8b SURGE
~ 3a ~ 3a ~ 3a
~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c
~ 3b ~3 ~3 ~ 3b ~3 ~ 3b
~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a
~ 3c ~ 3c ~ 3c
~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c
~ 4a ~ 4a ~ 4a
~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b
~ 4b ~4 ~4 ~ 4b ~4 ~ 4b
~ 4c ~ 8b SURGE ~ 4c ~ 4c
~ 5a ~ 5a
~ 5b ~5 ~5 ~ 5b
~ 5c ~ 5c
~ 6a ~ 6a
~ 6b ~6 ~6 ~ 6b
~ 6c ~ 6c
~ 7a
DIGITAL I/O

~ 7b ~7
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8b ~8

3
~ 8c

~ 5a CONTACT IN ~ 5a DIGITAL I/O 6N V ~ 1a ~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a DIGITAL I/O 6P V ~ 1a


I I
~ 5c CONTACT IN ~ 5c ~1 ~ 1b ~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c ~1 ~ 1b
~ 6a CONTACT IN ~ 6a ~ 1c ~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a ~ 1c
~ 6c CONTACT IN ~ 6c V ~ 2a ~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c V ~ 2a
I I
~ 5b COMMON ~ 5b ~2 ~ 2b ~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b ~2 ~ 2b
~ 2c ~ 2c
~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a ~ 8b SURGE
V ~ 3a V ~ 3a
~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c I I
~3 ~ 3b ~3 ~ 3b
~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a
~ 3c ~ 3c
~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c
V ~ 4a V ~ 4a
~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b I I
~4 ~ 4b ~4 ~ 4b
~ 8b SURGE ~ 4c ~ 4c
V ~ 5a
I
~5 ~ 5b
~ 5c
~ 5a CONTACT IN ~ 5a DIGITAL I/O 6R ~ 1a V ~ 6a
I
~ 5c CONTACT IN ~ 5c ~1 ~ 1b ~6 ~ 6b
~ 6a CONTACT IN ~ 6a ~ 1c ~ 6c
~ 6c CONTACT IN ~ 6c ~ 2a
~ 5b COMMON ~ 5b ~2 ~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a
~ 3a ~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a DIGITAL I/O 6S ~ 1a
~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c
~3 ~ 3b ~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c ~1 ~ 1b
~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a
~ 3c ~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a ~ 1c
~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c
~ 4a ~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c ~ 2a
~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b
~4 ~ 4b ~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b ~2 ~ 2b
~ 8b SURGE ~ 4c ~ 2c
~ 8b SURGE
~ 3a
~3 ~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 5a CONTACT IN ~ 5a DIGITAL I/O 6T ~ 1a ~ 4a
~ 5c CONTACT IN ~ 5c ~1 ~ 1b ~4 ~ 4b
~ 6a CONTACT IN ~ 6a ~ 1c ~ 4c
~ 6c CONTACT IN ~ 6c ~ 2a ~ 5a
~ 5b COMMON ~ 5b ~2 ~ 2b ~5 ~ 5b
~ 2c ~ 5c
~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a
~ 3a ~ 6a
~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c
~3 ~ 3b ~6 ~ 6b
~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a
~ 3c ~ 6c
~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c
~ 4a
~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b
~4 ~ 4b
~ 8b SURGE ~ 4c
~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a DIGITAL I/O 6U ~ 1a
~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c ~1 ~ 1b
~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a ~ 1c
~ 5a CONTACT IN ~ 5a DIGITAL I/O 6V V ~ 1a
I ~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c ~ 2a
~ 5c CONTACT IN ~ 5c ~1 ~ 1b
~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b ~2 ~ 2b
~ 6a CONTACT IN ~ 6a ~ 1c
~ 2c
~ 6c CONTACT IN ~ 6c V ~ 2a ~ 8b SURGE
I ~ 3a
~ 5b COMMON ~ 5b ~2 ~ 2b
~3 ~ 3b
~ 2c
~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a ~ 3c
~ 3a
~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c ~ 4a
~3 ~ 3b
~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a ~4 ~ 4b
~ 3c
~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c ~ 4c
~ 4a
~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b ~ 4a ~ 5a
~ 4b
~ 4c ~5 ~ 5b
~ 8b SURGE ~ 4c
~ 5c
~ 6a
~6 ~ 6b
~ 6c

842763A2.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-25


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-21: Contact input and output module wiring (Sheet 3 of 3)


DIGITAL I/O 6W DIGITAL I/O 6X
~ 1b CONTACT IN ~ 16 CONTACT IN ~ 1 ~ 1a ~ 1b ~ 1a
~ 10 ~ 1
~ 2b CONTACT IN ~ 17 CONTACT IN ~ 2 ~ 2a ~ 2b ~ 2a
~ 3b CONTACT IN ~ 18 CONTACT IN ~ 3 ~ 3a ~ 3b ~ 3a
~ 11 ~ 2
~ 4b CONTACT IN ~ 19 CONTACT IN ~ 4 ~ 4a ~ 4b ~ 4a
~ 5b CONTACT IN ~ 20 CONTACT IN ~ 5 ~ 5a ~ 5b ~ 5a
~ 12 ~ 3
~ 6b COMMON COMMON ~ 6a ~ 6b ~ 6a
~ 7b ~ 7a
~ 7b CONTACT IN ~ 21 CONTACT IN ~ 6 ~ 7a ~ 13 ~ 4
~ 8b ~ 8a
~ 8b CONTACT IN ~ 22 CONTACT IN ~ 7 ~ 8a
~ 9b ~ 9a
~ 9b CONTACT IN ~ 23 CONTACT IN ~ 8 ~ 9a ~ 14 ~ 5
~10b ~ 10a
~10b CONTACT IN ~ 24 CONTACT IN ~ 9 ~10a ~11b ~ 11a
~11b CONTACT IN ~ 25 CONTACT IN ~ 10 ~11a ~ 15 ~ 6
~12b ~ 12a
~12b COMMON COMMON ~12a ~13b ~ 13a
~ 16 ~ 7
~ 13b CONTACT IN ~ 26 CONTACT IN ~ 11 ~ 13a ~14b ~ 14a
~ 14b CONTACT IN ~ 27 CONTACT IN ~ 12 ~ 14a ~15b ~ 15a
~ 17 ~ 8
~ 15b CONTACT IN ~ 28 CONTACT IN ~ 13 ~ 15a ~16b ~ 16a
~16b CONTACT IN ~ 29 CONTACT IN ~ 14 ~16a ~17b ~ 17a
~ 18 ~ 9
~17b CONTACT IN ~ 30 CONTACT IN ~ 15 ~17a ~18b ~ 18a
~18b COMMON COMMON ~18a
859759A1.CDR

3 For proper functionality, observe the polarity shown in the figures for all contact input and output
connections.

3.3.6.1 Contact inputs


A dry contact has one side connected to terminal B3b. This is the positive 48 V DC voltage rail supplied by the power supply
module. The other side of the dry contact is connected to the required contact input terminal. Each contact input group
has its own common (negative) terminal that must be connected to the DC negative terminal (B3a) of the power supply
module. When a dry contact closes, a current of 1 to 3 mA flows through the associated circuit.
A wet contact has one side connected to the positive terminal of an external DC power supply. The other side of this
contact is connected to the required contact input terminal. If a wet contact is used, then the negative side of the external
source must be connected to the relay common (negative) terminal of each contact group. The maximum external source
voltage for this arrangement is 300 V DC.
The voltage threshold at which each group of four contact inputs detects a closed contact input is programmable as
17 V DC for 24 V sources, 33 V DC for 48 V sources, 84 V DC for 110 to 125 V sources, and 166 V DC for 250 V sources.
Figure 3-22: Dry and wet contact input connections
Terminals from type 6B Terminals from type 6B
(Dry) contact input/output module (Wet) contact input/output module
~7a Contact input 1 ~7a Contact input 1
~7c Contact input 2 ~7c Contact input 2
~8a Contact input 3 24 to 250 V ~8a Contact input 3
~8c Contact input 4 ~8c Contact input 4
~7b Common ~7b Common
~8b Surge ~8b Surge

B1b
B1a Critical failure
B2b
Power supply module

B3a
48 V DC output
B3b
B5b HI+
B6b LO+ Control power
B6a
B8a Surge
B8b Filter

827741A5.CDR

Where a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute the slot position of the module.

3-26 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

There is no provision in the relay to detect a DC ground fault on 48 V DC control power external output. We recommend
using an external DC supply.

3.3.6.2 General application considerations


Contacts outputs of protective relays, auxiliary contacts from breakers, disconnectors and other devices are connected
generally to contacts inputs of protective relays. In some situations, the contact outputs of some protective relays can
have high impedance connected across it. When such a contact output is connected across a F35 contact input, it can
spuriously operate the F35 input even when the output is open, if there is a substantial distributed capacitance
(represented by C1) present in the wiring between the output and the F35 input, and the debounce time setting in the F35
relay is low enough. This false assertion of the contact input, when there is inadvertent ground present at the DC positive
terminal, can be prevented by inserting a resistor across the F35 input.
The following figure shows a typical DC circuit, with battery ground detection, of contact input. The contact output has
parallel impedance across it (represented by R1).
Figure 3-23: Typical contact input DC circuit 3

Contact Input

859755A1.cdr

The presence of the impedance path (R1) across the contact output allows the stray (distributed) capacitance C1 to charge
as shown, thus developing a voltage across the contact input enough to momentarily operate the input while the
capacitance discharges in the presence of DC ground on the positive terminal of the battery.
The duration of the discharge depends on the value of the distributed capacitance, the initial voltage of the distributed
capacitance, and the input impedance of the contact input. If the duration is greater than the debounce time setting, then
the contact input operates.
The application example that follows describes how to mitigate this issue by connecting a resistor across the contact
input, as shown in the next figure, or by adjusting the debounce time setting to a value greater than the discharge time to
prevent spurious operation of the contact input only if the voltage (with output open) across the contact input due to trickle
current is less than the threshold voltage. This operation of contact inputs also can be prevented by using the Auto-Burnish
contact inputs or contact inputs with active impedance.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-27


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-24: Contact input connected to a contact output with resistor (R2) across the input

3
Contact Input

859756A1.cdr

Application example
This example is for illustrative purposes only and the calculations present the worst-case scenario. In practice, the value of
debounce time can be lower.
Contact input ON state impedance used in the calculation of the discharge period is based on the following table.
Table 3-4: Discharge period
Battery voltage (V) Input impedance (kΩ)
130 50
250 97

Debounce time setting = 2 ms


Assume a stray capacitance of 0.1 μF.
Assume an initial voltage across the stray capacitance "Vinitial" = 19 V (Vthreshold - 65 V), where Vthreshold = 84 V. The
initial voltage Vinitial depends on values of impedance of R1 and contact inputs when the contact input is OFF (non-
activated state).
Therefore, discharge time constant (τ) =50 kΩ *0.1 μF = 5 ms.
Discharge period t is calculated from the following equation:
Vthreshold = (Vbatt - VInitial) *e^ (-t/τ)
84 = -149 *e^ (t/0.005) Eq. 3-1
T = -0.005 * ln (84/149) = 0.0029 s
Therefore, in this example the contact inputs operate.
To prevent this operation, the debounce time must be increased to 4 ms (set debounce time as per the following table) or
insert a resistor less than or equal to "R" as calculated later.
Table 3-5: Typical debounce time setting
Stray capacitance (μF) Battery voltage (V) Debounce time (ms)
0.05 130 2
0.1 130 4
0.2 130 6
0.05 250 3

3-28 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

Stray capacitance (μF) Battery voltage (V) Debounce time (ms)


0.1 250 6*
0.2 250 11

* Default debounce time on contact inputs is 6 ms.


The value of this resistor "R" is calculated as follows:
1. Determine the minimum voltage (V threshold) required to turn on the input. This is determined by direct measurement
or referenced in the input specifications.
2. Calculate the resistance necessary to limit the voltage to 1/3 V threshold (when the contact is OFF, the non-activated
state) as follows:
R = (Vthreshold / 3) / (2 mA) Eq. 3-2
The 2 mA current is used in case the contact input is connected across the GE Form A contact output with voltage
monitoring. Otherwise use the amperage of the active circuit connected to the contact input when its contact output
is open and the voltage across the contact input is third trigger threshold to calculate the resistor value.
3
3. When the contact is ON (operate state), the battery voltage appears across the resistor. The wattage rating of the
resistor is then:
PR = 1.3 * (Vbatt) ^2 / R Watts Eq. 3-3
4. Applying the following equation to our example:
R = 84 V / 3 * (1 / 2 mA) = 14 kΩ
PR = 1.57 Watts Eq. 3-4
5. Calculating the voltage across the contact input with the Burden Resistor, Voltage across the contact Input:
Vresistor = 2 mA * 14 Kohm = 28 V
Vresistor < contact input threshold (84 V) Eq. 3-5
In conclusion, in this example, the contact input does NOT operate falsely with the Burden Resistor across its input AND
when a battery ground is present.

3.3.6.3 Use of contact inputs with auto-burnishing


The contact inputs sense a change of state of the external device contact based on the measured current. When external
devices are located in a harsh industrial environment (either outdoor or indoor), their contacts can be exposed to various
types of contamination. Normally, there is a thin film of insulating sulfidation, oxidation, or contaminates on the surface of
the contacts, sometimes making it difficult or impossible to detect a change of state. This film must be removed to
establish circuit continuity — an impulse of higher than normal current can accomplish this.
The contact inputs with auto-burnish create a high current impulse when the threshold is reached to burn off this oxidation
layer as a maintenance to the contacts. Afterwards the contact input current is reduced to a steady-state current. The
impulse has a five-second delay after a contact input changes state.
Figure 3-25: Current through contact inputs with auto-burnishing
Current

50 to 70 mA

3 mA
Time

25 to 50 ms
842749A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-29


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Regular contact inputs limit current to less than 3 mA to reduce station battery burden. In contrast, contact inputs with
auto-burnishing allow currents up to 50 to 70 mA at the first instance when the change of state is sensed. Then, within 25
to 50 ms, this current is slowly reduced to 3 mA as indicated. The 50 to 70 mA peak current burns any film on the contacts,
allowing for proper sensing of state changes. If the external device contact is bouncing, the auto-burnishing starts when
external device contact bouncing is over.
Another important difference between the auto-burnishing input module and the regular input modules is that only two
contact inputs have common ground, as opposed to four contact inputs sharing one common ground (see the Contact
Input and Output Module Wiring diagrams). This is beneficial when connecting contact inputs to separate voltage sources.
Consequently, the threshold voltage setting is also defined per group of two contact inputs.
The auto-burnish feature can be disabled or enabled using the DIP switches found on each daughter card. There is a DIP
switch for each contact, for a total of 16 inputs.
Figure 3-26: Auto-burnish DIP switches

3 CONTACT INPUT 1 AUTO-BURNISH = OFF


CONTACT INPUT 2 AUTO-BURNISH = OFF

CONTACT INPUT 1 AUTO-BURNISH = ON


CONTACT INPUT 2 AUTO-BURNISH = OFF

CONTACT INPUT 1 AUTO-BURNISH = OFF


CONTACT INPUT 2 AUTO-BURNISH = ON

CONTACT INPUT 1 AUTO-BURNISH = ON


CONTACT INPUT 2 AUTO-BURNISH = ON

842751A1.CDR

The auto-burnish circuitry has an internal fuse for safety purposes. During regular maintenance, check the auto-burnish
functionality using an oscilloscope.

3.3.6.4 Use of contact inputs with active impedance


Contact inputs can be susceptible to parasitic capacitance, caused by long cable runs affected by switching surges from
external circuits. This can result in inadvertent activation of contact inputs with the external contact open. In this case, GE
recommends using the contact I/O module with active impedance circuit.
Active impedance contact input can tolerate external cable capacitance of up to 0.2 µF, without entering the ON state for
more than 2 ms. The contact input debounce time can still be set above 2 ms for added security to prevent contact input
activations caused by external transient ON states.
An active impedance contact input is normally in Low impedance mode during OFF contact state (non-activated
condition). During Low impedance state, contact input impedance is maintained at 10 K Ohms impedance to allow fast
discharge of the stray capacitance of the long cables.
When the contact input voltage exceeds the set threshold, active impedance maintains 10 K Ohms impedance. If voltage
starts rapidly decreasing, this indicates that stray capacitance is being discharged through the contact input. If, however,
voltage stabilizes above the set threshold, the input impedance is switched to High impedance mode of 100 K Ohms. This
value reduces the input current to <3 mA, and contact input switches to the ON state (operated state).
The figure shows the active impedance contact input V-I characteristic. Different thresholds with their corresponding
characteristics are shown by color. The contact input is in the ON (operated) state if the input voltage is to the right of the
colored threshold band (+/-10% tolerance), and the contact input is in the OFF (non-activated) state when input voltage is
to the left of the band. A contact input is in LOW state during non-operated system condition, and actively switches to
HIGH state upon detection of input voltage above the settable threshold.

3-30 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

Figure 3-27: Active impedance contact input V-I characteristic

30

84 V threshold

166 V threshold
17 V threshold

33 V threshold

e
at
st
e
25

nc
da
pe
im
w
Lo
20

3
Current (millamperes)

15
s
m
oh
K
10

10

166 V threshold
84 V threshold
33 V threshold
5
17 V threshold

dance state
100 K ohms HIgh impe
0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300
Voltage (Volts) 859757A2.vsd

3.3.7 Transducer inputs and outputs


Transducer input modules receive input signals from external DCmA output transducers (DCmA In) or resistance
temperature detectors (RTDs). Hardware and software are provided to receive signals from these external transducers and
convert these signals into a digital format for use as required.
Transducer output modules provide DC current outputs in several standard DCmA ranges. Software is provided to
configure virtually any analog quantity used in the relay to drive the analog outputs.
Each transducer input/output module has 24 terminal connections. These connections are arranged as three terminals
per row over eight rows. A given row can be used for either inputs or outputs, with terminals in column "a" having positive
polarity and terminals in column "c" having negative polarity. Since an entire row is used for a single input/output channel,
the name of the channel is assigned using the module slot position and row number.
Each module also requires that a connection from an external ground bus be made to terminal 8b. The current outputs
require a twisted-pair shielded cable, where the shield is grounded at one end only. The following figure illustrates the
transducer module types (5A, 5C, 5D, 5E, and 5F) and channel arrangements that can be ordered for the relay.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-31


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Where a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute the slot position of the module.

Figure 3-28: Transducer input/output module wiring

842764A1.CDR

The following figure show how to connect RTDs.

3-32 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

Figure 3-29: RTD connections


Three-wire shielded cable
Route cable in separate conduit from
current carrying conductors
RTD terminals

SURGE ~8b RTD

Hot ~1a
RTD ~1
Comp ~1c
For RTD ~1 & ~2 Return ~1b RTD terminals

RTD ~2
Hot ~2a 3
Comp ~2c
RTD

Maximum total lead resistance:


25 ohms for Platinum RTDs
859736A1.CDR

3.3.8 RS232 port


On the enhanced and basic front panels is a nine-pin RS232C serial port for programming with a computer. All that is
required to use this interface is a computer running the EnerVista UR Setup software provided with the relay. Cabling for
the RS232 port is shown in the following figure for the nine-pin connector on the UR and nine or 25-pin connector on a
computer.
The baud rate for this port can be set, with a default of 115200 bps.
Figure 3-30: RS232 front panel port connection
Front panel 9 pin RS232 Program port

1: N/A
2: (TXD)
3: (RXD)
RELAY
PERSONAL 4: N/A
COMPUTER 5: (SGND) Signal Ground
FRONT PANEL
6: N/A
PROGRAM PORT 7: N/A
8: N/A
9: N/A

9 PIN
RS232 RS232
D CONNECTOR D CONNECTOR

URS232 INTERFACE COM1 OR COM2


SERIAL PORT
RELAY COMPUTER
1 1 8 827758A3.cdr
TXD 2 2 3 RXD
RXD 3 3 2 TXD
4 4 20
SGND 5 5 7 SGND
6 6 6
7 7 4
8 8 5
9 9 22

9 PIN 25 PIN
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-33


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

3.3.9 CPU communication ports

3.3.9.1 Overview
There is a rear RS485 communication port on the CPU module. The CPU module does not require a surge ground
connection.
Figure 3-31: CPU module communications wiring
MM fiber-
Port 1

T
optic cable Tx1 Rx1 100Base-FX
Tx2 Rx2 100Base-FX Port 2
Shielded
twisted-pairs
Tx3 Rx3 100Base-FX Port 3
D1a +
RS485
D2a —
COM2
3 Ground at
remote
device
D3a
D4b
D4a
COMMON
+
— IRIG-B
input

CPU
BNC
Co-axial cable

U
100Base-TX Port 1
MM fiber-
optic cable Tx1 Rx1 100Base-FX Port 2
Shielded Tx2 Rx2 100Base-FX Port 3
twisted-pairs
D1a +
RS485
D2a —
COM2
Ground at D3a COMMON
remote D4b +
device
D4a — IRIG-B
input

CPU
BNC
Co-axial cable

Port 1

V
100Base-TX

100Base-TX Port 2
Shielded 100Base-TX Port 3
twisted-pairs
D1a +
RS485
D2a —
COM2
Ground at D3a COMMON
remote D4b +
device
D4a — IRIG-B
input
CPU

BNC
Co-axial cable
W

10/100Base-TX Port 1
MM fiber-
optic cable
Tx1 Rx1 100Base-FX Port 2
Shielded Tx2 Rx2 100Base-FX Port 3
twisted-pairs
D1a +
RS485
D2a —
COM2
Ground at D3a COMMON
remote D4b +
device
D4a — IRIG-B
input
CPU

BNC
Co-axial cable
859774A1.CDR

3-34 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION WIRING

3.3.9.2 RS485 port


RS485 data transmission and reception are accomplished over a single twisted-pair wire with transmit and receive data
alternating over the same two wires. Through the use of the port, continuous monitoring and control from a remote
computer, SCADA system, or Power Line Carrier (PLC) is possible.
To minimize errors from noise, the use of shielded twisted-pair wire is recommended. Correct polarity must be observed.
For instance, the relays must be connected with all RS485 “+” terminals connected together, and all RS485 “–” terminals
connected together. Though data is transmitted over a two-wire twisted pair, all RS485 devices require a shared reference,
or common voltage. This common voltage is implied to be a power supply common. Some systems allow the shield (drain
wire) to be used as common wire and to connect directly to the F35 COM terminal (#3); others function correctly only if the
common wire is connected to the F35 COM terminal, but insulated from the shield.
To avoid loop currents, ground the shield at only one point. If other system considerations require the shield to be
grounded at more than one point, install resistors (typically 100 ohms) between the shield and ground at each grounding
point. Each relay needs to be daisy-chained to the next one in the link. A maximum of 32 relays can be connected in this
manner without exceeding driver capability. For larger systems, additional serial channels must be added. It is also 3
possible to use commercially available repeaters to have more than 32 relays on a single channel. Avoid star or stub
connections entirely.
Lightning strikes and ground surge currents can cause large momentary voltage differences between remote ends of the
communication link. For this reason, surge protection devices are provided internally at both communication ports. An
isolated power supply with an optocoupled data interface also acts to reduce noise coupling. To ensure maximum
reliability, ensure that all equipment has similar transient protection devices installed.
Terminate both ends of the RS485 circuit with an impedance as shown in the figure.
Figure 3-32: RS485 serial connection

SCADA / PLC / computer UR-series device


Shield Twisted pair
ZT (*) RS485 +
Data Optocoupler Optocoupler Data
RS485 –

COM

COMP 485COM

Ground shield at SCADA / PLC /


computer only or at
UR-series device only Relay
RS485 +
ZT (*) Terminating impedance at
RS485 –
each end (typically 120 Ω and 1 nF)

COMP 485COM

Up to 32 devices,
maximum 4000 feet
(1200 m)
Relay
ZT (*)
RS485 +
RS485 –

COMP 485COM Last device


827757AA.CDR

3.3.9.3 100Base-FX fiber optic ports


The fiber-optic communication ports allow for fast and efficient communications between relays at 100 Mbps. Optical
fiber can be connected to the relay supporting a wavelength of 1310 nm in multimode.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-35


WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Ensure that the dust covers are installed when the fiber is not in use. Dirty or scratched connectors can lead to high losses
on a fiber link.

3.3.10 IRIG-B
There is a round IRIG-B connector at the back of the CPU module, marked "IN". Use is optional.
IRIG-B is a standard time code format that allows stamping of events to be synchronized among connected devices. The
IRIG-B code allows time accuracies of up to 100 ns. The GE MultiSync 100 1588 GPS Clock as well as third-party equipment
are available for generating the IRIG-B signal. This equipment can use a global positioning system (GPS) satellite system to
obtain the time reference so that devices at different geographic locations can be synchronized. The IRIG time code
formats are serial, pulse width-modulated codes that can be either DC level shifted or amplitude modulated (AM). Using
IRIG-B input, the F35 operates an internal oscillator with 1 µs resolution and accuracy.
Figure 3-33: Options for IRIG-B connection
3

GPS connection GPS satellite system

UR-series device
4B IRIG-B (+)
IRIG-B
4A IRIG-B (–)
time code generator
RG58/59 coaxial cable Receiver
(DC-shift or + BNC (in)
amplitude modulated
signal can be used)

GPS connection GPS satellite system

IRIG-B
time code generator
UR-series device
Twisted-pair cable
(DC-shift or +
4B IRIG-B (+)
amplitude modulated
4A IRIG-B (–)
signal can be used)
Receiver
BNC (in)

827756A8.CDR

Using an amplitude-modulated receiver causes errors up to 1 ms in event time stamping.

3-36 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS

3.4 Direct input and output communications


3.4.1 Description
The direct inputs and outputs feature makes use of the type 7 series of communications modules and allows direct
messaging between UR devices. The communications modules are outlined in the table later in this section.
The communications channels are normally connected in a ring configuration, as shown in the following figure. The
transmitter of one module is connected to the receiver of the next module. The transmitter of this second module is then
connected to the receiver of the next module in the ring. This is continued to form a communications ring. The figure
illustrates a ring of four UR-series relays with the following connections: UR1-Tx to UR2-Rx, UR2-Tx to UR3-Rx, UR3-Tx to
UR4-Rx, and UR4-Tx to UR1-Rx. A maximum of 16 URs can be connected in a single ring.
Figure 3-34: Direct input and output single-channel connection
3
Tx
UR 1
Rx

Tx
UR 2
Rx

Tx
UR 3
Rx

Tx
UR 4
Rx
842006A2.CDR

Inter-relay communication (IRC) modules with protocol C37.94 and G.703 are designed for back-to-back communication
connections, so the ring configuration shown in the previous figure does not apply. To establish inter-relay communication
in more than two URs, you need to have a two-channel IRC module and enable the DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting
in all relays, as shown in the next figure. This configuration can be expanded to 16 URs, and this configuration does not
provide a redundancy ring since both channels are made into a single ring by the channel crossover function. As per the
figure entitled Typical Pin Interconnection between Two G.703 Interfaces later in this chapter, the clock is supplied typically
by multiplexer (MUX) and all URs are in Loop Timing Mode. If there is no MUX, then UR1 and UR3 can be in Internal Timing
Mode and UR2 and UR4 can be in Loop Timing Mode. That is, connected channels must have opposite timing modes.
Figure 3-35: Ring configuration for C37.94 module (concept also applies to G.703)

Tx1 Tx2 Tx1 Tx2


MUX UR 1 MUX MUX UR 2 MUX
Rx1 Rx2 Rx1 Rx2

Tx1 Tx2 Tx1 Tx2


MUX UR 4 MUX MUX UR 3 MUX
Rx1 Rx2 Rx1 Rx2

842236A1.CDR

The interconnection for dual-channel type 7 communications modules is shown as follows. Two-channel modules allow for
a redundant ring configuration. That is, two rings can be created to provide an additional independent data path. The
required connections are: UR1-Tx1 to UR2-Rx1, UR2-Tx1 to UR3-Rx1, UR3-Tx1 to UR4-Rx1, and UR4-Tx1 to UR1-Rx1 for the
first ring; and UR1-Tx2 to UR4-Rx2, UR4-Tx2 to UR3-Rx2, UR3-Tx2 to UR2-Rx2, and UR2-Tx2 to UR1-Rx2 for the second ring.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-37


DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-36: Direct input and output dual-channel connection

Tx1

Rx1
UR 1
Tx2

Rx2

Tx1

Rx1
UR 2
Tx2

Rx2

3 Tx1

Rx1
UR 3
Tx2

Rx2

Tx1

Rx1
UR 4
Tx2

Rx2
842007A3.CDR

The following figure shows the connection for three UR-series relays using two independent communication channels. UR1
and UR3 have single type 7 communication modules; UR2 has a dual-channel module. The two communication channels
can be of different types, depending on the type 7 modules used. To allow the direct input and output data to cross-over
from channel 1 to channel 2 on UR2, set the DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting to “Enabled” on UR2. This forces UR2 to
forward messages received on Rx1 out Tx2, and messages received on Rx2 out Tx1.
Figure 3-37: Direct input and output single/dual channel combination connection

Tx
UR 1
Rx

Channel 1

Tx1

Rx1
UR 2
Tx2

Rx2

Channel 2

Tx
UR 3
Rx
842013A2.CDR

The inter-relay communications modules are available with several interfaces and some are outlined here in more detail.
Those that apply depend on options purchased. The options are outlined in the Inter-Relay Communications section of the
Order Code tables in Chapter 2. All of the fiber modules use ST type connectors.

3-38 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS

3.4.2 Fiber: LED and ELED transmitters


The following figure shows the configuration for the 7A, 7B, 7C, 7H, 7I, and 7J fiber-only modules.
Figure 3-38: LED and ELED fiber modules
7A, 7B, and 7H, 7I, and
7C modules 7J modules

Rx1 Rx1

Tx1 Tx1

3
Rx2

Tx2

1 channel 2 channels
831719A3.CDR

3.4.3 Fiber laser transmitters


The following figure shows the configuration for the 72, 73, 7D, and 7K fiber-laser modules.
Figure 3-39: 7x Laser fiber modules
72 and 7D 73 and 7K
modules modules

Tx1 Tx1

Rx1 Rx1

Tx2

Rx2

1 channel 2 channels
831720A5.CDR

The following figure shows configuration for the 2I and 2J fiber-laser modules.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-39


DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-40: 2I and 2J laser fiber modules


2I and 2J
modules

Rx1

Tx1

Rx2

3 Tx2

2 channels
831827A1.CDR

Observing any fiber transmitter output can injure the eye.

When using a laser Interface, attenuators can be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed the
maximum optical input power to the receiver.

3.4.4 G.703 interface

3.4.4.1 Description
G.703 is an International Telecommunications Union (ITU) standard for the transmission of data and voice signals. Modules
7R (one channel) and 7S (two channels) apply.
The following figure shows the 64K ITU G.703 co-directional interface configuration. This is module 7S.
The G.703 module is fixed at 64 kbps. The SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  DIRECT I/O  DIRECT I/O DATA RATE setting is not
applicable to this module.
AWG 24 twisted shielded pair wiring is recommended for external connections, with the shield grounded only at one end.
Connecting the shield to pin X1a or X6a grounds the shield since these pins are connected internally to ground. Thus, if
pin X1a or X6a is used to ground the shield at one end, do not ground the shield at the other end. This interface module is
protected by surge suppression devices.
Figure 3-41: G.703 interface configuration
Shield ~1a
7S

Tx – ~1b
G.703 Rx – ~2a
channel 1
Tx + ~2b
Rx + ~3a
G.703 communications

Surge ~3b
Shield ~6a
Tx – ~6b
G.703 Rx – ~7a
channel 2
Tx + ~7b
Rx + ~8a
Surge ~8b
842773A3.CDR

3-40 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS

The following figure shows the typical pin interconnection between two G.703 interfaces. For the actual physical
arrangement of these pins, see the Rear Terminal Layout section earlier in this chapter. All pin interconnections are to be
maintained for a connection to a multiplexer.
Figure 3-42: Typical pin interconnection between two G.703 interfaces

Shield X1a X1a Shield

7S

7S
Tx – X1b X1b Tx –
G.703 Rx – X2a X2a Rx – G.703
channel 1 channel 1
Tx + X2b X2b Tx +
Rx + X3a X3a Rx +
G.703 communications

G.703 communications
Surge X3b X3b Surge
Shield X6a X6a Shield
Tx – X6b X6b Tx –
G.703 Rx – X7a X7a Rx – G.703
channel 2 channel 2

3
Tx + X7b X7b Tx +
Rx + X8a X8a Rx +
Surge X8b X8b Surge
831727A5.CDR

Pin nomenclature differs from one manufacturer to another. It is not uncommon to see pinouts numbered TxA, TxB,
RxA, and RxB. In such cases, assume that “A” is equivalent to “+” and “B” is equivalent to “–.”

3.4.4.2 G.703 selection switch procedures


1. With the power to the relay off, remove the G.703 module (7R or 7S) as follows. Record the original location of the
module to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct slot.
2. Simultaneously pull the ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module in order to release
the module for removal. (For more information on accessing modules, see the Maintenance chapter.)
3. Remove the module cover screw.
4. Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
5. Set the timing selection switches (channels 1 and 2) to the required timing modes.
6. Replace the top cover and the cover screw.
7. Re-insert the G.703 module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot position.
The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as the
module is inserted smoothly into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage the clips
simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is inserted fully.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-41


DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-43: G.703 timing selection switch setting


Bottom cover

Ejector/inserter clip

FRONT

Channel 1

Timing selection
switches

Top cover

3
Channel 2

Cover screw
Ejector/inserter clip

REAR
831774A3.CDR

Table 3-6: G.703 timing selections


Switches Function
S1 OFF octet timing disabled
ON octet timing 8 kHz
S5 and S6 S5 = OFF and S6 = OFF loop timing mode
S5 = ON and S6 = OFF internal timing mode
S5 = OFF and S6 = ON minimum remote loopback mode
S5 = ON and S6 = ON dual loopback mode

3.4.4.3 G.703 octet timing


If octet timing is enabled (ON), this 8 kHz signal is asserted during the violation of bit 8 (LSB) necessary for connecting to
higher order systems. When F35s are connected back-to-back, octet timing is disabled (OFF).

3.4.4.4 G.703 timing modes


There are two timing modes for the G.703 module: internal timing mode and loop timing mode (default).
• Internal Timing Mode — The system clock is generated internally. Therefore, set the G.703 timing selection to internal
timing mode for back-to-back (UR-to-UR) connections. For back-to-back connections, set octet timing (S1 = OFF) and
timing mode to internal timing (S5 = ON and S6 = OFF).
• Loop Timing Mode — The system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, set the G.703 timing
selection to loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems. For connection to a higher order system (UR-
to-multiplexer, factory defaults), set to octet timing (S1 = ON) and set timing mode to loop timing (S5 = OFF and S6 =
OFF).
The switch settings for the internal and loop timing modes are shown.

3-42 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS

Figure 3-44: Switches


Loop timing mode
Internal timing mode (factory default)

842752A2.CDR

3.4.4.5 G.703 test modes


In minimum remote loopback mode, the multiplexer is enabled to return the data from the external interface without any
processing to assist in diagnosing G.703 line-side problems irrespective of clock rate. Data enters from the G.703 inputs,
passes through the data stabilization latch that also restores the proper signal polarity, passes through the multiplexer,
and then returns to the transmitter. The differential received data is processed and passed to the G.703 transmitter module
3
after which point the data is discarded. The G.703 receiver module is fully functional and continues to process data and
passes it to the differential Manchester transmitter module. Since timing is returned as it is received, the timing source is
expected to be from the G.703 line side of the interface.
Figure 3-45: G.703 minimum remote loopback mode

DMR = Differential Manchester Receiver


DMR G7X DMX = Differential Manchester Transmitter
G7X = G.703 Transmitter
G7R = G.703 Receiver

DMX G7R
842774A1.CDR

In dual loopback mode, the multiplexers are active and the functions of the circuit are divided into two with each receiver/
transmitter pair linked together to deconstruct and then reconstruct their respective signals. Differential Manchester data
enters the Differential Manchester receiver module and then is returned to the differential Manchester transmitter module.
Likewise, G.703 data enters the G.703 receiver module and is passed through to the G.703 transmitter module to be
returned as G.703 data. Because of the complete split in the communications path and because, in each case, the clocks
are extracted and reconstructed with the outgoing data, in this mode there must be two independent sources of timing.
One source lies on the G.703 line side of the interface while the other lies on the differential Manchester side of the
interface.
Figure 3-46: G.703 dual loopback mode

DMR = Differential Manchester Receiver


DMR G7X DMX = Differential Manchester Transmitter
G7X = G.703 Transmitter
G7R = G.703 Receiver

DMX G7R
842775A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-43


DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

3.4.5 RS422 interface

3.4.5.1 Description
There are two RS422 inter-relay communications modules available: single-channel (module 7T) and dual-channel (module
7W). The modules can be configured to run at 64 kbps or 128 kbps. AWG 20 to 24 twisted shielded pair cable is
recommended for external connections. These modules are protected by optically-isolated surge suppression devices.
The shield pins (6a and 7b) are connected internally to the ground pin (8a). Proper shield termination is as follows:
• Site 1 — Terminate shield to pins 6a or 7b or both
• Site 2 — Terminate shield to COM pin 2b
Match the clock terminating impedance with the impedance of the line.
Figure 3-47: RS422 interface connections
3 Single-channel RS422 module Dual-channel RS422 module

7W
Tx – ~3b Tx – ~3b
7T

Rx – ~3a Rx – ~3a
RS422 communications

RS422 Tx + ~2a RS422 Tx + ~2a


channel 1 channel 1
Rx + ~4b Rx + ~4b
Shield ~6a Shield ~6a
+ ~7a Tx – ~5b
Clock
– ~8b Rx – ~5a
RS422 communications
Common COM ~2b RS422 Tx + ~4a
channel 2
Surge ~8a Rx + ~6b
Shield ~7b
Tx – ~7a
Clock
Rx – ~8b
Common COM ~2b
~ indicates the slot position Surge ~8a
842776A3.CDR

The following figure shows the typical pin interconnection between two single-channel RS422 interfaces installed in slot W.
All pin interconnections are to be maintained for a connection to a multiplexer.
Figure 3-48: Typical pin interconnect between two RS422 interfaces

Tx – W3b W3b Tx –
7T

7T

Rx – W3a W3a Rx –
RS422 communications

RS422 communications

RS422 Tx + W2a W2a Tx + RS422


channel 1 channel 1
Rx + W4b W4b Rx +
Shield W6a W6a Shield
+ W7a W7a +
Clock Clock
– W8b W8b –
Common COM W2b W2b COM Common
Surge W8a W8a Surge
+ –

64 or 128 kbps 831728A5.CDR

3.4.5.2 Two-channel application via multiplexers


The RS422 interface can be used for single-channel or two-channel applications over SONET/SDH or multiplexed systems.
When used in single-channel applications, the RS422 interface links to higher-order systems in a typical way, observing
transmit (Tx), receive (Rx), and send timing (ST) connections. However, when used in two-channel applications, certain
criteria must be followed since there is one clock input for the two RS422 channels. The system functions correctly when
the following connections are observed and your data module has a terminal timing feature. Terminal timing is a common
feature in most synchronous data units that allows the module to accept timing from an external source. Using the
terminal timing feature, two-channel applications can be achieved if these connections are followed: the send timing

3-44 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS

outputs from the multiplexer (data module 1) connects to the clock inputs of the UR RS422 interface in the usual way. In
addition, the send timing outputs of data module 1 are also paralleled to the terminal timing inputs of data module 2. By
using this configuration, the timing for both data modules and both UR RS422 channels is derived from a single clock
source. As a result, data sampling for both of the UR RS422 channels is synchronized via the send timing leads on data
module 1, shown as follows. If the terminal timing feature is not available or this type of connection is not wanted, the
G.703 interface is a viable option that does not impose timing restrictions.
Figure 3-49: Timing configuration for RS422 two-channel, three-terminal application
Data module 1
Signal name
Tx1(+) W2a SD(A) - Send data
7W

Tx1(–) W3b SD(B) - Send data


RS422
Rx1(+) W4b RD(A) - Received data
CHANNEL 1
Rx1(–) W3a RD(B) - Received data
Shield
+
W6a
W7a
RS(A) - Request to send (RTS)
RS(B) - Request to send (RTS)
3
CLOCK
– W8b RT(A) - Receive timing
RS422 COMMUNICATIONS

Tx2(+) W4a RT(B) - Receive timing


Tx2(–) W5b CS(A) - Clear To send
RS422
Rx2(+) W6b CS(B) - Clear To send
CHANNEL 2
Rx2(–) W5a Local loopback
Shield W7b Remote loopback
COMMON COM W2b Signal ground
SURGE W8a ST(A) - Send timing
ST(B) - Send timing

Data module 2
Signal name
TT(A) - Terminal timing
TT(B) - Terminal timing
SD(A) - Send data
SD(B) - Send data
RD(A) - Received data
RD(B) - Received data
RS(A) - Request to send (RTS)
RS(B) - Request to send (RTS)
CS(A) - Clear To send
CS(B) - Clear To send
Local loopback
Remote loopback
Signal ground
ST(A) - Send timing
ST(B) - Send timing
831022A3.CDR

Data module 1 provides timing to the F35 RS422 interface via the ST(A) and ST(B) outputs. Data module 1 also provides
timing to data module 2 TT(A) and TT(B) inputs via the ST(A) and AT(B) outputs. The data module pin numbers have been
omitted in the figure because they vary by manufacturer.

3.4.5.3 Transmit timing


The RS422 interface accepts one clock input for transmit timing. It is important that the rising edge of the 64 kHz transmit
timing clock of the multiplexer interface is sampling the data in the center of the transmit data window. Therefore, it is
important to confirm clock and data transitions to ensure proper system operation. For example, the following figure
shows the positive edge of the Tx clock in the center of the Tx data bit.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-45


DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-50: Clock and data transitions

Tx Clock

Tx Data

831733A1.CDR

3.4.5.4 Receive timing


The RS422 interface utilizes NRZI-MARK modulation code and therefore does not rely on an Rx clock to recapture data.
NRZI-MARK is an edge-type, invertible, self-clocking code.
To recover the Rx clock from the data-stream, an integrated digital phase lock loop (DPLL) circuit is utilized. The DPLL is
driven by an internal clock, which is 16-times over-sampled, and uses this clock along with the data-stream to generate a
data clock that can be used as the serial communication controller (SCC) receive clock.

3.4.6 RS422 and fiber interface


The following figure shows the combined RS422 plus fiberoptic interface configuration at 64 K baud. The 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P,
and 74 modules are used in two-terminal with a redundant channel or three-terminal configurations where channel 1 is
employed via the RS422 interface (possibly with a multiplexer) and channel 2 via direct fiber.
AWG 20 to 24 twisted shielded pair wiring is recommended for external RS422 connections. Ground the shield only at one
end. For the direct fiber channel, address power budget issues properly.

When using a laser interface, attenuators can be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed
maximum optical input power to the receiver.
Figure 3-51: RS422 and fiber interface connection

+ ~1a
7L, 7M, 7N,
7P, and 74

Clock
channel 1 – ~1b
Common COM ~2b
Tx – ~3b
Rx – ~3a
RS422 Tx + ~2a
channel 1
communications

Rx + ~4b
Shield ~6a
Fiber Tx2 Rx2
RS422

channel 2
Surge ~8a
842777A3.CDR

The connections shown in the figure are for multiplexers configured as data communications equipment (DCE) units.

3-46 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS

3.4.7 G.703 and fiber interface


The following figure shows the combined G.703 plus fiber-optic interface configuration at 64 kbps. The 7E, 7F, 7G, 7Q, and
75 modules are used in configurations where channel 1 is employed via the G.703 interface (possibly with a multiplexer)
and channel 2 via direct fiber. AWG 24 twisted shielded pair wiring is recommended for external G.703 connections
connecting the shield to pin 1a at one end only. For the direct fiber channel, address power budget issues properly. See
previous sections for details on the G.703 and fiber interfaces.

When using a laser interface, attenuators can be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed the
maximum optical input power to the receiver.
Figure 3-52: G.703 and fiber interface connection
Shield ~1a

75, 7E, 7F, 7G,


and 7Q
3
Tx – ~1b
G.703 Rx – ~2a
channel 1
Tx + ~2b

communications
Rx + ~3a
Surge ~3b

Fiber Tx2
G.703

channel 2 Rx2

842778A2.CDR

3.4.8 IEEE C37.94 interface


IEEE C37.94 is a standard interface between teleprotection equipment and digital multiplexers.
The UR-series IEEE C37.94 modules (module types 2G, 2H, 2I, 2J, 76, and 77) are designed to interface with IEEE C37.94
compliant digital multiplexers or an IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converter for use with direct input and output
applications. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link for synchronous data between a multiplexer
and a teleprotection device. Data speed is typically 64 kbps, but the standard provides for speeds up to 64n kbps, where n
= 1, 2,…, 12. The UR-series C37.94 communication modules are either 64 kbps (with n fixed at 1) or 128 kbps (with n fixed at
2). The frame is a valid International Telecommunications Union (ITU-T) recommended G.704 pattern from the standpoint
of framing and data rate. The frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit rate of 2048
kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:
• IEEE standard — C37.94 for 1  128 kbps optical fiber interface (for 2G and 2H modules) or C37.94 for 2  64 kbps
optical fiber interface (for 76 and 77 modules)
• Fiber-optic cable type — 50 nm or 62.5 μm core diameter optical fiber
• Fiber-optic mode — multimode
• Fiber-optic cable length — up to 2 km
• Fiber-optic connector — type ST
• Wavelength — 820 ±40 nm
• Connection — as per all fiber-optic connections, a Tx-to-Rx connection is required
The UR-series C37.94 module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that supports the IEEE C37.94
standard. The figure shows the concept.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-47


DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-53: IEEE C37.94 connection to compliant digital multiplexer


IEEE C37.94
fiber interface

Digital
UR-series multiplexer,
device IEEE C37.94
compliant

up to 2 km

842755A2.CDR

The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected to the electrical interface (G.703, RS422, or X.21) of a non-
compliant digital multiplexer via an optical-to-electrical interface converter that supports the IEEE C37.94 standard. The
following figure shows the concept.

3 Figure 3-54: IEEE C37.94 connection to non-compliant digital multiplexer

IEEE C37.94 RS422


fiber interface interface
Digital
UR-series IEEE C37.94 multiplexer
device converter with EIA-422
interface
up to 2 km

842756A2.CDR

In 2008, GE Grid Solutions released revised modules 76 and 77 for C37.94 communication to enable multi-ended fault
location functionality with firmware 5.60 release and higher. All modules 76 and 77 shipped since the change support this
feature and are fully backward compatible with firmware releases below 5.60. For customers using firmware release 5.60
and higher, the module can be identified with "Rev D" printed on it and is to be used on all ends of F35 communication for
two and three terminal applications. Failure to use it at all ends results in intermittent communication alarms. For
customers using firmware revisions below 5.60, it is not required to match the revision of the modules installed.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module has six switches to set the clock configuration. The following figure shows
the functions of these control switches.
Figure 3-55: Switches
Loop timing mode
Internal timing mode (factory default)

842753A2.CDR

For the internal timing mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, set the timing switch selection to internal
timing for relay 1 and loop timed for relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the looped timing mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, set the timing selection to
loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems.
The IEEE C37.94 communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
1. With power to the relay off, remove the IEEE C37.94 module (type 2G, 2H, 2I, 2J, 76, or 77 module) as follows. Record
the original location of the module to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct
slot.
2. Simultaneously pull the ejector/inserter clips located at the top and bottom of each module in order to release the
module for removal.
3. Remove the module cover screw.

3-48 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS

4. Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
5. Set the timing selection switches (channels 1 and 2) to the required timing modes (see description earlier).
6. Replace the top cover and the cover screw.
7. Re-insert the IEEE C37.94 module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot
position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged
position as the module is inserted smoothly into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis,
engage the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is inserted fully.
Figure 3-56: IEEE C37.94 timing selection switch setting
Bottom cover

Ejector/inserter clip

FRONT 3
Channel 1

Timing selection
switches

Top cover

Channel 2

Cover screw
Ejector/inserter clip

REAR
831774A3.CDR

Modules shipped since January 2012 have status LEDs that indicate the status of the DIP switches, as shown in the
following figure.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-49


DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-57: Status LEDs

Tx1
CH1 Link/Activity LED
COMMS
Rx1
2B
C37.94SM
1300nm single-mode
ELED
2 channel
Tx1

Tx2
REV. D CH2 Link/Activity LED
Technical support:

3
Tel: (905)294-6222
Fax: (905)201-2098
Rx2
(NORTH AMERICA)
1 800 547-8629

GE Multilin

Made in Canada Tx2

CH1 Clock Configuration LED


CH2 Clock Configuration LED

FRONT VIEW REAR VIEW 842837A1.cdr

The clock configuration LED status is as follows:


• Flashing green — loop timing mode while receiving a valid data packet
• Flashing yellow — internal mode while receiving a valid data packet
• Solid red — (switch to) internal timing mode while not receiving a valid data packet
The link/activity LED status is as follows:
• Flashing green — FPGA is receiving a valid data packet
• Solid yellow — FPGA is receiving a "yellow bit" and remains yellow for each "yellow bit"
• Solid red — FPGA is not receiving a valid packet or the packet received is invalid

3.4.9 C37.94SM interface


The UR-series C37.94SM communication modules (2A and 2B) are designed to interface with modified IEEE C37.94
compliant digital multiplexers or IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converters that have been converted from 820 nm multi-
mode fiber optics to 1300 nm ELED single-mode fiber optics. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link
for synchronous data between a multiplexer and a teleprotection device. This data is typically 64 kbps, but the standard
provides for speeds up to 64n kbps, where n = 1, 2,…, 12. The UR-series C37.94SM communication module is 64 kbps only
with n fixed at 1. The frame is a valid ITU-recommended G.704 pattern from the standpoint of framing and data rate. The
frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit rate of 2048 kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:
• Emulated IEEE standard — Emulates C37.94 for 1  64 kbps optical fiber interface (modules set to n = 1 or 64 kbps)
• Fiber-optic cable type — 9/125 m core diameter optical fiber
• Fiber-optic mode — Single-mode, ELED compatible with HP HFBR-1315T transmitter and HP HFBR-2316T receiver
• Fiber-optic cable length — Up to 11.4 km
• Fiber-optic connector — Type ST
• Wavelength — 1300 ±40 nm
• Connection — As per all fiber-optic connections, a Tx-to-Rx connection is required

3-50 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS

The UR-series C37.94SM communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that
supports C37.94SM, as shown.

C37.94SM
fiber interface

Digital
UR-series
multiplexer
device
C97.94SM

up to 10 km

842757A2.CDR

It also can be connected directly to any other UR-series relay with a C37.94SM module, as shown.

C37.94SM
fiber interface 3
UR-series UR-series
device with device with
C37.94SM C37.94SM
module module
up to 10 km

842758A2.CDR

In 2008, GE Grid Solutions released revised modules 2A and 2B for C37.94SM communication to enable multi-ended fault
location functionality with firmware 5.60 release and higher. All modules 2A and 2B shipped since the change support this
feature and are fully backward compatible with firmware releases below 5.60. For customers using firmware release 5.60
and higher, the module can be identified with "Rev D" printed on it and is to be used on all ends of F35 communication for
two and three terminal applications. Failure to use it at all ends results in intermittent communication alarms. For
customers using firmware revisions below 5.60, it is not required to match the revision of the modules installed.
The UR-series C37.94SM module has six switches that are used to set the clock configuration. The following figure shows
the functions of these control switches.
Figure 3-58: Switches

Loop timing mode


Internal timing mode (factory default)

842753A2.CDR

For the internal timing mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, set the timing switch selection to internal
timing for relay 1 and loop timed for relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the looped timing mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, set the timing selection to
loop timing mode for connections to higher-order systems.
The C37.94SM communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
1. With power to the relay off, remove the C37.94SM module (module 2A or 2B) as follows. Record the original location of
the module to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct slot.
2. Simultaneously pull the ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module in order to release
the module for removal.
3. Remove the module cover screw.
4. Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
5. Set the timing selection switches (channels 1 and 2) to the required timing modes (see description earlier).

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-51


DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

6. Replace the top cover and the cover screw.


7. Re-insert the C37.94SM module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot
position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged
position as the module is inserted smoothly into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis,
engage the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is inserted fully.
Figure 3-59: C37.94SM timing selection switch setting
Bottom cover

Ejector/inserter clip

FRONT

3 Channel 1

Timing selection
switches

Top cover

Channel 2

Cover screw
Ejector/inserter clip

REAR
831774A3.CDR

Modules shipped since January 2012 have status LEDs that indicate the status of the DIP switches, as shown in the
following figure.

3-52 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION ACTIVATE RELAY

Figure 3-60: Status LEDs

Tx1
CH1 Link/Activity LED
COMMS
Rx1
2B
C37.94SM
1300nm single-mode
ELED
2 channel
Tx1

Tx2
REV. D CH2 Link/Activity LED
Technical support:
Tel: (905)294-6222
Fax: (905)201-2098
(NORTH AMERICA)
1 800 547-8629
Rx2
3
GE Multilin

Made in Canada Tx2

CH1 Clock Configuration LED


CH2 Clock Configuration LED

FRONT VIEW REAR VIEW 842837A1.cdr

The clock configuration LED status is as follows:


• Flashing green — loop timing mode while receiving a valid data packet
• Flashing yellow — internal mode while receiving a valid data packet
• Solid red — (switch to) internal timing mode while not receiving a valid data packet
The link/activity LED status is as follows:
• Flashing green — FPGA is receiving a valid data packet
• Solid yellow — FPGA is receiving a "yellow bit" and remains yellow for each "yellow bit"
• Solid red — FPGA is not receiving a valid packet or the packet received is invalid

3.5 Activate relay


The relay is in the default “Not Programmed” state when it leaves the factory. When powered up successfully, looking at
the front panel, the "Trouble" LED is on and the "In Service" LED is off. The relay in the “Not Programmed” state blocks
signaling of any output relay. These conditions remain until the relay is explicitly put into “Programmed” state.

RELAY SETTINGS: When the relay is powered up, the "Trouble LED" is on, the "In Service" LED is off, and this message
Not Programmed displays, indicating that the relay is in the "Not Programmed" state and is safeguarding (output
relays blocked) against the installation of a relay whose settings have not been entered. This
message remains until the relay is explicitly put into "Programmed" state.

The relay can be activated on the front panel or in the EnerVista software.
To activate the relay using the front panel:
1. Press the MENU key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the PRODUCT SETUP message displays.
2. Press the MESSAGE right arrow until the SECURITY message displays.
3. Press the MESSAGE down arrow until the INSTALLATION message displays.
4. Press the MESSAGE right arrow until the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message displays.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-53


INSTALL SOFTWARE CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

SETTINGS


 SETTINGS  SECURITY
 PRODUCT SETUP  

 DISPLAY
  PROPERTIES


 INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS:
   Not Programmed

3 5. After the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message displays, press a VALUE key to change the selection to
"Programmed."
6. Press the ENTER key to save the change.

RELAY SETTINGS: RELAY SETTINGS: NEW SETTING


Not Programmed Programmed HAS BEEN STORED

7. When the "NEW SETTING HAS BEEN STORED" message appears, the relay is in "Programmed" state and the "In Service"
LED turns on.
To activate the relay using EnerVista software:
1. Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Installation and change the Relay Settings field to "Programmed."
2. Save the change.

3.6 Install software


3.6.1 EnerVista communication overview
The EnerVista UR Setup software communicates to the relay via the front panel RS232 or USB port or the rear RS485 /
Ethernet ports.
To communicate via the RS232 port, use a standard straight-through serial cable. Connect the DB-9 male end to the relay
and the DB-9 or DB-25 female end to the computer COM2 port as described in the CPU Communication Ports section
earlier in this chapter.

3-54 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION INSTALL SOFTWARE

Figure 3-61: Relay communication options

Regional
control
center

Ethernet Remote
10/100 Mbps communications link
Local
control

UR-series IED
EnerVista Engineer

GE Multilin F485
communications converter
Modem
3
RS485 115 kbps

RS232

EnerVista
Reports

EnerVista

Troubleshooting
Commissioning
Setting changes

842759A2.CDR

To communicate through the F35 rear RS485 port from a computer RS232 port, the GE Grid Solutions RS232/RS485
converter box is required. This device (catalog number F485) connects to the computer using a straight-through serial
cable. A shielded twisted-pair wire (20, 22, or 24 AWG) connects the F485 converter to the F35 rear communications port.
The converter terminals (+, –, GND) are connected to the F35 communication module (+, –, COM) terminals. See the CPU
Communication Ports section in chapter 3 for details. The line is terminated with an R-C network (that is, 120 , 1 nF) as
described in this chapter.

3.6.2 System requirements


The relay front panel or the EnerVista UR Setup software can be used to communicate with the relay. The software
interface is the preferred method to edit settings and view actual values because the computer monitor can display more
information.
The system requirements for the EnerVista software are as follows:
• Intel Pentium processor (dual core) or (recommended) Core Duo
• Microsoft Windows 7 with Service Pack 1 (32-bit or 64-bit), Windows 10, Windows Server 2008 Release 2 with Service
Pack 1 (64-bit), or Windows Server 2012 Release 2 (64-bit), in the required EnerVista language, such as French or
Japanese
• 1 GB free hard drive space
• 2 GB RAM
• 1280 x 800 display screen

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-55


INSTALL SOFTWARE CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

3.6.3 Install software


After ensuring that the requirements for using EnerVista UR Setup software are met, there are three ways to install the
software:
• From the DVD
• Download EnerVista Launchpad software from http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin and install it
• Download the EnerVista UR Setup software from http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin and install it
Install on a computer that has an operating system in the required language, for example a German operating system for
use with EnerVista software in German.

The front panel can be switched in the EnerVista software between enhanced and basic panels under
Maintenance > Change Front Panel.

3 To install the software from the DVD and using EnerVista Launchpad:
1. Insert the DVD into the DVD drive of your computer.
2. Click the Install Now button and follow the instructions.
3. When installation is complete, start the EnerVista Launchpad application.
4. Click the IED Setup section of the Launch Pad window.
Figure 3-62: Adding a UR device in Launchpad window

5. In the EnerVista Launch Pad window, click the Add Product button and select the appropriate product as follows.
Select the Web option to ensure the most recent software release, or select CD if you do not have an Internet
connection, then click the Add Now button to list software items for the product. EnerVista Launchpad obtains the
software from the Internet or DVD and automatically starts the installation program after prompting about updates.
From the web, the software is downloaded. A wizard opens.

3-56 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE

Figure 3-63: Identifying the UR device type

6. In the wizard, click the Next button and complete the process. The files are installed in the directory indicated, and the
installation program automatically creates icons and adds an entry to the Windows start menu.
The UR device is added to the EnerVista Launchpad window, as shown.
Figure 3-64: UR device added to Launchpad window

7. For other than English, configure the language for the front panel in the EnerVista software under Settings > Product
Setup > Display Properties. User-entered strings are not translated, for example relay names, so setting the language
now ensures that the names are entered/displayed in the required language. For the EnerVista software language,
access the View > Language menu item.

3.7 Add device to software


You connect remotely to the F35 through the rear RS485 or Ethernet port with a computer running the EnerVista UR Setup
software. The F35 also can be accessed locally with a computer through the front panel RS232 or USB port or the rear
Ethernet port using the Quick Connect feature.
The following procedures are outlined:
• Add device for serial access; see the Configure Serial Connection section
• Add device for the rear Ethernet port; see the Configure Ethernet Connection section
• Add device for access using a modem; see the Configure Modem Connection section

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-57


ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

• Connect locally with a computer through either the front RS232 or USB port or rear Ethernet port; see the Connect to
the F35 section
• Discover automatically UR devices within a network; see the Automatic Discovery of UR Devices section
Devices in the Device Setup window are listed in the order entered.
Devices in the main software window are listed alphabetically. Use the Device Name to order them as required, for
example B30 Odessa, B30 Truro, B90, T35.
You cannot import a file to add a device to the software. You can import settings as outlined at the end of the chapter.
The Quick Connect button also can be used to add devices. The device is added to a Quick Connect menu item in the
Online Window area, cannot be moved from it to another grouping, and needs to be renamed in the Device Setup window.
GE instead recommends using the Device Setup window to add devices, as outlined here.

3.7.1 Set IP address in UR


3
Implement IP addresses for the computer and a F35 device as follows.
The UR family supports the use of subnetworks as documented in RFC 950, which divides class-based networks into
subnetworks (non-CIDR). The classes and IP address ranges are defined as follows.
Table 3-7: IP address classes
Classes IP address range Default subnet mask address UR devices
A 1.0.0.0 to 127.255.255.255 255.0.0.0 65,535 or more
B 128.0.0.0 to 191.255.255.255 255.255.0.0 255 to 65,534
C 192.0.0.0 to 223.255.255.255 255.255.255.0 0 to 254
D 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255 (Reserved for multicasting)
E 240.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (Reserved)

Both network and subnet addresses are contained within a range. The number of hosts determines the class and
addresses as follows:
• Class A 255.0.0.0 — The first octet (255) specifies the network, the second to fourth octets (0) specify the subnet and
host. Use this class when you have more than 65,535 hosts (UR devices).
• Class B 255.255.0.0 — The first two octets (255) specify the network, the third octet (0) specifies the subnet, and the
fourth octet (0) specifies the host. Use this class when you have 255 to 65,534 hosts (UR devices).
• Class C 255.255.255.0 — The first three octets (255) specify the network and the last octet (0) specifies the subnet and
host. Use this class when you have up to 254 hosts (UR devices).
An example of implementation is one computer and one UR device. Because there is one UR device, class C addressing is
required. So we use UR 192.167.2.x with subnet mask 255.255.255.0 and computer 192.167.3.x with subnet mask
255.255.255.0.
For older, non-CIDR routing protocols, such as RIP version 1, follow these restrictions:
• Identical subnet masks — Use a single mask for all subnets within a network
• Contiguous subnets — The subnets must be contiguous and not split among networks. The subnets cannot pass
traffic through other networks.

The IP and subnet addresses need to be added to the UR for Ethernet communication.
For serial communication, for example using any front RS232 port and the Quick Connect feature, the addresses are not
required, but typically they are entered to add/configure devices for regular use.
To add the IP addresses:
1. On the front of the UR, press the MENU key until the SETTINGS menu displays.
2. Navigate to SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  NETWORK  PRT IP ADDRESS SETTING.
3. Enter an IP address, for example 10.11.33.1, and press the ENTER key to save the value. For example, press the period
key to clear any existing address, then press the number keys to add anew address.

3-58 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE

4. In the same menu, select the PRT SUBNET IP MASK setting. Enter a subnet IP address, for example 255.0.0.0.
5. Press the ENTER key to save the value.
The gateway address also needs to be configured when connecting through an Ethernet network. Access SETTINGS 
PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IPv4 ROUTE TABLE  DEFAULT IPv4 ROUTE  GATEWAY ADDRESS.
If using a blue or grey Ethernet cable, skip the rest of the this section. If using an orange cross-over Ethernet cable, the
computer needs to be set up as follows.
1. Use an orange Ethernet cross-over cable to connect the computer to the rear Ethernet port. In case you need it, the
following figure shows the pinout for an Ethernet cross-over cable.
Figure 3-65: Ethernet cross-over cable PIN layout

3 4 5 6
END 1 END 2
2 7 Pin Wire color Diagram Pin Wire color Diagram
1 8
3
1 White/orange 1 White/green
2 Orange 2 Green
3 White/green 3 White/orange
4 Blue 4 Blue
5 White/blue 5 White/blue
6 Green 6 Orange
7 White/brown 7 White/brown
8 Brown 8 Brown
842799A1.CDR

Next, assign the computer an IP address compatible with the relay’s IP address.
1. From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network
connections window. Or in Windows 7, access the Network and Sharing Center in the Control Panel.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-59


ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

2. Right-click the Local Area Connection icon and select Properties.

3. Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list, and click the Properties button.

4. Click the “Use the following IP address” box.


5. Enter an IP address with the first three numbers the same as the IP address of the F35 relay and the last number
different (in this example, 1.1.1.2).
6. Enter a subnet mask equal to the one set in the F35 (in this example, 255.0.0.0).
7. Click the OK button to save the values.

3-60 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE

Before continuing, test the Ethernet connection.


1. Open a Windows console window, for example by selecting Start > Run from the Windows Start menu and typing
“cmd” or clicking the Start button and entering "cmd".
2. Type the following command, substituting the IP address of 1.1.1.1 with yours:
C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1
3. If the connection is successful, the system returns four replies similar to the following:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Reply from 1.1.1.1: bytes=32 time<10ms TTL=255
Reply from 1.1.1.1: bytes=32 time<10ms TTL=255
Reply from 1.1.1.1: bytes=32 time<10ms TTL=255
Reply from 1.1.1.1: bytes=32 time<10ms TTL=255
Ping statistics for 1.1.1.1:
Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 4, Lost = 0 (0% loss),
Approximate round trip time in milliseconds:
Minimum = 0ms, Maximum = 0ms, Average = 0 ms 3
4. Note that the values for time and TTL vary depending on local network configuration.
5. If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Request timed out.
Request timed out.
Request timed out.
Request timed out.
Ping statistics for 1.1.1.1:
Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 0, Lost = 4 (100% loss),
Approximate round trip time in milliseconds:
Minimum = 0ms, Maximum = 0ms, Average = 0 ms
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
verify the physical connection between the F35 and the computer, and double-check the programmed IP address in
the PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  NETWORK  IP ADDRESS setting, then repeat step 2.
6. If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Hardware error.
Hardware error.
Hardware error.
Hardware error.
Ping statistics for 1.1.1.1:
Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 0, Lost = 4 (100% loss),
Approximate round trip time in milliseconds:
Minimum = 0ms, Maximum = 0ms, Average = 0 ms
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
verify the physical connection between the F35 and the computer, and double-check the programmed IP address in
the PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  NETWORK  IP ADDRESS setting, then repeat step 2.
7. If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Destination host unreachable.
Destination host unreachable.
Destination host unreachable.
Destination host unreachable.
Ping statistics for 1.1.1.1:
Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 0, Lost = 4 (100% loss),
Approximate round trip time in milliseconds:
Minimum = 0ms, Maximum = 0ms, Average = 0 ms
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
verify the IP address is programmed in the local computer by entering the ipconfig command in the command
window.
C:\WINNT>ipconfig
Windows IP Configuration

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-61


ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Ethernet adapter <F4FE223E-5EB6-4BFB-9E34-1BD7BE7F59FF>:


Connection-specific DNS suffix. . :
IP Address. . . . . . . . . . . . : 0.0.0.0
Subnet Mask . . . . . . . . . . . : 0.0.0.0
Default Gateway . . . . . . . . . :
Ethernet adapter Local Area Connection:
Connection-specific DNS suffix . :
IP Address. . . . . . . . . . . . : 1.1.1.2
Subnet Mask . . . . . . . . . . . : 255.0.0.0
Default Gateway . . . . . . . . . :
C:\WINNT>

Before using the Quick Connect feature through the Ethernet port, disable any configured proxy settings in Internet
Explorer.

3 1. Start the Internet Explorer software.


2. Select the Tools > Internet Options menu item and click the Connections tab.
3. Click on the LAN Settings button to open the following window.

4. Ensure that the “Use a proxy server for your LAN” box is not checked.

If this computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the computer has been
disconnected from the F35 relay.
1. Start the Internet Explorer software.
2. Select the UR device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.

3-62 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE

3. Click the Quick Connect button to open the window.

4. Select the Ethernet interface and enter the IP address assigned to the F35, then click the Connect button. The 3
EnerVista UR Setup software creates a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named “Quick
Connect” and displays them on the left side of the screen.
5. Expand the sections to view data directly from the F35 device.
Each time that the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct
communications to the F35. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the F35 model
number.

When direct communications with the F35 via Ethernet is complete, make the following changes:
1. From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network
connections window.
2. Right-click the Local Area Connection icon and select the Properties item.
3. Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list provided and click the Properties button.
4. Set the computer to “Obtain a relay address automatically” as shown.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-63


ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

If the computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the computer has been
disconnected from the F35 relay.

3.7.2 Configure serial connection


Two options are possible: local connection between computer and front RS232 port, and remote connection using the rear
RS485 terminals.
To use the RS485 terminals at the back of the relay, a GE Grid Solutions F485 converter (or compatible RS232-to-RS485
converter) is required. See the F485 instruction manual for details.
1. Connect the computer to the F485 and the F485 to the RS485 terminal on the back of the UR device. Or connect the
computer to the RS232 port on the front of the relay.
2. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software, or in EnerVista Launchpad select the UR device to start the software.

3 3.
4.
Click the Device Setup button. The window opens.
Click the Add Site button. A new category is added. Enter a site name in the Site Name field. Optionally add a short
Description of the site. This example uses “Location 1” as the site name.
5. Click the Add Device button. A new device is added.
6. Enter a name in the Device Name field, up to 15 characters, and optionally add a Description of the site. The Color is
for the text in the device list in the Online Window.
7. Select “Serial” from the Interface drop-down list. Interface parameters display that must be entered for serial
communications. Try to load automatically the fields by clicking the Read Order Code button.
Figure 3-66: Configuring serial communication

8. Enter the COM port used by the computer, the baud rate, and parity settings from the front panel SETTINGS  PRODUCT
SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  SERIAL PORTS menu, and the relay slave address setting from the front panel SETTINGS
 PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  MODBUS PROTOCOL  MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS menu in their respective

3-64 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE

fields.
Baud Rate — Typically 19200 bits per second (bps) for RS232, and higher for RS485. Both modems need to use the
same rate, meaning at the computer and the F35 ends.
Parity — Set to None if unsure
Bits — Set to 8 if unsure
Stop Bits — Set to 1 if unsure
Post Terminal Window — Enable this option if you have a Schweitzer Engineering (SEL) SEL-203x Communications
Processor, such as an SEL-2030 or SEL-2032. This option enables display of a terminal window to allow interaction
with the other device.
9. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the F35 and upload the order code to the EnerVista software. If a
communications error occurs, ensure that the EnerVista software serial communications values entered in the
previous step correspond to the relay setting values, and also ensure that the same IP address is not assigned to
multiple F35 ports.
10. Click the OK button when the relay order code has been received. The new site and device are added to the Online
3
Window.
The device has been configured for serial communications. Proceed to the Connect to the F35 section to begin
communication.

3.7.3 Configure Ethernet connection


You connect the Ethernet cable, define a site in the software, then add the relay as a device for the site.
The Ethernet cable can be connected from the relay to an Ethernet network or directly to the computer. The computer and
UR device must be on the same subnet.
1. Connect the Ethernet network cable and any SFP supplied with the F35 to the Ethernet port on the back of the device.
2. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software, or in EnerVista Launchpad select the UR device to start the software.
3. Click the Device Setup button. The window opens.
4. Click the Add Site button. A new category is added. Enter a site name in the Site Name field. Optionally add a short
Description of the site. This example uses “Location 1” as the site name.
5. Click the Add Device button. A new device is added.
6. Enter a name in the Device Name field, up to 15 characters, and optionally add a Description of the site. The Color is
for the text in the device list in the Online Window.
7. Select “Ethernet” from the Interface drop-down list. This displays a number of interface parameters that must be
entered for Ethernet functionality.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-65


ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-67: Configuring Ethernet communication

8. Enter the relay IP Address, which can be viewed on the device front panel under SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP 
COMMUNICATIONS  NETWORK  IP ADDRESS. Once the IP address is entered, try to load automatically the fields by
clicking the Read Order Code button.
9. Enter the relay Slave address and Modbus Port address values from the settings in the front panel SETTINGS 
PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL menu.
10. If using a gateway to connect to the device, select Yes from the drop-down list.
11. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the F35 device and upload the order code. If the device was entered
already, a message displays "Device ’x’ is also using IP address...." If a communications error occurs, ensure that the
values entered in the previous steps correspond to the relay setting values, and also ensure that the same IP address
is not assigned to multiple F35 ports.
12. Click the OK button when the relay order code has been received. The new site and device are added to the Online
Window.
The device has been configured for Ethernet communications. Proceed to the Connect to the F35 section to begin
communications.

3.7.4 Configure modem connection


A modem connection allows a computer to communicate with a UR device over phone lines.
Two modems are required. One modem is connected to the UR device, either by connecting the serial cable to the front
panel port or through a RS485 box to the rear terminals of the UR device. The second modem is connected to the
computer that initiates the connection.
To add a UR device for modem connections:
1. Connect the modems to the computer and UR.

3-66 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION ADD DEVICE TO SOFTWARE

2. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software, or in EnerVista Launchpad select the UR device to start the software.
3. Click the Device Setup button. The window opens.
4. Click the Add Site button. A new category is added. Enter a site name in the Site Name field, such as London East.
Optionally add a short Description of the site, such as the address or intersection.
5. Click the Add Device button. A new device is added.
6. Enter a name in the Device Name field, up to 15 characters, and optionally add a Description of the site. The Color is
for the text in the device list in the Online Window.
7. Select “Modem” from the Interface drop-down list. This displays a number of interface parameters that must be
entered.
8. Select "Generic Modem" from the Modem Name drop-down list, then enter the Phone Number to dial to establish
communication with the remote modem.
Post Terminal Window — Enable this option if you have a SEL-203x Communications Processor, such as an SEL-2030
or SEL-2032. It enables display of a terminal window to allow interaction with the other device. 3
9. Once the phone number is entered, try to load automatically the device information by clicking the Read Order Code
button.
10. Click the OK button when the relay order code has been received. The new device is added to the Online window.
The UR device has been added to the software.

3.7.5 Automatic discovery of UR devices


The EnerVista UR Setup software can find and communicate to all UR-family devices located on an Ethernet network.
Using the Discover button in the Device Setup window, a single click of the mouse triggers the software to detect any URs
located on the network. This is done by searching a range of IP addresses based on the subnet mask of the computer.
When a UR device is detected, the EnerVista UR Setup software proceeds to configure all settings and order code options
in the window. This feature allows the user to identify and interrogate all UR devices at a location.
Examples of address ranges are as follows:
• If the host has an IP address of 3.94.247.10 and its subnet mask is 255.255.252.0, then the host’s subnet is 3.94.244.0,
and the possible IP addresses in this subnet are
3.94.244.1 to 254
3.94.245.1 to 254
3.94.246.1 to 254
3.94.247.1 to 254
The discover function scans all those possible IP addresses to detect UR relays.
• If the host has an IP address of 3.94.247.145 and its subnet mask is 255.255.255.128, then the host’s subnet is
3.94.247.128, and the discover function scans IP addresses of 3.94.247.128 to 3.94.248.254 for UR relays
To automatically add UR devices:
1. In the EnerVista software, click the Device Setup button. The window opens.
2. Click the Discover button. The software searches for UR devices on the computer subnet and adds any found to the
Online Window area. If a required device is not found, add it manually as outlined earlier.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-67


CONNECT TO THE F35 CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-68: Discover button to detect UR devices in network

3 3.8 Connect to the F35


There are four ways to the connect to the device, as follows:
• RS232 or USB port (outlined here)
• RS485 port
• Ethernet port (outlined here)
• LAN
When unable to connect because of an "ACCESS VIOLATION," access Device Setup and refresh the order code for the
device.
When unable to connect, ensure that the same IP address is not assigned to multiple F35 ports, for example under
Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Network.
If still unable to connect, try unplugging and replugging the Ethernet connection. If that does not work, try to ping the
device from the computer, and if unsuccessful, restart the computer.

When multiple computers are connected to a F35 device, EnerVista settings windows are not updated
automatically. They are refreshed when re-opened. If a user changes a setting on one computer, the other users
need to refresh the display by closing and opening the settings window to see the change. To ensure that current
settings are always viewed, close settings windows when not in use so that they are up-to-date when next
accessed.

3.8.1 Connect to the F35 in EnerVista


For information on using the EnerVista software, see the Interfaces chapter.
To access the relay in EnerVista:
1. Open the Settings > Product Setup > Display Properties window as shown. The window opens with a status indicator
on the lower left of the EnerVista UR Setup window.

3-68 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION CONNECT TO THE F35

Figure 3-69: EnerVista window

Quick action hot links

3
Expand the site list by double-clicking
or selecting the +/– box.

Communications status indicators:


Green = OK
Red = No communications
UR icon = report is open

842743A3.CDR

2. If the status indicator is red, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the
back of the relay and that the relay has been properly set up for communication.
3. If a relay icon appears in place of the status indicator, then a report (such as an oscillography or event record) is open.
Close the report to re-display the green status indicator.
4. The Display Properties settings can now be viewed, edited, or printed.

3.8.1.1 Quick action hot links


The EnerVista UR Setup software has several quick action buttons to provide instant access to several functions that are
performed often when using URs. From the online window, users can select the relay to interrogate from a pull-down
window, then click the button for the action to perform. The following quick action functions are available:
• View the event record
• View the last recorded oscillography record
• View the F35 protection summary
• View all of the F35 metering values
• View the status of all F35 inputs and outputs
• Generate a service report

3.8.2 Use Quick Connect via front RS232 port


This feature applies to the enhanced and basic front panels.
To connect to the UR from a computer using a serial cable:
1. Connect an RS232 serial cable to the computer and the front panel RS232 port. For example, use a USB-to-serial
RS232 DB9M converter cable when connecting to the USB port on the computer.
2. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software, or in EnerVista Launchpad select the UR device to start the software.
3. Click the Quick Connect button. The window opens.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-69


CONNECT TO THE F35 CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-70: Quick Connect window to access a device

3 4. Select the serial Interface and the communications port (COM Port) from the drop-down lists, then click Connect. The
COM Port is that of the computer.
5. The EnerVista software creates a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named “Quick
Connect” and displays them in the Online Window. Expand the sections to view data directly from the UR device. Use
the Device Setup button to change the site name.
Each time that the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct
communications to the F35. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the F35 model
number.

3.8.3 Use Quick Connect via front USB port


This feature applies to the graphical front panel.
To connect to the UR from a computer using a USB cable:
1. Connect the cable to the computer and the front panel USB port (square connector).
2. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software, or in EnerVista Launchpad select the UR device to start the software.
3. Click the Quick Connect button to open the window.
4. Select the USB Interface and the "GE Virtual Serial Port" driver from the drop-down list, then click Connect. If the GE
driver does not display, it means that the USB cable was connected on Windows 10 when upgrading the UR software.
You need to re-install the EnerVista software with the USB cable disconnected.
5. The EnerVista software creates a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named “Quick
Connect” and displays them in the Online Window. Expand the sections to view data directly from the UR device. Use
the Device Setup button to change the site name.
Each time that the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct
communications to the F35. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the F35 model
number.

3.8.4 Use Quick Connect via a rear Ethernet port


To connect to a UR using an Ethernet cable:
1. In the EnerVista software, click the Quick Connect button. The window opens.

3-70 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION SET UP CYBERSENTRY AND CHANGE DEFAULT PASSWORD

Figure 3-71: Quick Connect window for Ethernet connection

2. Select the Ethernet interface and enter the IP address assigned to the F35, then click the Connect button. The 3
EnerVista UR Setup software creates a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named "Quick
Connect" and displays them in the Online Window.
3. Expand the sections to view data directly from the F35 device. Use the Device Setup button to change the site name.
Each time that the EnerVista software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct communications to
the F35. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the F35 model number.

3.9 Set up CyberSentry and change default password


If and when first using CyberSentry security, use the following procedure for set up.
1. Log in to the relay as Administrator by using the VALUE keys on the front panel or through EnerVista connected serially
(so that no IP address is required). If logging in through EnerVista choose Device authentication (see figure). Enter the
default password "ChangeMe1#". Note that the "Lock relay" setting needs to be disabled in the Security > Supervisory
menu. When this setting is disabled, configuration and firmware upgrade are possible. By default, this setting is
disabled.
2. Enable the Supervisor role if you have a need for it.
3. Make any required changes in configuration, such as setting a valid IP address for communication over Ethernet.
4. Log out of the Administrator account by choosing None.
Next, device or server authentication can be chosen on the login screen, but the choice is available only in EnerVista. Use
Device authentication to log in using the five pre-configured roles (Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator, Observer,
or Administrator and Supervisor when Device authentication is disabled). When using a serial connection, only Device
authentication is supported. When Server authentication is required, characteristics for communication with a RADIUS
server must be configured on the UR. This is possible only through the EnerVista software. The RADIUS server itself also
must be configured. At the end of this instruction manual, the appendix called RADIUS Server Configuration gives an
example of how to set up a simple RADIUS server. Once both the RADIUS server and the parameters for connecting the UR
to the server have been configured, you can choose Server authentication on the login screen of EnerVista.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-71


IMPORT SETTINGS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

Figure 3-72: Login screen for CyberSentry

3
During the commissioning phase, you have the option to bypass the use of passwords. Do so by enabling the Bypass
Access setting under Settings > Product Setup > Security > Supervisory. Be sure to disable this bypass setting after
commissioning the device.
You can change the password for any role either from the front panel or through EnerVista. If using EnerVista, navigate to
Settings > Product Setup > Security. Change the Local Administrator Password, for example. It is strongly recommended
that the password for the Administrator be changed from the default. Changing the passwords for the other three roles is
optional.

3.10 Import settings


The following file types can be imported:
• URS — UR settings file (firmware version7.3x or earlier)
• IID — Instantiated IED capability description file — Actual settings on UR
• CID — Configured IED description file — Settings sent to the UR (may or may not be actual settings). When using IEC
61850, network settings can also be configured by accepting a CID file that includes them, as long as the IP address of
at least one port is manually configured in the relay before the CID file is sent and the IP address matches that in the
file.
The import is done in the Offline Window area.
To import a settings file:
1. In the Offline Window area, right-click the device and select the Add Device from File option. The device is that from
which you want to import settings.
2. If required, change the Files of type drop-down list.
3. Select the file to import.
To apply the settings to a live device:
1. Drag-and-drop the device entry from the Offline Window area to its entry in the Online Window area.
Individual settings also can be dragged and dropped between Online and Offline Window areas.
The order codes much match.

This is what happens:


• CID — For version 7.30 or later, a new URS file generates and moves into a new device folder, generating SCL files from
the new URS file. Files in the folder have new time stamps. The CID file retains its time stamp.
• URS — When not IEC 61850 and version is lower than 7.30, the file is added and time stamp is unchanged. When
clicking in the software on the tree element, a device folder is created, the original file moves into it, and time stamp is
on the URS file is retained.

3-72 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION CONNECT TO D400 GATEWAY

When EIC 61850 and version is 7.30 or later, the file is added and time stamp is unchanged. When clicking in the
software on the tree element, a device folder is created, the original file moves into it, SCL files are generated there,
and the "Last modified" time stamp on the URS file changes.

3.11 Connect to D400 gateway


A GE Multilin D400 Substation Gateway can be used to collect data from UR devices in a local area network (LAN). It collects
metering, status, event, and fault report data from serial or LAN-based intelligent substation devices, and it pre-processes
the data. The D400 supports up to 16 serial and eight network connections, with multiple devices possible on each serial
connection. Up to 10 concurrent file transfer sessions are possible, meaning data for up to 10 URs can be transferred at
the same time and any additional IEDs are queued on a first-come-first-served basis. The D400 can then upload files to a
demilitarized zone (DMZ) server at the enterprise level.
Setup is as follows. For UR devices with the CyberSentry software option, when there is a need to retrieve periodically the 3
logs from the UR securely without a human interface, the following approach can be used. See the D400 manual for
configuration details to achieve it.
A UR in the substation can authenticate a user either connecting to a RADIUS server or on the device itself. This depends
on the user name used for authentication on a connection. The D400 connects to the UR device using an Ethernet, USB, or
serial port on the UR. The Ethernet connection can be ST or RJ-45 type. The serial connection can be RS232 or RS485. At
the other end, a cable attaches to the rear of D400. Use the D400 software to configure a serial or network
communication/connection for the UR, then to configure the IED device blocks/clients for the UR, and then to configure
record retrieval. Once configured, the UR and D400 use a keyfile authentication mechanism to establish communication.
For UR devices with the IEC 61850 software option, also use the D400 IEC 61850 Loader software.
When a D400 detects new files available for download from a UR, it connects to the UR and reads the files via sFTP
protocol. The following files can be transferred:
• Oscillography files
• Event records
• Log files
• Configuration (setting) files
The D400 information is viewable in its software and in a web browser.

3.11.1 Oscillography files


These are stored in COMTRADE format in the D400 folder system using the UR site and device name.

3.11.2 Event records


These are stored as the EVT.TXT file in the D400 folder system using the UR site and device name.

3.11.3 Log files


Log files can be retrieved for UR 7.0 and later. The following file types are possible, stored in the D400 folder system using
the UR site and device name:
• factory_event.txt — Information about change methods and origins. Saved with a "_YYMMDDhhmmss" retrieval time
stamp, for example FACTORY_EVENT_170525183124.TXT.
• setting_changes.log — Information on what settings have been changed. Saved with a "_YYMMDDhhmmss" retrieval
time stamp, for example SETTING_CHANGES_170525183124.TXT.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 3-73


CONNECT TO D400 GATEWAY CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION

3.11.4 Setting files


These are the configuration/settings files in the IEC 61850 SCL/IID format. The ur.iid file is saved with a
"_YYMMDDhhmmss" retrieval time stamp, for example ur_170525183124.iid. It is stored in the D400 folder system using
the UR site and device name.

3-74 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 4: Interfaces

Interfaces

This chapter explains the EnerVista software interface, the front panel interface, logic diagrams, and Engineer interface for
logic design and monitoring.

4.1 EnerVista software interface


4.1.1 Introduction
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a single facility to configure, monitor, maintain, and troubleshoot relays
connected over local or wide-area networks. It can be used while disconnected (offline) or connected (online) to a UR
device. In offline mode, settings files can be created for eventual downloading to the device. In online mode,
communication with the device is real-time.
The EnerVista UR Setup software is provided with every F35. This chapter outlines the EnerVista software interface. The
EnerVista UR Setup help file in the software also provides details for getting started and using the software interface.

4.1.2 Settings files


The EnerVista software supports the following three ways of handling changes to relay settings:
• In offline mode (relay disconnected) to create or edit relay settings files for later transfer to relays
• While connected to a relay to modify relay settings, and then save the settings to the relay
• Create/edit settings files and then write them to the relay while connected to the relay
See the back up section in the Maintenance chapter for instructions on how to create a settings file either offline or online.
Settings files are organized on the basis of file names assigned by the user. A settings file contains data pertaining to the
following types of relay settings:
• Device definition
• Product setup
• System setup
• FlexLogic
• Grouped elements
• Control elements
• Inputs/outputs

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-1


ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

• Remote resources
• Testing
Factory default values are supplied and can be restored after any changes.
The following communications settings are not transferred to the F35 with settings files:
Modbus Slave Address
Modbus TCP Port Number
RS485 COM2 Baud Rate
RS485 COM2 Parity
COM2 Minimum Response Time
COM2 Selection
RRTD Slave Address
RRTD Baud Rate
IP Address (see end of previous chapter for information)
IP Subnet Mask
IP Routing
When a settings file is loaded to a F35 that is in-service, the following sequence occurs:
4 1. The F35 takes itself out of service.
2. The F35 issues a UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED major self-test error.
3. The F35 closes the critical fail contact.
The Maintenance chapter outlines how to use a settings file in the .urs format for backup and restore.

4.1.3 Event viewing


In online or offline mode, you can view and analyze data generated by triggered parameters as follows:
• Event recorder — The event recorder captures contextual data associated with the last 1024 events, listed
chronologically from most recent to oldest
• Oscillography — The oscillography waveform traces and digital states are used to provide a visual display of power
system and relay operation data captured during specific triggered events
Event records are viewable at software and device-specific levels. Access the former under Admin > Event Log > View.
Access the latter under Actual Values > Records > Event Record.
Event record entries for CyberSentry are explained in the next chapter. The following table outlines some software-level
entries.
Table 4-1: Event record descriptions
Event Description
EnerVista UR Setup SESSION STARTED The EnerVista software was launched
Language was changed. The user changed the software language using the View > Language menu item
DEFAULT USERS CREATED The user management window was launched using the Admin > User Management menu
item
: Successful upload of firmware The firmware on a device was upgraded
END
Firmware verified
Firmware uploaded
Firmware erased
START: Upload new firmware
EnerVista UR Setup EVENT LOG CLEARED The event record was cleared. All event records were deleted using the Admin > Event Log >
Clear menu item.

4-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE

4.1.4 File support


The following support applies, where the Settings List is at the bottom left and the Site List is at the top left of the EnerVista
window:
• Execution — Any EnerVista UR Setup file that is opened launches the application or provides focus to the already
opened application. If the file was a settings file (has a .urs extension) that had been removed from the Settings List
navigation menu, it is added back to the menu.
• Drag and Drop — The device settings and individual settings can be dragged and dropped between the Online and
Offline Window areas. Also, any Windows Explorer directory folder is a file drag source and drop target.
New files that are dropped into the Offline Window are added to the tree, which is automatically sorted alphabetically
with respect to settings file names. In the Online Window, files or individual menu items that are dropped in the
selected device menu are sent automatically to the online device.

4.1.5 EnerVista main window


The EnerVista UR Setup software window has the following components:
1. Title bar that shows the pathname of the active data view or the name of the software
2. Main window menu bar
3. Main window toolbar 4
4. Site list / online window area
5. Settings list / offline window area
6. Software windows, with common toolbar
7. Settings file data view windows, with common toolbar
8. Workspace area with data view tabs
9. Status bar
10. Quick action hot links

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-3


ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-1: EnerVista UR Setup software window

2 1 6 7

10
4

4 5

9 8 842786A2.CDR

4.1.6 Protection summary window


The Protection Summary is a graphical user interface to manage elements, such as enabling and disabling them. Access it
under Settings > Protection Summary. See the Settings chapter for information on use.

4-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Figure 4-2: Protection Summary interface (B30 example shown)

4.1.7 Settings templates


Settings file templates simplify the configuration and commissioning of multiple relays that protect similar assets. An
example is a substation that has 10 similar feeders protected by 10 UR F60 relays.
In these situations, typically 90% or greater of the settings are identical among devices. The templates allow engineers to
configure and test these common settings, then lock them so that they are not available to users. For example, locked
settings can be hidden from view for field engineers, allowing them to quickly identify and concentrate on specific settings.
The remaining settings (typically 10% or less) can be specified as editable and made available to field engineers installing
the devices. These are settings such as protection element pickup values and CT and VT ratios.
The settings template mode allows the user to define which settings are visible in the software. Settings templates can be
applied to both settings files (settings file templates) and online devices (online settings templates). The functionality is
identical for both purposes.

Template mode is available in the English software only.

Settings file conversion from previous firmware versions is supported.

4.1.7.1 Enable the settings template


The settings file template feature is disabled by default. It can be enabled in offline or online mode.
The procedure outlines how to enable in offline mode the settings template for UR settings files.
1. Locate the settings file in the Offline Window area of the EnerVista UR Setup software. If not there, a file can be added
from an online device by right-clicking it and selecting the Add Device to Offline Window option.
2. In the Offline Window area, right-click the selected device or settings file and select the Template Mode > Create
Template option.
The settings file template is now enabled and the file menus display in light blue. The settings file is now in template
editing mode. To undo the action, select Template Mode > Remove Template.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-5


ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Alternatively, the settings template can be applied to online settings, as follows.


1. Locate the device in the Online Window area of the EnerVista UR Setup software.
2. Right-click the device and select the Template Mode > Create Template option. The software prompts for a template
password. This password is required to use the template feature and must be at least four characters in length.
Figure 4-3: Entering a settings file password

3. Enter and re-enter the new password, then click OK to continue.


The online settings template is now enabled. The device is now in template editing mode.

4 4.1.7.2 Edit the settings template


The settings template editing feature allows the user to specify which settings are available for viewing and modification in
EnerVista UR Setup. By default, all settings except the FlexLogic equation editor settings are locked.
1. With the template already enabled, locate the device or settings file in the Online or Offline Window area in the
software.
2. Right-click the device or file and select the Template Mode > Edit Template option to verify or place the device in
template editing mode (check mark beside option). If prompted, enter the template password then click OK.
3. Open the relevant settings window that contains settings to be specified as viewable.
By default, all settings are specified as locked and displayed against a grey background. The icon on the upper right of
the settings window indicates that the EnerVista software is in EDIT mode. The following example shows the phase
time overcurrent settings window in edit mode.
Figure 4-4: Settings template with all settings specified as locked

4. Specify the settings to make viewable by clicking them.


A setting available to view displays with a yellow background.

4-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Figure 4-5: Settings template with two settings specified as editable

5. Click the Save button to save changes to the settings template.


6. Continue through any other settings window to specify all viewable settings.
The next time that the device/settings are accessed, only those specified as viewable/editable display in the menu
hierarchy.
4
4.1.7.3 Add password protection to a template
GE recommends that templates be saved with password protection to maximize security.

When templates are created for online settings, the password is added during the initial template creation step. It
does not need to be added after the template is created.

To add password protection to a settings file template:


1. In the Offline Window area, right-click the device and select the Template Mode > Password Protect Template
option.
The software prompts for a template password. This password must be at least four characters in length.

2. Enter and re-enter the new password, then click OK to continue.


The settings file template is now secured with password protection.

4.1.7.4 View the settings template


Once all necessary settings are specified for viewing, users are able to view the settings template on the online device or
settings file. There are two ways to specify the settings view with the settings template feature:
• Display only those settings available for editing
• Display all settings, with settings not available for editing greyed-out
To display only the settings available for editing:
1. Right-click the device in the Online or Offline Window area and apply the template by selecting the Template Mode >

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-7


ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

View In Template Mode option.


2. Enter the template password if prompted, then click OK to apply the template.
Once the template has been applied, users are limited to view and edit the settings specified by the template. The effect of
applying the template to the phase time overcurrent settings is shown.
Figure 4-6: Applying templates using the View in Template Mode command

4
Phase time overcurrent window with template applied via
the Template Mode > View In Template Mode command.
The template specifies that only the Pickup and Curve
Phase time overcurrent settings window without template applied.
settings be available.
842858A1.CDR

Viewing the settings in template mode also modifies the settings menu, showing only the settings categories that contain
editable settings. The effect of applying the template to a typical settings menu is shown as follows.
Figure 4-7: Applying templates using the View in Template Mode settings command

Use the following procedure to display settings available for editing and settings locked by the template.
1. Right-click the device in the Online or Offline Window area and apply the template by selecting the Template Mode >
View All Settings option.
2. Enter the template password then click OK to apply the template.
Once the template has been applied, users are limited to edit the settings specified by the template, but all settings are
shown. The effect of applying the template to the phase time overcurrent settings is shown as follows.

4-8 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Figure 4-8: Applying templates using the View All Settings command

Phase time overcurrent settings window without template applied. Phase time overcurrent window with template applied via
the Template Mode > View All Settings command.
The template specifies that only the Pickup and Curve
settings be available.
4
842859A1.CDR

4.1.7.5 Remove the settings template


Once a settings template is removed, it cannot be reapplied and a new settings template needs to be defined before use.
1. Right-click the device in the Online or Offline Window area and select the Template Mode > Remove Template option.
2. Enter the template password if prompted and click OK to continue.
3. Confirm that you want to remove the template by clicking Yes.
The EnerVista software removes all template information and all settings are available.

4.1.8 Secure and lock FlexLogic equations


The UR allows users to secure some or all FlexLogic equations, preventing unauthorized viewing or modification of critical
FlexLogic applications. This is accomplished using the settings template feature to lock individual entries within FlexLogic
equations.
Secured FlexLogic equations remain secure when files are sent to and retrieved from any UR-series device.
Locking can be tied to the serial number too.

4.1.8.1 Lock FlexLogic equations


To lock individual entries of a FlexLogic equation:
1. Right-click the settings file or online device and select the Template Mode > Create Template item to enable the
settings template feature.
2. If prompted, enter the template password.
3. Select the FlexLogic > FlexLogic Equation Editor settings menu item.
By default, all FlexLogic entries are specified as viewable and display against a yellow background. The icon on the
upper right of the window also indicates that EnerVista UR Setup is in EDIT mode.
4. Specify the entries to lock by clicking them.
The locked entries display a grey background as shown in the example.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-9


ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-9: Locking FlexLogic equation entries in Edit Mode

4 5. Click the Save button to save and apply changes to the settings template.
6. Select the Template Mode > View In Template Mode option to view the template.
7. Optionally apply a password to the template by right-clicking the device and selecting the Template Mode >
Password Protect Template option.
Once the template has been applied, users are limited to view and edit the FlexLogic entries not locked by the template.
The effect of applying the template to the FlexLogic entries is shown here.
Figure 4-10: Locking FlexLogic entries through settings templates

Typical FlexLogic™ entries without template applied. Typical FlexLogic™ entries locked with template via
the Template Mode > View In Template Mode command.
842861A1.CDR

The FlexLogic entries are also shown as locked in the graphical view and on the front panel display.

4-10 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Figure 4-11: Secured FlexLogic in graphical view

4.1.8.2 Lock FlexLogic equations to the serial number


A settings file and associated FlexLogic equations also can be locked to a UR serial number. Once FlexLogic entries in a
settings file have been secured, use the following procedure to lock the settings file to a serial number. A serial number is
viewable under Actual Values > Product Info > Model Information, the inside front panel, and the rear of the device.
1. Right-click the setting file in the Offline Window area and select the Edit Device Properties item. The window opens.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-11


ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-12: Settings file properties window

2. Enter the serial number of the F35 device to lock to the settings file in the Serial # Lock field.
3. Click the OK button to apply the change. The serial number is not validated.
The settings file and corresponding secure FlexLogic equations are now locked to the F35 device specified by the serial
number.

4.1.9 Settings file traceability


A traceability feature for settings files allows the user to quickly determine if the settings in a F35 device have been
changed since the time of installation from a settings file. When a settings file is transferred to a F35 device, the date, time,
and serial number of the F35 are sent back to EnerVista UR Setup and added to the settings file on the local computer. This
information can be compared with the F35 actual values at any later date to determine if security has been compromised.
The traceability information is only included in the settings file if a complete settings file is either transferred to the F35
device or obtained from the F35 device. Any partial settings transfers by way of drag and drop do not add the traceability
information to the settings file.

4-12 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE

Figure 4-13: Settings file traceability

1 SETTING FILE TRANSFERRED


TO UR-SERIES DEVICE

The serial number and last setting change date


are stored in the UR-series device.

The serial number of the UR-series device and the file transfer
date are added to the setting file when setting files
are transferred to the device.

Compare transfer dates in the setting file and the


UR-series device to determine if security SERIAL NUMBER AND TRANSFER DATE 4
has been compromised. 2 SENT BACK TO ENERVISTA AND
ADDED TO SETTING FILE. 842864A2.CDR

With respect to the figure, the traceability feature is used as follows.


• The transfer date of a settings file written to a F35 is logged in the relay and can be viewed in the EnerVista software
or the front panel display. Likewise, the transfer date of a settings file saved to a local computer is logged in the
EnerVista software.
• Comparing the dates stored in the relay and on the settings file at any time in the future indicates if any changes have
been made to the relay configuration since the settings file was saved.

4.1.9.1 Settings file traceability information


The serial number and file transfer date are saved in the settings files when they are sent to a F35 device.
The F35 serial number and file transfer date are included in the settings file device definition within the EnerVista UR Setup
offline window as shown in the example.
Figure 4-14: Device definition showing traceability data

Traceability data in settings


file device definition

842863A1.CDR

This information is also available in printed settings file reports as shown in the example. A report is generated by right-
clicking and selecting the Print Settings option.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-13


ENERVISTA SOFTWARE INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-15: Settings file report showing traceability data

Traceability data
in settings report

4
842862A1.CDR

4.1.9.2 Online device traceability information


The F35 serial number and file transfer date are available for an online device through the actual values. Select the Actual
Values > Product Info > Model Information menu item within the EnerVista online window as shown in the example.
Figure 4-16: Traceability data in Actual Values window

This information is also available from the front panel display through the following actual values:
ACTUAL VALUES  PRODUCT INFO  MODEL INFORMATION  SERIAL NUMBER
ACTUAL VALUES  PRODUCT INFO  MODEL INFORMATION  LAST SETTING CHANGE

4.1.9.3 Additional traceability rules


The following additional rules apply for the traceability feature:
• If the user changes any settings within the settings file in the offline window, then the traceability information is
removed from the settings file
• If the user creates a new settings file, then no traceability information is included in the settings file
• If the user converts an existing settings file to another revision, then any existing traceability information is removed
from the settings file
• If the user duplicates an existing settings file, then any traceability information is transferred to the duplicate settings
file

4-14 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

4.2 Front panel interface


This section explains use of the enhanced, basic, and graphical front panels.

4.2.1 Front panel

4.2.1.1 Enhanced front panel


The enhanced front panel consists of LED panels, an RS232 port, keypad, LCD display, control pushbuttons, and optional
user-programmable pushbuttons.
The front panel is hinged to allow access to removable modules inside the chassis. The F35 enhanced front panel can be
horizontal or vertical. The following figure shows the horizontal front panel.
Figure 4-17: Enhanced horizontal front panel
Five column LED indicator panel

Display
4
Keypad

Control
pushbuttons (3)
Front panel
RS232 port

User-programmable pushbuttons 1 to 16 842810A2.CDR

4.2.1.2 Basic front panel


The basic front panel consists of LED panels, an RS232 port, keypad, LCD display, control pushbuttons, and optional user-
programmable pushbuttons.
The front panel is hinged to allow easy access to removable modules inside the chassis. There is also a removable dust
cover that is to be removed when accessing the keypad. The F35 basic front panel can be horizontal or vertical. The
following figure shows the horizontal front panel.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-15


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-18: Basic horizontal front panel


LED panel 1 LED panel 2 LED panel 3

Display
Front panel
RS232 port

Small user-programmable
User-programmable Keypad
(control) pushbuttons 1 to 7
pushbuttons 1 to 12
827801A9.CDR

The following figure shows the vertical front panel for relays ordered with the vertical option.
4 Figure 4-19: Basic vertical front panel

GE Multilin
Display

MENU 7 8 9

HELP MESSAGE 4 5 6

ESCAPE 1 2 3
Keypad
ENTER VALUE 0 . +/-

1 3 5
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
User-programmable
2 4 6
pushbuttons 1 to 6
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL

LED panel 2

STATUS EVENT CAUSE


IN SERVICE VOLTAGE
TROUBLE CURRENT RESET
TEST MODE FREQUENCY
TRIP OTHER USER 1
ALARM
PICKUP
PHASE A
PHASE B USER 2 LED panel 1
Front panel PHASE C
NEUTRAL/GROUND USER 3

RS232 port
827830A3.CDR

4-16 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

4.2.1.3 Graphical front panel


The graphical front panel consists of a USB port, LED panel, color screen display, user-programmable pushbuttons, and
navigation keys. The screen is used to read data, such as metering actual values, alarms, self-test messages, and event
records, and for viewing single-line diagrams. Settings can be changed on the front panel, except for the graphical front
panel itself and for IEC 61850. The USB port connects to a computer with the EnerVista software and can be used to
upgrade the relay and to transfer files and settings. The USB port is the square type B.
User-programmable pushbuttons 9 to 16 can be programmed among the 10 pushbuttons on the left and right sides of the
display.
Figure 4-20: Graphical front panel
Side pushbuttons
LEDs Display User-programmable pushbuttons

1 5
IN SERVICE

TROUBLE

TEST MODE

TRIP

ALARM 2 6

4
PICKUP

VOLTAGE

CURRENT 3 7
USB port FREQUENCY

OTHER

PHASE A 4 8
PHASE B

Not used
PHASE C

NEUTRAL / GND

RESET ESC
ENTER

Reset Tab pushbuttons Home Escape Navigation keys


859760A1.CDR

4.2.2 Front panel display

4.2.2.1 Enhanced and basic front panels


Messages display on a backlit liquid crystal display (LCD) to make them visible under poor lighting conditions. When the
keypad and display are not actively being used, the display defaults to user-defined messages. Any high-priority event-
driven message overrides the default messages.
Up to 20 characters can be used to configure some setting names in the software, while up to 12 characters display on the
front panel. A tilde ~ symbol is used for the twelfth character on the front panel when a name extends beyond the 12
character limit. An example is shown for a Virtual Input.
Figure 4-21: Tilde symbols displays with names 12 or more characters long

The front panel can be viewed and used in the EnerVista software, for example to view an error message displayed on the
front panel or the LEDs.
To view the front panel in EnerVista software:
1. Click Actual Values > Front Panel, then any option.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-17


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-22: Front panel use in the software (C60 shown)

4.2.2.2 Graphical front panel


The graphical front panel has a seven-inch (17.8 cm) color liquid crystal display (LCD). The display provides convenient
access to operational data generated by the relay, enables local control of power system devices, and allows display/
editing of settings.
Header content varies by page. The home page displays any active icons, such as security status, active setting group, and
active target messages. It shows the date and time of the relay. If the relay synchronizes to an external time source via PTP,
IRIG-B, SNTP, and so on, the date/time is shown in white, and otherwise in yellow. On pages other than the home page, the
header displays the name of the page.
The footer dynamically labels the Tab, or control, pushbuttons immediately below.
Page content displays between the header and footer.

4-18 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-23: Home page example with default content (product information)
Setting Group
Alarm Target Relay Date and Time

4
859850A1.cdr

There are multiple ways to navigate pages, by using the pushbuttons and the menu hierarchy. The menu hierarchy is
similar to the other front panels whereby you select a submenu using Up and Down arrow pushbuttons, and press the
ENTER or Right pushbutton. On setting pages, opening a setting for editing is done by highlighting the setting using Up and
Down pushbuttons, and pressing the ENTER or Right pushbutton.

Home page
Press the Home pushbutton to display the root page no matter the state. Any edit, control, or password entry sessions are
cancelled. The header shows several relay/system status icons. The default content of the home page is the product
information page and can be user-configured to show the content of any single-line diagram page, annunciator page,
metering page, or event records page for example. The Tab pushbuttons on the bottom row each navigate to their page.
The home page displays for a user-configured time period, then scrolls through user-configured pages, a feature referred
to as rolling.
Holding the Home pushbutton for one second displays the product information page. The Home page also can display
when settings are saved.

Security indicator, showing how many people are logged in, including local and remote users. The lock is red when
one or more users are logged in and other otherwise green.
When no users are logged in because login is not required, an icon does not display.
Identifies the active setting group number (not shown)

Displays when an abnormal annunciator alarm is present. Navigate to the Annunciator for details. When there
are no such alarms, the icon does not display.
Even when you acknowledge/reset an alarm, the icon displays as long as the condition remains. For example, a
breaker trouble alarm displays, you acknowledge it, but the icon remains because the breaker trouble remains.
Active targets symbol, where targets are error messages.
View error messages by pressing the Menu Tab pushbutton, then accessing the TARGETS menu. Pressing the
RESET button clears those messages that can be.

Configure the home page in the software under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Home Page. The menu
does not display when there is no graphical front panel.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-19


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Rolling mode
After a user-defined period of inactivity, the graphical front display rolls among up to 10 user-selected pages. The roll-to-
pages are selected in the EnerVista software, with the defaults being the product information page. Each page displays for
less than five seconds. Also, the display backlight intensity is lowered after a configurable period to a user-defined level (0,
10, 20, or 30%); lower intensity extends the life of the display.
Configure rolling mode in the software under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Rolling Mode.
Operation works as follows:
• Press the Home pushbutton or ESCAPE pushbutton twice to cancel rolling, restore full backlight intensity, and return
to the Home page
• Press the ENTER, ESCAPE, or a pushbutton to pause rolling once and restore full backlight intensity
Rolling is disabled by setting the delay to 0.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved
• Default — Changes all rolling mode settings to their factory default values
• Reset — Displays factory default values. Previous changes are not lost unless you save the reset window.
4 Single-line diagrams
A single-line diagram, or mimic diagram, is a line drawing of elements in an electrical system. The graphical front panel
displays up to five single-line diagrams. Each can be configured to show the arrangement of a portion of the power
system, the status of circuit breakers and of ground and disconnect switches, user-programmable pushbuttons, and
metering and status values. Each also enables control of the displayed power system devices.
One diagram is provided by default, single_bus_line_dsc.mif, which can be modified.
Configure the diagrams under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Single Line Diagram Editor.
Each single-line diagram page has a user-configurable name that appears in the header and in the footer Tab pushbutton
label. Factory default names are SLD 1 to SLD 5. Pages that have no configured content have a blank Tab pushbutton
label, and the Tab pushbutton does nothing. The label for the current page has a blue background.
Figure 4-24: Toolbar options for single-line diagram

Select Breaker IEEE Transformer 3W IEEE


Line Breaker IEC Transformer 2W IEEE

Line Crossover Breaker GE Transformer 3W IEC

Bus Crossover Switch IEEE Transformer 2W IEC


Bus Switch IEC Reactor IEEE
Feeder Switch GE Reactor IEC
Ground
Metering Capacitor General IEC
Generator Status Capacitor Polarity IEEE
Motor Text Current Transformer IEEE
AC Source
Pushbutton Current Transformer IEC

Voltage Transformer IEEE


Voltage Transformer IEC
859875A1.cdr

4-20 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

The letters T, S, B, R, and X next to a controllable element have the following meaning. An example (TSB) is shown in the
next figure.
• T — The element is "tagged." Local and remote control of the device are inhibited, both open and close. Tripping is
unaffected unless additional logic has been configured.
• S — The position indication of the device is substituted with a manually entered value
• B — Blocking open/close command is bypassed
• R — Autoreclose is enabled and not blocked
• X — The device is out-of-service and control is not available

Single-line diagram example


The following example outlines how to create a circuit breaker diagram, then how to close the second circuit breaker. The
figure shows six switches (SW, M), two breakers (CB), feeder (arrow), and ground (lined arrow).
Figure 4-25: Single-line diagram of open circuit breakers

Under Settings > System Setup > Switches and Breakers, enable and name the six switches and two breakers. Switch 6,
M568G, has the A/3 Pole Opened setting on.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-21


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-26: Configure Breaker and Switch settings

4
In the EnerVista software, open the single-line diagram editor under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Single
Line Diagram Editor.
Add the four switches for the top line by clicking the GE switch symbol in the toolbar, then clicking in the window. (If the UR
device is not online, the software attempts to connect.) Right-click to edit properties. Rotate switches SW569 and SW5682
to 270 degrees. Rotate switches 5681 and SW523 to 90 degrees. Ignore the TSB text.
Add the two lower switches. Leave rotation at 0 degrees.
Add the two breakers by clicking the GE breaker symbol in the toolbar, then click in the window. Right-click to edit
properties, rotating 90 degrees and setting the color to red (open).
Draw lines to fill in the gaps between the switches and breakers by clicking the line symbol in the toolbar, then clicking and
dragging on the canvas to draw a line. Do not draw a single line for the top line, but instead draw several small lines.
Add the feeder arrow head by clicking the symbol in the toolbar, then clicking the end of the line.
Add the ground symbol by clicking the symbol in the toolbar, then clicking the end of the line.
Add three metered values by clicking the M symbol in the toolbar, then clicking near the feeder arrow. Double-click to edit.
The three metered values are SRC1 Vag Mag, SRC 1 P, and SRC 1 Q.
Name the page by right-clicking the bottom tab. Here, page 1 is renamed "Milton line M568M."
Note that active symbols in the toolbar display and those that are inactive are greyed-out.
The diagram has been created. Save it by clicking the Save button.

Next is to close circuit breaker CB523. This circuit breaker is shown at the top right of the figure. A vertical line means that
it is open, and the color can be set as red or green.
On the graphical front panel, press the Home pushbutton, then press the SLDs pushbutton to activate the first single-line
diagram page.

4-22 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-27: Single-line diagram on graphical front panel

Press the Enable Control pushbutton. The side pushbutton labels display.
Figure 4-28: Side pushbutton display on graphical front panel 4

Press the CB523 breaker pushbutton. Its menu displays.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-23


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-29: Pushbuttons to control the breaker

Press the pushbutton to close the breaker, confirming the action at the prompt.
4 In this diagram, the two circuit breakers have hard-coded actions available to them. No action is possible on the switches.
Note the USER PB 9 and 10 entries in the earlier figure. As outlined later, these are activated by clicking the PB icon on the
software toolbar. These two pushbuttons can be configured under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable
Pushbuttons.

Single-line diagram editor use


Start the application in the EnerVista software under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Single Line Diagram
Editor.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved
• Load — Opens single-line diagram files, which replaces one or all five windows with that in the file selected
• Store — Saves all five single-line diagrams as a .mif file. Because single-line diagrams are not retained when using the
Convert Device Settings function, for example when converting in the Offline Window area from version 7.6 to 7.7, GE
recommends making backup files using this function.
On the right side of the window is a toolbox containing the components that can be added to the window. These include
line, breaker, disconnect, metering value, status value, text, and miscellaneous power system elements. To create the
single-line diagram, click the symbol, then click in the window. Once in the window, the component can be positioned and
its properties modified. When using the pointing device to position a component, the component can snap to the nearest
snap point. Snap points are in a 4 x 4 rectangular grid. The keyboard arrow keys move the selected component(s) in one
pixel increments when snap locations are inadequate. Multiple components can be selected and moved or deleted as a
group, or copied and pasted to another location. Right- or double-clicking a component opens the properties window.
Ctrl+A selects all objects in a diagram.

Lines
Line components represent power system buses or electrical connections between power system elements. They can also
be used as visual dividers and underline.
To add a line component, click it in the toolbox, then click in the window. Double-click a line to open its properties window
to set orientation.

4-24 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-30: Line and bus crossover symbols

Static symbols
Static symbols depicting power system elements are available. For information, see the ANSI/IEEE 315A and IEC 60617
standards.
Up to 32 static symbols can be used per single-line diagram.
To add a symbol, click it in the toolbox, then click in the window. Double-click the symbol to open its properties window to
set orientation.
Figure 4-31: IEEE and IEC static symbols

Breaker and disconnect components


Breaker components and disconnect components are interfaces to the UR breaker control elements and disconnect
switch elements. On a UR device they show dynamically the breaker or disconnect status as calculated by the element,
and provide means to open, close, tag, bypass interlock, and substitute (force status of) the element. Breaker components
in addition provide means to enable/disable breaker autoreclose.
Each breaker and disconnect component can be configured to use UR-style symbols, IEC symbols, or simple square/slash
symbols as shown in the following figure. The symbols assume horizontal symbol orientation, red - closed color, and green
- open scheme. With vertical orientation, they are rotated 90 degrees.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-25


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-32: Single-line diagram symbols

To add a breaker or disconnect component, click it in the toolbox, then click in the window. Up to 10 dynamic components
can be added to each single-line diagram.
Breaker and disconnect components have three different parts: label, symbol, and flags. Drag each of its parts to their final
locations. Double or right-click any of these parts to open the properties window. Properties that can be edited are label
text, breaker control element or disconnect switch element number, symbol orientation (horizontal or vertical), color
scheme (red - closed, or red - open), and assigned side button (if any). If the selected breaker or disconnect element does

4-26 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

not exist in the target relay or has not been enabled, then the component is displayed in the graphical front panel and in
the drawing edit window in grey. The color scheme selection has no effect when an IEC style symbol is used because IEC
style symbols do not use color.

Symbol orientation
The figure shows the orientation available for the breaker and disconnect switch (taking Open status as examples). The
default position is 0 degrees.
Figure 4-33: Single-line diagram symbol orientation

A question mark displays in a symbol on the graphical front panel when status is bad. The question mark does not rotate
with orientation.
Figure 4-34: Symbols when status is bad

The following figures show the orientation available for the static components. The default position is 0 degrees.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-27


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-35: Single-line diagram static symbol orientation (sheet 1 of 2)

4-28 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-36: Single-line diagram static symbol orientation (sheet 2 of 2)

User-programmable pushbuttons
User-programmable pushbuttons 1 to 8 are physical pushbuttons on the right side of the graphical front panel, numbering
down the two columns.
User-programmable pushbuttons 9 to 16 can be programmed among the 10 pushbuttons on the left and right sides of the
screen display. They show dynamically and provide a means to perform the same control as the other pushbuttons.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-29


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-37: Assigning pushbuttons 9 to 16 to the display

4 As an example, if you set up a single-line diagram with two breakers and six switches, then eight of the side pushbuttons
are used automatically for control of the breakers and switches. Side pushbuttons 9 and 10 are available. In the single-line
diagram, let us set side pushbutton 9 to clear event records as follows:
• Show side pushbutton 9 on the graphical front panel — Click the PB symbol in the toolbar, then set Side button 9 to
pushbutton 9 in the drop-down list. This pushbutton then displays when appropriate on the right side of the screen
display.
• Program event record clearing — Set Settings > Product Setup > Clear Relay Records > Clear Event Records to
FlexLogic operand PUSHBUTTON 9 ON
• Program pushbutton 9 — Set Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Pushbuttons > Pushbutton 9
Function to "Self-reset." When pressed, pushbutton 9 clears the event records.
To instead set the second user pushbutton (not a side pushbutton) to clear events, follow the second and third bullet
points, selecting settings of PUSHBUTTON 2 ON and Pushbutton 2.

Metering components
Metering components show dynamically the value of a FlexAnalog operand or actual value. Up to 16 metering
components can be added to each single-line diagram.
To add a metering component, click the M symbol in the toolbox, then click in the window. Drag it to its final location.
Double-click it to open the properties window. The figure shows the properties that can be edited.

4-30 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-38: Metering properties

Status components
Status components show dynamically the value of a FlexLogic operand. Up to 16 can be used in a diagram and 30 in all
single-line diagrams.
An example is to show the Off or On state of the ANY MAJOR ERROR FlexLogic operand. The name of the operand displays in
the single-line diagram editor, then as Off or On on the graphical front panel.
To add a status component, click the S symbol in the toolbox, then click in the window. Drag it to its final location. Double-
click it to open the properties window. Properties that can be edited include parameter (any FlexLogic operand), text color
background color, and on and off text.
Optionally add a text label to display beside the status.

Text
Text components show a single line of user-configured text.
Up to 16 text components can be used per single-line diagram.
To add a text component, click the T symbol in the toolbox, then click in the window. Drag it to its final location. Double-
click it to open the properties window. Properties that can be edited are text, color, and size.

Annunciator
An annunciator is a grid of small windows for alarms, actual values, self-test messages, and product information.
The graphical front panel emulates a conventional annunciator panel. The annunciator has 96 windows, each with a
description of the alarm condition that lights the window. The windows are arranged in rows and columns of 3 x 4, 4 x 6, or
6 x 8 over several pages. Each window can have up to three lines of configurable text, and one line can instead be a
metered value. Normally the window background is dark, and when the configured FlexLogic operand becomes On, the
window lights up.
The figure shows that two alarms are active. One alarm is configured red and the other alarm is configured blue. The red
alarm type is Self Reset, so the alarm displays in a solid color. The blue alarm type is Acknowledgeable, so the alarm flashes
until it is acknowledged, for example by navigating with the arrow keys and pressing the ENTER button. The alarm then
remains blue until the trigger condition is eliminated.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-31


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-39: 3x4 annunciator page with two active windows

To display the annunciator, press the Home pushbutton, then the Annunciator Tab pushbutton. If there is one or more
4 window in alarm or requiring reset, the annunciator page showing the first of these opens. Otherwise the first annunciator
page opens.
Alarms do not display automatically. Set the Home page and/or rolling pages to display annunciator pages.
The Tab pushbutton labels populate with the annunciator pages. The label text for each annunciator page is configurable
and displays in the header and Tab label. The current page has a blue Tab label. Tab labels for annunciator pages that
have an active window (that is, on, latched, or unacknowledged) are red. Pages where alarms are not triggered have a grey
Tab label. Pages that have no configured windows do not have Tab pushbuttons and do not display.
The Up, Down, Left, and Right pushbuttons cause the selection to move one window in the indicated direction. Pressing the
Right pushbutton past the last window in a row scrolls the display to any next annunciator page, not the next row. The
behavior is similar for the other pushbuttons, for example pressing the Up pushbutton while in the top row goes to any
previous page. If no previous page exists, no action occurs.
Annunciator windows are positioned statically, so that all windows are visible no matter their state.
Alarm types of each window can be configured as Self Reset, Latched, or Acknowledgeable. In Self Reset mode, the
window lighting follows the state of the configured FlexLogic operand. The self-reset mode alarm sequence conforms to
ISA-18.1-1979 (R2004) standard type A 4 5 6.
Figure 4-40: Annunciator alarm sequence in Self Reset mode

Process: Normal
Sequence: Normal
Visual: Off
Return to Normal

To Abnormal

Process: Abnormal
Sequence: Acknowledged
Visual: On
859856A1.vsd

4-32 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Latched mode is intended for transient signals such as trip, and it conforms to ISA-18.1-1979 (R2004) standard type M 6.
Figure 4-41: Annunciator alarm sequence in Latched mode

Process: Normal
Sequence: Normal To Abnormal
Visual: Off

Return to Normal Reset while


Process: Abnormal or Normal
Sequence: Alarm
Normal
Visual: Fast Flash

Process: Abnormal
Reset while
Sequence: Acknowledged
Abnormal
Visual: On
859857A1.vsd

4
In Acknowledgeable mode, both Off to On and On to Off state changes in the configured operand cause the background to
flash; the window must be acknowledged/reset to cancel flashing. This mode conforms to ISA-18.1-1979 (R2004) standard
type R-6.
Figure 4-42: Annunciator alarm sequence in Acknowledgeable mode

Process: Normal
Reset Sequence: Normal To Abnormal
Visual: Off

Process: Normal Reset while Normal Process: Abnormal or Normal


Sequence: Ringback Sequence: Alarm
Visual: Slow Flash Return to Abnormal Visual: Fast Flash

Process: Abnormal
Reset while
Return to Normal Sequence: Acknowledged
Abnormal
Visual: On
859858A1.vsd

To reset all annunciator windows:


1. In the software, access Actual Values > Graphical Panel > Annunciator Panel.

To acknowledge/reset all annunciator windows on a page:


1. On the graphical front panel with none of the annunciator windows selected, press the RESET pushbutton once for
acknowledgement and twice for reset. The flashing stops.

To acknowledge an annunciator window:


1. On the graphical front panel, press the Up, Down, Left, and Right pushbuttons to select the window, so that is has a
yellow outline. Press the RESET or ENTER pushbutton. While a window is selected, if that window has activated since
the last restart, the date/time of the last activation of that window displays in the header.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-33


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

An alarm remains in an alarm state (for example, displays red) when the condition remains. That is, if you acknowledged a
flashing alarm but the alarm condition remains, the background color remains red.
The SETTINGS > INPUTS/OUTPUTS > RESETTING > RESET ANNUNCIATOR setting can be used to select a FlexLogic
operand that when activated acknowledges/resets all annunciator windows.

Annunciator editor
The annunciator editor is used to configure alarms and actual value displays for the graphical front panel.
The path in the EnerVista software is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Annunciator Editor.
The figure shows the annunciator editor and its preview window. The page name is entered as General at the top right.
Acknowledgeable and self-resetting alarms are set for basic functions, such as online/offline, Ethernet ports, unauthorized
access/failed logins, and battery failure. The text to display in the annunciator window is entered. The IN SERVICE LED is set
to be green because when the device is on, this LED is green. The preview shows what the annunciator looks like with all
alarms triggered. The last window is not configured and displays blank/grey. In order for the Ethernet and battery alarms
to work, the corresponding self-test alarms have been enabled under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable
Self Tests (not shown). The LEDs can be viewed on the front panel, so adding them to the annunciator is for illustrative
purposes only.

4 Figure 4-43: Annunciator editor and preview window

4-34 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

The three page layouts (3 × 4, 4 × 6, and 6 × 8) select the number of rows x columns of windows that appear in a page.
Annunciator window size and text size shrink as the number of annunciator windows in a page increases.
Properties that can be edited include alarm type (acknowledgeable, latched, self-reset), alarm input (any FlexLogic
operand), text color, and alarm background color.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved
• Default — Changes all annunciator settings to their factory default values
• Reset — Displays factory default values. Previous settings are not lost unless you save the reset window.

Metering editor
The metering editor is an actual values display tool. It creates pages of actual values for the graphical front panel. There
are two types: tables and phasor diagrams. Tabular actual values pages have settings to configure, while phasor actual
values pages have no settings. Five tabular metering pages can be configured, while there can be a phasor page for each
configured AC source. They display on the graphical front panel using the Metering Tab pushbutton.
The path to the editor is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Metering Editor.
Figure 4-44: Metering editor with preview window
4

The inputs are selected at the top. Select from the drop-down list or start typing in the field.
The page, page name, and grid layout are set below the inputs.
Content to display is configured with the cell lines. The content can be actual values, a status indicator, or text.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-35


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

• Actual value — Select from the FlexAnalogs applicable to the F35, where a FlexAnalog is an analog parameter
• Status — Select from the FlexLogic operands identified in the Status Inputs at the top of the window. An example is to
display text to indicate whether the BATTERY FAIL operand is on or off.
• Text — Enter text to display in the table, for example name of table or column heading
If the metering input is other than OFF, the value of the selected metering input displays, formatted according to the size,
text color, units, multiplier, and decimal configuration. Otherwise either the Text or the Off Text displays depending on the
value of the operand selected by setting Status Input/Index.
A maximum of eight Status Inputs/Indexes can be used per metering page and 16 in all metering pages.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved
• Default — Changes all actual value settings to their factory default values
• Reset — Displays factory default values. Previous settings are not lost unless you save the reset window.

Configurable navigation editor


Configurable Navigation is a feature that opens specified pages when specific FlexLogic operands are activated. This
4 feature is useful to open the annunciator page containing an annunciator window that has entered its abnormal state.
In the example shown, failure of any of the three Ethernet ports triggers the Product Information page to display. With
unauthorized access (such as wrong password), IRIG-B clock failure, or breaker trouble, the Event Records display. When a
breaker opens, a single-line diagram displays. For the Ethernet and IRIG-B failure pages to work, these functions also have
been enabled under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Self Tests. For the breaker trouble, the single-line
diagram has been configured.
Figure 4-45: Navigation editor

The path is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Configurable Navigation.
The settings consist of 64 field pairs, each with a condition and an activation page. The condition selects any FlexLogic
operand. The activation page selection is the standard set, such as product information, event records, annunciator pages,
and single-line diagrams.
To use the feature, select a CONDITION, select its ACTIVATE PAGE option, then save. When selecting the condition
operand, open the drop-down list and start typing in the field to auto-fill. For example, typing F displays FIRST ETHERNET
FAIL.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved

4-36 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

• Default — Changes all settings in the window to factory default values


• Reset — Displays factory default values. Previous settings are not lost unless you save the reset window.

4.2.3 Front panel navigation keys

4.2.3.1 Enhanced and basic front panels


Display messages are organized into pages under the following headings: actual values, settings, commands, and targets.
The MENU key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is divided further into further submenus.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the submenus. The VALUE keys increment or decrement numerical setting values when
in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit mode. Alternatively, values can
be entered with the numeric keypad.
The decimal key initiates and advances to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point.
The HELP key can be pressed at any time for context-sensitive help messages.
The ENTER key stores setting values.
When entering an IP address on the front panel, key in the first sequence of the number, then press the • key for the
decimal place. For example, for 127.0.0.1, press 127, then •, then 0, then •, then 0, then •, then 1. To save the address, press
the ENTER key. 4
The figure shows the sequence to use to enter a setting. Subsequent sections provide more detail.
Figure 4-46: Front panel keypad use (basic front panel shown)

SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP

1. Press to scroll top level:


SETTINGS
MENU 7 8 9

HELP 4 5 6
3. Press to scroll third level fields MESSAGE
2. Press to scroll second level:
ESCAPE 1 2 3 PRODUCT SETUP.
4. Press to scroll through values
ENTER VALUE 0 . +/-
5. Press to save change

842231A1.cdr

4.2.3.2 Graphical front panel


These keys and pushbuttons navigate and select items.

Up/Down/Left/Right — These pushbuttons move the selector among the options on a page. The selection is
indicated by a yellow background or a yellow border. On menu pages, the Right pushbutton activates the selected
submenu drilling down the menu hierarchy, and the Left pushbutton backs up the menu hierarchy. These
pushbuttons have a typematic feature on some pages: after a short pause, the pushbutton repeats as long as it is
pressed.

ENTER — Activates the selection on the display, for example a submenu, a control, a keypad key, or a setting. Also
stores updated settings.

ESCAPE — If a setting is open for edit, this pushbutton closes the setting without saving. If a popup menu is open,
this pushbutton closes it. If an item is selected, this pushbutton deselects it. Otherwise this pushbutton activates
the previous page in the page hierarchy.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-37


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

RESET — Clears all latched LED indications and target messages. When a page with acknowledgeable/resettable
items is displayed, it instead resets/acknowledges all items on that page, or if an item on that page is selected, it
resets/acknowledges that item.
If you reset/acknowledge alarms, they stop flashing but remain in the alarm state as long as that state remains. In
other words, a red alarm does not switch off just because you acknowledged the alarm.
Home — Activates the home page, which is the root page. The page displays product information by default and
is configurable.

Side pushbutton — Five pushbuttons on the left side of the display and five pushbuttons on the right side of the
display. They perform various functions depending on the displayed page, such as switchgear controls. The
display dynamically shows its label next to each side pushbutton when the pushbutton has an assigned function.
These pushbuttons can also be programmed to function as user-programmable pushbuttons 9 to 16.
Tab pushbutton — Five pushbuttons under the display. They navigate through the page hierarchy, and on some
pages activate other actions. The display footer dynamically labels the page or action that is activated by the Tab
pushbutton.

User-programmable pushbutton — Eight physical pushbuttons are associated with the first eight user-
programmable pushbutton elements. Numbering is down, that is, 1 to 4 down the left column and 5 to 8 down the
right column.
These elements control a set of FlexLogic operands that can be used to initiate outputs or select modes. Each
physical pushbutton has an integrated LED indicator that can be user-configured to display the appropriate
status.
4 These pushbuttons have clear covers behind which custom labels can be mounted. A utility is available to print
the labels, under File > Front Panel Report in the software.

4.2.4 LED indicators

4.2.4.1 Enhanced front panel


The enhanced front panel display provides five columns of LED indicators. The first column contains 14 status and event-
cause LEDs. The next four columns contain the 48 user-programmable LEDs.
The RESET key is used to reset any latched LED indicator or target message, once the condition has been cleared (these
latched conditions can also be reset via the SETTINGS  INPUT/OUTPUTS  RESETTING menu).
The USER keys are used by the breaker control feature.

Figure 4-47: Typical LED panel for enhanced front pane

842811A1.CDR

The status indicators in the first column are as follows:


• IN SERVICE — Indicates that control power is applied, all monitored inputs/outputs and internal systems are fine, and
the relay is in (online) Programmed mode (under Settings > Product Setup > Installation)

4-38 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

• TROUBLE — Indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem. Check the self-test messages outlined at the
end of the Commands and Targets chapter, and view the event records under Actual Values > Records. For a beta /
pre-release, this LED is always on.
• TEST MODE — Indicates that the relay is in test mode. For information, see the Test Mode section in the Settings
chapter.
• TRIP — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as a trip input has operated. Set the operand under
Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable LEDs > Trip & Alarm LEDs. This indicator latches; initiate the reset
command to reset the latch.
• ALARM — Indicates that the FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm switch has operated. Set the operand under
Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable LEDs > Trip & Alarm LEDs. This indicator never latches.
• PICKUP — Indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator never latches.
The event-cause indicators in the first column are as follows.
Event-cause LEDs are below the status LEDs. They are turned on or off by protection elements that have their respective
target setting selected as either “Enabled” or “Latched.” If a protection element target setting is “Enabled,” then the
corresponding event-cause LEDs remain on as long as the operand associated with the element remains asserted. If a
protection element target setting is “Latched,” then the corresponding event-cause LEDs turn on when the operate
operand associated with the element is asserted and remains on until the RESET button on the front panel is pressed after
the operand is reset.
All elements that are able to discriminate faulted phases can independently turn off or on the phase A, B, or C LEDs. This 4
includes phase instantaneous overcurrent, phase undervoltage, and so on. This means that the phase A, B, and C operate
operands for individual protection elements are ORed to turn on or off the phase A, B, or C LEDs.
• VOLTAGE — This LED indicates voltage was involved
• CURRENT — This LED indicates current was involved
• FREQUENCY — This LED indicates frequency was involved
• OTHER — This LED indicates a composite function was involvedThis LED indicates a composite function was involved
• PHASE A — This LED indicates phase A was involved
• PHASE B — This LED indicates phase B was involved
• PHASE C — This LED indicates phase C was involved
• NEUTRAL/GROUND — This LED indicates that neutral or ground was involved

The user-programmable LEDs consist of 48 amber LED indicators in four columns. The operation of these LEDs is user-
defined. Support for applying a customized label beside every LED is provided. Default labels are shipped in the label
package of every F35, together with custom templates. The default labels can be replaced by user-printed labels.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used
to communicate with operators. See the User-Programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.

4.2.4.2 Basic front panel


The basic front panel consists of three panels with LED indicators, keys, and a communications port. The RESET key is used
to reset any latched LED indicator or target message, once the condition has been cleared (these latched conditions can
also be reset via the SETTINGS  INPUT/OUTPUTS  RESETTING menu). The RS232 port is for connection to a computer.
The USER keys are used by the breaker control feature.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-39


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-48: LED panel 1

Status indicators
• IN SERVICE — Indicates that control power is applied, all monitored inputs/outputs and internal systems are fine, and
the relay is in (online) Programmed mode (under Settings > Product Setup > Installation)
4 • TROUBLE — Indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem. Check the self-test messages outlined at the
end of the Commands and Targets chapter, and view the event records under Actual Values > Records. For a beta /
pre-release, this LED is always on.
• TEST MODE — Indicates that the relay is in test mode. For information, see the Test Mode section in the Settings
chapter.
• TRIP — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as a trip switch has operated. This indicator always
latches; initiate the reset command to reset the latch.
• ALARM — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm switch has operated. This indicator never
latches.
• PICKUP — Indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator never latches.

Event-cause indicators
Event-cause LEDs are turned on or off by protection elements that have their respective target setting selected as either
“Enabled” or “Latched.” If a protection element target setting is “Enabled,” then the corresponding event cause LEDs
remain on as long as the operand associated with the element remains asserted. If a protection element target setting is
“Latched,” then the corresponding event cause LEDs turn on when the operate operand associated with the element is
asserted and remains on until the RESET button on the front panel is pressed after the operand is reset.
All elements that are able to discriminate faulted phases can independently turn off or on the phase A, B, or C LEDs. This
includes phase instantaneous overcurrent, phase undervoltage, and so on. This means that the phase A, B, and C operate
operands for individual protection elements are ORed to turn on or off the phase A, B, or C LEDs.
• VOLTAGE — Indicates voltage was involved
• CURRENT — Indicates current was involved
• FREQUENCY — Indicates frequency was involved
• OTHER — Indicates a composite function was involved
• PHASE A — Indicates phase A was involved
• PHASE B — Indicates phase B was involved
• PHASE C — Indicates phase C was involved
• NEUTRAL/GROUND — Indicates that neutral or ground was involved

4-40 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

User-programmable indicators
The second and third panels provide 48 amber LED indicators whose operation is controlled by the user. Custom labelling
can be done.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used
to communicate with operators. See the User-programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.
Figure 4-49: LED panels 2 and 3 (index template)

Default labels for LED panel 2


4
The default labels are intended to represent the following:
• GROUP 1...6 — The illuminated GROUP is the active settings group
• RECLOSE ENABLED — The recloser is operational
• RECLOSE DISABLED — The recloser is not operational
• RECLOSE IN PROGRESS — A reclose operation is in progress
• RECLOSE LOCKED OUT — The recloser is not operational and requires a reset

Firmware revisions 2.9x and earlier support eight user setting groups; revisions 3.0x and higher support six setting
groups. For convenience of users using earlier firmware revisions, the relay panel shows eight setting groups. Even
though the LEDs have default labels, they are fully user-programmable.
The relay is shipped with the default label for the LED panel 2. The LEDs, however, are not pre-programmed. To match the
pre-printed label, the LED settings must be entered as shown in the User-programmable LEDs section of chapter 5. The
LEDs are fully user-programmable. The default labels can be replaced by user-printed labels for both panels as explained in
the next section.
Figure 4-50: LED panel 2 (default labels)

4.2.4.3 Graphical front panel


The graphical front panel has 14 LEDs. LEDs 1 to 5 are fixed status LEDs, and LEDs 6 to 14 are programmable.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-41


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Status indicators
• IN SERVICE — Indicates that control power is applied, all monitored inputs/outputs and internal systems are fine, the
relay’s test mode is disabled, and the relay is in (online) Programmed mode (under Settings > Product Setup >
Installation)
• TROUBLE — Indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem. Check the self-test messages outlined at the
end of the Commands and Targets chapter, and view the event records under Actual Values > Records. For a beta /
pre-release, this LED is always on.
• TEST MODE — Indicates that the relay is in Isolated (solid) or Forcible (flashing) test mode. For information, see the Test
Mode section in the Settings chapter.
• TRIP — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as a trip input has operated. Set the operand under
Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable LEDs > Trip & Alarm LEDs. This indicator latches; initiate the reset
command to reset the latch.
• ALARM — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm input has operated. Set the operand
under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable LEDs > Trip & Alarm LEDs.
Figure 4-51: Example of LEDs on graphical front panel

User-programmable event-cause indicators


Event-cause LEDs are below the status LEDs. They are turned on or off by protection elements that have their respective
target setting selected as “Self-Reset” or “Latched.” If set to “Self-Reset,” then the corresponding event cause LED remains
on as long as the operand associated with the element remains asserted. If set to “Latched” and asserted, then it remains
on until the operand is reset and then a reset command initiated.
All elements that are able to discriminate faulted phases can independently turn on or off the phase A, B, or C LEDs. This
includes phase instantaneous overcurrent, phase undervoltage, and so on. This means that the phase A, B, and C operate
operands for individual protection elements are ORed to turn on or off the phase A, B, or C LEDs.
The LEDs have defaults and can be configured to show instead the status of any FlexLogic operand.
The labelling area has a clear cover for custom labels. A utility is available to print stick-on labels, as outlined later in this
chapter.
These LEDs are programmed by default as follows:
• PICKUP — LED 6 — Indicates that an element is picked up, and hence a trip can be imminent
• VOLTAGE — LED 7 — Indicates voltage was involved
• CURRENT — LED 8 — Indicates current was involved
• FREQUENCY — LED 9 — Indicates frequency was involved
• OTHER — LED 10 — Indicates a composite function was involved
• PHASE A — LED 11 — Indicates phase A was involved
• PHASE B — LED 12 — Indicates phase B was involved

4-42 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

• PHASE C — LED 13 — Indicates phase C was involved


• NEUTRAL/GROUND — LED 14 — Indicates that neutral or ground was involved

4.2.5 Front panel labelling

4.2.5.1 Enhanced front panel


The following procedure requires these pre-requisites:
• The UR front panel label cutout sheet (GE part number 1006-0047) has been downloaded from
http://www.gegridsolutions.com/products/support/ur/URLEDenhanced.doc and printed
• Small-bladed knife
To create custom LED and pushbuttons labels for the enhanced front panel:
1. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software.
2. If not already copied to the Offline Window area, right-click the online device and select the Add Device to Offline
Window option. Click the Receive button in the window that opens to save the settings file to the Offline Window area.
3. Type labels as follows. Select the File > Front Panel Report. The window opens.
Figure 4-52: Enhanced front panel label designer
4

4. Enter the text to appear next to each LED and above each user-programmable pushbutton in the fields provided. The
LED Offsets and Button Offsets buttons move all labels left/right and up/down on the page (they both do the same
action, so use either button). The Button Offsets button does not display when there are no pushbuttons to customize.
5. Feed the UR front panel label cutout sheet into a printer and press the Print button in the front panel report window.
6. When printing is complete, fold the sheet along the perforated lines and punch out the labels.
7. Remove the UR label insert tool from the package and bend the tabs as described in the following procedures. These
tabs are used for removal of the default and custom LED labels.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-43


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Use the tool with the printed side containing the GE part number facing the user.

The label package shipped with every F35 contains the three default labels, the custom label template sheet, and the label
removal tool.
If the default labels are suitable for your application, insert them in the appropriate slots and program the LEDs to match
them. If you require custom labels, use the following procedures to remove the original labels and insert the new ones.
To set up and use the label removal tool:
1. Bend the tabs at the left end of the tool upwards as shown.

Bend the tab at the center of the tool tail as shown.

To remove the LED labels from the F35 front panel and insert the custom labels:
1. Use the knife to lift the LED label and slide the label tool underneath. Ensure that the bent tabs are pointing away from

4-44 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

the relay.

2. Slide the label tool under the LED label until the tabs snap out as shown. This attaches the label tool to the LED label.

3. Remove the tool and attached LED label as shown.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-45


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

4. Slide the new LED label inside the pocket until the text is properly aligned with the LEDs, as shown.

To remove the user-programmable pushbutton labels from the F35 front panel and insert the custom labels:
1. Use the knife to lift the pushbutton label and slide the tail of the label tool underneath, as shown. Ensure that the bent
4 tab points away from the relay.

2. Slide the label tool under the user-programmable pushbutton label until the tabs snap out as shown. This attaches the
label tool to the user-programmable pushbutton label.

4-46 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

3. Remove the tool and attached user-programmable pushbutton label.

4. Slide the new user-programmable pushbutton label inside the pocket until the text is properly aligned with the
buttons.
4

4.2.5.2 Basic front panel


After programming LEDs and pushbuttons under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Leds and User-
Programmable Pushbuttons, labels can be created for the front panel.
To create LED and pushbutton labels for a basic front panel:
1. In the EnerVista software, if the F35 is not already listed in the Offline Window area, add it by right-clicking it and
selecting the Add Device to Offline Window option.
2. Click the File > Front Panel Report menu item and select the device.
3. In the Front Panel Report window, double-click an LED or pushbutton slot and type a label. If you need to see the
existing front panel remotely, access Actual Values > Front Panel for the online device. If you need to see the In the
figure, note that labelling is being done for the third set of LEDs because the second panel of LEDs was factory-
labelled.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-47


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-53: Basic front panel label designer (LEDs shown)

4
4. Optionally save the changes by clicking the Save icon on the toolbar.
5. Click the Print icon on the toolbar. Consider printing to PDF format and adjusting the zoom for appropriate label size,
then print on a physical printer.
6. Cut labels as a block or individually, for example with scissors or an Exacto knife.
7. If there is a plastic cover over the front panel, remove it by gently pushing in on the right side and lifting off the cover.
8. Remove the plastic cover over the LEDs or pushbutton(s) using a screw driver.
9. Insert the labels.
10. Re-attach the plastic covers.

4.2.5.3 Graphical front panel


The F35 includes software for labelling the LEDs and pushbuttons on the graphical front panel and a sticker sheet with pre-
printed and blank labels. The pre-printed labels are on the top-left of the template sheet, and the blank labels are on the
bottom-right. Use the pre-printed labels, or use the designer provided in the software and print labels onto the template.
One sheet is provided.
The example shows LED labeling, wjth pushbutton labeling below it (cut off).
To create LED and pushbutton labels for the front panel:
1. In the EnerVista software, in the Online or Offline Window area, access Settings > Front Panel Label Designer or
Front Panel Label Designer (at the product root level). The designer window opens with pre-configured labels.
2. Under File > Print Setup, change the page orientation to Landscape.
3. In the label designer window, delete all labels not wanted for printing. This can be done by clicking the Reset button to
clear all labels, or by selecting each unwanted label and deleting it. Otherwise, all labels displayed print on the
template and use up the template. If you make a mistake, exit the window and open it again to view the default labels.
4. Based on the location on the template on which to print, create the labels by typing in the appropriate slots.

4-48 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-54: Front panel label designer for graphical front panel

5. Click the Print button in the window and select the printer.
6. Once printed, peel the labels off the template and stick them on the front panel. For the enhanced and graphical front
panels, they go over the clear plastic inserts, not under. For the basic front panel, they go under or over the plastic
covers.
Any changes are not saved. Each time that the label designer window opens, the original template displays. Any labels
deleted are not lost.

4.2.6 Menu navigation


Press the MENU key to display selections or home page. Each press of the key advances through the following main
headings:
• Actual Values
• Settings
• Commands
• Targets
• Factory Service
• User displays (when enabled)

4.2.6.1 Enhanced and basic front panels


The setting and actual value pages are arranged hierarchically. Header display pages are indicated by double scroll bars
(), while sub-header pages are indicated by a single scroll bar (). The header display pages represent the highest level
of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. Use the down, right, left, and up arrows to navigate
the menu. The MESSAGE up and down arrow keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-49


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

values. Continually pressing the MESSAGE right arrow from a header display displays specific information for the category.
Conversely, continually pressing the MESSAGE left arrow from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header
display.
Default values are indicated in this instruction manual in mixed case. In the example shown here, the default access level is
Restricted.
Highest level Lowest level (setting value)

 SETTINGS  SECURITY ACCESS LEVEL:


 PRODUCT SETUP    Restricted

 SETTINGS
 SYSTEM SETUP

Example

 ACTUAL VALUES Press the MENU key until the Actual Values header page appears. This page contains system
 STATUS and relay status information.

4  SETTINGS

Press the MENU key until the Settings header page appears. This category contains settings to
 PRODUCT SETUP configure the relay.

 SECURITY Press the MESSAGE right arrow once to display the first sub-header (Security).


ACCESS LEVEL: Press the MESSAGE right arrow once to display the first setting for Security.
Restricted

 SECURITY Press the MESSAGE left arrow to return to the Security heading.


 DISPLAY Press the MESSAGE down arrow to display the second setting sub-header associated with the
 PROPERTIES Product Setup header.

LANGUAGE: Press the MESSAGE right arrow once to display the first setting for Display Properties.
English

 SETTINGS Press the MESSAGE left arrow to return to the Display Properties page, then again to return to
 SYSTEM SETUP the Product Setup Page. Press the MESSAGE down arrow to move to the next Settings page. This
page contains settings for System Setup.

4.2.6.2 Graphical front panel


Access the main menu by pressing the Home pushbutton, then the Menu Tab pushbutton.
Use the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons to select a submenu, then press the Right or ENTER pushbutton to drill into that
submenu. The Left and ESCAPE pushbuttons back up the menu hierarchy.
The Page Up and Page Down Tab pushbuttons also navigate through the list. When there is only a single page of options,
they jump to the first and last entries.
The options displayed depend on order code.

4-50 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-55: Main menu on graphical front panel

4.2.7 Change settings


4
4.2.7.1 Enhanced and basic front panels

Numerical data
Each numerical setting has its own minimum, maximum, and increment value associated with it. These parameters define
what values are acceptable for a setting.

FLASH MESSAGE For example, select the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  DISPLAY PROPERTIES  FLASH
TIME: 10.0 s MESSAGE TIME setting.

MINIMUM: 0.5 Press the HELP key to view the minimum and maximum values. Press the key again to view the
MAXIMUM: 10.0 next context sensitive help message.

Two methods of editing and storing a numerical setting value are available.
• 0 to 9 and decimal point — The relay numeric keypad works the same as a calculator. A number is entered one digit at
a time. The leftmost digit is entered first and the rightmost digit is entered last. Pressing the MESSAGE left arrow or
pressing the ESCAPE key, returns the original value to the display.
• VALUE keys — The VALUE up arrow increments the displayed value by the step value, up to the maximum value
allowed. While at the maximum value, pressing the VALUE up arrow again allows the setting selection to continue
upward from the minimum value. The VALUE down arrow decrements the displayed value by the step value, down to
the minimum value. While at the minimum value, pressing the VALUE down arrow again allows the setting selection to
continue downward from the maximum value.

FLASH MESSAGE As an example, set the flash message time setting to 2.5 seconds. Press the appropriate numeric
TIME: 2.5 s keys in the sequence “2 . 5". The display message changes as the digits are being entered.

NEW SETTING Until ENTER is pressed, editing changes are not registered by the relay. Press ENTER to store the
HAS BEEN STORED new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as confirmation of the storing
process. Numerical values that contain decimal places are rounded-off if more decimal place digits
are entered than specified by the step value.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-51


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Enumeration data
Enumeration settings have data values that are part of a set, whose members are explicitly defined by a name. A set has
two or more members.

ACCESS LEVEL: For example, the selections available for ACCESS LEVEL are "Restricted," "Command," "Setting," and
Restricted "Factory Service."

Enumeration type values are changed using the VALUE keys. The VALUE up arrow displays the next selection while the
VALUE down arrow displays the previous selection.

ACCESS LEVEL: If the ACCESS LEVEL needs to be "Setting," press the VALUE keys until the proper selection displays.
Setting Press HELP at any time for the context sensitive help messages.

NEW SETTING Changes are not registered by the relay until the ENTER key is pressed. Pressing ENTER stores the
HAS BEEN STORED new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as confirmation.

4 Alphanumeric text
Text settings have data values that are fixed in length, but user-defined in characters. They can be upper-case letters,
lower-case letters, numerals, and a selection of special characters.
There are several places where text messages can be programmed to allow the relay to be customized for specific
applications. One example is the Message Scratchpad. Use the following procedure to enter alphanumeric text messages.
For example, enter the text “Breaker #1”.
1. Press the decimal point to enter text edit mode.
2. Press the VALUE keys until the character 'B' appears; press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
3. Repeat step 2 for the remaining characters: r,e,a,k,e,r, ,#,1.
4. Press ENTER to store the text.
5. If you have any problem, press HELP to view context sensitive help. Flash messages appear sequentially for several
seconds each. For the case of a text setting message, pressing HELP displays how to edit and store new values.

4.2.7.2 Graphical front panel


When enabling an element in the EnerVista software that outputs to an actual value, the actual values menu is not
updated on the graphical front panel via Ethernet connection when that menu is active on the graphical front panel.
Navigate out and back into the menu for activation.

Numerical data
This example outlines how to change the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. Flash messages are status, warning, error, and
information messages displayed in response to certain key presses during settings programming. An example is a
confirmation message upon saving settings. This setting specifies how long to display the message.
Press the Menu pushbutton to display the main menu.

4-52 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-56: Main menu

Use the Up or Down pushbutton to select SETTINGS, then press the Right or ENTER pushbutton.
Figure 4-57: Settings menu 4

With PRODUCT SETUP selected, press the Right or ENTER pushbutton.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-53


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-58: Product Setup menu

Use the Up or Down pushbutton to select DISPLAY PROPERTIES, then press the Right or ENTER pushbutton.
4 Figure 4-59: Display Properties menu

Use the Up or Down pushbutton to select FLASH MESSAGE TIME, then press the Right or ENTER pushbutton. If the relay is
configured to require login to edit settings, and the user is not already logged in, the login page displays. When the user
has successfully logged in, the setting is opened for edit. As the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting accepts a numerical value, a
keypad displays. The time is to be changed to 4.0 seconds.
The current setting displays. A flashing cursor line marks the insertion point, initially positioned after the last character of
the setting. The setting range displays under the text.
Press the <-- Move Cursor and Move Cursor --> Tab pushbuttons to move the insertion point. Place it after the 2.
Press the Backspace Tab pushbutton to remove the character to the left of the cursor, in this case the 2.
Using the arrow keys, enter another time, for example 4 for four seconds. These Up, Down, Left, and Right pushbuttons
move the keypad key selector. Pressing the ENTER pushbutton with the - key selected inverts the sign. Pressing the ENTER
pushbutton with the decimal point selected enters that character at the insertion point. Push ENTER now to accept the 4.

4-54 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-60: Settings page with numeric keypad

Press the Save Tab pushbutton, which does a range check on the value, saves the setting when valid, closes the page, and
displays the previous page. 4
When a setting is not saved due to an invalid value, a message flashes, for example being out of range. In cases where the
relay needs to be restarted for settings to take effect, the flash message advises.
Setting entry can be cancelled without impact on the original value by pressing the ESCAPE or Home pushbutton.

Alphanumeric text
Settings that accept alphanumeric values display a keyboard. An example is a pushbutton name.
The &123 key toggles between text and numbers.
The shift key (up arrow on keyboard) is green upon activation, while the keyboard letters switch to upper case. Double-click
the shift key to lock capital lettering, or full capitals.
The globe key (shown greyed-out) toggles the keyboard language between English and another display language selected,
for example between English and French. (The second language needs to be activated under Settings > Product Setup >
Display Properties.)
For Japanese and Chinese, up to 10 characters can be input in a field, not 20.
To add accents, highlight a key and hold the ENTER pushbutton on the graphical front panel. Any special characters
associated with the key display.
Figure 4-61: Settings page with keyboard and accents

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-55


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

4.2.8 View actual values

4.2.8.1 Graphical front panel


In addition to data viewable in the Actual Values menu on the front panel, phasor diagrams and metered data can be
displayed. The metered data can be arranged as a table.
The update rate of metered values is 500 ms.
A phasor page for each configured AC Source and up to five user-configurable metering pages can be displayed. The
phasor pages are not configurable. Each phasor page shows a phasor plot and numerical values of all currents, voltages,
and symmetrical components of a single AC source.
The Annunciator and Metering pages can be configured to display data. Each has a user-configured number of rows and
columns. Each cell can include either configurable static text or the value of a selected FlexLogic operand, FlexAnalog
operand, or actual value.
To display a metering page, press the Home pushbutton, then the Metering Tab pushbutton. The first metering page
opens, with phasor pages listed before tabular pages. The Tab pushbuttons display any other metering page, as do the Up,
Down, Left and Right pushbuttons. The current page is highlighted with a blue Tab pushbutton.
Each phasor page has a name, which consists of the value of the SOURCE NAME # setting appended with " Phasors."
Phasor pages that have no configured CTs or VTs do not have a Tab pushbutton, and phasor pages that have no
4 configured cells cannot be displayed.
Figure 4-62: Phasor display

The configurable name displays in the header and Tab pushbutton label. Factory default names are Page 1, Page 2, and so
on.

4-56 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

Figure 4-63: Metered actual values

The phasor sources are configured under Settings > System Setup > Signal Sources. The tables to display the actual
values are configured in the software under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Metering Editor.
4

4.2.9 Breaker control


The F35 can interface with associated circuit breakers. In many cases the application monitors the state of the breaker,
that can be presented on front panel LEDs, along with a breaker trouble indication. Breaker operations can be manually
initiated from the front panel keypad or automatically initiated from a FlexLogic operand. A setting is provided to assign
names to each breaker; this user-assigned name is for the display of related flash messages. These features are provided
for two breakers; the user can use only those portions of the design relevant to a single breaker, which must be breaker 1.
It is assumed in the following discussion that the SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  BREAKERS  BREAKER 1(2)  BREAKER
FUNCTION setting is "Enabled" for each breaker.

4.2.9.1 Control mode selection and monitoring


Installations can require that a breaker be operated in the three-pole only mode (3-pole), or in the one and three-pole (1-
pole) mode, selected by setting. If the mode is selected as three-pole, a single input tracks the breaker open or closed
position. If the mode is selected as one-pole, all three breaker pole states must be input to the relay. These inputs must be
in agreement to indicate the position of the breaker.
For the following discussion it is assumed that the SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  BREAKERS  BREAKER 1(2)  BREAKER
1(2) PUSH BUTTON CONTROL setting is “Enabled” for each breaker.

4.2.9.2 Front panel (user key) control


After the 30 minute interval during which command functions are permitted after a correct command password, the user
cannot open or close a breaker via the keypad. The following discussions begin from the not-permitted state.

4.2.9.3 Control of two breakers


For the following setup example, the (Name) field represents the user-programmed variable name.
For this example, the relay is connected and programmed for both breaker 1 and breaker 2. The USER 1 key performs the
selection of which breaker is to be operated by the USER 2 and USER 3 keys. The USER 2 key manually closes the breaker, and
the USER 3 key manually opens the breaker.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-57


FRONT PANEL INTERFACE CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

ENTER COMMAND This message appears when the USER 1, USER 2, or USER 3 key is pressed and a COMMAND
PASSWORD PASSWORD is required, that is, if COMMAND PASSWORD is enabled and no commands have been
issued within the last 30 minutes.

Press USER 1 This message appears if the correct password is entered or if none is required. This message
To Select Breaker displays for 30 seconds or until the USER 1 key is pressed again.

BKR1-(Name) SELECTED This message displays after the USER 1 key is pressed for the second time. Three possible actions
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP can be performed from this state within 30 seconds as per the following items (1), (2) and (3).

(1)
USER 2 OFF/ON If the USER 2 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 2 key is pressed
To Close BKR1-(Name) again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an output relay to
close breaker 1.

(2)
USER 3 OFF/ON If the USER 3 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 3 key is pressed
To Open BKR1-(Name) again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an output relay to
4 open breaker 1.

(3)
BKR2-(Name) SELECTED If the USER 1 key is pressed at this step, this message appears showing that a different breaker is
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP selected. Three possible actions can be performed from this state as per (1), (2) and (3). Repeatedly
pressing the USER 1 key alternates between available breakers. Pressing keys other than USER 1, 2,
or 3 at any time cancels the breaker control function.

4.2.9.4 Control of one breaker


For this application, the relay is connected and programmed for breaker 1 only. Operation for this application is identical to
that described in the previous section for two breakers.

4.2.10 Change passwords


The information in this section refers to password security. For information on how to set the password for the first time or
change CyberSentry passwords, see the previous chapter or the Settings > Product Setup > Security > CyberSentry section
in the next chapter.
The F35 supports password entry from a local or remote connection.
Local access is defined as access to settings or commands via the front panel. This includes both keypad entry and the
RS232 port. Remote access is defined as access to settings or commands via any rear communications port. This includes
both Ethernet and RS485 connections. Any change to the local or remote password enables this functionality.
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the
corresponding connection password. If the connection is to the back of the F35, the remote password must be used. If the
connection is to the RS232 port of the front panel, the local password must be used.
There are two user security access levels, setting and command, for which you can set a password for each. Use of a
password for each level controls whether users can enter commands or change settings. Another option is to specify
setting and/or command access for individual user accounts.
• Setting — Allows the user to make any changes to any of the setting values:
– Changing any setting
– Test mode operation
• Command — Restricts the user from making any settings changes, but allows the user to perform the following
operations:
– Changing the state of virtual inputs
– Clearing the event records

4-58 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FRONT PANEL INTERFACE

– Clearing the oscillography records


– Changing the date and time
– Clearing the breaker arcing current
– Clearing energy records
– Clearing the data logger
– Clearing the user-programmable pushbutton states
To enter the initial setting or command password:
1. Press the MENU key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the PRODUCT SETUP message appears on the
display.
2. Press the MESSAGE right arrow until the ACCESS LEVEL message appears on the display.
3. Press the MESSAGE down arrow until the CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS message appears on the display.
4. Press the MESSAGE right arrow until the CHANGE SETTING PASSWORD or CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD message
appears on the display.
 SECURITY ACCESS LEVEL:
  Restricted

 CHANGE LOCAL CHANGE COMMAND


 
 PASSWORDS PASSWORD: No
4
CHANGE SETTING
 PASSWORD: No

5. After the CHANGE...PASSWORD message appears on the display, press the VALUE up or down arrow to change the
selection to “Yes.”
6. Press the ENTER key and the display prompts you to ENTER NEW PASSWORD.
7. Type in a password and press the ENTER key.
8. When VERIFY NEW PASSWORD displays, re-type the password and press ENTER.
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No

CHANGE SETTING ENTER NEW VERIFY NEW


PASSWORD: Yes PASSWORD: ########## PASSWORD: ##########

NEW PASSWORD
HAS BEEN STORED

9. When the NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED message appears, your new Setting (or Command) password is active.

4.2.11 Invalid password entry


By default, when an incorrect Command or Setting password has been entered via the front panel three times within five
minutes, the LOCAL ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand is set to “On” and the F35 does not allow settings or command level
access via the front panel for five minutes.
By default, when an incorrect Command or Setting password has been entered via any external communications interface
three times within five minutes, the REMOTE ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand is set to “On” and the F35 does not allow
settings or command access via the any external communications interface for five minutes. The REMOTE ACCESS DENIED
FlexLogic operand is set to “Off” after five minutes for a Command password or 30 minutes for a Settings password.
These default settings can be changed in EnerVista under Settings > Product Setup > Security.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-59


LOGIC DIAGRAMS CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

4.3 Logic diagrams


Logic diagrams in this instruction manual provide an overview of function and settings. A logic diagram is based on
• Inputs-on the left side, which are setting and operands
• Logical gates, which is Boolean algebra to combine logical lines using AND, OR, NOT, and other gates to get a new
logical state
• Logical operators, which are timers, one-shot operations, latches, and so on
• Outputs-on the right side, which are products of the manipulations with inputs, logical gates, and logical operators to
produce new operands and define the output state of the element
True and false values are denoted by 1 and 0 respectively. A function usually is high/on/enabled when 1.
Reading from right to left in the following diagram, the TRIP BUS 1 OP and TRIP BUS 1 PKP FlexLogic operands on the right side
are triggered when either the settings or reset latch in the middle of the diagram is triggered. When this applies, the TRIP
BUS 1 OP operand is triggered after the delay set by the TRIP BUS 1 PICKUP DELAY or TRIP BUS 1 RESET DELAY setting, while the
TRIP BUS 1 PKP operand initiates immediately. The settings or reset latch in the middle of the diagram is triggered as follows.
• For the reset, one of three conditions are required to meet the OR requirement shown at the bottom left. That is, the
TRIP BUS 1 LATCHING setting must be 0=Disabled (which is negated by the NOT function to become 1=Enabled), output

4 •
from the TRIP BUS 1 RESET FlexLogic operand must be 1, or output from the RESET OP FlexLogic operand must be 1.
For the settings, one of 16 input conditions at the top left must be met for the OR, the TRIP BUS 1 FUNCTION must be
Enabled, and the TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK output must output as 0, which is then negated/reversed by NOT to become 1.
Table 4-2: Logic diagram symbols
Symbol Description
= Off Output from FlexLogic operand, so user-defined
= Enabled 1 = Enabled and 0 = Disabled
OR Any function input on the left side satisfies the condition
AND All functions input on the left side are required to satisfy the condition
 Not. Negates/reverses the output, for example 0 becomes 1.
 Connection
S, R Set, Reset
TPKP Timer pickup. Triggered by the settings latch in the diagram.
TRST Timer reset. Triggered by the reset latch in the diagram.

4-60 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Figure 4-64: Logic diagram


SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 1
SETTINGS
= Off
TRIP BUS 1 PICKUP
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 2
DELAY
= Off Non-volatile,
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
OR set-dominant
*** DELAY
AND S TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 16 TRIP BUS 1 OP
Latch
= Off TRST
R

SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FUNCTION
TRIP BUS 1 PKP
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK AND
= Off

SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1
LATCHING
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
= Off
OR
4
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESET OP 842023A1.CDR

4.4 FlexLogic design using Engineer


Parts of EnerVista Viewpoint Engineer software are integrated in the EnerVista UR Setup software. Engineer can be used to
create and modify FlexLogic that is used by a device, such as to monitor output, monitor triggers, and create self-tests.
Features include
• Automatically displays existing FlexLogic
• Drag-and-drop interface
• Open multiple tabs and edit simultaneously
• Display symbols in IEC, ISO, or UR formats
• Export a diagram as BMP file or copy it to the clipboard for import into other applications
• Scale and print files in various paper sizes
• Works with all UR firmware versions
The figure shows an example where several inputs are used to trigger an output. With the OR function, any one of the
inputs can trigger the output.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-61


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Figure 4-65: Inputs triggering output in Engineer

The process is as follows:


• Modify or create a logic diagram in the Offline Window area of the EnerVista UR Setup software
• Compile it and troubleshoot any errors
• The logic populates automatically into the FlexLogic Equation Editor
• Upload the file to the live device
• Monitor the output
This section explains how to use Engineer. It outlines the following topics:
• Design logic
• Send file to and from device
• Monitor logic
• View front panel
• Generate connectivity report
• Preferences

4-62 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

• Toolbars

4.4.1 Design logic


FlexLogic can be created with a block diagram. Note that although work is completed in the Offline Window area of the
software, communication occurs with the online device, for example when switching to monitoring mode.
The following procedures are outlined:
• Examples
• Add existing FlexLogic equations
• Create a logic diagram/sheet
• Rapidly add logic blocks in sequence
• Connect two logic diagrams/sheets
• Optimize the logic
• Change logic order
• Search logic
• Exclude sheet from compile

4.4.1.1 Examples 4
The symbols are displayed in the UR format.

Create oscillography trigger every three minutes


Figure 4-66: Three-minute timer turns on LED for 10 seconds

Preparation — Under Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Virtual Outputs, the first and second virtual outputs are named
OscTrigger
Top logic — Three-minute timer trigger
Bottom logic — Turn on LED 1 for 10 seconds when the trigger starts

Create data logger trigger every seven minutes


Figure 4-67: Seven-minute timer turns on LED for 10 seconds

Preparation — Under Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Virtual Outputs, virtual outputs 3 and 4 are named DLTrigger
Top logic — Seven-minute timer trigger
Bottom logic — Turn on LED 9 for 10 seconds when the trigger starts

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-63


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Create events every minute, then every 100 ms


Figure 4-68: One-minute timer turns on LED and creates events every 100 ms

4 Preparation — Under Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Virtual Outputs, virtual output 5 is named EVStart, 6 is named
EVTriggered, and 7 is named EVMakeEvent
Top logic — One-minute timer trigger
Middle logic — Turn on LED 17 for 10 seconds when trigger starts
Bottom logic — Create events at 100 ms intervals for the same 10 second period

4.4.1.2 Add existing FlexLogic equations


A logic diagram can be created using existing FlexLogic equations (this section) or by creating new ones (next section).
When using existing equations, you modify them in the FlexLogic Equation Editor in the Offline Window area, then apply
them.

The FlexLogic Equation Editor window is in view-only mode when the Logic Designer is open. To instead work in the
FlexLogic Equation Editor, close the Logic Designer window, then re-open the FlexLogic Equation Editor.

To create a logic diagram using existing FlexLogic equations:


1. In the Offline Window area, modify the FlexLogic for the device under FlexLogic > FlexLogic Equation Editor. If the
device is not listed, right-click the device in the Online Window area and select the Add Device to Offline Window
option.
Upon saving the modified FlexLogic, a yellow icon appears for the device in the Offline Window area to indicate that
the logic differs from the Online device.
2. In the Offline Window area, access Engineer for the device, then Logic Designer. The logic opens.
3. Click the Edit > Auto Populate Workbook menu item. If the software prompts if you want to keep or discard existing
sheets, either is acceptable, with the older excluded sheeted being denoted by brackets, such as < Sheet 1 >. The logic
displays in the various tabs. The FlexLogic created in the equation editor appears in Sheet 1, for example.

4.4.1.3 Create logic diagram


Upon access of the Logic Designer, the FlexLogic equations of the device display. You can create new logic in new sheets or
modify the ones that display.
This procedure uses input / output logic as an example.
To create a logic diagram:
1. In the Offline Window area, access Engineer for the device, then Logic Designer. If the device is not listed, right-click

4-64 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

the device in the Online Window area and select the Add Device to Offline Window option.
Figure 4-69: Access Engineer in the Offline Window area

4
A default block diagram opens that shows 48 inputs (boxes) and 48 user-programmable LEDs (circles).
For the graphical front panel, no LEDs can be added to the window and the LEDs are removed when opening any
existing files. For these existing files with the LEDs removed, save the file without them.
Figure 4-70: Default view of FlexLogic designer

2. Optionally delete the default logic diagram by right-clicking its tab at the bottom of the window and selecting Delete.
3. To add a blank sheet, click Edit > Add Sheet. A new tab displays. Or use the last tab displayed, which is a blank sheet.
4. Optionally right-click the new tab and Rename it.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-65


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

5. Add the input blocks to the logic diagram. For example, click the I/O Tokens tab on the right, click the Input element,
then click in the logic sheet to add it. Or drag-and-drop it.
6. Double-click the block on the sheet to configure it, selecting from the two drop-down lists. The figure shows that
virtual input 61 is being added. The View Associated Screen button opens its settings window.
Figure 4-71: Configuring an input block

4
7. Add the output blocks to the logic diagram. For example, click the I/O Tokens tab, click the Virtual Output element,
then click in the logic sheet to add it. Double-click the block on the sheet to configure it. For the name, make it unique.
The figure shows virtual output 61 is being added, with a suffix of "io" added to the name to make it unique. Note that
the outline color of a block is red until it is configured, and that this properties window varies by block and the
selectable options by order code.
Figure 4-72: Configuring an output block

8. Connect the input blocks to the output blocks by drawing a line as follows. Click at the end of one block and drag the
line to the next block. Or click the Drawing Tools tab, then select the Line option. The cursor needs to be at the
connection point to end the line, not elsewhere on the block. Note that the outline color is no longer red on the blocks.

4-66 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Figure 4-73: Completed inputs and outputs

9. Add any remaining blocks or information. Right-click a block to copy and paste it. Notes are as follows.
Add a text box — Drawing Tools > Text
Add a FlexElement — Elements > FlexElement. An analog input is expected where a small arrow head shows in the
box.
Figure 4-74: FlexElement accepts analog inputs on left side where arrow heads display

Add an Element — Elements tab. Available elements reflect the product, for example the Control Elements category.
Figure 4-75: Elements reflect Control Elements

10. Check for any blocks that have a red outline. These are invalid. Fix them before continuing, for example by configuring
them.
11. Compile the logic diagram to check for errors by clicking the Compile button at the bottom left or by pressing the F7
key.
If prompted about a message about sorting, click Yes to apply the default (for this example), which can be automatic
sorting based on an algorithm that applies fastest execution time.
With successful compiling, the file is saved and the FlexLogic equations populate automatically. Scroll up through the
compile messages, with the red errors being the only messages that require fixing before proceeding.
The figure shows that we forgot to add the "Io" suffix to the names of virtual outputs 62 and 63, as indicated by
"Warning: Virtual output xx using default name." This warning is a minor warning.
The warning "input using disabled feature" means that input needs to be enabled. Double-click the block, click the
View Associated Screen button, enable the setting, save, and recompile.
The output and messages are explained in the next section.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-67


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Some information displayed in the compile messages updates automatically, for example messages after a device is
unplugged.
Figure 4-76: Compile and check the logic

12. View the FlexLogic equations by navigating in the Offline Window area to FlexLogic > FlexLogic Equation Editor. The
window opens with the entries displayed in the next tab.
Figure 4-77: Logic displayed in FlexLogic Equation Editor
4

13. Save the work.


The logic diagram has been created and the FlexLogic equations populated. The next steps are to upload the file to the
device and to monitor the device.

4.4.1.4 Compiled results and warning messages


When a yellow caution symbol displays in the Offline Window area, it means that the settings file is not synchronized with
the online device. Right-click the device in the Offline Window area, and select the Update SCL files option. SCL refers to
the Substation Configuration Language. An Instantiated IED capability description (IID) file is an example of an SCL file and
contains the actual settings on a UR device.
Figure 4-78: Settings files not synchronized between offline and online files

When the Update SCL files option is selected, the CID and IID files in the device folder are updated by the user
configuration in the IEC 61850 panel and thereby become synchronized. The CID file and the IID file (depending on the
preference 'Do not update IID file when updating SCL files') are updated. If the CID file is not already there, it is generated.

4-68 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

The location of these files is C:\ProgramData\GE Power Management\urpc, for example, in the Offline and Online folders.
Any FlexLogic equations entered in the Offline Window area are erased. The logic drawn in the Logic Designer window in
Engineer in the Offline Window area remain. The warning icon disappears after updating.
The following information is contained in the compile window.
Figure 4-79: Compiled results

Number of Lines Saved — The number of compiled logic lines eliminated by using the optimization algorithm, as set in the
Optimize Compiled Output option of the Preferences. In the example shown, no lines were saved because the optimizer is
disabled.
FlexLogic Lines — The number of lines that the compiled logic uses, for example seven of 512 available.
Virtual Output equations — The number of FlexLogic equations used in the Logic Designer window.
Timers used — The number of timers used in the Logic Designer window.
Memory Used — The percent of memory used in the Logic Designer window.

Errors
Table 4-3: Errors from compiling
Category Block or gate Message Description
affected
Error All Number of lines (nnn) exceeds The compiled result exceeds the limit of 512. Reduce the number of
maximum limit of 512 equations to 512 or less.
Error Tag-In Tag-in not configured (TAG_ID, A Tag-In is connected to a circuit but the Tag-In is not referencing an
SheetReference) existing Tag-Out
Error 1 Shots One Shot is over limit The number of One-Shots contained within all of the VO blocks has
(SYMBOL_ID, SheetReference) exceeded the maximum allowed for the firmware revision. This value can
either be 0 or 32.
Error =VO VO has no inputs (VO_ID, A Virtual Output block is located within the FlexLogic diagram and there
SheetReference) is no block connected as input to it. Connect and identify the inputs.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-69


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Category Block or gate Message Description


affected
Error Timer Timer used more than once The same timer is used in more than one place in the editor. This means
(TIMER_ID, SheetReference) either the circuit that the Timer belongs to has been branched, or the
Timer has been duplicated.
Error Input Unrecognized Parameter An Input symbol is configured to an item that is not recognized by the
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,SheetRefere current order code and version. Possible cause: The order code and/or
nce) version of the settings file was converted causing the input parameter to
become unavailable.

Warnings
When using the 'Reset OP' operand, a warning can appear indicating that this is a disabled feature. This means that the
Reset Settting's FlexLogic operand is set to OFF. Resetting of the relay can be done by pressing the reset button on the front
panel of the relay or by sending a Reset command through communications.
Table 4-4: Warning messages from compiling
Category Block or Message Description
gate
affected
Minor warning Input Input set to unused VO An Input symbol is using an unassigned Virtual Output
4 Major warning Tag-Out
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,Sheet)
Tag-out not connected A Tag-Out symbol has no input
(TAG_ID,Sheet)
Major warning All Symbol not connected A symbol’s input and/or output is not connected and is not part of a
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,Sheet) VO block. Draw the input and/or output to the block.
Minor warning =VO Virtual Output n using default The Assigned Virtual Output is using the default name. Change the
name (VO_ID,Sheet) name.
Minor warning Input Input using default name An Input symbol is using a Contact Input, Contact Output, Digital
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,Sheet) Element, FlexElement, or Digital Counter set to the default name.
Change the name so that it is unique.
Setting warning Input Input using disabled feature An Input symbol is using a disabled Virtual Input, Contact Input, Digital
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,Sheet) Element, FlexElement, Digital Counter, Control Pushbutton,
Programmable Pushbutton, Contact Output, or Protection/Monitoring
Element. Enable it and try again.
Major warning Input Input set to OFF An Input symbol is set to OFF
(SYMBOL_ID,Sheet)
Major warning Input Input set to ON An Input symbol is set to ON
(SYMBOL_ID,Sheet)
Setting warning Input Contact Output Operate is OFF The symbol block is using the default setting of OFF
(SYMBOL_ID, Contacts)
Setting warning Input Contact Output Seal-In is OFF The symbol block is using the default setting of OFF
(SYMBOL_ID, Contacts)

4.4.1.5 Rapidly add logic blocks in sequence


Blocks are added by clicking an element then clicking in the drawing area, or by dragging and dropping the element onto
the canvas. Blocks can be added rapidly in sequence, for example when you have inputs 1 to 10, without having to select
the element each time.
To rapidly add logic blocks:
1. In Engineer, click File > Preferences. The window opens.
2. Click the Editor entry.
3. Enable the Repeat Symbol check box.
4. Click the Ok button to save and exit from the window.
5. In the logic diagram, select an element, then click in the drawing area to add it, click again to add a second box, and
so on.

4-70 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

4.4.1.6 Connect two logic diagrams


When the logic is complex and requires two sheets, for example, these two sheets can be connected. By connecting them,
the logic is continuous from one sheet to the next.
To connect two logic diagrams:
1. In the first sheet, click the I/O Tokens tab.
2. Scroll to the bottom, and click and drag the Tag Out element to the sheet where the next sheet is to connect.
3. Double-click the element and in the window that opens, give it a name, such as "To Sheet 2" or "To IO Sheet 2."
Figure 4-80: Connecting sheet 1 to sheet 2

4. In the second sheet, click and drag the Tag In element to the sheet where the first sheet is to connect.
5. Double-click the element and in the window that opens, select the first sheet from the drop-down list to connect the
two sheets.
6. Save the work.

4.4.1.7 Optimize the logic


The number of available FlexLogic entries depends on firmware, for example 515 or 1024 lines. The software can
automatically optimize a logic diagram to reduce space and free up entries.
To optimize the logic:
1. In Engineer, under File > Preferences, select the Compiler option. Ensure that the Optimize Compiled Output option is
enabled.
2. Run the compiler again, for example by clicking the Compile button at the bottom left of the software. The results
display in the Optimization Summary. Changes also display when the FlexLogic Equation Editor is accessed. The logic
diagram does not change. In the example shown, no lines were saved to free up space.
Figure 4-81: Code optimization results

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-71


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

4.4.1.8 Change logic order


The order in which the FlexLogic is populated in the FlexLogic Equation Editor window depends on settings.
First, when automatic sorting is not enabled, the sequence in which the blocks were drawn is followed.
Second, the order in which equations are executed can be manually changed, as outlined here.
Third, automatic sorting can be set in preferences, as outlined here. It is enabled by default and means that an algorithm is
implemented to give best results and quickest performance, For example, the block with the fastest execution time is
entered first in the FlexLogic. When two block functions have the same execution time the block drawn first displays first in
the FlexLogic. For example, drawing input 61 to output 61, then input 62 to output 62 causes the input/output 61 to be
entered into the FlexLogic first. Automatic sorting takes precedence over manual sort; if you enable this option, manual
sorting is not implemented.
To manually change logic order:
1. In the compile area, click the VO Order tab.
2. If the window is blank, click the Refresh button.
3. Select an entry and click the up or down arrow. To cancel any manual changes, click the Sort or Refresh button.
4. Recompile. The change is not executed or saved if automatic sorting is enabled.
Figure 4-82: Ordering FlexLogic entries
4

To set automatic sorting:


1. In Engineer, under File > Preferences, select the Compiler option. The Automatically Sort VOs option means that the
block with the fastest execution time is entered first in the FlexLogic. When two block functions have the same
execution time the block drawn first displays first in the FlexLogic. For example, drawing input 61 to output 61, then
input 62 to output 62 causes the input/output 61 to be entered into the FlexLogic first.

4.4.1.9 Search logic


Items that can be searched in a logic diagram include gates, Input, Contact Input, Contact Output, Timer, Virtual Output,
Tag In, Tag Out, and User-programmable LED. A search can be performed while designing or monitoring.
To search:
1. In the compiler area of Engineer, click the Search tab.
2. Use one of the following methods to set search criteria:
– Select an element from the first drop-down list. Results display automatically.
– Type in the second text string box, or select any of the 32 previous searches from the drop-down list. Click the
Search button. Any results display.
The search applies to all tabs, not just the active tab.
3. Double-click a search result to view the item.

4-72 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Figure 4-83: Search function

You can also select an element from the drop-down list on the toolbar. It is then highlighted in the logic diagram.

4.4.1.10 Exclude sheet from compile


While designing the FlexLogic equations, entire sheets can be removed from the compile logic. This allows the user to test
various schemes by placing schemes on separate sheets and including either sheet at compile time.
To exclude a sheet:
4
1. In the Logic Designer window, right-click the tab and select the Exclude from Compile option so that the check mark
displays. When sheets are excluded, a message displays with each compile that "excluded sheets will not be reflected
in the RPN." An excluded sheet is denoted with end brackets, similar to < Sheet 1 >.
Figure 4-84: Excluding a tab from compiling

Figure 4-85: Tab excluded from compiling

4.4.2 Send file to and from device


With the logic diagram created, compiled, and errors eliminated, the FlexLogic can be sent to a live device. And,
conversely, a file from a live device can be added to the Offline Window area for additional work.
To send a file to a device:
1. In the Offline Window area of the software, right-click the device name and select the Write Settings to Device option.
A prompt can appear that the URS file has been repaired; acknowledge the message.
2. When a window opens, select the device to which you want to send the file, then click the Send button and confirm.
The order codes and IEC 61850 edition must match. The file is sent to the live device. Any errors can be viewed in the

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-73


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

log file at the prompt.

To import a file from a device:


1. Close all open files in Engineer that relate to the device, else a message displays to that effect, for example to close
the FlexLogic view associated with the file. When the file is not associated with a live device, a message displays to
that effect; you need to identify the device to which you want to send the file. The order codes must match.
2. Right-click the device in the Online Window area and select the Add Device to Offline Window option. After you enter
a name for the file, it is written to the Offline Window area.

4.4.3 Monitor logic


After creating the logic diagram, validating it, and uploading the FlexLogic to a device, the results from the device can be
viewed.
The following checks are performed automatically when switching from design to monitoring, and prompts display when
necessary:
• Verify that the order code of the linked relay matches the settings file
• Verify that the version of the linked relay matches the settings file
4 • Verify that the FlexLogic Equation Editor of the linked relay matches the settings file. Solution: Compile the FlexLogic
logic diagram and send the settings file to the relay.
• Verify that the FlexLogic Timers of the linked relay match the settings file. Solution: Compile the FlexLogic logic
diagram and send the settings file to the relay.
• If the settings file contains a serial number lock, then verify that the serial number of the linked relay matches the
settings file
To view results:
1. In the Offline Window area of the software, expand the Engineer entry for the device.
2. Double-click the Logic Designer entry and Compile the logic.
3. Double-click the Logic Monitor entry, or click the M button in the toolbar at the top of the window. With successful
launch, the logic displays and a green indicator displays at the bottom of the tab.
When the file is not associated with a live device, a message displays to that effect; you need to identify the device to
which you want to send the file. The order codes must match between the Offline Window and the Online Window.
When the device is offline, a message indicates problems communicating with the device.
When the devices are not synchronized, a message indicates the FlexLogic does not match the settings file. To send
the offline file to the device, right-click the device name and select the Write Settings to Device option.
When the state of a symbol is OFF, the symbol is shown in the default color or no color.
When a symbol's state changes to ON, the symbol and connection line turns green.
The state of some symbols can either be unknown or the state transitions faster than the update interval. For these
two cases, the state of the symbol is considered 'UNKNOWN' and the symbol is outlined in red.
The colors for the ON and Unknown state can be customized in the Preferences.
The figure shows that the software is communicating with devices (square green indicator) and that a minor error is
present (green box outline). In this case, the battery is weak and needs to be replaced. This can be viewed as the
Replace Battery message on the front panel of the device and in the EnerVista software under Actual Values > Front
Panel > Front Panel or Display/Keypad.

4-74 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Figure 4-86: Monitoring a device, with minor error caused by weak battery

4.4.4 View front panel and print labels


This window displays the LEDs that are on the front panel. You can create labels and print them for the device. You do not
use the window to add text labels and upload them to the device. Custom labelling is also outlined earlier in this chapter;
see the Front Panel Labelling section.
To view the front panel:
4
1. In the Offline Window area of the software, expand the Engineer entry for the device.
2. Double-click the Front Panel Report entry. The report displays. The Device Summary is read from the settings file and
cannot be changed. The LEDs and pushbuttons display below the summary.
3. To save the report, click File > Save As, enter a file name, and select the front panel report (FPR), JPG, or PDF format.
Figure 4-87: Front panel display in Engineer

To print labels:
1. In the Front Panel Report window, double-click an LED or pushbutton and enter text.
2. To print the labels, click the Print icon on the toolbar.
3. To save the report and labels, click File > Save As, enter a file name, and select the FPR, JPG, or PDF format.
4. Use the instructions in the second tab of the window to add the labels to the physical device.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-75


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

4.4.5 Generate connectivity report


This report displays basic information about a device, such as order code, port numbers, inputs and outputs. You can use it
to create a PDF file of basic information. The report is based on CID and/or IID files, and not the system or full SCD. All
device details including Remote Inputs, Remote Outputs, and Analog Inputs/Outputs are indicated, including quantities
used and available.
To display a device report:
1. In the Offline Window area of the software, expand the Engineer entry for the device.
2. Double-click the Device Connectivity Report entry. The report displays.
3. To save as a PDF file, click File > Save As.
Figure 4-88: Device Connectivity Report

4.4.6 Preferences
Preferences determine functionality. As such, you are encouraged to review them. This section outlines some options
available in the menus and preference panels.
Access them in the Logic Designer panel under the View menu and under File > Preferences. The Logic Designer and
Logic Monitor preferences are outlined here, not all preferences for a device.

4.4.6.1 View menu


View > Toolbar > Advanced Actions — Active when in Logic Designer. Toggles a toolbar to nudge, rotate, flip, or change
the order of an element.
View > Show Unused Pins — Enable to display unconnected pins. Disable to eliminate unconnected pins from the view, for
example when printing.

4-76 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Figure 4-89: Unused pins on and off

4.4.6.2 Logic designer


The path is File > Preferences > Logic Designer.

Workbook Setup

Size and Units


Size and Units — Changes the size of diagram area displayed in Engineer. If you set the size to be smaller than an existing
logic diagram, the content is cut off.

WorkBook 4
Print Scale — The scale for logic diagram when printing. Scaling a large diagram to 200 percent, for example, results in the
diagram being cut off.
Orphan Protection — When enabled, the printing output prevents Virtual Output circuits from spanning more than a single
page. The largest Virtual Output circuit is scaled to fit on a single page and all remaining Virtual Output circuits are scaled
so that all circuits are printed using the same scale.
Show Title Block — When enabled, places an information box at the bottom right of the diagram when printing. Enter the
information in the File Information panel.
Show Sheet Name — When enabled, shows Sheet 1, Sheet 2, or any other name at the top of the logic diagram when
printing.
Start Sheet On New Page — Places the sheet on the next page when printing.
Show Notes Selection — When other than None, prints the text from any information notes added to the document (under
Drawing Tools tab > Note). The text is printed after the logic diagram.

File Information
The text entered here displays at the bottom right of a diagram when printing, provided that the Show Title Block option is
enabled. Note the option to change the logo from the GE logo to your company logo.

Display
The panel sets how the element boxes display. The figure shows how an AND gate displays when the UR default, IEC, or
ISO symbol type is selected.
Figure 4-90: AND gate varies by standard selected

Symbol Style — IEC, ISO, UR Setup — Sets how the gates display in the logic diagram.
Symbol Color — When set to Black & White, only logic blocks with issues continue to display red.
Zoom Operation — Determines what happens when the View > Zoom functions are used. When set to Sheet Only and the
zoom is changed, the single tab changes. When set to Workbook, all tabs change.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-77


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Editor
Repeat Symbol — Enable this feature to add element blocks rapidly in sequence, for example when you have inputs 1 to
10, without having to select the element each time. Select the element block from the toolbox, click the diagram, then
continue to click to add additional blocks.
Use first available VO / Timer — When enabled and you copy and paste a virtual output or timer element, the numbering
continues in sequence. For example, you copy timer 5 and paste it as timer 6. When disabled and you copy and paste a
virtual output or timer element, the same number is used. For example, you copy timer 5 and paste it as timer 5.
Auto-Save Logic Designer every x minutes — Logic diagrams with changes are saved automatically according to this
interval. The range is 5 minutes (default) to 30 minutes. With auto-save, the file extension of the saved file is .auto. This file
remains until you save the file manually.

Auto Populate
These options work in the Edit > Auto Populate Workbook function.
VOs per Worksheet — When an existing settings file is opened in the Logic Designer, the Logic Designer populates the
canvas and attempts to evenly distribute the Virtual Output circuits across multiple sheets. A value of 100 in this setting
places all FlexLogic equations on a single sheet until there are 100, then the next ones are placed on another sheet. A value
of 1 places each Virtual Output circuit on a separate sheet.

4 Show / FlexLogic Merge / Show Unused — If Show Contact Outputs and Show LEDs are selected, for example, the function
places Contact Output and User-programmable LED symbols for settings that are configured. If you disable the LED check
boxes, then the LED tab/sheet does not display when you next open the Logic Designer window. The settings apply to all
products, not just the active window when it is next opened. Close then reopen the Logic Designer window for the setting
to take effect.

Compiler
Show Warnings — Options to filter the messages that display when logic compiles.
Minor — Enable to display minor errors. An example is using the default values of an element added to the diagram, such
as the name of the element. An example is "Warning: Virtual output xx using default name," for which you simply click into
the element to rename it.
Major — Enable to display major errors. Examples are an input that does not have a corresponding output, using disabled
features, and failing to connect a symbol. Fix these errors.
Setting — Enable to display error message related to settings, such as an improperly configured setting, such as using ON
or OFF.
Automatically Sort VOs — When enabled, the logic is compiled with an algorithm to give best results and quickest
performance, for example the fastest logic first. The fastest logic displays in the FlexLogic Equation Editor output as the
first entries in the table. Use sorting when virtual outputs have dependencies on other virtual outputs. This setting takes
precedence over order set manually in the VO Order tab in the compiler.
When disabled, the sequence in which the blocks were drawn is followed.
Optimize Compiled Output — With this option enabled, the software automatically optimizes a logic diagram to reduce
space and free up FlexLogic entries. Run the compiler again, for example by clicking the Compile button at the bottom left
of the software. The number of saved lines displays in the Optimization Summary. Changes also display when the FlexLogic
Equation Editor is accessed. The logic diagram does not change.

4.4.6.3 Logic monitor

Display
The software displays the color specified when an element is on. There is no color when the element is off.
The software displays another color when the status cannot be determined and is unknown.

4-78 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Timing
Timing Information can be displayed in the monitoring window. This timing information is only an approximate
representation of how Engineer sees transitions. Use the device's Event Record to view accurate timing information.
The timing information can also be streamed to a comma-separated values (CSV) spreadsheet.
The timing information displayed and recorded can be filtered based on six categories. If a category is not selected, any
timing information related to that category does not display and is not recorded to the CSV file.
Show Timing Information in Output Window — Enable to display times in the monitoring window.
Because of the update rate of the Logic Monitoring, the timing information cannot be used as an accurate representation
of the events that occur within the relay. Use instead the device's event record. Timing information can be delayed by 30
seconds.
Save Timing Information to CSV File — Enable to write timing information in a spreadsheet. The timing information is
recorded in a text file that uses commas to separate each of the fields. This file uses the extension CSV that is supported by
any spreadsheet application.
Every change written to the CSV file requires a timestamp.
The format for the timing information in the output window is as follows:
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss
devicename offline 4
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss
devicename ONLINE
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss
VO1: Virt Out 1- 0
VI4: Virt In 4- 1
DI3: Direct In 3- 0
RI2: Remote In 2- 1
H5a: Contact In 1- 1
H1: Contact Output 1- 0

Data is only appended to the CSV file. The format for the data is as follows:
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, devicename, offline
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, devicename, ONLINE
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, VO1: Virt Out 1, 0
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, VI4: Virt In 4, 1
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, DI3: Direct In 3, 0
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, RI2: Remote In 2, 1
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, H5a: Contact In 1, 1
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, H1: Contact Output 1, 0

Options display for filtering, such as recording timing for Virtual Inputs and Outputs, but not Communications Status.

4.4.6.4 COMTRADE waveforms


Waveform files are viewable in the EnerVista software. The preferences are unrelated to Engineer and are outlined in the
UR Family Communications Guide.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-79


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

4.4.7 Toolbars
These are toggled in the View > Toolbar menu.
The UR symbols are displayed for the toolbox icons. They change when the default setting is changed to IEC or ISO
symbols. The symbols displayed in the toolbox also vary by firmware version, reflecting what is supported for each release.

4.4.7.1 FlexLogic Editor toolbar

New Device Create a new settings file

Open File Open an existing settings file in the URS, CID, or IID format

Save FlexLogic Save the Logic Designer diagram

PDF Report Create a PDF document from Logic Designer diagram(s). Settings can be
changed under File > Preferences > Workbook Setup.

4 Toggle Compile Window Display or hide the compile window area

Sort Order Select to change the sort order of the Virtual Output list to the right of the
icon. Virtual Outputs can be sorted numerically in ascending and
descending order based on numbers and names.
Select VO to View (x - x) Select a Virtual Output to locate and select it in the workbook. Each Virtual
Output listed also contains the name of the sheet where the Virtual Output
is located.
Edit Mode Switch to Logic Designer mode
Logic Designer
Monitor Mode Switch to Logic Monitor mode
Logic Monitor
Turn On ALL Communications Turn on all communications to all Logic Designer diagrams that are in the
monitoring mode. Default upon each launch of Engineer.
Turn Off All Communications Turn off all communications to all Logic Designer diagrams that are in the
monitoring mode. This is a legacy function for serial communication to turn
off communication to devices. Turning off communication applies to the
current session only. When you re-launch the EnerVista software,
communication is on by default.

4.4.7.2 Token Toolbox

Drawing Tools

Draw a line. Click and drag to draw.

Draw multiple joined lines. Click and drag for each line. Double-click to finish.

4-80 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Draw multi-sided object. Click for each line. Double-click to finish.

Draw four-sided object. Click and drag to draw.

Draw multiple curves. Click for each line. Double-click to finish.

Draw multiple, closed curves. Click for each line. Double-click to finish.

Draw oval or circle. Click and drag to draw.

Add text box with rectangle around it. Click to add. Double-click it to change text.

4
Add figure. Select file in the window that opens, then click on diagram canvas to add figure.

Add note icon and text. Click to add. Double-click to edit the title and text.

I/O Tokens
These are parts used in FlexLogic equations. They are the inputs and outputs of the Virtual Output equations. The display
can vary from that shown here.

Input symbol that can be configured to any FlexLogic operand value

Remote inputs from other devices

Input from another UR device. Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive and
cannot be used simultaneously.

Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive and cannot be used simultaneously.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-81


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

FlexAnalog symbol that can be used as the input to a FlexElement or use the FlexAnalog symbol to monitor an actual
value when in logic Monitoring mode

Contact Input Gate is similar to the Input symbol but is restricted to the operands associated with a Contact Input

Contact Output Gate is similar to the Input symbol but is restricted to the operands associated with a Contact Output.
The Operate and Seal-In settings can be configured graphically.

The Non-Volatile Latch is similar to the Input symbol but is restricted to the operands associated with a Non-Volatile
Latch. The Set and Reset settings can be configured graphically.

The final output of an equation is a numbered register called a virtual output. Virtual outputs can be used as an input
operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a seal-in or other type of feedback.

4
Place and configure a Remote Output. The UR's order code and firmware version then determine the availability of the
Remote Output.

Place and configure a Direct Output. The UR's order code and firmware version then determine the availability of the
Direct Output to another UR device.

Place and configure a Teleprotection Output. The UR's order code and firmware version then determine the availability
of the Teleprotection Output.

Place a User Programmable LED in the Logic Designer diagram. Not applicable when using a graphical front panel.

A Tag Out can be used in 1 of 2 ways. The first use of the Tag Out is to break up logic that needs to span several sheets.
The second use of the Tag Out is to associate a frequently used block of code with the Tag Out and then repeatedly use
the same block of code using a Tag In. When a Tag Out is referenced more than once, the Tag Out is replaced with a
Virtual Output during the compile phase.
Tag-In can is used to reference an existing Tag-Out. It joins another diagram to a previous diagram.

Boolean Tokens
These symbols are used to create FlexLogic Equations. Use them as intermediate logic for the Virtual Output equations.
The display can vary from that shown here.

4-82 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Place an OR gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Only one action needs to occur. Any function input on the left side
satisfies the condition.
The number of inputs is configurable from two to 16.

Place an AND gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Multiple actions need to occur. All functions input on the left side are
required to satisfy the condition.
The number of inputs is configurable from two to 16.

Place a NOR gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Gives the value of one when all input operands have a value of zero
and otherwise gives a value of zero. It gives an output signal when there are no input signals. An inverter that reverses
the logic state.
The number of inputs is configurable from two to 16.
Place a NAND gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Gives the value of zero when all input operands have a value of one
and otherwise gives a value of one. It gives an output signal until all signals are present on its inputs. An inverter that
reverses the logic state.
The number of inputs is configurable from two to 16.
Place a XOR gate in the Logic Designer diagram, which is two exclusive OR gates. Only one action needs to occur. If
there are two inputs or there is no input, there is no output.

Place a NOT gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Gives the value of one when the input operand has a value of zero and
otherwise gives a value of zero. It gives an output signal when there is no input signal. An inverter that reverses the
logic state.
4
Place a latch in the Logic Designer diagram. A latch has two inputs and one output. One input is the Set input, and
other input is the Reset input.

Place a positive one shot symbol that responds to a positive going edge in the Logic Designer diagram. A "one shot" is a
single input gate that generates a pulse ins response to an edge on the input.

Place a negative one shot symbol that responds to a negative going edge in the Logic Designer diagram

Place a positive one shot and a negative one shot symbol in the Logic Designer diagram

Place a timer in the Logic Designer diagram

Elements
These blocks configure properties of the element or use element operands as input to FlexLogic equations.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-83


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

Place and configure a FlexElement. A FlexElement is a universal comparator used to monitor any analog actual value
calculated by the relay or a net difference of any two analog actual values of the same type.

Place and configure the Settings Group settings

Place and configure a Selector Switch element. Firmware version determines feature availability. The Selector Switch
element is intended to replace a mechanical selector switch. Typical applications include setting group
control or control of multiple logic sub-circuits in user-programmable logic. The element provides for two control inputs.

Place and configure a Digital Element. A Digital Element can monitor any FlexLogic operand
and present a target message and/or enable events recording depending on the output operand state.

Place and configure a Digital Counter element. A Digital Counter counts the number of state transitions
4 from Logic 0 to Logic 1. The counter is used to count operations such as the pickups of an element.

4.4.7.3 Basic Actions toolbar

Select Select components. Click one component and hold down the CTRL key to select others.
Or click and drag an area that contains multiple components to select.
Edit Vertices Shows vertices points for the component selected (if the component support vertices
manipulation)
Properties Shows the properties of the selected component

Zoom Normal Zoom in and center the screen to the spot selected

Zoom to Fit Zoom in to a magnitude that fits your entire schema layout on your entire screen

Zoom Custom Zoom in on the components that you have selected

Pan Move the viewable area of your screen around the schema. To activate, select this tool
and then place the hand icon over and part of your schema. Click and drag the hand in
a direction to move around the schema.
Align Top, Middle, Bottom Align the selected components to the top, middle, or bottom of the reference
component
Align Left, Center, Right Align the selected components to the left, middle, or right of the reference component

Space Across Evenly space the selected components across a horizontal axis, starting from the far
left component and ending at the far right component
Space Down Evenly space the selected components across a vertical axis, starting from the top
component and ending at the bottom component
Same Width Set the width of the selected components to the same width as the reference
component
Same Height Set the height of the selected components to the same height as the reference
component

4-84 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER

Same Size Set the width and height of the selected components to the same width and height of
the reference component

4.4.7.4 Advanced Actions toolbar

Only basic objects (lines, rectangles, ellipses) can be rotated and flipped.
Only objects from the Drawing Toolbar can be structured (grouped, ungrouped, forward, backward).
Nudge Up, Down, Left, Right Moves selected component one pixel upward, downward, left, right

Rotate Rotates selected component freely. Once selected, put your mouse cursor over the
component and move the component clockwise or counter-clockwise depending on
what you need.
Rotate Left, Right Rotates selected component 90 degrees counter-clockwise or clockwise

Flip Vertical Flips the selected component on the vertical axis

Flip Horizontal Flips the selected component on the horizontal axis


4
Group, Ungroup Combines all selected components into one combined entity. Ungroups them into
separate components.
Front, Back Moves current components to the absolute front or back of all viewable layers

Forward, Backward Moves current components on layer higher or lower than its original layer hierarchy

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 4-85


FLEXLOGIC DESIGN USING ENGINEER CHAPTER 4: INTERFACES

4-86 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 5: Settings

Settings

This chapter outlines front panel and/or software settings. The relay is not taken out of service when saving settings; the
relay is taken out of service when a settings file is written to it.
Settings can be viewed remotely in a web browser by entering the IP address of the relay, accessing the Device
Information Menu option, then the Front-Panel Display Report option.
When indicated that a restart is required for a setting change to take effect, use the Maintenance > Reboot Relay
Command in the software.
Settings file conversion from previous firmware versions is supported. See the Maintenance chapter.

5.1 Settings menu

 SETTINGS  SECURITY See page 5-7


 PRODUCT SETUP  

 DISPLAY See page 5-26


   PROPERTIES

 GRAPHICAL FRONT PANEL Access in EnerVista


  See page 5-28

 CLEAR RELAY See page 5-40


  RECORDS

 COMMUNICATIONS See page 5-41


 

 MODBUS USER MAP See page 5-147


 

 REAL TIME See page 5-148


  CLOCK

 FAULT REPORTS See page 5-153


 

 OSCILLOGRAPHY See page 5-155


 

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-1


SETTINGS MENU CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

 DATA LOGGER See page 5-157


 

 DEMAND See page 5-158


 

 USER-PROGRAMMABLE See page 5-160


  LEDS

 USER-PROGRAMMABLE See page 5-164


  SELF TESTS

 CONTROL See page 5-165


  PUSHBUTTONS

 USER-PROGRAMMABLE See page 5-166


  PUSHBUTTONS

 FLEX STATE See page 5-172


  PARAMETERS

 USER-DEFINABLE See page 5-173


  DISPLAYS

 DIRECT I/O See page 5-175


 

 TELEPROTECTION See page 5-181


 

 INSTALLATION See page 5-182


  

5  REMOTE RESOURCES
  

Access in EnerVista
See page 5-183

 SETTINGS  AC INPUTS See page 5-184


 SYSTEM SETUP  

 POWER SYSTEM See page 5-185


  

 SIGNAL SOURCES See page 5-186


 

 BREAKERS See page 5-189


 

 SWITCHES See page 5-194


 

 FLEXCURVES See page 5-199


  

 SETTINGS  FLEXLOGIC See page 5-224


 FLEXLOGIC   EQUATION EDITOR

 FLEXLOGIC See page 5-224


   TIMERS

 FLEXELEMENTS See page 5-224


 

 NON-VOLATILE See page 5-229


   LATCHES

 SETTINGS  SETTING GROUP 1 See page 5-230


 GROUPED ELEMENTS  

 SETTING GROUP 2
  

5-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SETTINGS MENU

 SETTING GROUP 3
 

 SETTING GROUP 4
 

 SETTING GROUP 5
 

 SETTING GROUP 6
  

 SETTINGS  TRIP BUS See page 5-259


 CONTROL ELEMENTS  

 SETTING GROUPS See page 5-261


  

 SELECTOR SWITCH See page 5-262


 

 UNDERFREQUENCY See page 5-269


 

 AUTORECLOSE See page 5-270


 

 DIGITAL ELEMENTS See page 5-277


 

 DIGITAL COUNTERS See page 5-280


 

  8-BIT SWITCHES

See page 5-282 5
 MONITORING See page 5-284
  ELEMENTS

 COLD LOAD PICKUP See page 5-307


 

 PID REGULATOR See page 5-308


  

 SETTINGS  CONTACT INPUTS See page 5-311


 INPUTS / OUTPUTS  

 VIRTUAL INPUTS See page 5-313


  

 CONTACT OUTPUTS See page 5-314


 

 VIRTUAL OUTPUTS See page 5-317


 

 RESETTING See page 5-317


 

 DIRECT INPUTS See page 5-318


 

 DIRECT OUTPUTS See page 5-318


 

 TELEPROTECTION See page 5-322


  

 SETTINGS  DCMA INPUTS See page 5-324


 TRANSDUCER I/O  

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-3


OVERVIEW CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

 RTD INPUTS See page 5-325


  

 DCMA OUTPUTS See page 5-326


  

 SETTINGS TEST MODE See page 5-330


 TESTING  FUNCTION: Disabled

TEST MODE FORCING: See page 5-330


  On

 FORCE CONTACT See page 5-331


  INPUTS

 FORCE CONTACT See page 5-331


   OUTPUTS

 SETTINGS  GOOSE See page 5-332


 SIMULATION  

5.2 Overview
5.2.1 Introduction to elements
For URs, the term element is used to describe a feature that is based around a comparator. The comparator is provided
with an input (or set of inputs) that is tested against a programmed setting (or group of settings) to determine if the input is
5 within the defined range that sets the output to logic 1, also referred to as setting the flag. A single comparator can make
multiple tests and provide multiple outputs. For example, the time overcurrent comparator sets a pickup flag when the
current input is above the setting and sets an operate flag when the input current has been at a level above the pickup
setting for the time specified by the time-current curve settings. All comparators use analog actual values as the input.

An exception to this rule is digital elements, which use logic states as inputs.

Elements are arranged into two classes, grouped and control. Each element classed as a grouped element is provided with
six alternate sets of settings, in setting groups numbered 1 through 6. The performance of a grouped element is defined by
the setting group that is active at a given time. The performance of a control element is independent of the selected active
setting group.
The main characteristics of an element are shown on a logic diagram. This includes the inputs, settings, fixed logic, and the
output operands generated. The previous chapter explains how to read a logic diagram, and the abbreviations used in a
diagram are defined in the Abbreviations chapter.
Some settings are specified in per-unit (pu) calculated quantities:
pu quantity = (actual quantity) / (base quantity)
Where the current source is from a single current transformer (CT), the base quantity is the nominal secondary or primary
current of the CT. Use the secondary current base to convert per-unit settings to/from a secondary current value, and use
the primary current base to convert to/from a primary current value.
Where the current source is the sum of two or more CTs with different nominal primary current, the primary base quantity
is the largest nominal primary current. For example, if CT1 = 300 / 5 A and CT2 = 100 / 1 A, then in order to sum these, CT2
is scaled to the CT1 ratio. In this case, the base quantity is 300 A primary, 5 A secondary for CT1, and 300/(100/1) = 3 A
secondary for CT2.
For voltage elements, the primary base quantity is the nominal phase-to-phase primary voltage of the protected system
provided that the VT ratio setting is set to the nominal ratio of the VTs and the secondary voltage setting is set to the
phase-to-phase voltage seen by the relay when the voltage of the protected system in nominal. The UR uses the
convention that nominal voltages in a three-phase system are phase-to-phase voltages.

5-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS OVERVIEW

For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage, the base quantity is 13800 V. With 14400:120 V delta-
connected VTs, the secondary base quantity and secondary voltage setting is:

Eq. 5-1

For wye-connected VTs, the primary and secondary base quantities are as before, but the secondary voltage setting (here
a phase-to-ground value) is:

Eq. 5-2

Some settings are common to many elements, outlined as follows:


• FUNCTION setting — This setting programs the element to operate when selected as “Enabled.” The factory default is
“Disabled.” Once “Enabled,” any element associated with the function becomes active and all options become
available.
• NAME setting — This setting is used to uniquely identify the element.
• SOURCE setting — This setting is used to select the AC source to be monitored. See the Introduction to AC Sources
section later.
• PICKUP setting — For simple elements, this setting is used to program the level of the measured parameter above or
below which the pickup state is established. In more complex elements, a set of settings can be provided to define the
range of the measured parameters that cause the element to pick up.
• PICKUP DELAY setting — This setting sets a time-delay-on-pickup, or on-delay, for the duration between the pickup
and operate output states.
• RESET DELAY setting — This setting is used to set a time-delay-on-dropout, or off-delay, for the duration between the
operate output state and the return to logic 0 after the input transits outside the defined pickup range.
5
• BLOCK setting — The default output operand state of all comparators is a logic 0 or “flag not set.” The comparator
remains in this default state until a logic 1 is asserted at the RUN input, allowing the test to be performed. If the RUN
input changes to logic 0 at any time, the comparator returns to the default state. The RUN input is used to supervise
the comparator. The BLOCK input is used as one of the inputs to RUN control.
• TARGET setting — This setting is used to define the operation of an element target message. When set to "Disabled,"
no target message or illumination of a front panel LED indicator is issued upon operation of the element. When set to
“Self-Reset,” the target message and LED indication follow the operate state of the element and self-resets once the
operate element condition clears. When set to “Latched,” the target message and LED indication remains visible after
the element output returns to logic 0 until a RESET command is received by the relay.
• EVENTS setting — This setting is used to control whether the pickup, dropout, or operate states are recorded by the
event recorder. When set to “Disabled,” element pickup, dropout, or operate are not recorded as events. When set to
“Enabled,” events are created for
<Element> PKP (pickup)
<Element> DPO (dropout)
<Element> OP (operate)
The DPO event is created when the measure and decide comparator output transits from the pickup state (logic 1) to
the dropout state (logic 0). This can happen when the element is in the operate state if the reset delay time is not zero.
Not every operand of a given element in a UR relay generates events, only the major output operands. Elements,
asserting output per phase, log operating phase output only, without asserting the common three-phase operand
event.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-5


OVERVIEW CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.2.2 Introduction to AC sources

5.2.2.1 Background
A mechanism called a source configures the routing of CT and VT input channels to measurement sub-systems. Sources, in
the context of UR series relays, refer to the logical grouping of current and voltage signals such that one source contains all
the signals required to measure the load or fault in a particular power apparatus. A given source can contain all or some of
the following signals: three-phase currents, single-phase ground current, three-phase voltages, and an auxiliary voltage
from a single VT for checking for synchronism.
The basic idea of an AC source is to select a point on the power system where the voltages and currents are of interest. To
illustrate the concept of sources, as applied to current inputs only, consider the breaker-and-a-half scheme that follows.
(The breaker-and-a-half scheme is used for illustrative purposes and is available on select UR products.) In this application,
the current flows as shown by the arrows. Some current flows through the upper bus bar to some other location or power
equipment, and some current flows into transformer winding 1. The current into winding 1 is the phasor sum (or difference)
of the currents in CT1 and CT2 (whether the sum or difference is used depends on the relative polarity of the CT
connections). The same considerations apply to transformer winding 2. The protection elements require access to the net
current for transformer protection, but some elements can need access to the individual currents from CT1 and CT2.
Figure 5-1: Breaker-and-a-half scheme
CT1 through current CT2

Winding 1

5
current

Winding 1
UR-series
relay Power
transformer

Winding 2

CT3 CT4
827791A3.CDR

In conventional analog or electronic relays, the sum of the currents is obtained from an appropriate external connection of
all CTs through which any portion of the current for the element being protected can flow. Auxiliary CTs are required to
perform ratio matching if the ratios of the primary CTs to be summed are not identical. In the UR series of relays, provisions
have been included for all the current signals to be brought to the UR device where grouping, ratio correction, and
summation are applied internally via configuration settings.
A major advantage of using internal summation is that the individual currents are available to the protection device, for
example as additional information to calculate a restraint current, or to allow the provision of additional protection
features that operate on the individual currents, such as breaker failure.
Given the flexibility of this approach, it becomes necessary to add configuration settings to the platform to allow the user
to select which sets of CT inputs are to be added to form the net current into the protected device.
The internal grouping of current and voltage signals forms an AC source. This source can be given a specific name through
the settings and becomes available to protection and metering elements in the UR platform. Individual names can be
given to each source to help identify them for later use. For example, in the scheme shown in the preceding figure, the user
configures one source to be the sum of CT1 and CT2 and can name this source as “Wdg1 I.”

5-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Once the sources have been configured, the user has them available as selections for the choice of input signal for the
protection elements and as metered quantities.

5.2.2.2 CT/VT module configuration


CT and voltage transformer (VT) input channels are contained in CT/VT modules. The type of input channel can be phase/
neutral/other voltage, phase/ground current, or sensitive ground current. The CT/VT modules calculate total waveform
RMS levels, fundamental frequency phasors, symmetrical components, and harmonics for voltage or current, as allowed
by the hardware in each channel. These modules can calculate other parameters as directed by the CPU module.
A CT/VT module contains up to eight input channels, numbered 1 through 8. The channel numbering corresponds to the
module terminal numbering 1 through 8 and is arranged as follows. Channels 1, 2, 3, and 4 are always provided as a group,
hereafter called a “bank,” and all four are either current or voltage, as are channels 5, 6, 7, and 8. Channels 1, 2, 3 and 5, 6,
7 are arranged as phase A, B, and C respectively. Channels 4 and 8 are either another current or voltage.
Banks are ordered sequentially from the block of lower-numbered channels to the block of higher-numbered channels,
and from the CT/VT module with the lowest slot position letter to the module with the highest slot position letter, as follows.
Increasing slot position letter -->
CT/VT module 1 CT/VT module 2 CT/VT module 3
< bank 1 > < bank 3 > < bank 5 >
< bank 2 > < bank 4 > < bank 6 >

The UR platform allows for a maximum of six sets of three-phase voltages and six sets of three-phase currents. The result
of these restrictions leads to the maximum number of CT/VT modules in a chassis to three. The maximum number of
sources is six. A summary of CT/VT module configurations is as follows.
Item
CT/VT Module
Maximum number
3
5
CT Bank (3 phase channels, 1 ground channel) 6
VT Bank (3 phase channels, 1 auxiliary channel) 3

5.2.2.3 CT/VT input channel configuration


Upon relay startup, configuration settings for every bank of current or voltage input channels in the relay are generated
automatically from the order code. Within each bank, a channel identification label is assigned automatically to each bank
of channels in a given product. The bank naming convention is based on the physical location of the channels, required by
the user to know how to connect the relay to external circuits. Bank identification consists of the letter designation of the
slot in which the CT/VT module is mounted as the first character, followed by numbers indicating the channel, either 1 or 5.
See the HardFiber instruction manual for designations of HardFiber voltage and current banks.
For three-phase channel sets, the number of the lowest numbered channel identifies the set. For example, F1 represents
the three-phase channel set of F1/F2/F3, where F is the slot letter and 1 is the first channel of the three channels.
Upon startup, the CPU configures the settings required to characterize the current and voltage inputs, and it displays them
in the appropriate section in the sequence of the banks (as described earlier) as follows for a maximum configuration: F1,
F5, M1, M5, U1, and U5.

5.3 Product setup


5.3.1 Security

5.3.1.1 Security overview


The following security features are available:
• Password security — Basic security present by default

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-7


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

• EnerVista security — Role-based access to various EnerVista software screens and configuration elements. The
feature is present by default in the EnerVista software.
• CyberSentry security — Advanced security available using a software option. When purchased, the option is enabled
automatically, and the default Password security and EnerVista security are disabled.

Lost password
If all passwords are lost, recovery is possible by resetting the unit to default values. Note that the relay is reset to default
values, not just the passwords.
To reset the unit after a lost password:
1. Email GE customer service at [email protected] with the serial number and using a recognizable corporate email
account. Customer service provides a code to reset the relay to the factory defaults.
2. Enter the reset code on the front panel, under COMMANDS  RELAY MAINTENANCE  SERVICE COMMAND.
3. Change the default password of ChangeMe1# as outlined in the Set Up CyberSentry and Change Default Password
section at the end of the Installation chapter.

Password requirements
A user account requires an alpha-numeric password that meets the following requirements:
• Password is case-sensitive
• Password cannot contain the user account name or parts of the user account that exceed two consecutive
characters
• Password must be 8 to 20 characters in length

5 • Password must contain characters from all of the following categories:


– English uppercase characters (A through Z)
– English lowercase characters (a through z)
– Base 10 digits (0 through 9)
– Non-alphabetic characters (for example, ~, !, @, #, $,%, &)

5.3.1.2 Password security


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY
 SECURITY ACCESS LEVEL: Range: Restricted, Command, Setting,
  Restricted Factory Service (for factory use only)

 CHANGE LOCAL See page 5-10


  PASSWORDS

 CHANGE REMOTE See page 5-10


  PASSWORDS

 ACCESS See page 5-11


  SUPERVISION

 DUAL PERMISSION See page 5-12


  SECURITY ACCESS

PASSWORD ACCESS Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The F35 supports password entry from a local or remote connection.


Local access is defined as access to settings or commands via the front panel. This includes both keypad entry and the
RS232 port. Remote access is defined as access to settings or commands via any rear communications port. This includes
both Ethernet and RS485 connections. Any change to the local or remote password enables this functionality.

5-8 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

ACCESS LEVEL — The "Restricted" option means that settings and commands can be accessed, but there is no access to
factory configuration. Access automatically reverts to the Restricted level according to the access level timeout setting
values. The access level is set to Restricted when control power is cycled.
The "Factory Service" level is not available and intended for factory use only.
There are two user security access levels, setting and command, for which you can set a password for each. Use of a
password for each level controls whether users can enter commands or change settings. Another option is to specify
setting and/or command access for individual user accounts.
• Setting — Allows the user to make any changes to any of the setting values:
– Changing any setting
– Test mode operation
• Command — Restricts the user from making any settings changes, but allows the user to perform the following
operations:
– Changing the state of virtual inputs
– Clearing the event records
– Clearing the oscillography records
– Changing the date and time
– Clearing energy records
– Clearing the data logger
– Clearing the user-programmable pushbutton states
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the
corresponding connection password. If the connection is to the back of the F35, the remote password must be used. If the
connection is to the RS232 port of the front panel, the local password must be used.
The local setting and command sessions are initiated by the user through the front panel display and are disabled either by
5
the user or by timeout (via the setting and command level access timeout settings). The remote setting and command
sessions are initiated by the user through the EnerVista software and are disabled either by the user or by timeout.
The state of the session (local or remote, setting or command) determines the state of the following FlexLogic operands:
• ACCESS LOC SETG OFF — Asserted when local setting access is disabled
• ACCESS LOC SETG ON — Asserted when local setting access is enabled
• ACCESS LOC CMND OFF — Asserted when local command access is disabled
• ACCESS LOC CMND ON — Asserted when local command access is enabled
• ACCESS REM SETG OFF — Asserted when remote setting access is disabled
• ACCESS REM SETG ON — Asserted when remote setting access is enabled
• ACCESS REM CMND OFF — Asserted when remote command access is disabled
• ACCESS REM CMND ON — Asserted when remote command access is enabled

A command or setting write operation is required to update the state of the remote and local security operands
listed.
When a setting password or command password is set or updated, user access with a graphical front panel is
removed. Simply log in again on the graphical front panel.
When the setting password is set or updated, the graphical front panel Access Level displays as Command. This is
because the graphical front panel is a Modbus client and it does not have automatic access to the password
change.
PASSWORD ACCESS EVENTS — This setting allows recording of password access events in the event recorder.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-9


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Change local passwords


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS
 CHANGE LOCAL CHANGE SETTING Range: No, Yes
 PASSWORDS  PASSWORD: No

CHANGE COMMAND Range: No, Yes


 PASSWORD: No

As outlined in the previous section, there are two user security access levels, setting and command. Use of a password for
each level controls whether users can enter commands or change settings.
Proper password codes are required to enable each access level. When a CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD or CHANGE
SETTING PASSWORD setting is programmed to “Yes” via the front panel interface, the following message sequence is
invoked:
1. ENTER NEW PASSWORD: ____________.
2. VERIFY NEW PASSWORD: ____________.
3. NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED.
To gain write access to a “Restricted” setting, program the ACCESS LEVEL setting in the main security menu to “Setting” and
then change the setting, or attempt to change the setting and follow the prompt to enter the programmed password. If the
password is correctly entered, access is allowed. Access automatically reverts to the “Restricted” level according to the
access level timeout setting values and when power is cycled.

If the setting and command passwords are identical, then this one password allows access to both commands and
settings.

5 If a remote connection is established, local passcodes are not visible.

Change remote passwords


Proper passwords are required to enable each command or setting level access, which are explained in the previous
section.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  CHANGE REMOTE PASSWORDS
 CHANGE REMOTE CHANGE SETTING Range: No, Yes
 PASSWORDS  PASSWORD: No

CHANGE COMMAND Range: No, Yes


 PASSWORD: No

To set the command or setting password in EnerVista:


1. In the EnerVista software or from the front panel, navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Security menu item to open
the remote password settings window.
2. Click the command or setting password Change button.
3. Enter the new password in the New Password field. Requirements are outlined in the Password Requirements section
earlier in this chapter. When an original password has already been used, enter it in the Enter Password field and click
the Send Password to Device button.
4. Re-enter the password in the Confirm Password field.

5-10 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

5. Click the OK button. The password is checked to ensure that it meets requirements.

If you establish a local (serial) connection to the relay, you cannot view remote passcodes.

Access supervision
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  ACCESS SUPERVISION
 ACCESS  ACCESS LEVEL See below
 SUPERVISION   TIMEOUTS

INVALID ATTEMPTS Range: 2 to 5 in steps of 1


 BEFORE LOCKOUT: 3

PASSWORD LOCKOUT Range: 5 to 60 minutes in steps of 1


5
 DURATION: 5 min

The following access supervision settings are available.


INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT — This setting specifies the number of times that an incorrect password can be entered
within a three-minute time span before lockout occurs. When lockout occurs, the LOCAL ACCESS DENIED or REMOTE ACCESS
DENIED FlexLogic operands are set to “On.” These operands are returned to the “Off” state upon expiration of the lockout.
PASSWORD LOCKOUT DURATION — This setting specifies the time that the F35 locks out password access after the number
of invalid password entries specified by the INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT setting has occurred.
The F35 provides a means to raise an alarm upon failed password entry. If password verification fails while accessing a
password-protected level of the relay (either settings or commands), the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS FlexLogic operand is
asserted. The operand can be programmed to raise an alarm via contact outputs or communications. This feature can be
used to protect against both unauthorized and accidental access attempts.
The UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand is reset with the COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS  RESET UNAUTHORIZED ALARMS
command. Therefore, to apply this feature with security, password-protect the Command level. The operand does not
generate events or targets.
If events or targets are required, the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand can be assigned to a digital element programmed with
event logs or targets enabled.
The following table outlines access level timeout settings.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  ACCESS SUPERVISION  ACCESS LEVEL TIMEOUTS
 ACCESS LEVEL COMMAND LEVEL ACCESS Range: 5 to 480 minutes in steps of 1
 TIMEOUTS  TIMEOUT: 5 min

SETTING LEVEL ACCESS Range: 5 to 480 minutes in steps of 1


 TIMEOUT: 30 min

These settings allow the user to specify the length of inactivity required before returning to the Restricted access level.
Note that the access level is set to Restricted when control power is cycled.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-11


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

COMMAND LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT — This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access) required to
return to Restricted access from the Command password level.
SETTING LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT — This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access) required to return
to Restricted access from the Command password level.

Dual-permission security access


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  DUAL PERMISSION SECURITY ACCESS
 DUAL PERMISSION LOCAL SETTING AUTH: Range: selected FlexLogic operands (see below)
 SECURITY ACCESS  On

REMOTE SETTING AUTH: Range: FlexLogic operand


 On

ACCESS AUTH Range: 5 to 480 minutes in steps of 1


 TIMEOUT: 30 min

This feature provides a mechanism to prevent unauthorized or unintended upload of settings to a relay through the local
or remote interface.
The following settings are available through the local (front panel) interface only.
• LOCAL SETTING AUTH — This setting is used for local (front panel or RS232 interface) setting access supervision. Valid
values for the FlexLogic operands are either “On” (default) or any physical “Contact Input ~~ On” value.
If this setting is “On,“ then local setting access functions as normal; that is, a local setting password is required. If this
setting is any contact input on FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (on) prior to providing the local
setting password to gain setting access.

5 If setting access is not authorized for local operation (front panel or RS232 interface) and the user attempts to obtain
setting access, then the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS message displays on the front panel.
If this setting is "Off," firmware upgrades are blocked. If this setting is "On," firmware upgrades are allowed.
• REMOTE SETTING AUTH — This setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interface) setting access supervision.
If this setting is “On” (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is
required. If this setting is “Off,” then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is
provided. If this setting is any other FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to
providing the remote setting password to gain setting access.
If this setting is "Off," firmware upgrades are blocked. If this setting is "On," firmware upgrades are allowed.
• ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT — This setting represents the timeout delay for local setting access. This setting is applicable
when the LOCAL SETTING AUTH setting is programmed to any operand except “On.” The state of the FlexLogic operand
is monitored continuously for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, local access is permitted and the timer
programmed with the ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT setting value is started. When this timer expires, local setting access is
immediately denied. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic operand is detected, the
timeout is restarted. The status of this timer updates every five seconds.

5-12 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The following settings are available through the remote (EnerVista UR Setup) interface only. Select the Settings > Product
Setup > Security menu item to display the security settings window.

The Remote Settings Authorized setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interface) setting access supervision. If this
setting is “On” (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is required.
If this setting is “Off,” then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is provided. If this
setting is any other FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (on) prior to providing the remote setting
password to gain setting access.
The Access Authorized Timeout setting represents the timeout delay remote setting access. It applies when the Remote 5
Settings Authorized setting is programmed to any operand except “On” or “Off.” The state of the FlexLogic operand is
continuously monitored for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, remote setting access is permitted, and the timer
programmed with the Access Authorized Timeout setting value is started. When this timer expires, remote setting access
is denied immediately. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic operand is detected, the timeout
is restarted. The status of this timer updates every five seconds.

5.3.1.3 EnerVista security

Enable the security management system


The EnerVista security system allows an administrator to manage access privileges of multiple users of EnerVista.
It is disabled by default to allow access to the device immediately after installation. When security is disabled, all users
have administrator access. GE recommends enabling the EnerVista security before placing the device in service.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-13


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

To enable the security system and require password use:


1. Select the Security > User Management menu to open the user management window.

2. Enable the Enable Security check box in the lower-left corner to enable the security management system.
3. Click the Ok button.

5 If you force password entry by using this feature, ensure that you know the Administrator password. If you do not
know the password and are locked out of the software, contact GE Grid Solutions for the default password of a UR
device. When using CyberSentry, the default password is "ChangeMe1#".
Security is now enabled for the EnerVista UR Setup software. Upon starting the software, users are now required to enter a
username and password.

Add a new user


The following pre-requisites are required to add user accounts to the EnerVista security management system:
• The user adding the account must have administrator rights
• The EnerVista security management system must be enabled (previous section)
To add a user account:
1. Select the Security > User Management item from the top menu to open the user management window.
2. Enter a username in the User field. The username must be four to 20 characters in length.

5-14 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

3. Select the user access rights by enabling the check box of one or more fields.

The table outlines access rights.


Table 5-1: Access rights summary
Field Description
Delete Entry Deletes the user account when exiting the user management window
Actual Values Allows the user to read Actual Values 5
Settings Allows the user to read Settings values
Commands Allows the user to execute Commands
Event Recorder Allows the user to use the Event Recorder
FlexLogic Allows the user to read FlexLogic values
Update Info Allows the user to write to any function to which they have read privileges. When any of the Settings, Event
Recorder, and FlexLogic check boxes are enabled by themselves, the user is granted read access. When
any of them are enabled in conjunction with the Update Info box, they are granted read and write access.
The user is not granted write access to functions that are not enabled, even if the Update Info field is
enabled.
Admin When the check box is enabled, the user becomes an EnerVista UR Setup administrator and has all
administrative rights. Exercise caution when granting administrator rights.

4. Click OK to add the user account to the system.

Modify user privileges


The following pre-requisites are required to modify user privileges in the EnerVista security management system:
• The user modifying the privileges must have administrator rights
• The EnerVista security management system must be enabled (the Enable Security check box enabled)
To modify user privileges:
1. Select the Security > User Management item from the top menu to open the user management window.
2. Locate the username in the User field.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-15


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

3. Modify the user access rights by enabling or disabling one or more of the check boxes.

The table outlines access rights.


Table 5-2: Access rights summary
Field Description
Delete Entry Deletes the user account when exiting the user management window
5 Actual Values Allows the user to read actual values
Settings Allows the user to read setting values
Commands Allows the user to execute commands
Event Recorder Allows the user to use the digital fault recorder
FlexLogic Allows the user to read FlexLogic values
Update Info Allows the user to write to any function to which they have read privileges. When any of the Settings, Event
Recorder, and FlexLogic check boxes are enabled by themselves, the user is granted read access. When
any of them are enabled in conjunction with the Update Info box, they are granted read and write access.
The user is not granted write access to functions that are not enabled, even if the Update Info field is
enabled.
Admin When this check box is enabled, the user becomes an EnerVista UR Setup administrator and has all
administrative rights. Exercise caution when granting administrator rights.

4. Click OK to save the changes.

5.3.1.4 CyberSentry security

This feature requires a CyberSentry software option. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

The EnerVista software provides the means to configure and authenticate the F35 access using either a server or the
device. Access to functions depends on user role.
The login screen of EnerVista has two options for access to the F35, these being Server and Device authentication.

5-16 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-2: Login screen for CyberSentry

When the "Server" Authentication Type is selected, the F35 uses the RADIUS server and not its local authentication
database to authenticate the user.
When the "Device" button is selected, the F35 uses its local authentication database and not the RADIUS server to
authenticate the user. In this case, it uses built-in roles (Administrator, Engineer, Supervisor, Operator, Observer, or
Administrator and Supervisor when Device Authentication is disabled), as login accounts and the associated passwords
are stored on the F35 device. In this case, access is not user-attributable. In cases where user-attributable access is
required, especially for auditable processes for compliance reasons, use server authentication (RADIUS) only.
No password or security information is displayed in plain text by the EnerVista software or the UR device, nor are they ever
transmitted without cryptographic protection.

Only (TCP/UDP) ports and services that are needed for device configuration and for customer enabled features are
open. All the other ports are closed. For example, Modbus is on by default, so its TCP port 502, is open. But if
Modbus is disabled, port 502 is closed. This function has been tested and no unused ports have been found open. 5
When CyberSentry is enabled, Modbus communications over Ethernet is encrypted, which is not always tolerated by
SCADA systems. The UR has a bypass access feature for such situations, which allows unencrypted Modbus over Ethernet.
The Bypass Access setting is available on the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  SUPERVISORY screen. Note that
other protocols (DNP, 101, 103, 104, EGD) are not encrypted, and they are good communications options for SCADA
systems when CyberSentry is enabled.
When using the rear RS485 port and CyberSentry, registers can be read with a maximum buffer of 64 bytes. Settings may
not be written, so use another port or configure the SERIAL INACTIVITY TIMEOUT setting to a high value, such as eight
minutes, to give the relay enough time to finish the task.

CyberSentry settings through EnerVista


CyberSentry security settings are configured under Device > Settings > Product Setup > Security.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-17


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-3: Security panel when CyberSentry installed

For the Device > Settings > Product Setup > Supervisory option, the panel looks like the following.
Figure 5-4: Supervisory panel
5

For the Security panel, the following settings are available.

5-18 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Table 5-3: RADIUS server settings


Setting name Description Minimum Maximum Default Units Minimum
permission
Primary RADIUS IP IP address of the main RADIUS server. 0.0.0.0 223.255.255.254 0.0.0.0 - Administrator
Address Default value indicates no Primary
RADIUS server is configured, and hence
RADIUS is disabled.
Restart the relay for any change to take
effect.
Primary RADIUS authentication port 1 65535 1812 - Administrator
Authentication Port
Primary Accounting RADIUS accounting port 1 65535 1813 - Administrator
Port
Vendor ID An identifier that specifies RADIUS Value that Administrator
vendor-specific attributes used with the represents
protocol General
Electric
RADIUS Authentication method used by RADIUS EAP-TTLS PAP EAP-TTLS - Administrator
Authentication server. Can use EAP-TTLS, PEAP-GTC, or
Method PAP. Selecting the PEAP-GTC option
disables RADIUS authentication.
RADIUS Shared secret used in authentication. It See the See the following N/A - Administrator
Authentication displays as asterisks. This setting must Password password section
(Shared) Secret meet the CyberSentry password Requirements for requirements
requirements. section earlier
in this chapter
Timeout Timeout in seconds between re- 0 9999 10 sec Administrator
transmission requests
Retries Number of retries before giving up 0 9999 3 - Administrator 5
Confirm RADIUS Confirmation of the shared secret. The See the 245 characters N/A - Administrator
Authentication entry displays as asterisks. Password
(Shared) Secret Requirements
section

Table 5-4: General security settings


Setting name Description Minimum Maximum Default Units Minimum
permission
Session Lockout Number of failed authentications before the 0 (lockout 99 3 - Administrator
device blocks subsequent authentication disabled)
attempts for the lockout period
Session Lockout The period in minutes that a user is prevented 0 (no period) 9999 3 min Administrator
Period from logging in after being locked out
Syslog Server IP The IP address of the target Syslog server to 0.0.0.0 223.255. 0.0.0.0 - Administrator
Address which all security events are transmitted 255.254
Syslog Server Port The UDP port number of the target syslog 1 65535 514 - Administrator
Number server to which all security events are
transmitted
Device When enabled, local Device authentication Disabled Enabled Enabled - Administrator
Authentication with roles is allowed. When disabled, the UR
only authenticates to the AAA server (RADIUS).
NOTE: Administrator and Supervisor (if still
enabled) remain active even after Device
authentication is disabled. The only permission
for local Administrator is to re-enable Device
authentication when Device authentication is
disabled. To re-enable Device authentication,
the Supervisor unlocks the device for setting
changes, and then the Administrator can re-
enable Device authentication.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-19


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Setting name Description Minimum Maximum Default Units Minimum


permission
Firmware Lock Indicates if the device receives firmware Disabled Enabled Enabled - Administrator
(via Lock Relay) upgrades. If Enabled and the firmware
upgrade attempt is made, the device denies
the upgrade and displays an error message
that the lock is set. On each firmware upgrade,
this setting goes back to the default.

The Lock Relay setting blocks settings and


firmware updates.
Factory Service When enabled, the device can go into factory Disabled Enabled Disabled - Supervisor
Mode service mode. To enable, Supervisor (Administrator
authentication is necessary. when Supervisor
is disabled)
Restore to Defaults Sets the device to factory defaults No Yes No - Administrator
Supervisor Role When enabled, the Supervisor role is active. To Disabled Enabled Enabled - Administrator to
enable, Administrator authentication is enable and
necessary. When disabled, the Supervisor role Supervisor to
is inactive. To disable, Supervisor disable
authentication is necessary.
RADIUS user names Ensures that RADIUS user names are not the See RADIUS See - Administrator
same as local/device role names server RADIUS
documents server
document
s
Password Local/device roles except for Observer are See the See the Change Text The specified
password-protected. All RADIUS users are Password following Me1# role and
password-protected. Requirements password Administrator,
5 section earlier
in this chapter
section for
requireme
except for
Supervisor,
nts where it is only
itself

Table 5-5: Security alarm settings


Setting name Description / Details Min Max Default Units Minimum
permissions
Failed A threshold number indicating when an alarm 0 99 3 - Administrator
Authentications is set off to indicate too many failed (disabled)
authentication attempts
Firmware Lock A value indicating if the device can receive a Disabled Enabled Enabled - Administrator
firmware upgrade. If Enabled and a firmware
upgrade attempt is made, the device alarm
activates. If Disabled, the device alarm does not
activate. On each firmware upgrade this setting
goes back to the default.
Settings Lock A value indicating if the device can accept any Disabled Enabled Enabled - Supervisor
settings changes. If Enabled and a settings (Administrator if
change attempt is made, the device alarm Supervisor has
activates. If Disabled, the device alarm does not been disabled)
activate.

CyberSentry settings through the front panel


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY
 SECURITY LOGIN: Range: Administrator, Engineer, Supervisor,
  None Operator, Factory (for factory use only), None

 CHANGE LOCAL See page 5-21


  PASSWORDS

 SESSION See page 5-22


  SETTINGS

5-20 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

 RESTORE DEFAULTS See page 5-22


 

 SUPERVISORY See page 5-22


 

SYSLOG IP ADDRESS: Range: 0.0.0.0, 255.255.255.255


 0.0.0.0

SYSLOG PORT NUMBER: Range: 1 to 65535


 514

LOGIN — This setting is applicable for Device authentication only. This setting allows a user to log in with a specific role, as
outlined here. For the Supervisor role, enable the “Supervisor Role” setting. Log out by right-clicking the device in EnerVista
and selecting the Disconnect option.
Whenever a new role is logged in, the user is prompted to enter a password. Passwords must obey the requirements
specified earlier in the chapter in the Password Requirements section.The UR device supports five roles. Roles have their
corresponding passwords, except the Observer role, which does not require a password. There are no time-outs for the
Administrator, Engineer, Operator, and Supervisor when logged in using the front panel; log out manually or use the
Command > Security commands in the software.
The roles are defined as follows:
• Administrator — Complete read/write access to all settings and commands. This role does not allow concurrent
access. This role has an operand to indicate when it is logged on.
• Engineer — Complete read/write access to all settings and commands except configuring Security settings and
firmware upgrades. This role does not allow concurrent access.
• Operator — The Operator has read/write access to all settings under the Commands menu/section. This role does not


exist offline.
Supervisor — This is only an approving role. This role’s authentication commits setting changes submitted by
5
Administrator or Engineer. The Supervisor role authenticates to unlock the UR relay for setting changes and not
approve changes after the fact. Only a Supervisor can set the Settings Lock and Firmware Lock in the Security
settings. This role also has the ability to forcefully log off any other role and clear the security event log. This role can
also be disabled, but only through a Supervisor authentication. When this role is disabled its permissions are assigned
to the Administrator role.
• Observer — This role has read-only access to all F35 settings. This role allows unlimited concurrent access but it has
no download access to any files on the device. Observer is the default role if no authentication has been done to the
device. This role displays as "None" on the front panel. When local authentication is used, no password is required for
this role. When RADIUS server authentication is used, a password is required.

The Factory service role is not available. It is for factory use only.
The Local Access Denied message on the front panel can mean that you need to log in to the UR in order to
complete the action.

Change local passwords


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS
 CHANGE LOCAL LOGIN: Range: 20 alphanumeric characters
 PASSWORDS  None

NEW PASSWORD: Range: 20 alphanumeric characters



CONFIRM PASSWORD: Range: 20 alphanumeric characters

The menu is shown on the front panel upon successful login of the Administrator role.
The LOGIN setting in this menu is similar to that described in SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > SECURITY except for the factory
role.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-21


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Passwords are stored in text format. No encryption is applied.

In Device authentication mode, the Observer role does not have a password associated with it. In Server
authentication mode the Observer role requires a password.
If you are locked out of the software, contact GE Grid Solutions for the default password. When using CyberSentry,
the default password is "ChangeMe1#".
Once the passwords are set, the Administrator with Supervisor approval can change the role-associated password.
In CyberSentry, password encryption is not supported.

Session settings
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  SESSION SETTINGS
 SESSION SESSION LOCKOUT: Range: 0 to 99
 SETTINGS  3

SESSION LOCKOUT Range: 0 to 9999 minutes


 PERIOD: 3 min

SESSION LOCKOUT — This setting specifies the number of failed authentications before the device blocks subsequent
authentication attempts for the lockout period. A value of zero means lockout is disabled.
SESSION LOCKOUT PERIOD — This setting specifies the period of time in minutes of a lockout period. A value of 0 means that
there is no lockout period.

Restore defaults

5 SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  RESTORE DEFAULTS


 RESTORE DEFAULTS LOAD FACTORY Range: Yes, No
  DEFAULTS: No

LOAD FACTORY DEFAULTS — This setting is used to reset all the settings, communication, and security passwords. An
Administrator role is used to change this setting and a Supervisor role (if not disabled) approves it.

Supervisory
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  SUPERVISORY
 SUPERVISORY DEVICE Range: Yes, No
  AUTHENTICATION: Yes

BYPASS ACCESS: Range: Local, Remote, Local and Remote, Disabled,


 Disabled Pushbuttons

LOCK RELAY: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Disabled

FACTORY SERVICE Range: Enabled, Disabled


 MODE: Disabled

 SELF TESTS See below


 

SUPERVISOR ROLE: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Disabled

SERIAL INACTIVITY Range: 1 to 9999 minutes


 TIMEOUT: 1 min

The Supervisory menu settings are available for Supervisor role only, or if the Supervisor role is disabled then for the
Administrator role only.

5-22 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

DEVICE AUTHENTICATION — This setting is enabled by default, meaning "Yes" is selected. When enabled, Device
authentication with roles is enabled. When this setting is disabled, the UR only authenticates to the AAA server (RADIUS).
However, the Administrator and Supervisor (when enabled) remain active even after device authentication is disabled and
their only permission is to re-enable Device authentication. To re-enable Device authentication, the Supervisor unlocks the
device for settings changes, then the Administrator re-enables device authentication.
BYPASS ACCESS — The bypass security feature provides an easier access, with no authentication and encryption for those
special situations when this is considered safe. Only the Supervisor, or the Administrator when the Supervisor role is
disabled, can enable this feature.
Mode Front panel or serial (RS232, RS485) Ethernet
Normal mode Authentication — Role Based Access Control (RBAC) Authentication — RBAC and passwords encrypted
and passwords in clear SSH tunneling
Bypass access mode No passwords for allowed RBAC levels No passwords for allowed RBAC levels
No SSH tunneling

The bypass options are as follows:


• Local — Bypasses authentication for push buttons, keypad, RS232, and RS485
• Remote — Bypasses authentication for Ethernet
• Local and Remote — Bypasses authentication for push buttons, keypad, RS232, RS485, and Ethernet
• Pushbuttons — Bypasses authentication for front panel push buttons only. On the graphical front panel, the
authentication for side pushbuttons to control breakers and disconnects also is bypassed.
LOCK RELAY — This setting uses a Boolean value (Enabled/Disabled) to indicate if the device accepts settings changes and
whether the device can receive a firmware upgrade. This setting can be changed by the Supervisor role, if it is enabled, or
by the Administrator if the Supervisor role is disabled. The Supervisor role disables this setting for the relay to start
accepting settings changes, command changes, or firmware upgrade. After all the setting changes are applied or
commands executed, the Supervisor enables to lock settings changes.
5
Example: If this setting is enabled and an attempt is made to change settings or upgrade the firmware, the UR device
denies the settings changes or denies upgrading the firmware. If this setting is disabled, the UR device accepts settings
changes and firmware upgrade.
This role is disabled by default.
FACTORY SERVICE MODE — When Enabled, the device can go into factory service mode. For this setting to become enabled a
Supervisor authentication is necessary. The default value is Disabled.
SUPERVISOR ROLE — When Enabled, the Supervisor role is active. To Disable this setting a Supervisor authentication is
necessary. If disabled, the Supervisor role is not allowed to log in. In this case, the Administrator can change the settings
under the Supervisory menu.
If enabled, Supervisor authentication is required to change the settings in the Supervisory menu. If the Supervisor disables
their role after authentication, the Supervisor session remains valid until they switch to another role using MMI or until they
end the current Supervisor session if using communications.
This role is disabled by default.
SERIAL INACTIVITY TIMEOUT — The role logged via a serial port is auto logged off after the Serial Inactivity timer times out. A
separate timer is maintained for RS232 and RS485 connections. Set this value to a high number, such as eight minutes,
when using the rear RS485 terminals for settings write.
GE recommends setting this value to at least 3 minutes for the following scenario: while connected to a CyberSentry
device, with serial or USB cable connected to the front panel, and performing "Add Device to Offline Window" or an online/
offline comparison. With less than the recommended 3 minutes, the serial activity timeout interrupts the connection and
the security role login window appears. Upon login, the process resumes.

Self-tests
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  SUPERVISORY  SELF TESTS
 SELF TESTS  FAILED See below
   AUTHENTICATE

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-23


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

FIRMWARE LOCK: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Enabled

SETTINGS LOCK: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Enabled

FAILED AUTHENTICATE — If this setting is Enabled then the number of failed authentications is compared with the Session
Lockout threshold. When the Session Lockout threshold is exceeded, this minor alarm indication comes up.
FIRMWARE LOCK — If this setting is Enabled, then any firmware upgrade operation attempt when the Lock Relay setting is
enabled brings up this self test alarm.
SETTINGS LOCK — If this setting is Enabled then an unauthorized write attempt to a setting for a given role activates this self
test.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY  SUPERVISORY  SELF TESTS  FAILED AUTHENTICATE
 FAILED FAILED AUTHENTICATE: Range: Enabled, Disabled
 AUTHENTICATE  Enabled

CyberSentry setup
When first using CyberSentry security, use the following procedure for setup.
1. Log in to the relay as Administrator by using the VALUE keys on the front panel to enter the default password
"ChangeMe1#". Note that the Lock Relay setting needs to be disabled in the Security > Supervisory menu. When this
setting is disabled, configuration and firmware upgrade are possible. By default, this setting is disabled.
2. Enable the Supervisor role if you have a need for it.
3. Make any required changes in configuration, such as setting a valid IP address for communication over Ethernet.
5 4. Log out of the Administrator account by choosing None.
5. Next, Device or Server authentication can be chosen on the login screen, but the choice is available only in EnerVista.
Use Device authentication to log in using the five pre-configured roles (Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator,
Observer). When using a serial connection, only Device authentication is supported. When Server authentication is
required, characteristics for communication with a RADIUS server must be configured. This is possible only in the
EnerVista software. The RADIUS server itself also must be configured. The appendix called RADIUS Server at the end of
this instruction manual gives an example of how to set up a simple RADIUS server. Once both the RADIUS server and
the parameters for connecting the UR to the server have been configured, you can choose Server authentication on
the login screen of EnerVista.

The use of CyberSentry for devices communicating through an Ethernet-to-RS485 gateway is not
supported. Because these gateways do not support the secure protocols necessary to communicate
with such devices, the connection cannot be established. Use the device as a non-CyberSentry
device.
Users logged in through the front panel are not timed out and cannot be forcefully logged out by a
supervisor. Roles logged in through the front panel that do no allow multiple instances (Administrator,
Supervisor, Engineer, Operator) must switch to None (equivalent to a logout) when they are done in
order to log out.
For all user roles except Observer, only one instance can be logged in at a time, for both login by front
panel and software.
To configure Server authentication:
1. In the EnerVista software, choose Device authentication and log in as Administrator.
2. Configure the following RADIUS server parameters: IP address, authentication port, shared secret, and vendor ID.
3. On the RADIUS server, configure the user accounts. Do not use the five pre-defined roles as user names (Administrator,
Supervisor, Engineer, Operator, Observer) in the RADIUS server. If you do, the UR relay automatically provides the
authentication from the device.
4. In the EnerVista software, choose Server authentication and log in using the user name and password configured on
the RADIUS server for Server authentication login.

5-24 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

5. After making any required changes, log out.

When changing settings offline, ensure that only settings permitted by the role that performs the
settings download are changed because only those changes are applied.
Pushbuttons (both user-control buttons and user-programmable buttons) located on the front panel can be pressed by an
Administrator or Engineer role. This also applies to the RESET button, which resets targets, where targets are errors
displayed on the front panel or the Targets panel of the EnerVista software. The RESET button has special behavior in that it
allows these two roles to press it even when they are logged in through the RS232 port and not through the front panel.
To reset the security event log and self-test operands:
1. Log in as Supervisor (if the role is enabled) or Administrator (if the Supervisor role is disabled) and execute a clear
security command under Commands > Security > Clear Security.

Security events
The security events produced when the CyberSentry option is purchased are sent as sytem log (syslog) messages to a
syslog server, if one is configured. The format is as follows.
Security log Event Number Date & Username IP address Role Activity Value
Timestamp

Event Number — Event identification number (index)


Date & Timestamp — UTC date and time
Username — 255 chars maximum, but in the security log it is truncated to 20 characters
IP address — Device IP address
Role — 16 bit unsigned, of type format F617 5
Enumeration Role
0 None
1 Administrator
2 Supervisor
3 Engineer
4 Operator
5 Factory

Activity Value — 16 bit unsigned

Enumeration Description
1 Authentication Failed
2 User Lockout
3 FW Upgrade
4 FW Lock
5 Settings Lock
6 Settings Change. Because this can fill the entire event log, it is supported by the
already existing Settings_Change.log file. This event is not required.
7 Clear Oscillography command
8 Clear Data Logger command (not applicable to all UR products)
9 Clear Demand Records command (not applicable to all UR products)
10 Clear Energy command (not applicable to all UR products)
11 Clear Unauthorized Access command
12 Clear Teleprotection Counters command (not applicable to all UR products)
13 Clear All Relay Records command
14 Role Log in

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-25


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Enumeration Description
15 Role Log off

In addition to supporting syslog, a F35 with CyberSentry also saves the security events in two local security files, these
being SECURITY_EVENTS.CSV and SETTING_CHANGES.LOG. Details on these files and how to retrieve them are available in
the EnerVista software under Maintenance > Retrieve File. Depending on the level of criticality/severity, a syslog server or
a reporting tool gathering information from a syslog server can produce reports, charts, and so on. All severity levels are
per RFC 5424.
Table 5-6: CyberSentry system events recorded
Event Severity Description
FAILED_AUTH, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Notice (5) A failed authentication with origin information (username and IP:MAC
address), a time stamp in UTC time when it occurred
AUTH_LOCKOUT, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Warning (4) An authentication lockout has occurred because of too many failed
authentication attempts
FIRMWARE_UPGD, ORIGIN, Information (6) Indicates that a change of firmware has occurred
TIMESTAMP
FIRMWARE_LOCK, ORIGIN, Warning (4) An attempt was made to change firmware while the firmware lock was
TIMESTAMP enabled
SETTING_CHG, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Notice (5) Indicates setting change(s)
SETTING_LOCK, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Warning (4) An attempt was made to change settings while the settings lock was enabled
LOGIN, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Information (6) Indicates when a certain role logged in
LOGOUT, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Information (6) Indicates when a certain role logged out or timed out
CLEAR_OSCILLOGRAPHY Notice (5) Clear oscillography command was issued

5 CLEAR_DATA_LOGGER
CLEAR_DEMAND_RECS
Notice (5)
Notice (5)
Clear data logger command was issued
Clear demand records command was issued
CLEAR_ENERGY Notice (5) Clear energy command was issued
RESET_UNAUTH_ACCESS Notice (5) Reset Unauthorized access command was issued
CLEAR_TELEPROTECTION_CNT Notice (5) Clear teleprotection counters command was issued
CLEAR_ALL_RECS Notice (5) Clear all records command was issued
WRITE_SETTING_FILE Notice (5) Write settings file to the relay

5.3.2 Display properties


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  DISPLAY PROPERTIES
 DISPLAY LANGUAGE: Range: English; English, French; English, Russian; English,
 PROPERTIES  English Chinese; English, German (examples; depends on order code)
Visible when language other than English purchased

FLASH MESSAGE Range: 0.5 to 10.0 s in steps of 0.1


 TIME: 1.0 s

DEFAULT MESSAGE Range: 10 to 900 s in steps of 1


 TIMEOUT: 300 s

DEFAULT MESSAGE Range: 25%, 50%, 75%, 100%


 INTENSITY: 25 % Visible when a VFD is installed

SCREEN SAVER Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FEATURE: Disabled Visible when an LCD is installed

SCREEN SAVER WAIT Range: 1 to 65535 min. in steps of 1


 TIME: 30 min Visible when an LCD is installed

CURRENT CUT-OFF Range: 0.002 to 0.020 pu in steps of 0.001


 LEVEL: 0.020 pu

VOLTAGE CUT-OFF Range: 0.1 to 1.0 V secondary in steps of 0.1


 LEVEL: 1.0 V

5-26 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Some relay messaging characteristics can be modified to suit different situations using the display properties settings.
LANGUAGE — This setting selects the language used to display settings, actual values, and targets. This setting displays
when a language other than English was purchased, and the range depends on the order code of the relay.
For Japanese, the settings display in Japanese on the graphical front panel, while the keys printed on the panel are in
English.
For Japanese and Chinese, up to 10 characters can be input in a field on the graphical front panel, not 20.
With the graphical front panel, the language can be changed regardless of the language purchased. That is, all languages
can be used. If you select a language with which you are unfamiliar and want to switch back to English for example, the
menu order remains the same. That is, Settings is always second, Product Setup is always first, Display Properties is always
second, and Language is always first.
If the language is changed after entering user-configured names, such as relay names, the strings are not translated. For
example, a relay name is entered in English, the language is changed to Japanese, and the relay name remains in English.
Set the language before changing settings.
The language can be selected also for the front panel in EnerVista under Maintenance > Change Front Panel.
The language of the EnerVista software can be changed under View > Language. Languages supported by the operating
system display; that is for Polish or Japanese to display, the software needs to be installed on a Polish or Japanese
operating system.
FLASH MESSAGE TIME — Flash messages are status, warning, error, and information messages displayed in response to
certain key presses during settings programming. These messages override any normal messages. Use this setting to
change the duration of flash messages on the display.
DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT — If the keypad is inactive for a period of time, the relay automatically reverts to a default
message. The inactivity time is modified using this setting to ensure that messages remain on the screen long enough
during programming or reading of actual values. This setting is not supported on the graphical front panel.
DEFAULT MESSAGE INTENSITY — To extend phosphor life in the vacuum fluorescent display, the brightness can be
5
attenuated during default message display. During keypad interrogation, the display always operates at full brightness.
This setting is not supported on the graphical front panel.
SCREEN SAVER FEATURE and SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME — These settings are only visible if the F35 has a liquid crystal display
(LCD) and control its backlighting. When the SCREEN SAVER FEATURE is “Enabled,” the LCD backlighting turns off after the
DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT followed by the SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME, provided that no keys have been pressed and no
target messages are active. When a keypress occurs or a target becomes active, the LCD backlighting turns on. These
settings are not supported on the graphical front panel.
CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL — This setting modifies the current cut-off threshold. Very low currents (1 to 2% of the rated value)
are very susceptible to noise. Some customers prefer very low currents to display as zero, while others prefer the current to
display even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The F35 applies a cut-off value to the magnitudes
and angles of the measured currents. If the magnitude is below the cut-off level, it is substituted with zero. This applies to
phase and ground current phasors as well as true RMS values and symmetrical components. The cut-off operation applies
to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those used by communications protocols. Note that the
cut-off level for the sensitive ground input is 10 times lower that the CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL setting value. Raw current
samples available via oscillography are not subject to cut-off.

VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL — This setting modifies the voltage cut-off threshold. Very low secondary voltage measurements
(at the fractional volt level) can be affected by noise. Some customers prefer these low voltages to be displayed as zero,
while others prefer the voltage to be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The F35
applies a cut-off value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured voltages. If the magnitude is below the cut-off level,
it is substituted with zero. This operation applies to phase and auxiliary voltages, and symmetrical components. The cut-off
operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those used by communications
protocols. Raw samples of the voltages available via oscillography are not subject to cut-off.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-27


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

The CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL and the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are used to determine the metered power cut-off levels. The
power cut-off level is calculated using the following equations. For Delta connections:

Eq. 5-3

For Wye connections:

Eq. 5-4

Eq. 5-5

where VT primary = VT secondary  VT ratio and CT primary = CT secondary  CT ratio.


For example, given the following settings:
CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL: “0.02 pu”
VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL: “1.0 V”
PHASE CT PRIMARY: “100 A”
PHASE VT SECONDARY: “66.4 V”
PHASE VT RATIO: “208.00 : 1"
PHASE VT CONNECTION: “Delta”
We have:
CT primary = “100 A”, and
VT primary = PHASE VT SECONDARY x PHASE VT RATIO = 66.4 V x 208 = 13811.2 V
5 The power cut-off is therefore:
power cut-off= (CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL  VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL  CT primary  VT primary)/VT secondary
=(  0.02 pu  1.0 V  100 A  13811.2 V) / 66.4 V
= 720.5 watts
Any calculated power value below this cut-off does not display. As well, the three-phase energy data do not accumulate if
the total power from all three phases does not exceed the power cut-off.

Lower the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL and CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL with care as the relay accepts lower signals as valid
measurements. Unless dictated otherwise by a specific application, the default settings of “0.02 pu” for CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL and “1.0 V” for VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are recommended.

5.3.3 Graphical front panel

The graphical front panel is a hardware option. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

Use the EnerVista software to configure the graphical front panel. The settings are not accessible from the graphical front
panel.
The following screens are available:
• Home page
• Rolling mode
• Metering editor
• Single-line diagram editor
• Annunciator editor
• Configurable navigation

5-28 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The settings menu itself and the event record pages are not configurable.
Multiple screens can be opened in the EnerVista software, but the first remains active and the others can be read-only. For
example, the Annunciator Editor and Single Line Diagram Editor can be open and active, then subsequently opened Rolling
Mode and Home Page screens are read-only. Close the windows, then re-open the one required.

5.3.3.1 Home page


This window sets the home page displayed on the graphical front panel and the date and time formats for all pages. Home
page options include display of product information, alarms, actual values, and event records.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Home Page. The menu does not display when there is no
graphical front panel.
Figure 5-5: Home page with product information
Setting Group
Alarm Target Relay Date and Time

859850A1.cdr

Figure 5-6: Home page settings

Home Page Content


Range: Product Information, SLD 1…5, Annunciator, Annunciator 1…8, Phasors 1…6, Tabular 1…5, Event Records, Targets
Default: Product Information
This setting specifies the page to display between the home page header and footer. Pressing the Home button returns
the display to this page. The home page displays for the rolling mode delay specified, then changes to the rolling mode
pages.
The "Annunciator" option without a page number specifies the first annunciator page in the following sequence:
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in alarm (fast flash)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-29


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in ringback. Ringback is a "return alert."
Visual and audible signals are given when conditions return to normal, then the sequence returns to normal by
pushing the RESET button.
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in abnormal state
– Annunciator page 1
Whenever an annunciator window changes state this list is re-evaluated, which can result in the home page displaying
a different annunciator page.
The Tabular option displays a configured actual values/metering page.
The Targets option displays error messages, such as wrong transceiver, similar to event record entries.
Date Format
Range: yyyy-mm-dd, dd-mmm-yy, yyyy/mm/dd, m/d/yyyy, m/d/yy, mm/dd/yy, mm/dd/yyyy, yy/mm/dd
Default: yyyy-mm-dd
This setting specifies the format for dates on the graphical front panel. It applies to the page header, the events records,
the annunciator, and everywhere else a date displays on the panel. If the relay is synchronized to an external time
source via PTP, IRIG-B, SNTP, and so on, the date/time is shown in white, and otherwise in yellow.
yyyy — four-digit year, for example 2017
yy — two-digit year, for example 17 for 2017
mmm — abbreviation of month name, for example Jan for January
mm — two-digit month, for example 01 for January
m — one or two-digit month, for example 1 for January and 10 for October
dd — two-digit day, for example 08

5 d — one or two-digit day, for example 8 and 28


To set the date and time, access Synchronize Devices in the software, synchronize to a time source using Settings >
Product Setup > Real Time Clock, or synchronize to the computer using Commands > Set Date and Time.
Time Format
Range: hh:mm:ss, h:mm:ss tt
Default: hh:mm:ss
This setting specifies the format for time on the graphical front panel. It applies to the page header and everywhere else
a time displays on the panel. When the Date Format and the Time Format use the defaults, the date and time are
separated by the character "T" per the ISO convention, such as "2017-09-24T10:58:31". Otherwise the date and time are
separated by a space. If the relay is synchronized to an external time source via PTP, IRIG-B, SNTP, and so on, the date/
time is shown in white, and otherwise in yellow.
hh — two-digit hour, for example 02 for two o’clock
h — one or two-digit hour, for example 2 for two o’clock
mm — two-digit minute, for example 51 minutes
ss — two-digit second (can have a decimal and further digits appended), for example 16 seconds
tt — AM or PM based on 12 hour clock
If microseconds have to be displayed, for example, in the event records, the 24-hour clock is adopted. The representation
of an accumulated period (for example hh:mm) is not affected by the selected time format.
To set the date and time, access Synchronize Devices in the software or synchronize to a time source using Settings >
Product Setup > Real Time Clock.

5.3.3.2 Rolling mode


After a user-defined period of inactivity, the graphical front panel changes, or rolls, to user-selected pages. Up to 10 pages
can be specified. Similarly, the display backlight intensity is lowered to a specified level; lower intensity extends the life of
the display.
Each rolling page displays for a few seconds; duration cannot be set.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Rolling Mode.

5-30 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-7: Rolling mode settings

Rolling Mode Delay


Range: 0 to 900 s in steps of 1
Default: 300 s
Set this delay to 0 to disable the rolling mode feature.
Otherwise, after no pushbutton has been pressed for the amount of time specified by this setting, the display
automatically enters rolling mode. While in the rolling mode, the Rolling Mode Pages display. Rolling mode can be
interrupted when a setting changes, such as changing the home page, then resumes rolling.
5
Automatic Annunciator Recall
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
When Enabled, an annunciator window changes state, and the display is in rolling mode, this setting terminates rolling
mode and displays the annunciator page containing the changed state.
The Configurable Navigation feature takes precedence over this setting when the Automatic Annunciator Recall and
Configurable Navigation are activated by the same input.
Screen Saver Delay
Range: 0 to 900 s in steps of 1
Default: 300 s
The screen saver mode extends the life of the display. After the amount of time set here, the screen saver activates and
the display intensity is reduced to the level set by the Screen Saver Intensity setting. When in rolling mode, rolling
continues while the screen saver is active. The screen saver terminates when rolling mode terminates. To disable the
screen saver, set the delay to 0.
Screen Saver Intensity
Range: 0, 10, 20, or 30 %
Default: 30 %
This setting sets the brightness of the display while the screen saver is active. For example, 0% means that the screen is
dark and nothing displays. Pressing a pushbutton or changing a setting in the software, for example, re-activates the
display.
Number of Rolling Mode Pages
Range: 1 to 10 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting specifies the number of rolling pages. During rolling mode, the graphical front panel displays pages from 1
to the selected number.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-31


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Rolling Mode Page 1 to 10


Range: Product Information, SLD 1…5, Annunciator, Annunciator 1…8, Phasors 1…6, Tabular 1…5, Event Records, Targets
Default: Product Information
These settings specify the pages to display on the graphical front panel while in rolling mode.
The "Annunciator" selection without a page number specifies the first annunciator page in the following sequence:
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in alarm (fast flash)
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in ringback. Ringback is a "return alert."
Visual and audible signals are given when conditions return to normal, then the sequence returns to normal by
pushing the RESET button.
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in abnormal state
– Annunciator page 1
Whenever an annunciator window changes state the list is re-evaluated, which can result in the display of a different
annunciator page in the rolling sequence.
The Tabular option displays a configured actual values/metering page.
The Targets option displays error messages, such as wrong transceiver, similar to event record entries.

5.3.3.3 Metering editor


This feature creates tables of actual/metered values for the graphical front panel. It configures the content that displays in
the Metering Tab pushbutton. An actual value, status, or text can be displayed. Five tabular metering pages can be
configured. There also can be a phasor page for each configured AC source, and these pages are not configurable.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Metering Editor.

5 Set the Current Page, Page Name, Layout, configure the top inputs, then the cells. The 16 inputs at the top of the page are
used as inputs for the Status Index fields. Click the Preview button to view the page.
For a phasor diagram, configure the source under Settings > System Setup > Signal Sources. The diagram is then
viewable by pushing the Metering Tab pushbutton on the graphical front panel. The Metering Editor is not used for these
phasor diagrams.
The figures show setup and table preview.
The Cells configured are not retained when using the Convert Device Settings function, for example when converting a
file in the Offline Window from version 7.6 to 7.7.

5-32 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-8: Metering Editor window

5
Figure 5-9: Preview for graphical front panel

STATUS INPUTS 1 to 16
Range: OFF, ON, any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting identifies the potential inputs for use in the STATUS INDEX fields, for display of the status of FlexLogic
operands.
A maximum of eight Status Inputs can be used per metering page, and 16 in all metering pages.
Select the metering input from the drop-down list. The options reflect the FlexLogic operands applicable to the F35. They
are inputs for all five metering pages, not just the current page.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-33


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

CURRENT PAGE
Range: Page 1...Page 5
Default: Page 1
Select the metering page to configure from the drop-down list. There are five pages possible, viewable with the Tab
pushbuttons on the graphical front panel.
PAGE NAME
Range: Page 1...Page 5
Default: Page 1
Up to 20 characters can be input here as the name of each metering page. The name displays for the Tab pushbutton on
the graphical front panel.
LAYOUT
Range: 3x4, 4x6, 6x8, 6x4, 8x6, 12x8, 12x4, 16x6, 18x8
Default: 6x4
This setting determines how many rows and columns display on the graphical front panel with the metering information.
The configurable rows in the settings window change dynamically based on this setting.
CONTENT
Range: Actual, Status, Text
Default: Text
Select the type of content to display.
– Actual — an actual value/data. The Configure button becomes active for the actual value to be selected.
– Status — one of the operands selected from the STATUS INPUTS fields. Select it in the STATUS INDEX field.

5 – Text — indicates that text is to display instead of a metered value


STATUS INDEX
Range: 1...16
Default:
This field becomes active when the CONTENT field is set to Status. It selects the input from the STATUS INPUTS to display
the on/off status of the selected operand.
A maximum of eight Status Inputs can be used per metering page, and 16 in all metering pages.
TEXT
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
Default:
Enter the text to display on the graphical front panel. This field is active when the CONTENT field is set to Text or Status.
When Status is selected, the text displays when the status input is in the "on" state.
OFF TEXT
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
Default:
Enter the text to display on the graphical front panel when the element being monitored is in an off/closed state. This
field is active when the CONTENT field is set to Status. The text displays when the status input is in the "off" state.
FONT
Range: 16, 18, 20
Default: 16
Set the font size to display on the graphical front panel.
TEXT COLOR
Range: 24-bit color selector
Default: Black
Set the text color to display in the specified cell.

5-34 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

BACK COLOR
Range: 24-bit color selector
Default: Grey
Set the background color to display in the specified cell.
ACTUAL (Configure)
Range: Configure
Default: Configure
The Configure button becomes active when the CONTENT field is set to "Actual." The window specifies the metering
data to display.
Figure 5-10: Metering value properties window

5
Parameter
Range: any FlexAnalog parameter
Default:
This setting selects a FlexAnalog parameter that specifies the metered value to display in the metering window. A
FlexAnalog is an analog parameter.
Units
Range: up to eight alphanumeric characters
Default:
This setting specifies the units of measurement for the metered value and is populated based on the Parameter
selected. The field can be left blank when units of measure do not apply.
Scale Factor
Range: G Giga, M Mega, k Kilo, None
Default: None
This setting allows the user to specify the scaling factor for the metering units value. Options depend on the Parameter.
Multiplier
Range: -1000000 to 1000000
Default: 1.0
This setting allows the user to specify a multiplier for the metering parameter value. The multiplier must be in
compliance with the 32-bit floating-point format per IEEE 754, otherwise, the input value is represented as per the IEEE
standard. For example, 1234.56789 is represented as 1234.567871094, and 9876.54321 as 9876.54296875.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-35


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Number of Integers
Range: 1 to 12 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting specifies the number of integers in the displayed metered value. It can be used to provide for leading
character spacing of the display value.
For example, setting the number to 2 displays 00.000[V] and setting it to 3 displays 000.000[V].
Number of Decimals
Range: 0 to 10 in steps of 1
Default: 3
This setting specifies the number of decimal places in the displayed metered value. For example, setting the number to 1
displays 0.0 and setting it to 2 displays 0.00.

5.3.3.4 Single-line diagram editor


The path is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Single Line Diagram Editor. Use is explained in the Interfaces
chapter.

5.3.3.5 Annunciator editor


The annunciator editor is used to create annunciator content for the graphical front panel, including alarms and actual
values. Use is explained in the Interfaces chapter.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Annunciator Editor.
To add an alarm, access the Annunciator Editor, configure the Layout and Page Name, configure the alarm or actual value,
set the text and color, then save. On the graphical front panel, view the content by pressing the Annunciator Tab
5 pushbutton at the bottom of the Home page. (Alarms do not display automatically.) Acknowledge the alarm by navigating
to it with the arrow pushbuttons, then pressing the ENTER or RESET pushbutton.
The figure shows alarms for basic functions. The last annunciator page is named Device Alarms. Alarms are set for the
device being offline, Ethernet cable issues, unauthorized access, battery failure, and high ambient temperature. They can
reset themselves when conditions return to normal, except for unauthorized access and temperature monitoring, which
require the alarms to be acknowledged. The self-test error functions, here for Ethernet and battery failures, also have been
enabled under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Self Tests (not shown). When the alarms are triggered,
they display with a red background. An alarm is acknowledged by using the arrow keys on the graphical front panel then
pressing the ENTER button.

5-36 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-11: Annunciator editor with preview shown

Reset
Range: ON, OFF, any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting selects a FlexLogic operand that when activated acknowledges/resets all annunciator windows in the
graphical front panel. For example, to have the first user pushbutton resets all alarms, set this to PUSHBUTTON 1 ON and
turn on the pushbutton under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Pushbuttons. This setting is the same
as the one defined in Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Resetting > Reset Annunciator. See the Resetting section later in this
chapter.
LAYOUT
Range: 3x4, 4x6, 6x8
Default: 3x4
Selects the number of rows and columns to display on the annunciator pages. For example, 3x4 means 12 windows
display per page over eight pages. Up to 96 entries are possible.
To view the layout, click the Preview button.
PAGE NAMES
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
Default: Page 1...Page 8
Up to 20 characters can be input as the name of each annunciator page. The number of pages depends on the Layout.
The name displays for the Tab pushbutton on the graphical front panel.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-37


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

PARAMETER
Range: Indicator 1...Indicator 96
Default: Indicator 1...Indicator 96
Read-only field. Up to 96 windows are possible.
CONTENT
Range: Actual, Alarm, Mixed
Default: Alarm
Select if the cell is to be an alarm, an actual value, or a combination thereof, for example consists of a single metered
value (set to “Actual”), contains a single alarm indication (set to “Alarm”), or contains both a metered value and an alarm
indication (set to “Mixed”).
ALARM INPUT
Range: OFF, ON, any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
Select a trigger for the alarm, or the input signal connected to the alarm. For example, when set to "FIRST ETHERNET
FAIL" and the Ethernet cable connected to port 1 is removed, the alarm is triggered. (Note that when the Ethernet cable
is inserted into an SFP connector and the SFP connector is removed, the alarm is not triggered.) The field is read-only for
an actual value.
The selectable options are the FlexLogic operands specific to the product.
ALARM TYPE
Range: Acknowledgeable, Self Reset, Latched
Default: Acknowledgeable
Set the alarm type. The field is read-only for an actual value.
5 Acknowledgeable — Follow the state transitions, as outlined in the Annunciator section of the Interfaces chapter. The
alarm blinks until acknowledged, then remains on until the condition clears.
Self Reset — Track the state of the input operand. The alarm turns on when the trigger activates and off when the trigger
clears.
Latched — Alarm is on until acknowledged/reset individually or until the RESET button is pressed.
To acknowledge/reset/unlatch an alarm, use the arrow buttons on the graphical front panel and press the ENTER
button.
TEXT (LINE 1 to 3)
Range: up to 10 alphanumeric characters
Default:
The text that displays in the annunciator cell. Three lines can be displayed. Note that a specified metering value replaces
the text for the selected line. This means that a line can display text or be set to show an actual metered value. If the text
does not display it is because an actual metered value is over-riding it; change the line for the text or for the actual value.
TEXT COLOR
Range: 24-bit color selector
Default: White
The color to display for the three text or actual value lines specified.
BACK COLOR
Range: 24-bit color selector
Default: Red
The background color to display for any triggered cell, for example when an alarm is triggered.
ACTUAL (Configure)
Range: Configure
Default: Configure
The Configure button becomes active when the CONTENT field is set to "Actual" or "Mixed." The window specifies the
metering data to display.

5-38 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Parameter
Range: any FlexAnalog parameter
Default:
This setting selects a FlexAnalog parameter that specifies the metered value to display in the annunciator alarm.
Units
Range: up to eight alphanumeric characters
Default:
This setting specifies the units of measurement for the metered value and is populated based on the Parameter
selected. The field can be left blank when units of measure do not apply.
Scale Factor
Range: G Giga, M Mega, k Kilo, None
Default: None
This setting allows the user to specify the scaling factor for the metering units value. Options depend on the Parameter.
Multiplier
Range: -1000000 to 1000000
Default: 1.0
This setting allows the user to specify a multiplier for the metering parameter value. The multiplier must be in
compliance with the 32-bit floating-point format per IEEE 754, otherwise, the input value is represented as per the IEEE
standard. For example, 1234.56789 is represented as 1234.567871094, and 9876.54321 as 9876.54296875.
Number of Integers
Range: 1 to 12 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting specifies the number of integers in the displayed analog value. It can be used to provide for leading 5
character spacing of the display value.
For example, setting the number to 2 displays 00.000[V] and setting it to 3 displays 000.000[V].
Number of Decimals
Range: 0 to 10 in steps of 1
Default: 3
This setting specifies the number of decimal places in the displayed analog value. For example, setting the number to 1
displays 0.0 and setting it to 2 displays 0.00.
Display in Line
Range: 1, 2, 3
Default: 1
This setting specifies the line in the annunciator alarm window to display the metered value. The actual value replaces
the text for the selected line. For example, 2 means the value displays in line 2 of the text; any text configured to display
in that line does not display.

5.3.3.6 Configurable navigation


The path is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Configurable Navigation.
This feature allows FlexLogic operands to trigger page display on the graphical front panel. It consists of 64 setting pairs,
each with a condition and an activation page. The condition selects any FlexLogic operand. The activation page selects
any page available for the graphical front panel. The page opens whenever the selected operand transitions from Off to
On. The page remains open until rolling mode initiates, another trigger initiates from Configurable Navigation, or the Home
button is pressed.
Avoid selecting condition operands that are likely to operate simultaneously but activate different pages, as only one page
can be opened at a time. For example, do not select a single-line diagram page for breaker status open and select an
annunciator page for a trip alarm.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-39


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

In the example shown, failure of any of the three Ethernet ports triggers the Product Information page to display. With
unauthorized access (such as wrong password), IRIG-B clock failure, or breaker trouble, the Event Records display. When a
breaker opens, a single-line diagram displays. For the Ethernet and IRIG-B failure operation to work, these functions also
have been enabled under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Self Tests.
Figure 5-12: Configurable navigation editor

To use the feature, select a CONDITION, select an ACTIVATE PAGE, then save.
CONDITION

5 Range: OFF, ON, any FlexLogic operand


Default: OFF
Select the FlexLogic operand for the trigger. When it transitions from Off to On, it opens the page specified by the
ACTIVATE PAGE setting. The FlexLogic operands selectable depend on product. Select it from the drop-down list. Or click
or select the field and start typing to auto-fill. For example, typing F displays FIRST ETHERNET FAIL, while typing BR
displays the first breaker option.
ACTIVATE PAGE
Range: Product Information, SLD 1…5, Annunciator, Annunciator 1…8, Actual Values Phasors 1…6, Tabular 1…5, Event
Records, Targets
Default: Product Information
This setting specifies the page to display on the graphical front panel when the FlexLogic operand selected by its
CONDITON setting transitions from Off to On.
The "Annunciator" option without a page number specifies the first annunciator page in the following sequence:
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in alarm (fast flash)
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in ringback. Ringback is a "return alert."
Visual and audible signals are given when conditions return to normal, then the sequence returns to normal by
pushing the RESET button.
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in abnormal state
– Annunciator page 1
The Tabular option displays a configured actual values/metering page.
The Targets option displays error messages, such as wrong transceiver, similar to event record entries.

5.3.4 Clear relay records


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  CLEAR RELAY RECORDS
 CLEAR RELAY CLEAR FAULT REPORTS: Range: FlexLogic operand
 RECORDS  Off

5-40 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

CLEAR EVENT RECORDS: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CLEAR DATA LOGGER: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CLEAR ARC AMPS 1: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CLEAR ARC AMPS 2: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CLEAR DEMAND: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CLEAR ENERGY: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

RESET UNAUTH ACCESS: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CLEAR DIR I/O STATS: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off Visible only for units with Direct I/O module

RESET UNAUTH ACCESS — Resets the access restriction counter.


Selected records can be cleared from user-programmable conditions with FlexLogic operands. Assigning user-
programmable pushbuttons to clear specific records is a typical application for these commands. Since the F35 responds
to rising edges of the configured FlexLogic operands, they must be asserted for at least 50 ms to take effect.
Clearing records with user-programmable operands is not protected by the command password. However, user- 5
programmable pushbuttons are protected by the command password. Thus, if they are used to clear records, the user-
programmable pushbuttons can provide extra security if required.
For example, to assign user-programmable pushbutton 1 to clear demand records, apply the following settings.
1. Assign the clear demand function to pushbutton 1 by making the following change in the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP
 CLEAR RELAY RECORDS menu:
CLEAR DEMAND: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
2. Set the properties for user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS  PRODUCT
SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS  USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: “Self-reset”
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: “0.20 s”

5.3.5 Communications

5.3.5.1 Menu
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS
 COMMUNICATIONS  SERIAL PORTS See below
  

 NETWORK See page 5-42


 

 IPv4 ROUTE TABLE See page 5-48


 

 MODBUS PROTOCOL See page 5-51


 

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-41


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

 PROTOCOL See page 5-51


 

 DNP PROTOCOL See page 5-52


 

 DNP / IEC104 See page 5-55


  POINT LISTS

 IEC 61850 PROTOCOL Access in EnerVista


  See page 5-56

 WEB SERVER See page 5-138


  HTTP PROTOCOL

 TFTP PROTOCOL See page 5-139


 

 IEC 60870-5-104 See page 5-139


  PROTOCOL

 EGD PROTOCOL See page 5-141


 

 IEC103 See page 5-142


  PROTOCOL

 USB 2.0 PORT See page 5-147


 

5.3.5.2 Serial ports


5 SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  SERIAL PORTS
 SERIAL PORTS RS232 BAUD Range: 19200, 115200
  RATE: 115200

RS485 COM2 BAUD Range: 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200,
 RATE: 19200 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, 115200 bit/s

RS485 COM2 PARITY: Range: None, Odd, Even


 Even

RS485 COM2 RESPONSE Range: 0 to 1000 ms in steps of 10


 MIN TIME: 0 ms

The front RS232 port applies to enhanced and basic front panels.
RS232 BAUD RATE, RS485 COM2 BAUD RATE, and PARITY — The F35 is equipped with two independent serial communication
ports. The front panel RS232 port (USB port with graphical front panel) is intended for local use. The rear COM2 port is
RS485 and has settings for baud rate and parity. It is important that these parameters agree with the settings used on the
computer or other equipment that is connected to these ports. Any of these ports can be connected to a computer
running the EnerVista software, for example to download and upload setting files, view measured parameters, and
upgrade the relay firmware. A maximum of 32 relays can be daisy-chained and connected to a DCS, PLC, or computer
using the RS485 ports. If IEC 60870-103 is chosen as the protocol, valid baud rates are 9600 and 19200 bit/s, and valid
parity is Even.
RS485 COM2 RESPONSE MIN TIME — This setting specifies the minimum time before the rear RS485 port transmits after
receiving data from a host. This feature allows operation with hosts that hold the RS485 transmitter active for some time
after each transmission.

5.3.5.3 Ethernet network topology


The F35 has three Ethernet ports. Each Ethernet port must belong to a different network or subnetwork. Configure the IP
address and subnet to ensure that each port meets this requirement. Two subnets are different when the bitwise AND
operation performed between their respective IP address and mask produces a different result. Communication becomes
unpredictable when more than one port is configured to the same subnet.

5-42 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Example 1
IP1/Mask1: 10.1.1.2/255.255.255.0 (where LAN 1 is 10.1.1.x/255.255.255.0)
IP2/Mask2: 10.2.1.2/255.255.255.0 (where LAN2 is 10.2.1.x/255.255.255.0)
IP3/Mask3: 10.3.1.2/255.255.255.0 (where LAN3 is 10.3.1.x/255.255.255.0)

Example 2
IP1/Mask1: 10.1.1.2/255.0.0.0 (where LAN1 is 10.x.x.x/255.0.0.0)
IP2/Mask2: 11.1.1.2/255.0.0.0 (where LAN2 is 11.x.x.x/255.0.0.0)
IP3/Mask3: 12.1.1.2/255.0.0.0 (where LAN3 is 12.x.x.x/255.0.0.0)

Example 3 — Incorrect
IP1/Mask1: 10.1.1.2/255.0.0.0
IP2/Mask2: 10.2.1.2/255.0.0.0
IP3/Mask3: 10.3.1.2/255.0.0.0
This example is incorrect because the mask of 255.0.0.0 used for the three IP addresses makes them belong to the same
network of 10.x.x.x.

Single LAN, no redundancy


The topology shown in the following figure allows communications to SCADA, local configuration/monitoring through
EnerVista, and access to the public network shared on the same LAN. No redundancy is provided.
Figure 5-13: Network configuration for single LAN 5
Public Network

SCADA

EnerVista Software

LAN1

ML3000

P1
IP1/ P2 P3
MAC1
UR
859708A2.vsd

Multiple LANS, with redundancy


The following topology provides local configuration/monitoring through EnerVista software and access to the public
network shared on LAN1, to which port 1 (P1) is connected. There is no redundancy provided on LAN1. Communications to
SCADA is provided through LAN2. P2 and P3 are connected to LAN2, where P2 is the primary channel and P3 is the
redundant channel. In this configuration, P3 uses the IP and MAC addresses of P2.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-43


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-14: Multiple LANs, with redundancy

Public Network

SCADA
EnerVista Software

LAN1 LAN2
LAN2

ML3000
ML3000 ML3000

P1 P2 P3
IP1/ IP2/ IP2/
MAC1 MAC2 MAC2
Redundancy mode
UR
859709A4.vsd

5 Multiple LANS, no redundancy


The following topology provides local configuration/monitoring through EnerVista software on LAN1, to which port 1 (P1) is
connected, access to the public network on LAN2, to which port 2 (P2) is connected, and communications with SCADA on
LAN3, to which port 3 (P3) is connected. There is no redundancy.
Figure 5-15: Multiple LANS, no redundancy

Public Network

SCADA
EnerVista Software

LAN1 LAN2
LAN3

ML3000
ML3000 ML3000

P1 P2 P3
IP1/ IP2/ IP3/
MAC1 MAC2 MAC3

UR
859710A2.vsd

5-44 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

5.3.5.4 Network
As outlined in the previous section, when using more than one Ethernet port, configure each to belong to a different
network or subnet using the IP addresses and mask. Configure the network IP and subnet settings before configuring the
routing settings.
Follow the IP and subnet mask rules outlined in the Set IP Address in UR section of the Installation chapter.
To obtain a list of all port numbers used, for example for audit purposes, contact GE technical support with substantiating
information, such as the serial number and order code of your device.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  NETWORK 1(3)
 NETWORK PORT 1 PRT1 IP ADDRESS: Range: standard IPV4 address format
  127.0.0.1

PRT1 SUBNET IP MASK: Range: standard IPV4 address format


 255.0.0.0

PRT1 FUNCTION: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Enabled

 NETWORK PORT 2 PRT2 IP ADDRESS: Range: standard IPV4 address format


  127.0.0.1

PRT2 SUBNET IP MASK: Range: standard IPV4 address format


 255.0.0.0

PRT2 REDUNDANCY: Range: None, Failover, PRP


 None Range if no PRP license: None, Failover

 PRP MCST ADDR: Range: 01-15-4E-00-01-00 to 01-15-4E-00-01-FF 5


01154E000100

PRT2 FUNCTION: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Enabled

 NETWORK PORT 3 PRT3 IP ADDRESS: Range: standard IPV4 address format


  127.0.0.1

PRT3 SUBNET IP MASK: Range: standard IPV4 address format


 255.0.0.0

PRT3 FUNCTION: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Enabled

The IP addresses are used with the DNP, Modbus/TCP, IEC 61580, IEC 60870-5-104, TFTP, HTTP, and PRP protocols. PRP is
explained in its own section later.
Use the front panel to change these settings. When online, the EnerVista software can be used to enable/disable each port
only. In the Offline Window area, all settings can be changed except port 2 redundancy (depending on firmware version).
When using GOOSE, in failover or PRP mode, port 3 configuration in the CID file is ignored. The Port 3 ConnectedAP
elements has no meaning, as ports 2 and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask.
PRT1 (2 or 3) IP ADDRESS — This setting sets the port’s IPv4 address in standard IPV4 format. This setting is valid on port 3 if
port 2 REDUNDANCY is set to None.
PRT1 (2 or 3) SUBNET MASK — This setting sets the port’s IPv4 subnet mask in standard IPV4 format. This setting is valid on
port 3 if port 2 REDUNDANCY is set to None.
PRT1 (2 or 3) FUNCTION — This setting enable/disables network communication on the respective port. When the port
function is Disabled, the network traffic on this port is disabled. The PRT2 redundancy setting has no effect on this
functionality. The change takes effect upon relay restart.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-45


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

If you disable a port here that is used to communicate between the relay and the software, this can take down all
communication between the two. For example, an Ethernet connection set to the IP address of the relay can be disabled
and cannot be reached, even when pinging. The port needs to be re-enabled, IP and any gateway addresses need to be
checked, and the relay needs to be set to Programmed.
PRT2 REDUNDANCY — Determines if ports 2 and 3 operate in redundant or independent mode. If a license for PRP was
purchased, the options are None, Failover, and PRP. If a license for PRP was not purchased, the options are None and
Failover. In non-redundant mode (REDUNDANCY set to None), ports 2 and 3 operate independently with their own MAC, IP,
and mask addresses. If REDUNDANCY is set to Failover, the operation of ports 2 and 3 is as follows:
• Ports 2 and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask
• The configuration fields for IP address and mask on port 3 are hidden
• Port 3 is in standby mode and does not actively communicate on the Ethernet network but monitors its link to the
Multilink switch. If port 2 detects a problem with the link, communications is switched to Port 3. Port 3 is, in effect,
acting as a redundant or backup link to the network for port 2. Once port 2 detects that the link between itself and the
switch is good and that communication is healthy for five minutes, then switching back to port 2 is performed. The
delay in switching back ensures that rebooted switching devices connected to the F35, which signal their ports as
active prior to being completely functional, have time to completely initialize themselves and become active. Once
port 2 is active again, port 3 returns to standby mode.
If REDUNDANCY is set to PRP, the operation of ports 2 and 3 is as follows:
• Ports 2 and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask
• The configuration fields for IP address and mask on port 3 are overwritten with those from port 2. This is visible on the
front panel but not displayed in the EnerVista software.
• Port 2 MCST ADDRESS field is visible
• The port 2 PTP function still uses only port 2 and the port 3 PTP function still uses only port 3. The relay still
5 synchronizes to whichever port has the best master. When ports 2 and 3 see the same master, as is typically the case
for PRP networks, the port with the better connectivity is used.
Behavior for GOOSE messages is as follows:
• If REDUNDANCY is set to Failover or PRP, In order to transmit a GOOSE message on port 2, the CID file must be
configured to have the corresponding GSE element in both ConnectedAPs S2 and S3. In the EnerVista software, the
TxGOOSE PORT ASSIGNMENT needs to be "Ports-1,2,3" to transmit GOOSE on both ports 1 and 2, or "Ports-2,3" to have
GOOSE only on port 2, with failover/ PRP.
• If REDUNDANCY is set to PRP, the port 2 configured GOOSE message is simultaneously transmitted on ports 2 and 3
• If REDUNDANCY is set to failover and the port 2 link fails, then only the port 2 configured GOOSE message is transmitted
on port 3

The two ports must be connected to completely independent LANs with no single point of failure, such as common
power supplies that feed switches on both LANs.

For any changes to this setting to take effect, restart the unit.
PRT2 PRP MCST ADDR — This setting allows the user to change the multicast address used by the PRP supervision frames.
This setting is available if REDUNDANCY is set to PRP. All devices in the same PRP network need to have the same multicast
address. Choose an address that does not conflict with another multicast protocol.

5.3.5.5 Far-End Fault Indication (FEFI)


Since 100BASE-FX does not support Auto-Negotiation, a Far-End Fault Indication (FEFI) feature is included since UR 7 that
allows for detection of link failures.
The purpose of the Far-End Fault feature is to allow the stations on both ends of a pair of fibers to be informed when there
is a problem with one of the fibers. Without the Far-End Fault feature, it is impossible for a fiber interface to detect a
problem that affects only its transmit fiber.
When the Far-End Fault feature is supported, a loss of receive signal (link) causes the transmitter to generate a Far-End
Fault pattern in order to inform the device at the far end of the fiber pair that a fault has occurred.

5-46 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

When the local receiver again detects a signal, the local transmitter automatically returns to normal operation.
If a Far-End Fault pattern is received by a fiber interface that supports the Far-End Fault feature and it is enabled, it reacts
by dropping the link as if there were no signal at all.
If the receiving interface does not support the Far-End Fault feature or has it disabled, an incoming Far-End Fault pattern is
ignored.
It is strongly recommended to have switches used for substation automation that support the Far-End Fault feature,
especially when UR 7 redundancy Failover is selected for redundancy.

5.3.5.6 Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)

The F35 is provided with optional PRP capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time of
ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

The Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) defines a redundancy protocol for high availability in substation automation
networks. It applies to networks based on Ethernet technology (ISO/IEC 8802-3) and is based on the second edition (July
2012) of IEC 62439-3, clause 4.
PRP is designed to provide seamless recovery in case of a single failure in the network, by using a combination of LAN
duplication and frame duplication. Identical frames are sent on two completely independent networks that connect source
and destination. Under normal circumstances both frames reach the destination and one of them is sent up the OSI stack
to the destination application, while the second one is discarded. If an error occurs in one of the networks and traffic is
prevented from flowing on that path, connectivity is provided through the other network to ensure continuous
communication. Take care when designing the two LANs, so that no single point of failure (such as a common power
supply) is encountered, as such scenarios can bring down both LANs simultaneously.
Figure 5-16: Example of parallel redundant network 5

PRP uses specialized nodes called doubly attached nodes (DANPs) for handling the duplicated frames. DANP devices have
an additional module, called a Link Redundancy Entity (LRE). LRE is responsible for duplicating frames and adding the
specific PRP trailer when sending the frames out on the LAN, as well as making decisions on received frames as to which
one is sent up the OSI stack to the application layer and which one is discarded. LRE is responsible for making PRP
transparent to the higher layers of the stack.
In addition, there is a second type of specialized device used in PRP networks, called RedBox, with the role of connecting
Single Attached Nodes (SANs) to a redundant network.
UR relays implement the DANP functionality. The RedBox functionality is not implemented.
The original standard IEC 62439-3 (2010) was amended to align PRP with the High-availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR)
protocol. To achieve this, the original PRP was modified at the cost of losing compatibility with the PRP 2010 version. The
revised standard IEC 62439-3 (2012) is commonly referred to as PRP-1, while the original standard is PRP-0. The UR relays
support PRP-1.
The relay implements PRP on two of its Ethernet ports, specifically Ports 2 and 3 of the CPU module. Use the previous
section (network port configuration) to configure PRP.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-47


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

PRP is purchased as a separate option. If purchased (valid order code), PRP can be enabled in configuration through a
setting available on the network configuration menu, REDUNDANCY, which already has the capability of enabling failover
redundancy. The options on this setting must be changed to accommodate two types of redundancy: failover and PRP.
When REDUNDANCY is set to either failover or PRP, the ports dedicated for PRP (Ports 2 and 3) operate in redundant mode.
In this mode, Port 3 uses the MAC, IP address, and mask of Port 2.

5.3.5.7 IPv4 route table


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IPv4 ROUTE TABLE 1(6)
 IPv4 ROUTE TABLE  DEFAULT IPv4 ROUTE
  

 IPv4 NETWORK
  ROUTE 1

 IPv4 NETWORK
  ROUTE 6

A default route and up to six static routes can be configured.


The default route is used as the last choice when no other route towards a given destination is found.
 DEFAULT IPv4 ROUTE GATEWAY ADDRESS: Range: standard IPV4 unicast address format
  127.0.0.1

5  IPv4 NETWORK
 ROUTE 1  RT1 DESTINATION:
127.0.0.1
Range: standard IPV4 address format

RT1 NET MASK: Range: standard IPV4 subnet mask format


 255.0.0.0

RT1 GATEWAY: Range: standard IPV4 unicast address format


 127.0.0.1

Configure the network IP and subnet settings before configuring the routing settings.

Add and delete static routes


Host routes are not supported at present.
The routing table configuration is available on the serial port and front panel. This is a deliberate decision, to avoid loss of
connectivity when remotely configuring the F35.
By default, the value of the destination field is 127.0.0.1 for all static routes (1 to 6). This is equivalent to saying that the
static routes are not configured. When the destination address is 127.0.0.1, the mask and gateway also must be kept on
default values.
By default, the value of the route gateway address is 127.0.0.1. This means that the default route is not configured.
To add a route:
1. Use any of the static network route entries numbered 1 to 6 to configure a static network route. Once a route
destination is configured for any of the entries 1 to 6, that entry becomes a static route and it must meet all the rules
listed in the next section, General Conditions to be Satisfied by Static Routes.
2. To configure the default route, enter a default gateway address. Once a default gateway address is configured, it
must be validated against condition 2 of the General Conditions to be Satisfied by Static Routes, where the route
gateway must be on a connected network.
To delete a route:
1. Replace the route destination with the default loopback address of 127.0.0.1. When deleting a route, the mask and
gateway also must be brought back to default values.

5-48 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

2. Delete the default route by replacing the default gateway with the default value of 127.0.0.1.

General conditions to be satisfied by static routes


The following rules are validated internally:
• The route mask has IP mask format. In binary this needs to be a set of contiguous bits of 1 from left to right, followed
by one or more contiguous bits of 0.
• The route destination and mask must match. This can be verified by checking that
RtDestination and RtMask = RtDestination
Example of good configuration: RtDestination = 10.1.1.0; Rt Mask = 255.255.255.0
Example of bad configuration: RtDestination = 10.1.1.1; Rt Mask = 255.255.255.0
The following rules must be observed when you configure static routes:
• The route destination must not be a connected network
• The route gateway must be on a connected network. This rule applies to the gateway address of the default route as
well. This can be verified by checking that:
(RtGwy & Prt1Mask) == (Prt1IP & Prt1Mask) || (RtGwy & Prt2Mask) == (Prt2IP & Prt2Mask) || (RtGwy & Prt3Mask) == (Prt3IP
& Prt3Mask)
where
& is the bitwise-AND operator
== is the equality operator
|| is the logical OR operator

Routing behavior compared to previous releases


Prior to release 7.10, UR devices did not have an explicit manner of configuring routes. The only available route was the 5
default route configured as part of the network settings (port gateway IP address). This limited the ability to route to
specific destinations, particularly if these destinations were reachable through a different interface than the one on which
the default gateway was.
Starting with UR 7.10, up to six static network routes can be configured in addition to a default route. The default route
configuration was also moved from the network settings into the routing section.
The figure shows an example of topology that benefits from the addition of static routes.
Figure 5-17: Using static routes

Router1
Public network
.1

Router2
10.1.2.0/24 10.1.3.0/24
10.1.1.0/24
ML3000 ML3000 .1
EnerVista Software
P1 P2 P3
IP1/ IP2/ IP3/
.2 .2 MAC2 MAC3
MAC1

UR
859714A1.vsd

In the figure, the UR connects through the following two Ethernet ports:
• Port 1 (IP address 10.1.1.2) connects the UR to LAN 10.1.1.0/24 and to the Internet through Router1. Router1 has an
interface on 10.1.1.0/24 and the IP address of this interface is 10.1.1.1.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-49


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

• Port 2 (IP address 10.1.2.2) connects the UR to LAN 10.1.2.0/24 and to the EnerVista software through Router2. Router2
has an interface on 10.1.2.0/24 and the IP address of this interface is 10.1.2.1.
The configuration before release 7.10 was as follows:
• PRT1 IP ADDRESS = 10.1.1.2
PRT1 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
PRT1 GWY IP ADDRESS = 10.1.1.1
PRT2 IP ADDRESS = 10.1.2.2
PRT2 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
The behavior before release 7.10 was as follows. When sending packets to EnerVista, the UR noticed that the destination
was not on a connected network and it tried to find a route to destination. Since the default route was the only route it
knew, it used it. Yet EnerVista was on a private network, which was not reachable through Router1. Hence a destination
unreachable message was received from the router.
The configuration starting with release 7.10 is as follows:
• PRT1 IP ADDRESS = 10.1.1.2
PRT1 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
PRT2 IP ADDRESS = 10.1.2.2
PRT2 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
IPV4 DEFAULT ROUTE: GATEWAY ADDRESS = 10.1.1.1
STATIC NETWORK ROUTE 1: RT1 DESTINATION = 10.1.3.0/24; RT1 NET MASK = 255.255.255.0; and RT1 GATEWAY =
10.1.2.1
The behavior since release 7.10 is as follows. There is one added static network route to the destination 10.1.3.0/24, where
a computer running EnerVista is located. This static route uses a different gateway (10.1.2.1) than the default route. This
gateway is the address of Router2, which has knowledge about 10.1.3.0 and is able to route packets coming from the UR

5 and destined to EnerVista.

Show routes and ARP tables


This feature is available on the Web interface, where the main menu contains an additional Communications menu and
two submenus:
• Routing Table
• ARP Table
The tables outline the information displayed when the two submenus are selected.
Table 5-7: Routing table information
Field Description
Destination The IP address of the remote network to which this route points
Mask The network mask for the destination
Gateway The IP address of the next router to the remote network
Interface Interface through which the specified network can be reached

Table 5-8: IP ARP information


Field Description
IP Address The network address that corresponds to Hardware Address
Age (min) Age, in minutes, of the cache entry. A hyphen (-) means the address is local.
Hardware Address LAN hardware address, a MAC address that corresponds to network address
Type Dynamic or Static
Interface Interface to which this address mapping has been assigned

5-50 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

5.3.5.8 Modbus protocol


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  MODBUS PROTOCOL
 MODBUS PROTOCOL MODBUS SLAVE Range: 1 to 254 in steps of 1
  ADDRESS: 254

MODBUS TCP PORT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 NUMBER(502): 502

The serial communication ports utilize the Modbus protocol, unless the port is configured for DNP or IEC 60870-5-103
operation. This allows the EnerVista UR Setup software to be used on the port. UR devices operate as Modbus slave
devices only.
For more information on the protocol, including the memory map table, see the UR Family Communications Guide.
MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS — When using the Modbus protocol on the RS232 port, the F35 responds regardless of the
MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS programmed. For the RS485 port, each device on the serial bus must have a unique slave address
from 1 to 254. Address 0 and addresses from 248 and up are reserved by the Modbus protocol specification, and so their
use here is not recommended. Address 0 is the broadcast address to which all Modbus slave devices listen. Addresses do
not have to be sequential, but no two devices can have the same address or conflicts resulting in errors occur. Generally,
starting at 1, set each device added to the link to use the next higher address. When using Modbus TCP/IP, the client must
use the programmed MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS value in the Unit Identifier field.
MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER — Modbus over TCP/IP can also be used on any of the Ethernet ports. The listening TCP port 502
is reserved for Modbus communications, and only in exceptional cases when MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER is set to any other
port. The MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER setting sets the TCP port used by Modbus on Ethernet. A MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER of
0 disables Modbus over TCP/IP, meaning closes the Modbus TCP port. When the port number is changed to 0, the change
takes effect when the F35 is restarted. When it is set to 0, use the front panel or serial port to communicate with the relay.

Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
5
those protocols.

5.3.5.9 Protocol selection


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  PROTOCOL
 PROTOCOL SCADA PROTOCOL: Range: DNP 3.0, IEC 60870-5-104, IEC 60870-5-103
  DNP 3.0

MMS CONNECTION Range: 10 to 7200 in steps of 10


 TIMEOUT: 120 s

IEC61850 EDITION: Range: Edition1, Edition2


 Edition2

The PROTOCOL menu allows selection of one of the following protocols: DNP 3.0, IEC60870-104, or IEC60870-103.
SCADA PROTOCOL — This setting selects the SCADA protocol on which the unit communicates, among DNP3.0, IEC 60870-
104, and IEC 60870-103, with DNP being the default. Options depend on order code. For any change to take effect, restart
the unit.
MMS CONNECTION TIMEOUT — This setting specifies a time delay for the detection of network TCP connection lost. If there is
no data traffic on the TCP connection for greater than the time specified by this setting, the connection is terminated. This
frees up the connection to be re-used by a client. A setting of 10 seconds disables this timer. The TCP connection then is
managed by a standard TCP KeepAlive message sequence. These messages are transmitted every 20 seconds when there
is no MMS communication between the relay and the client. If there are no responses to the TCP KeepAlive messages, the
connection is closed. For any change to this setting to take effect, restart the unit. The change takes effect for a new
connection. For any existing open connection when the change is made, close and re-open the connection. Cycling power
to the relay also applies the new setting.
The table shows which of DNP 3.0, IEC 60870-5-104, IEC 60870-5-103, and IEC 61850 protocols are operational on the
RS232, RS485, and Ethernet ports. It shows all possible combinations of the PROTOCOL and DNP CHANNEL 1(2) PORT settings.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-51


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Table 5-9: Port and protocol combinations


PROTOCOL DNP CHANNEL 1(2) PORT RS232 RS485 Ethernet
setting settings
DNP Channel 1: Eth TCP Modbus Modbus DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: Eth TCP
Channel 1: Eth TCP Modbus Modbus DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: none
Channel 1: none Modbus Modbus DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: Eth TCP
Channel 1: Eth UDP Modbus Modbus DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: none
Channel 1: Eth TCP Modbus DNP DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: RS485
Channel 1: Eth TCP DNP Modbus DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: RS232
Channel 1: Eth UDP Modbus DNP DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: RS485
Channel 1: Eth UDP DNP Modbus DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: RS232
Channel 1: RS485 Modbus DNP DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: Eth TCP
Channel 1: RS232 DNP Modbus DNP, Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: Eth TCP
Channel 1: RS485 DNP DNP Modbus, IEC 61850
Channel 2: RS232

5 Channel 1: RS232
Channel 2: RS485
DNP DNP Modbus, IEC 61850

Channel 1: RS485 Modbus DNP Modbus, IEC 61850


Channel 2: none
IEC 104 Modbus Modbus IEC 104, Modbus, IEC 61850
IEC 103 Modbus IEC 103 Modbus, IEC 61850

IEC61850 EDITION — Switches between Editions 1 and 2 of the IEC 61850 protocol. Settings default with the change, except
GGIO1, GGIO2, GGIO4, and those for the graphical front panel. A message displays that a reboot is required, which can be
done using Maintenance > Reboot Relay Command.

5.3.5.10 DNP protocol


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  DNP PROTOCOL
 DNP PROTOCOL  DNP CHANNELS See below
  

DNP ADDRESS: Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 1

 DNP NETWORK See below


  CLIENT ADDRESSES

DNP TCP/UDP PORT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 NUMBER(20000): 20000

DNP UNSOL RESPONSE Range: Enabled, Disabled


 FUNCTION: Disabled

DNP UNSOL RESPONSE Range: 0 to 60 s in steps of 1


 TIMEOUT: 5 s

DNP UNSOL RESPONSE Range: 1 to 255 in steps of 1


 MAX RETRIES: 10

5-52 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

DNP UNSOL RESPONSE Range: 0 to 65519 in steps of 1


 DEST ADDRESS: 1

DNP CURRENT SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
 FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000

DNP VOLTAGE SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
 FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000

DNP POWER SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
 FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000

DNP ENERGY SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
 FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000

DNP PF SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
 FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000

DNP OTHER SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
 FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000

DNP CURRENT DEFAULT Range: 0 to 100000000 in steps of 1


 DEADBAND: 30000

DNP VOLTAGE DEFAULT Range: 0 to 100000000 in steps of 1


 DEADBAND: 30000

DNP POWER DEFAULT Range: 0 to 100000000 in steps of 1


 DEADBAND: 30000

DNP ENERGY DEFAULT Range: 0 to 100000000 in steps of 1


 DEADBAND: 30000

 DNP PF DEFAULT
DEADBAND: 30000
Range: 0 to 100000000 in steps of 1 5
DNP OTHER DEFAULT Range: 0 to 100000000 in steps of 1
 DEADBAND: 30000

DNP TIME SYNC IIN Range: 1 to 10080 min. in steps of 1


 PERIOD: 1440 min

DNP MESSAGE FRAGMENT Range: 30 to 2048 in steps of 1


 SIZE: 240

DNP OBJECT 1 Range: 1, 2


 DEFAULT VARIATION: 2

DNP OBJECT 2 Range: 1, 2, 3


 DEFAULT VARIATION: 2

DNP OBJECT 20 Range: 1, 2, 5, 6


 DEFAULT VARIATION: 1

DNP OBJECT 21 Range: 1, 2, 9, 10


 DEFAULT VARIATION: 1

DNP OBJECT 22 Range: 1, 2, 5, 6


 DEFAULT VARIATION: 1

DNP OBJECT 23 Range: 1, 2, 5, 6


 DEFAULT VARIATION: 1

DNP OBJECT 30 Range: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5


 DEFAULT VARIATION: 1

DNP OBJECT 32 Range: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7


 DEFAULT VARIATION: 1

DNP NUMBER OF PAIRED Range: 0 to 32 in steps of 1


 CONTROL POINTS: 0

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-53


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

DNP TCP CONNECTION Range: 10 to 7200 s in steps of 1


 TIMEOUT: 120 s

DNP EVENT TIME BASE: Range: UTC, LOCAL


 LOCAL

The Distributed Network Protocol (DNP) allows for the optimization of control and data acquisition between the equipment
in the substation and the central control center. The protocol is scalable; that is, it is designed to be compatible with the
latest high speed LAN technology yet still be implemented over slower speed serial links.
The DNP improves upon many master-slave protocols by improving overall communication performance requirements
and provides time-stamping with millisecond accuracy.
The F35 supports DNP version 3.0.
DNP is enabled when the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  PROTOCOL setting is set to DNP 3.0. The F35
can be used as a DNP slave device connected to multiple DNP masters (usually an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since
the F35 maintains two sets of DNP data change buffers and connection information, two DNP masters can actively
communicate with the F35 at one time.
DNP is not available using the USB port on the graphical front panel.
See the UR Family Communications Guide for more information on DNP.
The DNP Channels sub-menu is shown.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  DNP PROTOCOL  DNP CHANNELS
 DNP CHANNELS DNP CHANNEL 1 PORT: Range: NONE, COM1 - RS485, COM2 - RS485, FRONT
  NONE PANEL - RS232, NETWORK - TCP, NETWORK - UDP

DNP CHANNEL 2 PORT: Range: NONE, COM1 - RS485, COM2 - RS485, FRONT

5 NONE PANEL - RS232, NETWORK - TCP

The DNP CHANNEL 1 PORT and DNP CHANNEL 2 PORT settings select the communications port assigned to the DNP protocol
for each channel. Once DNP is assigned to a serial port, DNP is the only protocol running on that port; Modbus or IEC
60870-5-103 are disabled. If DNP is assigned to RS485, the protocol must be set to DNP on the serial port configuration as
well, for the change to take effect. When the DNP CHANNEL 1(2) PORT setting is set to “Network - TCP,” the channel 1(2) DNP
protocol can be used over TCP/IP on the Ethernet ports. When this value is set to “Network - UDP,” the DNP protocol can be
used over UDP/IP on channel 1 only. The "Front Panel - RS232" setting does not apply to the graphical front panel; when
selected the DNP client cannot establish a connection on a USB port.
For any change to take effect, restart the relay.

Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.

The DNP ADDRESS setting is the DNP slave address. This number identifies the F35 on a DNP communications link. Assign a
unique address to each DNP slave.

The F35 can specify a maximum of five clients for its DNP connections. These are IP addresses for the controllers to which
the F35 can connect. The settings follow.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  DNP PROTOCOL  DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESSES
 DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS 1: Range: standard IP address
 CLIENT ADDRESSES  0.0.0.0

CLIENT ADDRESS 5: Range: standard IP address
 0.0.0.0

The DNP TCP/UDP PORT NUMBER setting is for normal DNP operation. To close the port, set the port number to 0. The change
takes effect when the F35 is restarted.

5-54 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE FUNCTION is set to “Disabled” for RS485 applications since there is no collision avoidance
mechanism. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE TIMEOUT sets the time the F35 waits for a DNP master to confirm an unsolicited
response. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE MAX RETRIES setting determines the number of times the F35 retransmits an
unsolicited response without receiving confirmation from the master; a value of “255” allows infinite re-tries. The DNP
UNSOL RESPONSE DEST ADDRESS is the DNP address to which all unsolicited responses are sent. The IP address to which
solicited responses are sent is determined by the F35 from the current TCP connection or the most recent UDP message.
The DNP scale factor settings are numbers used to scale analog input point values. These settings group the F35 analog
input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other. Each setting represents the
scale factor for all analog input points of that type. For example, if the DNP VOLTAGE SCALE FACTOR setting is set to “1000,”
all DNP analog input points that are voltages are returned with values 1000 times smaller (for example, a value of 72000 V
on the F35 is returned as 72). These settings are useful when analog input values must be adjusted to fit within certain
ranges in DNP masters. Note that a scale factor of 0.1 is equivalent to a multiplier of 10 (that is, the value is 10 times larger).
The DNP DEFAULT DEADBAND settings determine when to trigger unsolicited responses containing analog input data. These
settings group the F35 analog input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other.
Each setting represents the default deadband value for all analog input points of that type. For example, to trigger
unsolicited responses from the F35 when any current values change by 15 A, the DNP CURRENT DEFAULT DEADBAND setting
is set to “15.” Note that these settings are the deadband default values. DNP object 34 points can be used to change
deadband values, from the default, for each individual DNP analog input point. For any change to take effect, restart the
relay. Whenever power is removed and re-applied to the F35, the default deadbands are in effect.
The DNP TIME SYNC IIN PERIOD setting determines how often the Need Time Internal Indication (IIN) bit is set by the F35.
Changing this time allows the DNP master to send time synchronization commands more or less often, as required.
The DNP MESSAGE FRAGMENT SIZE setting determines the size, in bytes, at which message fragmentation occurs. Large
fragment sizes allow for more efficient throughput; smaller fragment sizes cause more application layer confirmations to
be necessary, which provides more robust data transfer over noisy communication channels.
5
Check the “DNP Points Lists” F35 web page to view the analog inputs and/or binary inputs points lists. This page
can be viewed with a web browser by entering the IP address of the F35 Ethernet port employed to access the F35
Main Menu, then by clicking the Device Information Menu item, then the DNP Points Lists item.
The DNP OBJECT 1 DEFAULT VARIATION to DNP OBJECT 32 DEFAULT VARIATION settings select the DNP default variation
number for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32. The default variation refers to the variation response when variation
0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. See the DNP Implementation section in the UR Family Communications
Guide.
The DNP binary outputs typically map one-to-one to IED data points. That is, each DNP binary output controls a single
physical or virtual control point in an IED. In the F35 relay, DNP binary outputs are mapped to virtual inputs. However, some
legacy DNP implementations use a mapping of one DNP binary output to two physical or virtual control points to support
the concept of trip/close (for circuit breakers) or raise/lower (for tap changers) using a single control point. That is, the DNP
master can operate a single point for both trip and close, or raise and lower, operations. The F35 can be configured to
support paired control points, with each paired control point operating two virtual inputs. The DNP NUMBER OF PAIRED
CONTROL POINTS setting allows configuration of 0 to 32 binary output paired controls. Points not configured as paired
operate on a one-to-one basis.
The DNP TCP CONNECTION TIMEOUT setting specifies a time delay for the detection of dead network TCP connections. If
there is no data traffic on a DNP TCP connection for greater than the time specified by this setting, the connection is
aborted by the F35. This frees up the connection to be re-used by a client. For any change to take effect, restart the relay.

5.3.5.11 DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS
 DNP / IEC104  BINARY INPUT / MSP See below
 POINT LISTS   POINTS

 ANALOG INPUT / MME See below


  POINTS

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-55


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Up to 256 binary and up to 256 analog input points for the DNP protocol, or the MSP and MME points for IEC 60870-5-104
protocol, can be configured. The value for each point is user-programmable and can be configured by assigning FlexLogic
operands for binary inputs / MSP points or FlexAnalog parameters for analog inputs / MME points.
The menu for the binary input points (DNP) or MSP points (IEC 60870-5-104) follows.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS  BINARY INPUT / MSP POINTS
 BINARY INPUT / MSP Point: 0 Range: FlexLogic operand
 POINTS  Off

Point: 1 Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

Point: 255 Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

Up to 256 binary input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The points are configured by
assigning an appropriate FlexLogic operand. See the Introduction to FlexLogic section in this chapter for the range of
assignable operands.
Changes to the DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists take effect when the F35 is restarted.
The menu for the analog input points (DNP) or MME points (IEC 60870-5-104) follows.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS  ANALOG INPUT / MME
POINTS
 ANALOG INPUT / MME Point: 0 Range: any FlexAnalog parameter
 POINTS  Off

5  Point: 1
Off
Range: any FlexAnalog parameter


Point: 255 Range: any FlexAnalog parameter
 Off

Up to 256 analog input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The analog point list is
configured by assigning an appropriate FlexAnalog parameter to each point. See the FlexAnalog Parameters section in
Appendix A for the range of assignable parameters.
Changes to the DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists take effect when the F35 is restarted.

The DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists always begin with point 0 and end at the first “Off” value. Since DNP / IEC
60870-5-104 point lists must be in one continuous block, any points assigned after the first “Off” point are ignored.

5.3.5.12 IEC 61850 protocol

The F35 is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications. This feature is specified as a software option at
the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

The IEC 61850 settings are accessible in EnerVista software or a substation configuration language (SCL) generating tool.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 or Settings > IEC 61850. The settings are not
accessible from the front panel of the device.

IEC 61850 messaging can form part of protection schemes. Consider IEC 61850 settings with the same criticality as
protection element settings. To ensure reliable performance of protection schemes utilizing IEC 61850 messaging,
route IEC 61850 traffic on a separate port from SCADA communications, or use redundant, independent ports, and
a high-speed network recovery method, such as PRP.

5-56 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Overview
IEC 61850 is a series of international standards and technical reports applicable to power utility automation systems. It
includes semantics, abstract communication services, specific communication services, performance specifications,
network engineering guidelines, configuration description methodologies, and engineering processes. The standard
enables interoperability among intelligent electronic devices (IEDs) from different suppliers and interoperability among
software configuration tools from different suppliers. Interoperability in this case is the ability for IEDs to operate on the
same network or communication path sharing information and commands, and for configuration tools to understand
each other's configuration files.
The UR family supports a large subset of IEC 61850 features. These are detailed in the UR Family Communications Guide
and include the information model, GOOSE publish, GOOSE subscribe, buffered report server, unbuffered report server, and
Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) query, read, write, and control services. In addition, the URs and their
EnerVista UR Setup software support IEC 61850 Substation Configuration Language (SCL) file import/export and merging.
Many settings of UR protection, control, and monitoring elements, that is to say elements that are not concerned with the
IEC 61850 protocol, can nevertheless be accessed via IEC 61850. These settings are documented elsewhere in this Settings
chapter. This section of the Settings chapter deals solely with the settings that configure the IEC 61850 protocol itself.
The maximum number of simultaneous clients supported by the UR family is five.

IEC 61850 Editions 1 and 2


This release supports IEC 61850 Edition 1 and Edition 2. The default is Edition 2.
Select IEC 61850 Edition 1 or Edition 2 under Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Protocol. Switching defaults
the IEC 61850 settings, except GGIO1, GGIO2, GGIO4, and those for the graphical front panel. A message displays that a
reboot is required, which can be done using Maintenance > Reboot Relay Command.
Edition 2.0 is used with certain modifications according to IEC/TR 61850-90-5. Only edition 2.0 61850 configuration tools
can interoperate with edition 2.0 devices, such as the UR 7.3x, 7.4x, or 7.6x release. When using Edition 2, the UR release 5
uses edition 2.0 SCL, which differs from edition 1.0 SCL. GSSE, fixed GOOSE, and fixed report services of Edition 1 are not
supported in Edition 2, and thus UR devices using these features have to be converted to configurable GOOSE to
communicate with a 7.3x, 7.4x, or 7.6x device.
When set to Edition 1
• The Test Flag in the Tx GOOSE message header is set to TRUE when the TEST MODE FUNCTION is set to Forcible or
Isolated
• The test flag in the received GOOSE message header is not validated
• Routable GOOSE is not supported
• The FlexLogic category does not display in the IEC 61850 panels in the EnerVista UR Setup software
• With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must match one IP address of the device,
while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must match
The fields that display in the software depend on the Edition selected and the F35. Differences are noted in the sections
that follow. If required, consult the Model Implementation Conformance Statement (MICS) section of the UR Family
Communications Guide to understand what applies to your setup.

EnerVista setup for IEC 61850


The EnerVista UR Setup software provides the interface to configure F35 settings for the IEC 61850 protocol. This section
describes this interface. The software also supports import/export and merging of IEC 61850 Substation Configuration
Language (SCL) files as documented in the UR Family Communications Guide.
The IEC 61850 protocol configuration settings cannot be accessed through the UR front panel and are instead accessible
with the EnerVista software, via MMS query, read, and write services, or via 61850 SCL file transfer. Accordingly, whereas
other settings are presented in this manual as they appear on the front panel, IEC 61850 settings are presented as they
appear in the software. See the UR Family Communications Guide for MMS and SCL access. Note that if you update the IEC
61850 settings in the EnerVista software by writing to them by MMS while the corresponding IEC 61850 panel is open in
EnerVista, you need to close then open the panel in EnerVista for the correct readings to display.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-57


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

IEC 61850 protocol configuration settings are accessed through software panels that are selected either in the Online
Window area (see figure) or the Offline Window area in the EnerVista software.
The EnerVista software also includes an interface that is compatible with firmware versions 5.0 to 7.2 to configure
subscribers. Use the Simplified GOOSE Configurator in the Offline Window area.
Figure 5-18: IEC 61850 protocol panel in EnerVista software (Edition 2)

5 The IEC 61850 window is divided into a navigation pane on the left and a settings panel on the right. You expand and click
an option on the left to display its panel on the right. The following figure shows an example for Server Configuration. The
SETTING column contains the names of the settings, and the PARAMETER column is used to enter the settings. Hovering
the mouse over a setting name displays a tool-tip showing the 61850 information model name of the setting or its location
in SCL files.
Figure 5-19: IEC 61850 panel (Edition 2)

Opening the IEC 61850 window while online causes the UR Setup software to retrieve and import an SCL file from the F35.
This System Configuration Description (SCD) file contains all the settings in the UR at the time of the file request, both those
that are mapped into the IEC 61850 information model (that is, the "public" sections) and those that are not in the model

5-58 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

(that is, the "private" section). The UR EnerVista Setup software imports all of these settings into the current session, not just
those in the IEC 61850 window. To avoid loss of any unsaved setting changes made in other panels during the current
session, all other panels for the F35 must be closed before the IEC 61850 panel can be opened, and the software prompts
for this when applicable. Panels for other devices can be open concurrently to facilitate parameter coordination.
When CyberSentry security is enabled, editable settings depend on the user role logged in. For example, an Administrator
and Engineer can change settings. If prompted for a "Settings password," it means the Administrator or Engineer
password.
The Restore button restores settings in the window to their last saved values. The Default button reverts settings in the
window to factory default values or Oscillography, Data Logger, or FlexLogic Equation Editor pre-configured values. The
Reset button reverts all IEC 61850 settings to the factory default values, not just the current window. (In other settings
windows, the button reverts settings in the window to factory default values.)
When a setting is enabled, its panel continues to read Disabled until relaunched. There is no polling capability to update
automatically the IEC 61850 readings, so the panel needs to be closed then opened for the correct status to display. Good
practice is to close any panel not in use because changes being made by other users too are reflected only upon relaunch
of the panel.
Some of the IEC 61850 settings use floating point data, which guarantees accurate representation of real numbers up to
seven digits. Numbers with more than seven digits are approximated within a certain precision. This can result in
differences between what is entered and what is saved, and for example results in differences shown on a settings
comparison report.

Create CID and settings files


When the Save button is clicked in the online IEC 61850 window, UR Setup software prepares a configured IED description
(CID) file containing all the settings of the UR and sends the CID file to the F35. Upon receipt, the F35 checks the CID file for
correctness, going out of service, then back into service when the CID file is accepted. The software displays a message
when the F35 is running the new settings, confirming successful transfer. This process can take a minute or so due to the 5
amount of processing required by the software and the F35.
When the Save button is clicked in the offline IEC 61850 window, UR Setup software saves to local storage, for example the
hard drive, a .urs file containing all settings of the UR.

View IID/CID files


The file types are described as follows:
• IID — Instantiated IED capability description file — Actual settings on UR
• CID — Configured IED description file — Settings sent to the UR (may or may not contain the present settings)
The IID file type applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2 only.
IID and CID files are viewable. For example, after modifying settings in the IEC 61850 panels and clicking Developer IID/
CID Viewer in the software, a CID file generates and an SCL Viewer shows the updated CID file content. There are no edit
or save functions; use instead the Back Up and Restore Settings instructions later in this document to save the files.
Searches are case insensitive.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-59


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-20: View CID settings file (Edition 2)

Server configuration
The Server Configuration panel contains IEC 61850 settings relevant to the server functions of the IED implementation.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Server Configuration.
The following settings are available, where <iedName> is a syntactic variable representing the present value of the IED
NAME setting.
5 IED NAME
Range: 1 to 58 VisibleString characters
Default: TEMPLATE
The value entered sets the IED name used by IEC 61850 for the F35. An IED name unique within the network must be
entered for proper operation. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character.
The first character must be a letter.
The IED NAME and the Product LD inst name comprise the <LDName> for a product. The longest LD inst are "Master"
and "System" at six characters, with Master being fixed and the others configurable with the configurable Logical device
feature. So the IED NAME needs to be restricted to 58 characters to meet a 64 character limit.
Access Point
Range: S1, S2, S3
Default: S1
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 1. It is the subnetwork.
Location
Range: 0 to 255 ASCII characters
Default: Location
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.location. This data attribute is
provided by the protocol to allow the user to declare where the equipment is installed.
Latitude
Range: -90.000 to 90.000 degrees in steps of 0.001 degree
Default: 0.000 deg
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.latitude. This data attribute is provided
by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates -latitude. Negative values
indicate a southern latitude. WGS refers to the world geodetic system, which is used in global positioning systems (GPS),
and 84 is the current version of the standard.

5-60 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Longitude
Range: -180.000 to 180.000 degrees in steps of 0.001 degree
Default: 0.000 deg
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.longitude. This data attribute is
provided by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates -longitude. Negative
values indicate a western longitude.
Altitude
Range: 0 to 10,0000 m in steps of 1 m
Default: 0 m
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.altitude. This data attribute is provided
by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates - altitude.
Prefix for GGIO1
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 11 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 6 VisibleString characters
Default:
This setting sets the LN Prefix of the FlexLogic operand interface logical node GGIO1 that is described in the GGIO1
section later. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first
character must be a letter. UR Setup software does not allow entry of a prefix that duplicates any other GGIO1 prefix
that is used by the product, such as ConIn and ConOut.
Prefix for GGIO2
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 11 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 6 VisibleString characters
Default:
This setting sets the LN Prefix of the Virtual Inputs Interface logical node GGIO2 that is described in the GGIO2 section
5
later. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first character must
be a letter. UR Setup software does not allow entry of a prefix that duplicates any other GGIO2 prefix that is used by the
product.
Prefix for GGIO4
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 11 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 6 VisibleString characters
Default:
This setting sets the LN Prefix of the FlexAnalog operand interface logical node GGIO4 that is described in the GGIO4
section later. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first
character must be a letter. UR Setup software does not allow entry of a prefix that duplicates any other GGIO4 prefix
that is used by the product.
LLN0.Mod.ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: sbo-with-normal-security
This setting specifies the control service that clients must use to control the TEST MODE FUNCTION of the F35. An "on"
control to <LDName>/LLN0.Mod changes TEST MODE FUNCTION to Disabled, an "on-blocked" control changes it to
Forcible, and a "test/blocked" changes it to Isolated.
Configuration Type
Range: G2, E3-2.0
Default: G2
This setting is read only. It specifies the method used to describe GOOSE subscription configuration in SCL. See the UR
Family Communications Guide for details. In the G2 mode, the CID file contains IED elements for IEDs subscribed to by
this IED containing GOOSE subscription information. In the E3 2.0 mode, the CID file has only one IED element and
GOOSE subscription information is coded in data objects in the standard LGOS logical node used to monitor reception of

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-61


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

the subscribed GOOSE. UR 7.30 or later accepts either mode. The set value is for the entire EnerVista installation and is
preserved between sessions. To change this global field, click File > Preferences and access the IEC 61850 panel; you do
not need to be connected to the device.

Logical devices
The Logical Devices panel contains IEC 61850 settings relevant to the configurable logical devices feature, wherein logical
device naming can be reconfigured and logical nodes re-assigned.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Logical Devices.
Figure 5-21: Default IEC 61850 Logical Devices panel with devices middle and nodes right (Edition 2)

5
To configure logical devices and nodes:
1. Right-click an entry and edit an existing device, add a new one, or move a logical node. The rest of this section
explains the window and how to perform these actions.

The default logical device categories are as follows:


• Master — Communications, including GOOSE, reports, Remote I/O, Virtual Inputs, Modbus, DNP, and setting group
control
• System — Power system devices: breakers, switches, CTs, VTs, and so on, including interfaces to these, such as AC
inputs, contact I/O, transducer I/O, HardFiber I/O
• Prot — Protection and protection-related functions
• Ctrl — Control and monitoring functions
• Meter — Metering and measurement functions
• Gen — FlexLogic, Virtual Outputs, non-volatile latches, FlexElements, recording (for example oscillography), security,
front panel, clock
For the Master logical device, the following logical nodes have fixed assignment:
• The LLN0 in the Master logical device, which includes setting group, GOOSE and report control blocks, and datasets
• LPHD1 — Models common issues for physical devices
• GGIO1 — For unmapped FlexLogic operands
• GGIO2 — For Virtual Input control
• GGIO3 — For RxGOOSE Inputs
• GGIO4 — For unmapped FlexAnalog operands
• LGOS logical nodes — For GOOSE subscription

5-62 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The Logical Devices panel has middle and right panes. The middle pane has a list of the instantiated logical devices in the
sequence that they appear in SCL, with one device selected. The right pane has a list of the logical nodes presently
assigned to the selected logical device in lexicographic order by logical node name.
In the middle pane logical devices are shown with their product-related name, followed in brackets by their function-
related ldName, and followed by the value of their confRev. In the following example, by right-clicking and editing, the
Protection logical device has been set to instance name "Prot", the function-related name "Feeder1Prot" and the
configuration revision "2016-03-07 08:46." The text is clipped on the right if the line is longer than the available width. The
next paragraphs explain how to do this setup.
Figure 5-22: Protection logical node selected

5
Right-clicking a logical device displays the menu that allows insertion of a new logical device immediately below the
selected one, deletion of the selected logical device, or editing the selected logical device's parameters. The insert option is
disabled and greyed-out if there are already 16 logical devices instantiated. The delete option is disabled and greyed-out if
the selected logical device is Master or it contains any logical nodes other than LLN0.
Figure 5-23: Menu for logical node

If the insert option is selected, or the edit option is selected for other than the Master logical device, a logical device
parameters edit dialog opens.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-63


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-24: Insert new logical node (Edition 2)

If the edit option is selected for the Master logical device, the Product LD inst name setting is not editable.
Figure 5-25: Edit logical node

When the Ok button is clicked, the entered values for Product LD inst name and Functional ldName are checked for
uniqueness within the UR, and they are updated in the pane.

The settings are explained as follows, where <iedName> is a syntactic variable representing the present value of the IED
NAME setting. When adding or editing a logical device entry, these are the fields that need to be completed.

Customized logical nodes are not saved in the URS file.

Product LD inst name


Range: 1 to 64 VisibleString characters
Default: as per the following table
Each logical device has this setting. The value is fixed at "Master" in the first logical device and configurable in all others.
Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first character must be a
letter. The entered value sets the logical device inst name. Each logical device inst name is required to be unique within
the device, and it cannot be blank. Also, if the corresponding functional ldName setting is blank, the concatenation of the

5-64 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

IED name and the logical device inst name must form an LDName that is unique within the network for proper operation.
It is recommended that the length of the IED NAME plus the length of this setting be not greater than 64 to respect the
requirements of IEC 61850 7 2:2010 22.2 for LDName.
The factory default configuration is for six logical devices with Product LD inst name settings and logical node
assignments as per the following table.
Table 5-10: Factory default logical nodes
Default logical Contains logical nodes modeling...
device inst name
Master communications, including GOOSE, reports, Remote I/O, Virtual Inputs, Modbus, DNP, and so on.
(root logical device; Setting group control.
name is fixed) This is the root logical device.
To comply with IEC 61850 7 1 Ed2 clause 6.4.5.1, all group L logical nodes (logical nodes with class names
begin with "L"), except LLN0, belonging to this IED are in this logical device.
Protection (Prot) protection functions
Control (Ctrl) control and monitoring functions
System power system devices: breakers, switches, CTs, VTs, and so on, including interface to these such as AC inputs,
contact I/O, transducer I/O, HardFiber I/O
Metering (Meter) metering and measurement, including Signal Sources
General (Gen) FlexLogic, virtual outputs, non-volatile latches, FlexElements, FlexMath, recording (for example oscillography),
security, front panel, clock

Functional ldName
Range: 0 to 64 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
Each logical device has this setting. The value is configurable in all logical devices. Valid characters are upper and
lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. If the number of characters entered is greater than zero, the
5
setting sets the value of the function-related name used in communications. If an ldName is entered, it must form an
LDName that is unique within the network for proper operation. The standard recommends choosing this name
according to IEC 81346-1. If the number of characters entered is zero, no function-related name is defined.

Throughout the remainder of this IEC 61850 section, <LDName> is a syntactic variable representing the present
LDName of the master logical device. In other contexts LDName can refer to some other logical device. Depending
on its context, <LDName> can be a product-related name or a function-related name.
configRev
Range: 0 to 255 ASCII characters
Default:
This data attribute is provided by the protocol to declare changes to the semantic of the data model of the UR. The intent
is that the user changes Master configRev each time that the semantic or data model changes, so that clients can
readily detect the change. A semantic change is a logical node getting a new semantic use; for example, an instance of
logical node CSWI is now serving a different physical switch, or an instance of a logical node PDIS is now used for
another zone. A data model change is a change in the presence of logical nodes, data objects, data attributes, or
instance names.
The scope of Maser configRev is the entire relay configuration, as the Master logical device is the root logical device.
Similar settings are provided for the other logical nodes; the scope of these other configRev settings is limited to the
corresponding logical device configuration.
paramRev
Range: -2,147,483,648 to 2,147,483,647
Default: 0
The configurable data attribute paramRev has a scope that includes the entire device, and thus is modified whenever
any setting in the device changes. The UR increments the value of paramRev by one whenever one or multiple setting
changes occurs in one Modbus write request by any means (front panel, Modbus, or MMS) other than by SCL file

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-65


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

download. Incrementing occurs whether or not the setting is represented in the information model. When a UR device or
EnerVista UR Setup accepts an SCL file, paramRev is set to the value in that SCL file. When EnerVista UR Setup changes
one or more settings, and prepares an SCL file, it increments paramRev to the next higher multiple of 10 000.

Each logical device has a name: LDName. (Note the upper case LD.) LDName has both a product-related form and
a function-related form as per IEC 61850 6:2009 8.5.3.
SCL files invariably use the product-related form of LDName. The product-related form is the concatenation of the
IED name of the device and the individual logical device's inst name. The IED name is the value of the "IED NAME"
setting on the Server Configuration panel, and the logical device inst names are each the value of the
corresponding "Product LD inst name" setting here. The "Product LD inst name" of the first logical device is fixed at
"Master".
Communications use the function-related form of LDName if a function-related name is defined, otherwise
communications use the product-related name. The function-related name is the value of the corresponding
"Functional ldName" setting if this setting is not empty, if empty the function-related name is not defined.
In SCL, the function-related name is specified by the LDevice element attribute ldName (note the lower case ld).
Absence of this attribute indicates the function-related name is not defined. In SCL the product-related name is
specified by the name attribute of the IED element and the inst attribute of the LDevice element.
In the right pane, logical nodes assigned permanently to the Master logical device and LLN0 in all logical devices are
greyed-out as shown earlier. These are not movable. Any other logical node can be dragged to any of the logical devices in
the middle pane, which causes that logical device to be re-assigned to that logical device. Right-clicking a logical node
device displays a menu that lists the logical devices that this logical node can be moved to. Clicking one of these re-assigns
the logical node. Other common keyboard and/or mouse action can be used to select one or more logical nodes and move
the selected nodes together.

5 Figure 5-26: Move logical node (Edition2)

GOOSE
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE.

Support for Routable GOOSE


Routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE) is supported in firmware release 7.4 and later for IEC 61850 Edition 2. Routable GOOSE allows
UR and other devices to be located in separate networks. Encryption/decryption of messages is performed by a separate
gateway device. Messages are routed using a separate router, using IP addresses.
Note the following behavior:
• A v7.4 device can send an R-GOOSE message to another v7.4 device when both have R-GOOSE active as the protocol
• A v7.4 device can send a GOOSE message to another v7.4 device when both have GOOSE active as the protocol

5-66 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

• A v7.4 device cannot send an R-GOOSE message to non-R-GOOSE devices, such as v7.3 or v5.9 UR device
• UR devices with firmware below v7.3 can send a GOOSE message to a v7.4 device that has GOOSE as the active
protocol

R-GOOSE is available through the IEC 61850 software option. If R-GOOSE security is required, the CyberSentry
software option also must be purchased.

TxGOOSE
IEC 61850 GOOSE is an efficient method for simultaneous high-speed delivery of generic substation event information by a
publishing device to more than one subscribing device. A TxGOOSE is a UR element implementing a single IEC 61850
GOOSE message publishing service. The subscribing function in URs is performed by RxGOOSE elements, as described in
the next section. Each UR with IEC 61850 order code options has 16 TxGOOSE elements. Each TxGOOSE can either use the
original format specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 or the routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE; IEC 61850 Edition 2) format specified in
IEC TR 61850-90-5:2012. Each TxGOOSE element can publish the values of up to 64 attributes of the IEC 61850 nodes in the
UR.
Published TxGOOSE messages configured in the EnerVista UR Setup software can be subscribed by and the published
operand values understood by other UR devices. Furthermore, they can be subscribed to and understood by any device of
any manufacturer that implements the IEC 61850 edition 1.0 or 2.0 GOOSE subscription mechanism. The messages are
published with a multicast address so that the network sends the messages to all devices; any number of devices that
want to subscribe can.
For wide area protection, control, and monitoring schemes, R-GOOSE wraps the proven original format GOOSE in IP/UDP to
multicast (or unicast) the data over a Wide Area Network (WAN). Sample applications are Wide area Remedial Action
Scheme (RAS) and Under Voltage/ Frequency Load Shedding Schemes (UVLS/UFLS). R GOOSE uses IGMPv3 (Internet Group 5
Management Protocol version-3, RFC 3376) for multicasting.
The entities whose values are published in GOOSE messages are known as members. The members are itemized in an
ordered list known as a data set. Each TxGOOSE can use any one of the configured data sets. (See the DataSets section
later for details.) The performance of a TxGOOSE is determined by its dataset. Booleans in fast GOOSE datasets are
designed for the TT6 transfer time class (3 ms), while Booleans in the Normal datasets are designed for the TT3 class (100
ms). Due to the significant amount of CPU time required to compose a TT6 TxGOOSE message and the limited amount of
time allowed by the TT6 class, at most four of these can be configured in a given UR. So only four fast GOOSE are allowed
to be configured, and the UR software has a check to disallow the use of more than four fast datasets in GOOSE. If six fast
datasets are configured outside of UR software and the file sent directly to the relay, the relay rejects the file. The design
does allow six fast datasets to be used in report control blocks, which allows fast scanned data in reports.
Each enabled TxGOOSE transmits its message whenever a value change is detected in one or more of its members. If the
changed value is a Boolean in a fast dataset, then the change detect occurs in the TT6 detection time of 3 ms or less. If the
member is an analog value in a fast dataset, the change detect occurs in theTT3 time of 100 ms. In Normal GOOSE
Datasets, change detection for all dataset members occurs in the TT3 time of 100 ms. To guard against the possibility that
such a message is lost in the network before it reaches all subscribers, the message is quickly retransmitted several times.
To allow subscribers to verify that their link to the publisher and the publisher itself are healthy, each message is also
retransmitted periodically even while the values are unchanging. These latter messages are known as heartbeat
messages, while the former are known as event messages. Heartbeat messages also provide means for a subscriber
newly online to receive the published values in the absence of an event.
The details of TxGOOSE message construction are contained in the UR Family Communications Guide. Knowledge of these
details is not required to configure GOOSE.
The UR does not implement the Fixed-Length encoded GOOSE messages option specified in IEC 61850-8-1:2011 clause
A.3; the UR always uses the ASN.1 Basic encoding rules (as specified in ISO/IEC 8825-1) as specified in IEC 61850 edition 1.0
and as optional in IEC 61850 edition 2.0.

Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > TxGOOSE > TxGOOSE1 to access the
settings for the first TxGOOSE. The settings and functionality for the others are similar.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-67


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-27: IEC 61850 TxGOOSE panel (Edition 2)

5
A data set needs to be set up and selected in the TxGOOSEx DatSet field for all content to display.
When saving changes, when a "dataset member is empty" message displays, you need to set the member in the bottom
right of the window.
TxGOOSE1 MODE
Range for Edition 2: Disabled, GOOSE, R-GOOSE
Range for Edition 1: Disabled, GOOSE
Default: Disabled
When set to Disabled, TxGOOSE1 messages are not published. When set to GOOSE, TxGOOSE1 messages are published
in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 GOOSE format. When set to R-GOOSE, TxGOOSE1 messages are published in Routable GOOSE
format according to IEC 61850 90-5, and the TxGOOSE1 DST MAC address is set to 00 00 00 00 00 00 and cannot be
changed.
TxGOOSE1 GoCB name
Range: 0 up to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: GoCB01
The entered value sets the GOOSE control block (GoCB) name value for TxGOOSE1.
An ObjectReference to the control block, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0." and the
control block name, is published in the gocbRef field of TxGOOSE1 messages and is used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. <LDName> is a syntactic variable that is set to the value of setting
Master functional ldName if one or more characters have been entered to that setting, otherwise the value of setting IED
NAME suffixed with "Master".

5-68 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

TxGOOSE1 GoID
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 65 VisibleString characters
Default: TxGOOSE1
The entered value sets the goID value published in TxGOOSE1 messages, and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
the TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. Special characters are not allowed, such as <, >, &, ’, and ".
TxGOOSE1 DatSet
Range: None, TT6DataSet1,TT6 DataSet2, … TT3DataSet01,TT3 DataSet02, …
Default: None
This setting selects the published data set using the UR Setup software designator for the data set. If None is selected,
no TxGOOSE1 messages are sent.
The IEC 61850 name of the data sets are configured in the Datasets panel, as described later.
Some datasets are designed for the TT6 transfer time class (3 ms), while others are designed for the TT3 class (100 ms).
The performance of a TxGOOSE is determined by its dataset. Use TT6 datasets for trips and blocking applications, TT3
datasets for slow automatic interactions. The 61850 name of the datasets are configured in the Datasets panel.
An ObjectReference to the data set, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0." and the data
set name, is published in the datSet field of TxGOOSE1 messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. <LDName> is a syntactic variable that is set to the value of setting
Master functional ldName if one or more characters have been entered to that setting, otherwise the value of setting IED
NAME suffixed with "Master".
To configure a DataSet, select it at the top of the window from the drop-down list. In the lower part of the window, drag
and drop configuration items to the right side. Dataset members configured here affect other Report or TxGOOSE
control blocks that use the same DataSet.
The performance of the TxGOOSE is determined by the performance of the selected dataset. When the selection is 5
TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, … it is possible that transient events can be missed.
TxGOOSE1 DST MAC
Range: any 12 digit hexadecimal number
Default: 01-0C-CD-01-00-00
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is R-GOOSE, the TxGOOSE1 DST MAC address is set to 00 00 00 00 00 00 and cannot be
changed. Otherwise, the value entered here sets the Ethernet destination Media Access Control (MAC) address in
published TxGOOSE1 messages. As the standard requires that the address have the multicast bit set TRUE, that is to say
the second digit is set to an odd number, messages transmitted have the multicast bit set TRUE no matter its value in
this setting.
The destination MAC address can be used by the network to restrict message delivery to selected devices that need to
receive them, reducing network load. This address also can be used by hardware in receiving devices to filter out
messages that are of no interest to them, reducing processor burden. Different filtering algorithms are implemented by
different devices. The standard recommends that the algorithm used by hardware of the receiving device be considered
when assigning destination multicast addresses.
Subscribers can use this address to discriminate TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages.
TxGOOSE1 VLAN PRIORITY
Range: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 5-4, 6-4, 6-5, 7-4, 7-5, 7-6
Default: 4
When the value entered is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7, the User Priority value in the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN tag included in published
TxGOOSE1 messages is set to that value. When one of the two-digit values is entered, the dynamic priority feature is
selected: the first event message has the User Priority value of the first digit, and User Priority is decremented in each
following message until reaching the value of the second digit. For instance, if the selected value is 7-5, then the User
Priority values in successive messages beginning with the message triggered by an event is 7, 6, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, and so on.
Do not make a dynamic priority selection when standard behavior is required.
Network devices can forward a message with a higher priority value before a message with a lower priority value, which
speeds delivery of high-priority messages in heavily loaded networks. The standard recommends that higher-priority
messages, such as GOOSE, have priority values in the range of 4 to 7.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-69


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

TxGOOSE1 VLAN ID
Range: 0 to 4095 in steps of 1
Default: 0
The value entered sets the VID value in the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN tag included in published TxGOOSE1 messages. VID can be
used by network devices to direct messages to only selected devices, reducing network burden. VID values of 0 and 1
are assigned by IEEE 802.1Q to other functions and are not to be used for GOOSE.
TxGOOSE1 ETYPE APPID
Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
Default: 0
The value entered sets the APPID value in published GOOSE messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages.
The standard reserves the value range 0 to 16383 for GOOSE Type 1 (Fast messages), and reserves the value range
32768 to 41151 for GOOSE Type 1A (Trip messages). Some subscribers can process messages in the Type 1A range
faster than messages in the Type 1 range. The standard reserves the default value (0) to indicate lack of configuration.
The standard strongly recommends unique, source-orientated APPIDs within a given system.
TxGOOSE1 CONFREV
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the confRev value in published GOOSE messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE messages of the expected configuration revision from messages of a different revision. The standard requires
that CONFREV be incremented each time the members or the order of the members published is changed. The standard
states that the value of 0 is reserved.

5 TxGOOSE1 RETRANS TIME


Range: 0 to 100 ms in steps of 1 ms
Default: 4 ms
If the entered time is non-zero, when a member value change is detected, four event transmissions are sent, then
heartbeat transmissions resume. The interval between the first and second event transmissions, and between the
second and third, is the time set here. The interval between the third and the fourth event transmission is double the set
time. If the entered time is zero, only a single event transmission occurs, then heartbeat transmissions resume.
TxGOOSE1 TIME TO LIVE
Range: 1 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 60 s
The value entered sets the timeAllowedtoLive value in published TxGOOSE1 messages. The standard requires
subscribers to assume a failure has occurred when another TxGOOSE1 message is not received within the published
timeAllowedtoLive time.
Base this setting on the TxGOOSE UPDATE TIME and the tolerable number of contiguous message delivery misses. For
example, if the heartbeat time is 10 s, and missing up to three successive messages is tolerable, make the setting
10 * 3 + 1 = 31 s. The extra second is to ensure that arrival of the third heartbeat transmission beats the
timeAllowedtoLive timer.
In the imported CID file, if the TxGOOSE1 TIME TO LIVE is greater than 60 seconds, clamp the setting value to 60 seconds
and an information log is provided in SCL log.
TxGOOSE1 UPDATE TIME
Range: 1 to 59 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the time interval between heartbeat messages, meaning messages that are sent periodically while
no events are detected.
TxGOOSE1 PORT ASSIGNMENT
Range: Disabled, Port-1; Port-2; Port-3; Ports-1,2; Ports-2,3; Ports-1,3; Ports-1,2,3
Default: Ports-1, 2, 3
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.

5-70 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

This setting specifies the Ethernet ports for transmission of TxGOOSE1. When set to disabled, TxGOOSE1 messages are
not transmitted on any port no matter the state of GoEna. When set to Port-1, TxGOOSE1 is published over Ethernet
Port-1 only; while selecting Ports-1, 3 option, the same TxGOOSE1 is published to both Ports 1 and 3; and similarly if set
to Ports-1, 2, 3, all ports publish TxGOOSE1.

When setting PRT2 REDUNDANCY to Failover or to PRP, the TxGOOSE 1 port assignment needs to be set to ports 2
and 3 (Ports-2,3).
Also, Port 3 configuration in the CID file is ignored. The Port 3 ConnectedAP elements has no meaning, as ports 2
and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask.
R-TxGOOSE1 IP CLASS
Range: 0 to 256 in steps of 1
Default: 46
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise this setting
selects the IPv4 Differentiated Services Code Point-DSCP (formerly called TypeOfService-TOS) value. This value provides
priority routing, when supported in the routers. The default value is for Expedited Forwarding (101110B, 46 or 2EH).
R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 224.0.0.0
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise this setting
specifies destination IP address for the R-TXGOOSE1 that is entered in Standard IPV4 address format. The destination IP
address needs to be a valid multicast or unicast IP address. The value specified in this setting is mapped to IPv4 header
32 bit field for Destination IP Address while publishing R-GOOSE1. 5
The default IP address 224.0.0.0 is reserved, and hence not a valid multicast IP address.
The source IP address is that of the UR port from which the R-GOOSE messages are transmitted.
R-TxGOOSE1 SECURITY
Range: None, Signature, SignatureAndEncryption
Default: None
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
This setting specifies level of security (authentication/encryption) used for TxGOOSE1. None specifies no security
mechanisms are to be used. Signature specifies only signature (no encryption) is to be used. SignatureAndEncryption
specifies that both signature and encryption are to be used.

RxGOOSE
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Messages.
IEC 61850, GOOSE is an efficient method for simultaneous high-speed delivery of the same generic substation event
information by a publishing device to more than one subscribing device. An RxGOOSE is a UR element implementing a
single IEC 61850 GOOSE message subscribing service. The publishing function in URs is performed by TxGOOSE elements,
as described in the previous section.
Each UR with the IEC 61850 order code option has 64 RxGOOSE elements. Each RxGOOSE element can subscribe to GOOSE
messages from a specified publisher. Each RxGOOSE can either use the original format specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 or
the routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE; IEC 61850 Edition 2) format specified in IEC TR 61850-90-5:2012. Subscribed message
members can be DataObjects, SubDataObjects, DataAttributes or SubAttributes. In E2-2.0 mode members are restricted to
basic types BOOLEAN, FLOAT32, INT32, Dbpos, TimeStamp or Quality. Each subscribed message can contain up to 64
values. A member can be a structure containing several values; note that it is the number of values rather than the number
of members that are limited to 64.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-71


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

GOOSE messages from any device of any manufacturer that implements the IEC 61850 Edition 1.0 or 2.0 GOOSE publish
service or the 61850-90-5 R-GOOSE service (IEC 61850 Edition 2) can be subscribed to. The UR accepts both the variable
length encoded GOOSE messages specified IEC 61850 8 1:2004 and the Fixed-Length encoded GOOSE messages as
specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 clause A.3.
Each enabled RxGOOSE monitors for interruption of the GOOSE messages it subscribes to based on the value in the
timeAllowedtoLive field of the last message received. If a new message is not received within that time interval, the
RxGOOSE assumes that connectivity is lost. FlexLogic operands (for example RxGOOSE1 On, RxGOOSE1 Off) reflect the
status of each RxGOOSE connectivity. An RxGOOSE connection is also considered lost after the UR finishes restart until a
message is received. While any RxGOOSE connectivity is lost, a common RxGOOSE Fail self-test is activated.
Messages that contain the value true in the ndsCom field are never accepted. Messages that contain the value true in the
simulation field (test field in edition 1.0 messages) are accepted only when the UR Test Mode Function setting is set to
Forcible or Isolated.
RxGOOSE messages can be received through any UR Ethernet port.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Messages >
RxGOOSE1 to access the settings that specify the messages to be accepted by the first RxGOOSE element. The settings
and functionality for the other RxGOOSE are similar. The following settings are available. They allow RxGOOSE1 to
recognize the GOOSE messages it is to accept. Most of these settings are automatically configured by UR Setup software
when an association to an RxGOOSE Boolean Input, RxGOOSE DPS Input, and/or RxGOOSE Analog Input is made as
described in the sections following this. For IEC 61850 Edition 2, settings R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE, R-RxGOOSE1
SECURITY, and R-RxGOOSE SRC IP need to be manually completed as the information is not contained in publisher SCL.
Figure 5-28: IEC 61850 RxGOOSE Messages panel (Edition 2)

RxGOOSE1 MODE
Range for Edition 2: GOOSE, R-GOOSE
Range for Edition 1: GOOSE
Default: GOOSE
When set to GOOSE, TxGOOSE1 messages are published in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 GOOSE format. When set to R-GOOSE,
TxGOOSE1 messages are published in Routable GOOSE format according to IEC 61850 90-5. When set to R-GOOSE, the
R-RxGOOSE DST IP needs to be a valid multicast or unicast IP address.

5-72 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

RxGOOSE1 goID
Range: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
If the entered value has one or more characters, the goID field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this
value for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. If the entered value is the empty string, RxGOOSE1
does not check the value received in the goID field. Special characters are not allowed, such as <, >, &, ’, and ".
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, this setting needs match the value of the publisher's TxGOOSE GoID setting.
RxGOOSE1 Dst MAC
Range: any 12 digit hexadecimal number
Default: 01-0C-CD-01-00-00
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used, the destination Media Access
Control (MAC) address for RxGOOSE1 messages is calculated based on the RxGOOSE DST IP address. Otherwise, set this
setting to the MAC address of the publisher. Only received GOOSE messages having a MAC address equal to this value
are accepted as valid RxGOOSE1 messages. An entered address of zero disables RxGOOSE1.
If the publisher is a UR series 7.3x device, the setting needs to match the value of the publisher’s TxGOOSE DST MAC
setting.
RxGOOSE1 ETYPE APPID
Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
Default: 0
If the value entered is non-zero, the APPID field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the
message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. If the value entered is zero, RxGOOSE1 does not check the value
received in the APPID field.
If the publisher is a UR series 7.3x device, the setting needs to match the value of the publisher’s TxGOOSE ETYPE APPID
setting. 5
RxGOOSE1 GoCBRef
Range: 0 to 129 alphanumeric, underscore, slash and period characters, beginning with an alpha character
The gocbRef field of incoming GOOSE messages must match this value for the message to be accepted as a valid
RxGOOSE1 message. If the entered value is the empty string, RxGOOSE1 is disabled. If not the empty string, the entry
needs to be an ACSI ObjectReference to the publishing control block in the format:
<LDName>/LLN0.<GoCBName>
where <LDName> is the function-related name if the logical device containing the publishing control block has "ldName"
configured, otherwise the product-related name of that logical device, and <GoCBName> is the name of the publishing
control block.
The F35 translates the ACSI format required for this setting to the MMS format used in GOOSE messages:
<LDName>/LLN0$GO$<GoCBName>
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x or 7.40 series device, <LDName> is the value of the publisher's Master functional ldName
setting if that setting is not empty, otherwise it is the value of the publisher's IED NAME suffixed with "Master". If the
publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, <GoCBName> is "GoCB" suffixed with the two digit TxGOOSE instance number, for
example "GoCB01". If the publisher is a UR 7.40 series device, <GoCBName> is as specified earlier in the TxGOOSE
section of this chapter.
RxGOOSE1 datSet
Range: 0 to 32 alphanumeric and underscore characters, beginning with an alpha character
Default: empty string
If the entered value has one or more characters, the datSet field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this
value prefixed by <LDName>/LLN0$ for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. <LDName> is as
specified in the RxGOOSE GoCBRef setting above. If the entered value is the empty string, RxGOOSE1 does not check the
value received in the datSet field.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, set this setting to the value of the publisher's DataSetxx name setting, where xx
is the instance number of the data set selected by the publisher's TxGOOSE datSet setting. If the publisher is a UR 7.40
series device, datSet is as specified in the DataSets section of this chapter.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-73


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

RxGOOSE1 ConfRev
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
If the value entered is non-zero, the confRev field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the
message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. If the entered value is zero, RxGOOSE1 does not check the value
received in the confRev field.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, set this setting to match the value of the publisher's TxGOOSE ConfRev setting.
R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE
Range: SSM, ASM, Unicast
Default: SSM
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise it selects the
R-GOOSE reception mode.
R-RxGOOSE RECEPTION MODE specifies the R-RxGOOSE DST IP range. When set to SSM, R-RxGOOSE DST IP must be in
the range of 232.0.0.1 to 232.255.255.255. When set to ASM, R-RxGOOSE DST IP must be in the range of 224.0.0.1 to
239.255.255.255, excluding the SSM range. Note that the SSM range is inside the ASM range and therefore the ASM use
excludes the SSM range. The default destination IP address 224.0.0.0 is reserved, and hence not a valid multicast IP
address.
The reception modes are related to Layer-3 R-GOOSE reception from routers/WAN. The subscription to multicasting of R-
GOOSE is supported using IGMP Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM). It is made available in either Source Specific
Multicast (SSM) mode or Any Source Multicast (ASM) mode. Unicast (over UDP) mode can also be used. In case of
multicasting (IGMPv3 based SSM or ASM), the R-GOOSE subscriber device requests the Last Hop Router (LHR) to
subscribe to a specific multicasting group.
5 If the publisher is using a unicast destination IP address for this R-GOOSE, then set R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE to
Unicast. Otherwise set R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE to the SSM or ASM mode used by the local routers/firewalls.
R-RxGOOSE1 SRC IP
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 127.0.0.1
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. When the RxGOOSE1
MODE setting is R-GOOSE and the R-RxGOOSE RECEPTION MODE setting is ASM, the value of this setting is not used.
Otherwise the Source IP Address field of incoming R-GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the message to
be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. Set this setting to the value of the source IP address used by the publisher.
For UR publishers, this value is in setting PRT# IP ADDRESS.
The UR does not validate the address entered. The default IP address 127.0.0.1 is a reserved, not a valid IP address. Enter
a valid IP source address.
R-RxGOOSE1 DST IP
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 224.0.0.0
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise the
Destination IP Address field of incoming R GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the message to be
accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. Set this setting to the same value as the R-GOOSE publisher's Destination IP
Address. For UR publishers, this value is in setting R-TxGOOSE# DST IP.
The destination IP address needs to be a valid multicast or unicast IP address. The UR does not validate the address
entered. The default IP address 224.0.0.0 is reserved, and hence not a valid multicast IP address.
R-RxGOOSE1 SECURITY
Range: None, Signature, SignatureAndEncryption
Default: None
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.

5-74 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

This setting specifies the level of security (authentication/encryption) used for RxGOOSE1. None indicates no security
mechanisms are in use. Signature indicates only signature (no encryption) is in use. SignatureAndEncryption indicates
that both signature and encryption are in use. Normally this setting is set to match the GOOSE publisher's security
method.
RxGOOSE1 Member 1
Range: End of List, BOOLEAN, FLOAT32, INT32, Dbpos (DPS), Quality, TimeStamp, Struct
Default: End of List
This setting specifies the type that the first member of incoming GOOSE messages must be for the message to be
accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. There are similar settings for each of the up to 64 members that the UR is able
to subscribe to in a given GOOSE message. The member before the first member setting set to "End of List" must be the
last member of the message for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x or 7.40 series device, set these settings to match the basic type of the members of the
publisher's data set selected by the publisher's TxGOOSE datSet setting.
If the publisher dataset includes members with structured data, that is, data attributes, sub-data objects, and/or data
attributes with sub-data attributes, configuration must use one of the new 7.40 UR Setup RxGOOSE Inputs pages. In this
case the Member setting displays as the product-related name used by the publishing IED of the data object or data
attribute, in standard SCSM format (e.g. Publisher1LD1/LLN0$ST$Off$stVal).
Note that a dataset can hold at most 64 basic data attribute values, and that a single structured data object or attribute
can contain multiple basic data attribute values. UR Setup software does not allow more that 64 basic data attribute
values to be entered, in which case the last several members settings cannot be changed from End of List.
Note that the publisher's name alone does not contain all the information required for subscription, additional publisher
information model information is stored elsewhere. For this reason, manual entry of the name is not supported.

RxGOOSE inputs
5
The values received by RxGOOSE elements need to be converted to FlexLogic or FlexAnalog operands so that they can be
used by other UR elements. This conversion is done by RxGOOSE Boolean, RxGOOSE DPS, and RxGOOSE Analog elements.
Each RxGOOSE Boolean can convert the value of a specified Boolean value received by a specified RxGOOSE to a FlexLogic
operand. Each RxGOOSE DPS can convert the value of a specified Dbpos (Double bit position) value to four FlexLogic
operands, one for each of the four possible Dbpos states. Each RxGOOSE Analog can convert the value of a specified
FLOAT32 member to a FlexAnalog operand. Each of these operands reverts to its default state when the RxGOOSE
connectivity is lost. Other types of values can be present in subscribed GOOSE messages, but cannot be converted to
operands.
When an RxGOOSE Input is mapped to a value in the GOOSE message, the associated q value is validated, if the q value is
included in that GOOSE message as part of the data object.
The RxGOOSE Input value is reverted to its default value, if the associated:
• q.validity is invalid
• or q.test bit is set and the relay test mode is disabled
When the test mode function is Forcible or Isolated, the q.test bit is not validated. That means, when the relay is in Test or
Test/blocked mode, the q.test = False is treated same as q.test = True.
RxGOOSE Boolean, RxGOOSE DPS, and RxGOOSE Analog elements are mapped to various data objects in
<iedName>Master/GGIO3. This is to allow reading of their values via MMS and to allow references to them in SCL files.
GGIO3 has no settings, nor is it visible in the UR Setup software. See the UR Family Communications Guide for more
information on GGIO3.

RxGOOSE Boolean inputs


Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Boolean Inputs.
The number of RxGOOSE Boolean (remote inputs) is 256.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-75


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

There are Add IED and Remove IED buttons. The Add IED button allows SCL files to be used, including ICD, CID, and SCD
(supported in version 7.40 and later). With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must
match one IP address of the device, while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must
match. When the file format is SCD, the system lists all IEDs inside the SCD file and lets the user select the ones to add. The
figure shows a selection being made by importing a CID file using the Add IED function.
Figure 5-29: RxGOOSE Boolean panel (Edition 2)

Most of the settings are configured by drag-and-drop. However the ID, DEFAULT STATE, and EVENTS settings must be
individually entered when the factory default values are not acceptable.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG Bool1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the name of the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. The full
operand name is the value of this setting appended with " On". The basic and enhanced front panels display the first 17
characters of this setting plus " On" to fit the 20 character display.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 RxGOOSE
Range: None, RxGOOSE1, RxGOOSE2, and so on
Default: None
This setting selects the RxGOOSE containing the value that drives the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. If set to
None, the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand assumes its default state.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 Member
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting selects the GOOSE message member that drives the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. A setting of 1
selects the first member, 2 selects the second member, and so on. Entering a number greater than the number of
members in the message and entering the number of a member which does not contain a BOOLEAN results in the
RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand assuming its default state. The Subscribed to column identifies the particular
Boolean subscribed to even if the member is a structure containing more than one Boolean.

5-76 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

RxGOOSE Boolean1 DEFAULT STATE


Range: On, Off, Latest/On, Latest/Off
Default: Off
This setting selects the logic state for the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand if the UR has just completed startup and
the selected RxGOOSE has not yet received a message, or the selected RxGOOSE has lost its connectivity with the
publisher. The following choices are available:
– "On" value defaults the input to logic 1
– "Off" value defaults the input to logic 0
– "Latest/On" freezes the input in case of lost connectivity. If the latest state is unknown, such as after UR power-up
but before the first communication, the input defaults to logic 1. When communication resumes, the input
becomes fully operational.
– "Latest/Off" freezes the input in case of lost connectivity. If the latest state is unknown, such as after UR power-up
but before the first communication, the input defaults to logic 0. When communication resumes, the input
becomes fully operational.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting selects whether Off to On transitions of the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand are recorded by the event
recorder. If set to Enabled, Off to On transitions are recorded. On to Off transitions are never recorded, even if events are
enabled.

RxGOOSE DPS inputs


Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 618560 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE DPS Inputs.
5
There are Add IED and Remove IED buttons. The Add IED button allows SCL files to be used, including ICD, CID, and SCD
(supported in version 7.40 and later). With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must
match one IP address of the device, while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must
match. When the file format is SCD, the system lists all IEDs inside the SCD file and lets the user select the ones to add.
Figure 5-30: RxGOOSE DPS Inputs panel (Edition 2)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-77


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

RxGOOSE DPS1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG DPS1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the names of the four RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operands. The
full operand name is the value of this setting appended with "Interm," "On," "Off," or "Bad." The basic and enhanced front
panels display the first 13 characters of this setting plus the state suffix to fit the 20 character display.
RxGOOSE DPS1 RxGOOSE
Range: None, RxGOOSE1, RxGOOSE2, and so on
Default: None
This setting selects the GOOSE message containing the value that drives the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand. If set to
None, the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand assumes its default state.
RxGOOSE DPS1 Member
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting selects the GOOSE message member that drives the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand. A setting of 1 selects
the first member, 2 selects the second member, and so on. Entering a number greater than the number of members in
the message and entering the number of a member that is not a Dbpos results in the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand
assuming its default state. In the case that the member is a structure containing more than one Dbpos, the Subscribed
to column identifies the particular Dbpos subscribed to.
RxGOOSE DSP1 DEFAULT STATE
Range: Intermediate-state, Off, On, Bad-state, Latest
Default: Latest

5 This setting selects the logic state for the data attribute @Master/GGIO3.IndPos01.stVal and the DPS FlexLogic operands
when the UR has just completed start-up and the selected RxGOOSE has not yet received a message, and when the
RxGOOSE has lost its connection with the publisher. When this setting is selected to Latest, the value of @Master/
GGIO3.IndPosψψ.stVal is Intermediate-state when the UR has just completed start-up and the selected RxGOOSE has
not yet received a message, and the latest received value when the RxGOOSE loses its connectivity with the publisher.
RxGOOSE DPS1 EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting selects whether Off to On transitions of the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operands are recorded by the event
recorder. If set to Enabled, Off to On transitions are recorded. On to Off transitions are never recorded, even if events are
enabled.

RxGOOSE analog inputs


Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Analog Inputs.
There are Add IED and Remove IED buttons. The Add IED button allows SCL files to be used, including ICD, CID, and SCD
(supported in version 7.40 and later). With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must
match one IP address of the device, while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must
match. When the file format is SCD, the system lists all IEDs inside the SCD file and lets the user select the ones to add.

5-78 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-31: RxGOOSE Analog Inputs panel (Edition 2)

There are 32 RxGOOSE analog inputs.


RxGOOSE Analog1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG Analog1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to RxGOOSE Analog1. Unlike RxGOOSE Booleans and RxGOOSE
DPS, the RxGOOSE Analog operands have fixed names, for example RxGOOSE Analog1.
5
RxGOOSE Analog1 RxGOOSE
Range: None, RxGOOSE1, RxGOOSE2, and so on
Default: None
This setting selects the GOOSE message that drives the RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexAnalog operand. If set to None, the
RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexAnalog operand assumes its default state.
RxGOOSE Analog1 Member
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting selects the GOOSE message member that drives the RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexAnalog operand. A setting of 1
selects the first member, 2 selects the second member, and so on. Entering a number greater than the number of
members in the message and entering the number of a member that does not contain a FLOAT32 results in the
RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexAnalog operand assuming its default state. The Subscribed to column identifies the particular
FLOAT32 subscribed to even if the member is a structure containing more than one FLOAT32.
RxGOOSE Analog1 DEFAULT
Range: -1000000.000 to 1000000.000 in steps of 0.001
Default: 1000.000
This setting specifies the value of the GOOSE analog input when the selected RxGOOSE has lost its connectivity with the
publisher and the RxGOOSE Analog1 DEFAULT MODE is set to "Default Value." Otherwise this setting has no effect. This
setting is stored as an IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating point number. Because of the large range of this setting, not all
possible values can be stored. Some values can be rounded to the closest possible floating point number.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-79


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

RxGOOSE Analog1 DEFAULT MODE


Range: Default Value, Last Known
Default: Default Value
When the selected RxGOOSE has lost its connectivity with the publisher and this setting is "Last Known," the value of the
RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexLogic operand remains at the last received value. When the selected RxGOOSE has lost its
connectivity with the publisher and this setting value is "Default Value," then the RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexLogic operand is
defined by the RxGOOSE Analog1 DEFAULT setting. After restart, until a message is received, the operand value is the
default value.
RxGOOSE Analog1 UNITS
Range: up to 4 characters
Default: empty string
This setting specifies a four-character string that is used in the actual values display of RxGOOSE Analog1.
RxGOOSE Analogs are floating-point values, with no units. The RxGOOSE UNIT and PU base settings allow the user to
configure RxGOOSE Analog, so that it can be used in a FlexElement.
RxGOOSE Analogs that represent current, voltage, power, frequency, angles, or power factor can be used in a
FlexElement. The following text must be used in the UNITS setting, to represent these types of analogs: A, V, W, var, VA,
Hz, deg, and no text (blank setting) for power factor.
RxGOOSE Analogs can be compared to other RxGOOSE Analogs with any character string or no string.
RxGOOSE Analog1 PU Base in kilo
Range: 0.000 to 1000000000.000 in steps of 0.001
Default: 1.000
This setting specifies the per-unit base value for other F35 features to use with the RxGOOSE Analog1 operand. A
5 FlexElement for instance subtracts two quantities after converting their values to integers rescaled to a common base,
the common base being the largest of the base values of the two quantities. If one of quantities is RxGOOSE Analog1 and
its per-unit base value is not appropriate, the rescaling operation can result in unnecessary loss of precision or overflow
in the integer result. The FlexElement Base Units table in the Settings > FlexLogic > FlexElements section later, which
tabulates the per-unit base value used by its pickup setting and implies the per-unit base used by other FlexAnalogs, can
be of use in selecting a value for the RxGOOSE Analog1 PU setting.
Some UR elements have requirements for the type of input operands, for instance current type or voltage type. These
elements assume that RxGOOSE Analog operands are of whatever type is necessary to meet these requirements.
The per-unit base setting represents thousands, not single units. For example, a PU base of 1.000 is actually 1000 and a
PU base of 0.001 is 1.
When using RxGOOSE Analogs and PU base in FlexElements, the largest value that can be displayed in the FlexElement
actual values is 2,140,000.000.

Reports
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Reports.

Report settings
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Reports > Report Settings.
ReportSettings rptID
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the RptID attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false. The RptID is the name of the report.
ReportSettings optFields
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the OptFlds attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.

5-80 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

ReportSettings bufTime
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the BufTm attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.
ReportSettings trgOps
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the TrgOps attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.
ReportSettings intgPd
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the IntgPd attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.

Buffered and unbuffered reports


Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Reports > Buffered Reports or Unbuffered
Reports.
Figure 5-32: IEC 61850 buffered report panel

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-81


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

An IEC 61850 Report server is an efficient method to deliver generic substation event information from a single server to a
single client, such as a supervisory control IED. A Configurable Report is a UR element implementing an IEC 61850 Report
server, either of the buffered or unbuffered kind. The following table lists the number of Configurable Report elements.
Each Configurable Report element can report the values of up to 64 FlexLogic or FlexAnalog operands. Buffered report
elements queue value changes that occur while the client is offline and delivered when the client re-connects. Up to 512
events can be queued. Unbuffered control blocks purge all value change events when the connection to the client is lost;
any events that occur while the client is not connected are lost.
Table 5-11: Number of report elements
Number
Buffered reports 30
Unbuffered reports 18

When using IEC 61850 Edition 2, configurable Reports interoperate with any client device of any manufacturer that
conforms to the IEC 61850 edition 1.0 or 2.0 report client requirements.
When using IEC 61850 Edition 1, configurable Reports interoperate with any client device of any manufacturer that
conforms to the IEC 61850 edition 1.0 report client requirements.
The entities whose values are reported by a Configurable Report are known as members. The members are itemized in an
ordered list known as a data set. Each Configurable Report can use any one of the data sets provided that no more than
four data sets are used for reports. This restriction is to limit the amount of processing power that can be allocated to
reporting.
Each enabled Configurable Report transmits an update to its client whenever a value change is detected in one or more of
its members. Also, the control block can be configured to send integrity reports containing the present value of all
members either on demand from the client or periodically. A TCP handshaking mechanism causes messages that are not
5 read and acknowledged by the client to be retransmitted.
For a Configurable Report to operate, its members must be selected (that is, its data set configured) and a client must open
a connection to, configure, and enable its report control block. Control blocks and data sets can be pre-configured by
sending the F35 a CID file. See the UR Family Communications Guide for details. EnerVista UR Setup also can be used to
select the data set members and to pre-configure the control blocks.
Each buffered report has the following settings.
Buffered Report1 RptID
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 65 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
The name of the report. The entered value sets the RptID value in Buffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by the
client to discriminate Buffered Report1 messages from other messages. If the number of characters entered is zero, the
value used for RptID in messages is an ObjectReference to the report's control block, that is, "<LDName>/
LLN0$BR$"BRCB01".
Buffered Report1 Name
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: BRCB01
The entered value sets the report control block name value for Buffered Report1.
Buffered Report1 DatSet
Range: None, TT6DataSet1, TT6 DataSet2, …, TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, …
Default: None
This setting selects the data set whose members' status is reported in Buffered Report1 messages using the UR Setup
software designator for the data set. The IEC 61850 name of the data sets are configured in the Datasets panel, as
described later.
An ObjectReference to the data set, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0$" and the data
set name, is used in the datSet field of report messages, and it can be used by the client to discriminate Buffered Report1
messages from other messages.

5-82 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The performance of the report is determined by the performance of the selected dataset. When the selection is
TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, … it is possible that transient events can be missed.
To configure a DataSet, select it at the top of the window from the drop-down list, for example DataSet02 shown in the
previous figure. In the lower part of the window, drag and drop configuration items to the right side. For example select
the ST Ind001 stVal item and drag it to DataSet Member 1. Dataset members configured here affect other Report or
TxGOOSE control blocks that use the same DataSet.
Buffered Report1 ConfRev
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the confRev value in Buffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by clients to discriminate
report messages of the expected configuration revision from messages of a different revision. The standard requires
that confRev be incremented each time the members or the order of the members is changed, and each time the data
set name is changed. The standard states that the value of 0 is reserved.
Buffered Report1 OptFlds
Range: The check box for each individual bit can be enabled or not (see figure)
Default: All bits enabled/ true
The OptFlds setting is bitstring that controls which of the optional fields are included in report messages. The figure
shows the available option bits. To reduce message size, uncheck any fields that are not needed.
Figure 5-33: Options for buffered report messages (Edition 2)

Buffered Report1 BufTm


Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 0 ms
The entered value sets the time interval in milliseconds for the buffering of events for inclusion in a single report.
Buffered Report1 TrgOps
Range: The check box for an individual bit can be enabled or not
Default: All bits enabled / true
The TrgOps setting is bitstring that controls which trigger conditions are monitored in this report. The options are as
follows. Uncheck any trigger conditions that are not needed.
– data-change
– quality-change
– integrity
– general interrogation (IEC 61850 Edition 2)
Buffered Report1 IntgPd
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 0 ms
The entered value sets the period in milliseconds for generating Buffered Report1 integrity reports. An integrity report
includes the values of all members of the referenced data set, whether a change has occurred or not.

Each unbuffered report has the following settings.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-83


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Unbuffered Report1 RptID


Range for Edition 2: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 65 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
The name of the report. The entered value sets the RptID value in Unbuffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by
the client to discriminate Unbuffered Report1 messages from other messages. If the number of characters entered is
zero, the value used for RptID in messages is an ObjectReference to the report's control block, that is, "<LDName>/
LLN0$RP$"URCB01".
Unbuffered Report1 Name
Range: 0 up to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: URCB01
The entered value sets the report control block name value for Unbuffered Report1.
Unbuffered Report1 DatSet
Range: None, TT6DataSet1, TT6 DataSet2, …, TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, …
Default: None
This setting selects the data set whose members' status is reported in Unbuffered Report1 messages using the UR Setup
software designator for the data set. The IEC 61850 name of the data sets are configured in the Datasets panel, as
described later.
An ObjectReference to the data set, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0$" and the data
set name, is used in the datSet field of report messages, and it can be used by the client to discriminate Unbuffered
Report1 messages from other messages.
The performance of the report is determined by the performance of the selected dataset. When the selection is
TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, … it is possible that transient events can be missed.
5 Unbuffered Report1 ConfRev
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the confRev value in Unbuffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by clients to discriminate
report messages of the expected configuration revision from messages of a different revision. The standard requires
that confRev be incremented each time the members or the order of the members is changed, and each time the data
set name is changed. The standard states that the value of 0 is reserved.
Unbuffered Report1 OptFlds
Range: The check box for an individual bit can be enabled or not
Default: All bits enabled / true
The OptFlds setting is bitstring that controls which of the optional fields are included in report messages. The options are
as follows. To reduce message size, uncheck any fields that are not needed.
– sequence-number
– report-time-stamp
– reason-for-inclusion
– data-set-name
– data-reference
– conf-revision
For IEC 61850 Edition 2, the OptFlds bits buffer-overflow and entryID also listed are not applicable to unbuffered reports
even though the bits exist in the protocol. They are unchecked by default.
For IEC 61850 Edition 1, the entryID also listed is not applicable to unbuffered reports even though the bits exist in the
protocol. It is unchecked by default.
Unbuffered Report1 BufTm
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 0 ms
The entered value sets the time interval in milliseconds for the buffering of events for inclusion into a single report.

5-84 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Unbuffered Report1 TrgOps


Range: The check box for an individual bit can be enabled or not
Default: All bits enabled / true
The TrgOps setting is bitstring that controls which trigger conditions are monitored in this report. The options are as
follows. Uncheck any trigger conditions that are not needed.
– data-change
– quality-change
– integrity
– general interrogation (IEC 61850 Edition 2)
Unbuffered Report1 IntgPd
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 0 ms
The entered value sets the period in milliseconds for generating Unbuffered Report1 integrity reports. An integrity report
includes the values of all members of the referenced data set, whether a change has occurred or not.

DataSets
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > DataSets.
As mentioned in the preceding GOOSE and Reports sections, the members whose values are communicated by these
services are itemized in an ordered list known as a data set. Each UR with the IEC 61850 option has 18 data sets (six fast
and 12 slow). Each data set can contain as many as 64 members. Any data set can be used simultaneously by any number
of TxGOOSE elements and/or by any number of Configurable Report elements. UR Setup software can configure any
FlexLogic operands and any FlexAnalog operands as members.
Figure 5-34: IEC 61850 DataSets (Edition 2) 5

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-85


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

UR Setup software requires data set members to be IEC 61850 data objects or data attributes with Functional Constraint
ST or MX. Certain FlexLogic and FlexAnalog operands have factory-assigned data attributes as tabulated in the UR Family
Communications Guide. All FlexLogic and FlexAnalog operands can be user-assigned to GGIO1 or GGIO4 data attributes,
so that operands without factory-assigned data attributes can still have their values published. See the GGIO1 and GGIO4
sections later for details.
Datasets used by TxGOOSE1, TxGOOSE2, and/or by reports also provide a chatter suppression service for their Boolean
members. Oscillation in a value, also known as chatter, can be caused by errors in logic programming, inadequate
hysteresis (deadband) on a threshold, or a failed station component. Chatter can flood a communications network with
GOOSE messages, degrading response time for all users. If chatter is detected in a Boolean member, TxGOOSE suspends
GOOSE event message triggering and report message triggering from that member for as long as the condition exists, and
for a minimum period of one second. While sending is suspended, a self-test message identifying the specific data item
detected as oscillating is activated.
For a summary of the panels in which the data sets are used, the path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications >
IEC 61850 > DataSets > Summary.
For the settings, navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > DataSets > TT6DataSet1 for the
first data set.
Copy and paste functions are available when right-clicking a DataSet. They allow the target dataset to be configured
based on its order code. If some dataset items are not supported, they are not pasted, and a warning message shows a list
of dataset items that were not supported and not pasted. The DataSet name is not copied or pasted. In short, use this
feature to copy a DataSet Member setting and paste it into another Member setting, a text file, or Word, as examples.
Figure 5-35: Member right-click

DataSet01 name
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: DataSet01
The value entered sets the name of the data set, which is required to be unique within the UR for proper operation. The
value entered sets the name of the data set, which is required to be unique within the UR for proper operation. Fast
datasets start with TT6, and slow datasets start with TT3. Up to six fast datasets are allowed. Up to four fast GOOSE
datasets are allowed.

5-86 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

An ObjectReference to the data set consists of a string that is the concatenation of "<LDName>/LLN0$" and the
DataSet01 name setting value. An ObjectReference to the data set is published in the datSet field of TxGOOSE messages,
and it can be used by subscribers to discriminate the messages of that TxGOOSE from other GOOSE messages. An
ObjectReference to the data set is optionally published in the DatSet field of Report messages. Valid characters are
upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first character must be a letter.
DataSet01 shared by
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default:
Names of all control blocks that use this DataSet. Read-only field.
DataSet01 Member1
Range: End of List or any instantiated 61850 data object or data attribute with Functional Constraint ST or MX
Default: End of List
This setting specifies the first member in TxGOOSE1 messages. There is a similar setting for each of the up to 64
members that the UR allows in a Dataset. Only values of members before the first set to End of List are published.
Select the member from the drop-down list. Or right-click an entry to copy, paste, delete, or insert.

Product setup
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Product Setup.

Security
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Product Setup > Security.
Figure 5-36: IEC 61850 Security 5

SecGSAL1.SecDataClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model that clients must use to clear security data via commands to
SecGSAL1.SecDataClr. "sbo" here is select-before-operate.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-87


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

SecGSAL1.OpCntRs ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model that clients must use to clear security data via commands to SecGSAL1.OpCntRs.
"sbo" here is select-before-operate.

Demand
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the Demand metering are configured here.

Energy
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the Energy metering are configured here.

Real Time Clock


This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Product Setup > Real Time Clock.
Figure 5-37: IEC 61850 Real Time Clock

TmClkLTMS1.TmnsDelta.db
Range: 0.000 to 100.000 %
Default: 0.000 %
This setting is a deadband setting and is used by the relay to determine when to update the "mag" and "cVal" values
from the associated "instMag" and "instCVal" values. The value shall represent the percentage of difference between
maximum and minimum in units of 0.001%. The minimum and maximum values for TmnsDelta data object are
-500000000 ns and 500000000 ns respectively and for example, a setting value of 0.002% results in the dead banded
value of (500000000 - (-500000000)) * 0.002 / 100 = 20000 ns. The default setting value of 0.000% does not update the
"mag" and "cVal" values.

Deadband settings
A deadband is a range in which no action occurs, usually expressed as a percentage.
The IEC 61850 panels contain hundreds of deadband settings, such as in the following panels: Product Setup > Real Time
Clock, FlexLogic, Control Elements, and GGIO4. Each panel is not outlined here. The FlexLogic category applies to IEC 61850
Edition 2.

5-88 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Deadband setting names all end either with "DB" or .db. As they all work the same way, but each on a different analog
value, a single description applicable to all deadband settings is given here. The analog value that each deadband setting
applies is usually obvious from the name of the setting. However, a tabulation of the analog values and their associated
deadband setting can be found in the UR Family Communications Guide.
Figure 5-38: Deadband settings with .db suffix (Edition 2)

GOOSE, buffered report, and unbuffered report messages are for the most part transmitted only when there is a value
change in one or more of their members. Most analog values continuously dither by an amount that is not significant.
Were a report to be sent each time an insignificant analog value change occurred, then the communications network
5
floods with GOOSE and report messages, degrading response time for all users.
To control this, a deadband setting is provided for each analog value. Also, in addition to the present actual value of each
analog ("instMag" in the following figure), there is a deadbanded value ("mag" in the figure), which is updated with the
present value only when the difference between the two exceeds the deadband setting (db in the figure). Changes to this
deadbanded value trigger transmissions when included in GOOSE and report data sets.
Figure 5-39: Deadband settings

Deadband settings are entered in UR Setup software in units of percent of the difference between the "max." and "min." of
the associated analog value. A zero deadband setting suppresses transmission triggering. The range of deadband settings
is 0.000 to 100.000% in steps of 0.001. The default value is 0.000%.
GGIO4 elements have individual settings for "min." and "max." The min. and max. for FlxEIGAPC#.OpSig.db (FLEXELEMENT #
OpSig) are -50 pu and +50 pu respectively. The min. value for all other quantities is 0. The max. values are as follows:
• Phase current — 46 x phase CT primary setting
• Neutral current — 46 x ground CT primary setting
• Ground current (sensitive ground CT) — 4.6 x sensitive ground CT primary setting
• Phase, phase-to-phase, and sequence voltage — 275 x phase VT ratio setting

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-89


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

• Auxiliary voltage — 275 x auxiliary VT ration setting


• Power (real, reactive, apparent, 3-phase, and 1-phase) — 4 × phase CT primary setting × 1.5 × VT Secondary setting ×
VT ratio setting
• Energy (real or imaginary) — 4 × phase CT primary setting × 1.5 × VT Secondary setting × VT ratio setting x 1 hour
• Frequency — 90 Hz
• Frequency rate of change — 90 Hz/s
• Power factor — 2
• Angle — 360 degrees
Select the deadband settings from knowledge of the characteristics of the power system quantity measured and
knowledge of the demands of the applications receiving the measurement via GOOSE or report such that changes of
significance to the application are promptly reported, yet the network is not overly burdened with event messages.

Signal sources
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the signal sources are configured here.

Breakers
The UR breaker control and status monitoring elements have certain settings that configure how the IEC 61850 protocol
interacts with these elements. These settings are described in this section. See the Breakers section in the System Setup
section of this chapter for details on the operation of breaker control elements.
Navigate to Settings > Communications > IEC 61850 > System Setup > Breakers > Breaker 1 to access the settings that
configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface with the first breaker control and status monitoring element. The settings and
functionality for the others are similar.
5 Figure 5-40: IEC 61850 Breaker panel (Edition 2)

XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND


Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that breaker 1 is selected for local
control. While the selected operand is asserted, Bkr0XCBR1.Loc.stVal is true and IEC 61850 commands to BkrCSWI1.Pos
and Bkr0XCBR1.Pos are not accepted, and a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-
switching-hierarchy.

5-90 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

XCBR1 SYNCCHECK CLS


Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that synchrocheck conditions are
acceptable for closing breaker 1. If a SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal true and with Check.SynchroCheck
true is requested of either BkrCSWI1.Pos or Bkr0XCBR1.Pos and the selected operand is not asserted, a Negative
Response (-Rsp) is issued with the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-synchrocheck.
XCBR1 INTERLOCK OPN
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that interlocking conditions are not
acceptable for opening breaker 1. While the selected operand is asserted, the value of BkrCILO.EnaOpn.stVal is false. If a
SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal false and with Check.Interlock-check true is requested of either
BkrCSWI1.Pos or Bkr0XCBR1.Pos, and the selected operand is not activated, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with
the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-interlocking.
XCBR1 INTERLOCK CLS
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that interlocking conditions are not
acceptable for closing breaker 1. While the selected operand is asserted, the value of BkrCILO.EnaCls.stVal is false. If a
SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal true and with Check.Interlock-check true is requested of either
BkrCSWI1.Pos or Bkr0XCBR1.Pos and the selected operand is not activated, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with the
REASON CODE of Blocked-by-interlocking.
XCBR1 Pos ctlModel 5
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security, direct-with-enhanced-security, sbo-with-
enhanced-security
Default: sbo-with-enhanced-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the breaker 1 signals marked
Bkr0XCBR1.PosOpn.ctlVal and Bkr0XCBR1.PosCls.ctlVal on the Breaker Control Logic (Sheet 1 of 2) diagram in the
Settings > System Setup section later in this chapter. These signals force a breaker 1 three-phase trip or close control
while the operand selected by setting XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND is not active.
"sbo" here is select-before-operate. Enhanced security means that the UR reports to the client the breaker 1 position at
the end of the command sequence.
XCBR1 Pos sboTimeout
Range: 2 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between a select and an operate command to breaker 1 signals marked
Bkr0XCBR1.PosOpn.ctlVal and Bkr0XCBR1.PosCls.ctlVal in order for the operand to be successful. This setting is only
relevant when XCBR1 Pos ctlModel is sbo-with-normal-security or sbo-with-enhanced-security.
XCBR1 BlkOpn ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the breaker 1 signal marked
Bkr0XCBR1.BlkOpn.ctlVal signal on the Breaker Control Logic (Sheet 1 of 2) diagram in the Settings > System Setup
section later. This signal when true blocks breaker 1 trip control while the operand selected by setting XCBR1 ST.LOC
OPERAND is not active.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-91


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

XCBR1 BlkCls ctlModel


Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the breaker 1 signal marked
Bkr0XCBR1.BlkCls.ctlVal signal on the Breaker Control Logic (Sheet 1 of 2) diagram in the Settings > System Setup section
later. This signal when true blocks breaker 1 close control while the operand selected by setting XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND
is not active.
CSWI1 Pos ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security, direct-with-enhanced-security, sbo-with-
enhanced-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the breaker 1 signals marked
BkrCSWI1.PosOpn.ctlVal and BkrCSWI1.PosCls.ctlVal on the Breaker Control Logic (Sheet 1 of 2) diagram in the Settings >
System Setup section earlier. These signals force a breaker 1 three-phase trip or close control while the operand selected
by setting XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND is not active.
CSWI1 Pos sboTimeout
Range: 2 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between a select and an operate command to breaker 1 via BkrCSWI1.Pos in
order for the operand to be successful. This setting is only relevant when CSWI1 Pos ctlModel is sbo-with-normal-
security or sbo-with-enhanced-security.
CSWI1 Pos operTimeout
Range: 0.000 to 2.000 s in steps of 0.001s
5 Default: 0.100 s
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
This setting specifies the maximum time between an operate command to breaker 1 via BkrCSWI1.Pos until
BkrCSWI1.Pos.stVal enters the commanded state. The command terminates if the commanded state is not reached in
the set time.

Switches
The UR disconnect switch control and status monitoring elements have certain settings that configure how the IEC 61850
protocol interacts with these elements. These settings are described in this section. See the Settings > System Setup >
Disconnect Switches section later in this chapter for details on the operation of the disconnect switch control elements.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > System Setup > Switches > Switch 1 to access
the settings that configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface with the first disconnect switch control and status monitoring
element. The settings and functionality for the others are similar.

5-92 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-41: Switch panel

Disc0XSWI1.InRef5.setSrcRef OPERAND
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that disconnect switch 1 is selected
for local control. While the selected operand is asserted, Disc0XSWI1.Loc.stVal is true and IEC 61850 commands to
DiscCSWI1.Pos and Disc0XSWI1.Pos are not accepted, and a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with the REASON CODE
of Blocked-by-switching-hierarchy.
XSWI1 INTERLOCK OPN
5
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that interlocking conditions are not
acceptable for opening disconnect switch 1. While the selected operand is asserted, the value of DiscCILO.EnaOpn.stVal
is false. If a SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal false and with Check.Interlock-check true is requested of
DiscCSWI1.Pos or Disc0XSWI1.Pos and the selected operand is not activated, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with
the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-interlocking.
XSWI1 INTERLOCK CLS
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that interlocking conditions are not
acceptable for closing disconnect switch 1. While the selected operand is asserted, the value of DiscCILO.EnaCls.stVal is
false. If a SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal true and with Check.Interlock-check true is requested of
DiscCSWI1.Pos or Disc0XSWI1.Pos and the selected operand is not activated, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with
the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-interlocking.
XSWI1 Pos ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security, direct-with-enhanced-security, sbo-with-
enhanced-security
Default: sbo-with-enhanced-security
This setting selects the control model that clients must use to successfully control the disconnect switch 1 signals
marked Disc0XCBR1.PosOpn.ctlVal and Disc0XCBR1.PosCls.ctlVal on the Disconnect Switch Logic diagram in the Settings
> System Setup section later. These signals force a disconnect switch trip or close control while the operand selected by
setting XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND is not active.
"sbo" here is select-before-operate. Enhanced security means that the F35 reports to the client the disconnect switch 1
position the end of the command sequence.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-93


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

XSWI1 Pos sboTimeout


Range: 2 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between a select and an operate command to disconnect switch 1 signals
marked Disc0XCBR1.PosOpn.ctlVal and Disc0XCBR1.PosCls.ctlVal in order for the operand to be successful. This setting is
only relevant when XSWI1 Pos ctlModel is sbo-with-normal-security or sbo-with-enhanced-security.
Disc0XSWI1 BlkOpn ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the disconnect switch 1 signal marked
DiscCSWI1.BlkOpn.ctlVal signal on the Disconnect Switch Logic diagram in the Settings > System Setup section later. This
signal when true blocks disconnect switch 1 trip control while the operand selected by setting XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND is
not active.
Disc0XSWI1 BlkCls ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the disconnect switch 1 signal marked
DiscCSWI1.BlkCls.ctlVal signal on the Disconnect Switch Logic diagram in the Settings > System Setup section later. This
signal when true blocks disconnect switch 1 close control while the operand selected by setting XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND
is not active.
Disc0CSWI1 Pos ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security, direct-with-enhanced-security, sbo-with-
enhanced-security
5 Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the disconnect switch 1 signals marked
DiscCSWI1.PosOpn.ctlVal and DiscCSWI1.PosCls.ctlVal on the Disconnect Switch Logic diagram in the Settings > System
Setup section later. These signals force a disconnect switch trip or close control while the operand selected by setting
XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND is not active.
Disc0CSWI1 Pos sboTimeout
Range: 2 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between a select and an operate command to disconnect switch 1 via
BkrCSWI1.Pos in order for the operand to be successful. This setting is only relevant when CSWI1 Pos ctlModel is sbo-
with-normal-security or sbo-with-enhanced-security.
Disc0CSWI1 Pos operTimeout
Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001s
Default: 5.000 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between an operate command to disconnect switch 1 via BkrCSWI1.Pos until
BkrCSWI1.Pos.stVal enters the commanded state. The command terminates if the commanded state is not reached in
the set time.

Setting Groups
The UR implements a setting groups element as detailed in the Control Elements > Setting Groups section of this chapter.
The active setting group and the setting group open for edits can be selected via MMS commands SelectActiveSG and
SelectEditSG. The setting related to these IEC 61850 commands are described here.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Control Elements > Setting Groups to access
the setting that configures the IEC 61850 setting group commands.

5-94 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-42: Setting Groups panel (Edition 2)

Initial Setting Group


Range: 1 to 6 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the initial value of the non-volatile register normally controlled by the service SelectActiveSG. This
initialization occurs only on the UR reboot immediately following the receipt of a valid CID file.
This setting is not mapped into the IEC 61850 information model, but sets the value of SettingControl element attribute
actSG in SCL files.
5
Overview
IEC 61850 is a series of international standards and technical reports applicable to power utility automation systems. It
includes semantics, abstract communication services, specific communication services, performance specifications,
network engineering guidelines, configuration description methodologies, and engineering processes. The standard
enables interoperability among intelligent electronic devices (IEDs) from different suppliers and interoperability among
software configuration tools from different suppliers. Interoperability in this case is the ability for IEDs to operate on the
same network or communication path sharing information and commands, and for configuration tools to understand
each other's configuration files.
The UR family supports a large subset of IEC 61850 features. These are detailed in the UR Family Communications Guide
and include the information model, GOOSE publish, GOOSE subscribe, buffered report server, unbuffered report server, and
Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) query, read, write, and control services. In addition, the URs and their
EnerVista UR Setup software support IEC 61850 Substation Configuration Language (SCL) file import/export and merging.
Many settings of UR protection, control, and monitoring elements, that is to say elements that are not concerned with the
IEC 61850 protocol, can nevertheless be accessed via IEC 61850. These settings are documented elsewhere in this Settings
chapter. This section of the Settings chapter deals solely with the settings that configure the IEC 61850 protocol itself.
The maximum number of simultaneous clients supported by the UR family is five.

EnerVista setup for IEC 61850


The EnerVista UR Setup software provides the interface to configure F35 settings for the IEC 61850 protocol. This section
describes this interface. The software also supports import/export and merging of IEC 61850 Substation Configuration
Language (SCL) files as documented in the UR Family Communications Guide.
The IEC 61850 protocol configuration settings cannot be accessed through the UR front panel and are instead accessible
with the EnerVista software, via MMS query, read, and write services, or via 61850 SCL file transfer. Accordingly, whereas
other settings are presented in this manual as they appear on the front panel, IEC 61850 settings are presented as they

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-95


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

appear in the software. See the UR Family Communications Guide for MMS and SCL access. Note that if you update the IEC
61850 settings in the EnerVista software by writing to them by MMS while the corresponding IEC 61850 panel is open in
EnerVista, you need to close then open the panel in EnerVista for the correct readings to display.
IEC 61850 protocol configuration settings are accessed through software panels that are selected either in the Online
Window area (see figure) or the Offline Window area in the EnerVista software.
The EnerVista software also includes an interface that is compatible with firmware versions 5.0 to 7.2 to configure
subscribers. Use the Simplified GOOSE Configurator in the Offline Window area.
Figure 5-43: IEC 61850 protocol panel in EnerVista software (Edition 2)

The IEC 61850 window is divided into a navigation pane on the left and a settings panel on the right. You expand and click
an option on the left to display its panel on the right. The following figure shows an example for Server Configuration. The
SETTING column contains the names of the settings, and the PARAMETER column is used to enter the settings. Hovering
the mouse over a setting name displays a tool-tip showing the 61850 information model name of the setting or its location
in SCL files.
Figure 5-44: IEC 61850 panel (Edition 2)

5-96 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Opening the IEC 61850 window while online causes the UR Setup software to retrieve and import an SCL file from the F35.
This System Configuration Description (SCD) file contains all the settings in the UR at the time of the file request, both those
that are mapped into the IEC 61850 information model (that is, the "public" sections) and those that are not in the model
(that is, the "private" section). The UR EnerVista Setup software imports all of these settings into the current session, not just
those in the IEC 61850 window. To avoid loss of any unsaved setting changes made in other panels during the current
session, all other panels for the F35 must be closed before the IEC 61850 panel can be opened, and the software prompts
for this when applicable. Panels for other devices can be open concurrently to facilitate parameter coordination.
When CyberSentry security is enabled, editable settings depend on the user role logged in. For example, an Administrator
and Engineer can change settings. If prompted for a "Settings password," it means the Administrator or Engineer
password.
The Restore button restores settings in the window to their last saved values. The Default button reverts settings in the
window to factory default values or Oscillography, Data Logger, or FlexLogic Equation Editor pre-configured values. The
Reset button reverts all IEC 61850 settings to the factory default values, not just the current window. (In other settings
windows, the button reverts settings in the window to factory default values.)
When a setting is enabled, its panel continues to read Disabled until relaunched. There is no polling capability to update
automatically the IEC 61850 readings, so the panel needs to be closed then opened for the correct status to display. Good
practice is to close any panel not in use because changes being made by other users too are reflected only upon relaunch
of the panel.
Some of the IEC 61850 settings use floating point data, which guarantees accurate representation of real numbers up to
seven digits. Numbers with more than seven digits are approximated within a certain precision. This can result in
differences between what is entered and what is saved, and for example results in differences shown on a settings
comparison report.
Create CID and settings files
When the Save button is clicked in the online IEC 61850 window, UR Setup software prepares a configured IED description
(CID) file containing all the settings of the UR and sends the CID file to the F35. Upon receipt, the F35 checks the CID file for
5
correctness, going out of service, then back into service when the CID file is accepted. The software displays a message
when the F35 is running the new settings, confirming successful transfer. This process can take a minute or so due to the
amount of processing required by the software and the F35.
When the Save button is clicked in the offline IEC 61850 window, UR Setup software saves to local storage, for example the
hard drive, a .urs file containing all settings of the UR.

View IID/CID files


The file types are described as follows:
• IID — Instantiated IED capability description file — Actual settings on UR
• CID — Configured IED description file — Settings sent to the UR (may or may not contain the present settings)
The IID file type applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2 only.
IID and CID files are viewable. For example, after modifying settings in the IEC 61850 panels and clicking Developer IID/
CID Viewer in the software, a CID file generates and an SCL Viewer shows the updated CID file content. There are no edit
or save functions; use instead the Back Up and Restore Settings instructions later in this document to save the files.
Searches are case insensitive.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-97


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-45: View CID settings file (Edition 2)

Server configuration
The Server Configuration panel contains IEC 61850 settings relevant to the server functions of the IED implementation.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Server Configuration.
The following settings are available, where <iedName> is a syntactic variable representing the present value of the IED
NAME setting.
5 IED NAME
Range: 1 to 58 VisibleString characters
Default: TEMPLATE
The value entered sets the IED name used by IEC 61850 for the F35. An IED name unique within the network must be
entered for proper operation. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character.
The first character must be a letter.
The IED NAME and the Product LD inst name comprise the <LDName> for a product. The longest LD inst are "Master"
and "System" at six characters, with Master being fixed and the others configurable with the configurable Logical device
feature. So the IED NAME needs to be restricted to 58 characters to meet a 64 character limit.
Access Point
Range: S1, S2, S3
Default: S1
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 1. It is the subnetwork.
Location
Range: 0 to 255 ASCII characters
Default: Location
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.location. This data attribute is
provided by the protocol to allow the user to declare where the equipment is installed.
Latitude
Range: -90.000 to 90.000 degrees in steps of 0.001 degree
Default: 0.000 deg
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.latitude. This data attribute is provided
by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates -latitude. Negative values
indicate a southern latitude. WGS refers to the world geodetic system, which is used in global positioning systems (GPS),
and 84 is the current version of the standard.

5-98 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Longitude
Range: -180.000 to 180.000 degrees in steps of 0.001 degree
Default: 0.000 deg
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.longitude. This data attribute is
provided by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates -longitude. Negative
values indicate a western longitude.
Altitude
Range: 0 to 10,0000 m in steps of 1 m
Default: 0 m
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.altitude. This data attribute is provided
by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates - altitude.
Prefix for GGIO1
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 11 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 6 VisibleString characters
Default:
This setting sets the LN Prefix of the FlexLogic operand interface logical node GGIO1 that is described in the GGIO1
section later. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first
character must be a letter. UR Setup software does not allow entry of a prefix that duplicates any other GGIO1 prefix
that is used by the product, such as ConIn and ConOut.
Prefix for GGIO2
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 11 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 6 VisibleString characters
Default:
This setting sets the LN Prefix of the Virtual Inputs Interface logical node GGIO2 that is described in the GGIO2 section
5
later. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first character must
be a letter. UR Setup software does not allow entry of a prefix that duplicates any other GGIO2 prefix that is used by the
product.
Prefix for GGIO4
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 11 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 6 VisibleString characters
Default:
This setting sets the LN Prefix of the FlexAnalog operand interface logical node GGIO4 that is described in the GGIO4
section later. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first
character must be a letter. UR Setup software does not allow entry of a prefix that duplicates any other GGIO4 prefix
that is used by the product.
LLN0.Mod.ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: sbo-with-normal-security
This setting specifies the control service that clients must use to control the TEST MODE FUNCTION of the F35. An "on"
control to <LDName>/LLN0.Mod changes TEST MODE FUNCTION to Disabled, an "on-blocked" control changes it to
Forcible, and a "test/blocked" changes it to Isolated.
Configuration Type
Range: G2, E3-2.0
Default: G2
This setting is read only. It specifies the method used to describe GOOSE subscription configuration in SCL. See the UR
Family Communications Guide for details. In the G2 mode, the CID file contains IED elements for IEDs subscribed to by
this IED containing GOOSE subscription information. In the E3 2.0 mode, the CID file has only one IED element and
GOOSE subscription information is coded in data objects in the standard LGOS logical node used to monitor reception of

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-99


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

the subscribed GOOSE. UR 7.30 or later accepts either mode. The set value is for the entire EnerVista installation and is
preserved between sessions. To change this global field, click File > Preferences and access the IEC 61850 panel; you do
not need to be connected to the device.

Logical devices
The Logical Devices panel contains IEC 61850 settings relevant to the configurable logical devices feature, wherein logical
device naming can be reconfigured and logical nodes re-assigned.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Logical Devices.
Figure 5-46: Default IEC 61850 Logical Devices panel with devices middle and nodes right (Edition 2)

5
To configure logical devices and nodes:
1. Right-click an entry and edit an existing device, add a new one, or move a logical node. The rest of this section
explains the window and how to perform these actions.

The default logical device categories are as follows:


• Master — Communications, including GOOSE, reports, Remote I/O, Virtual Inputs, Modbus, DNP, and setting group
control
• System — Power system devices: breakers, switches, CTs, VTs, and so on, including interfaces to these, such as AC
inputs, contact I/O, transducer I/O, HardFiber I/O
• Prot — Protection and protection-related functions
• Ctrl — Control and monitoring functions
• Meter — Metering and measurement functions
• Gen — FlexLogic, Virtual Outputs, non-volatile latches, FlexElements, recording (for example oscillography), security,
front panel, clock
For the Master logical device, the following logical nodes have fixed assignment:
• The LLN0 in the Master logical device, which includes setting group, GOOSE and report control blocks, and datasets
• LPHD1 — Models common issues for physical devices
• GGIO1 — For unmapped FlexLogic operands
• GGIO2 — For Virtual Input control
• GGIO3 — For RxGOOSE Inputs
• GGIO4 — For unmapped FlexAnalog operands
• LGOS logical nodes — For GOOSE subscription

5-100 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The Logical Devices panel has middle and right panes. The middle pane has a list of the instantiated logical devices in the
sequence that they appear in SCL, with one device selected. The right pane has a list of the logical nodes presently
assigned to the selected logical device in lexicographic order by logical node name.
In the middle pane logical devices are shown with their product-related name, followed in brackets by their function-
related ldName, and followed by the value of their confRev. In the following example, by right-clicking and editing, the
Protection logical device has been set to instance name "Prot", the function-related name "Feeder1Prot" and the
configuration revision "2016-03-07 08:46." The text is clipped on the right if the line is longer than the available width. The
next paragraphs explain how to do this setup.
Figure 5-47: Protection logical node selected

5
Right-clicking a logical device displays the menu that allows insertion of a new logical device immediately below the
selected one, deletion of the selected logical device, or editing the selected logical device's parameters. The insert option is
disabled and greyed-out if there are already 16 logical devices instantiated. The delete option is disabled and greyed-out if
the selected logical device is Master or it contains any logical nodes other than LLN0.
Figure 5-48: Menu for logical node

If the insert option is selected, or the edit option is selected for other than the Master logical device, a logical device
parameters edit dialog opens.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-101


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-49: Insert new logical node (Edition 2)

If the edit option is selected for the Master logical device, the Product LD inst name setting is not editable.
Figure 5-50: Edit logical node

When the Ok button is clicked, the entered values for Product LD inst name and Functional ldName are checked for
uniqueness within the UR, and they are updated in the pane.

The settings are explained as follows, where <iedName> is a syntactic variable representing the present value of the IED
NAME setting. When adding or editing a logical device entry, these are the fields that need to be completed.

Customized logical nodes are not saved in the URS file.

Product LD inst name


Range: 1 to 64 VisibleString characters
Default: as per the following table
Each logical device has this setting. The value is fixed at "Master" in the first logical device and configurable in all others.
Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first character must be a
letter. The entered value sets the logical device inst name. Each logical device inst name is required to be unique within
the device, and it cannot be blank. Also, if the corresponding functional ldName setting is blank, the concatenation of the

5-102 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

IED name and the logical device inst name must form an LDName that is unique within the network for proper operation.
It is recommended that the length of the IED NAME plus the length of this setting be not greater than 64 to respect the
requirements of IEC 61850 7 2:2010 22.2 for LDName.
The factory default configuration is for six logical devices with Product LD inst name settings and logical node
assignments as per the following table.
Table 5-12: Factory default logical nodes
Default logical Contains logical nodes modeling...
device inst name
Master communications, including GOOSE, reports, Remote I/O, Virtual Inputs, Modbus, DNP, and so on.
(root logical device; Setting group control.
name is fixed) This is the root logical device.
To comply with IEC 61850 7 1 Ed2 clause 6.4.5.1, all group L logical nodes (logical nodes with class names
begin with "L"), except LLN0, belonging to this IED are in this logical device.
Protection (Prot) protection functions
Control (Ctrl) control and monitoring functions
System power system devices: breakers, switches, CTs, VTs, and so on, including interface to these such as AC inputs,
contact I/O, transducer I/O, HardFiber I/O
Metering (Meter) metering and measurement, including Signal Sources
General (Gen) FlexLogic, virtual outputs, non-volatile latches, FlexElements, FlexMath, recording (for example oscillography),
security, front panel, clock

Functional ldName
Range: 0 to 64 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
Each logical device has this setting. The value is configurable in all logical devices. Valid characters are upper and
lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. If the number of characters entered is greater than zero, the
5
setting sets the value of the function-related name used in communications. If an ldName is entered, it must form an
LDName that is unique within the network for proper operation. The standard recommends choosing this name
according to IEC 81346-1. If the number of characters entered is zero, no function-related name is defined.

Throughout the remainder of this IEC 61850 section, <LDName> is a syntactic variable representing the present
LDName of the master logical device. In other contexts LDName can refer to some other logical device. Depending
on its context, <LDName> can be a product-related name or a function-related name.
configRev
Range: 0 to 255 ASCII characters
Default:
This data attribute is provided by the protocol to declare changes to the semantic of the data model of the UR. The intent
is that the user changes Master configRev each time that the semantic or data model changes, so that clients can
readily detect the change. A semantic change is a logical node getting a new semantic use; for example, an instance of
logical node CSWI is now serving a different physical switch, or an instance of a logical node PDIS is now used for
another zone. A data model change is a change in the presence of logical nodes, data objects, data attributes, or
instance names.
The scope of Maser configRev is the entire relay configuration, as the Master logical device is the root logical device.
Similar settings are provided for the other logical nodes; the scope of these other configRev settings is limited to the
corresponding logical device configuration.
paramRev
Range: -2,147,483,648 to 2,147,483,647
Default: 0
The configurable data attribute paramRev has a scope that includes the entire device, and thus is modified whenever
any setting in the device changes. The UR increments the value of paramRev by one whenever one or multiple setting
changes occurs in one Modbus write request by any means (front panel, Modbus, or MMS) other than by SCL file

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-103


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

download. Incrementing occurs whether or not the setting is represented in the information model. When a UR device or
EnerVista UR Setup accepts an SCL file, paramRev is set to the value in that SCL file. When EnerVista UR Setup changes
one or more settings, and prepares an SCL file, it increments paramRev to the next higher multiple of 10 000.

Each logical device has a name: LDName. (Note the upper case LD.) LDName has both a product-related form and
a function-related form as per IEC 61850 6:2009 8.5.3.
SCL files invariably use the product-related form of LDName. The product-related form is the concatenation of the
IED name of the device and the individual logical device's inst name. The IED name is the value of the "IED NAME"
setting on the Server Configuration panel, and the logical device inst names are each the value of the
corresponding "Product LD inst name" setting here. The "Product LD inst name" of the first logical device is fixed at
"Master".
Communications use the function-related form of LDName if a function-related name is defined, otherwise
communications use the product-related name. The function-related name is the value of the corresponding
"Functional ldName" setting if this setting is not empty, if empty the function-related name is not defined.
In SCL, the function-related name is specified by the LDevice element attribute ldName (note the lower case ld).
Absence of this attribute indicates the function-related name is not defined. In SCL the product-related name is
specified by the name attribute of the IED element and the inst attribute of the LDevice element.
In the right pane, logical nodes assigned permanently to the Master logical device and LLN0 in all logical devices are
greyed-out as shown earlier. These are not movable. Any other logical node can be dragged to any of the logical devices in
the middle pane, which causes that logical device to be re-assigned to that logical device. Right-clicking a logical node
device displays a menu that lists the logical devices that this logical node can be moved to. Clicking one of these re-assigns
the logical node. Other common keyboard and/or mouse action can be used to select one or more logical nodes and move
the selected nodes together.

5 Figure 5-51: Move logical node (Edition2)

GOOSE
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE.

Support for Routable GOOSE


Routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE) is supported in firmware release 7.4 and later for IEC 61850 Edition 2. Routable GOOSE allows
UR and other devices to be located in separate networks. Encryption/decryption of messages is performed by a separate
gateway device. Messages are routed using a separate router, using IP addresses.
Note the following behavior:
• A v7.4 device can send an R-GOOSE message to another v7.4 device when both have R-GOOSE active as the protocol
• A v7.4 device can send a GOOSE message to another v7.4 device when both have GOOSE active as the protocol

5-104 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

• A v7.4 device cannot send an R-GOOSE message to non-R-GOOSE devices, such as v7.3 or v5.9 UR device
• UR devices with firmware below v7.3 can send a GOOSE message to a v7.4 device that has GOOSE as the active
protocol

R-GOOSE is available through the IEC 61850 software option. If R-GOOSE security is required, the CyberSentry
software option also must be purchased.

TxGOOSE
IEC 61850 GOOSE is an efficient method for simultaneous high-speed delivery of generic substation event information by a
publishing device to more than one subscribing device. A TxGOOSE is a UR element implementing a single IEC 61850
GOOSE message publishing service. The subscribing function in URs is performed by RxGOOSE elements, as described in
the next section. Each UR with IEC 61850 order code options has 16 TxGOOSE elements. Each TxGOOSE can either use the
original format specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 or the routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE; IEC 61850 Edition 2) format specified in
IEC TR 61850-90-5:2012. Each TxGOOSE element can publish the values of up to 64 attributes of the IEC 61850 nodes in the
UR.
Published TxGOOSE messages configured in the EnerVista UR Setup software can be subscribed by and the published
operand values understood by other UR devices. Furthermore, they can be subscribed to and understood by any device of
any manufacturer that implements the IEC 61850 edition 1.0 or 2.0 GOOSE subscription mechanism. The messages are
published with a multicast address so that the network sends the messages to all devices; any number of devices that
want to subscribe can.
For wide area protection, control, and monitoring schemes, R-GOOSE wraps the proven original format GOOSE in IP/UDP to
multicast (or unicast) the data over a Wide Area Network (WAN). Sample applications are Wide area Remedial Action
Scheme (RAS) and Under Voltage/ Frequency Load Shedding Schemes (UVLS/UFLS). R GOOSE uses IGMPv3 (Internet Group 5
Management Protocol version-3, RFC 3376) for multicasting.
The entities whose values are published in GOOSE messages are known as members. The members are itemized in an
ordered list known as a data set. Each TxGOOSE can use any one of the configured data sets. (See the DataSets section
later for details.) The performance of a TxGOOSE is determined by its dataset. Booleans in fast GOOSE datasets are
designed for the TT6 transfer time class (3 ms), while Booleans in the Normal datasets are designed for the TT3 class (100
ms). Due to the significant amount of CPU time required to compose a TT6 TxGOOSE message and the limited amount of
time allowed by the TT6 class, at most four of these can be configured in a given UR. So only four fast GOOSE are allowed
to be configured, and the UR software has a check to disallow the use of more than four fast datasets in GOOSE. If six fast
datasets are configured outside of UR software and the file sent directly to the relay, the relay rejects the file. The design
does allow six fast datasets to be used in report control blocks, which allows fast scanned data in reports.
Each enabled TxGOOSE transmits its message whenever a value change is detected in one or more of its members. If the
changed value is a Boolean in a fast dataset, then the change detect occurs in the TT6 detection time of 3 ms or less. If the
member is an analog value in a fast dataset, the change detect occurs in theTT3 time of 100 ms. In Normal GOOSE
Datasets, change detection for all dataset members occurs in the TT3 time of 100 ms. To guard against the possibility that
such a message is lost in the network before it reaches all subscribers, the message is quickly retransmitted several times.
To allow subscribers to verify that their link to the publisher and the publisher itself are healthy, each message is also
retransmitted periodically even while the values are unchanging. These latter messages are known as heartbeat
messages, while the former are known as event messages. Heartbeat messages also provide means for a subscriber
newly online to receive the published values in the absence of an event.
The details of TxGOOSE message construction are contained in the UR Family Communications Guide. Knowledge of these
details is not required to configure GOOSE.
The UR does not implement the Fixed-Length encoded GOOSE messages option specified in IEC 61850-8-1:2011 clause
A.3; the UR always uses the ASN.1 Basic encoding rules (as specified in ISO/IEC 8825-1) as specified in IEC 61850 edition 1.0
and as optional in IEC 61850 edition 2.0.

Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > TxGOOSE > TxGOOSE1 to access the
settings for the first TxGOOSE. The settings and functionality for the others are similar.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-105


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-52: IEC 61850 TxGOOSE panel (Edition 2)

5
A data set needs to be set up and selected in the TxGOOSEx DatSet field for all content to display.
When saving changes, when a "dataset member is empty" message displays, you need to set the member in the bottom
right of the window.
TxGOOSE1 MODE
Range for Edition 2: Disabled, GOOSE, R-GOOSE
Range for Edition 1: Disabled, GOOSE
Default: Disabled
When set to Disabled, TxGOOSE1 messages are not published. When set to GOOSE, TxGOOSE1 messages are published
in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 GOOSE format. When set to R-GOOSE, TxGOOSE1 messages are published in Routable GOOSE
format according to IEC 61850 90-5, and the TxGOOSE1 DST MAC address is set to 00 00 00 00 00 00 and cannot be
changed.
TxGOOSE1 GoCB name
Range: 0 up to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: GoCB01
The entered value sets the GOOSE control block (GoCB) name value for TxGOOSE1.
An ObjectReference to the control block, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0." and the
control block name, is published in the gocbRef field of TxGOOSE1 messages and is used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. <LDName> is a syntactic variable that is set to the value of setting
Master functional ldName if one or more characters have been entered to that setting, otherwise the value of setting IED
NAME suffixed with "Master".

5-106 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

TxGOOSE1 GoID
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 65 VisibleString characters
Default: TxGOOSE1
The entered value sets the goID value published in TxGOOSE1 messages, and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
the TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. Special characters are not allowed, such as <, >, &, ’, and ".
TxGOOSE1 DatSet
Range: None, TT6DataSet1,TT6 DataSet2, … TT3DataSet01,TT3 DataSet02, …
Default: None
This setting selects the published data set using the UR Setup software designator for the data set. If None is selected,
no TxGOOSE1 messages are sent.
The IEC 61850 name of the data sets are configured in the Datasets panel, as described later.
Some datasets are designed for the TT6 transfer time class (3 ms), while others are designed for the TT3 class (100 ms).
The performance of a TxGOOSE is determined by its dataset. Use TT6 datasets for trips and blocking applications, TT3
datasets for slow automatic interactions. The 61850 name of the datasets are configured in the Datasets panel.
An ObjectReference to the data set, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0." and the data
set name, is published in the datSet field of TxGOOSE1 messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. <LDName> is a syntactic variable that is set to the value of setting
Master functional ldName if one or more characters have been entered to that setting, otherwise the value of setting IED
NAME suffixed with "Master".
To configure a DataSet, select it at the top of the window from the drop-down list. In the lower part of the window, drag
and drop configuration items to the right side. Dataset members configured here affect other Report or TxGOOSE
control blocks that use the same DataSet.
The performance of the TxGOOSE is determined by the performance of the selected dataset. When the selection is 5
TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, … it is possible that transient events can be missed.
TxGOOSE1 DST MAC
Range: any 12 digit hexadecimal number
Default: 01-0C-CD-01-00-00
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is R-GOOSE, the TxGOOSE1 DST MAC address is set to 00 00 00 00 00 00 and cannot be
changed. Otherwise, the value entered here sets the Ethernet destination Media Access Control (MAC) address in
published TxGOOSE1 messages. As the standard requires that the address have the multicast bit set TRUE, that is to say
the second digit is set to an odd number, messages transmitted have the multicast bit set TRUE no matter its value in
this setting.
The destination MAC address can be used by the network to restrict message delivery to selected devices that need to
receive them, reducing network load. This address also can be used by hardware in receiving devices to filter out
messages that are of no interest to them, reducing processor burden. Different filtering algorithms are implemented by
different devices. The standard recommends that the algorithm used by hardware of the receiving device be considered
when assigning destination multicast addresses.
Subscribers can use this address to discriminate TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages.
TxGOOSE1 VLAN PRIORITY
Range: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 5-4, 6-4, 6-5, 7-4, 7-5, 7-6
Default: 4
When the value entered is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7, the User Priority value in the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN tag included in published
TxGOOSE1 messages is set to that value. When one of the two-digit values is entered, the dynamic priority feature is
selected: the first event message has the User Priority value of the first digit, and User Priority is decremented in each
following message until reaching the value of the second digit. For instance, if the selected value is 7-5, then the User
Priority values in successive messages beginning with the message triggered by an event is 7, 6, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, and so on.
Do not make a dynamic priority selection when standard behavior is required.
Network devices can forward a message with a higher priority value before a message with a lower priority value, which
speeds delivery of high-priority messages in heavily loaded networks. The standard recommends that higher-priority
messages, such as GOOSE, have priority values in the range of 4 to 7.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-107


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

TxGOOSE1 VLAN ID
Range: 0 to 4095 in steps of 1
Default: 0
The value entered sets the VID value in the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN tag included in published TxGOOSE1 messages. VID can be
used by network devices to direct messages to only selected devices, reducing network burden. VID values of 0 and 1
are assigned by IEEE 802.1Q to other functions and are not to be used for GOOSE.
TxGOOSE1 ETYPE APPID
Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
Default: 0
The value entered sets the APPID value in published GOOSE messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages.
The standard reserves the value range 0 to 16383 for GOOSE Type 1 (Fast messages), and reserves the value range
32768 to 41151 for GOOSE Type 1A (Trip messages). Some subscribers can process messages in the Type 1A range
faster than messages in the Type 1 range. The standard reserves the default value (0) to indicate lack of configuration.
The standard strongly recommends unique, source-orientated APPIDs within a given system.
TxGOOSE1 CONFREV
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the confRev value in published GOOSE messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE messages of the expected configuration revision from messages of a different revision. The standard requires
that CONFREV be incremented each time the members or the order of the members published is changed. The standard
states that the value of 0 is reserved.

5 TxGOOSE1 RETRANS TIME


Range: 0 to 100 ms in steps of 1 ms
Default: 4 ms
If the entered time is non-zero, when a member value change is detected, four event transmissions are sent, then
heartbeat transmissions resume. The interval between the first and second event transmissions, and between the
second and third, is the time set here. The interval between the third and the fourth event transmission is double the set
time. If the entered time is zero, only a single event transmission occurs, then heartbeat transmissions resume.
TxGOOSE1 TIME TO LIVE
Range: 1 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 60 s
The value entered sets the timeAllowedtoLive value in published TxGOOSE1 messages. The standard requires
subscribers to assume a failure has occurred when another TxGOOSE1 message is not received within the published
timeAllowedtoLive time.
Base this setting on the TxGOOSE UPDATE TIME and the tolerable number of contiguous message delivery misses. For
example, if the heartbeat time is 10 s, and missing up to three successive messages is tolerable, make the setting
10 * 3 + 1 = 31 s. The extra second is to ensure that arrival of the third heartbeat transmission beats the
timeAllowedtoLive timer.
In the imported CID file, if the TxGOOSE1 TIME TO LIVE is greater than 60 seconds, clamp the setting value to 60 seconds
and an information log is provided in SCL log.
TxGOOSE1 UPDATE TIME
Range: 1 to 59 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the time interval between heartbeat messages, meaning messages that are sent periodically while
no events are detected.
TxGOOSE1 PORT ASSIGNMENT
Range: Disabled, Port-1; Port-2; Port-3; Ports-1,2; Ports-2,3; Ports-1,3; Ports-1,2,3
Default: Ports-1, 2, 3
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.

5-108 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

This setting specifies the Ethernet ports for transmission of TxGOOSE1. When set to disabled, TxGOOSE1 messages are
not transmitted on any port no matter the state of GoEna. When set to Port-1, TxGOOSE1 is published over Ethernet
Port-1 only; while selecting Ports-1, 3 option, the same TxGOOSE1 is published to both Ports 1 and 3; and similarly if set
to Ports-1, 2, 3, all ports publish TxGOOSE1.

When setting PRT2 REDUNDANCY to Failover or to PRP, the TxGOOSE 1 port assignment needs to be set to ports 2
and 3 (Ports-2,3).
Also, Port 3 configuration in the CID file is ignored. The Port 3 ConnectedAP elements has no meaning, as ports 2
and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask.
R-TxGOOSE1 IP CLASS
Range: 0 to 256 in steps of 1
Default: 46
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise this setting
selects the IPv4 Differentiated Services Code Point-DSCP (formerly called TypeOfService-TOS) value. This value provides
priority routing, when supported in the routers. The default value is for Expedited Forwarding (101110B, 46 or 2EH).
R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 224.0.0.0
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise this setting
specifies destination IP address for the R-TXGOOSE1 that is entered in Standard IPV4 address format. The destination IP
address needs to be a valid multicast or unicast IP address. The value specified in this setting is mapped to IPv4 header
32 bit field for Destination IP Address while publishing R-GOOSE1. 5
The default IP address 224.0.0.0 is reserved, and hence not a valid multicast IP address.
The source IP address is that of the UR port from which the R-GOOSE messages are transmitted.
R-TxGOOSE1 SECURITY
Range: None, Signature, SignatureAndEncryption
Default: None
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
This setting specifies level of security (authentication/encryption) used for TxGOOSE1. None specifies no security
mechanisms are to be used. Signature specifies only signature (no encryption) is to be used. SignatureAndEncryption
specifies that both signature and encryption are to be used.

RxGOOSE
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Messages.
IEC 61850, GOOSE is an efficient method for simultaneous high-speed delivery of the same generic substation event
information by a publishing device to more than one subscribing device. An RxGOOSE is a UR element implementing a
single IEC 61850 GOOSE message subscribing service. The publishing function in URs is performed by TxGOOSE elements,
as described in the previous section.
Each UR with the IEC 61850 order code option has 64 RxGOOSE elements. Each RxGOOSE element can subscribe to GOOSE
messages from a specified publisher. Each RxGOOSE can either use the original format specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 or
the routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE; IEC 61850 Edition 2) format specified in IEC TR 61850-90-5:2012. Subscribed message
members can be DataObjects, SubDataObjects, DataAttributes or SubAttributes. In E2-2.0 mode members are restricted to
basic types BOOLEAN, FLOAT32, INT32, Dbpos, TimeStamp or Quality. Each subscribed message can contain up to 64
values. A member can be a structure containing several values; note that it is the number of values rather than the number
of members that are limited to 64.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-109


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

GOOSE messages from any device of any manufacturer that implements the IEC 61850 Edition 1.0 or 2.0 GOOSE publish
service or the 61850-90-5 R-GOOSE service (IEC 61850 Edition 2) can be subscribed to. The UR accepts both the variable
length encoded GOOSE messages specified IEC 61850 8 1:2004 and the Fixed-Length encoded GOOSE messages as
specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 clause A.3.
Each enabled RxGOOSE monitors for interruption of the GOOSE messages it subscribes to based on the value in the
timeAllowedtoLive field of the last message received. If a new message is not received within that time interval, the
RxGOOSE assumes that connectivity is lost. FlexLogic operands (for example RxGOOSE1 On, RxGOOSE1 Off) reflect the
status of each RxGOOSE connectivity. An RxGOOSE connection is also considered lost after the UR finishes restart until a
message is received. While any RxGOOSE connectivity is lost, a common RxGOOSE Fail self-test is activated.
Messages that contain the value true in the ndsCom field are never accepted. Messages that contain the value true in the
simulation field (test field in edition 1.0 messages) are accepted only when the UR Test Mode Function setting is set to
Forcible or Isolated.
RxGOOSE messages can be received through any UR Ethernet port.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Messages >
RxGOOSE1 to access the settings that specify the messages to be accepted by the first RxGOOSE element. The settings
and functionality for the other RxGOOSE are similar. The following settings are available. They allow RxGOOSE1 to
recognize the GOOSE messages it is to accept. Most of these settings are automatically configured by UR Setup software
when an association to an RxGOOSE Boolean Input, RxGOOSE DPS Input, and/or RxGOOSE Analog Input is made as
described in the sections following this. For IEC 61850 Edition 2, settings R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE, R-RxGOOSE1
SECURITY, and R-RxGOOSE SRC IP need to be manually completed as the information is not contained in publisher SCL.
Figure 5-53: IEC 61850 RxGOOSE Messages panel (Edition 2)

RxGOOSE1 MODE
Range for Edition 2: GOOSE, R-GOOSE
Range for Edition 1: GOOSE
Default: GOOSE
When set to GOOSE, TxGOOSE1 messages are published in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 GOOSE format. When set to R-GOOSE,
TxGOOSE1 messages are published in Routable GOOSE format according to IEC 61850 90-5. When set to R-GOOSE, the
R-RxGOOSE DST IP needs to be a valid multicast or unicast IP address.

5-110 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

RxGOOSE1 goID
Range: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
If the entered value has one or more characters, the goID field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this
value for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. If the entered value is the empty string, RxGOOSE1
does not check the value received in the goID field. Special characters are not allowed, such as <, >, &, ’, and ".
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, this setting needs match the value of the publisher's TxGOOSE GoID setting.
RxGOOSE1 Dst MAC
Range: any 12 digit hexadecimal number
Default: 01-0C-CD-01-00-00
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used, the destination Media Access
Control (MAC) address for RxGOOSE1 messages is calculated based on the RxGOOSE DST IP address. Otherwise, set this
setting to the MAC address of the publisher. Only received GOOSE messages having a MAC address equal to this value
are accepted as valid RxGOOSE1 messages. An entered address of zero disables RxGOOSE1.
If the publisher is a UR series 7.3x device, the setting needs to match the value of the publisher’s TxGOOSE DST MAC
setting.
RxGOOSE1 ETYPE APPID
Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
Default: 0
If the value entered is non-zero, the APPID field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the
message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. If the value entered is zero, RxGOOSE1 does not check the value
received in the APPID field.
If the publisher is a UR series 7.3x device, the setting needs to match the value of the publisher’s TxGOOSE ETYPE APPID
setting. 5
RxGOOSE1 GoCBRef
Range: 0 to 129 alphanumeric, underscore, slash and period characters, beginning with an alpha character
The gocbRef field of incoming GOOSE messages must match this value for the message to be accepted as a valid
RxGOOSE1 message. If the entered value is the empty string, RxGOOSE1 is disabled. If not the empty string, the entry
needs to be an ACSI ObjectReference to the publishing control block in the format:
<LDName>/LLN0.<GoCBName>
where <LDName> is the function-related name if the logical device containing the publishing control block has "ldName"
configured, otherwise the product-related name of that logical device, and <GoCBName> is the name of the publishing
control block.
The F35 translates the ACSI format required for this setting to the MMS format used in GOOSE messages:
<LDName>/LLN0$GO$<GoCBName>
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x or 7.40 series device, <LDName> is the value of the publisher's Master functional ldName
setting if that setting is not empty, otherwise it is the value of the publisher's IED NAME suffixed with "Master". If the
publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, <GoCBName> is "GoCB" suffixed with the two digit TxGOOSE instance number, for
example "GoCB01". If the publisher is a UR 7.40 series device, <GoCBName> is as specified earlier in the TxGOOSE
section of this chapter.
RxGOOSE1 datSet
Range: 0 to 32 alphanumeric and underscore characters, beginning with an alpha character
Default: empty string
If the entered value has one or more characters, the datSet field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this
value prefixed by <LDName>/LLN0$ for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. <LDName> is as
specified in the RxGOOSE GoCBRef setting above. If the entered value is the empty string, RxGOOSE1 does not check the
value received in the datSet field.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, set this setting to the value of the publisher's DataSetxx name setting, where xx
is the instance number of the data set selected by the publisher's TxGOOSE datSet setting. If the publisher is a UR 7.40
series device, datSet is as specified in the DataSets section of this chapter.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-111


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

RxGOOSE1 ConfRev
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
If the value entered is non-zero, the confRev field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the
message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. If the entered value is zero, RxGOOSE1 does not check the value
received in the confRev field.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, set this setting to match the value of the publisher's TxGOOSE ConfRev setting.
R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE
Range: SSM, ASM, Unicast
Default: SSM
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise it selects the
R-GOOSE reception mode.
R-RxGOOSE RECEPTION MODE specifies the R-RxGOOSE DST IP range. When set to SSM, R-RxGOOSE DST IP must be in
the range of 232.0.0.1 to 232.255.255.255. When set to ASM, R-RxGOOSE DST IP must be in the range of 224.0.0.1 to
239.255.255.255, excluding the SSM range. Note that the SSM range is inside the ASM range and therefore the ASM use
excludes the SSM range. The default destination IP address 224.0.0.0 is reserved, and hence not a valid multicast IP
address.
The reception modes are related to Layer-3 R-GOOSE reception from routers/WAN. The subscription to multicasting of R-
GOOSE is supported using IGMP Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM). It is made available in either Source Specific
Multicast (SSM) mode or Any Source Multicast (ASM) mode. Unicast (over UDP) mode can also be used. In case of
multicasting (IGMPv3 based SSM or ASM), the R-GOOSE subscriber device requests the Last Hop Router (LHR) to
subscribe to a specific multicasting group.
5 If the publisher is using a unicast destination IP address for this R-GOOSE, then set R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE to
Unicast. Otherwise set R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE to the SSM or ASM mode used by the local routers/firewalls.
R-RxGOOSE1 SRC IP
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 127.0.0.1
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. When the RxGOOSE1
MODE setting is R-GOOSE and the R-RxGOOSE RECEPTION MODE setting is ASM, the value of this setting is not used.
Otherwise the Source IP Address field of incoming R-GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the message to
be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. Set this setting to the value of the source IP address used by the publisher.
For UR publishers, this value is in setting PRT# IP ADDRESS.
The UR does not validate the address entered. The default IP address 127.0.0.1 is a reserved, not a valid IP address. Enter
a valid IP source address.
R-RxGOOSE1 DST IP
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 224.0.0.0
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise the
Destination IP Address field of incoming R GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the message to be
accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. Set this setting to the same value as the R-GOOSE publisher's Destination IP
Address. For UR publishers, this value is in setting R-TxGOOSE# DST IP.
The destination IP address needs to be a valid multicast or unicast IP address. The UR does not validate the address
entered. The default IP address 224.0.0.0 is reserved, and hence not a valid multicast IP address.
R-RxGOOSE1 SECURITY
Range: None, Signature, SignatureAndEncryption
Default: None
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.

5-112 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

This setting specifies the level of security (authentication/encryption) used for RxGOOSE1. None indicates no security
mechanisms are in use. Signature indicates only signature (no encryption) is in use. SignatureAndEncryption indicates
that both signature and encryption are in use. Normally this setting is set to match the GOOSE publisher's security
method.
RxGOOSE1 Member 1
Range: End of List, BOOLEAN, FLOAT32, INT32, Dbpos (DPS), Quality, TimeStamp, Struct
Default: End of List
This setting specifies the type that the first member of incoming GOOSE messages must be for the message to be
accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. There are similar settings for each of the up to 64 members that the UR is able
to subscribe to in a given GOOSE message. The member before the first member setting set to "End of List" must be the
last member of the message for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x or 7.40 series device, set these settings to match the basic type of the members of the
publisher's data set selected by the publisher's TxGOOSE datSet setting.
If the publisher dataset includes members with structured data, that is, data attributes, sub-data objects, and/or data
attributes with sub-data attributes, configuration must use one of the new 7.40 UR Setup RxGOOSE Inputs pages. In this
case the Member setting displays as the product-related name used by the publishing IED of the data object or data
attribute, in standard SCSM format (e.g. Publisher1LD1/LLN0$ST$Off$stVal).
Note that a dataset can hold at most 64 basic data attribute values, and that a single structured data object or attribute
can contain multiple basic data attribute values. UR Setup software does not allow more that 64 basic data attribute
values to be entered, in which case the last several members settings cannot be changed from End of List.
Note that the publisher's name alone does not contain all the information required for subscription, additional publisher
information model information is stored elsewhere. For this reason, manual entry of the name is not supported.

RxGOOSE inputs
5
The values received by RxGOOSE elements need to be converted to FlexLogic or FlexAnalog operands so that they can be
used by other UR elements. This conversion is done by RxGOOSE Boolean, RxGOOSE DPS, and RxGOOSE Analog elements.
Each RxGOOSE Boolean can convert the value of a specified Boolean value received by a specified RxGOOSE to a FlexLogic
operand. Each RxGOOSE DPS can convert the value of a specified Dbpos (Double bit position) value to four FlexLogic
operands, one for each of the four possible Dbpos states. Each RxGOOSE Analog can convert the value of a specified
FLOAT32 member to a FlexAnalog operand. Each of these operands reverts to its default state when the RxGOOSE
connectivity is lost. Other types of values can be present in subscribed GOOSE messages, but cannot be converted to
operands.
When an RxGOOSE Input is mapped to a value in the GOOSE message, the associated q value is validated, if the q value is
included in that GOOSE message as part of the data object.
The RxGOOSE Input value is reverted to its default value, if the associated:
• q.validity is invalid
• or q.test bit is set and the relay test mode is disabled
When the test mode function is Forcible or Isolated, the q.test bit is not validated. That means, when the relay is in Test or
Test/blocked mode, the q.test = False is treated same as q.test = True.
RxGOOSE Boolean, RxGOOSE DPS, and RxGOOSE Analog elements are mapped to various data objects in
<iedName>Master/GGIO3. This is to allow reading of their values via MMS and to allow references to them in SCL files.
GGIO3 has no settings, nor is it visible in the UR Setup software. See the UR Family Communications Guide for more
information on GGIO3.

RxGOOSE Boolean inputs


Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Boolean Inputs.
The number of RxGOOSE Boolean (remote inputs) is 256.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-113


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

There are Add IED and Remove IED buttons. The Add IED button allows SCL files to be used, including ICD, CID, and SCD
(supported in version 7.40 and later). With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must
match one IP address of the device, while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must
match. When the file format is SCD, the system lists all IEDs inside the SCD file and lets the user select the ones to add. The
figure shows a selection being made by importing a CID file using the Add IED function.
Figure 5-54: RxGOOSE Boolean panel (Edition 2)

Most of the settings are configured by drag-and-drop. However the ID, DEFAULT STATE, and EVENTS settings must be
individually entered when the factory default values are not acceptable.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG Bool1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the name of the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. The full
operand name is the value of this setting appended with " On". The basic and enhanced front panels display the first 17
characters of this setting plus " On" to fit the 20 character display.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 RxGOOSE
Range: None, RxGOOSE1, RxGOOSE2, and so on
Default: None
This setting selects the RxGOOSE containing the value that drives the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. If set to
None, the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand assumes its default state.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 Member
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting selects the GOOSE message member that drives the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. A setting of 1
selects the first member, 2 selects the second member, and so on. Entering a number greater than the number of
members in the message and entering the number of a member which does not contain a BOOLEAN results in the
RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand assuming its default state. The Subscribed to column identifies the particular
Boolean subscribed to even if the member is a structure containing more than one Boolean.

5-114 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

RxGOOSE Boolean1 DEFAULT STATE


Range: On, Off, Latest/On, Latest/Off
Default: Off
This setting selects the logic state for the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand if the UR has just completed startup and
the selected RxGOOSE has not yet received a message, or the selected RxGOOSE has lost its connectivity with the
publisher. The following choices are available:
– "On" value defaults the input to logic 1
– "Off" value defaults the input to logic 0
– "Latest/On" freezes the input in case of lost connectivity. If the latest state is unknown, such as after UR power-up
but before the first communication, the input defaults to logic 1. When communication resumes, the input
becomes fully operational.
– "Latest/Off" freezes the input in case of lost connectivity. If the latest state is unknown, such as after UR power-up
but before the first communication, the input defaults to logic 0. When communication resumes, the input
becomes fully operational.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting selects whether Off to On transitions of the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand are recorded by the event
recorder. If set to Enabled, Off to On transitions are recorded. On to Off transitions are never recorded, even if events are
enabled.

RxGOOSE DPS inputs


Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 618560 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE DPS Inputs.
5
There are Add IED and Remove IED buttons. The Add IED button allows SCL files to be used, including ICD, CID, and SCD
(supported in version 7.40 and later). With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must
match one IP address of the device, while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must
match. When the file format is SCD, the system lists all IEDs inside the SCD file and lets the user select the ones to add.
Figure 5-55: RxGOOSE DPS Inputs panel (Edition 2)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-115


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

RxGOOSE DPS1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG DPS1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the names of the four RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operands. The
full operand name is the value of this setting appended with "Interm," "On," "Off," or "Bad." The basic and enhanced front
panels display the first 13 characters of this setting plus the state suffix to fit the 20 character display.
RxGOOSE DPS1 RxGOOSE
Range: None, RxGOOSE1, RxGOOSE2, and so on
Default: None
This setting selects the GOOSE message containing the value that drives the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand. If set to
None, the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand assumes its default state.
RxGOOSE DPS1 Member
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting selects the GOOSE message member that drives the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand. A setting of 1 selects
the first member, 2 selects the second member, and so on. Entering a number greater than the number of members in
the message and entering the number of a member that is not a Dbpos results in the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand
assuming its default state. In the case that the member is a structure containing more than one Dbpos, the Subscribed
to column identifies the particular Dbpos subscribed to.
RxGOOSE DSP1 DEFAULT STATE
Range: Intermediate-state, Off, On, Bad-state, Latest
Default: Latest

5 This setting selects the logic state for the data attribute @Master/GGIO3.IndPos01.stVal and the DPS FlexLogic operands
when the UR has just completed start-up and the selected RxGOOSE has not yet received a message, and when the
RxGOOSE has lost its connection with the publisher. When this setting is selected to Latest, the value of @Master/
GGIO3.IndPosψψ.stVal is Intermediate-state when the UR has just completed start-up and the selected RxGOOSE has
not yet received a message, and the latest received value when the RxGOOSE loses its connectivity with the publisher.
RxGOOSE DPS1 EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting selects whether Off to On transitions of the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operands are recorded by the event
recorder. If set to Enabled, Off to On transitions are recorded. On to Off transitions are never recorded, even if events are
enabled.

RxGOOSE analog inputs


Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Analog Inputs.
There are Add IED and Remove IED buttons. The Add IED button allows SCL files to be used, including ICD, CID, and SCD
(supported in version 7.40 and later). With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must
match one IP address of the device, while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must
match. When the file format is SCD, the system lists all IEDs inside the SCD file and lets the user select the ones to add.

5-116 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-56: RxGOOSE Analog Inputs panel (Edition 2)

There are 32 RxGOOSE analog inputs.


RxGOOSE Analog1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG Analog1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to RxGOOSE Analog1. Unlike RxGOOSE Booleans and RxGOOSE
DPS, the RxGOOSE Analog operands have fixed names, for example RxGOOSE Analog1.
5
RxGOOSE Analog1 RxGOOSE
Range: None, RxGOOSE1, RxGOOSE2, and so on
Default: None
This setting selects the GOOSE message that drives the RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexAnalog operand. If set to None, the
RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexAnalog operand assumes its default state.
RxGOOSE Analog1 Member
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting selects the GOOSE message member that drives the RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexAnalog operand. A setting of 1
selects the first member, 2 selects the second member, and so on. Entering a number greater than the number of
members in the message and entering the number of a member that does not contain a FLOAT32 results in the
RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexAnalog operand assuming its default state. The Subscribed to column identifies the particular
FLOAT32 subscribed to even if the member is a structure containing more than one FLOAT32.
RxGOOSE Analog1 DEFAULT
Range: -1000000.000 to 1000000.000 in steps of 0.001
Default: 1000.000
This setting specifies the value of the GOOSE analog input when the selected RxGOOSE has lost its connectivity with the
publisher and the RxGOOSE Analog1 DEFAULT MODE is set to "Default Value." Otherwise this setting has no effect. This
setting is stored as an IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating point number. Because of the large range of this setting, not all
possible values can be stored. Some values can be rounded to the closest possible floating point number.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-117


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

RxGOOSE Analog1 DEFAULT MODE


Range: Default Value, Last Known
Default: Default Value
When the selected RxGOOSE has lost its connectivity with the publisher and this setting is "Last Known," the value of the
RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexLogic operand remains at the last received value. When the selected RxGOOSE has lost its
connectivity with the publisher and this setting value is "Default Value," then the RxGOOSE Analog1 FlexLogic operand is
defined by the RxGOOSE Analog1 DEFAULT setting. After restart, until a message is received, the operand value is the
default value.
RxGOOSE Analog1 UNITS
Range: up to 4 characters
Default: empty string
This setting specifies a four-character string that is used in the actual values display of RxGOOSE Analog1.
RxGOOSE Analogs are floating-point values, with no units. The RxGOOSE UNIT and PU base settings allow the user to
configure RxGOOSE Analog, so that it can be used in a FlexElement.
RxGOOSE Analogs that represent current, voltage, power, frequency, angles, or power factor can be used in a
FlexElement. The following text must be used in the UNITS setting, to represent these types of analogs: A, V, W, var, VA,
Hz, deg, and no text (blank setting) for power factor.
RxGOOSE Analogs can be compared to other RxGOOSE Analogs with any character string or no string.
RxGOOSE Analog1 PU Base in kilo
Range: 0.000 to 1000000000.000 in steps of 0.001
Default: 1.000
This setting specifies the per-unit base value for other F35 features to use with the RxGOOSE Analog1 operand. A
5 FlexElement for instance subtracts two quantities after converting their values to integers rescaled to a common base,
the common base being the largest of the base values of the two quantities. If one of quantities is RxGOOSE Analog1 and
its per-unit base value is not appropriate, the rescaling operation can result in unnecessary loss of precision or overflow
in the integer result. The FlexElement Base Units table in the Settings > FlexLogic > FlexElements section later, which
tabulates the per-unit base value used by its pickup setting and implies the per-unit base used by other FlexAnalogs, can
be of use in selecting a value for the RxGOOSE Analog1 PU setting.
Some UR elements have requirements for the type of input operands, for instance current type or voltage type. These
elements assume that RxGOOSE Analog operands are of whatever type is necessary to meet these requirements.
The per-unit base setting represents thousands, not single units. For example, a PU base of 1.000 is actually 1000 and a
PU base of 0.001 is 1.
When using RxGOOSE Analogs and PU base in FlexElements, the largest value that can be displayed in the FlexElement
actual values is 2,140,000.000.

Reports
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Reports.

Report settings
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Reports > Report Settings.
ReportSettings rptID
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the RptID attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false. The RptID is the name of the report.
ReportSettings optFields
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the OptFlds attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.

5-118 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

ReportSettings bufTime
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the BufTm attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.
ReportSettings trgOps
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the TrgOps attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.
ReportSettings intgPd
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the IntgPd attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.

Buffered and unbuffered reports


Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Reports > Buffered Reports or Unbuffered
Reports.
Figure 5-57: IEC 61850 buffered report panel

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-119


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

An IEC 61850 Report server is an efficient method to deliver generic substation event information from a single server to a
single client, such as a supervisory control IED. A Configurable Report is a UR element implementing an IEC 61850 Report
server, either of the buffered or unbuffered kind. The following table lists the number of Configurable Report elements.
Each Configurable Report element can report the values of up to 64 FlexLogic or FlexAnalog operands. Buffered report
elements queue value changes that occur while the client is offline and delivered when the client re-connects. Up to 512
events can be queued. Unbuffered control blocks purge all value change events when the connection to the client is lost;
any events that occur while the client is not connected are lost.
Table 5-13: Number of report elements
Number
Buffered reports 30
Unbuffered reports 18

When using IEC 61850 Edition 2, configurable Reports interoperate with any client device of any manufacturer that
conforms to the IEC 61850 edition 1.0 or 2.0 report client requirements.
When using IEC 61850 Edition 1, configurable Reports interoperate with any client device of any manufacturer that
conforms to the IEC 61850 edition 1.0 report client requirements.
The entities whose values are reported by a Configurable Report are known as members. The members are itemized in an
ordered list known as a data set. Each Configurable Report can use any one of the data sets provided that no more than
four data sets are used for reports. This restriction is to limit the amount of processing power that can be allocated to
reporting.
Each enabled Configurable Report transmits an update to its client whenever a value change is detected in one or more of
its members. Also, the control block can be configured to send integrity reports containing the present value of all
members either on demand from the client or periodically. A TCP handshaking mechanism causes messages that are not
5 read and acknowledged by the client to be retransmitted.
For a Configurable Report to operate, its members must be selected (that is, its data set configured) and a client must open
a connection to, configure, and enable its report control block. Control blocks and data sets can be pre-configured by
sending the F35 a CID file. See the UR Family Communications Guide for details. EnerVista UR Setup also can be used to
select the data set members and to pre-configure the control blocks.
Each buffered report has the following settings.
Buffered Report1 RptID
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 65 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
The name of the report. The entered value sets the RptID value in Buffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by the
client to discriminate Buffered Report1 messages from other messages. If the number of characters entered is zero, the
value used for RptID in messages is an ObjectReference to the report's control block, that is, "<LDName>/
LLN0$BR$"BRCB01".
Buffered Report1 Name
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: BRCB01
The entered value sets the report control block name value for Buffered Report1.
Buffered Report1 DatSet
Range: None, TT6DataSet1, TT6 DataSet2, …, TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, …
Default: None
This setting selects the data set whose members' status is reported in Buffered Report1 messages using the UR Setup
software designator for the data set. The IEC 61850 name of the data sets are configured in the Datasets panel, as
described later.
An ObjectReference to the data set, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0$" and the data
set name, is used in the datSet field of report messages, and it can be used by the client to discriminate Buffered Report1
messages from other messages.

5-120 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The performance of the report is determined by the performance of the selected dataset. When the selection is
TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, … it is possible that transient events can be missed.
To configure a DataSet, select it at the top of the window from the drop-down list, for example DataSet02 shown in the
previous figure. In the lower part of the window, drag and drop configuration items to the right side. For example select
the ST Ind001 stVal item and drag it to DataSet Member 1. Dataset members configured here affect other Report or
TxGOOSE control blocks that use the same DataSet.
Buffered Report1 ConfRev
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the confRev value in Buffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by clients to discriminate
report messages of the expected configuration revision from messages of a different revision. The standard requires
that confRev be incremented each time the members or the order of the members is changed, and each time the data
set name is changed. The standard states that the value of 0 is reserved.
Buffered Report1 OptFlds
Range: The check box for each individual bit can be enabled or not (see figure)
Default: All bits enabled/ true
The OptFlds setting is bitstring that controls which of the optional fields are included in report messages. The figure
shows the available option bits. To reduce message size, uncheck any fields that are not needed.
Figure 5-58: Options for buffered report messages (Edition 2)

Buffered Report1 BufTm


Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 0 ms
The entered value sets the time interval in milliseconds for the buffering of events for inclusion in a single report.
Buffered Report1 TrgOps
Range: The check box for an individual bit can be enabled or not
Default: All bits enabled / true
The TrgOps setting is bitstring that controls which trigger conditions are monitored in this report. The options are as
follows. Uncheck any trigger conditions that are not needed.
– data-change
– quality-change
– integrity
– general interrogation (IEC 61850 Edition 2)
Buffered Report1 IntgPd
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 0 ms
The entered value sets the period in milliseconds for generating Buffered Report1 integrity reports. An integrity report
includes the values of all members of the referenced data set, whether a change has occurred or not.

Each unbuffered report has the following settings.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-121


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Unbuffered Report1 RptID


Range for Edition 2: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 65 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
The name of the report. The entered value sets the RptID value in Unbuffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by
the client to discriminate Unbuffered Report1 messages from other messages. If the number of characters entered is
zero, the value used for RptID in messages is an ObjectReference to the report's control block, that is, "<LDName>/
LLN0$RP$"URCB01".
Unbuffered Report1 Name
Range: 0 up to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: URCB01
The entered value sets the report control block name value for Unbuffered Report1.
Unbuffered Report1 DatSet
Range: None, TT6DataSet1, TT6 DataSet2, …, TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, …
Default: None
This setting selects the data set whose members' status is reported in Unbuffered Report1 messages using the UR Setup
software designator for the data set. The IEC 61850 name of the data sets are configured in the Datasets panel, as
described later.
An ObjectReference to the data set, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0$" and the data
set name, is used in the datSet field of report messages, and it can be used by the client to discriminate Unbuffered
Report1 messages from other messages.
The performance of the report is determined by the performance of the selected dataset. When the selection is
TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, … it is possible that transient events can be missed.
5 Unbuffered Report1 ConfRev
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the confRev value in Unbuffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by clients to discriminate
report messages of the expected configuration revision from messages of a different revision. The standard requires
that confRev be incremented each time the members or the order of the members is changed, and each time the data
set name is changed. The standard states that the value of 0 is reserved.
Unbuffered Report1 OptFlds
Range: The check box for an individual bit can be enabled or not
Default: All bits enabled / true
The OptFlds setting is bitstring that controls which of the optional fields are included in report messages. The options are
as follows. To reduce message size, uncheck any fields that are not needed.
– sequence-number
– report-time-stamp
– reason-for-inclusion
– data-set-name
– data-reference
– conf-revision
For IEC 61850 Edition 2, the OptFlds bits buffer-overflow and entryID also listed are not applicable to unbuffered reports
even though the bits exist in the protocol. They are unchecked by default.
For IEC 61850 Edition 1, the entryID also listed is not applicable to unbuffered reports even though the bits exist in the
protocol. It is unchecked by default.
Unbuffered Report1 BufTm
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 0 ms
The entered value sets the time interval in milliseconds for the buffering of events for inclusion into a single report.

5-122 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Unbuffered Report1 TrgOps


Range: The check box for an individual bit can be enabled or not
Default: All bits enabled / true
The TrgOps setting is bitstring that controls which trigger conditions are monitored in this report. The options are as
follows. Uncheck any trigger conditions that are not needed.
– data-change
– quality-change
– integrity
– general interrogation (IEC 61850 Edition 2)
Unbuffered Report1 IntgPd
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 0 ms
The entered value sets the period in milliseconds for generating Unbuffered Report1 integrity reports. An integrity report
includes the values of all members of the referenced data set, whether a change has occurred or not.

DataSets
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > DataSets.
As mentioned in the preceding GOOSE and Reports sections, the members whose values are communicated by these
services are itemized in an ordered list known as a data set. Each UR with the IEC 61850 option has 18 data sets (six fast
and 12 slow). Each data set can contain as many as 64 members. Any data set can be used simultaneously by any number
of TxGOOSE elements and/or by any number of Configurable Report elements. UR Setup software can configure any
FlexLogic operands and any FlexAnalog operands as members.
Figure 5-59: IEC 61850 DataSets (Edition 2) 5

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-123


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

UR Setup software requires data set members to be IEC 61850 data objects or data attributes with Functional Constraint
ST or MX. Certain FlexLogic and FlexAnalog operands have factory-assigned data attributes as tabulated in the UR Family
Communications Guide. All FlexLogic and FlexAnalog operands can be user-assigned to GGIO1 or GGIO4 data attributes,
so that operands without factory-assigned data attributes can still have their values published. See the GGIO1 and GGIO4
sections later for details.
Datasets used by TxGOOSE1, TxGOOSE2, and/or by reports also provide a chatter suppression service for their Boolean
members. Oscillation in a value, also known as chatter, can be caused by errors in logic programming, inadequate
hysteresis (deadband) on a threshold, or a failed station component. Chatter can flood a communications network with
GOOSE messages, degrading response time for all users. If chatter is detected in a Boolean member, TxGOOSE suspends
GOOSE event message triggering and report message triggering from that member for as long as the condition exists, and
for a minimum period of one second. While sending is suspended, a self-test message identifying the specific data item
detected as oscillating is activated.
For a summary of the panels in which the data sets are used, the path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications >
IEC 61850 > DataSets > Summary.
For the settings, navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > DataSets > TT6DataSet1 for the
first data set.
Copy and paste functions are available when right-clicking a DataSet. They allow the target dataset to be configured
based on its order code. If some dataset items are not supported, they are not pasted, and a warning message shows a list
of dataset items that were not supported and not pasted. The DataSet name is not copied or pasted. In short, use this
feature to copy a DataSet Member setting and paste it into another Member setting, a text file, or Word, as examples.
Figure 5-60: Member right-click

DataSet01 name
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: DataSet01
The value entered sets the name of the data set, which is required to be unique within the UR for proper operation. The
value entered sets the name of the data set, which is required to be unique within the UR for proper operation. Fast
datasets start with TT6, and slow datasets start with TT3. Up to six fast datasets are allowed. Up to four fast GOOSE
datasets are allowed.

5-124 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

An ObjectReference to the data set consists of a string that is the concatenation of "<LDName>/LLN0$" and the
DataSet01 name setting value. An ObjectReference to the data set is published in the datSet field of TxGOOSE messages,
and it can be used by subscribers to discriminate the messages of that TxGOOSE from other GOOSE messages. An
ObjectReference to the data set is optionally published in the DatSet field of Report messages. Valid characters are
upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first character must be a letter.
DataSet01 shared by
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default:
Names of all control blocks that use this DataSet. Read-only field.
DataSet01 Member1
Range: End of List or any instantiated 61850 data object or data attribute with Functional Constraint ST or MX
Default: End of List
This setting specifies the first member in TxGOOSE1 messages. There is a similar setting for each of the up to 64
members that the UR allows in a Dataset. Only values of members before the first set to End of List are published.
Select the member from the drop-down list. Or right-click an entry to copy, paste, delete, or insert.

Product setup
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Product Setup.

Security
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Product Setup > Security.
Figure 5-61: IEC 61850 Security 5

SecGSAL1.SecDataClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model that clients must use to clear security data via commands to
SecGSAL1.SecDataClr. "sbo" here is select-before-operate.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-125


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

SecGSAL1.OpCntRs ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model that clients must use to clear security data via commands to SecGSAL1.OpCntRs.
"sbo" here is select-before-operate.

Demand
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the Demand metering are configured here.

Energy
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the Energy metering are configured here.

Real Time Clock


This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Product Setup > Real Time Clock.
Figure 5-62: IEC 61850 Real Time Clock

TmClkLTMS1.TmnsDelta.db
Range: 0.000 to 100.000 %
Default: 0.000 %
This setting is a deadband setting and is used by the relay to determine when to update the "mag" and "cVal" values
from the associated "instMag" and "instCVal" values. The value shall represent the percentage of difference between
maximum and minimum in units of 0.001%. The minimum and maximum values for TmnsDelta data object are
-500000000 ns and 500000000 ns respectively and for example, a setting value of 0.002% results in the dead banded
value of (500000000 - (-500000000)) * 0.002 / 100 = 20000 ns. The default setting value of 0.000% does not update the
"mag" and "cVal" values.

Deadband settings
A deadband is a range in which no action occurs, usually expressed as a percentage.
The IEC 61850 panels contain hundreds of deadband settings, such as in the following panels: Product Setup > Real Time
Clock, FlexLogic, Control Elements, and GGIO4. Each panel is not outlined here. The FlexLogic category applies to IEC 61850
Edition 2.

5-126 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Deadband setting names all end either with "DB" or .db. As they all work the same way, but each on a different analog
value, a single description applicable to all deadband settings is given here. The analog value that each deadband setting
applies is usually obvious from the name of the setting. However, a tabulation of the analog values and their associated
deadband setting can be found in the UR Family Communications Guide.
Figure 5-63: Deadband settings with .db suffix (Edition 2)

GOOSE, buffered report, and unbuffered report messages are for the most part transmitted only when there is a value
change in one or more of their members. Most analog values continuously dither by an amount that is not significant.
Were a report to be sent each time an insignificant analog value change occurred, then the communications network
5
floods with GOOSE and report messages, degrading response time for all users.
To control this, a deadband setting is provided for each analog value. Also, in addition to the present actual value of each
analog ("instMag" in the following figure), there is a deadbanded value ("mag" in the figure), which is updated with the
present value only when the difference between the two exceeds the deadband setting (db in the figure). Changes to this
deadbanded value trigger transmissions when included in GOOSE and report data sets.
Figure 5-64: Deadband settings

Deadband settings are entered in UR Setup software in units of percent of the difference between the "max." and "min." of
the associated analog value. A zero deadband setting suppresses transmission triggering. The range of deadband settings
is 0.000 to 100.000% in steps of 0.001. The default value is 0.000%.
GGIO4 elements have individual settings for "min." and "max." The min. and max. for FlxEIGAPC#.OpSig.db (FLEXELEMENT #
OpSig) are -50 pu and +50 pu respectively. The min. value for all other quantities is 0. The max. values are as follows:
• Phase current — 46 x phase CT primary setting
• Neutral current — 46 x ground CT primary setting
• Ground current (sensitive ground CT) — 4.6 x sensitive ground CT primary setting
• Phase, phase-to-phase, and sequence voltage — 275 x phase VT ratio setting

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-127


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

• Auxiliary voltage — 275 x auxiliary VT ration setting


• Power (real, reactive, apparent, 3-phase, and 1-phase) — 4 × phase CT primary setting × 1.5 × VT Secondary setting ×
VT ratio setting
• Energy (real or imaginary) — 4 × phase CT primary setting × 1.5 × VT Secondary setting × VT ratio setting x 1 hour
• Frequency — 90 Hz
• Frequency rate of change — 90 Hz/s
• Power factor — 2
• Angle — 360 degrees
Select the deadband settings from knowledge of the characteristics of the power system quantity measured and
knowledge of the demands of the applications receiving the measurement via GOOSE or report such that changes of
significance to the application are promptly reported, yet the network is not overly burdened with event messages.

Signal sources
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the signal sources are configured here.

Breakers
The UR breaker control and status monitoring elements have certain settings that configure how the IEC 61850 protocol
interacts with these elements. These settings are described in this section. See the Breakers section in the System Setup
section of this chapter for details on the operation of breaker control elements.
Navigate to Settings > Communications > IEC 61850 > System Setup > Breakers > Breaker 1 to access the settings that
configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface with the first breaker control and status monitoring element. The settings and
functionality for the others are similar.
5 Figure 5-65: IEC 61850 Breaker panel (Edition 2)

XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND


Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that breaker 1 is selected for local
control. While the selected operand is asserted, Bkr0XCBR1.Loc.stVal is true and IEC 61850 commands to BkrCSWI1.Pos
and Bkr0XCBR1.Pos are not accepted, and a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-
switching-hierarchy.

5-128 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

XCBR1 SYNCCHECK CLS


Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that synchrocheck conditions are
acceptable for closing breaker 1. If a SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal true and with Check.SynchroCheck
true is requested of either BkrCSWI1.Pos or Bkr0XCBR1.Pos and the selected operand is not asserted, a Negative
Response (-Rsp) is issued with the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-synchrocheck.
XCBR1 INTERLOCK OPN
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that interlocking conditions are not
acceptable for opening breaker 1. While the selected operand is asserted, the value of BkrCILO.EnaOpn.stVal is false. If a
SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal false and with Check.Interlock-check true is requested of either
BkrCSWI1.Pos or Bkr0XCBR1.Pos, and the selected operand is not activated, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with
the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-interlocking.
XCBR1 INTERLOCK CLS
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that interlocking conditions are not
acceptable for closing breaker 1. While the selected operand is asserted, the value of BkrCILO.EnaCls.stVal is false. If a
SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal true and with Check.Interlock-check true is requested of either
BkrCSWI1.Pos or Bkr0XCBR1.Pos and the selected operand is not activated, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with the
REASON CODE of Blocked-by-interlocking.
XCBR1 Pos ctlModel 5
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security, direct-with-enhanced-security, sbo-with-
enhanced-security
Default: sbo-with-enhanced-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the breaker 1 signals marked
Bkr0XCBR1.PosOpn.ctlVal and Bkr0XCBR1.PosCls.ctlVal on the Breaker Control Logic (Sheet 1 of 2) diagram in the
Settings > System Setup section later in this chapter. These signals force a breaker 1 three-phase trip or close control
while the operand selected by setting XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND is not active.
"sbo" here is select-before-operate. Enhanced security means that the UR reports to the client the breaker 1 position at
the end of the command sequence.
XCBR1 Pos sboTimeout
Range: 2 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between a select and an operate command to breaker 1 signals marked
Bkr0XCBR1.PosOpn.ctlVal and Bkr0XCBR1.PosCls.ctlVal in order for the operand to be successful. This setting is only
relevant when XCBR1 Pos ctlModel is sbo-with-normal-security or sbo-with-enhanced-security.
XCBR1 BlkOpn ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the breaker 1 signal marked
Bkr0XCBR1.BlkOpn.ctlVal signal on the Breaker Control Logic (Sheet 1 of 2) diagram in the Settings > System Setup
section later. This signal when true blocks breaker 1 trip control while the operand selected by setting XCBR1 ST.LOC
OPERAND is not active.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-129


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

XCBR1 BlkCls ctlModel


Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the breaker 1 signal marked
Bkr0XCBR1.BlkCls.ctlVal signal on the Breaker Control Logic (Sheet 1 of 2) diagram in the Settings > System Setup section
later. This signal when true blocks breaker 1 close control while the operand selected by setting XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND
is not active.
CSWI1 Pos ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security, direct-with-enhanced-security, sbo-with-
enhanced-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the breaker 1 signals marked
BkrCSWI1.PosOpn.ctlVal and BkrCSWI1.PosCls.ctlVal on the Breaker Control Logic (Sheet 1 of 2) diagram in the Settings >
System Setup section earlier. These signals force a breaker 1 three-phase trip or close control while the operand selected
by setting XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND is not active.
CSWI1 Pos sboTimeout
Range: 2 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between a select and an operate command to breaker 1 via BkrCSWI1.Pos in
order for the operand to be successful. This setting is only relevant when CSWI1 Pos ctlModel is sbo-with-normal-
security or sbo-with-enhanced-security.
CSWI1 Pos operTimeout
Range: 0.000 to 2.000 s in steps of 0.001s
5 Default: 0.100 s
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
This setting specifies the maximum time between an operate command to breaker 1 via BkrCSWI1.Pos until
BkrCSWI1.Pos.stVal enters the commanded state. The command terminates if the commanded state is not reached in
the set time.

Switches
The UR disconnect switch control and status monitoring elements have certain settings that configure how the IEC 61850
protocol interacts with these elements. These settings are described in this section. See the Settings > System Setup >
Disconnect Switches section later in this chapter for details on the operation of the disconnect switch control elements.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > System Setup > Switches > Switch 1 to access
the settings that configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface with the first disconnect switch control and status monitoring
element. The settings and functionality for the others are similar.

5-130 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-66: Switch panel

Disc0XSWI1.InRef5.setSrcRef OPERAND
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that disconnect switch 1 is selected
for local control. While the selected operand is asserted, Disc0XSWI1.Loc.stVal is true and IEC 61850 commands to
DiscCSWI1.Pos and Disc0XSWI1.Pos are not accepted, and a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with the REASON CODE
of Blocked-by-switching-hierarchy.
XSWI1 INTERLOCK OPN
5
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that interlocking conditions are not
acceptable for opening disconnect switch 1. While the selected operand is asserted, the value of DiscCILO.EnaOpn.stVal
is false. If a SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal false and with Check.Interlock-check true is requested of
DiscCSWI1.Pos or Disc0XSWI1.Pos and the selected operand is not activated, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with
the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-interlocking.
XSWI1 INTERLOCK CLS
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting is used to select a FlexLogic operand that declares to IEC 61850 services that interlocking conditions are not
acceptable for closing disconnect switch 1. While the selected operand is asserted, the value of DiscCILO.EnaCls.stVal is
false. If a SelectWithValue or Operate service with ctlVal true and with Check.Interlock-check true is requested of
DiscCSWI1.Pos or Disc0XSWI1.Pos and the selected operand is not activated, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with
the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-interlocking.
XSWI1 Pos ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security, direct-with-enhanced-security, sbo-with-
enhanced-security
Default: sbo-with-enhanced-security
This setting selects the control model that clients must use to successfully control the disconnect switch 1 signals
marked Disc0XCBR1.PosOpn.ctlVal and Disc0XCBR1.PosCls.ctlVal on the Disconnect Switch Logic diagram in the Settings
> System Setup section later. These signals force a disconnect switch trip or close control while the operand selected by
setting XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND is not active.
"sbo" here is select-before-operate. Enhanced security means that the F35 reports to the client the disconnect switch 1
position the end of the command sequence.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-131


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

XSWI1 Pos sboTimeout


Range: 2 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between a select and an operate command to disconnect switch 1 signals
marked Disc0XCBR1.PosOpn.ctlVal and Disc0XCBR1.PosCls.ctlVal in order for the operand to be successful. This setting is
only relevant when XSWI1 Pos ctlModel is sbo-with-normal-security or sbo-with-enhanced-security.
Disc0XSWI1 BlkOpn ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the disconnect switch 1 signal marked
DiscCSWI1.BlkOpn.ctlVal signal on the Disconnect Switch Logic diagram in the Settings > System Setup section later. This
signal when true blocks disconnect switch 1 trip control while the operand selected by setting XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND is
not active.
Disc0XSWI1 BlkCls ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the disconnect switch 1 signal marked
DiscCSWI1.BlkCls.ctlVal signal on the Disconnect Switch Logic diagram in the Settings > System Setup section later. This
signal when true blocks disconnect switch 1 close control while the operand selected by setting XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND
is not active.
Disc0CSWI1 Pos ctlModel
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security, direct-with-enhanced-security, sbo-with-
enhanced-security
5 Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the disconnect switch 1 signals marked
DiscCSWI1.PosOpn.ctlVal and DiscCSWI1.PosCls.ctlVal on the Disconnect Switch Logic diagram in the Settings > System
Setup section later. These signals force a disconnect switch trip or close control while the operand selected by setting
XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND is not active.
Disc0CSWI1 Pos sboTimeout
Range: 2 to 60 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 30 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between a select and an operate command to disconnect switch 1 via
BkrCSWI1.Pos in order for the operand to be successful. This setting is only relevant when CSWI1 Pos ctlModel is sbo-
with-normal-security or sbo-with-enhanced-security.
Disc0CSWI1 Pos operTimeout
Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001s
Default: 5.000 s
This setting specifies the maximum time between an operate command to disconnect switch 1 via BkrCSWI1.Pos until
BkrCSWI1.Pos.stVal enters the commanded state. The command terminates if the commanded state is not reached in
the set time.

Setting Groups
The UR implements a setting groups element as detailed in the Control Elements > Setting Groups section of this chapter.
The active setting group and the setting group open for edits can be selected via MMS commands SelectActiveSG and
SelectEditSG. The setting related to these IEC 61850 commands are described here.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Control Elements > Setting Groups to access
the setting that configures the IEC 61850 setting group commands.

5-132 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-67: Setting Groups panel (Edition 2)

Initial Setting Group


Range: 1 to 6 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the initial value of the non-volatile register normally controlled by the service SelectActiveSG. This
initialization occurs only on the UR reboot immediately following the receipt of a valid CID file.
This setting is not mapped into the IEC 61850 information model, but sets the value of SettingControl element attribute
actSG in SCL files.
5
Commands
The UR implements a number of clear records commands as detailed in the Commands and Targets chapter of this
manual. Several of these commands also can be issued via IEC 61850. The settings related to these IEC 61850 commands
are described here.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Settings for Commands to access the settings
that configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface for record clear commands.
Figure 5-68: Commands panel (Edition 2)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-133


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

FltRptRFLO1.RsStat.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR FAULT REPORTS. "sbo"
here is select-before-operate. Enhanced security means that the F35 reports to the client the breaker 1 position at the
end of the command sequence.
LLN0.EvtRcdClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR EVENT RECORDS.
LPHD1.RsStat.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR ALL RELAY RECORDS.
OscRDRE1.RcdTrg.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command FORCE TRIGGER.
OscRDRE1.MemClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security

5 This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY.
DatLogRDRE1.MemClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR DATA LOGGER.
CBArc0SCBR1.MemClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security

DmdMtrMMTR1.RsStat.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security

EnrMtrMMTR1.RsStat.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security

GGIO1
GGIO1 is a UR feature that allows up to 128 UR FlexLogic operands to be user-mapped to IEC 61850 information model
data attributes.
For the value of a FlexLogic operand to be read via MMS, included in TxGOOSE messages, or included in buffered/
unbuffered reports, the value must be assigned to a data attribute. GGIO1 allows those FlexLogic operands that have not
yet been factory-assigned to a data attribute to be user-assigned to a generic data attribute, and thus have their values
included in IEC 61850 communications.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO > GGIO1 to access the settings for GGIO1.

5-134 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-69: IEC 61850 GGIO1 panel (Edition 2)

GGIO1 INDICATION 1
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting selects the FlexLogic operand whose value is mapped into the IEC 61850 data attribute
<LDName>/GGIO1.Ind001.stVal. See the FlexLogic section in this chapter for a list of FlexLogic operands.
GGIO1 INDICATION 2
Range: any FlexLogic operand
5
Default: OFF
Selects the FlexLogic operand mapped to <LDName>/GGIO1.Ind002.stVal, and so on.

GGIO2
Virtual Inputs are controllable FlexLogic operands that can be controlled via IEC 61850 commands to GGIO2, by DNP, by
Modbus, and by the UR front panel. The settings related to these IEC 61850 commands are described here.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO > GGIO2 to access the settings that
configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface for Virtual Input commands.
Figure 5-70: GGIO2 panel (Edition 2)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-135


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

GGIO2 CF SPCSO 1 CTLMODEL


Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control Virtual Input 1. "sbo" here is select-before-
operate.
GGIO2 CF SPCSO 2 CTLMODEL
Range: status-only, direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
Selects the control model for Virtual Input 2, and so on.

GGIO4
GGIO4 is a UR feature that allows up to 32 UR FlexAnalog operands to be user-mapped to an IEC 61850 information model
data attribute.
For the value of a FlexAnalog operand to be read via MMS, included in TxGOOSE messages, or included in buffered/
unbuffered reports, the value must be assigned to a data attribute. GGIO4 allows those FlexAnalog operands that have not
yet been factory-assigned to a data attribute to be user-assigned to a generic data attribute, and thus have their values
included in IEC 61850 communications.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO > GGIO4 > GGIO4.AnIn1 to access the
settings for the first GGIO4 value. The settings and functionality for the others are similar.
Figure 5-71: GGIO4 panel (Edition 2)

ANALOG IN 1 VALUE
Range: any FlexAnalog operand
Default: OFF
This setting selects the FlexAnalog operand whose value is mapped into the IEC 61850 data attribute
<LDName>/GGIO4.AnIn01.instMag.f. The value of the FlexAnalog operand is converted automatically to the format and
scaling required by the standard, that is to say primary amperes, primary volts, and so on. See Appendix A for a list of
FlexAnalog operands.

5-136 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

ANALOG IN 1 DB
Range: 0.000 to 100.000% in steps of 0.001
Default: 0.000%
This setting specifies the deadband for the ANALOG IN 1 VALUE. The deadband is used to determine when to update the
deadbanded magnitude from the instantaneous magnitude. The deadband is a percentage of the difference between
the "max." and "min." values. Here, the "max." and "min." are as specified by the settings ANALOG IN 1 MAX and ANALOG IN
1 MIN.
See the Deadband Settings section earlier for a description of deadbanded values.
ANALOG IN 1 MIN
Range: -1000000000.000 to 1000000000.000 in steps of 0.001
Default: 0.000
This setting specifies the "min." value used in deadband calculations. The scaling of this setting is the same as used by
<LDName>/GGIO4.AnIn01.instMag.f. This setting is stored as an IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating point number. Because of
the large range of this setting, not all possible values can be stored. Some values are rounded to the closest possible
floating point number.
ANALOG IN 1 MAX
Range: -1000000000.000 to 1000000000.000 in steps of 0.001
Default: 1000000.000
This setting specifies the "max." value used in deadband calculations. The scaling of this setting is the same as used by
<LDName>/GGIO4.AnIn01.instMag.f. This setting is stored as an IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating point number. Because of
the large range of this setting, not all possible values can be stored. Some values are rounded to the closest possible
floating point number.

File transfer by IEC 61850 5


The F35 supports file transfer by IEC 61850. The approach is as follows, using the SISCO AX-S4 61850 client software as an
example.
1. In the AX-S4 61850 Explorer window, click the Tools menu and access the SISCO File Transfer Utility.
2. Select the Remote AR Name from the drop-down list. Available files appear in the File Specification area on the right
side of the window.
3. With the Copy option active, select a file to transfer and click the Go button. The file is copied and displays in the Local
list on the left side of the window.
4. Repeat the process to transfer any other files.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-137


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-72: File transfer by IEC 61850

5.3.5.13 Web server HTTP protocol


5 SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  WEB SERVER HTTP PROTOCOL
 WEB SERVER HTTP TCP PORT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
 HTTP PROTOCOL  NUMBER(80): 80

The F35 contains an embedded web server and can display pages in a web browser. The web pages are organized as a
series of menus that can be accessed starting at the F35 “Main Menu.” Web pages are read-only and are available
showing DNP and IEC 60870-5-104 points lists, Modbus registers, event records, fault reports, and so on. First connect the
F35 and a computer to an Ethernet network, then enter the IP address of the F35 Ethernet port in a web browser.
To close the port, set the port number to 0.
Any change takes effect when the F35 is restarted.

5-138 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-73: Example of UR web page showing event records

Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.

5.3.5.14 TFTP protocol


5
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  TFTP PROTOCOL
 TFTP PROTOCOL TFTP MAIN UDP PORT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
  NUMBER(69): 69

TFTP DATA UDP PORT 1 Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 NUMBER: 0

TFTP DATA UDP PORT 2 Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 NUMBER: 0

The Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) can be used to transfer files from the F35 over a network. The F35 operates as a
TFTP server. TFTP client software is available from various sources, including Microsoft Windows NT. The dir.txt file obtained
from the F35 contains a list and description of all available files, for example event records and oscillography.
The "put" function is not for security reasons. You can enter a "get" command but not a "put" command.
TFTP MAIN UDP PORT NUMBER — To close the port, set the port number to 0. Any change takes effect when the F35 is
restarted.

Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.

5.3.5.15 IEC 60870-5-104 protocol


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IEC 60870-5-104 PROTOCOL
 IEC 60870-5-104 IEC TCP PORT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
 PROTOCOL  NUMBER: 2404

 IEC NETWORK See below


  CLIENT ADDRESSES

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-139


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

IEC COMMON ADDRESS Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 OF ASDU: 0

IEC CYCLIC DATA Range: 1 to 65535 s in steps of 1


 PERIOD: 60 s

IEC CURRENT DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 THRESHOLD: 30000

IEC VOLTAGE DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 THRESHOLD: 30000

IEC POWER DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 THRESHOLD: 30000

IEC ENERGY DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 THRESHOLD: 30000

IEC PF DEFAULT Range: 0.00 to 1.00


 THRESHOLD: 1.00

IEC OTHER DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 THRESHOLD: 30000

IEC REDUNDANCY Range: No, Yes


 ENABLED: No

IEC 60870-5-104 is a transmission protocol for network access, specifically for communication between a control station
and substation over a TCP/IP network.
The F35 supports the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol. This protocol is enabled when the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP 
COMMUNICATIONS  PROTOCOL setting is set to IEC 60870-5-104. The F35 can be used as an IEC 60870-5-104 slave device
5 connected to a maximum of two masters (usually either an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the F35 maintains two
sets of IEC 60870-5-104 data change buffers, ideally no more than two masters actively communicate with the F35 at one
time.
The IEC ------- DEFAULT THRESHOLD settings are used to determine when to trigger spontaneous responses containing
M_ME_NC_1 analog data. These settings group the F35 analog data into types: current, voltage, power, energy, and other.
Each setting represents the default threshold value for all M_ME_NC_1 analog points of that type. For example, to trigger
spontaneous responses from the F35 when any current values change by 15 A, the IEC CURRENT DEFAULT THRESHOLD
setting is set to 15. Note that these settings are the default values of the deadbands. P_ME_NC_1 (parameter of measured
value, short floating point value) points can be used to change threshold values, from the default, for each individual
M_ME_NC_1 analog point. Whenever power is removed and re-applied to the F35, the default thresholds are in effect.
The IEC REDUNDANCY setting decides whether multiple client connections are accepted or not. If redundancy is set to Yes,
two simultaneous connections can be active at any given time.
IEC TCP PORT NUMBER — To close the port, set the port number to 0. Any change takes effect when the F35 is restarted.
IEC COMMON ADDRESS OF ASDU — The change takes effect when the F35 is restarted.
IEC CYCLIC DATA PERIOD — The change takes effect when the F35 is restarted.

Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.

SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IEC 60870-5-104 PROTOCOL  IEC NETWORK CLIENT
ADDRESSES
 IEC NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS 1: Range: standard IPV4 address format
 CLIENT ADDRESSES  0.0.0.0

CLIENT ADDRESS 5: Range: standard IPV4 address format
 0.0.0.0

5-140 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The F35 can specify a maximum of five clients for its IEC 104 connections. These are IP addresses for the controllers to
which the F35 can connect. A maximum of two simultaneous connections are supported at any given time.

5.3.5.16 EGD protocol


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  EGD PROTOCOL
 EGD PROTOCOL  FAST PROD EXCH 1 See below
   CONFIGURATION

 SLOW PROD EXCH 1 See below


  CONFIGURATION

 SLOW PROD EXCH 2 See below


  CONFIGURATION

The F35 is provided with optional Ethernet Global Data (EGD) communications capability. This feature is
specified as a software option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

Ethernet Global Data (EGD) is a suite of protocols used for the real-time transfer of data for display and control purposes.
The relay can be configured to ‘produce’ EGD data exchanges, and other devices can be configured to ‘consume’ EGD data
exchanges. The number of produced exchanges (up to three), the data items in each exchange (up to 50), and the
exchange production rate can be configured.
The relay supports one fast EGD exchange and two slow EGD exchanges. There are 20 data items in the fast-produced
EGD exchange and 50 data items in each slow-produced exchange.
EGD cannot be used to transfer data between UR series relays. The relay supports EGD production only. An EGD exchange
is not be transmitted unless the destination address is non-zero, and at least the first data item address is set to a valid 5
Modbus register address. The default setting value of “0” is considered invalid.
Fast exchanges (50 to 1000 ms) are generally used in control schemes. The F35 has one fast exchange (exchange 1) and
two slow exchanges (exchange 2 and 3).
The settings menu for the fast EGD exchange follows.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  EGD PROTOCOL FAST PROD EXCH 1 CONFIGURATION
 FAST PROD EXCH 1 EXCH 1 FUNCTION: Range: Disable, Enable
 CONFIGURATION  Disable

EXCH 1 DESTINATION: Range: standard IP address


 0.0.0.0

EXCH 1 DATA RATE: Range: 50 to 1000 ms in steps of 1


 1000 ms

EXCH 1 DATA ITEM 1: Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1 (Modbus register


 0 address range)

EXCH 1 DATA ITEM 20: Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1 (Modbus register
 0 address range)

The settings menu for the slow EGD exchanges follows.


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  EGD PROTOCOL SLOW PROD EXCH 1(2) CONFIGURATION
 SLOW PROD EXCH 1 EXCH 1 FUNCTION: Range: Disable, Enable
 CONFIGURATION  Disable

EXCH 1 DESTINATION: Range: standard IP address


 0.0.0.0

EXCH 1 DATA RATE: Range: 50 to 1000 ms in steps of 1


 1000 ms

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-141


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

EXCH 1 DATA ITEM 1: Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1 (Modbus register


 0 address range)

EXCH 1 DATA ITEM 50: Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1 (Modbus register
 0 address range)

Slow EGD exchanges (500 to 1000 ms) are generally used for the transfer and display of data items. The settings for the
fast and slow exchanges are as follows.
EXCH 1 DESTINATION — This setting specifies the destination IP address of the produced EGD exchange. This is usually
unicast or broadcast.
EXCH 1 DATA RATE — This setting specifies the rate at which this EGD exchange is transmitted. If the setting is 50 ms, the
exchange data is updated and sent once every 50 ms. If the setting is 1000 ms, the exchange data is updated and sent
once per second. EGD exchange 1 has a setting range of 50 to 1000 ms. Exchanges 2 and 3 have a setting range of 500 to
1000 ms.
EXCH 1 DATA ITEM 1 to 20/50 — These settings specify the data items that are part of this EGD exchange. Almost any data
from the F35 memory map can be configured to be included in an EGD exchange. The settings are the starting Modbus
register address for the data item in decimal format. See the Modbus memory map in the UR Series Communications
Guide for details. The Modbus memory map display shows addresses in hexadecimal format. Convert these hex values to
decimal format before entering them as values for these setpoints.
To select a data item to be part of an exchange, it is only necessary to choose the starting Modbus address of the item.
That is, for items occupying more than one Modbus register (for example, 32 bit integers and floating point values), only the
first Modbus address is required. The EGD exchange configured with these settings contains the data items up to the first
setting that contains a Modbus address with no data, or 0. That is, if the first three settings contain valid Modbus addresses
and the fourth is 0, the produced EGD exchange contains three data items.
5
5.3.5.17 IEC 60870-5-103 protocol
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IEC 60870-5-103
 IEC103 IEC103 COMMON Range: 0 to 254 in steps of 1
 PROTOCOL  ADDRESS OF ASDU: 0

IEC103 SYNC TIMEOUT: Range: 1 to 1440 min in steps of 1


 1

 IEC103 INPUTS See below


  BINARY

 IEC103 INPUTS See below


  MEASURANDS

 IEC103 COMMANDS See below


 

The F35 is provided with optional IEC 60870-5-103 communications capability. This feature is specified as a
software option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

IEC 60870-5-103 is a companion standard to the IEC 60870-5 suite of standards for transmission protocols. It defines
messages and procedures for interoperability between protection equipment and devices of a control system in a
substation for communicating on a serial line.
The IEC 60870-5-103 protocol is enabled when the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  PROTOCOL setting
is set to IEC 60870-5-103.
The IEC 60870-5-103 is an unbalanced (master-slave) protocol for coded-bit serial communication, exchanging
information with a control system. In the context of this protocol, the protection equipment is the slave and the control
system is the master. The communication is based on a point-to-point principle. The master must be able to interpret the
IEC 60870-5-103 communication messages.

5-142 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The UR implementation of IEC 60870-5-103 consists of the following functions:


• Report binary inputs
• Report analog values (measurands)
• Commands
• Time synchronization
The RS485 port supports IEC 60870-5-103.
The UR Family Communications Guide contains more information on the protocol.
IEC103 COMMON ADDRESS OF ASDU — This setting uniquely defines this F35 on the serial line. Select an ID between 0 and
254. This ID does not need to be in sequential order for all stations that communicate with a controller, but it is
recommended. Note that RS485 only allows a maximum of 32 slave stations on a communication line, so the entire range
of 254 addresses is never exhausted.
IEC103 SYNC TIMEOUT — This setting defines the time that the F35 waits for a synchronization message. The F35
synchronizes its clock using all available sources, with the source synching more frequently overwriting the time of the
other sources. Since the synchronization message received from the IEC 60870-5-103 master is less frequent than IRIG-B,
PTP, or SNTP, its time is overwritten by these three sources, if any of them is active. If the synchronization timeout occurs
and none of IRIG-B, PTP, or SNTP is active, the F35 sets the invalid bit in the time stamp of a time-tagged message.
The settings for the remaining menus are outlined as follows.
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IEC 60870-5-103  IEC103 INPUTS BINARY
 IEC103 INPUTS  POINT 0 See below
 BINARY  

 POINT 1 See below


 
 5
 POINT 95 See below
 

 POINT 0 POINT 0 FUN Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


  0

POINT 0 INF Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


 0

POINT 0 Input Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

 POINT 95 POINT 95 FUN Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1
  0

POINT 95 INF Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


 0

POINT 95 Input Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

The binary input points are mapped using elements from a list of possible FlexLogic operands. A maximum of 96 binary
inputs (points) can be mapped this way.
The IEC 60870-5-103 point list always starts with point 0 and ends at the first "Off" value. Since the IEC 60870-5-103 point
list must be in a continuous block, any points assigned after the first "Off" point are ignored.
For each defined point, set appropriate values for the Function Type (FUN) and Information Number (INF), which form the
Information Object Identifier field of the ASDU, as defined in IEC 60870-5-103.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-143


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

The binary input points are sent as Class 1 data. They are sent either as a response to a general interrogation received
from the controller or reported spontaneously. Spontaneous transmission occurs as a response to cyclic Class 2 requests.
If the F35 wants to transmit Class 1 data at that time, it demands access for Class 1 data transmission (ACD=1 in the
control field of the response).
For any change to take effect, restart the relay.

SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IEC 60870-5-103  IEC103 INPUTS MEASURANDS


 IEC103 INPUTS  ASDU 1 See below
 MEASURANDS  

 ASDU 4
 

 ASDU 1 ASDU 1 TYP: Range: 3 or 9


  9

ASDU 1 FUN: Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


 0

ASDU 1 INF: Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


 0

ASDU 1 SCAN TOUT: Range: 0 to 1000 s in steps of 1


 0

5  ASDU 1 ANALOG 1
Off
Range: FlexAnalog parameter

ASDU 1 ANALOG 1 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 in steps of 0.001


 FACTOR: 1.000

ASDU 1 ANALOG 1 Range: -32768 to 32767 in steps of 1


 OFFSET: 0

ASDU 1 ANALOG 9 Range: FlexAnalog parameter
 Off

ASDU 1 ANALOG 9 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 in steps of 0.001


 FACTOR: 1.000

ASDU 1 ANALOG 9 Range: -32768 to 32767 in steps of 1


 OFFSET: 0

 ASDU 4 ASDU 4 TYP: Range: 3 or 9
  9

ASDU 4 FUN: Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


 0

ASDU 4 INF: Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


 0

ASDU 4 SCAN TOUT: Range: 0 to 1000 s in steps of 1


 0

ASDU 4 ANALOG 1 Range: FlexAnalog parameter


 Off

ASDU 4 ANALOG 1 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 in steps of 0.001


 FACTOR: 1.000

5-144 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

ASDU 4 ANALOG 1 Range: -32768 to 32767 in steps of 1


 OFFSET: 0

ASDU 4 ANALOG 9 Range: FlexAnalog parameter
 Off

ASDU 4 ANALOG 9 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 in steps of 0.001


 FACTOR: 1.000

ASDU 4 ANALOG 9 Range: -32768 to 32767 in steps of 1


 OFFSET: 0

The configuration menu allows a maximum of four ASDUs containing measurands.


Measurands are sent as a response to Class 2 requests, which are cyclic requests coming from the master.
TYPE IDENTIFICATION (TYP) — The configuration field TYP indicates how many measurands are present in the corresponding
ASDU. Each ASDU can take either 4 or 9 measurands maximum, depending on the type identification (3 respectively 9). For
any change to take effect, restart the relay.
FUNCTION TYPE (FUN) and INFORMATION NUMBER (INF) — These two fields form the Information Object Identifier of the ASDU
as defined in IEC 60870-103. For any change to take effect, restart the relay.
SCAN TIMEOUT (SCAN TOUT) — This is the cyclic period used by the F35 to decide when a measurand ASDU is included in a
response. The measurand is sent as response to a Class 2 request when the corresponding timeout expires. The default
value 0 means 500 ms.
ANALOG # — This field contains the actual measurand to be sent in the response to the master. The measurands can be
mapped using elements from a list of FlexAnalog operands. The measurands sent are voltage, current, power, power
factor, and frequency. If any other FlexAnalog is chosen, the F35 sends 0 instead of its value. Note that the power is
transmitted in KW, not W. Measurands are transmitted as ASDU 3 or ASDU 9 (type identification value set to measurands I,
respectively measurands II).
5
Each IEC 60870-5-103 measurands list ends at the first unconfigured ("Off") value. Any measurand assigned after the first
"Off" value is ignored.
At least one measurand per ASDU must be configured in order to configure the following ASDU. For example, the user can
configure only one measurand for each ASDU, but the user is not allowed to skip ASDU 2 and configure measurands in
ASDU 3.
For any change to take effect, restart the relay.
ANALOG # FACTOR and OFFSET — For each measurand included in the ASDU, a factor and offset also can be configured. The
factor and offset allow for scaling to be performed on measurands. The final measurement sent to the IEC 60870-103
master is then "a*x + b," where x is the measurand, a is the multiplying factor and b is the offset. The master has to perform
the reversed operation in order to retrieve the actual value if such scaling is done. By default a = 1 and b = 0, so no scaling
is done if these values are left at their defaults. Examples of when scaling is appropriate are as follows:
• If the measured value contains decimals and it is important to preserve the resolution. Since the format for
transmitting the measurand does not permit decimals, a factor a>1 can be applied before transmission. For example,
a frequency F=59.9Hz can be transmitted as Ft = 10 * F = 10 * 59.9 = 599. In this case a = 10, b = 0. The master receives
599 and has to divide by 10 to retrieve the real value 59.9.
• If the measured value is larger than what fits in the format defined in IEC 103. The format defined in the standard
allows for signed integers up to 4095. By offsetting, unsigned integers up to 4096 + 4095 = 8191 are supported.
Scaling using factors <1 can be required in such cases. The calculation is outlined in the IEC 60870-5-103 chapter of
the UR Family Communications Guide. Two examples follow, where you decide factors a and b.
Example 1: Nominal power Pn = 100 MW = 100000 KW (power is transmitted in KW)
Since P can be both positive and negative:
Transmitted power Pt = (4095/(Pn*2.4)) * P = (4095/(100000 * 2.4) ) * P
= 0.017 * P
a = 0.017
b=0

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-145


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Pt = 0.017 * P
For a max power 100000 KW * 2.4 = 240000 KW, we transmit
Pt = 0.017 * 240000 = 4080
A value above 240 MW is indicated by overflow.

Example 2: Nominal voltage Vn = 500000 V


Since RMS voltage V can be only positive:
Transmitted voltage Vt = (8191/(Vn*2.4)) * V - 4096 =
= (8191/(500000 * 2.4) ) * V - 4096 = 0.0068 * V - 4096
a = 0.0068
Since the step is in increments of 0.001, we round it at:
a = 0.006
b = -4096
Vt = 0.006 * V - 4096
For max voltage 500000 V * 2.4 = 1200000 V, we transmit
Vt = 0.006 * 1200000 - 4096 = 7200 - 4096 = 3104

SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IEC 60870-5-103  IEC103 COMMANDS


 IEC103 COMMANDS  COMMAND 0 See below
  

5   COMMAND 1


 COMMAND 31
 

 COMMAND 0 COMMAND 0 FUN: Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


  0

COMMAND 0 INF: Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


 0

COMMAND 0 ON: Range: Virtual input


 Off

COMMAND 0 OFF: Range: Virtual input


 Off

 COMMAND 31 COMMAND 31 FUN: Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1
  0

COMMAND 31 INF: Range: 0 to 255 in steps of 1


 0

COMMAND 31 ON: Range: Virtual input


 Off

COMMAND 31 OFF: Range: Virtual input


 Off

Commands are received as General Command (Type Identification 20). The user can configure the action to perform when
an ASDU command comes.

5-146 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

A list of available mappings is provided on the F35. This includes 64 virtual inputs (see the following table). The ON and OFF
for the same ASDU command can be mapped to different virtual inputs.
Each command is identified by the unique combination made by the function type (FUN) and information number (INF). If
the master sends an ASDU command that does not have the FUN and INF of any configured command, the relay rejects it.
Table 5-14: Commands mapping table
Description Value
Off 0
Virtual Input 1 1
Virtual Input 2 2
... ...
Virtual Input 64 64

For any change to take effect, restart the relay.

5.3.5.18 USB port


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  USB 2.0
 USB 2.0 USB DEVICE PORT Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Enabled

This setting applies to the USB port on the graphical front panel.

5
This setting enables/disables the USB port on the graphical front panel. When the port function is "Enabled," a standard
USB serial cable allows a computer running the EnerVista UR Setup software to retrieve, display, and write settings either
individually or collectively, to display status and actual values, to initiate controls, and to retrieve and display event records,
oscillography records, data logger records, and disturbance records. Installation of the EnerVista software automatically
installs the drivers required to use this USB port.
DNP is not available using the USB port on the graphical front panel.

5.3.6 Modbus user map


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  MODBUS USER MAP
 MODBUS USER MAP ADDRESS 1: 0 Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
  VALUE: 0

ADDRESS 256: 0 Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
 VALUE: 0

The Modbus user map provides read-only access for up to 256 registers. To obtain a memory map value, enter the address
in the ADDRESS line (converted from hex to decimal format). The corresponding value (if programmed) displays in the VALUE
line. A value of “0” in subsequent register ADDRESS lines automatically returns values for the previous ADDRESS lines
incremented by 1. An address value of “0” in the initial register means “none” and values of “0” display for all registers.
Different ADDRESS values can be entered as required in any of the register positions.
The UR Family Communications Guide outlines the Modbus memory map. The map is also viewable in a web browser;
enter the IP address of the F35 in a web browser and click the option.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-147


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.3.7 Real time clock

5.3.7.1 Menu
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  REAL TIME CLOCK
 REAL TIME SYNCRONIZING SOURCE: Range: None, PP/IRIG-B/PTP/Other, IRIG-B/PP/PTP/
 CLOCK  None Other, PP/PTP/IRIG-B/Other

REAL TIME CLOCK Range: Enabled, Disabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE: Range: None, DC Shift, Amplitude Modulated


 None

 PRECISION TIME See below


  PROTOCOL (1588)

 SNTP PROTOCOL See below


 

 LOCAL TIME See below


 

The relay contains a real time clock (RTC) to create time stamps for communications protocols as well as for historical data,
such as event records and oscillography. When the relay restarts, the RTC initializes from an onboard battery-backed
clock, which has the same accuracy as an electronic watch, approximately ±1 minute per month (~23 ppm). Once the RTC
is synchronized with the Precision Time Protocol (PTP), IRIG-B, or SNTP, its accuracy approaches that of the synchronizing
time delivered to the relay. While the RTC is not synchronized via PTP or IRIG-B, or the relay determines that it has an offset

5 possibly greater than 10 µs from the international time standard, the CLOCK UNSYNCHRONIZED FlexLogic operand is
activated.
The SYNCHRONIZING SOURCE setting displays in the software when the relay includes the IEEE 1588 software option. The
setting configures the priority sequence of the time synchronization source, to determine which of the available external
time sources to use for time synchronization. A setting of None causes the RTC and the synchrophasor clock to free-run,
and the clock can be changed from the front panel or from communications protocols. A setting of PP/IRIG-B/PTP/Other,
IRIG-B/PP/PTP/Other, or PP/PTP/IRIG-B/Other causes the relay to track the first source named that is enabled and
operational, or free-run if none of these are available. Here, PP means a time source that is strictly compliant with PP, PTP
means a time source that is not strictly compliant with PP, and Other means any less precise source (SNTP, IEC 103, IEC 104,
Modbus, or DNP). When a time source fails or recovers, the relay automatically transfers synchronization as required by
this setting.
When the relay does not have the IEEE 1588 software option and this setting does not display, it uses IRIG-B when enabled
and operational, then failing that SNTP when configured and operational, and otherwise it free-runs unless the clock is
changed from the front panel or from communications protocols.
Setup for IRIG-B is illustrated in the Installation chapter.
For the Other protocols, whenever a time synchronization message is received through any of the active protocols, the F35
clock updates. However, given that IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-104, Modbus, and DNP are low-accuracy time
synchronization methods, avoid their use for synchronization when better accuracy time protocols, such as IRIG-B and PTP,
are active in the system. If IRIG-B or PTP is used to update the relay clock, the other protocols (such as SNTP) are not
allowed to update, even if active.
See the COMMANDS  SET DATE AND TIME menu section of this manual to manually set the RTC.
The REAL TIME CLOCK EVENTS setting allows changes to the date and/or time to be captured in the event record. The event
records the RTC time before the adjustment. A Date/Time Changed event is generated when:
• The real time clock changed from SNTP/PTP/IRIG-B and the time difference is more than one second
• The real time clock changed from the front panel or via Modbus register. The relay always generates this event
regardless of the time difference.
• The Daylight Saving Time (DST) setting gets enabled and the current relay time is already in the DST zone
• The real time clock enters or leaves DST

5-148 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

To enable IRIG-B synchronization, the input IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE must be set to DC Shift or Amplitude Modulated. IRIG-B
synchronization can be disabled by making this setting None.
Clocks can be synchronized locally among several relays using the computer time. When using a time source, such as IRIG-
B, the time is overwritten eventually by the time source. To synchronize clocks among UR devices:
1. In the EnerVista software, expand the main menu in the Online Window area and select the Synchronize Devices
entry. The window opens. The software prompts to acknowledge any offline devices.
2. Click the Synchronize Devices button at the top of the window, and confirm the action at the prompt. The devices
assume the time of the computer being used.
To configure and enable PTP and/or SNTP, or to set local time parameters (for example time zone, daylight savings), use the
following sections.

5.3.7.2 Precision time protocol (1588)


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  REAL TIME CLOCK  PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL (1588)
 PRECISION TIME STRICT POWER Range: Enabled, Disabled
 PROTOCOL (1588)  PROFILE: Disabled

PTP DOMAIN NUMBER: Range: 0 to 255


 0

PTP VLAN PRIORITY: Range: 0 to 7


 4

PTP VLAN ID: Range: 0 to 4095


 0

 PTP PORT 1 See below


  5
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  REAL TIME CLOCK  PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL (1588)  PTP PORT 1(3)
 PTP PORT 1 PORT 1 PTP FUNCTION: Range: Enabled, Disabled
  Disabled

PORT 1 PATH DELAY Range: 0 to 60000 ns in steps of 1


 ADDER: 0 ns

PORT 1 PATH DELAY Range: –1000 to +1000 ns in steps of 1


 ASYMMETRY: 0 ns

The F35 is provided with optional Precision Time Protocol capability. This feature is specified as the IEEE 1588
software option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

The F35 supports the Precision Time Protocol (PTP) specified in IEEE Std 1588 2008 using the Power Profile (PP) specified in
IEEE Std C37.238 2011. This enables the relay to synchronize to the international time standard over an Ethernet network
that implements PP.
The relay can be configured to operate on some PTP networks that are not strictly PP. Time accuracy can be less than
specified for a PP network. Tolerated deviations from strict PP include 1) missing declaration of PP compliance in the
messages, 2) connection to a network device that does not support the PTP peer delay mechanism, 3) jitter substantially
greater than 1 µs in received event messages, and 4) certain non-compliant announce and sync message update rates.
The relay implements PTP according to IEEE Std 1588 2008 and the equivalent IEC 61588:2009(E), sometimes referred to as
version 2 PTP. It does not support the previous version of the standard (version 1).
PTP is a protocol that allows multiple clocks in a network to synchronize with one another. It permits synchronization
accuracies better than 1 ns, but this requires that each and every component in the network achieve very high levels of
accuracy and a very high baud rate, faster than normally used for relay communications. When operating over a generic
Ethernet network, time error can amount to 1 ms or more. PP is a profile of PTP which specifies a limited subset of PTP

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-149


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

suitable for use in power system protection, control, automation, and data communication applications, and thereby
facilitates interoperability between different vendor’s clocks and switches. PP specifies a worst-case delivered time error of
less than 1 µs over a 16-hop network.
In a PTP system and in a PP system, the clocks automatically organize themselves into a master-slave synchronization
hierarchy with the “best” clock available making itself the "grandmaster" at the top of the hierarchy; all others make
themselves “slaves” and track the grandmaster. Typically the grandmaster clock receives its time from GPS satellites or
some other link to the international time standard. If the grandmaster fails, the next “best” clock available in the domain
assumes the grandmaster role. When a clock on start-up discovers that it is “better” than the present grandmaster, it
assumes the grandmaster role and the previous grandmaster reverts to slave. The F35 qualification mechanism accepts a
potential master clock as a new grandmaster, when in a four-second interval it has received three announce messages
from it, all better than the present grandmaster clock and better than any other announce in this interval.
Time messages issued by the grandmaster are delayed as they pass through the network both due to the finite speed of
the signal in the interconnecting fiber or wire, and due to processing delays in the Ethernet switches. Each clock and switch
implementing PP measures the propagation delay to each of its PP neighbors, and compensates for these delays in the
time received. Each network device implementing PP measures the processing delay it introduces in each time message
and compensates for this delay in the time it transmits. As a result, the time delivered to end-devices such as the UR are
virtually identical to the grandmaster time. If one of the network devices in the hierarchy does not fully implement PP, the
associated propagation delay and/or latency may not be compensated for, and the time received at the end-device can be
in error by more than 100 µs.
See the preceding Real Time Clock section for a description of when time values received via PTP are used to update the
relay’s real time clock.
The following settings are available for configuring the relay for PTP. The PTP menu displays only when the option was
purchased.
STRICT POWER PROFILE — Power profile (IEEE Std C37.238 2011) requires that the relay only select a power profile compliant
5 clock as a grandmaster, that the delivered time have worst-case error of ±1 µs, and that the peer delay mechanism be
implemented. With the strict power profile setting enabled, the relay only selects as master the clocks displaying the
IEEE_C37_238 identification codes. It uses a port only when the peer delay mechanism is operational. With the strict power
profile setting disabled, the relay uses clocks without the power profile identification when no power profile clocks are
present, and uses ports even if the peer delay mechanism is non-operational. This setting applies to all of the relay’s PTP
capable ports.
PTP DOMAIN NUMBER — Set this setting to the domain number of the grandmaster-capable clock(s) to be synchronized to. A
network can support multiple time distribution domains, each distinguished with a unique domain number. More
commonly, there is a single domain using the default domain number zero.
This setting applies to all of the relay’s PTP capable ports.
PTP VLAN PRIORITY — This setting selects the value of the priority field in the 802.1Q VLAN tag in request messages issued
by the relay’s peer delay mechanism. In compliance with PP the default VLAN priority is 4, but it is recommended that it be
set to 7 in accordance with PTP. Depending on the characteristics of the device to which the relay is linked directly, VLAN
Priority can have no effect.
This setting applies to all of the relay’s PTP capable ports.
PTP VLAN ID — This setting selects the value of the ID field in the 802.1Q VLAN tag in request messages issued by the relay’s
peer delay mechanism. It is provided in compliance with PP. As these messages have a destination address that indicates
they are not to be bridged, their VLAN ID serves no function, and so can be left at its default value. Depending on the
characteristics of the device to which the relay is linked directly, VLAN ID can have no effect. This setting applies to all of
the relay’s PTP capable ports.
PORT 1 ... 3 FUNCTION — While this port setting is selected to disabled, PTP is disabled on this port. The relay does not
generate or listen to PTP messages on this port.
PORT 1 ... 3 PATH DELAY ADDER — The time delivered by PTP is advanced by the time value in this setting prior to the time
being used to synchronize the relay’s real time clock. This is to compensate to the extent practical for time delivery delays
not compensated for in the network. In a fully compliant PP network, the peer delay and the processing delay mechanisms
compensate for all the delays between the grandmaster and the relay. In such networks, make this setting zero.

5-150 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

In networks containing one or more switches and/or clocks that do not implement both of these mechanisms, not all
delays are compensated, so the time of message arrival at the relay is later than the time indicated in the message. This
setting can be used to approximately compensate for this delay. However, as the relay is not aware of network switching
that dynamically changes the amount of uncompensated delay, there is no setting that always and completely corrects
for uncompensated delay. A setting can be chosen that reduces the worst-case error to half of the range between
minimum and maximum uncompensated delay, if these values are known.
PORT 1 ... 3 PATH DELAY ASSYMMETRY — This setting corresponds to “delayAsymmetry” in PTP, which is used by the peer delay
mechanism to compensate for any difference in the propagation delay between the two directions of a link. Except in
unusual cases, the two fibers are of essentially identical length and composition, so make this setting zero.
In unusual cases where the length of the link is different in different directions, set this setting to the number of
nanoseconds the Ethernet propagation delay to the relay is longer than the mean of path propagation delays to and from
the relay. For instance, if it is known say from the physical length of the fibers and the propagation speed in the fibers that
the delay from the relay to the Ethernet switch it is connected to is 9000 ns and that the delay from the switch to the relay
is 11000 ns, then the mean delay is 10000 ns, and the path delay asymmetry is 11000 - 10000 = +1000 ns.

5.3.7.3 SNTP protocol


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  REAL TIME CLOCK  SNTP PROTOCOL
 SNTP PROTOCOL SNTP FUNCTION: Range: Enabled, Disabled
  Disabled

SNTP SERVER1 IP Range: standard IP address format


 ADDR: 127.0.0.1

SNTP SERVER2 IP Range: standard IP address format


 ADDR: 127.0.0.1

 SNTP SERVER1 UDP Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1 5


PORT: 123

SNTP SERVER2 UDP Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 PORT: 123

The F35 supports the Simple Network Time Protocol specified in RFC-2030. With SNTP, the F35 can obtain clock time over
an Ethernet network. The F35 acts as an SNTP client to receive time values from redundant SNTP/NTP servers, usually a
dedicated product using a GPS receiver to provide an accurate time. One or two SNTP servers can be used; use of both
servers for redundancy is recommended but not required.
To use SNTP, enable the function and set SNTP SERVER1 IP ADDR and/or SNTP SERVER2 IP ADDR to the SNTP/NTP server IP
addresses. The F35 attempts to obtain time values from the SNTP SERVER1 SNTP/NTP server. If SERVER1 is not available/
reachable, the F35 switches to the SNTP SERVER2 to get the time value and vice versa.
Since many time values are obtained and averaged, it generally takes three to four minutes until the F35 clock is closely
synchronized with the SNTP/NTP server. It can take up to 20 minutes for the F35 to signal an SNTP self-test error if the
server is offline, depending on the number and SNTP server modes. Broadcast mode timeout is 10 minutes and unicast
timeout is 80 seconds (corresponds to three unicast request retries).
SNTP FUNCTION — Enables or disables the SNTP feature on the F35.
SNTP SERVER1 IP ADDR — The F35 uses the SERVER1 address to contact an SNTP/NTP server to obtain time values. When the
SNTP FUNCTION setting is set to enabled or on startup if the setting is enabled, the F35 SNTP client requests SERVER1 for the
time value. If the SERVER1 channel fails or is not reachable, the F35 switches to SERVER2 SNTP/NTP server.
If SERVER1 SNTP server is set to 127.0.0.1, the F35 considers the SERVER1 SNTP server to be unconfigured.
To use SERVER1 SNTP in broadcast mode, set the SNTP SERVER1 IP ADDR setting to "0.0.0.0" and SNTP FUNCTION to "Enabled."
The F35 SNTP client then listens to SNTP messages sent to the "all ones" broadcast address for the subnet. The F35 waits
up to 18 minutes (>1024 seconds) without receiving an SNTP broadcast message before switching to the alternate
channel.
SNTP SERVER2 IP ADDR — The F35 uses this address to contact an SNTP/NTP server if SERVER1 channel fails or is not
reachable. If SERVER2 SNTP server is set to 127.0.0.1, the F35 considers the SERVER2 SNTP server to be unconfigured.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-151


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

To use SERVER2 SNTP in broadcast mode, set the SNTP SERVER2 IP ADDR setting to "0.0.0.0" and SNTP FUNCTION to "Enabled."
The F35 SNTP client then listens to SNTP messages sent to the "all ones" broadcast address for the subnet. The F35 waits
up to 18 minutes (>1024 seconds) without receiving an SNTP broadcast message before switching to the alternate
channel.
SNTP SERVER1 UDP PORT — This setting is 123 for normal SNTP operation. If SERVER1 SNTP is not required, close the port by
changing this setting to zero.
SNTP SERVER2 UDP PORT — This setting is 123 for normal SNTP operation. If SERVER2 SNTP is not required, close the port by
changing this setting to zero.

Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
If SERVER1 IP ADDR and UDP PORT settings match the SERVER2 IP ADDR and UDP PORT settings, the F35 considers only
the SERVER1 SNTP server as being configured and an SNTP Failure error message generates. The failure message
also displays when both servers are unavailable.

5.3.7.4 Local time


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  REAL TIME CLOCK  LOCAL TIME
 LOCAL TIME LOCAL TIME OFFSET Range: –24.0 to 24.0 hr in steps of 0.5
  FROM UTC: 0.0 hr

DAYLIGHT SAVINGS Range: Disabled, Enabled


 TIME: Disabled

DST START MONTH: Range: January to December (all months)



5 January

DST START DAY: Range: Sunday to Saturday (all days of the week)
 Sunday

DST START DAY Range: First, Second, Third, Fourth, Last


 INSTANCE: First

DST START HOUR: Range: 0:00 to 23:00 in steps of one hour


 2:00

DST STOP MONTH: Range: January to December (all months)


 January

DST STOP DAY: Range: Sunday to Saturday (all days of the week)
 Sunday

DST STOP DAY Range: First, Second, Third, Fourth, Last


 INSTANCE: First

DST STOP HOUR: Range: 0:00 to 23:00 in steps of one hour


 2:00

The F35 maintains two times: local time and Universal Coordinated Time (UTC). Local time can be provided by IRIG-B
signals. UTC time is provided by SNTP servers.
The real-time clock (RTC) and time stamps reported in historical records and communication protocols can be incorrect if
the Local Time settings are not configured properly.
See the IRIG-B section in the Installation chapter for guidance on these settings when using an IRIG-B source that sets the
IRIG-B control bits according to IEEE Std 1344-1995.
LOCAL TIME OFFSET FROM UTC — Used to specify the local time zone offset from UTC (Greenwich Mean Time) in hours. Time
zones in the eastern hemisphere have positive values; time zones in the western hemisphere have negative values. A value
of zero causes the relay to use UTC for local time. This setting has two uses. When the system RTC is synchronized with a
communications protocol providing only local time or it is free-running, the offset setting is used to calculate UTC from the

5-152 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

local time these provide. When the RTC is synchronized with a communications protocol providing only UTC (such as PTP or
SNTP), the time offset setting is used to determine local time from the UTC provided. PTP
ALTERNATE_TIME_OFFSET_INDICATOR TLVs are not used to calculate local time.
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME and DST — Can be used to allow the relay to follow the DST rules of the local time zone. Note that
when IRIG-B time synchronization is active, the local time in the IRIG-B signal contains any daylight savings time offset and
so the DST settings are ignored.

5.3.8 Fault reports


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  FAULT REPORTS  FAULT REPORT 1(5)
 FAULT REPORT 1 FAULT REPORT 1 Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
  SOURCE: SRC 1

FAULT REPORT 1 TRIG: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

FAULT REPORT 1 Z1 Range: 0.01 to 250.00 ohms in steps of 0.01


 MAG: 3.00 

FAULT REPORT 1 Z1 Range: 25 to 90° in steps of 1


 ANGLE: 75°

FAULT REPORT 1 Z0 Range: 0.01 to 650.00 ohms in steps of 0.01


 MAG: 9.00 

FAULT REPORT 1 Z0 Range: 25 to 90° in steps of 1


 ANGLE: 75°

 FAULT REPORT 1 Z0M


MAG: 0.00 
Range: 0.00 to 650.00 ohms in steps of 0.01
5
FAULT REPORT 1 Z0M Range: 25 to 90° in steps of 1
 ANGLE: 75°

FAULT REPORT 1 LINE Range: km, miles


 LENGTH UNITS: km

FAULT REP 1 LENGTH Range: 0.0 to 2000.0 in steps of 0.1


 (km ): 100.0

FAULT REPORT 1 VT Range: None, I0, V0


 SUBSTITUTION: None

FAULT REP 1 SYSTEM Range: 0.01 to 650.00 ohms in steps of 0.01


 Z0 MAG: 2.00 

FAULT REP 1 SYSTEM Range: 25 to 90° in steps of 1


 Z0 ANGLE: 75°

FAULT REPORT 1 Z0M Range: 0.00 to 650.00 ohms in steps of 0.01


 MAG: 0.00 

The F35 relay supports one fault report and an associated fault locator per CT bank to a maximum of five. The signal
source and trigger condition, as well as the characteristics of the line or feeder, are entered in this menu.
The fault report stores data, in non-volatile memory, pertinent to an event when triggered. The captured data contained in
the FaultReport.txt file includes:
• Fault report number
• Name of the relay, programmed by the user
• Firmware revision of the relay
• Date and time of trigger
• Name of trigger (specific operand)
• Line or feeder ID via the name of a configured signal source

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-153


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

• Active setting group at the time of trigger


• Pre-fault current and voltage phasors (two cycles before either a 50DD disturbance associated with fault report
source or the trigger operate). Once a disturbance is detected, pre-fault phasors hold for three seconds waiting for the
fault report trigger. If trigger does not occur within this time, the values are cleared to prepare for the next disturbance.
• Fault current and voltage phasors (one cycle after the trigger)
• Elements operated at the time of triggering
• Events — Nine before trigger and seven after trigger (only available via the relay web page)
• Fault duration times for each breaker (created by the breaker arcing current feature)
The captured data also includes the fault type, the distance to the fault location, distance to the fault location, fault loop
impedance, as well as the reclose shot number (when applicable). To include fault duration times in the fault report, enable
and configure the breaker arcing current feature for each of the breakers. Fault duration is reported on a per-phase basis.
The relay allows locating faults, including ground faults, from delta-connected VTs. In this case, the missing zero-sequence
voltage is substituted either by the externally provided neutral voltage (broken delta VT) connected to the auxiliary voltage
channel of a VT bank, or by the zero-sequence voltage approximated as a voltage drop developed by the zero-sequence
current, and user-provided zero-sequence equivalent impedance of the system behind the relay.
The trigger can be any FlexLogic operand, but in most applications it is expected to be the same operand, usually a virtual
output, that is used to drive an output relay to trip a breaker. To prevent the overwriting of fault events, do not use the
disturbance detector to trigger a fault report. A FAULT RPT TRIG event is automatically created when the report is triggered.
If a number of protection elements are ORed to create a fault report trigger, the first operation of any element causing the
OR gate output to become high triggers a fault report. However, If other elements operate during the fault and the first
operated element has not been reset (the OR gate output is still high), the fault report is not triggered again. Considering
the reset time of protection elements, there is very little chance that a fault report can be triggered twice in this manner. As
the fault report must capture a usable amount of pre and post-fault data, it cannot be triggered faster than every 20 ms.
5 Each fault report is stored as a file; the relay capacity is 15 files. A 16th trigger overwrites the oldest file.
Individual fault report features store their files in the same memory space. The sixteenth report overwrites the first one
regardless of which fault report feature produced the sixteenth and the first records.
The EnerVista software is required to view all captured data. The relay faceplate display can be used to view the date and
time of trigger, the fault type, the distance location of the fault, and the reclose shot number.
The FAULT REPORT 1 SOURCE setting selects the source for input currents and voltages and disturbance detection. For the
application of entirely parallel lines, the fault report can be programmed to apply compensation for the zero sequence
mutual coupling between parallel lines when calculating fault resistance and fault loop impedance. If this compensation is
required, the ground current (3I_0) from the parallel line must be connected to the ground input CT of the CT bank
configured under the FAULT REPORT 1 SOURCE with the same polarity as the phase current input configured in the same
source.
The FAULT 1 REPORT TRIG setting assigns the FlexLogic operand representing the protection element/elements requiring
operational fault location calculations. The distance to fault calculations are initiated by this signal. The FAULT REPORT 1 Z1
MAG, FAULT REPORT 1 Z0 MAG, and FAULT REPORT 1 Z0M MAG impedances are entered in secondary ohms.
For the application of entirely parallel lines, Z0M MAG/ANG is the mutual zero-sequence impedance for the whole line,
required to compensate the calculation of fault resistance and fault loop impedance.
The FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting is set to “None” if the relay is fed from wye-connected VTs. If delta-connected
VTs are used, and the relay is supplied with the neutral (3V0) voltage, this setting is set to “V0”. The method is still exact, as
the fault locator combines the line-to-line voltage measurements with the neutral voltage measurement to re-create the
line-to-ground voltages. See the ACTUAL VALUES  RECORDS  FAULT REPORTS menu for details. It is required to configure
the delta and neutral voltages under the source indicated as input for the fault report. Also, the relay checks if the auxiliary
signal configured is marked as “Vn” by the user (under VT setup) and inhibits the fault location if the auxiliary signal is
labeled differently.
If the broken-delta neutral voltage is not available to the relay, an approximation is possible by assuming the missing zero-
sequence voltage to be an inverted voltage drop produced by the zero-sequence current and the user-specified
equivalent zero-sequence system impedance behind the relay: V0 = –Z0  I0. In order to enable this mode of operation, the
FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting is set to “I0”.

5-154 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

The FAULT REP 1 SYSTEM Z0 MAG and FAULT REP 1 SYSTEM Z0 ANGLE settings are used only when the VT SUBSTITUTION setting
value is “I0”. The magnitude is to be entered in secondary ohms. This impedance is an average system equivalent behind
the relay. It can be calculated as zero-sequence Thevenin impedance at the local bus with the protected line/feeder
disconnected. The method is accurate only if this setting matches perfectly the actual system impedance during the fault.
If the system exhibits too much variability, this approach is questionable and the fault location results for single-line-to-
ground faults is trusted accordingly. Keep in mind that grounding points in the vicinity of the installation impact the system
zero-sequence impedance (grounded loads, reactors, zig-zag transformers, shunt capacitor banks, and so on).

5.3.9 Oscillography

5.3.9.1 Menu
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  OSCILLOGRAPHY
 OSCILLOGRAPHY NUMBER OF RECORDS: Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
  5

TRIGGER MODE: Range: Automatic Overwrite, Protected


 Automatic Overwrite

TRIGGER POSITION: Range: 0 to 100% in steps of 1


 50%

TRIGGER SOURCE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AC INPUT WAVEFORMS: Range: Off; 8, 16, 32, 64 samples/cycle


 16 samples/cycle

  DIGITAL CHANNELS

See below 5
 ANALOG CHANNELS See below
 

Oscillography records contain waveforms captured at the sampling rate as well as other relay data at the point of trigger.
Oscillography records are triggered by a programmable FlexLogic operand. Multiple oscillography records can be captured
simultaneously.
To retrieve an Oscillography record from a relay:
1. If not yet set up for oscillography, configure settings under Settings > Product Setup > Oscillography in the EnerVista
software.
2. Access Actual Values > Records > Oscillography in the EnerVista software.
3. In the window that opens, select the record number. The highest number is the most recent record (Newest Record
Number).
4. Click the Read button to get the waveform. When available, waveforms are displayed graphically, and otherwise error
messages display.
5. In the waveform window that opens, you can save the file, for example with the CFG extension.
When EnerVista UR Setup creates a new settings file, a Smart defaults feature automatically enters a basic oscillography
configuration. The basic configuration changes the factory default values to make the number of samples per cycle 32,
adds a selection of digital and analog channels that are often of interest, and adds a FlexLogic equation to trigger
oscillography. Review and update this basic configuration as required for the application at hand.
The NUMBER OF RECORDS is selectable, but the number of cycles captured in a single record varies considerably based on
other factors, such as sample rate and the number of operational modules. There is a fixed amount of data storage for
oscillography; the more data captured, the less the number of cycles captured per record. See the ACTUAL VALUES 
RECORDS  OSCILLOGRAPHY menu to view the number of cycles captured per record. The following table provides sample
configurations with corresponding cycles/record. The minimum number of oscillographic records is three.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-155


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Table 5-15: Oscillography cycles/record example


Records CT/VTs Sample rate Digital Analog Cycles per
channels channels record
3 1 32 32 16 2399
3 1 64 32 16 1450
16 1 32 32 16 666
16 1 64 32 16 402
32 1 32 32 16 352
32 1 64 32 16 213
3 2 32 32 16 1516
3 2 64 32 16 851
16 2 32 32 16 421

TRIGGER MODE — A new record automatically overwrites an older record when TRIGGER MODE is set to “Automatic
Overwrite.”
TRIGGER POSITION — Set this to a percentage of the total buffer size (for example, 10%, 50%, 75%, and so on). A trigger
position of 25% consists of 25% pre- and 75% post-trigger data.
TRIGGER SOURCE — Always captured in oscillography and can be any FlexLogic parameter (element state, contact input,
virtual output, and so on). The relay sampling rate is 64 samples per cycle.
AC INPUT WAVEFORMS — Determines the sampling rate at which AC input signals (that is, current and voltage) are stored.
Reducing the sampling rate allows longer records to be stored. This setting has no effect on the internal sampling rate of
the relay, which is always 64 samples per cycle. That is, it has no effect on the fundamental calculations of the device.

5 When changes are made to the oscillography settings, all existing oscillography records are cleared.

5.3.9.2 Digital channels


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  OSCILLOGRAPHY  DIGITAL CHANNELS
 DIGITAL CHANNELS DIGITAL CHANNEL 1: Range: FlexLogic operand
  Off

DIGITAL CHANNEL 63: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

DIGITAL 1(63) CHANNEL — This setting selects the FlexLogic operand state recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of
each oscillography trace depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to “Off” are ignored.
To populate quickly the rows in the Offline Window, use Ctrl C/V to copy/paste, or click then double-click a row to display a
quick selection window.
Figure 5-74: Quick selection window

5-156 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

5.3.9.3 Analog channels


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  OSCILLOGRAPHY  ANALOG CHANNELS
 ANALOG CHANNELS ANALOG CHANNEL 1: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog/actual value parameter
  Off See Appendix A for list

ANALOG CHANNEL 16: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog/actual value parameter
 Off See Appendix A for list

These settings select the metering actual value recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of each oscillography trace
depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to “Off” are ignored. The parameters available
in a given relay depend on
• the type of relay,
• the type and number of CT/VT hardware modules installed, and
• the type and number of analog input hardware modules installed
A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is presented in Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters. The
parameter index number shown in any of the tables is used to expedite the selection of the parameter on the relay display.
It can be time-consuming to scan through the list of parameters via the relay keypad and display — entering this number
via the relay keypad causes the corresponding parameter to display.
All eight CT/VT module channels are stored in the oscillography file. The CT/VT module channels are named as follows:
<slot_letter><terminal_number>—<I or V><phase A, B, or C, or 4th input>
The fourth current input in a bank is called IG, and the fourth voltage input in a bank is called VX. For example, F2-IB
designates the IB signal on terminal 2 of the CT/VT module in slot F.
If there are no CT/VT modules and analog input modules, no analog traces appear in the file; only the digital traces appear. 5
5.3.10 Data logger
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  DATA LOGGER
 DATA LOGGER DATA LOGGER MODE: Range: Continuous, Trigger
  Continuous

DATA LOGGER TRIGGER: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

DATA LOGGER RATE: Range: 15 to 3600000 ms in steps of 1


 60000 msec

DATA LOGGER CHNL 1: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog/actual value parameter


 Off See Appendix A for list

DATA LOGGER CHNL 16: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog/actual value parameter
 Off See Appendix A for list

DATA LOGGER CONFIG: Range: Not applicable - shows computed data only
 0 CHNL x 0.0 DAYS

The data logger samples and records up to 16 analog parameters at a user-defined sampling rate. This recorded data can
be downloaded to EnerVista UR Setup and displayed with parameters on the vertical axis and time on the horizontal axis.
All data is stored in non-volatile memory, so the information is retained when power to the relay is lost.
For a fixed sampling rate, the data logger can be configured with a few channels over a long period or a larger number of
channels for a shorter period. The relay automatically partitions the available memory between the channels in use. The
following table outlines examples of storage capacities for a system frequency of 60 Hz.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-157


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Table 5-16: Data logger storage capacity example


Sampling rate Channels Days Storage capacity
15 ms 1 0.1 482 s
8 0.1 60 s
9 0.1 54 s
16 0.1 30 s
1000 ms 1 0.3 32729 s
8 0.1 4091 s
9 0.1 3637 s
16 0.1 2046 s
60000 ms 1 22.7 1963710 s
8 2.8 245460 s
9 2.5 218190 s
16 1.4 127230 s
3600000 ms 1 1362.1 117822600 s
8 170.2 14727600 s
9 151.3 13091400 s

Changing any setting affecting data logger operation clears data in the log.

5 DATA LOGGER MODE — This setting configures the mode in which the data logger operates. When set to “Continuous,” the
data logger actively records any configured channels at the rate as defined by the DATA LOGGER RATE. The data logger is
idle in this mode when no channels are configured. When set to “Trigger,” the data logger records any configured channels
at the instance of the rising edge of the DATA LOGGER TRIGGER source FlexLogic operand. The data logger ignores all
subsequent triggers and continues to record data until the active record is full. Once the data logger is full, a CLEAR DATA
LOGGER command is required to clear the data logger record before a new record can be started. Performing the CLEAR
DATA LOGGER command also stops the current record and resets the data logger to be ready for the next trigger.
DATA LOGGER TRIGGER — This setting selects the signal used to trigger the start of a new data logger record. Any FlexLogic
operand can be used as the trigger source. This setting only applies when the mode is set to “Trigger.”
DATA LOGGER RATE — This setting selects the time interval at which the actual value data is recorded.
DATA LOGGER CHNL 1(16) — This setting selects the metering actual value that is to be recorded in Channel 1(16) of the data
log. The parameters available in a given relay are dependent on: the type of relay, the type and number of CT/VT hardware
modules installed, and the type and number of Analog Input hardware modules installed. Upon startup, the relay
automatically prepares the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is shown in
Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is used to expedite the
selection of the parameter on the relay display. It can be time-consuming to scan through the list of parameters via the
relay keypad/display—entering this number via the relay keypad causes the corresponding parameter to display.
DATA LOGGER CONFIG — This display presents the total amount of time that the Data Logger can record the channels not
selected to “Off” without overwriting old data.

5.3.11 Demand
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUTP  DEMAND
 DEMAND CRNT DEMAND METHOD: Range: Thermal Exponential, Block Interval, Rolling
  Thermal Exponential Demand

POWER DEMAND METHOD: Range: Thermal Exponential, Block Interval, Rolling


 Thermal Exponential Demand

5-158 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

DEMAND INTERVAL: Range: 5, 10, 15, 20, 30, 60 minutes


 15 MIN

DEMAND TRIGGER: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off Note: for calculation using method 2a

The relay measures current demand on each phase, and three-phase demand for real, reactive, and apparent power.
Current and Power methods can be chosen separately for the convenience of the user. Settings are provided to allow the
user to emulate common electrical utility demand measuring techniques, for statistical or control purposes. If the CRNT
DEMAND METHOD is set to "Block Interval" and the DEMAND TRIGGER is set to “Off,” Method 2 is used as follows. If DEMAND
TRIGGER is assigned to any other FlexLogic operand, Method 2a is used as follows.
The relay can be set to calculate demand by any of the following three methods.

5.3.11.1 Calculation method 1: Thermal exponential


This method emulates the action of an analog peak-recording thermal demand meter. The relay measures the quantity
(RMS current, real power, reactive power, or apparent power) on each phase every second and assumes that the circuit
quantity remains at this value until updated by the next measurement. It calculates the 'thermal demand equivalent'
based on the following equation:

Eq. 5-6

where
d = demand value after applying input quantity for time t (in minutes)
D = input quantity (constant)
k = 2.3 / thermal 90% response time
The figure shows the 90% thermal response time characteristic of 15 minutes. A setpoint establishes the time to reach
90% of a steady-state value, just as the response time of an analog instrument. A steady state value applied for twice the
5
response time indicates 99% of the value.
Figure 5-75: Thermal demand characteristic
Demand (%)

Time (minutes) 842787A1.CDR

5.3.11.2 Calculation method 2: Block interval


This method calculates a linear average of the quantity (RMS current, real power, reactive power, or apparent power) over
the programmed demand time interval, starting daily at 00:00:00 (that is, 12:00 am). The 1440 minutes per day is divided
into the number of blocks as set by the programmed time interval. Each new value of demand becomes available at the
end of each time interval.

5.3.11.3 Calculation method 2a: Block interval (with start demand interval logic trigger)
This method calculates a linear average of the quantity (RMS current, real power, reactive power, or apparent power) over
the interval between successive Start Demand Interval logic input pulses. Each new value of demand becomes available at
the end of each pulse. Assign a FlexLogic operand to the DEMAND TRIGGER setting to program the input for the new
demand interval pulses.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-159


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

If no trigger is assigned in the DEMAND TRIGGER setting and the CRNT DEMAND METHOD is "Block Interval," use
calculation method 2. If a trigger is assigned, the maximum allowed time between two trigger signals is 60 minutes.
If no trigger signal appears within 60 minutes, demand calculations are performed and available, and the algorithm
resets and starts the new cycle of calculations. The minimum required time for trigger contact closure is 20 µs.

5.3.11.4 Calculation method 3: Rolling demand


This method calculates a linear average of the quantity (RMS current, real power, reactive power, or apparent power) over
the programmed demand time interval, in the same way as Block Interval. The value is updated every minute and
indicates the demand over the time interval just preceding the time of update.

5.3.12 User-programmable LEDs


5.3.12.1 Menu - Enhanced and basic front panels
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
 USER-PROGRAMMABLE  LED TEST See below
 LEDS  

 TRIP & ALARM LEDS See page 5-163


 

 USER-PROGRAMMABLE See page 5-163


  LED 1

5   USER-PROGRAMMABLE
 LED 48

5.3.12.2 Menu - Graphical front panel


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
 USER-PROGRAMMABLE  LED TEST See below
 LEDS  

 TRIP & ALARM LEDS See page 5-163


 

 EVENT CAUSE LED 1 See page 5-164


 

 EVENT CAUSE LED 9
 

The LEDs can be customized to illuminate when a selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state. The trip and alarm
LEDs can also be customized in a similar manner. To ensure correct functionality of all LEDs, an LED test feature is also
provided.

5.3.12.3 LED test


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS  LED TEST
 LED TEST LED TEST FUNCTION: Range: Disabled, Enabled
  Disabled

LED TEST CONTROL: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

5-160 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

When enabled, the LED test can be initiated from any digital input or user-programmable condition, such as a user-
programmable pushbutton. The control operand is configured under the LED TEST CONTROL setting. The test covers all
LEDs, including the LEDs of the optional user-programmable pushbuttons.
For the enhanced and basic front panels, the test consists of the following three stages:
1. All 62 LEDs on the relay are illuminated. This is a quick test to verify if any of the LEDs is “burned.” This stage lasts as
long as the control input is on, up to a maximum of one minute. After one minute, the test ends.
2. All the LEDs are turned off, and then one LED at a time turns on for one second, then back off. The test routine starts at
the top left panel, moving from the top to bottom of each LED column. This test checks for hardware failures that lead
to more than one LED being turned on from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
3. All the LEDs are turned on. One LED at a time turns off for one second, then back on. The test routine starts at the top
left panel moving from top to bottom of each column of the LEDs. This test checks for hardware failures that lead to
more than one LED being turned off from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
For the graphical front panel, the test consists of the following stages:
1. All 22 LEDs on the relay are illuminated. This is a quick test to verify if any of the LEDs is "burned." This stage lasts as
long as the control input is on, up to a maximum of one minute. After one minute, the test ends.
2. All the LEDs are turned off, and then one LED at a time turns on with the orange color for one second, then back off.
The test routine starts at the top left panel, moving from the top to bottom for all 14 LEDs. Then the eight pushbutton
LEDs are tested in the same manner. This test checks for hardware failures that lead to more than one LED being
turned on from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
3. All the LEDs are turned on with the orange color. One LED at a time turns off for one second, then back on. The test
routine starts at the top left panel moving from top to bottom for all 14 LEDs. Then the eight pushbutton LEDs are
tested in the same manner. This test checks for hardware failures that lead to more than one LED being turned off
from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
4. Additionally, stages 2 and 3 are repeated twice for the five device status LEDs and nine event cause LEDs, one time 5
with green color on and the other with red color on.
When testing is in progress, the LEDs are controlled by the test sequence, rather than the protection, control, and
monitoring features. However, the LED control mechanism accepts all the changes to LED states generated by the relay
and stores the actual LED states (on or off) in memory. When the test completes, the LEDs reflect the actual state resulting
from relay response during testing. The reset pushbutton does not clear any targets when the LED Test is in progress.
A dedicated FlexLogic operand, LED TEST IN PROGRESS, is set for the duration of the test. When the test sequence is initiated,
the LED TEST INITIATED event is stored in the event recorder.
The entire test procedure is user-controlled. In particular, stage 1 can last as long as necessary, and stages 2 and 3 can be
interrupted. The test responds to the position and rising edges of the control input defined by the LED TEST CONTROL
setting. The control pulses must last at least 250 ms to take effect. The following diagram explains how the test is
executed.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-161


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-76: LED test sequence

READY TO TEST

Reset the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
rising edge of the
operand
control input

Start the software image of Restore the LED states


the LEDs from the software image

Set the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
operand

control input is on

STAGE 1 time-out
(all LEDs on) (1 minute)

dropping edge of the


control input

rising edge of the


Wait 1 second
control input

STAGE 2 rising edge of the


(one LED on at a time) control input

rising edge of the

5
Wait 1 second
control input

rising edge
STAGE 3
of the control
(one LED off at a time) input

842011A1.CDR

Application example 1
Assume one needs to check if any of the LEDs is “burned” through user-programmable pushbutton 1. Apply the following
settings.
Configure user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following entries in the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-
PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS  USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu. (The option does not display when not purchased.)
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: “Self-reset”
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: “0.10 s”
Configure the LED test to recognize user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following entries in the SETTINGS 
PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS  LED TEST menu:
LED TEST FUNCTION: “Enabled”
LED TEST CONTROL: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
The test is initiated when the user-programmable pushbutton 1 is pressed. Keep the pushbutton pressed for as long as the
LEDs are being visually inspected. When finished, release the pushbutton. The relay then automatically starts stage 2. At
this point, test can be cancelled by pressing the pushbutton.

Application example 2
Assume one needs to check if any LEDs are “burned” as well as exercise one LED at a time to check for other failures. This
is to be performed via user-programmable pushbutton 1.
After applying the settings in application example 1, hold down the pushbutton as long as necessary to test all LEDs. When
finished, release the pushbutton so that the relay then automatically starts stage 2. When stage 2 is completed, stage 3
starts automatically. The test can be cancelled at any time by pressing the pushbutton.

5-162 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

5.3.12.4 Trip and alarm LEDs


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS  TRIP & ALARMS LEDS
 TRIP & ALARM LEDS TRIP LED INPUT: Range: FlexLogic operand
  Off

ALARM LED INPUT: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

The trip and alarm LEDs are in the first LED column (enhanced and graphical front panels) and on LED panel 1 (basic front
panel). Each LED can be programmed to turn on when the selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state.

5.3.12.5 User-programmable LED 1(48)


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS  USER-PROGRAMMABLE LED 1(48)
 USER-PROGRAMMABLE LED 1 OPERAND: Range: FlexLogic operand
 LED 1  Off

LED 1 TYPE: Range: Self-Reset, Latched


 Self-Reset

For the enhanced and basic front panels, there are 48 amber LEDs across the relay LED panels. Each of these indicators
can be programmed to illuminate when the selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state.
For the basic front panel, the LEDs are located as follows:
• LED Panel 2 — User-programmable LEDs 1 through 24
• LED Panel 3 — User programmable LEDs 25 through 48
For the enhanced front panel, the LEDs are located as follows: 5
• LED column 2 — User-programmable LEDs 1 through 12
• LED column 3 — User-programmable LEDs 13 through 24
• LED column 4 — User-programmable LEDs 25 through 36
• LED column 5 — User-programmable LEDs 37 through 48
See the LED Indicators section in chapter 4 for information on the location of these indexed LEDs.
The user-programmable LED settings select the FlexLogic operands that control the LEDs. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is “Self-
Reset” (the default setting), the LED illumination tracks the state of the selected LED operand. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is
“Latched,” the LED, once lit, remains so until reset by the front panel RESET button, from a remote device via a
communications channel, or from any programmed operand, even if the LED operand state de-asserts.
Table 5-17: Recommended settings for user-programmable LEDs
Setting Parameter Setting Parameter
LED 1 operand SETTING GROUP ACT 1 LED 13 operand Off
LED 2 operand SETTING GROUP ACT 2 LED 14 operand BREAKER 2 OPEN
LED 3 operand SETTING GROUP ACT 3 LED 15 operand BREAKER 2 CLOSED
LED 4 operand SETTING GROUP ACT 4 LED 16 operand BREAKER 2 TROUBLE
LED 5 operand SETTING GROUP ACT 5 LED 17 operand SYNC 1 SYNC OP
LED 6 operand SETTING GROUP ACT 6 LED 18 operand SYNC 2 SYNC OP
LED 7 operand Off LED 19 operand Off
LED 8 operand Off LED 20 operand Off
LED 9 operand BREAKER 1 OPEN LED 21 operand AR ENABLED
LED 10 operand BREAKER 1 CLOSED LED 22 operand AR DISABLED
LED 11 operand BREAKER 1 TROUBLE LED 23 operand AR RIP
LED 12 operand Off LED 24 operand AR LO

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-163


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

See the figure in the Setting Groups section of the Control Elements section later in this chapter for an example of group
activation.

5.3.12.6 Event cause LED 1(9)


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS  EVENT CAUSE LED 1(9)
 EVENT CAUSE LED 1 LED 1 OPERAND: Range: FlexLogic operand
  LED PICKUP

LED 1 COLOR: Range: Red, Green, Orange


 Green

LED 1 TYPE: Range: Self-Reset, Latched


 Self-Reset

For the graphical front panel, the event cause LED settings select the FlexLogic operands that control the LEDs.
LED 1 TYPE — If set to "Self-Reset," the LED illumination tracks the state of the selected LED operand. If set to "Latched," the
LED, once lit, remains so even the LED operand state already de-asserts, until reset by the front panel RESET button, from a
remote device via a communications channel, or from any programmed operand.
The table outlines default input operand and output operands for each event cause LED.
Table 5-18: Default input and output operand for event cause LEDs
LED Default input operand Output operand Default color
Event Cause LED 1 LED PICKUP EVENT CAUSE LED 1 Green
Event Cause LED 2 LED VOLTAGE EVENT CAUSE LED 2 Orange

5 Event Cause LED 3


Event Cause LED 4
LED CURRENT
LED FREQUENCY
EVENT CAUSE LED 3
EVENT CAUSE LED 4
Orange
Orange
Event Cause LED 5 LED OTHER EVENT CAUSE LED 5 Orange
Event Cause LED 6 LED PHASE A EVENT CAUSE LED 6 Orange
Event Cause LED 7 LED PHASE B EVENT CAUSE LED 7 Orange
Event Cause LED 8 LED PHASE C EVENT CAUSE LED 8 Orange
Event Cause LED 9 LED NEUTRAL/GROUND EVENT CAUSE LED 9 Orange

5.3.13 User-programmable self-tests


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMALBE SELF TESTS
 USER-PROGRAMMABLE DIRECT RING BREAK Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units equipped
 SELF TESTS  FUNCTION: Enabled with Direct Input/Output module.

DIRECT DEVICE OFF Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units equipped
 FUNCTION: Enabled with Direct Input/Output module.

RxGOOSE OFF Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Enabled

FIRST ETHERNET FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Disabled

SEC. ETHERNET FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Disabled

THIRD ETHERNET FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Disabled

SFP MODULE FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Disabled

BATTERY FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Enabled

5-164 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

SNTP FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Enabled

IRIG-B FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Enabled

PTP FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Enabled

All major self-test alarms are reported automatically with their corresponding FlexLogic operands, events, and targets.
This settings menu allows enabling and disabling of most minor self-test alarms.
When in the Disabled mode, minor alarms do not assert a FlexLogic operand, write to the event recorder, or display target
messages. Moreover, they do not trigger the ANY MINOR ALARM or ANY SELF-TEST messages. When in Enabled mode,
minor alarms continue to function along with other major and minor alarms. See the Relay Self-tests section in chapter 7
for information on major and minor self-test alarms.
When using the graphical front panel and setting annunciator alarms, the function needs to be enabled here too, else the
alarm is not triggered.

5.3.14 Control pushbuttons


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS  CONTROL PUSHBUTTON 1(7)
 CONTROL CONTROL PUSHBUTTN 1 ID Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
 PUSHBUTTON 1  CTRL PB 1

CONTROL PUSHBUTTON 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 FUNCTION: Disabled

 CONTROL PUSHBUTTON 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled 5


EVENTS: Disabled

This feature is supported with enhanced and basic front panels.


There are three standard control pushbuttons, labelled USER 1, USER 2, and USER 3, on the basic and enhanced front
panels. These are user-programmable and can be used for various applications such as performing an LED test, switching
setting groups, and invoking and scrolling though user-programmable displays.
The location of the control pushbuttons are shown in the following figures.
Figure 5-77: Control pushbuttons (enhanced front panel)

Control pushbuttons
842813A1.CDR

An additional four control pushbuttons are included on the basic front panel when the F35 is ordered with the 12 user-
programmable pushbutton option.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-165


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-78: Control pushbuttons (basic front panel)

STATUS EVENT CAUSE


IN SERVICE VOLTAGE
TROUBLE CURRENT RESET
TEST MODE FREQUENCY
TRIP OTHER USER 1 THREE
ALARM PHASE A STANDARD
PICKUP PHASE B USER 2
PHASE C
CONTROL
NEUTRAL/GROUND USER 3 PUSHBUTTONS

USER 4

USER 5 FOUR EXTRA


OPTIONAL
USER 6
CONTROL
USER 7 PUSHBUTTONS

842733A2.CDR

Control pushbuttons are not typically used for critical operations and are not protected by the control password. However,
by supervising their output operands, the user can dynamically enable or disable control pushbuttons for security reasons.
Each control pushbutton asserts its own FlexLogic operand. Each operand need to be configured appropriately to perform
the required function. Each operand remains asserted as long as the pushbutton is pressed and resets when the
pushbutton is released. A dropout delay of 100 ms is incorporated to ensure fast pushbutton manipulation is recognized
by various features that can use control pushbuttons as inputs.
An event is logged in the event record (as per user setting) when a control pushbutton is pressed. No event is logged when

5 the pushbutton is released. The front panel keys (including control keys) cannot be operated simultaneously—a given key
must be released before the next one can be pressed.
Figure 5-79: Control pushbutton logic
SETTING
CONTROL PUSHBUTTON

{
1 FUNCTION:
Enabled=1

SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP/
BREAKERS/BREAKER 1/
BREAKER 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL:
When applicable

AND RUN
Enabled=1
OFF TIMER
SYSTEM SETUP/ FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKERS/BREAKER 2/ ON 0 CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON
BREAKER 2 PUSHBUTTON 100 msec
CONTROL:
842010A2.CDR
Enabled=1

5.3.15 User-programmable pushbuttons


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS  USER PUSHBUTTON 1(16)
 USER PUSHBUTTON 1 PUSHBUTTON 1 Range: Self-Reset, Latched, Disabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters


 USER PB 1

PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters



PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters

5-166 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

PUSHBTN 1 HOLD: Range: 0.0 to 10.0 s in steps of 0.1


 0.0 s

PUSHBTN 1 SET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PUSHBTN 1 RESET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST Range: 0.2 to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1


 DELAY: 1.0 s

PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT Range: 0 to 60.00 s in steps of 0.05


 TIME: 0.00 s

PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE: Range: Disabled, Normal, High Priority


 Disabled

PUSHBUTTON 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

5
The F35 is provided with this optional feature, specified as an option at the time of ordering. Using the order
code for your device, see the order codes in chapter 2 for details.

User-programmable pushbuttons provide an easy and error-free method of entering digital state (on, off) information. The
number depends on the front panel ordered.
• Enhanced horizontal front panel — 16 user-programmable pushbuttons
• Enhanced vertical front panel — 6 user-programmable pushbuttons
• Basic horizontal front panel — 12 user-programmable pushbuttons
• Graphical front panel — 16 user-programmable pushbuttons (eight physical pushbuttons, eight graphical interface
pushbuttons)

User-programmable pushbuttons require a front panel with that option. If the front panel was ordered separately,
update the EnerVista software under Maintenance > Change Front Panel.

The digital state can be entered locally (by directly pressing the front panel pushbutton or optional graphical front panel
interface) or remotely (via FlexLogic operands) into FlexLogic equations, protection elements, and control elements. Typical
applications include breaker control, autorecloser blocking, and setting groups changes. For example, set pushbuttons 1 to
5 to select settings groups 1 to 5, or set pushbutton 1 to clear event records. The user-programmable pushbuttons are
under the control level of password protection.

Example
To clear event records using pushbutton 1, set Settings > Product Setup > Clear Relay Records > Clear Event Records to
FlexLogic operand PUSHBUTTON 1 ON. Then program the pushbutton by setting Settings > Product Setup > User-
Programmable Pushbuttons > Pushbutton 1 Function to "Self-reset." For a graphical front panel, to use a side
pushbutton 9 to 16 to clear the event records, it also needs to be programmed in a single-line diagram.
The figures show user-configurable pushbuttons for the front panels.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-167


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-80: User-programmable pushbuttons (enhanced front panel)


USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER
LABEL 1 LABEL 2 LABEL 3 LABEL 4 LABEL 5 LABEL 6 LABEL 7 LABEL 8 LABEL 9 LABEL 10 LABEL 11 LABEL 12 LABEL 13 LABEL 14 LABEL 15 LABEL 16

842814A1.CDR

Figure 5-81: User-programmable pushbuttons (basic front panel)

1 3 5 7 9 11
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL

2 4 6 8 10 12
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL

842779A1.cdr

Figure 5-82: User-programmable pushbuttons (graphical front panel)


Program any buttons for pushbuttons 9 to 16 Pushbuttons 1 to 8

5
1 5

2 6

3 7

4 8

RESET ESC
ENTER

Multilin N60 Network Stability and Synchrophasor Measurement System

859761A1.CDR

Front panel pushbuttons and LEDs can be custom labelled as outlined in the Front Panel Labelling section in the previous
chapter.
Each pushbutton asserts its own “On” and “Off” FlexLogic operands (for example, PUSHBUTTON 1 ON and PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF).
These operands are available for each pushbutton and are used to program specific actions. If any pushbutton is active,
the ANY PB ON operand is asserted.
Each pushbutton has an associated LED indicator. By default, this indicator displays the present status of the
corresponding pushbutton (on or off). However, each LED indicator can be assigned to any FlexLogic operand through the
PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL setting.
The activation and deactivation of user-programmable pushbuttons depends on whether latched or self-reset mode is
programmed.
• Latched mode — In latched mode, a pushbutton can be set (activated) by asserting the operand assigned to the
PUSHBTN 1 SET setting, by directly pressing the associated front panel pushbutton, or with the graphical front panel

5-168 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

interface. The state of each pushbutton is stored in non-volatile memory and maintained through a loss of control
power.
The pushbutton is reset (deactivated) in latched mode by asserting the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 RESET
setting, by directly pressing the active front panel pushbutton, or with the graphical front panel interface.
It can also be programmed to reset automatically through the PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST and PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY
settings. These settings enable the autoreset timer and specify the associated time delay. The autoreset timer can be
used in select-before-operate (SBO) breaker control applications, where the command type (close/open) or breaker
location (feeder number) must be selected prior to command execution. The selection must reset automatically if
control is not executed within a specified time period.
• Self-reset mode — In self-reset mode, a user-programmable pushbutton can be set (activated) by asserting the
operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting, by pressing the front panel pushbutton, or by the graphical front panel
interface. A pushbutton remains active for the time it is pressed physically or pressed in the graphical front panel
interface, plus the dropout time specified in the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME setting. If the pushbutton is activated via
FlexLogic, the pulse duration is specified by the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME only. The time the operand assigned to the
PUSHBTN 1 SET setting remains On has no effect on the pulse duration.

The pulse duration of the remote set or local front panel pushbutton must be at least 50 ms to operate the
pushbutton. This allows the user-programmable pushbuttons to properly operate during power cycling events and
various system disturbances that can cause transient assertion of the operating signals.
The local and remote operation of each user-programmable pushbutton can be inhibited through the PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL
and PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE settings. If local inhibit is applied, the pushbutton ignores set and reset commands executed
through the front panel pushbuttons. If remote inhibit is applied, the pushbutton ignores set and reset commands
executed through FlexLogic operands.
The inhibit functions are not applied to the autoreset feature. The inhibit function can be used in SBO control operations to
prevent user-programmable pushbutton activation and ensuring “one-at-a-time” select operation. 5
The inhibit functions can also be used to prevent pushbutton activation from the accidental pressing of the front panel
pushbuttons. The separate inhibit of the local and remote operation simplifies the implementation of local/remote control
supervision.
Pushbutton states can be logged by the event recorder. User-defined messages can also be associated with each
pushbutton and displayed on basic and enhanced front panels when the user-programmable pushbutton is activated, and
when in the latched mode when the user-programmable pushbutton is deactivated. With the graphical front panel
interface, instead of messages, the status of user-programmable pushbuttons can display on a single-line diagram and
can also display in annunciator page windows and in actual values page cells.
For the graphical front panel, the pushbuttons 1 to 8 are linked to the eight physical pushbuttons, and pushbuttons 9 to 16
are mapped to the graphical interface pushbuttons. To set the buttons for pushbuttons 9 to 16, access Settings > Product
Setup > Graphical Panel > Single Line Diagram Editor, click the PB symbol in the toolbox, then configure pushbuttons 9 to
16.
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION — This setting selects the mode of the pushbutton (Self-Reset, Latched, Disabled). If set to
“Disabled,” the pushbutton is not active and the corresponding FlexLogic operands (both “On” and “Off”) are de-asserted. If
set to "Latched," the pushbutton remains on until reset.
PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT — This setting specifies the top 20-character line of the user-programmable pushbutton message and is
intended to provide ID information of the pushbutton. For example, the text displays in the Event Record. See the User-
definable Displays section in this chapter for instructions on how to enter alphanumeric characters from the keypad. On a
graphical front panel, this setting instead controls the label of the user-programmable pushbutton component on single-
line diagrams.
PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT — This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable pushbutton message
and is displayed when the pushbutton is in the “on” position. See the User-definable Displays section for instructions on
entering alphanumeric characters from the keypad. On a graphical front panel, this setting instead controls the on status
text of the user-programmable pushbutton component on single-line diagrams. This setting is not applied to the physical
pushbuttons on the graphical front panel.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-169


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT — This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable pushbutton message
and displays when the pushbutton is deactivated and the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Latched.” A message does not
display when the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Self-reset” as the pushbutton operand status is implied to be “Off” upon its
release. The length of the “Off” message is configured with the PRODUCT SETUP  DISPLAY PROPERTIES  FLASH MESSAGE
TIME setting. On a graphical front panel, this setting instead controls the off status text of the user-programmable
pushbutton component on single-line diagrams. This setting is not applied to the physical pushbuttons on the graphical
front panel.
PUSHBTN 1 HOLD — This setting specifies the time required for a front panel pushbutton to be pressed before it is deemed
active. This timer is reset upon release of the pushbutton. Note that user-programmable pushbutton operation requires the
front panel pushbutton to be pressed a minimum of 50 ms. This minimum time is required prior to activating the user-
programmable pushbutton hold timer.
PUSHBTN 1 SET — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to activate the user-programmable pushbutton
element. The duration of the incoming set signal must be at least 50 ms.
PUSHBTN 1 RESET — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to deactivate the user-programmable pushbutton
element. This setting is applicable only if the user-programmable pushbutton is in "Latched" mode.
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST — This setting enables the user-programmable pushbutton autoreset feature. This setting is applicable
only if the pushbutton is in “Latched” mode.
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY — This setting specifies the time delay for automatic reset of the pushbutton when in "Latched"
mode.
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit user-programmable pushbutton
operation from the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET or PUSHBTN 1 RESET settings.
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit user-programmable pushbutton operation
from the front panel pushbuttons. This inhibit functionality is not applicable to pushbutton autoreset.
5 PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME — This setting applies only to “Self-Reset” mode and specifies the duration of the user-
programmable pushbutton active status after the front panel pushbutton or graphical front panel interface pushbutton
has been released. When activated remotely, this setting specifies the entire activation time of the pushbutton; the length
of time the operand selected by PUSHBTN 1 SET remains on has no effect on the pulse duration.
PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to drive the front panel pushbutton LED. If this
setting is “Off,” then LED operation is directly linked to the PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand. This setting is not applied to
Pushbuttons 9 to 16 on the graphical front panel, where the label background shows the orange glow color for the "on"
state.
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE — This setting controls the behavior of the user-programmable pushbutton on message that is
programmed in the PUSHBTN 1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT settings, and the behavior of the user-programmable pushbutton
off message that is programmed in the PUSHBTN 1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT settings. This settings has no effect on the
graphical front panel.
When set to "Disabled", user-programmable pushbutton messages do not display. Otherwise the on message displays
when the user-programmable pushbutton becomes activated, and if in the "Latched" mode the off message displays when
the user-programmable pushbutton becomes deactivated.
When set to "Normal", the duration the message displays is as specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting.
When set to "High Priority", the duration of the off message is as specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting, but the on
message is displayed as long as the user-programmable pushbutton is activated. While activated, target and other
messages are suppressed. To allow front panel keypad operation, when a keypad button is pressed the message is
supressed for 10 seconds.
PUSHBUTTON 1 EVENTS — If this setting is enabled, each user-programmable pushbutton state change is logged as an
event into the event recorder.
The figures show the user-programmable pushbutton logic.

5-170 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-83: User-programmable pushbutton logic (Sheet 1 of 2)


SETTING
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION
= Enabled
= Latched LATCHED To user-programmable
= Self-Reset pushbuttons logic
sheet 2
OR From front panel
SETTING SETTING
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL PUSHBTN 1 HOLD
Off = 0 TPKP
From front panel AND
0
AND
OR TIMER
From graphical front panel
50 ms

SETTING 0 OR
PUSHBTN 1 SET
Off = 0 TIMER
50 ms Non-volatile latch
SETTING AND S
AND
0
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE Latch
Off = 0 R
TIMER
SETTING 200 ms
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
0

SETTING
PUSHBTN 1 RESET AND
Off = 0

OR To user-programmable
SETTING OR PUSHBUTTON ON pushbuttons logic
SETTING sheet 2
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST
TPKP
= Enabled
AND AND
= Disabled

5
0

TIMER
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND 200 ms OR
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
0

SETTING
AND PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME
0
OR
TRST
AND

842237A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-171


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-84: User-programmable pushbutton logic (Sheet 2 of 2)

OFF MESSAGE
ENGAGE MESSAGE
SETTING
LATCHED FLASH MESSAGE TIME
SETTINGS
0 PUSHBTN ID TEXT
AND
OR TRST = XXXXXXXXXX
PUSHBTN OFF TEXT
= XXXXXXXXXX
Instantaneous
From user-programmable reset * Enhanced and standard front panels
pushbuttons logic sheet 1

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LATCHED/SELF-RESET
AND PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON ON PUSHBUTTON 1 ON

ON MESSAGE
SETTING ENGAGE MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE
AND
= Disabled
= High Priority SETTINGS
= Normal PUSHBTN ID TEXT
= XXXXXXXXXX
OR
PUSHBTN ON TEXT
SETTING
= XXXXXXXXXX
FLASH MESSAGE TIME
0 Enhanced and standard front panels
AND
TRST The message is temporarily removed if

5
any keypad button is pressed. Ten
seconds of keypad inactivity restores
Instantaneous
Instantaneous reset is executed if any reset * the message.
front panel button is pressed or any new
target or message becomes active.

PUSHBUTTON 1 LED LOGIC


1. If pushbutton 1 LED control is set to off.
Pushbutton 1
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND LED
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
PUSHBUTTON 2 ON
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 3 ON 2. If pushbutton 1 LED control is not set to off.
OR ANY PB ON
SETTING Pushbutton 1
LED
PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL
PUSHBUTTON 16 ON = any FlexLogic operand
The enhanced front panel has 16 operands;
the standard front panel has 12
842239A1.CDR

5.3.16 Flex state parameters


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  FLEX STATE PARAMETERS
 FLEX STATE PARAMETER 1: Range: FlexLogic operand
 PARAMETERS  Off

PARAMETER 256: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

This feature provides a mechanism where any of 256 selected FlexLogic operand states can be used for efficient
monitoring. The feature allows user-customized access to the FlexLogic operand states in the relay. The state bits are
packed so that 16 states are readable in a single Modbus register. The state bits can be configured so that all states of
interest are available in a minimum number of Modbus registers.
The state bits can be read out in the “Flex States” register array beginning at Modbus address 0900h. Sixteen states are
packed into each register, with the lowest-numbered state in the lowest-order bit. Sixteen registers accommodate the 256
state bits.

5-172 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

5.3.17 User-definable displays

5.3.17.1 Menu
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
 USER-DEFINABLE INVOKE AND SCROLL: Range: FlexLogic operand
 DISPLAYS  Off

 USER DISPLAY 1 See below


 

 USER DISPLAY 16
 

This feature is supported with enhanced and basic front panels.


This menu provides a mechanism for manually creating up to 16 user-defined information displays in a convenient
viewing sequence in the USER DISPLAY menu (between the TARGETS and ACTUAL VALUES top-level menus). The sub-menus
facilitate text entry and Modbus register data pointer options for defining the user display content.
This feature is not supported with the optional graphical front panel.
Once programmed, the user-definable displays can be viewed in two ways.
• Keypad — Use the MENU key to select the USER DISPLAY menu item to access the first user-definable display (note that
only the programmed screens are displayed). The screens can be scrolled using the up and down arrow keys. The
display disappears after the default message time-out period specified by the PRODUCT SETUP  DISPLAY PROPERTIES
 DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting.
• User-programmable control input — The user-definable displays also respond to the INVOKE AND SCROLL setting. Any 5
FlexLogic operand (in particular, the user-programmable pushbutton operands), can be used to navigate the
programmed displays.
On the rising edge of the configured operand (such as when the pushbutton is pressed), the displays are invoked by
showing the last user-definable display shown during the previous activity. From this moment onward, the operand
acts exactly as the down key and allows scrolling through the configured displays. The last display wraps up to the
first one. The INVOKE AND SCROLL input and the down arrow key operate concurrently.
When the default timer expires (set by the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting), the relay starts to cycle through the user
displays. The next activity of the INVOKE AND SCROLL input stops the cycling at the currently displayed user display, not
at the first user-defined display. The INVOKE AND SCROLL pulses must last for at least 250 ms to take effect.

5.3.17.2 User display 1(16)


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS  USER DISPLAY 1(16)
 USER DISPLAY 1 DISP 1 TOP LINE: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
 
DISP 1 BOTTOM LINE: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters

DISP 1 ITEM 1: Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
 0

DISP 1 ITEM 5: Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
 0

Any existing system display can be automatically copied into an available user display by selecting the existing display and
pressing the ENTER key. The display then prompts with ADD TO USER DISPLAY LIST? After selecting “Yes,” a message
indicates that the selected display has been added to the user display list. When this type of entry occurs, the sub-menus
are automatically configured with the proper content—this content can be edited subsequently.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-173


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

This menu is used to enter user-defined text and user-selected Modbus-registered data fields into the particular user
display. Each user display consists of two 20-character lines (top and bottom). The tilde (~) character is used to mark the
start of a data field – the length of the data field needs to be accounted for. Up to five separate data fields can be entered
in a user display – the nth tilde (~) refers to the nth item.
A user display can be entered from the front panel keypad or the EnerVista interface (preferred for convenience). The
following procedure shows how to enter text characters in the top and bottom lines from the front panel keypad:
1. Select the line to be edited.
2. Press the decimal key to enter text edit mode.
3. Use either VALUE key to scroll through the characters. A space is selected like a character.
4. Press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
5. Repeat step 3 and continue entering characters until the desired text is displayed.
6. The HELP key can be pressed at any time for context sensitive help information.
7. Press the ENTER key to store the new settings.
To enter a numerical value for any of the five items (the decimal form of the selected Modbus address) from the front panel
keypad, use the number keypad. Use the value of “0” for any items not being used. Use the HELP key at any selected
system display (setting, actual value, or command) which has a Modbus address, to view the hexadecimal form of the
Modbus address, then manually convert it to decimal form before entering it (EnerVista usage conveniently facilitates this
conversion).
Use the MENU key to go to the user displays menu to view the user-defined content. The current user displays show in
sequence, changing every four seconds. While viewing a user display, press the ENTER key and then select the ‘Yes” option
to remove the display from the user display list. Use the MENU key again to exit the user displays menu.
An example of user display setup and result is shown as follows.
5  USER DISPLAY 1
 DISP 1 TOP LINE: Shows user-defined text with first tilde marker
 Current X ~ A

DISP 1 BOTTOM LINE: Shows user-defined text with second tilde marker
 Current Y ~ A

DISP 1 ITEM 1: Shows decimal form of user-selected Modbus register


 6016 address, corresponding to first tilde marker

DISP 1 ITEM 2: Shows decimal form of user-selected Modbus register


 6357 address, corresponding to second tilde marker

DISP 1 ITEM 3: This item is not being used. There is no corresponding


 0 tilde marker in top or bottom lines.

DISP 1 ITEM 4: This item is not being used. There is no corresponding


 0 tilde marker in top or bottom lines.

DISP 1 ITEM 5: This item is not being used. There is no corresponding


 0 tilde marker in top or bottom lines.

USER DISPLAYS Current X 0.850 Shows the resultant display content


 Current Y 0.327 A

If the parameters for the top line and the bottom line items have the same units, then the unit is displayed on the bottom
line only. The units are only displayed on both lines if the units specified both the top and bottom line items are different.

5-174 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

5.3.18 Direct inputs and outputs

5.3.18.1 Menu
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  DIRECT I/O
 DIRECT I/O DIRECT OUTPUTS Range: 1 to 16 in steps of 1
  DEVICE ID: 1

DIRECT I/O CH1 RING Range: Yes, No


 CONFIGURATION: Yes

DIRECT I/O CH2 RING Range: Yes, No


 CONFIGURATION: Yes

DIRECT I/O DATA Range: 64 kbps, 128 kbps


 RATE: 64 kbps

DIRECT I/O CHANNEL Range: Disabled, Enabled


 CROSSOVER: Disabled

 CRC ALARM CH1 See page 5-180


 

 CRC ALARM CH2


 

 UNRETURNED See page 5-181


  MESSAGES ALARM CH1

 UNRETURNED
  MESSAGES ALARM CH2
5
This option is available when an Inter-Relay Communications card is specified at the time of ordering (see the
Order Code tables). With the option, direct inputs/outputs display by default. When you enable the
teleprotection feature, direct I/O is not visible.
Direct inputs and outputs exchange status information (inputs and outputs) between UR-series relays connected directly
via type 7 digital communications cards. The mechanism is very similar to IEC 61850 GOOSE, except that communications
takes place over a non-switchable isolated network and is optimized for speed. On type 7 cards that support two channels,
direct output messages are sent from both channels simultaneously. This effectively sends direct output messages both
ways around a ring configuration. On type 7 cards that support one channel, direct output messages are sent only in one
direction. Messages are resent (forwarded) when it is determined that the message did not originate at the receiver.
Direct Inputs and Outputs are initiated automatically and start running once at least one Direct Output in the given UR is
set to anything but Off.

Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive. As such, they cannot be used
simultaneously. Once teleprotection inputs and outputs are enabled, direct inputs and outputs are disabled, and
vice versa.
Direct output message timing is similar to GOOSE message timing. Integrity messages (with no state changes) are sent at
least every 1000 ms. Messages with state changes are sent within the main pass scanning the inputs and asserting the
outputs unless the communication channel bandwidth has been exceeded. Two self-tests are performed and signaled by
the following FlexLogic operands:
• DIRECT RING BREAK (direct input/output ring break). This FlexLogic operand indicates that direct output messages sent
from a UR-series relay are not being received back by the relay.
• DIRECT DEVICE 1 OFF to DIRECT DEVICE 16 OFF (direct device offline). These FlexLogic operands indicate that direct output
messages from at least one direct device are not being received.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-175


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Direct input and output settings are similar to remote input and output settings. The equivalent of the remote device name
strings for direct inputs and outputs is the DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID setting, which identifies the relay in all direct output
messages. All UR-series IEDs in a ring need to have unique numbers assigned. The IED ID is used to identify the sender of
the direct input and output message.
If the direct input and output scheme is configured to operate in a ring (DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION or DIRECT I/O
CH2 RING CONFIGURATION is “Yes”), all direct output messages are received back. If not, the direct input/output ring break
self-test is triggered. The self-test error is signaled by the DIRECT RING BREAK FlexLogic operand.
Select the DIRECT I/O DATA RATE to match the data capabilities of the communications channel. All IEDs communicating
over direct inputs and outputs must be set to the same data rate. UR-series IEDs equipped with dual-channel
communications cards apply the same data rate to both channels. Delivery time for direct input and output messages is
approximately 0.2 of a power system cycle at 128 kbps and 0.4 of a power system cycle at 64 kbps, per each "bridge."
Table 5-19: Direct input and output data rates
Module Supported data rates
2A, 2B 64 kbps
2E, 2F 64 kbps
2G, 2H 128 kbps
2I, 2J 64 kbps, 128 kbps
72, 73 64 kbps, 128 kbps
74, 75 64 kbps
76, 77 64 kbps
7A, 7B, 7C, 7D 64 kbps, 128 kbps
7E, 7F, 7G 64 kbps
5 7H, 7I, 7J, 7K 64 kbps, 128 kbps
7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, 7Q 64 kbps
7R, 7S 64 kbps
7T, 7W 64 kbps

The G.703 modules are fixed at 64 kbps. The DIRECT I/O DATA RATE setting is not applicable to these modules.

The DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting applies to a F35 with dual-channel communication cards and allows crossing
over messages from channel 1 to channel 2. This places all UR-series IEDs into one direct input and output network
regardless of the physical media of the two communication channels.
The following application examples illustrate the basic concepts for direct input and output configuration. See the Inputs
and Outputs section in this chapter for information on configuring FlexLogic operands (flags, bits) to be exchanged.

Example 1: Extending the input/output capabilities of a UR-series relay


Consider an application that requires additional quantities of contact inputs or output contacts or lines of programmable
logic that exceed the capabilities of a single UR-series chassis. The problem is solved by adding an extra UR-series IED,
such as the C30, to satisfy the additional input and output and programmable logic requirements. The two IEDs are
connected via single-channel digital communication cards as shown in the figure.

5-176 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-85: Input and output extension via direct inputs and outputs

TX1
UR IED 1
RX1

TX1
UR IED 2
RX1

842711A1.CDR

In this application, apply the following settings. For UR-series IED 1:


DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “1”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O DATA RATE: “128 kbps”
For UR-series IED 2:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “2”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O DATA RATE: “128 kbps”
The message delivery time is about 0.2 of power cycle in both ways (at 128 kbps); that is, from device 1 to device 2, and
from device 2 to device 1. Different communications cards can be selected by the user for this back-to-back connection
(for example: fiber, G.703, or RS422).

Example 2: Interlocking busbar protection


A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme could be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream 5
devices, say 2, 3, and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown.
Figure 5-86: Sample interlocking busbar protection scheme

UR IED 1 BLOCK

UR IED 2 UR IED 3 UR IED 4

842712A1.CDR

For increased reliability, a dual-ring configuration (shown as follows) is recommended for this application.
Figure 5-87: Interlocking bus protection scheme via direct inputs/outputs

TX1 RX1
UR IED 1
RX2 TX2

RX1 TX2 RX2 TX1


UR IED 2 UR IED 4
TX1 RX2 TX2 RX1

TX2 RX2
UR IED 3
RX1 TX1
842716A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-177


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

In this application, apply the following settings. For UR-series IED 1:


DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “1”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
For UR-series IED 2:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “2”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
For UR-series IED 3:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “3”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
For UR-series IED 4:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “4”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
Message delivery time is approximately 0.2 of power system cycle (at 128 kbps) times number of ‘bridges’ between the
origin and destination. Dual-ring configuration effectively reduces the maximum ‘communications distance’ by a factor of
two.
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps) if both rings are healthy:
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle
IED 1 to IED 3: 0.4 of power system cycle
IED 1 to IED 4: 0.2 of power system cycle
5 IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle
IED 2 to IED 4: 0.4 of power system cycle
IED 3 to IED 4: 0.2 of power system cycle
If one ring is broken (say TX2-RX2) the delivery times are as follows:
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle
IED 1 to IED 3: 0.4 of power system cycle
IED 1 to IED 4: 0.6 of power system cycle
IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle
IED 2 to IED 4: 0.4 of power system cycle
IED 3 to IED 4: 0.2 of power system cycle
A coordinating timer for this bus protection scheme could be selected to cover the worst case scenario (0.4 of a power
system cycle). Upon detecting a broken ring, the coordination time is adaptively increased to 0.6 of a power system cycle.
The complete application requires addressing a number of issues, such as failure of both the communications rings, failure
or out-of-service conditions of one of the relays, and so on. Self-monitoring flags of the direct inputs and outputs feature
primarily are used to address these concerns.

Example 3: Pilot-aided schemes


Consider the three-terminal line protection application shown.

5-178 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Figure 5-88: Three-terminal line application

UR IED 1 UR IED 2

UR IED 3 842713A1.CDR

A permissive pilot-aided scheme can be implemented in a two-ring configuration, shown as follows (IEDs 1 and 2
constitute a first ring, while IEDs 2 and 3 constitute a second ring).
Figure 5-89: Single-channel open loop configuration

TX1 RX1 RX2


UR IED 1 UR IED 2
RX1 TX1 TX2

UR IED 3
RX1 5
TX1
842714A1.CDR

In this application, apply the following settings. For UR-series IED 1:


DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “1”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
For UR-series IED 2:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “2”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
For UR-series IED 3:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “3”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps):
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle
IED 1 to IED 3: 0.5 of power system cycle
IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle
In this scheme, IEDs 1 and 3 do not communicate directly. IED 2 must be configured to forward the messages as explained
in the Inputs and Outputs section. Implement a blocking pilot-aided scheme with more security and, ideally, faster
message delivery time. This is accomplished using a dual-ring configuration as shown here.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-179


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-90: Dual-channel closed loop (dual-ring) configuration

TX2 TX1 RX1 RX2


UR IED 1 UR IED 2
RX1 RX2 TX2 TX1

TX1 RX1
UR IED 3
RX2 TX2
842715A1.CDR

In this application, apply the following settings. For UR-series IED 1:


DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “1”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
For UR-series IED 2:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “2”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
For UR-series IED 3:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “3”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
5 DIRECT I/O CH2 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps) if both the rings are healthy:
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle
IED 1 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle
IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle
The two communications configurations can be applied to both permissive and blocking schemes. Take speed, reliability,
and cost into account when selecting the required architecture.

5.3.18.2 CRC alarm CH1(2)


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  DIRECT I/O  CRC ALARM CH1(2)
 CRC ALARM CH1 CRC ALARM CH1 Range: Enabled, Disabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

CRC ALARM CH1 Range: 100 to 10000 in steps of 1


 MESSAGE COUNT: 600

CRC ALARM CH1 Range: 1 to 1000 in steps of 1


 THRESHOLD: 10

CRC ALARM CH1 Range: Enabled, Disabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The F35 checks integrity of the incoming direct input and output messages using a 32-bit CRC. The CRC alarm function is
available for monitoring the communication medium noise by tracking the rate of messages failing the CRC check. The
monitoring function counts all incoming messages, including messages that failed the CRC check. A separate counter
adds up messages that failed the CRC check. When the failed CRC counter reaches the user-defined level specified by the
CRC ALARM CH1 THRESHOLD setting within the user-defined message count CRC ALARM 1 CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 CRC
ALARM FlexLogic operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT
setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.

5-180 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP

Configure the operand to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based output.
Latching and acknowledging conditions—if required—are programmed accordingly.
The CRC alarm function is available on a per-channel basis. The total number of direct input and output messages that
failed the CRC check is available as the ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  DIRECT INPUTS  CRC FAIL COUNT CH1 actual value.
• Message count and length of the monitoring window — To monitor communications integrity, the relay sends 1
message per second (at 64 kbps) or 2 messages per second (at 128 kbps) even if there is no change in the direct
outputs. For example, setting the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT to “10000,” corresponds a time window of about 160
minutes at 64 kbps and 80 minutes at 128 kbps. If the messages are sent faster as a result of direct outputs activity,
the monitoring time interval shortens. Take this into account when determining the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT
setting. For example, if the requirement is a maximum monitoring time interval of 10 minutes at 64 kbps, then the CRC
ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT is set to 10  60  1 = 600.
• Correlation of failed CRC and bit error rate (BER) — The CRC check can fail if one or more bits in a packet are
corrupted. Therefore, an exact correlation between the CRC fail rate and the BER is not possible. Under certain
assumptions an approximation can be made as follows. A direct input and output packet containing 20 bytes results
in 160 bits of data being sent and therefore, a transmission of 63 packets is equivalent to 10,000 bits. A BER of 10–4
implies 1 bit error for every 10000 bits sent or received. Assuming the best case of only 1 bit error in a failed packet,
having 1 failed packet for every 63 received is about equal to a BER of 10–4.

5.3.18.3 Unreturned messages alarm CH1(2)


SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  DIRECT I/O  UNRETURNED MESSAGES ALARM CH1(2)
 UNRETURNED UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 Range: Enabled, Disabled
 MESSAGES ALARM CH1  FUNCTION: Disabled

UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 Range: 100 to 10000 in steps of 1


 MESSAGE COUNT: 600
5
UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 Range: 1 to 1000 in steps of 1
 THRESHOLD: 10

UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 Range: Enabled, Disabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The F35 checks integrity of the direct input and output communication ring by counting unreturned messages. In the ring
configuration, all messages originating at a given device should return within a pre-defined period of time. The unreturned
messages alarm function is available for monitoring the integrity of the communication ring by tracking the rate of
unreturned messages. This function counts all the outgoing messages and a separate counter adds the messages have
failed to return. When the unreturned messages counter reaches the user-definable level specified by the UNRET MSGS
ALARM CH1 THRESHOLD setting and within the user-defined message count UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1
UNRET ALM FlexLogic operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 MESSAGE
COUNT setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
Configure the operand to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based output.
Latching and acknowledging conditions, if required, are programmed accordingly.
The unreturned messages alarm function is available on a per-channel basis and is active only in the ring configuration.
The total number of unreturned input and output messages is available as the ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  DIRECT INPUTS
 UNRETURNED MSG COUNT CH1 actual value.

5.3.19 Teleprotection
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  TELEPROTECTION
 TELEPROTECTION TELEPROTECTION Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

NUMBER OF TERMINALS: Range: 2, 3


 2

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-181


PRODUCT SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

NUMBER OF COMM Range: 1, 2


 CHANNELS: 1

LOCAL RELAY ID Range: 0 to 63 in steps of 1


 NUMBER: 0

TERMINAL 1 RELAY ID Range: 0 to 63 in steps of 1


 NUMBER: 0

TERMINAL 2 RELAY ID Range: 0 to 63 in steps of 1


 NUMBER: 0

This option is available when an Inter-Relay Communications card is specified at the time of ordering (see the
Order Code tables). With the option, direct inputs/outputs display by default. When you enable the
teleprotection feature, direct I/O is not visible.
Digital teleprotection transfers protection commands between two or three relays in a secure, fast, dependable, and
deterministic way. Possible applications are permissive or blocking pilot schemes and direct transfer trip (DTT).
Teleprotection can be applied over any analog or digital channels and any communications media, such as direct fiber,
copper wires, optical networks, or microwave radio links. A mixture of communication media is possible.
Once teleprotection is enabled and the teleprotection input/outputs are configured, data packets are transmitted
continuously every 1/4 cycle (3/8 cycle if using C37.94 modules) from peer-to-peer. Security of communication channel
data is achieved by using CRC-32 on the data packet.

Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive. As such, they cannot be used
simultaneously. Once teleprotection inputs and outputs are enabled, direct inputs and outputs are blocked, and
vice versa.
5 NUMBER OF TERMINALS — Specifies whether the teleprotection system operates between two peers or three peers.
NUMBER OF CHANNELS — Specifies how many channels are used. If the NUMBER OF TERMINALS is “3” (three-terminal system),
set the NUMBER OF CHANNELS to “2.” For a two-terminal system, the NUMBER OF CHANNELS can set to “1” or “2” (redundant
channels).
LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER, TERMINAL 1 RELAY ID NUMBER, and TERMINAL 2 RELAY ID NUMBER — In installations that use
multiplexers or modems, it is desirable to ensure that the data used by the relays protecting a given line is from the correct
relays. The teleprotection function performs this check by reading the message ID sent by transmitting relays and
comparing it to the programmed ID in the receiving relay. This check is also used to block inputs if inadvertently set to
loopback mode or data is being received from a wrong relay by checking the ID on a received channel. If an incorrect ID is
found on a channel during normal operation, the TELEPROT CH1 ID FAIL or TELEPROT CH2 ID FAIL FlexLogic operand is set,
driving the event with the same name and blocking the teleprotection inputs. For commissioning purposes, the result of
channel identification is also shown in the STATUS  CHANNEL TESTS  VALIDITY OF CHANNEL CONFIGURATION actual
value. The default value of “0” for the LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER indicates that relay ID is not to be checked. On two- terminals
two-channel systems, the same LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER is transmitted over both channels; as such, only the TERMINAL 1 ID
NUMBER has to be programmed on the receiving end.

5.3.20 Installation
SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  INSTALLATION
 INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS: Range: Not Programmed, Programmed
  Not Programmed

RELAY NAME: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters


 Relay-1

RELAY SETTINGS — To safeguard against the installation of a relay without any entered settings, the unit does not allow
signaling of any output relay until RELAY SETTINGS is set to "Programmed." This setting is "Not Programmed" by default. The
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED self-test error message displays until the relay is put into the "Programmed" state.
RELAY NAME — This setting allows the user to uniquely identify a relay. This name appears on generated reports.

5-182 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS REMOTE RESOURCES

5.4 Remote resources


5.4.1 Remote resources configuration
When the F35 is ordered with a process card module as a part of HardFiber system, an additional Remote Resources
menu tree is available in the EnerVista software to allow configuration of the HardFiber system.
Figure 5-91: Remote Resources configuration menu

5
The remote resources settings configure a F35 with a process bus module to work with HardFiber Bricks. Remote
resources configuration is only available through the EnerVista software, and is not available through the F35 front panel.
A Brick provides eight AC measurements, along with contact inputs, DC analog inputs, and contact outputs, to be the
remote interface to field equipment such as circuit breakers and transformers. The F35 with a process bus module has
access to all of the capabilities of up to eight Bricks. Remote resources settings configure the point-to-point connection
between specific fiber optic ports on the F35 process card and specific Brick. The relay is then configured to measure
specific currents, voltages and contact inputs from those Bricks, and to control specific outputs.
The configuration process for remote resources is straightforward and consists of the following steps.
• Configure the field units. This establishes the point-to-point connection between a specific port on the relay process
bus module, and a specific digital core on a specific Brick. This is a necessary first step in configuring a process bus
relay.
• Configure the AC banks. This sets the primary and secondary quantities and connections for currents and voltages. AC
bank configuration also provides a provision for redundant measurements for currents and voltages, a powerful
reliability improvement possible with process bus.
• Configure signal sources. This functionality of the F35 has not changed other than the requirement to use currents
and voltages established by AC bank configuration under the remote resources menu.
• Configure field contact inputs, field contact outputs, RTDs, and transducers as required for the application's
functionality. These inputs and outputs are the physical interface to circuit breakers, transformers, and other
equipment. They replace the traditional contact inputs and outputs located at the relay to virtually eliminate copper
wiring.
• Configure shared inputs and outputs as required for the application's functionality. Shared inputs and outputs are
distinct binary channels that provide high-speed protection quality signaling between relays through a Brick.
For additional information on how to configure a relay with a process bus module, see the HardFiber Process Bus System
Instruction Manual.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-183


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.5 System setup


5.5.1 AC inputs

5.5.1.1 Current banks


SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  AC INPUTS  CURRENT BANK F1(U5)
 CURRENT BANK F1 PHASE CT F1 Range: 1 to 65000 A in steps of 1
  PRIMARY: 1 A

PHASE CT F1 Range: 1 A, 5 A
 SECONDARY: 1 A

GROUND CT F1 Range: 1 to 65000 A in steps of 1


 PRIMARY: 1 A

GROUND CT F1 Range: 1 A, 5 A
 SECONDARY: 1 A

Because energy parameters are accumulated, record these values and then reset immediately prior to changing CT
characteristics.
Six banks of phase and ground CTs can be set, where the current banks are denoted in the following format (X represents
the module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M, U} and a = {1, 5}

5 See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for details.
These settings are critical for all features that have settings dependent on current measurements. When the relay is
ordered, the CT module must be specified to include a standard or sensitive ground input. As the phase CTs are connected
in wye (star), the calculated phasor sum of the three phase currents (IA + IB + IC = neutral current = 3Io) is used as the input
for the neutral overcurrent elements. In addition, a zero-sequence (core balance) CT which senses current in all of the
circuit primary conductors, or a CT in a neutral grounding conductor can also be used. For this configuration, the ground
CT primary rating must be entered. To detect low level ground fault currents, the sensitive ground input can be used. In this
case, the sensitive ground CT primary rating must be entered. See chapter 3 for more details on CT connections.
Enter the rated CT primary current values. For both 1000:5 and 1000:1 CTs, the entry would be 1000. For correct operation,
the CT secondary rating must match the setting (which must also correspond to the specific CT connections used).
The following example illustrates how multiple CT inputs (current banks) are summed as one source current. Given the
following current banks:
• F1: CT bank with 500:1 ratio
• F5: CT bank with 1000:1 ratio
• M1: CT bank with 800:1 ratio
The following rule applies:
SRC 1 = F1 + F5 + M1 Eq. 5-7
1 pu is the highest primary current. In this case, 1000 is entered and the secondary current from the 500:1 and 800:1 ratio
CTs are adjusted to that created by a 1000:1 CT before summation. If a protection element is set up to act on SRC 1
currents, then a pickup level of 1 pu operates on 1000 A primary.
The same rule applies for current sums from CTs with different secondary taps (5 A and 1 A).

5.5.1.2 Voltage banks


SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  AC INPUTS  VOLTAGE BANK F5(U5)
 VOLTAGE BANK F5 PHASE VT F5 Range: Wye, Delta
  CONNECTION: Wye

5-184 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

PHASE VT F5 Range: 25.0 to 240.0 V in steps of 0.1


 SECONDARY: 66.4 V

PHASE VT F5 Range: 1.00 to 24000.00 in steps of 0.01


 RATIO: 1.00 :1

AUXILIARY VT F5 Range: Vn, Vag, Vbg, Vcg, Vab, Vbc, Vca


 CONNECTION: Vag

AUXILIARY VT F5 Range: 25.0 to 240.0 V in steps of 0.1


 SECONDARY: 66.4 V

AUXILIARY VT F5 Range: 1.00 to 24000.00 in steps of 0.01


 RATIO: 1.00 :1

Because energy parameters are accumulated, these values should be recorded and then reset immediately prior to
changing VT characteristics.
Three banks of phase/auxiliary VTs can be set, where voltage banks are denoted in the following format (X represents the
module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M, U} and a = {5}
See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for details.
With VTs installed, the relay can perform voltage measurements as well as power calculations. Enter the PHASE VT F5
CONNECTION made to the system as “Wye” or “Delta.” An open-delta source VT connection is entered as “Delta.”

The nominal PHASE VT F5 SECONDARY voltage setting is the voltage across the relay input terminals when nominal
voltage is applied to the VT primary.
For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage and with a 14400:120 volt VT in a delta
connection, the secondary voltage is 115; that is, (13800 / 14400) × 120. For a wye connection, the voltage value
entered must be the phase to neutral voltage, which is 115  = 66.4.
5
On a 14.4 kV system with a delta connection and a VT primary to secondary turns ratio of 14400:120, the voltage
value entered is 120; that is, 14400 / 120.

If the PHASE VT F5 CONNECTION is set to “Delta”, the relay does not calculate voltage harmonics.

5.5.2 Power system


SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  POWER SYSTEM
 POWER SYSTEM NOMINAL FREQUENCY: Range: 25 to 60 Hz in steps of 1
  60 Hz

PHASE ROTATION: Range: ABC, ACB


 ABC

FREQUENCY AND PHASE Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 REFERENCE: SRC 1

FREQUENCYTRACKING: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Enabled

The power system NOMINAL FREQUENCY value is used as a default to set the digital sampling rate if the system frequency
cannot be measured from available signals. This can happen if the signals are not present or are heavily distorted. Before
reverting to the nominal frequency, the frequency tracking algorithm holds the last valid frequency measurement for a
safe period of time while waiting for the signals to reappear or for the distortions to decay.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-185


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

The phase sequence of the power system is required to properly calculate sequence components and power parameters.
The PHASE ROTATION setting matches the power system phase sequence and informs the relay of the actual system phase
sequence, either ABC or ACB. CT and VT inputs on the relay, labelled as A, B, and C, must be connected to system phases A,
B, and C for correct operation.
The FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting determines which signal source is used (and hence which AC signal) for
phase angle reference. The AC signal used is prioritized based on the AC inputs configured for the signal source. Phase
voltages takes precedence, followed by auxiliary voltage, then phase currents, and finally ground current.
For three phase selection, phase A is used for angle referencing (VANGLE REF = VA), while Clarke transformation of the phase
signals is used for frequency metering and tracking (VFREQUENCY = (2VA - VB - VC) / 3) for better performance during fault,
open pole, and VT and CT fail conditions.
The phase reference and frequency tracking AC signals are selected based upon the source configuration, regardless of
whether or not a particular signal is actually applied to the relay.
Phase angle of the reference signal always displays zero degrees and all other phase angles are relative to this signal. If the
pre-selected reference signal is not measurable at a given time, the phase angles are not referenced.
The phase angle referencing is done via a phase locked loop, which can synchronize independent UR-series relays if they
have the same AC signal reference. This results in very precise correlation of phase angle indications between different UR-
series relays.
FREQUENCY TRACKING is set to “Disabled” only in unusual circumstances; consult GE Grid Solutions for special variable-
frequency applications.

The frequency tracking feature functions only when the F35 is in the “Programmed” mode. If the F35 is “Not
Programmed,” then metering values are available but can exhibit significant errors.

5
5.5.3 Signal sources
SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES  SOURCE 1(6)
 SOURCE 1 SOURCE 1 NAME: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
  SRC 1

SOURCE 1 PHASE CT: Range: None, F1,... up to any 6 CTs. Only Phase CT
 None inputs are displayed.

SOURCE 1 GROUND CT: Range: None, F1,... up to any 6 CTs. Only Ground CT
 None inputs are displayed.

SOURCE 1 PHASE VT: Range: None, F5, M5, U5


 None Only phase voltage inputs are displayed

SOURCE 1 AUX VT: Range: None, F5, M5, U5


 None Only auxiliary voltage inputs are displayed

Identical menus are available for each source. The "SRC 1" text can be replaced by with a user-defined name appropriate
for the associated source.
The first letter in the source identifier represents the module slot position. The number directly following this letter
represents either the first bank of four channels (1, 2, 3, 4) called “1” or the second bank of four channels (5, 6, 7, 8) called
“5” in a particular CT/VT module. See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for details.
It is possible to select the sum of all CT combinations. The first channel displayed is the CT to which all others are referred.
For example, the selection “F1+F5” indicates the sum of each phase from channels “F1” and “F5,” scaled to whichever CT
has the higher ratio. Selecting “None” hides the associated actual values.
The approach used to configure the AC sources consists of several steps; first step is to specify the information about each
CT and VT input. For CT inputs, this is the nominal primary and secondary current. For VTs, this is the connection type, ratio
and nominal secondary voltage. Once the inputs have been specified, the configuration for each source is entered,
including specifying which CTs are summed together.

5-186 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

5.5.3.1 User selection of AC parameters for comparator elements


CT/VT modules automatically calculate all current and voltage parameters from the available inputs. Users must select the
specific input parameters to be measured by every element in the relevant settings menu. The internal design of the
element specifies which type of parameter to use and provides a setting for source selection. In elements where the
parameter can be either fundamental or RMS magnitude, such as phase time overcurrent, two settings are provided. One
setting specifies the source, the second setting selects between fundamental phasor and RMS.

5.5.3.2 AC input actual values


The calculated parameters associated with the configured voltage and current inputs are displayed in the current and
voltage sections of actual values. Only the phasor quantities associated with the actual AC physical input channels display
here. All parameters contained within a configured source are displayed in the sources section of the actual values.

5.5.3.3 Disturbance detectors (internal)


The disturbance detector (ANSI 50DD) element is a sensitive current disturbance detector that detects any disturbance on
the protected system. The 50DD function is used directly in some elements in the relay, for example VT Fuse Failure
detector or Fault Report. It can also be used to supervise current-based elements to prevent maloperation as a result of
the wrong settings or external CT wiring problem. A disturbance detector is provided for each source.
The 50DD function responds to the changes in magnitude of the sequence currents. The disturbance detector logic is as
follows.
Figure 5-92: Disturbance detector logic
SETTING
ACTUAL
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY

5
SOURCE 1 PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CURRENT PHASOR CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1 I_1 - I_1’ >2*CUT-OFF FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_2 I_2 - I_2’ >2*CUT-OFF OR SRC 1 50DD OP
I_0 I_0 - I_0’ >2*CUT-OFF
Where I’ is 2 cycles old

SETTING
ACTUAL
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
SOURCE 2 PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CURRENT PHASOR CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1 I_1 - I_1’ >2*CUT-OFF FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_2 I_2 - I_2’ >2*CUT-OFF OR SRC 2 50DD OP
I_0 I_0 - I_0’ >2*CUT-OFF
Where I’ is 2 cycles old

SETTING
ACTUAL
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
SOURCE 6 PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CURRENT PHASOR CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1 I_1 - I_1’ >2*CUT-OFF FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_2 I_2 - I_2’ >2*CUT-OFF OR SRC 6 50DD OP
I_0 I_0 - I_0’ >2*CUT-OFF
Where I’ is 2 cycles old 827092A3.CDR

The disturbance detector responds to the change in currents of twice the current cut-off level. The default cut-off threshold
is 0.02 pu; thus by default the disturbance detector responds to a change of 0.04 pu. The metering sensitivity setting
(PRODUCT SETUP  DISPLAY PROPERTIES  CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL) controls the sensitivity of the disturbance detector
accordingly.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-187


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.5.3.4 Example for use of sources


An example of the use of sources is shown in the following figure. A relay can have the following hardware configuration:
Increasing slot position letter -->
UR CT/VT module 1 CT/VT module 2 CT/VT module 3
B30, B90, C70, F35, N60, T35 8 CTs 4 CTs, 4 VTs 4 CTs, 4 VTs
C60, D60, G30, G60, L30, L90, M60, T60 CTs VTs not applicable

This configuration can be used on a two-winding transformer, with one winding connected into a breaker-and-a-half
system. The following figure shows the arrangement of sources used to provide the functions required in this application,
and the CT/VT inputs that are used to provide the data.
Figure 5-93: Example of use of sources

F1 DSP Bank

F5
Source 1 Source 2
Amps Amps

Source 3
51BF-1 51BF-2
U1 Volts Amps
5 A W Var 87T

A W Var 51P

Volts Amps
M1

M1 Source 4

UR Relay
M5
827794A1.CDR

Y LV D HV AUX
SRC 1 SRC 2 SRC 3
Phase CT M1 F1+F5 None
Ground CT M1 None None
Phase VT M5 None None
Aux VT None None U1

5-188 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

5.5.4 Breakers
SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  BREAKERS  BREAKER 1(6)
 BREAKER 1 BREAKER 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

BREAKER1 PUSH BUTTON Range: Disabled, Enabled


 CONTROL: Disabled

BREAKER 1 TAGGING: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

BREAKER 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 SUBSTITUTN: Disabled

BREAKER 1 BYPASS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

BREAKER 1 AR BLOCK: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

BREAKER 1 NAME: Range: up to six alphanumeric characters


 Bkr 1

BREAKER 1 MODE: Range: 3-Pole, 1-Pole


 3-Pole

BREAKER 1 OPEN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 BLK OPEN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 CLOSE: Range: FlexLogic operand


5
 Off

BREAKER 1 BLK CLOSE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER1 A/3P CLSD: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER1 A/3P OPND: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 B CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 B OPENED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 C CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 C OPENED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 TOPERATE: Range: 0 to 65535 s in steps of 1


 70 ms

BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 ALARM Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.000 s

MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 TIME: 0.000 s

BREAKER 1 OPEN Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 SEAL-IN: 0.000 s

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-189


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 RACKED-IN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER 1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

The breaker control element contains the auxiliary logic for status and serves as the interface for opening and closing of a
circuit breaker from protection, autoreclose, SCADA, or through the front panel interface. The breaker control element can
be used to create interlocking functionality. For greater security in determination of the breaker position, both the 52/a and
52/b auxiliary contacts are used with reporting of the discrepancy between them.
To use this element, configure the contact outputs that trip and close the breaker to use FlexLogic operands BREAKER 1 OFF
CMD (or BREAKER 1 TRIP A/B/C in the case of single-pole tripping) and BREAKER 1 ON CMD, and configure the breaker control
element inputs as described here.
A description of the operation of the breaker control and status monitoring features from the front panel is provided in
chapter 4.
There are two breaker control elements for each CT/VT module installed. The following settings are available for each
breaker control element.
BREAKER 1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the operation of the breaker 1 control feature.
BREAKER1 PUSH BUTTON CONTROL — Set to “Enable” to allow front panel pushbutton open/close control operations.
BREAKER1 TAGGING — Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to tag breaker 1. When tagged, the following
operations are disabled: pushbutton open/close, IEC 61850 open/close, and close command initiated by BREAKER 1 CLOSE
setting. The trip command issued by the Trip Out element or BREAKER 1 OPEN setting is not affected.
5 BREAKER1 SUBSTITUTN — Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to substitute breaker 1 status. When substituted,
breaker 1 control open/close status is forced to the substituted value.
BREAKER1 BYPASS — Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to bypass breaker 1 interlocking. When asserted,
BREAKER 1 BLK OPEN and BREAKER 1 BLK CLOSE settings are bypassed.
BREAKER1 AR BLOCK —Set to "Enable" to generate an operand to block the Autoreclose element.
The Autoreclose element is not automatically inhibited by BLOCK AR from the front panel. If the autoreclose scheme needs
to be inhibited, set setting AR BLOCK in the corresponding autoreclose element with the BREAKER 1 BLK RCLS operand.
BREAKER 1 NAME — Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the breaker. This name is used in flash messages
related to breaker 1.
BREAKER 1 MODE — Selects “3-Pole” mode, where all breaker poles are operated simultaneously, or “1-Pole” mode where all
breaker poles are operated either independently or simultaneously.
BREAKER 1 OPEN — Selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the Breaker 1 open and individual
phase trip commands.
BREAKER 1 BLK OPEN — Selects an operand that prevents initiation of Breaker 1 open and individual phase trip commands.
This setting can be used for blocking circuit breaker tripping for instance when breaker monitoring detects conditions such
as low SF6 gas density during which breaker opening can cause damage.
BREAKER 1 CLOSE — Selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the Breaker 1 close commands.
BREAKER 1 BLK CLOSE — Selects an operand that prevents initiation of Breaker 1 close commands. This setting can be used
for blocking circuit breaker closing, for instance to prevent closing into a closed ground switch.
BREAKER1 A/3P CLSD — Selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a breaker auxiliary position tracking
mechanism. This input is for a normally-open 52/a status input that creates a logic 1 when the breaker is closed. If the
BREAKER 1 MODE setting is selected as "3-Pole," this setting selects a single 52/a input as the operand used to track the
breaker open or closed position. If the mode is selected as "1-Pole," the input mentioned is used to track phase A and the
BREAKER 1 B and BREAKER 1 C settings select operands to track phases B and C, respectively.

5-190 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

BREAKER1 A/3P OPND — Selects an operand, usually a contact input, that is for a normally-closed 52/b status input that
creates a logic 1 when the breaker is open. If a separate 52/b contact input is not available, then the inverted 52/a status
signal or the inverted BREAKER 1 CLOSED status signal can be used.
BREAKER 1 B CLOSED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase B closed position as outlined for phase A.
BREAKER 1 B OPENED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase B opened position as outlined for phase A.
BREAKER 1 C CLOSED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase C closed position as outlined for phase A.
BREAKER 1 C OPENED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase C opened position as outlined for phase A.
BREAKER 1 TOPERATE — This setting specifies the required interval to overcome transient disagreement between the 52/a
and 52/b auxiliary contacts during breaker operation. If transient disagreement still exists after this time has expired, the
BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted for alarm or blocking purposes.
BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM — This setting selects an operand, usually an external contact input connected to a breaker alarm
reporting contact. While the selected operand is active, the BREAKER 1 TROUBLE operand is activated.
BREAKER 1 ALARM DELAY — This setting specifies the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among the three-
pole position tracking operands does not declare a pole disagreement. This allows for non-simultaneous operation of the
poles.
BREAKER 1 OPEN SEAL-IN — This setting specifies the seal-in time of the three-pole open command initiated by either the
Trip Out element or a manual open command to the circuit breaker.
MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 TIME — This setting specifies the seal-in time of the close commands due to an operator-initiated
manual close command to the circuit breaker.
BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV — Selects an operand indicating that breaker 1 is out-of-service.
5
BREAKER 1 RACKED-IN — This setting selects a contact input to show whether the breaker is racked-in or racked-out. The
racked-in or racked-out status is used to indicate dynamically the status of breaker symbol, only applied in the single-line
diagram in the graphical front panel. If this setting is set to Off, the racked status is not considered.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-191


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-94: Dual breaker control logic (Sheet 1 of 3)


SETTING
BREAKER 1 FUNCTION
= Enabled

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 TAG ON

SETTING
BREAKER 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL
= Enabled AND

USER 3 OFF/ON
To open BKR1-(Name)
OR

Breaker 1 Open
From graphical front panel
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING (on IEC 61850 page) AND BREAKER 1 MNL OPEN
XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND: OR

Off = 0 AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


OPERANDS
BrkCSWI1.Pos.ctlVal = off AND BREAKER 1 OFF CMD
OR SETTING
Brk0XCBR1.Pos.ctlVal = off OR
BREAKER 1 OPEN SEAL-IN
SETTING T PKP
BREAKER 1 OPEN AND
Off = 0 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPERANDS
OR AND BREAKER 1 TRIP
OFF CMD
A
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
TRIP 3-POLE
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPERANDS
TRIP PHASE A
OR AND BREAKER 1 TRIP
OFF CMD
B
TRIP PHASE B
TRIP PHASE C

5
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPERANDS
On D60, L60, L90 from OR
Trip Output AND BREAKER 1 TRIP
OFF CMD
C

AND
Brk0XCBR1.BlkOpn.ctVal = On
From IEC 61850 protocol

SETTING OR Bkr0XCBR1.BlkOpn.stVal
BREAKER 1 BLK OPEN To IEC 61850 protocol
Off = 0
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 BYPASS ON

USER 2 OFF/ON AND


To close BKR1-(Name)
OR

Breaker 1 Close
From graphical front panel
OR AND
AND
BkrCSWI1.Pos.ctlVal = on FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
Bkr0XCBR1.Pos.ctlVal = on OR AND BREAKER 1 MNL CLS
SETTING
From IEC 61850 protocol AND
MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 TIME
SETTING T PKP
BREAKER 1 CLOSE
AND 0
Off = 0

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


BREAKER 1 ENA RCLS OR AND BREAKER 1 ON CMD
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AR CLOSE BKR1 0
On C60, D60, L60, L90 breaker AND
OR 20 ms OR
1 and 2 from Autoreclose

AND
Bkr0XCBR1.BlkCls.ctlVal = on
From IEC 61850 protocol
OR Bkr0XCBR1.BlkCls.stVal
SETTING To IEC 61850 protocol
BREAKER 1 BLK CLOSE
AND
Off = 0
Enable to sheet 2
859719A1.CDR

5-192 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

Figure 5-95: Dual breaker control logic (Sheet 2 of 3)


from sheet 2
Enable

SETTING
BREAKER 1 MODE
= 1-Pole
= 3-Pole

FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
BREAKER 1 SUBD CLSD
BREAKER 1 SUBD OPEN FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR1 A CLOSED AND BREAKER 1 ΦA CLSD
SETTING AND
BREAKER 1 ΦA/3P CLSD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR BKR1 A OPENED AND BREAKER 1 ΦA OPEN
= Off AND
AND
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 ΦA/3P OPND AND BREAKER 1 ΦA INTERM
OR SETTING
= Off AND
AND BREAKER 1 TOPERATE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR T PKP AND BREAKER 1 ΦA BAD ST
0
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR1 B CLOSED AND BREAKER 1 ΦB CLSD
SETTING AND
BREAKER 1 ΦB CLSD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR BKR1 B OPENED AND BREAKER 1 ΦB OPEN
= Off AND
AND
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 ΦB OPENED AND BREAKER 1 ΦB INTERM
OR AND
= Off AND
OR SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 TOPERATE
AND AND BREAKER 1 ΦB BAD ST
T PKP
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR1 C CLOSED AND BREAKER 1 ΦC CLSD
SETTING AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND

5
BREAKER 1 ΦC CLSD
OR BKR1 C OPENED AND BREAKER 1 ΦC OPEN
= Off AND
AND
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 ΦC OPENED AND BREAKER 1 ΦC INTERM
OR AND
= Off AND
OR SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 TOPERATE
AND AND BREAKER 1 ΦC BAD ST
T PKP
0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS

SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM
AND BREAKER 1 TROUBLE
= Off OR

AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


BKR1 A CLOSED AND BREAKER 1 CLOSED
OR
BKR1 B CLOSED
AND
BKR1 C CLOSED SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 ALARM DELAY
AND BREAKER 1 DISCREP
T PKP
AND
0

BKR1 A OPENED
AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR1 B OPENED
AND BREAKER 1 OPEN
BKR1 C OPENED OR

AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR1 A CLOSED AND BREAKER 1 ANY P OPEN
BKR1 B CLOSED AND
BKR1 C CLOSED
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND BREAKER 1 1P OPEN
XOR
SETTING
BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
= Off AND BREAKER 1 OOS

Enable
to sheet 3 859763A1.vsd

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-193


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-96: Dual breaker / graphical front panel control logic (Sheet 3 of 3)

from sheet 2
SETTING Enable
BREAKER 1 TAGGING
= Enabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
Breaker 1 Tag S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch BREAKER 1 TAG ON
Breaker 1 Remove Tag
OR R BREAKER 1 TAG OFF
From graphical front panel

SETTING
BREAKER 1 SUBSTITUTN
= Enabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
Breaker 1 Substitute Open S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch BREAKER 1 SUBD OPEN
Breaker 1 Remove Substitution
OR R

Breaker 1 Substitute Closed S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


From graphical front panel Latch BREAKER 1 SUBD CLSD
OR R

SETTING
BREAKER 1 BYPASS
= Enabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
Breaker 1 Bypass S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch BREAKER 1 BYPASS ON

5
Breaker 1 Remove Bypass
From graphical front panel OR R BREAKER 1 BYPASS OFF

For relays with Autoreclose element


SETTING
BREAKER 1 AR BLOCK
= Enabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
Breaker 1 Block Autoreclose S
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch BREAKER 1 BLK RCLS
Breaker 1 Unblock Autoreclose
OR BREAKER 1 ENA RCLS
From graphical front panel R
859764A1.vsd

The breaker element has direct hard-coded connections to the IEC 61850 model as shown in the logic diagram. This allows
remote open/close operation of each breaker, using either CSWI or XCBR IEC 61850 logical nodes. IEC 61850 select-before-
operate functionality, local/remote switch functionality, along with blocking of open/close commands are provided. Note
that the dwell time for the IEC 61850 trip and close commands shown is one protection pass only. To maintain the close/
open command for a certain time, do so by setting the seal-in timers BREAKER 1 OPEN SEAL-IN and MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1
TIME, on the contact outputs using the "Seal-in" setting, in the Trip Output element, and/or in FlexLogic.

5.5.5 Disconnect switch control


SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SWITCHES  SWITCH 1(24)
 SWITCH 1 SWITCH 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

SWITCH 1 NAME: Range: up to six alphanumeric characters


 SW 1

SWITCH 1 MODE: Range: 3-Pole, 1-Pole


 3-Pole

SWITCH 1 OPEN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

5-194 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

SWITCH 1 BLK OPEN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWITCH 1 CLOSE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWTCH 1 A/3P CLSD: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWTCH 1 A/3P OPND: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWITCH 1 B CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWITCH 1 B OPENED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWITCH 1 C CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWITCH 1 C OPENED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SWITCH1 PUSH BUTTON Range: Disabled, Enabled


 CONTROL: Disabled

SWITCH 1 TAGGING: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

 SWITCH 1 SUBSTITUTN:
Disabled
Range: Disabled, Enabled 5
SWITCH 1 BYPASS: Range: Disabled, Enabled
 Disabled

SWITCH 1 OPEN Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 SEAL-IN: 0.000 s

SWITCH 1 CLOSE Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 SEAL-IN: 0.000 s

SWITCH 1 TOPERATE: Range: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1


 70 ms

SWITCH 1 ALARM Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.000 s

SWITCH 1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

The disconnect switch control element contains the auxiliary logic for status and serves as the interface for opening and
closing of disconnect switches from SCADA or through the front panel interface. The disconnect switch control element
can be used to create interlocking functionality. For greater security in determination of the switch pole position, both the
89/a and 89/b auxiliary contacts are used with reporting of the discrepancy between them. There are eight disconnect
switch control elements for each CT/VT module installed.
To use this element, configure the contact outputs that open and close the disconnect switch to use FlexLogic operands
SWITCH 1 OFF CMD and SWITCH 1 ON CMD, and configure the disconnect switch control element's inputs as outlined here.
SWITCH 1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables operation of the disconnect switch element.
SWITCH 1 NAME — Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the disconnect switch. This name is used in flash
messages related to disconnect switch 1.
SWITCH 1 MODE — This setting selects “3-Pole” mode, where disconnect switch poles have a single common auxiliary
switch, or “1-Pole” mode where each disconnect switch pole has its own auxiliary switch.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-195


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

SWITCH 1 OPEN — This setting selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the disconnect switch 1
open command.
SWITCH 1 BLK OPEN — This setting selects an operand that prevents initiation of the disconnect switch 1 command. This
setting can be used to block the disconnect switch from opening, for instance when switchyard monitoring indicates that
current exceeding the switch's interrupting rating can be flowing through the switch.
SWITCH 1 CLOSE — This setting selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the disconnect switch
1 close command.
SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE — This setting selects an operand that prevents initiation of disconnect switch 1 close commands. This
setting can be used to block the disconnect switch from closing, for instance to prevent closing into a closed ground
switch.
SWTCH 1A/3P CLSD — This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a disconnect switch auxiliary
position tracking mechanism. This input is for a normally-open 89/a status input that creates a logic 1 when the
disconnect switch is closed. If the SWITCH 1 MODE setting is selected as “3-Pole,” this setting selects a single 89/a input as
the operand used to track the disconnect switch open or closed position. If the mode is selected as “1-Pole,” the input
mentioned is used to track phase A and the SWITCH 1 B and SWITCH 1 C settings select operands to track phases B and
C, respectively.
SWTCH 1 A/3P OPND — This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input, that is for a normally-closed 89/b status
input that creates a logic 1 when the disconnect switch is open. If a separate 89/b contact input is not available, then an
inverted 89/a status signal can be used.
SWITCH 1 B CLOSED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase B closed position as outlined for phase A.
SWITCH 1 B OPENED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase B opened position as outlined for phase A.
5 SWITCH 1 C CLOSED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase C closed position as outlined for phase A.
SWITCH 1 C OPENED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase C opened position as outlined for phase A.
SWITCH 1 PUSH BUTTON CONTROL — Set to "Enable" to allow front panel pushbutton open/close control operations.
SWITCH 1 TAGGING — Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to tag switch 1. When tagged, the following
operations are disabled:
• Pushbutton Open/Close
• IEC 61850 Open/Close
• Open command initiated by SWITCH 1 OPEN setting
• Close command initiated by SWITCH 1 CLOSE setting
SWITCH 1 SUBSTITUTN — Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to substitute switch 1 status. When substituted,
switch 1 control open/close status is forced to the substituted value.
SWITCH 1 BYPASS —Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to bypass switch 1 interlocking. When asserted,
SWITCH 1 BLK OPEN and SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE settings are bypassed.
SWITCH 1 OPEN SEAL-IN — This setting specifies the seal-in time of the open command due to an operator-initiated manual
open command to the disconnect switch.
SWITCH 1 CLOSE SEAL-IN — This setting specifies the seal-in time of the close command due to an operator-initiated manual
close command to the disconnect switch.
SWITCH 1 TOPERATE — This setting specifies the required interval to overcome transient disagreement between the 89/a
and 89/b auxiliary contacts during disconnect switch operation. If transient disagreement still exists after this time has
expired, the SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted for alarm or blocking purposes.
SWITCH 1 ALARM DELAY — This setting specifies the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among the pole
position tracking operands do not declare a pole disagreement. This allows for non-simultaneous operation of the poles.

5-196 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

IEC 61850 functionality is permitted when the F35 is in “Programmed” mode and not in local control mode.

The switch element has direct hard-coded connections to the IEC 61850 model as shown in the logic diagrams. This allows
remote open/close operation of each switch, using either CSWI or XSWI IEC 61850 logical nodes. IEC 61850 select-before-
operate functionality, local/remote switch functionality, along with blocking open/close commands are provided. Note that
the dwell time for the IEC 61850 trip and close commands shown is one protection pass only. To maintain close/open
command for a certain time, do so using the seal-in timers SWITCH 1 OPEN SEAL-IN and SWITCH 1 CLOSE SEAL-IN, on the
contact outputs using the "Seal-in" setting, or in FlexLogic.
Figure 5-97: Disconnect switch control logic (sheet 1 of 3)
SETTING
SWITCH 1 FUNCTION
= Enabled

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 TAG ON

SETTING
SWITCH 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL = Enabled
AND
SWITCH 1 Open
From graphical front panel

SETTING (on 61850 page)


XSWI1 ST.LOC OPERAND
= Off
AND OR
DiscCSWI1.Pos.ctlVal = off
OR FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Disc0XSWI1.Pos.ctlVal = off SETTING
OR AND SWITCH 1 OFF CMD
From IEC 61850 protocol SWITCH 1 OPEN SEAL-IN

SETTING
SWITCH 1 OPEN
= Off
AND
T PKP
0 AND
5
AND
DiscCSWI1.BlkOpn.ctlVal = on
From IEC 61850 protocol

SETTING OR Disc0XSWI1.BlkOpn.stVal
SWITCH 1 BLOCK OPEN To IEC 61850 protocol
= Off

AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 BYPASS ON

AND
SWITCH 1 Close
From graphical front panel

AND
OR
DiscCSWI1.Pos.ctlVal = on
OR FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Disc0XSWI1.Pos.ctlVal = on SETTING
OR AND SWITCH 1 ON CMD
From IEC 61850 protocol SWITCH 1 CLOSE SEAL-IN
T PKP
SETTING 0 AND
SWITCH 1 CLOSE
AND
= Off

AND
DiscCSWI1.BlkCls.ctlVal = on
From IEC 61850 protocol
OR Disc0XSWI1.BlkCls.stVal
SETTING To IEC 61850 protocol
SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE AND Enable
= Off to sheet 2 859765A1.vsd

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-197


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-98: Disconnect switch control status logic (sheet 2 of 3)


From sheet 1
Enable

SETTING
SWITCH 1 MODE
= 1-Pole
= 3-Pole

FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SWITCH 1 SUBD CLSD
SWITCH 1 SUBD OPEN FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 A CLOSED AND SWITCH 1 ΦA CLSD
SETTING AND
SWITCH 1 ΦA/3P CLSD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR SW1 A OPENED AND SWITCH 1 ΦA OPEN
= Off AND
AND
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 ΦA/3P OPND AND SWITCH 1 ΦA INTERM
OR SETTING
= Off AND
AND SWITCH 1 TOPERATE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR T PKP AND SWITCH 1 ΦA BAD ST
0
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 B CLOSED AND SWITCH 1 ΦB CLSD
SETTING AND
SWITCH 1 ΦB CLSD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR SW1 B OPENED AND SWITCH 1 ΦB OPEN
= Off AND
AND
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 ΦB OPENED AND SWITCH 1 ΦB INTERM
OR AND
= Off AND
OR SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 TOPERATE
AND AND SWITCH 1 ΦB BAD ST
T PKP
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 C CLOSED AND SWITCH 1 ΦC CLSD
SETTING AND
SWITCH 1 ΦC CLSD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR SW1 C OPENED AND SWITCH 1 ΦC OPEN

5
= Off AND
AND
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 ΦC OPENED AND SWITCH 1 ΦC INTERM
OR AND
= Off AND
OR SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 TOPERATE
AND AND SWITCH 1 ΦC BAD ST
T PKP
0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND SWITCH 1 TROUBLE
OR

AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


SW1 A CLOSED AND SWITCH 1 CLOSED
OR
SW1 B CLOSED
AND
SW1 C CLOSED SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 ALARM DELAY
AND SWITCH 1 DISCREP
T PKP
AND
0

SW1 A OPENED
AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 B OPENED
AND SWITCH 1 OPEN
SW1 C OPENED OR

AND
Enable
to sheet 3 859766A1.vsd

5-198 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

Figure 5-99: Disconnect switch control graphical front panel logic (sheet 3 of 3)
From sheet 2
SETTING Enable
SWITCH 1 TAGGING
= Enabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
SWITCH 1 Tag S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch SWITCH 1 TAG ON
SWITCH 1 Remove Tag
OR R SWITCH 1 TAG OFF
From graphical front panel

SETTING
SWITCH 1 SUBSTITUTN
= Enabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
SWITCH 1 Substitute Open S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch SWITCH 1 SUBD OPEN
SWITCH 1 Remove Substitution
OR R

SWITCH 1 Substitute Closed S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


From graphical front panel Latch SWITCH 1 SUBD CLSD
OR R

SETTING
SWITCH 1 BYPASS
= Enabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
SWITCH 1 Bypass S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SWITCH 1 Remove Bypass Latch SWITCH 1 BYPASS ON
From graphical front panel OR R SWITCH 1 BYPASS OFF

859767A1.vsd

5.5.6 FlexCurves

5.5.6.1 Settings
5
SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  FLEXCURVES  FLEXCURE A(D)
 FLEXCURVE A FLEXCURVE A TIME AT Range: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1
  0.00 xPKP: 0 ms

FLEXCURVE A TIME AT Range: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1


 0.05 xPKP: 0 ms

FLEXCURVE A TIME AT Range: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1
 20.00xPKP: 0 ms

FlexCurves A through D have settings for entering times to reset and operate at the following pickup levels: 0.00 to 0.98
and 1.03 to 20.00. This data is converted into two continuous curves by linear interpolation between data points. To enter
a custom FlexCurve, enter the reset and operate times (using the VALUE keys) for each selected pickup point (using the
MESSAGE up/down keys) for the required protection curve (A, B, C, or D).

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-199


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Table 5-20: FlexCurve table


Reset Time Reset Time Operate Time Operate Time Operate Time Operate Time
ms ms ms ms ms ms
0.00 0.68 1.03 2.9 4.9 10.5
0.05 0.70 1.05 3.0 5.0 11.0
0.10 0.72 1.1 3.1 5.1 11.5
0.15 0.74 1.2 3.2 5.2 12.0
0.20 0.76 1.3 3.3 5.3 12.5
0.25 0.78 1.4 3.4 5.4 13.0
0.30 0.80 1.5 3.5 5.5 13.5
0.35 0.82 1.6 3.6 5.6 14.0
0.40 0.84 1.7 3.7 5.7 14.5
0.45 0.86 1.8 3.8 5.8 15.0
0.48 0.88 1.9 3.9 5.9 15.5
0.50 0.90 2.0 4.0 6.0 16.0
0.52 0.91 2.1 4.1 6.5 16.5
0.54 0.92 2.2 4.2 7.0 17.0
0.56 0.93 2.3 4.3 7.5 17.5
0.58 0.94 2.4 4.4 8.0 18.0
0.60 0.95 2.5 4.5 8.5 18.5
0.62 0.96 2.6 4.6 9.0 19.0
0.64 0.97 2.7 4.7 9.5 19.5
5 0.66 0.98 2.8 4.8 10.0 20.0

The relay using a given FlexCurve applies linear approximation for times between the user-entered points. Take
care when setting the two points that are close to the multiple of pickup of 1; that is, 0.98 pu and 1.03 pu. It is
recommended to set the two times to a similar value, otherwise the linear approximation can result in undesired
behavior for the operating quantity that is close to 1.00 pu.

5.5.6.2 FlexCurve configuration with EnerVista software


The EnerVista software allows for easy configuration and management of FlexCurves and their associated data points.
Prospective FlexCurves can be configured from a selection of standard curves to provide the best approximate fit, then
specific data points can be edited afterwards. Alternately, curve data can be imported from a specified file (.csv format) by
selecting the EnerVista Import Data From setting (Settings > System Setup > FlexCurves > FlexCurve).
Curves and data can be exported, viewed, and cleared by clicking the appropriate buttons. FlexCurves are customized by
editing the operating time (ms) values at pre-defined per-unit current multiples. Note that the pickup multiples start at zero
(implying the "reset time"), operating time below pickup, and operating time above pickup.

5.5.6.3 Recloser curve editing


Recloser curve selection is special in that recloser curves can be shaped into a composite curve with a minimum response
time and a fixed time above a specified pickup multiples. There are 41 recloser curve types supported. These definite
operating times are useful to coordinate operating times, typically at higher currents and where upstream and
downstream protective devices have different operating characteristics. The recloser curve configuration window shown
here appears when the Initialize From setting in the EnerVista software is set to “Recloser Curve” and the Initialize
FlexCurve button is clicked.

5-200 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

Figure 5-100: Recloser curve initialization

Multiplier: Scales (multiplies) the curve operating times

Addr: Adds the time specified in this field (in ms) to each
curve operating time value.

Minimum Response Time (MRT): If enabled, the MRT setting


defines the shortest operating time even if the curve suggests
a shorter time at higher current multiples. A composite operating
characteristic is effectively defined. For current multiples lower
than the intersection point, the curve dictates the operating time;
otherwise, the MRT does. An information message appears
when attempting to apply an MRT shorter than the minimum
curve time.

High Current Time: Allows the user to set a pickup multiple


from which point onwards the operating time is fixed. This is
normally only required at higher current levels. The HCT Ratio
defines the high current pickup multiple; the HCT defines the
operating time.
842721A1.CDR

The Multiplier and Adder settings only affect the curve portion of the characteristic and not the MRT and HCT
settings. The HCT settings override the MRT settings for multiples of pickup greater than the HCT ratio.

5.5.6.4 Example
A composite curve can be created from the GE_111 standard with MRT = 200 ms and HCT initially disabled and then 5
enabled at eight times pickup with an operating time of 30 ms. At approximately four times pickup, the curve operating
time is equal to the MRT and from then onwards the operating time remains at 200 ms.
Figure 5-101: Composite recloser curve with HCT disabled

842719A1.CDR

With the HCT feature enabled, the operating time reduces to 30 ms for pickup multiples exceeding eight times pickup.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-201


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-102: Composite recloser curve with HCT enabled

842720A1.CDR

Configuring a composite curve with an increase in operating time at increased pickup multiples is not allowed. If
this is attempted, the EnerVista software generates an error message and discards the proposed changes.

5.5.6.5 Standard recloser curves


The following graphs display standard recloser curves available for the F35.
5 Figure 5-103: Recloser curves GE101 to GE106

1 GE106

0.5

0.2
TIME (sec)

GE103

GE104 GE105
0.1

0.05
GE101 GE102

0.02

0.01
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842723A1.CDR

5-202 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

Figure 5-104: Recloser curves GE113, GE120, GE138, and GE142

50

20 GE142

10

5
GE138
TIME (sec)

1 GE120
GE113
0.5

0.2

0.1

0.05
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842725A1.CDR

5
Figure 5-105: Recloser curves GE134, GE137, GE140, GE151, and GE201

50

20

10
GE201
TIME (sec)

GE151
2

GE134 GE140
1
GE137

0.5

1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20


CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842730A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-203


SYSTEM SETUP CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-106: Recloser curves GE131, GE141, GE152, and GE200

50

GE152

20
TIME (sec)

GE141
10

GE131
5

GE200

2
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842728A1.CDR

5
Figure 5-107: Recloser curves GE133, GE161, GE162, GE163, GE164, and GE165

50

20
GE164
10

2
TIME (sec)

GE162
1

0.5
GE133
0.2
GE165
0.1

0.05
GE161
0.02 GE163

0.01
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842729A1.CDR

5-204 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP

Figure 5-108: Recloser curves GE116, GE117, GE118, GE132, GE136, and GE139
20
GE132
10

1
TIME (sec)

0.5 GE139

0.2
GE136
0.1
GE116
0.05
GE118 GE117

0.02

0.01
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842726A1.CDR

5
Figure 5-109: Recloser curves GE107, GE111, GE112, GE114, GE115, GE121, and GE122
20

10

5
GE122
2

1
TIME (sec)

0.5
GE114
0.2
GE111
GE121
0.1

0.05 GE115 GE112


GE107

0.02

0.01
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842724A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-205


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-110: Recloser curves GE119, GE135, and GE202

50

20
GE202
10
TIME (sec)

GE135
2 GE119

0.5

0.2
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842727A1.CDR

5
5.6 FlexLogic
5.6.1 FlexLogic operands
For flexibility, the arrangement of internal digital logic combines fixed and user-programmed parameters. Logic upon
which individual features are designed is fixed, and all other logic, from contact input signals through elements or
combinations of elements to contact outputs, is variable. The user has complete control of all variable logic through
FlexLogic. In general, the system receives analog and digital inputs that it uses to produce analog and digital outputs. The
figure shows major subsystems of a generic UR-series relay involved in this process.

5-206 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Figure 5-111: UR architecture overview

CTs DSP
VTs (A/D) FlexLogic™ Virtual
equations outputs
Calculate
DCmA parameters Measuring
Analog and
or
input decision Digital Flags
RTD
(A/D) elements elements
inputs
V I
Contact Form-A and
inputs FlexLogic™ SCR only
Block counters
operation Contact
(each outputs
element)
Keypad
Virtual Remote
inputs (FlexLogic operands) outputs
OR

Remote Display
inputs Control and LEDs
(GOOSE) and Display
monitoring
features
fiber Analog
Direct output (D/A)
G.703 inputs
RS422 (dcmA)

5
(Status) Fiber
Direct
G.703
outputs
RS422
(Actual values) (Status)

EnerVista UR Setup and LAN communications

827022A7.cdr

The states of all digital signals used in the F35 are represented by flags (or FlexLogic operands, which are described later in
this section). A digital “1” is represented by a set flag. Any external contact change-of-state can be used to block an
element from operating, as an input to a control feature in a FlexLogic equation, or to operate a contact output. The state
of the contact input can be displayed locally or viewed remotely via the communications facilities provided. If a simple
scheme where a contact input is used to block an element is wanted, this selection is made when programming the
element. This capability also applies to the other features that set flags: elements, virtual inputs, remote inputs, schemes,
and human operators.
If more complex logic than shown in the figure is required, it is implemented via FlexLogic. For example, to have the closed
state of contact input H7a and the operated state of the phase undervoltage element block the operation of the phase
time overcurrent element, the two control input states are programmed in a FlexLogic equation. This equation ANDs the
two control inputs to produce a virtual output that is then selected when programming the phase time overcurrent to be
used as a blocking input. Virtual outputs can only be created by FlexLogic equations.
Traditionally, protective relay logic has been relatively limited. Any unusual applications involving interlocks, blocking, or
supervisory functions had to be hard-wired using contact inputs and outputs. FlexLogic minimizes the requirement for
auxiliary components and wiring while making more complex schemes possible.
The logic that determines the interaction of inputs, elements, schemes, and outputs is field-programmable through the use
of logic equations that are sequentially processed. The use of virtual inputs and outputs in addition to hardware is
available internally and on the communication ports for other relays to use (distributed FlexLogic).
FlexLogic allows users to customize the relay through a series of equations that consist of operators and operands. The
operands are the states of inputs, elements, schemes, and outputs. The operators are logic gates, timers, and latches (with
set and reset inputs). A system of sequential operations allows any combination of operands to be assigned as inputs to

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-207


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

specified operators to create an output. The final output of an equation is a numbered register called a virtual output.
Virtual outputs can be used as an input operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a
seal-in or other type of feedback.
A FlexLogic equation consists of parameters that are either operands or operators. Operands have a logic state of 1 or 0.
Operators provide a defined function, such as an AND gate or a Timer. Each equation defines the combinations of
parameters to be used to set a Virtual Output flag. Evaluation of an equation results in either a 1 (=ON, or flag set) or 0
(=OFF, or flag not set). Each equation is evaluated at least four times every power system cycle.
Some types of operands are present in the relay in multiple instances, for example contact and remote inputs. These types
of operands are grouped together (for presentation purposes only) on the front panel display. The table lists characteristics
of the different types of operands.
Table 5-21: F35 FlexLogic operand types
Operand type State Example of format Characteristics
[Input Is ‘1’ (= ON) if...]
Contact Input On Cont Ip On Voltage is applied presently to the input (external contact
closed)
Off Cont Ip Off Voltage is not applied presently to the input (external
contact open)
Contact Output Contact Closed Cont Op 1 Closed Contact output is closed
(type Form-A contact
Current On Cont Op 1 Ion Current is flowing through the contact
only)
Voltage On Cont Op 1 VOn Voltage exists across the contact
Voltage Off Cont Op 1 VOff Voltage does not exist across the contact
Direct Input On DIRECT INPUT 1 On The direct input is presently in the ON state
Element Pickup PHASE TOC1 PKP The tested parameter is presently above the pickup setting
5 (Analog) of an element that responds to rising values or below the
pickup setting of an element that responds to falling values
Dropout PHASE TOC1 DPO This operand is the logical inverse of the above PKP
operand
Operate PHASE TOC1 OP The tested parameter has been above/below the pickup
setting of the element for the programmed delay time, or
has been at logic 1 and is now at logic 0 but the reset timer
has not finished timing
Block PHASE TOC1 BLK The output of the comparator is set to the block function
Element Pickup Dig Element 1 PKP The input operand is at logic 1
(Digital)
Dropout Dig Element 1 DPO This operand is the logical inverse of the above PKP
operand
Operate Dig Element 1 OP The input operand has been at logic 1 for the programmed
pickup delay time, or has been at logic 1 for this period and
is now at logic 0 but the reset timer has not finished timing
Element Higher than Counter 1 HI The number of pulses counted is above the set number
(Digital Counter)
Equal to Counter 1 EQL The number of pulses counted is equal to the set number
Lower than Counter 1 LO The number of pulses counted is below the set number
Fixed On On Logic 1
Off Off Logic 0
RxGOOSE Boolean On RxGOOSE Boolean 1 On The RxGOOSE Boolean is presently in the ON state
Virtual Input On Virt Ip 1 On The virtual input is presently in the ON state
Virtual Output On Virt Op 1 On The virtual output is presently in the set state (that is,
evaluation of the equation that produces this virtual output
results in a "1")

The following table lists the operands available for the relay. The operands can be viewed online by entering the IP address
of the relay in a web browser and accessing the Device Information Menu.

5-208 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Table 5-22: F35 FlexLogic operands


Operand type Operand syntax Operand description
ANNUNCIATOR ANY ANCTR ABNORMAL On for one second when any annunciator window state changes from
Graphical front panel normal to abnormal
ANY ANCTR ALARMED On while any annunciator window state is abnormal
CONTROL CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON Control pushbutton 1 is being pressed
PUSHBUTTONS CONTROL PUSHBTN 2 ON Control pushbutton 2 is being pressed
Enhanced and basic CONTROL PUSHBTN 3 ON Control pushbutton 3 is being pressed
front panels CONTROL PUSHBTN 4 ON Control pushbutton 4 is being pressed
CONTROL PUSHBTN 5 ON Control pushbutton 5 is being pressed
CONTROL PUSHBTN 6 ON Control pushbutton 6 is being pressed
CONTROL PUSHBTN 7 ON Control pushbutton 7 is being pressed
CYBERSENTRY ROLE ADMIN ACT Administrator role is active and is set to true when that is the case
ROLE SUPERVISOR ACT Supervisor role is active and is set to true when that is the case
ROLE ENGINEER ACT Engineer role is active and is set to true when that is the case
ROLE OPERATOR ACT Operator role is active and is set to true when that is the case
ROLE OBSERVER ACT Observer role is active and is set to true when that is the case
AUTHENTICATION FAIL Operand set for Failed Authentication self-test and alarm
UNAUTH FW ATTEMPT Operand set for firmware lock self-test and alarm
UNAUTH SETTING WRITE Operand set for settings lock self-test and alarm
DIRECT DEVICES DIRECT DEVICE 1On Flag is set, logic=1
 
DIRECT DEVICE 16On Flag is set, logic=1
DIRECT DEVICE 1Off Flag is set, logic=1
 
DIRECT DEVICE 16Off Flag is set, logic=1
DIRECT INPUT/ DIR IO CH1 CRC ALARM The rate of direct input messages received on channel 1 and failing the CRC
OUTPUT CHANNEL exceeded the user-specified level
MONITORING DIR IO CH2 CRC ALARM The rate of direct input messages received on channel 2 and failing the CRC

DIR IO CH1 UNRET ALM


exceeded the user-specified level
The rate of returned direct input/output messages on channel 1 exceeded
5
the user-specified level (ring configurations only)
DIR IO CH2 UNRET ALM The rate of returned direct input/output messages on channel 2 exceeded
the user-specified level (ring configurations only)
ELEMENT: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 0 Bit 0 of eight-bit switch 1 asserted (the least significant bit)
Eight-bit switch 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 1 Bit 1 of eight-bit switch 1 asserted
8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 2 Bit 2 of eight-bit switch 1 asserted
8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 3 Bit 3 of eight-bit switch 1 asserted
8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 4 Bit 4 of eight-bit switch 1 asserted
8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 5 Bit 5 of eight-bit switch 1 asserted
8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 6 Bit 6 of eight-bit switch 1 asserted
8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 7 Bit 7 of eight-bit switch 1 asserted (the most significant bit)
8BIT SWITCH 2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for 8 BIT SWITCH 1
ELEMENT: AR1 ENABLED Autoreclose 1 is enabled
Autoreclose AR1 RIP Autoreclose 1 is in progress
(per CT bank) AR1 LO Autoreclose 1 is locked out
AR1 BLK FROM MAN CLS Autoreclose 1 is temporarily disabled
AR1 CLOSE Autoreclose 1 close command is issued
AR1 SHOT CNT=0 Autoreclose 1 shot count is 0
AR1 SHOT CNT=1 Autoreclose 1 shot count is 1
AR1 SHOT CNT=2 Autoreclose 1 shot count is 2
AR1 SHOT CNT=3 Autoreclose 1 shot count is 3
AR1 SHOT CNT=4 Autoreclose 1 shot count is 4
AR1 DISABLED Autoreclose 1 is disabled
AR2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for AR1
ELEMENT: AUX OV1 PKP Auxiliary overvoltage element has picked up
Auxiliary overvoltage AUX OV1 DPO Auxiliary overvoltage element has dropped out
AUX OV1 OP Auxiliary overvoltage element has operated
AUX OV2 to 3 Same set of operands as shown for AUX OV1
ELEMENT: AUX UV1 PKP Auxiliary undervoltage element has picked up
Auxiliary AUX UV1 DPO Auxiliary undervoltage element has dropped out
undervoltage AUX UV1 OP Auxiliary undervoltage element has operated
AUX UV2 to 3 Same set of operands as shown for AUX UV1

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-209


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Operand type Operand syntax Operand description


ELEMENT: BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP A Breaker 1 flashover element phase A has picked up
Breaker flashover BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP B Breaker 1 flashover element phase B has picked up
BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP C Breaker 1 flashover element phase C has picked up
BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP Breaker 1 flashover element has picked up
BKR 1 FLSHOVR OP A Breaker 1 flashover element phase A has operated
BKR 1 FLSHOVR OP B Breaker 1 flashover element phase B has operated
BKR 1 FLSHOVR OP C Breaker 1 flashover element phase C has operated
BKR 1 FLSHOVR OP Breaker 1 flashover element has operated
BKR 1 FLSHOVR DPO A Breaker 1 flashover element phase A has dropped out
BKR 1 FLSHOVR DPO B Breaker 1 flashover element phase B has dropped out
BKR 1 FLSHOVR DPO C Breaker 1 flashover element phase C has dropped out
BKR 1 FLSHOVR DPO Breaker 1 flashover element has dropped out
BKR 2 FLSHOVR Same set of operands as shown for BKR 1 FLSHOVR
ELEMENT: BKR ARC 1 OP Breaker arcing current 1 has operated
Breaker arcing BKR ARC 1 DPO Breaker arcing current 1 has dropped out
BKR ARC 1 MAX OP Breaker arcing current 1 max interrupting current has operated
BKR ARC 1 MAX DPO Breaker arcing current 1 max interrupting current has dropped out
BKR ARC 2 OP Breaker arcing current 2 has operated
BKR ARC 2 DPO Breaker arcing current 2 has dropped out
BKR ARC 2 MAX OP Breaker arcing current 2 max interrupting current has operated
BKR ARC 2 MAX DPO Breaker arcing current 2 max interrupting current has dropped out
BKR ARC 3 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for BKR ARC 1
ELEMENT: BRK RESTRIKE 1 OP Breaker restrike detected in any phase of the breaker control 1 element
Breaker restrike BRK RESTRIKE 1 OP A Breaker restrike detected in phase A of the breaker control 1 element
BRK RESTRIKE 1 OP B Breaker restrike detected in phase B of the breaker control 1 element
BRK RESTRIKE 1 OP C Breaker restrike detected in phase C of the breaker control 1 element
BKR RESTRIKE 2 to 3 Same set of operands as shown for BKR RESTRIKE 1

5-210 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Operand type Operand syntax Operand description


ELEMENT: BREAKER 1 OFF CMD Breaker 1 3-pole open command/trip initiated
Breaker control BREAKER 1 ON CMD Breaker 1 close command initiated
BREAKER 1 A BAD ST Breaker 1 phase A bad status is detected (discrepancy between the 52/a and
52/b contacts)
BREAKER 1 A INTERM Breaker 1 phase A intermediate status is detected (transition from one
position to another)
BREAKER 1 A CLSD Breaker 1 phase A is closed
BREAKER 1 A OPEN Breaker 1 phase A is open
BREAKER 1 B BAD ST Breaker 1 phase B bad status is detected (discrepancy between the 52/a and
52/b contacts)
BREAKER 1 B INTERM Breaker 1 phase B intermediate status is detected (transition from one
position to another)
BREAKER 1 B CLSD Breaker 1 phase B is closed
BREAKER 1 B OPEN Breaker 1 phase B is open
BREAKER 1 C BAD ST Breaker 1 phase C bad status is detected (discrepancy between the 52/a and
52/b contacts)
BREAKER 1 C INTERM Breaker 1 phase C intermediate status is detected (transition from one
position to another)
BREAKER 1 C CLSD Breaker 1 phase C is closed
BREAKER 1 C OPEN Breaker 1 phase C is open
BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS Breaker 1 bad status is detected on any pole
BREAKER 1 CLOSED Breaker 1 is closed
BREAKER 1 OPEN Breaker 1 is open
BREAKER 1 DISCREP Breaker 1 has discrepancy
BREAKER 1 TROUBLE Breaker 1 trouble alarm
BREAKER 1 MNL OPEN Breaker 1 manual open
BREAKER 1 MNL CLS Breaker 1 manual close
BREAKER 1 TRIP A Breaker 1 trip phase A command
BREAKER 1 TRIP B Breaker 1 trip phase B command
BREAKER 1 TRIP C Breaker 1 trip phase C command
BREAKER 1 ANY P OPEN
BREAKER 1 ONE P OPEN
BREAKER 1 OOS
At least one pole of breaker 1 is open
Only one pole of breaker 1 is open
Breaker 1 is out of service
5
BREAKER 1 TAG ON Breaker 1 tagged so manual trip and close and autoreclose are blocked
BREAKER 1 TAG OFF Breaker 1 not tagged
BREAKER 1 SUBD CLSD Breaker 1 status manually substituted to closed
BREAKER 1 SUBD OPEN Breaker 1 status manually substituted to open
BREAKER 1 BYPASS ON Breaker 1 control interlocking is manually bypassed
BREAKER 1 BYPASS OFF Breaker 1 control interlocking is not manually bypassed
BREAKER 1 BLK RCLS Breaker 1 command to manually block autoreclose
BREAKER 1 ENA RCLS Breaker 1 command to manually enable autoreclose
BREAKER 2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for BREAKER 1
ELEMENT: BROKEN CONDUCT 1 OP Asserted when the broken conductor 1 element operates
Broken conductor BROKEN CONDUCT 1 PKP Asserted when the broken conductor 1 element picks up
BROKEN CONDUCT 2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1
ELEMENT: COLD LOAD 1 OP Cold load pickup element 1 has operated
Cold load pickup
COLD LOAD 2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for COLD LOAD 1
ELEMENT: Counter 1 HI Digital counter 1 output is ‘more than’ comparison value
Digital counters Counter 1 EQL Digital counter 1 output is ‘equal to’ comparison value
Counter 1 LO Digital counter 1 output is ‘less than’ comparison value
Counter 2 to 8 Same set of operands as shown for Counter 1
ELEMENT: Dig Element 1 PKP Digital Element 1 is picked up
Digital elements Dig Element 1 OP Digital Element 1 is operated
Dig Element 1 DPO Digital Element 1 is dropped out
Dig Element 2 to 48 Same set of operands as shown for Dig Element 1
ELEMENT: FxE 1 PKP FlexElement 1 has picked up
FlexElements FxE 1 OP FlexElement 1 has operated
FxE 1 DPO FlexElement 1 has dropped out
FxE 2 to 16 Same set of operands as shown for FxE 1
ELEMENT: GROUND IOC1 PKP Ground instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
Ground GROUND IOC1 OP Ground instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
instantaneous GROUND IOC1 DPO Ground instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
overcurrent

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-211


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Operand type Operand syntax Operand description


GROUND IOC2 to 12 Same set of operands as shown for GROUND IOC 1
ELEMENT: GROUND TOC1 PKP Ground time overcurrent 1 has picked up
Ground time GROUND TOC1 OP Ground time overcurrent 1 has operated
overcurrent GROUND TOC1 DPO Ground time overcurrent 1 has dropped out
GROUND TOC2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for GROUND TOC1
ELEMENT: INCIPNT FLT 1 OP Asserted when incipient cable fault detector 1 operates in any phase
Incipient cable fault INCIPNT FLT 1 OP A Asserted when incipient cable fault detector 1 operates in phase A
detection INCIPNT FLT 1 OP B Asserted when incipient cable fault detector 1 operates in phase B
INCIPNT FLT 1 OP C Asserted when incipient cable fault detector 1 operates in phase C
INCIPNT FLT 1 PKP Asserted when incipient cable fault detector 1 picks up in any phase
INCIPNT FLT 1 PKP A Asserted when incipient cable fault detector 1 picks up in phase A
INCIPNT FLT 1 PKP B Asserted when incipient cable fault detector 1 picks up in phase B
INCIPNT FLT 1 PKP C Asserted when incipient cable fault detector 1 picks up in phase C
INCIPNT FLT 2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for INCIPNT FLT 1
ELEMENT: LATCH 1 ON Non-volatile latch 1 is ON (Logic = 1)
Non-volatile latches LATCH 1 OFF Non-volatile latch 1 is OFF (Logic = 0)
LATCH 2 to 16 Same set of operands as shown for LATCH 1
ELEMENT: NEG SEQ IOC1 PKP Negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
Negative-sequence NEG SEQ IOC1 OP Negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
instantaneous NEG SEQ IOC1 DPO Negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
overcurrent
NEG SEQ IOC2 Same set of operands as shown for NEG SEQ IOC1
ELEMENT: NEG SEQ TOC1 PKP Negative-sequence time overcurrent 1 has picked up
Negative-sequence NEG SEQ TOC1 OP Negative-sequence time overcurrent 1 has operated
time overcurrent NEG SEQ TOC1 DPO Negative-sequence time overcurrent 1 has dropped out

5 ELEMENT:
NEG SEQ TOC2
NEUTRAL IOC1 PKP
Same set of operands as shown for NEG SEQ TOC1
Neutral instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
Neutral NEUTRAL IOC1 OP Neutral instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
instantaneous NEUTRAL IOC1 DPO Neutral instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
overcurrent
NEUTRAL IOC2 to 12 Same set of operands as shown for NEUTRAL IOC1
ELEMENT: NEUTRAL OV1 PKP Neutral overvoltage element 1 has picked up
Neutral overvoltage NEUTRAL OV1 DPO Neutral overvoltage element 1 has dropped out
NEUTRAL OV1 OP Neutral overvoltage element 1 has operated
NEUTRAL OV2 to 3 Same set of operands as shown for NEUTRAL OV1
ELEMENT: NEUTRAL TOC1 PKP Neutral time overcurrent 1 has picked up
Neutral time NEUTRAL TOC1 OP Neutral time overcurrent 1 has operated
overcurrent NEUTRAL TOC1 DPO Neutral time overcurrent 1 has dropped out
NEUTRAL TOC2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for NEUTRAL TOC1
ELEMENT: PID 1 RAISE
PID regulator PID 1 LOWER
PID 2 RAISE
PID 2 LOWER
PID 3 RAISE
PID 3 LOWER
PID 4 RAISE
PID 4 LOWER
ELEMENT: PHASE IOC1 PKP At least one phase of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
Phase instantaneous PHASE IOC1 OP At least one phase of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
overcurrent PHASE IOC1 DPO All phases of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 have dropped out
PHASE IOC1 PKP A Phase A of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE IOC1 PKP B Phase B of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE IOC1 PKP C Phase C of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE IOC1 OP A Phase A of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE IOC1 OP B Phase B of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE IOC1 OP C Phase C of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE IOC1 DPO A Phase A of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE IOC1 DPO B Phase B of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE IOC1 DPO C Phase C of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE IOC2 to 12 Same set of operands as shown for PHASE IOC1

5-212 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Operand type Operand syntax Operand description


ELEMENT: PHASE OV1 PKP At least one phase of overvoltage 1 has picked up
Phase overvoltage PHASE OV1 OP At least one phase of overvoltage 1 has operated
PHASE OV1 DPO All phases of overvoltage 1 have dropped out
PHASE OV1 PKP A Phase A of overvoltage 1 has picked up
PHASE OV1 PKP B Phase B of overvoltage 1 has picked up
PHASE OV1 PKP C Phase C of overvoltage 1 has picked up
PHASE OV1 OP A Phase A of overvoltage 1 has operated
PHASE OV1 OP B Phase B of overvoltage 1 has operated
PHASE OV1 OP C Phase C of overvoltage 1 has operated
PHASE OV1 DPO A Phase A of overvoltage 1 has dropped out
PHASE OV1 DPO B Phase B of overvoltage 1 has dropped out
PHASE OV1 DPO C Phase C of overvoltage 1 has dropped out
PHASE OV2 to 3 Same set of operands as shown for PHASE OV1
ELEMENT: PHASE TOC1 PKP At least one phase of phase time overcurrent 1 has picked up
Phase time PHASE TOC1 OP At least one phase of phase time overcurrent 1 has operated
overcurrent PHASE TOC1 DPO All phases of phase time overcurrent 1 have dropped out
PHASE TOC1 PKP A Phase A of phase time overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE TOC1 PKP B Phase B of phase time overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE TOC1 PKP C Phase C of phase time overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE TOC1 OP A Phase A of phase time overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE TOC1 OP B Phase B of phase time overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE TOC1 OP C Phase C of phase time overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE TOC1 DPO A Phase A of phase time overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE TOC1 DPO B Phase B of phase time overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE TOC1 DPO C Phase C of phase time overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE TOC2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for PHASE TOC1
ELEMENT: PHASE UV1 PKP At least one phase of phase undervoltage 1 has picked up
Phase undervoltage PHASE UV1 OP At least one phase of phase undervoltage 1 has operated
PHASE UV1 DPO
PHASE UV1 PKP A
PHASE UV1 PKP B
All phases of phase undervoltage 1 have dropped out
Phase A of phase undervoltage 1 has picked up
Phase B of phase undervoltage 1 has picked up
5
PHASE UV1 PKP C Phase C of phase undervoltage 1 has picked up
PHASE UV1 OP A Phase A of phase undervoltage 1 has operated
PHASE UV1 OP B Phase B of phase undervoltage 1 has operated
PHASE UV1 OP C Phase C of phase undervoltage 1 has operated
PHASE UV1 DPO A Phase A of phase undervoltage 1 has dropped out
PHASE UV1 DPO B Phase B of phase undervoltage 1 has dropped out
PHASE UV1 DPO C Phase C of phase undervoltage 1 has dropped out
PHASE UV2 to 3 Same set of operands as shown for PHASE UV1
ELEMENT: SELECTOR 1 POS Y Selector switch 1 is in Position Y (mutually exclusive operands)
Selector switch SELECTOR 1 BIT 0 First bit of the 3-bit word encoding position of selector 1
SELECTOR 1 BIT 1 Second bit of the 3-bit word encoding position of selector 1
SELECTOR 1 BIT 2 Third bit of the 3-bit word encoding position of selector 1
SELECTOR 1 STP ALARM Position of selector 1 has been pre-selected with the stepping up control
input but not acknowledged
SELECTOR 1 BIT ALARM Position of selector 1 has been pre-selected with the 3-bit control input but
not acknowledged
SELECTOR 1 ALARM Position of selector 1 has been pre-selected but not acknowledged
SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM Position of selector switch 1 is undetermined or restored from memory when
the relay powers up and synchronizes to the three-bit input
SELECTOR 2 Same set of operands as shown for SELECTOR 1
ELEMENT: SETTING GROUP ACT 1 Setting group 1 is active
Setting group SETTING GROUP ACT 2 Setting group 2 is active
SETTING GROUP ACT 3 Setting group 3 is active
SETTING GROUP ACT 4 Setting group 4 is active
SETTING GROUP ACT 5 Setting group 5 is active
SETTING GROUP ACT 6 Setting group 6 is active
ELEMENT: SRC1 50DD OP Source 1 disturbance detector has operated
Disturbance detector SRC2 50DD OP Source 2 disturbance detector has operated
SRC3 50DD OP Source 3 disturbance detector has operated
SRC4 50DD OP Source 4 disturbance detector has operated
SRC5 50DD OP Source 5 disturbance detector has operated
SRC6 50DD OP Source 6 disturbance detector has operated

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-213


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Operand type Operand syntax Operand description


ELEMENT: SRC1 VT FF OP Source 1 VT fuse failure detector has operated
VTFF (Voltage SRC1 VT FF DPO Source 1 VT fuse failure detector has dropped out
transformer fuse SRC1 VT FF VOL LOSS Source 1 has lost voltage signals (V2 below 10% and V1 below 5% of nominal)
failure) SRC1 VT FF ALARM Source 1 has triggered a VT fuse failure alarm
SRC1 VT NEU WIRE OPEN Source 1 VT neutral wire open detected. When the VT is connected in Delta,
do not enable this function because there is no neutral wire for Delta
connected VT.
SRC2 VT FUSE FAIL to SRC6 Same set of operands as shown for SRC1 VT FF
ELEMENT: SWITCH 1 OFF CMD Disconnect switch 1 open command initiated
Disconnect switch SWITCH 1 ON CMD Disconnect switch 1 close command initiated
SWITCH 1 CLOSED Disconnect switch 1 is closed
SWITCH 1 OPEN Disconnect switch 1 is open
SWITCH 1 DISCREP Disconnect switch 1 has discrepancy
SWITCH 1 TROUBLE Disconnect switch 1 trouble alarm
SWITCH 1 A CLSD Disconnect switch 1 phase A is closed
SWITCH 1 A OPEN Disconnect switch 1 phase A is open
SWITCH 1 A BAD ST Disconnect switch 1 phase A bad status is detected (discrepancy between
the 89/a and 89/b contacts)
SWITCH 1 A INTERM Disconnect switch 1 phase A intermediate status is detected (transition from
one position to another)
SWITCH 1 B CLSD Disconnect switch 1 phase B is closed
SWITCH 1 B OPEN Disconnect switch 1 phase B is open
SWITCH 1 B BAD ST Disconnect switch 1 phase B bad status is detected (discrepancy between
the 89/a and 89/b contacts)
SWITCH 1 B INTERM Disconnect switch 1 phase B intermediate status is detected (transition from
one position to another)
SWITCH 1 C CLSD Disconnect switch 1 phase C is closed
SWITCH 1 C OPEN Disconnect switch 1 phase C is open
SWITCH 1 C BAD ST Disconnect switch 1 phase C bad status is detected (discrepancy between
5 SWITCH 1 C INTERM
the 89/a and 89/b contacts)
Disconnect switch 1 phase C intermediate status is detected (transition from
one position to another)
SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS Disconnect switch 1 bad status is detected on any pole
SWITCH 1 TAG ON Switch 1 tagged so manual trip and close is blocked
SWITCH 1 TAG OFF Switch 1 not tagged
SWITCH 1 SUBD CLSD Switch 1 status manually substituted to closed
SWITCH 1 SUBD OPEN Switch 1 status manually substituted to open
SWITCH 1 BYPASS ON Switch 1 control interlocking is bypassed manually
SWITCH 1 BYPASS OFF Switch 1 control interlocking is not bypassed manually
SWITCH 2 to 24 Same set of operands as shown for SWITCH 1
ELEMENT: TELEPRO CH1 FAIL Channel 1 failed
Teleprotection TELEPRO CH2 FAIL Channel 2 failed
channel tests TELEPRO CH1 ID FAIL The ID check for a peer relay on channel 1 has failed
TELEPRO CH2 ID FAIL The ID check for a peer relay on channel 2 has failed
TELEPRO CH1 CRC FAIL CRC detected packet corruption on channel 1
TELEPRO CH2 CRC FAIL CRC detected packet corruption on channel 2
TELEPRO CH1 PKT LOST CRC detected lost packet on channel 1
TELEPRO CH2 PKT LOST CRC detected lost packet on channel 2
ELEMENT: TELEPRO INPUT 1-1 On Flag is set, Logic =1
Teleprotection  
inputs/outputs TELEPRO INPUT 1-16 On Flag is set, Logic =1
TELEPRO INPUT 2-1 On Flag is set, Logic =1
 
TELEPRO INPUT 2-16 On Flag is set, Logic =1
ELEMENT: THERMAL PROT 1 PKP Thermal overload protection 1 picked up
Thermal overload THERMAL PROT 1 OP Thermal overload protection 1 operated
protection
THERMAL PROT 2 Same set of operands as shown for THERMAL PROT 1
ELEMENT: TRIP BUS 1 PKP Asserted when the trip bus 1 element picks up
Trip bus TRIP BUS 1 OP Asserted when the trip bus 1 element operates
TRIP BUS 2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for TRIP BUS 1
ELEMENT: UNDERFREQ 1 PKP Underfrequency 1 has picked up
Underfrequency UNDERFREQ 1 OP Underfrequency 1 has operated
UNDERFREQ 1 DPO Underfrequency 1 has dropped out

5-214 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Operand type Operand syntax Operand description


UNDERFREQ 2 to 6 Same set of operands as shown for UNDERFREQ 1
ELEMENT: WATTMETRIC 1 PKP Wattmetric directional element 1 has picked up
Wattmetric zero- WATTMETRIC 1 OP Wattmetric directional element 1 has operated
sequence directional
WATTMETRIC 2 to 4 Same set of operands as per WATTMETRIC 1
FIXED OPERANDS Off Logic = 0. Does nothing and can be used as a delimiter in an equation list;
used as ‘Disable’ by other features.
On Logic = 1. Can be used as a test setting.
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: Cont Ip 1 On (does not appear unless ordered)
Contact inputs Cont Ip 2 On (does not appear unless ordered)
 
Cont Ip 1 Off (does not appear unless ordered)
Cont Ip 2 Off (does not appear unless ordered)
 
Cont Ip 120 On (does not appear unless ordered)
Cont Ip 120 Off (does not appear unless ordered)
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: Cont Op 1 IOn (does not appear unless ordered)
Contact outputs, Cont Op 2 IOn (does not appear unless ordered)
current  
(from detector on Cont Op 72 IOn (does not appear unless ordered)
form-A output only)
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: Cont Op 1 VOn (does not appear unless ordered)
Contact outputs, Cont Op 2 VOn (does not appear unless ordered)
voltage  
(from detector on Cont Op 72 VOn (does not appear unless ordered)
form-A output only)
Cont Op 1 VOff (does not appear unless ordered)
Cont Op 2 VOff

Cont Op 72 VOff
(does not appear unless ordered)

(does not appear unless ordered)
5
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: DIRECT INPUT 1 On Flag is set, logic=1
Direct inputs  
DIRECT INPUT 32 On Flag is set, logic=1
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: RxG DPS 1 BAD Asserted while the RxGOOSE double-point status input is in the bad state
RxGOOSE DPS RxG DPS 1 INTERM Asserted while the RxGOOSE double-point status input is in the intermediate
state
RxG DPS 1 OFF Asserted while the RxGOOSE double-point status input is off
RxG DPS 1 ON Asserted while the RxGOOSE double-point status input is on
RxG DPS 2 to 5 Same set of operands as per RxG DPS 1
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: RxG Bool 1 On Flag is set, logic=1
RxGOOSE Booleans RxG Bool 2 On Flag is set, logic=1
RxG Bool 3 On Flag is set, logic=1
 
RxG Bool 256 On Flag is set, logic=1
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: Virt Ip 1 On Flag is set, logic=1
Virtual inputs Virt Ip 2 On Flag is set, logic=1
Virt Ip 3 On Flag is set, logic=1
 
Virt Ip 64 On Flag is set, logic=1
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: Virt Op 1 On Flag is set, logic=1
Virtual outputs Virt Op 2 On Flag is set, logic=1
Virt Op 3 On Flag is set, logic=1
 
Virt Op 96 On Flag is set, logic=1

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-215


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Operand type Operand syntax Operand description


LED INDICATORS: LED IN SERVICE Asserted when the front panel IN SERVICE LED is on
Enhanced and basic LED TROUBLE Asserted when the front panel TROUBLE LED is on
front panels LED TEST MODE Asserted when the front panel TEST MODE LED is on
LED TRIP Asserted when the front panel TRIP LED is on
LED ALARM Asserted when the front panel ALARM LED is on
LED PICKUP Asserted when an element picks up and to turn PICKUP LED on
LED VOLTAGE Asserted when a voltage element involved and to turn VOLTAGE LED on
LED CURRENT Asserted when a current element involved and to turn CURRENT LED on
LED FREQUENCY Asserted when a frequency element involved and to turn FREQUENCY LED on
LED OTHER Asserted when a composite element involved and to turn OTHER LED on
LED PHASE A Asserted when phase A involved and to turn PHASE A LED on
LED PHASE B Asserted when phase B involved and to turn PHASE B LED on
LED PHASE C Asserted when phase C involved and to turn PHASE C LED on
LED NEUTRAL/GROUND Asserted when a neutral or ground element involved and to turn NEUTRAL/
GROUND LED on
LED INDICATORS: LED IN SERVICE Asserted when the front panel IN SERVICE LED is on
Graphical front panel LED TROUBLE Asserted when the front panel TROUBLE LED is on
LED TEST MODE Asserted when the front panel TEST MODE LED is on
LED TRIP Asserted when the front panel TRIP LED is on
LED ALARM Asserted when the front panel ALARM LED is on
LED PICKUP Asserted when an element picks up and to turn Event Cause LED 1 on by
default
LED VOLTAGE Asserted when a voltage element involved and to turn Event Cause LED 2 on
by default
LED CURRENT Asserted when a current element involved and to turn Event Cause LED 3 on
by default
LED FREQUENCY Asserted when a frequency element involved and to turn Event Cause LED 4
on by default
LED OTHER Asserted when a composite element involved and to turn Event Cause LED 5
on by default
5 LED PHASE A
LED PHASE B
Asserted when phase A involved and to turn Event Cause LED 6 on by default
Asserted when phase B involved and to turn Event Cause LED 7 on by default
LED PHASE C Asserted when phase C involved and to turn Event Cause LED 8 on by default
LED NEUTRAL/GROUND Asserted when a neutral or ground element involved and to turn Event Cause
LED 9 on by default
LED INDICATORS: LED TEST IN PROGRESS An LED test has been initiated and has not finished
LED test
LED INDICATORS: LED USER 1 Asserted when user-programmable LED 1 is on
User-programmable
LEDs
Enhanced and basic
front panels
LED USER 2 to 48 The operand above is available for user-programmable LEDs 2 through 48
LED INDICATORS: EVENT CAUSE LED 1 Asserted when event cause LED 1 is on
User-programmable
EVENT CAUSE LED 2 to 9 Same operand as EVENT CAUSE LED 1
LEDs
Graphical front panel
PASSWORD ACCESS LOC SETG OFF Asserted when local setting access is disabled
SECURITY ACCESS LOC SETG ON Asserted when local setting access is enabled
ACCESS LOC CMND OFF Asserted when local command access is disabled
ACCESS LOC CMND ON Asserted when local command access is enabled
ACCESS REM SETG OFF Asserted when remote setting access is disabled
ACCESS REM SETG ON Asserted when remote setting access is enabled
ACCESS REM CMND OFF Asserted when remote command access is disabled
ACCESS REM CMND ON Asserted when remote command access is enabled
UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS Asserted when a password entry fails while accessing a password protected
level of the F35
RxGOOSE RxGOOSE 1 On Flag is set, logic=1
 
RxGOOSE 64 On Flag is set, logic=1
RxGOOSE 1 Off Flag is set, logic=1
 
RxGOOSE 64 Off Flag is set, logic=1

5-216 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Operand type Operand syntax Operand description


<RxGOOSE Boolean1 ID> On Replace bracketed text with RxGOOSE Boolean1 status of "true"
<RxGOOSE DPS1 ID> Bad Replace bracketed text with RxGOOSE DPS1 status of "bad-state"
<RxGOOSE DPS1 ID> Interm Replace bracketed text with RxGOOSE DPS1 status is "intermediate-state"
<RxGOOSE DPS1 ID> Off Replace bracketed text with RxGOOSE DPS1 status is "off"
<RxGOOSE DPS1 ID> On Replace bracketed text with RxGOOSE DPS1 status is "on"
RxGOOSE INVLD ON One or more Rx GOOSE Inputs are received with Invalid quality
RxGOOSE QUES ON One or more Rx GOOSE Inputs are received with questionable quality

RxGOOSE INVLD ON and RxGOOSE QUES ON operands have no dependency


with test mode or simulation mode. The operands are set when any of the
RxGOOSE Inputs received with Invalid or questionable quality.
RESETTING RESET OP Reset command is operated (set by all three operands below)
RESET OP (COMMS) Communications source of the reset command
RESET OP (OPERAND) Operand (assigned in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS  RESETTING menu) source of
the reset command
RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON) Reset key (pushbutton) source of the reset command
RESET ANCTR OP Reset annunciator command is operated (set by any operands below)
RESET ANCTR OP(OPRD) Reset operand (assigned in INPUTS/OUTPUTS  RESETTING
ANNUNCIATOR menu) source of the reset annunciator command
RESET ANCTR OP(MNUL) Reset manual (pushbutton or EnerVista software) source of the reset
annunciator command
SELF-DIAGNOSTICS ANY MAJOR ERROR Any of the major self-test errors generated (major error)
(See Relay Self-tests ANY MINOR ERROR Any of the minor self-test errors generated (minor error)
descriptions in ANY SELF-TESTS Any self-test errors generated (generic, any error)
Chapter 7: BATTERY FAIL The battery is weak or not functioning. Replace as outlined in the
Commands and Maintenance chapter.
Targets) CLOCK UNSYNCHRONIZED Relay is not synchronized to the international time standard
DIRECT DEVICE OFF A direct device is configured but not connected
DIRECT RING BREAK The Direct I/O settings is for a connection that is not in a ring
EQUIPMENT MISMATCH
FLEXLOGIC ERR TOKEN
IRIG-B FAILURE
The configuration of modules does not match the stored order code
A FlexLogic equation is incorrect
"Bad IRIG-B Signal" self-test. See Chapter 7: Commands and Targets.
5
LATCHING OUT ERROR A difference is detected between the desired and actual latch contact state
MAINTENANCE ALERT A subset of the minor self-test errors generated, see Chapter 7
FIRST ETHERNET FAIL Link failure detected. See description in Chapter 7: Commands and Targets.
PROCESS BUS FAILURE See description in Chapter 7: Commands and Targets
PTP FAILURE "Bad PTP Signal" self-test as described in Chapter 7
RxGOOSE OFF One or more GOOSE messages are not being received
RRTD COMM FAIL See description in Chapter 7: Commands and Targets
SECOND ETHERNET FAIL See description in Chapter 7: Commands and Targets
THIRD ETHERNET FAIL See description in Chapter 7: Commands and Targets
SNTP FAILURE SNTP server is not responding
SYSTEM EXCEPTION See description in Chapter 7: Commands and Targets
TEMP MONITOR Monitors ambient temperature and maximum operating temperature
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED The product SETUP > INSTALLATION > RELAYS SETTINGS setting is not
programmed
SETTING CHANGED Any device settings changed over any available interface; operand is
asserted for at least one second and then self-reset
SIMULATION TxGOOSE SIM ON Sim bit enabled in all Tx GOOSE
RxGOOSE SIM ON GOOSE messages with Sim bit set are accepted
TEMPERATURE TEMP MONITOR Asserted while the ambient temperature is greater than the maximum
MONITOR operating temperature (80°C)
USER- PUSHBUTTON 1 ON Pushbutton number 1 is in the “On” position
PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF Pushbutton number 1 is in the “Off” position
PUSHBUTTONS ANY PB ON Any of 12 pushbuttons is in the “On” position
PUSHBUTTON 2 to 6, 12, or 16 Same set of operands as PUSHBUTTON 1
depending on front panel

Some operands can be re-named. These are the names of the breakers in the breaker control feature, the ID (identification)
of contact inputs and outputs, the ID of virtual inputs, and the ID of virtual outputs. If the user changes the default name or
ID of any of these operands, the assigned name appears in the relay list of operands. The default names are shown in the
FlexLogic operands table.
The characteristics of the logic gates are tabulated in the following table, and the operators available in FlexLogic are
listed in the FlexLogic operators table.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-217


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Table 5-23: FlexLogic gate characteristics


Gates Number of inputs Output is ‘1’ (= ON) if...
NOT 1 input is ‘0’
OR 2 to 16 any input is ‘1’
AND 2 to 16 all inputs are ‘1’
NOR 2 to 16 all inputs are ‘0’
NAND 2 to 16 any input is ‘0’
XOR 2 only one input is ‘1’

Table 5-24: FlexLogic operators


Type Syntax Description Notes
Editor INSERT Insert a parameter in an equation list
DELETE Delete a parameter from an equation list
End END The first END encountered signifies the last entry in
the list of processed FlexLogic parameters
One-shot POSITIVE ONE SHOT One shot that responds to a positive going edge A ‘one shot’ refers to a single input gate that
generates a pulse in response to an edge on
NEGATIVE ONE SHOT One shot that responds to a negative going edge
the input. The output from a ‘one shot’ is
DUAL ONE SHOT One shot that responds to both the positive and True (positive) for only one pass through the
negative going edges FlexLogic equation. There is a maximum of
64 ‘one shots.’
Logic NOT Logical NOT Operates on the previous parameter
gate
OR(2) 2 input OR gate Operates on the 2 previous parameters
  
5 OR(16) 16 input OR gate Operates on the 16 previous parameters
AND(2) 2 input AND gate Operates on the 2 previous parameters
  
AND(16) 16 input AND gate Operates on the 16 previous parameters
NOR(2) 2 input NOR gate Operates on the 2 previous parameters
  
NOR(16) 16 input NOR gate Operates on the 16 previous parameters
NAND(2) 2 input NAND gate Operates on the 2 previous parameters
  
NAND(16) 16 input NAND gate Operates on the 16 previous parameters
XOR(2) 2 input Exclusive OR gate Operates on the 2 previous parameters
LATCH (S,R) Latch (set, reset): reset-dominant The parameter preceding LATCH(S,R) is the
reset input. The parameter preceding the
reset input is the set input.
Timer TIMER 1 Timer set with FlexLogic timer 1 settings The timer is started by the preceding
  parameter. The output of the timer is
TIMER 32 Timer set with FlexLogic timer 32 settings TIMER #.
Assign = Virt Op 1 Assigns previous FlexLogic operand to virtual The virtual output is set by the preceding
virtual  output 1 parameter
output = Virt Op 96 
Assigns previous FlexLogic operand to virtual
output 96

5.6.2 FlexLogic rules


When forming a FlexLogic equation, the sequence in the linear array of parameters must follow these general rules:
1. Operands must precede the operator that uses the operands as inputs.
2. Operators have only one output. The output of an operator must be used to create a virtual output if it is to be used as
an input to two or more operators.
3. Assigning the output of an operator to a virtual output terminates the equation.
4. A timer operator (for example, "TIMER 1") or virtual output assignment (for example, " = Virt Op 1") can be used once

5-218 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

only. If this rule is broken, a syntax error is declared.

5.6.3 FlexLogic evaluation


Each equation is evaluated in the ascending order in which the parameters have been entered.

FlexLogic provides built-in latches that by definition have a memory action, remaining in the set state after the set
input has been asserted. These built-in latches are reset dominant, meaning that if logical "1" is applied to both set
and reset entries simultaneously, then the output of the latch is logical "0." However, they are volatile, meaning that
they reset upon removal of control power.
When making changes to FlexLogic entries in the settings, all FlexLogic equations are re-compiled whenever any
new FlexLogic entry value is entered, and as a result of the re-compile all latches are reset automatically.
To implement FlexLogic using a graphical user interface, see the FlexLogic Design and Monitoring using Engineer
section in the previous chapter.

5.6.4 FlexLogic example


This section provides an example of logic implementation for a typical application. The sequence of steps is important to
minimize the work to develop the relay settings. Note that the example in the following figure demonstrates the procedure,
not to solve a specific application situation.
Note that there is also a graphical interface with which to draw logic and populate FlexLogic equation entries. See the
Engineer content at the end of the previous chapter.
In the example, it is assumed that logic has already been programmed to produce virtual outputs 1 and 2, and is only a
part of the full set of equations used. When using FlexLogic, it is important to make a note of each virtual output used; a
virtual output designation (1 to 96) can be assigned only once. 5
Figure 5-112: Logic example
Virtual output 1
state = On

Virtual output 2
Set
state = On
Latch
Virtual input 1 OR #1 Reset
state = On
XOR
Digital element 1 Timer 2
state = Pickup Time Delay Operate output
OR #2
on dropout relay H1
Digital element 2 Timer 1
(200 ms)
state = Operated Time delay
AND on pickup
(800 ms)
Contact input H1c
state = Closed 827025A2.CDR

1. Inspect the example logic diagram to determine if the required logic can be implemented with the FlexLogic
operators. If this is not possible, the logic must be altered until this condition is satisfied. Once done, count the inputs
to each gate to verify that the number of inputs does not exceed the FlexLogic limits, which is unlikely but possible. If
the number of inputs is too high, subdivide the inputs into multiple gates to produce an equivalent. For example, if 25
inputs to an AND gate are required, connect Inputs 1 through 16 to AND(16), 17 through 25 to AND(9), and the outputs
from these two gates to AND(2).
Inspect each operator between the initial operands and final virtual outputs to determine if the output from the
operator is used as an input to more than one following operator. If so, the operator output must be assigned as a
virtual output.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-219


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

For the example shown, the output of the AND gate is used as an input to both OR#1 and Timer 1, and must therefore
be made a virtual output and assigned the next available number (that is, Virtual Output 3). The final output must also
be assigned to a virtual output as virtual output 4, which is programmed in the contact output section to operate relay
H1 (that is, contact output H1).
Therefore, the required logic can be implemented with two FlexLogic equations with outputs of virtual output 3 and
virtual output 4, shown as follows.
Figure 5-113: Logic example with virtual outputs
Virtual output 1
state = On

Virtual output 2
Set
state = On
Latch
OR #1 Reset
Virtual input 1
state = On Timer 2
XOR Time delay
Digital element 1 OR #2 Virtual output 4
on dropout
state = Pickup
(200 ms)

Digital element 1 Timer 1


state = Operated Time delay
AND on pickup
(800 ms)
Contact input H1c
state = Closed Virtual output 3

827026A2.CDR

5 2. Prepare a logic diagram for the equation to produce virtual output 3, as this output is used as an operand in the virtual
output 4 equation (create the equation for every output that is used as an operand first, so that when these operands
are required they already have been evaluated and assigned to a specific virtual output). The logic for virtual output 3
is shown as follows with the final output assigned.
Figure 5-114: Logic for virtual output 3

Digital element 2
state= Operated

AND(2) Virtual output 3

Contact input H1c


state = Closed
827027A2.CDR

3. Prepare a logic diagram for virtual output 4, replacing the logic ahead of virtual output 3 with a symbol identified as
virtual output 3, shown as follows.

5-220 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Figure 5-115: Logic for virtual output 4

Virtual output 1
state = On

Virtual output 2
Set
state = On
Latch
OR #1 Reset
Virtual input 1
state = On Timer 2
XOR Time delay
OR #2 Virtual output 4
Digital element 1 on dropout
state = Pickup
(200 ms)

Timer 1
Virtual output 3 Time delay
state = On on pickup
(800 ms)
Contact input H1c
state = Closed
827028A2.CDR

4. Program the FlexLogic equation for virtual output 3 by translating the logic into available FlexLogic parameters. The
equation is formed one parameter at a time until the required logic is complete. It is generally easier to start at the
output end of the equation and work back towards the input, as shown in the following steps. It is also recommended
to list operator inputs from bottom to top. For demonstration, the final outputs are arbitrarily identified as parameter
99, and each preceding parameter decremented by one in turn. Until accustomed to using FlexLogic, it is suggested
that a worksheet with a series of cells marked with the arbitrary parameter numbers be prepared shown as follows.
Figure 5-116: FlexLogic worksheet
5
01
02
03
04
05
.....

97
98
99
827029A1.VSD

5. Following the procedure outlined, start with parameter 99, as follows:


– 99: The final output of the equation is virtual output 3, which is created by the operator "= Virt Op n". This
parameter is therefore "= Virt Op 3".
– 98: The gate preceding the output is an AND, which in this case requires two inputs. The operator for this gate is a
2-input AND so the parameter is “AND(2)”. Note that FlexLogic rules require that the number of inputs to most
types of operators must be specified to identify the operands for the gate. As the 2-input AND operates on the
two operands preceding it, these inputs must be specified, starting with the lower.
– 97: This lower input to the AND gate must be passed through an inverter (the NOT operator) so the next
parameter is “NOT”. The NOT operator acts upon the operand immediately preceding it, so specify the inverter
input next.
– 96: The input to the NOT gate is to be contact input H1c. The ON state of a contact input can be programmed to
be set when the contact is either open or closed. Assume for this example that the state is to be ON for a closed
contact. The operand is therefore “Cont Ip H1c On”.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-221


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

– 95: The last step in the procedure is to specify the upper input to the AND gate, the operated state of digital
element 2. This operand is "DIG ELEM 2 OP".
Writing the parameters in numerical order forms the equation for virtual output 3:
[95] DIG ELEM 2 OP
[96] Cont Ip H1c On
[97] NOT
[98] AND(2)
[99] = Virt Op 3
It is now possible to check that this selection of parameters produces the required logic by converting the set of
parameters into a logic diagram. The result of this process is shown in the figure, which is compared to the logic for
virtual output 3 diagram as a check.
Figure 5-117: FlexLogic equation for virtual output 3
FlexLogic entry:
95
Dig Element 2 (DE2) OP
AND Virtual output 3
FlexLogic entry:
96
Cont Ip 2 On (H1c)
FlexLogic entry:
97
NOT
FlexLogic entry:
98
AND (2)
FlexLogic entry:
99
= Virt Op 3 (VO3)
827030A2.CDR

6. Repeating the process described for virtual output 3, select the FlexLogic parameters for Virtual Output 4.
– 99: The final output of the equation is virtual output 4, which is parameter “= Virt Op 4".

5 – 98: The operator preceding the output is timer 2, which is operand “TIMER 2". Note that the settings required for
the timer are established in the timer programming section.
– 97: The operator preceding timer 2 is OR #2, a 3-input OR, which is parameter “OR(3)”.
– 96: The lowest input to OR #2 is operand “Cont Ip H1c On”.
– 95: The center input to OR #2 is operand “TIMER 1".
– 94: The input to timer 1 is operand “Virt Op 3 On".
– 93: The upper input to OR #2 is operand “LATCH (S,R)”.
– 92: There are two inputs to a latch, and the input immediately preceding the latch reset is OR #1, a 4-input OR,
which is parameter “OR(4)”.
– 91: The lowest input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 3 On".
– 90: The input just above the lowest input to OR #1 is operand “XOR(2)”.
– 89: The lower input to the XOR is operand “DIG ELEM 1 PKP”.
– 88: The upper input to the XOR is operand “Virt Ip 1 On".
– 87: The input just below the upper input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 2 On".
– 86: The upper input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 1 On".
– 85: The last parameter is used to set the latch, and is operand “Virt Op 4 On".
The equation for virtual output 4 is:
[85] Virt Op 4 On
[86] Virt Op 1 On
[87] Virt Op 2 On
[88] Virt Ip 1 On
[89] DIG ELEM 1 PKP
[90] XOR(2)
[91] Virt Op 3 On
[92] OR(4)
[93] LATCH (S,R)
[94] Virt Op 3 On
[95] TIMER 1
[96] Cont Ip H1c On

5-222 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

[97] OR(3)
[98] TIMER 2
[99] = Virt Op 4
Now check that the selection of parameters produce the required logic by converting the set of parameters into a
logic diagram. The result is shown in the figure, which is compared to the logic for virtual output 4 diagram as a check.
Figure 5-118: FlexLogic equation for virtual output 4
FlexLogic entry:
85 Virt Op 4 On (VO4)
FlexLogic entry:
86 Virt Op 1 On (VO1)
FlexLogic entry:
87 Virt Op 2 On (VO2)
FlexLogic entry: Set
88 Latch
Virt Ip 1 On (VI1)
XOR OR Reset
FlexLogic entry:
89 Dig Element 1 (DE1) PKP
FlexLogic entry:
90 XOR (2 Input)
FlexLogic entry:
91 Virt Op 3 On (VO3)
OR T2 Virtual output 4
FlexLogic entry:
92 OR (4 Input)
FlexLogic entry:
93 Latch (Set, Reset)
FlexLogic entry:
94 Virt Op 3 On (VO3) T1
FlexLogic entry:
95 Timer 1
FlexLogic entry:
96

5
Cont Ip 2 On (H1c)
FlexLogic entry:
97 OR (3 Input)
FlexLogic entry:
98 Timer 2
FlexLogic entry:
99 =Virt Op 4 (VO4) 827031A2.CDR

7. Now write the complete FlexLogic expression required to implement the logic, making an effort to assemble the
equation in an order where Virtual Outputs that are used as inputs to operators are created before needed. In cases
where a lot of processing is required to perform logic, this can be difficult to achieve, but in most cases does not cause
problems as all logic is calculated at least four times per power frequency cycle. The possibility of a problem caused by
sequential processing emphasizes the necessity to test the performance of FlexLogic before it is placed in service.
In the following equation, virtual output 3 is used as an input to both latch 1 and timer 1 as arranged in the following
order:
DIG ELEM 2 OP
Cont Ip H1c On
NOT
AND(2)
= Virt Op 3
Virt Op 4 On
Virt Op 1 On
Virt Op 2 On
Virt Ip 1 On
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
XOR(2)
Virt Op 3 On
OR(4)
LATCH (S,R)
Virt Op 3 On
TIMER 1
Cont Ip H1c On
OR(3)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-223


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

TIMER 2
= Virt Op 4
END
In this expression, the virtual output 4 input to the four-input OR is listed before it is created. This is typical of a form of
feedback, in this case, used to create a seal-in effect with the latch, and is correct.
8. Always test the logic after it is loaded into the relay, in the same way as has been used in the past. Testing can be
simplified by placing an "END" operator within the overall set of FlexLogic equations. The equations are evaluated up
to the first "END" operator.
The "On" and "Off" operands can be placed in an equation to establish a known set of conditions for test purposes, and
the "INSERT" and "DELETE" commands can be used to modify equations.

5.6.5 FlexLogic equation editor


SETTINGS  FLEXLOGIC  FLEXLOGIC EQUATION EDITOR
 FLEXLOGIC FLEXLOGIC ENTRY 1: Range: FlexLogic operands
 EQUATION EDITOR  END

FLEXLOGIC ENTRY 1024: Range: FlexLogic operands
 END

There are 1,024 FlexLogic entries available, numbered from 1 to 1024, with default END entry settings. If a "Disabled"
element is selected as a FlexLogic entry, the associated state flag is never set to ‘1’. Press the +/– key when editing
FlexLogic equations to quickly scan through the major parameter types.

5 5.6.6 FlexLogic timers


SETTINGS  FLEXLOGIC  FLEXLOGIC TIMERS  FLEXLOGIC TIMER 1(32)
 FLEXLOGIC TIMER 1 Range: millisecond, second, minute
 TIMER 1  TYPE: millisecond

TIMER 1 PICKUP Range: 0 to 60000 in steps of 1


 DELAY: 0

TIMER 1 DROPOUT Range: 0 to 60000 in steps of 1


 DELAY: 0

There are 32 identical FlexLogic timers available. These timers are used as operators for FlexLogic equations.
TIMER 1 TYPE — Selects the time measurement unit.
TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY — Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set this function to "0."
TIMER 1 DROPOUT DELAY — Sets the time delay to dropout. If a dropout delay is not required, set this function to "0."

5.6.7 FlexElements
SETTINGS  FLEXLOGIC  FLEXELEMENTS  FLEXELEMENT 1(16)
 FLEXELEMENT 1 FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

FLEXELEMENT 1 NAME: Range: up to six alphanumeric characters


 FxE 1

FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN: Range: Off, any analog actual value parameter


 Off

FLEXELEMENT 1 -IN: Range: Off, any analog actual value parameter


 Off

5-224 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT Range: SIGNED, ABSOLUTE


 MODE: SIGNED

FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP Range: LEVEL, DELTA


 MODE: LEVEL

FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: OVER, UNDER


 DIRECTION: OVER

FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: –90.000 to 90.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: 0.1 to 50.0% in steps of 0.1


 HYSTERESIS: 3.0%

FLEXELEMENT 1 dt Range: Milliseconds, Seconds, Minutes


 UNIT: Milliseconds

FLEXELEMENT 1 dt: Range: 20 to 86400 in steps of 1


 20

FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.000 s

FLEXELEMENT 1 RST Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.000 s

FLEXELEMENT 1 BLK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: Self-reset, Disabled, Latched


 TARGET: Self-reset

 FLEXELEMENT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
Range: Disabled, Enabled 5
A FlexElement is a universal comparator used to monitor any analog actual value calculated by the relay or a net
difference of any two analog actual values of the same type. The effective operating signal can be treated as a signed
number or its absolute value can be used.
FlexElements run every half power cycle (every four protection passes).
The element can be programmed to respond either to a signal level or to a rate-of-change (delta) over a pre-defined period
of time. The output operand is asserted when the operating signal is higher than a threshold or lower than a threshold, as
per your choice.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-225


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-119: FlexElement logic

SETTING
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1
FUNCTION: FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE:
Enabled = 1
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE:

FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION:
SETTING
FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP:
FLEXELEMENT 1 BLK:
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
AND HYSTERESIS:
Off = 0
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT: SETTINGS

SETTINGS FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP


FLEXELEMENT 1 dt: DELAY:
FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN: FLEXELEMENT 1 RST
RUN DELAY:
Actual Value FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
+ tPKP
FLEXELEMENT 1 -IN: FxE 1 OP
- tRST
Actual Value FxE 1 DPO

FxE 1 PKP

ACTUAL VALUE

FlexElement 1 OpSig

842004A4.CDR

5
FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN — This setting specifies the first (non-inverted) input to the FlexElement. Zero is assumed as the input if
this setting is set to “Off.” For proper operation of the element, at least one input must be selected. Otherwise, the element
does not assert its output operands.
FLEXELEMENT 1 –IN — Specifies the second (inverted) input to the FlexElement. Zero is assumed as the input if this setting is
set to “Off.” For proper operation of the element, at least one input must be selected. Otherwise, the element does not
assert its output operands. This input is used to invert the signal if needed for convenience, or to make the element
respond to a differential signal, such as for a top-bottom oil temperature differential alarm. The element does not operate
if the two input signals are of different types, for example if one tries to use active power and phase angle to build the
effective operating signal.
The element responds directly to the differential signal if the FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE setting is set to “Signed” The
element responds to the absolute value of the differential signal if this setting is set to “Absolute.” Sample applications for
the “Absolute” setting include monitoring the angular difference between two phasors with a symmetrical limit angle in
both directions, monitoring power regardless of its direction, or monitoring a trend.
The element responds directly to its operating signal—as defined by the FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN, FLEXELEMENT 1 –IN and
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE settings—if the FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE setting is set to “Level.” The element responds to the
rate of change of its operating signal if the FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE setting is set to “Delta.” In this case, the
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT and FLEXELEMENT 1 dt settings specify how the rate of change is derived.
FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION — Enables the relay to respond to either high or low values of the operating signal. The following
figure explains the application of the FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION, FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP, and FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS
settings.

5-226 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Figure 5-120: FlexElement direction, pickup, and hysteresis

FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP

FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over

HYSTERESIS = % of PICKUP

FlexElement 1 OpSig

PICKUP
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP

FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under

HYSTERESIS = % of PICKUP

FlexElement 1 OpSig
PICKUP
842705A1.CDR

In conjunction with the FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE setting, the element can be programmed to provide two extra
characteristics, as shown in the following figure.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-227


FLEXLOGIC CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-121: FlexElement input mode setting


FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP

FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Signed;

FlexElement 1 OpSig

FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP

FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Absolute;

FlexElement 1 OpSig

FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP

FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under;

5 FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Signed;

FlexElement 1 OpSig

FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP

FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Absolute;

FlexElement 1 OpSig
842706A2.CDR

FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the operating threshold for the effective operating signal of the element. If
set to “Over,” the element picks up when the operating signal exceeds the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value. If set to “Under,” the
element picks up when the operating signal falls below the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value.
FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS — This setting controls the element dropout. Notice that both the operating signal and the
pickup threshold can be negative, facilitating applications such as reverse power alarm protection. The FlexElement can be
programmed to work with all analog actual values measured by the relay. The FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP setting is entered in
per-unit values using the following definitions of the base units.
Table 5-25: FlexElement base units
Unit Description
BREAKER ACC ARCING AMPS BASE = 2000 kA2  cycle
(Brk X Acc Arc Amp A, B, and C)
BREAKER ARCING AMPS BASE = 1 kA2  cycle
(Brk X Arc Amp A, B, and C)

5-228 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC

Unit Description
DCmA BASE = maximum value of the DCMA INPUT MAX setting for the two transducers configured
under the +IN and –IN inputs
DELTA TIME BASE = 1 µs
FAULT LOCATION BASE = Line Length as specified in Fault Report
FREQUENCY fBASE = 1 Hz
PHASE ANGLE BASE = 360 degrees (see the UR angle referencing convention)
POWER FACTOR PFBASE = 1.00
RTDs BASE = 100°C
SOURCE CURRENT IBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
SOURCE ENERGY EBASE = 10000 MWh or MVAh, respectively
(Positive and Negative Watthours,
Positive and Negative Varhours)
SOURCE POWER PBASE = maximum value of VBASE  IBASE for the +IN and –IN inputs
SOURCE THD & HARMONICS BASE = 1%
SOURCE VOLTAGE VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs

FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS — This setting defines the pickup–dropout relation of the element by specifying the width of the
hysteresis loop as a percentage of the pickup value as shown in the FlexElement Direction, Pickup, and Hysteresis diagram.
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT — Specifies the time unit for the setting FLEXELEMENT 1 dt. This setting is applicable only if
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to “Delta.”
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt — Specifies duration of the time interval for the rate of change mode of operation. This setting is
applicable only if FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to “Delta.”
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP DELAY — Specifies the pickup delay of the element. 5
FLEXELEMENT 1 RST DELAY — Specifies the reset delay of the element.

5.6.8 Non-volatile latches


SETTINGS  FLEXLOGIC  NON-VOLATILE LATCHES  LATCH 1(16)
 LATCH 1 LATCH 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

LATCH 1 ID: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters


 NV Latch 1

LATCH 1 TYPE: Range: Reset Dominant, Set Dominant


 Reset Dominant

LATCH 1 SET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

LATCH 1 RESET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

LATCH 1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

LATCH 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The non-volatile latches provide a permanent logical flag that is stored safely and do not reset upon restart after the relay
is powered down. Typical applications include sustaining operator commands or permanently blocking relay functions,
such as Autorecloser, until a deliberate interface action resets the latch.
LATCH 1 TYPE — This setting characterizes Latch 1 to be Set- or Reset-dominant.
LATCH 1 SET — If asserted, the specified FlexLogic operands 'sets' Latch 1.
LATCH 1 RESET — If asserted, the specified FlexLogic operand 'resets' Latch 1.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-229


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-122: Non-volatile latch operation table (N = 1 to 16) and logic


SETTING SETTING

LATCH 1 FUNCTION: LATCH 1 TYPE:

Enabled=1 RUN

SETTING

LATCH 1 SET:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Off=0 SET LATCH 1 ON
LATCH 1 OFF
SETTING

LATCH 1 RESET:

Off=0 RESET 842005A3.CDR

Latch n type Latch n Latch n Latch n Latch n


set reset on off
Reset ON OFF ON OFF
Dominant
OFF OFF Previous Previous
State State
ON ON OFF ON
OFF ON OFF ON
Set ON OFF ON OFF
Dominant

5 ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
Previous
OFF
Previous
State State
OFF ON OFF ON

5.7 Grouped elements


5.7.1 Overview
Each protection element can be assigned up to six sets of settings with designations 1 to 6. The performance of these
elements is defined by the active setting group at a given time. Multiple setting groups allow the user to conveniently
change protection settings for different operating situations (for example, altered power system configuration or season of
the year). The active setting group can be preset or selected in the SETTING GROUPS menu (see the Control Elements section
later in this chapter). See also the Introduction to Elements section at the beginning of this chapter.

5.7.2 Setting group 1


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)
 SETTING GROUP 1  PHASE CURRENT See below
  

 NEUTRAL CURRENT See page 5-240


 

 WATTMETRIC See page 5-243


  GROUND FAULT

 GROUND CURRENT See page 5-247


 

5-230 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE See page 5-250


  CURRENT

 VOLTAGE ELEMENTS See page 5-252


 

Each of the six setting group menus is identical. Setting group 1 (the default active group) is active automatically when no
other group is active.
If the device incorrectly switches to group 1 after power cycling, upgrade the firmware to version 7.31 or later to correct
this issue.

5.7.3 Phase current


5.7.3.1 Menu
SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  PHASE CURRENT
 PHASE CURRENT  PHASE TOC 1 See page 5-236
  

 PHASE TOC 6
 

 PHASE IOC 1 See page 5-239


 

  PHASE IOC 12

5
5.7.3.2 Inverse TOC curve characteristics
The inverse time overcurrent curves used by the time overcurrent elements are the IEEE, IEC, GE Type IAC, and I2t standard
curve shapes. This allows for simplified coordination with downstream devices.
If none of these curve shapes is adequate, FlexCurves can be used to customize the inverse time curve characteristics. The
definite time curve is also an option that can be appropriate if only simple protection is required.
Table 5-26: Overcurrent curve types
IEEE IEC GE type IAC Other
IEEE Extremely Inverse IEC Curve A (BS142) IAC Extremely Inverse I2t
IEEE Very Inverse IEC Curve B (BS142) IAC Very Inverse FlexCurves A, B, C, and D
IEEE Moderately Inverse IEC Curve C (BS142) IAC Inverse Recloser Curves
IEC Short Inverse IAC Short Inverse Definite Time

A time dial multiplier setting allows selection of a multiple of the base curve shape (where the time dial multiplier = 1) with
the curve shape (CURVE) setting. Unlike the electromechanical time dial equivalent, operate times are directly proportional
to the time multiplier (TD MULTIPLIER) setting value. For example, all times for a multiplier of 10 are 10 times the multiplier 1
or base curve values. Setting the multiplier to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
Time overcurrent time calculations are made with an internal energy capacity memory variable. When this variable
indicates that the energy capacity has reached 100%, a time overcurrent element operates. If less than 100% energy
capacity is accumulated in this variable and the current falls below the dropout threshold of 97 to 98% of the pickup value,
the variable must be reduced. Two methods of this resetting operation are available: “Instantaneous” and “Timed.” The
“Instantaneous” selection is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static relays, which set the energy
capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” selection can be used where the
relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-231


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

IEEE curves
The IEEE time overcurrent curve shapes conform to industry standards and the IEEE C37.112-1996 curve classifications for
extremely, very, and moderately inverse curves. The IEEE curves are derived from the operate and reset time equations.

Eq. 5-8

where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A, B, p = constants defined in the table
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
tr = characteristic constant defined in the table
Table 5-27: IEEE inverse time curve constants
IEEE curve shape A B p tr
IEEE Extremely Inverse 28.2 0.1217 2.0000 29.1
IEEE Very Inverse 19.61 0.491 2.0000 21.6
IEEE Moderately Inverse 0.0515 0.1140 0.02000 4.85

5 Table 5-28: IEEE curve trip times (in seconds)


Multiplier Current ( I / Ipickup)
(TDM)
1.5 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
IEEE Extremely Inverse
0.5 11.341 4.761 1.823 1.001 0.648 0.464 0.355 0.285 0.237 0.203
1.0 22.682 9.522 3.647 2.002 1.297 0.927 0.709 0.569 0.474 0.407
2.0 45.363 19.043 7.293 4.003 2.593 1.855 1.418 1.139 0.948 0.813
4.0 90.727 38.087 14.587 8.007 5.187 3.710 2.837 2.277 1.897 1.626
6.0 136.090 57.130 21.880 12.010 7.780 5.564 4.255 3.416 2.845 2.439
8.0 181.454 76.174 29.174 16.014 10.374 7.419 5.674 4.555 3.794 3.252
10.0 226.817 95.217 36.467 20.017 12.967 9.274 7.092 5.693 4.742 4.065
IEEE Very Inverse
0.5 8.090 3.514 1.471 0.899 0.654 0.526 0.450 0.401 0.368 0.345
1.0 16.179 7.028 2.942 1.798 1.308 1.051 0.900 0.802 0.736 0.689
2.0 32.358 14.055 5.885 3.597 2.616 2.103 1.799 1.605 1.472 1.378
4.0 64.716 28.111 11.769 7.193 5.232 4.205 3.598 3.209 2.945 2.756
6.0 97.074 42.166 17.654 10.790 7.849 6.308 5.397 4.814 4.417 4.134
8.0 129.432 56.221 23.538 14.387 10.465 8.410 7.196 6.418 5.889 5.513
10.0 161.790 70.277 29.423 17.983 13.081 10.513 8.995 8.023 7.361 6.891
IEEE Moderately Inverse
0.5 3.220 1.902 1.216 0.973 0.844 0.763 0.706 0.663 0.630 0.603
1.0 6.439 3.803 2.432 1.946 1.688 1.526 1.412 1.327 1.260 1.207
2.0 12.878 7.606 4.864 3.892 3.377 3.051 2.823 2.653 2.521 2.414
4.0 25.756 15.213 9.729 7.783 6.753 6.102 5.647 5.307 5.041 4.827
6.0 38.634 22.819 14.593 11.675 10.130 9.153 8.470 7.960 7.562 7.241
8.0 51.512 30.426 19.458 15.567 13.507 12.204 11.294 10.614 10.083 9.654

5-232 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

Multiplier Current ( I / Ipickup)


(TDM)
1.5 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
10.0 64.390 38.032 24.322 19.458 16.883 15.255 14.117 13.267 12.604 12.068

IEC curves
For European applications, the relay offers three standard curves defined in IEC 255-4 and British standard BS142. These
are defined as IEC Curve A, IEC Curve B, and IEC Curve C. The IEC curves are derived by the operate and reset time
equations.

Eq. 5-9

where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
K, E = constants defined in the table
tr = characteristic constant defined in the table
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
Table 5-29: IEC (BS) inverse time curve constants
IEC (BS) curve shape K E tr
IEC Curve A (BS142) 0.140 0.020 9.7 5
IEC Curve B (BS142) 13.500 1.000 43.2
IEC Curve C (BS142) 80.000 2.000 58.2
IEC Short Inverse 0.050 0.040 0.500

Table 5-30: IEC curve trip times (in seconds)


Multiplier Current ( I / Ipickup)
(TDM)
1.5 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
IEC Curve A
0.05 0.860 0.501 0.315 0.249 0.214 0.192 0.176 0.165 0.156 0.149
0.10 1.719 1.003 0.630 0.498 0.428 0.384 0.353 0.330 0.312 0.297
0.20 3.439 2.006 1.260 0.996 0.856 0.767 0.706 0.659 0.623 0.594
0.40 6.878 4.012 2.521 1.992 1.712 1.535 1.411 1.319 1.247 1.188
0.60 10.317 6.017 3.781 2.988 2.568 2.302 2.117 1.978 1.870 1.782
0.80 13.755 8.023 5.042 3.984 3.424 3.070 2.822 2.637 2.493 2.376
1.00 17.194 10.029 6.302 4.980 4.280 3.837 3.528 3.297 3.116 2.971
IEC Curve B
0.05 1.350 0.675 0.338 0.225 0.169 0.135 0.113 0.096 0.084 0.075
0.10 2.700 1.350 0.675 0.450 0.338 0.270 0.225 0.193 0.169 0.150
0.20 5.400 2.700 1.350 0.900 0.675 0.540 0.450 0.386 0.338 0.300
0.40 10.800 5.400 2.700 1.800 1.350 1.080 0.900 0.771 0.675 0.600
0.60 16.200 8.100 4.050 2.700 2.025 1.620 1.350 1.157 1.013 0.900
0.80 21.600 10.800 5.400 3.600 2.700 2.160 1.800 1.543 1.350 1.200
1.00 27.000 13.500 6.750 4.500 3.375 2.700 2.250 1.929 1.688 1.500
IEC Curve C
0.05 3.200 1.333 0.500 0.267 0.167 0.114 0.083 0.063 0.050 0.040

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-233


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Multiplier Current ( I / Ipickup)


(TDM)
1.5 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
0.10 6.400 2.667 1.000 0.533 0.333 0.229 0.167 0.127 0.100 0.081
0.20 12.800 5.333 2.000 1.067 0.667 0.457 0.333 0.254 0.200 0.162
0.40 25.600 10.667 4.000 2.133 1.333 0.914 0.667 0.508 0.400 0.323
0.60 38.400 16.000 6.000 3.200 2.000 1.371 1.000 0.762 0.600 0.485
0.80 51.200 21.333 8.000 4.267 2.667 1.829 1.333 1.016 0.800 0.646
1.00 64.000 26.667 10.000 5.333 3.333 2.286 1.667 1.270 1.000 0.808
IEC Short Inverse
0.05 0.153 0.089 0.056 0.044 0.038 0.034 0.031 0.029 0.027 0.026
0.10 0.306 0.178 0.111 0.088 0.075 0.067 0.062 0.058 0.054 0.052
0.20 0.612 0.356 0.223 0.175 0.150 0.135 0.124 0.115 0.109 0.104
0.40 1.223 0.711 0.445 0.351 0.301 0.269 0.247 0.231 0.218 0.207
0.60 1.835 1.067 0.668 0.526 0.451 0.404 0.371 0.346 0.327 0.311
0.80 2.446 1.423 0.890 0.702 0.602 0.538 0.494 0.461 0.435 0.415
1.00 3.058 1.778 1.113 0.877 0.752 0.673 0.618 0.576 0.544 0.518

IAC curves
The curves for the General Electric type IAC relay family are derived from the formulae:

Eq. 5-10
5
where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input current
Ipkp = Pickup Current setting
A to E = constants defined in the table
tr = characteristic constant defined in the table
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
Table 5-31: GE type IAC inverse time curve constants
IAC curve shape A B C D E tr
IAC Extreme Inverse 0.0040 0.6379 0.6200 1.7872 0.2461 6.008
IAC Very Inverse 0.0900 0.7955 0.1000 –1.2885 7.9586 4.678
IAC Inverse 0.2078 0.8630 0.8000 –0.4180 0.1947 0.990
IAC Short Inverse 0.0428 0.0609 0.6200 –0.0010 0.0221 0.222

Table 5-32: GE type IAC curve trip times


Multiplier Current ( I / Ipickup)
(TDM)
1.5 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
IAC Extremely Inverse
0.5 1.699 0.749 0.303 0.178 0.123 0.093 0.074 0.062 0.053 0.046
1.0 3.398 1.498 0.606 0.356 0.246 0.186 0.149 0.124 0.106 0.093
2.0 6.796 2.997 1.212 0.711 0.491 0.372 0.298 0.248 0.212 0.185
4.0 13.591 5.993 2.423 1.422 0.983 0.744 0.595 0.495 0.424 0.370
6.0 20.387 8.990 3.635 2.133 1.474 1.115 0.893 0.743 0.636 0.556

5-234 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

Multiplier Current ( I / Ipickup)


(TDM)
1.5 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
8.0 27.183 11.987 4.846 2.844 1.966 1.487 1.191 0.991 0.848 0.741
10.0 33.979 14.983 6.058 3.555 2.457 1.859 1.488 1.239 1.060 0.926
IAC Very Inverse
0.5 1.451 0.656 0.269 0.172 0.133 0.113 0.101 0.093 0.087 0.083
1.0 2.901 1.312 0.537 0.343 0.266 0.227 0.202 0.186 0.174 0.165
2.0 5.802 2.624 1.075 0.687 0.533 0.453 0.405 0.372 0.349 0.331
4.0 11.605 5.248 2.150 1.374 1.065 0.906 0.810 0.745 0.698 0.662
6.0 17.407 7.872 3.225 2.061 1.598 1.359 1.215 1.117 1.046 0.992
8.0 23.209 10.497 4.299 2.747 2.131 1.813 1.620 1.490 1.395 1.323
10.0 29.012 13.121 5.374 3.434 2.663 2.266 2.025 1.862 1.744 1.654
IAC Inverse
0.5 0.578 0.375 0.266 0.221 0.196 0.180 0.168 0.160 0.154 0.148
1.0 1.155 0.749 0.532 0.443 0.392 0.360 0.337 0.320 0.307 0.297
2.0 2.310 1.499 1.064 0.885 0.784 0.719 0.674 0.640 0.614 0.594
4.0 4.621 2.997 2.128 1.770 1.569 1.439 1.348 1.280 1.229 1.188
6.0 6.931 4.496 3.192 2.656 2.353 2.158 2.022 1.921 1.843 1.781
8.0 9.242 5.995 4.256 3.541 3.138 2.878 2.695 2.561 2.457 2.375
10.0 11.552 7.494 5.320 4.426 3.922 3.597 3.369 3.201 3.072 2.969
IAC Short Inverse
0.5
1.0
0.072
0.143
0.047
0.095
0.035
0.070
0.031
0.061
0.028
0.057
0.027
0.054
0.026
0.052
0.026
0.051
0.025
0.050
0.025
0.049
5
2.0 0.286 0.190 0.140 0.123 0.114 0.108 0.105 0.102 0.100 0.099
4.0 0.573 0.379 0.279 0.245 0.228 0.217 0.210 0.204 0.200 0.197
6.0 0.859 0.569 0.419 0.368 0.341 0.325 0.314 0.307 0.301 0.296
8.0 1.145 0.759 0.559 0.490 0.455 0.434 0.419 0.409 0.401 0.394
10.0 1.431 0.948 0.699 0.613 0.569 0.542 0.524 0.511 0.501 0.493

I2t curves
The I2t curves are derived as follows:

Eq. 5-11

where
T = Operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)

Table 5-33: I2t curve trip times


Multiplier Current ( I / Ipickup)
(TDM)
1.5 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
0.01 0.44 0.25 0.11 0.06 0.04 0.03 0.02 0.02 0.01 0.01
0.10 4.44 2.50 1.11 0.63 0.40 0.28 0.20 0.16 0.12 0.10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-235


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Multiplier Current ( I / Ipickup)


(TDM)
1.5 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
1.00 44.44 25.00 11.11 6.25 4.00 2.78 2.04 1.56 1.23 1.00
10.00 444.44 250.00 111.11 62.50 40.00 27.78 20.41 15.63 12.35 10.00
100.00 4444.4 2500.0 1111.1 625.00 400.00 277.78 204.08 156.25 123.46 100.00
600.00 26666.7 15000.0 6666.7 3750.0 2400.0 1666.7 1224.5 937.50 740.74 600.00

FlexCurves
FlexCurves are described in the FlexCurves section later in this chapter. The curve shapes for the FlexCurves are derived
from the formulae:

Eq. 5-12

Eq. 5-13

where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input Current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = Reset Time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)
5
Definite time curve
The Definite Time curve shape operates as soon as the pickup level is exceeded for a specified period of time. The base
definite time curve delay is in seconds. The curve multiplier of 0.00 to 600.00 makes this delay adjustable from
instantaneous to 600.00 seconds in steps of 10 ms. The definite time curve shapes are defined as follows:

Eq. 5-14

Eq. 5-15

where
T = Operate Time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input Current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = Reset Time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)

Recloser curves
The F35 uses the FlexCurve feature to facilitate programming of 41 recloser curves. See the FlexCurves settings section
earlier in this chapter for details.

5.7.3.3 Phase time overcurrent (ANSI 51P, IEC PTOC)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  PHASE CURRENT  PHASE TOC1(6)
 PHASE TOC 1 PHASE TOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

5-236 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

PHASE TOC1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

PHASE TOC1 Range: Phasor, RMS


 INPUT: Phasor

PHASE TOC1 Range: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

PHASE TOC1 Range: see Overcurrent Curve Types table


 CURVE: IEEE Mod Inv

PHASE TOC1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01


 TD MULTIPLIER: 1.00

PHASE TOC1 Range: Instantaneous, Timed


 RESET: Instantaneous

PHASE TOC1 VOLTAGE Range: Disabled, Enabled


 RESTRAINT: Disabled

PHASE TOC1 BLOCK A: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PHASE TOC1 BLOCK B: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PHASE TOC1 BLOCK C: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PHASE TOC1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

 PHASE TOC1
EVENTS: Disabled
Range: Disabled, Enabled 5
The phase time overcurrent element can provide a specified time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current
or be used as a simple definite time element. The phase current input quantities can be programmed as fundamental
phasor magnitude or total waveform RMS magnitude as required by the application.
Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (see the Inverse TOC Curve Characteristics
section earlier for details on curve setup, trip times, and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time
accumulator resets according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to
“Instantaneous” and the element is blocked, the time accumulator clears immediately.
The PHASE TOC1 PICKUP setting can be reduced dynamically by a voltage restraint feature (when enabled). This is
accomplished via the multipliers (Mvr) corresponding to the phase-phase voltages of the voltage restraint characteristic
curve (see the figure); the pickup level is calculated as Mvr times the PHASE TOC1 PICKUP setting. If the voltage restraint
feature is disabled, the pickup level always remains at the setting value.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-237


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-123: Phase time overcurrent voltage restraint characteristic

Multiplier for Pickup Current


1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1

0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Phase-Phase Voltage ÷ VT Nominal Phase-phase Voltage
VOLTAGE RESTRAINT CHARACTERISTIC FOR PHASE TIME O/C
818784A4.CDR

FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the phase time overcurrent protection element.
SIGNAL SOURCE — Selects the signal source for the phase time overcurrent protection element.
INPUT — Selects how phase current input quantities are interpreted by the F35. Inputs can be selected as fundamental
phasor magnitudes or total waveform RMS magnitudes as required by the application.
PICKUP — Specifies the phase time overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.

5 CURVE — Selects the time inverse overcurrent curve style.


TD MULTIPLIER — Specifies a multiple of the base curve shape specified by the CURVE setting. Programming this value to
zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
RESET — The “Instantaneous” reset method is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static relays, which
set the energy capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” reset method can be
used where the relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.
VOLTAGE RESTRAINT — Enables and disables the phase time overcurrent voltage restraint feature.
BLOCK A — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks phase A of the phase time overcurrent element.
EVENTS — Enables and disables the logging of phase time overcurrent events in the sequence of events recorder.

5-238 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

Figure 5-124: Phase time overcurrent 1 logic


SETTING
PHASE TOC1
FUNCTION:
Enabled=1

SETTING
PHASE TOC1
BLOCK-A :
Off=0

SETTING
PHASE TOC1
BLOCK-B:
Off=0
SETTING
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
PHASE TOC1 INPUT:
BLOCK-C:
PHASE TOC1
Off=0 PICKUP:
PHASE TOC1
SETTING CURVE:
PHASE TOC1 PHASE TOC1
SOURCE: TD MULTIPLIER:
IA
PHASE TOC1
IB RESET: FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
IC AND RUN PHASE TOC1 A PKP
IA PICKUP
Seq=ABC Seq=ACB PHASE TOC1 A DPO
MULTIPLY INPUTS
RUN
t PHASE TOC1 A OP
VAB VAC Set
Calculate Multiplier Set Pickup AND RUN PHASE TOC1 B PKP
RUN
Multiplier-Phase A IB PICKUP
Set PHASE TOC1 B DPO
VBC VBA Set Pickup
Calculate Multiplier t PHASE TOC1 B OP
RUN
Multiplier-Phase B
Set AND RUN PHASE TOC1 C PKP
VCA VCB IC PICKUP
Calculate Multiplier Set Pickup PHASE TOC1 C DPO
Multiplier-Phase C
t PHASE TOC1 C OP
SETTING OR PHASE TOC1 PKP
PHASE TOC1 VOLT
RESTRAINT:

5
OR PHASE TOC1 OP
Enabled

AND PHASE TOC1 DPO

827072A5.CDR

5.7.3.4 Phase instantaneous overcurrent (ANSI 50P, IEC PIOC)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  PHASE CURRENT  PHASE IOC 1(12)
 PHASE IOC 1 PHASE IOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

PHASE IOC1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

PHASE IOC1 Range: 0.005 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

PHASE IOC1 PICKUP Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

PHASE IOC1 RESET Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

PHASE IOC1 BLOCK A: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PHASE IOC1 BLOCK C: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

PHASE IOC1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

PHASE IOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-239


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

The phase instantaneous overcurrent element can be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a
definite time element. The input current is the fundamental phasor magnitude. For timing curves, see the publication
Instantaneous Overcurrent (IOC) Element Response to Saturated Waveforms in UR Series Relays (GET-8400A).
FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the phase instantaneous overcurrent protection element.
SOURCE — Selects the signal source for the phase instantaneous overcurrent protection element.
PICKUP — Specifies the phase instantaneous overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.
DELAY —Delays the assertion of the PHASE IOC OP operands. It is used to achieve timing coordination with other elements
and relays.
RESET DELAY — Specifies a delay for the reset of the phase instantaneous overcurrent element between the operate output
state and the return to logic 0 after the input passes outside the defined pickup range. This setting is used to ensure that
the relay output contacts are closed long enough to ensure reception by downstream equipment.
BLOCK A — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting block’s phase A of the phase instantaneous overcurrent
element.
EVENTS — Enables and disables the logging of phase instantaneous overcurrent events in the sequence of events recorder.

Figure 5-125: Phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 logic

SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS


SETTING
SETTING Pickup Delay PHASE IOC1 A PKP
Function
Pickup Reset Delay PHASE IOC1 A DPO
AND RUN TPKP PHASE IOC1 B PKP
1 = Enabled
IA > Pickup PHASE IOC1 B DPO
TRST PHASE IOC1 C PKP
AND RUN TPKP PHASE IOC1 C DPO
SETTING
Source IB > Pickup
TRST

5
= IA FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND RUN TPKP
= IB PHASE IOC1 A OP
IC > Pickup PHASE IOC1 B OP
= IC TRST
PHASE IOC1 C OP

SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


Block A OR PHASE IOC1 PKP
= Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Block B
OR PHASE IOC1 OP
= Off
Block C FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
= Off AND PHASE IOC1 DPO
827033A8.CDR

5.7.4 Neutral current

5.7.4.1 Menu
SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  NEUTRAL CURRENT
 NEUTRAL CURRENT  NEUTRAL TOC 1 See below
  

 NEUTRAL TOC 6
 

 NEUTRAL IOC 1 See page 5-242


 

 NEUTRAL IOC 12
 

5-240 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

5.7.4.2 Neutral time overcurrent (ANSI 51N, IEC PTOC)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  NEUTRAL CURRENT  NEUTRAL TOC1(6)
 NEUTRAL TOC1 NEUTRAL TOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

NEUTRAL TOC1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

NEUTRAL TOC1 Range: Phasor, RMS


 INPUT: Phasor

NEUTRAL TOC1 Range: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

NEUTRAL TOC1 Range: see Overcurrent Curve Types table


 CURVE: IEEE Mod Inv

NEUTRAL TOC1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01


 TD MULTIPLIER: 1.00

NEUTRAL TOC1 Range: Instantaneous, Timed


 RESET: Instantaneous

NEUTRAL TOC1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

NEUTRAL TOC1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

NEUTRAL TOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The neutral time overcurrent element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current
5
or be used as a simple definite time element. The neutral current input value is a quantity calculated as 3Io from the phase
currents and can be programmed as fundamental phasor magnitude or total waveform RMS magnitude as required by the
application.
Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (see the Inverse TOC Curve Characteristics
section for details on curve setup, trip times, and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator
resets according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to “Instantaneous” and
the element is blocked, the time accumulator clears immediately.
NEUTRAL TOC1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the neutral time overcurrent protection element.
NEUTRAL TOC1 SIGNAL SOURCE — This setting selects the signal source for the neutral time overcurrent protection element.
NEUTRAL TOC1 INPUT — This setting selects how neutral current input quantities are interpreted by the F35. Inputs can be
selected as fundamental phasor magnitudes or total waveform RMS magnitudes as required by the application.
NEUTRAL TOC1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the neutral time overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.
NEUTRAL TOC1 CURVE — This setting selects the inverse time overcurrent curve style.
NEUTRAL TOC1 TD MULTIPLIER — This setting specifies a multiple of the base curve shape specified by the CURVE setting.
Programming this value to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
NEUTRAL TOC1 RESET — The “Instantaneous” reset method is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static
relays, which set the energy capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” reset
method can be used where the relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.
NEUTRAL TOC1 BLOCK — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks operation of the neutral time overcurrent
element.
NEUTRAL TOC1 EVENTS — This setting enables and disables the logging of neutral time overcurrent events in the sequence
of events recorder.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-241


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-126: Neutral time overcurrent 1 logic

SETTINGS
NEUTRAL TOC1
INPUT:
SETTING NEUTRAL TOC1
NEUTRAL TOC1 PICKUP:
FUNCTION: NEUTRAL TOC1
Enabled = 1 CURVE:
NEUTRAL TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
NEUTRAL TOC 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
RESET: NEUTRAL TOC1 PKP
NEUTRAL TOC1
AND RUN IN PICKUP NEUTRAL TOC1 DPO
SOURCE:
NEUTRAL TOC1 OP
IN t
I
SETTING
NEUTRAL TOC1
BLOCK:
Off = 0 827034A4.VSD

5.7.4.3 Neutral instantaneous overcurrent (ANSI 50N, IEC PIOC)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  NEUTRAL CURRENT  NEUTRAL IOC1(12)
 NEUTRAL IOC1 NEUTRAL IOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

NEUTRAL IOC1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

NEUTRAL IOC1 Range: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


5  PICKUP: 1.000 pu

NEUTRAL IOC1 PICKUP Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

NEUTRAL IOC1 RESET Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

NEUTRAL IOC1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

NEUTRAL IOC1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

NEUTRAL IOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The neutral instantaneous overcurrent element can be used as an instantaneous function with no intentional delay or as a
definite time function. The element essentially responds to the magnitude of a neutral current fundamental frequency
phasor calculated from the phase currents. A positive-sequence restraint is applied for better performance. A small portion
(6.25%) of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the zero-sequence current magnitude when
forming the operating quantity of the element as follows:
Iop = 3 x (|I_0| - K x |I_1|) where K = 1/16 Eq. 5-16
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from:
• System unbalances under heavy load conditions
• Transformation errors of current transformers (CTs) during double-line and three-phase faults
• Switch-off transients during double-line and three-phase faults

5-242 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on how test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection):

Eq. 5-17

NEUTRAL IOC1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the neutral instantaneous overcurrent protection element.
NEUTRAL IOC1 SIGNAL SOURCE — This setting selects the signal source for the neutral instantaneous overcurrent protection
element.
NEUTRAL IOC1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the neutral instantaneous overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.
NEUTRAL IOC1 PICKUP DELAY — This setting delays the assertion of the NEUTRAL IOC OP operands. It is used to achieve timing
coordination with other elements and relays.
NEUTRAL IOC1 RESET DELAY — This setting specifies a delay for the reset of the neutral instantaneous overcurrent element
between the operate output state and the return to logic 0 after the input passes outside the defined pickup range. This
setting is used to ensure that the relay output contacts are closed long enough to ensure reception by downstream
equipment.a
NEUTRAL IOC1 BLOCK — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks operation of the neutral instantaneous
overcurrent element.
NEUTRAL IOC1 EVENTS — This setting enables and disables the logging of neutral instantaneous overcurrent events in the
sequence of events recorder.
Figure 5-127: Neutral IOC1 logic

SETTING
SETTINGS
NEUTRAL IOC1 FUNCTION:

Enabled=1
SETTING
NEUTRAL IOC1
PICKUP DELAY :
5
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEUTRAL IOC1
NEUTRAL IOC1 PICKUP: NEUTRAL IOC1 PKP
RESET DELAY :
SETTING NEUTRAL IOC1 DPO
AND RUN tPKP
tRST NEUTRAL IOC1 OP
NEUTRAL IOC1 BLOCK: 3( I_0 - K I_1 ) PICKUP

Off=0

SETTING

NEUTRAL IOC1 SOURCE:

I_0
827035A5.CDR

5.7.5 Wattmetric ground fault

5.7.5.1 Wattmetric zero-sequence directional (ANSI 32N, IEC PSDE)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  WATTMETRIC...  WATTMETRIC GROUND FAULT 1(5)
 WATTMETRIC WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
 GROUND FAULT 1  FUNCTION: Disabled

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: Calculated VN, Measured VX


 VOLT: Calculated VN

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: 0.02 to 3.00 pu in steps of 0.01


 OV PKP: 0.20 pu

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: Calculated IN, Measured IG


 CURR: Calculated IN

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-243


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: 0.002 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 OC PKP: 0.060 pu

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 OC PKP DEL: 0.20 s

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: 0.001 to 1.200 pu in steps of 0.001


 PWR PKP: 0.100 pu

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: 0.001 to 1.200 pu in steps of 0.001


 REF PWR: 0.500 pu

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: 0 to 360° Lag in steps of 1


 ECA: 0° Lag

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 PWR PKP DEL: 0.20 s

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: Definite Time, Inverse, FlexCurves A through


 CURVE: Definite Time D

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: 0.01 to 2.00 s in steps of 0.01


 MULTIPLIER: 1.00 s

WATT GND FLT 1 BLK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled
5 The wattmetric zero-sequence directional element responds to power derived from zero-sequence voltage and current in
a direction specified by the element characteristic angle. The angle can be set within all four quadrants, and the power can
be active or reactive. Therefore, the element can be used to sense either forward or reverse ground faults in either
inductive, capacitive, or resistive networks. The inverse time characteristic allows time coordination of elements across the
network.
Typical applications include ground fault protection in solidly grounded transmission networks, grounded/ungrounded/
resistor-grounded/resonant-grounded distribution networks, or for directionalizing other non-directional ground elements.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 VOLT — The element uses neutral voltage (that is, three times the zero-sequence voltage). This
setting allows selecting between the internally calculated neutral voltage or the externally supplied voltage (broken delta
VT connected to the auxiliary channel bank of the relay). When the latter selection is made, the auxiliary channel must be
identified by the user as a neutral voltage under the VT bank settings. This element operates when the auxiliary voltage is
configured as neutral.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 OV PKP — This setting specifies the minimum zero sequence voltage supervising the directional
power measurement. Set this threshold higher than possible unbalance during normal operation of the system. Typically,
this setting is at 0.1 to 0.2 pu for the ungrounded or resonant grounded systems and at 0.05 to 0.1 pu for solidly or resistor-
grounded systems. When using externally supplied voltage via the auxiliary voltage channel, 1 pu is the nominal voltage of
this channel as per VT bank settings. When using internally calculated neutral voltage, 1 pu is the nominal phase to ground
voltage as per the VT bank settings.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 CURR — The element responds to the neutral current (that is, three times zero-sequence current),
either calculated internally from the phase currents or supplied externally via the ground CT input from more accurate
sources such as the core balanced CT. This setting allows selecting the source of the operating current.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 OC PKP — This setting specifies the current supervision level for the measurement of the zero-
sequence power.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 OC PKP DEL — This setting specifies delay for the overcurrent portion of this element. The delay
applies to the WATTMETRIC 1 PKP operand driven from the overcurrent condition.

5-244 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 PWR PKP — This setting specifies the operating point of the element. A value of 1 pu is a product of
the 1 pu voltage as specified for the overvoltage condition of this element, and 1 pu current as specified for the
overcurrent condition of this element.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 REF PWR — This setting is used to calculate the inverse time characteristic delay (defined by Sref in
the following equations). A value of 1 pu represents the product of a 1 pu voltage (as specified in the overvoltage condition
for this element) and a 1 pu current (as specified in the overcurrent condition for this element.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 ECA — This setting adjusts the maximum torque angle of the element. The operating power is
calculated as:
S_op = Re(Vn(In x 1ECA)*) Eq. 5-18
where
* indicates complex conjugate
By varying the element characteristic angle (ECA), the element can be made to respond to forward or reverse direction in
inductive, resistive, or capacitive networks as shown in the Wattmetric Characteristic Angle Response diagram.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 PWR PKP DEL — This setting defines a definite time delay before the inverse time characteristic is
activated. If the curve selection is set as “Definite Time”, the element operates after this security time delay. If the curve
selection is “Inverse” or one of the FlexCurves, the element uses both the definite and inverse time timers simultaneously.
The definite time timer, specified by this setting, is used and when expires it releases the inverse time timer for operation
(torque control).
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 CURVE — Choose one of three methods to delay the operate signal once all conditions are met to
discriminate fault direction.
The “Definite Time” selection allows for a fixed time delay defined by the WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 PWR PKP DEL setting.
The “Inverse” selection allows for inverse time characteristics delay defined by the following formula:
5
Eq. 5-19

where
m is a multiplier defined by the multiplier setting
Sref is the multiplier setting
Sop is the operating power at the time
This timer starts after the definite time timer expires.
The four FlexCurves allow for custom user-programmable time characteristics. When working with FlexCurves, the
element uses the operate to pickup ratio, and the multiplier setting is not applied:

Eq. 5-20

Again, the FlexCurve timer starts after the definite time timer expires.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-245


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-128: Wattmetric characteristic angle response


FORWARD FAULT REVERSE FAULT

ECA = 180 to 270° ECA = 0 to 90°

INDUCTIVE NETWORK
Vn Vn

In In
RESISTIVE NETWORK

ECA = 180° ECA = 0°

Vn Vn

In In

5
In In
CAPACITIIVE NETWORK

Vn Vn

ECA = 90 to 180° ECA = 270 to 360°

837804A1.CDR

WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 MULTIPLIER — This setting is applicable if the WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 CURVE is set to Inverse and
defines the multiplier factor for the inverse time delay.

5-246 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL



5.7.6.1 Menu
CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

 GROUND CURRENT
5.7.6 Ground current

 
SETTINGS SETTINGS
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1
SOURCE: PWR PICKUP:
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1
CURRENT: SETTING SETTINGS
OC PICKUP:
Calculated: Measured: WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1
Neutral, In Ground, Ig ECA: OV PICKUP: CURVE:
SETTING


WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1

 GROUND TOC1
VOLTAGE: S = V*conj (I*exp(-j*ECA)) SOP > PWR PICKUP WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 REF PWR:

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


Calculated: Measured: 1 PWR PKP DEL:
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1
Neutral, Vn Auxiliary, Vx MULTIPLIER:
VMAG > OV PICKUP
tPKP RUN
AND

IMAG > OC PICKUP 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


SREF
SETTINGS t = m× WATTMETRIC 1 OP
SOP
WATTMETRIC GND FLT SETTING
AND

1 FUNCTION:
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1
Enabled = 1
OC PKP DEL:
WATT GND FLT 1 BLK:

AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
tPKP WATTMETRIC 1 PKP
0

See below
837033A4.CDR

SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  GROUND CURRENT


Figure 5-129: Wattmetric zero-sequence directional logic

5-247
GROUPED ELEMENTS

5
GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

 GROUND TOC6
 

 GROUND IOC1 See page 5-249


 

 GROUND IOC12
 

5.7.6.2 Ground time overcurrent (ANSI 51G, IEC PTOC)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  GROUND CURRENT  GROUND TOC1(6)
 GROUND TOC1 GROUND TOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

GROUND TOC1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

GROUND TOC1 Range: Phasor, RMS


 INPUT: Phasor

GROUND TOC1 Range: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

GROUND TOC1 Range: see the Overcurrent Curve Types table


 CURVE: IEEE Mod Inv

GROUND TOC1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01


 TD MULTIPLIER: 1.00
5  GROUND TOC1
RESET: Instantaneous
Range: Instantaneous, Timed

GROUND TOC1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

GROUND TOC1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

GROUND TOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

This element can provide a required time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current or be used as a simple
definite time element. The ground current input value is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the
fundamental phasor or RMS magnitude. Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous”
(see the Inverse TOC Curve Characteristics section for details). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator resets
according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to “Instantaneous” and the
element is blocked, the time accumulator clears immediately.
GROUND TOC1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the ground time overcurrent protection element.
GROUND TOC1 SIGNAL SOURCE — This setting selects the signal source for the ground time overcurrent protection element.
GROUND TOC1 INPUT — This setting selects how ground current input quantities are interpreted by the F35. Inputs can be
selected as fundamental phasor magnitudes or total waveform RMS magnitudes as required by the application.
GROUND TOC1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the ground time overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.
GROUND TOC1 CURVE — This setting selects the inverse time overcurrent curve style.
GROUND TOC1 TD MULTIPLIER — This setting specifies a multiple of the base curve shape specified by the CURVE setting.
Programming this value to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
GROUND TOC1 RESET — The “Instantaneous” reset method is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static
relays, which set the energy capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” reset
method can be used where the relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.

5-248 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

GROUND TOC1 BLOCK — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks operation of the ground time overcurrent
element.
GROUND TOC1 EVENTS — This setting enables and disables the logging of ground time overcurrent events in the sequence
of events recorder.

These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. The conversion
range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46 times the CT rating.

This channel can be also equipped with a sensitive input. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is from 0.002
to 4.6 times the CT rating.

Figure 5-130: Ground TOC1 logic

SETTINGS
GROUND TOC1
INPUT:
SETTING GROUND TOC1
GROUND TOC1 PICKUP:
FUNCTION: GROUND TOC1
Enabled = 1 CURVE:
GROUND TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
GROUND TOC 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
RESET: GROUND TOC1 PKP
GROUND TOC1
AND RUN IG PICKUP GROUND TOC1 DPO
SOURCE:
GROUND TOC1 OP
IG t

SETTING
I
5
GROUND TOC1
BLOCK:
827036A4.VSD
Off = 0

5.7.6.3 Ground instantaneous overcurrent (ANSI 50G, IEC PIOC)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  GROUND CURRENT  GROUND IOC1(12)
 GROUND IOC1 GROUND IOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

GROUND IOC1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

GROUND IOC1 Range: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

GROUND IOC1 PICKUP Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

GROUND IOC1 RESET Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

GROUND IOC1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

GROUND IOC1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

GROUND IOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The ground instantaneous overcurrent element can be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a
definite time element. The ground current input is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the fundamental
phasor magnitude.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-249


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. The conversion
range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46 times the CT rating.

This channel can be equipped with a standard or sensitive input. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is
from 0.002 to 4.6 times the CT rating.

Figure 5-131: Ground IOC1 logic

FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
GROUND IOC1 PKP
SETTING GROUND IOIC DPO
GROUND IOC1
SETTINGS GROUND IOC1 OP
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1 GROUND IOC1 PICKUP
SETTING DELAY:
GROUND IOC1 GROUND IOC1 RESET
SETTING
PICKUP: DELAY:
GROUND IOC1
AND RUN tPKP
SOURCE:
IG
IG PICKUP tRST
SETTING
GROUND IOC1
BLOCK:
827037A5.VSD
Off = 0

5.7.7 Negative sequence current


5
5.7.7.1 Menu
SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  NEGATIVE SEQUENCE CURRENT
 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE  NEG SEQ TOC1 See below
 CURRENT  

 NEG SEQ TOC2


 

 NEG SEQ IOC1 See page 5-251


 

 NEG SEQ IOC2


 

For information on the negative sequence time overcurrent curves, see the Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves section
earlier.

5.7.7.2 Negative sequence time overcurrent (ANSI 51Q, IEC PTOC)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  NEGATIVE SEQUENCE CURRENT  NEG SEQ TOC1
 NEG SEQ TOC1 NEG SEQ TOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

NEG SEQ TOC1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

NEG SEQ TOC1 Range: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

NEG SEQ TOC1 Range: see Overcurrent Curve Types table


 CURVE: IEEE Mod Inv

5-250 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

NEG SEQ TOC1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01


 TD MULTIPLIER: 1.00

NEG SEQ TOC1 Range: Instantaneous, Timed


 RESET: Instantaneous

NEG SEQ TOC1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

NEG SEQ TOC1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

NEG SEQ TOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The negative-sequence time overcurrent element can be used to determine and clear unbalance in the system. The input
for calculating negative-sequence current is the fundamental phasor value.
Two methods of resetting operation are available; “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (see the Inverse TOC Curve Characteristics
section earlier for details on curve setup, trip times and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time
accumulator resets according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to
“Instantaneous” and the element is blocked, the time accumulator clears immediately.
Figure 5-132: Negative sequence TOC1 logic
SETTING

NEG SEQ TOC1 INPUT:

NEG SEQ TOC1 PICKUP:

SETTING

NEG SEQ TOC1 FUNCTION:


NEG SEQ TOC1 CURVE:
5
NEG SEQ TOC1 TD MULTIPLIER:
Enabled=1
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEG SEQ TOC1 RESET:
NEG SEQ TOC1 PKP
SETTING
AND RUN NEG SEQ < PICKUP NEG SEQ TOC1 DPO
NEG SEQ TOC1 BLOCK: NEG SEQ TOC1 OP

Off=0
t

SETTING

NEG SEQ TOC1 SOURCE:

Neg Seq 827057A5.CDR

5.7.7.3 Negative sequence instantaneous overcurrent (ANSI 50Q, IEC PIOC)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  NEGATIVE SEQUENCE CURRENT  NEG SEQ OC1
 NEG SEQ IOC1 NEG SEQ IOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

NEG SEQ IOC1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

NEG SEQ IOC1 Range: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

NEG SEQ IOC1 PICKUP Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

NEG SEQ IOC1 RESET Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

NEG SEQ IOC1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-251


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

NEG SEQ IOC1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

NEG SEQ IOC1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent element can be used as an instantaneous function with no intentional
delay or as a definite time function. The element responds to the negative-sequence current fundamental frequency
phasor magnitude (calculated from the phase currents) and applies a positive-sequence restraint for better performance:
a small portion (12.5%) of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the negative-sequence current
magnitude when forming the operating quantity.
Iop = |I_2| - K x |I_1| where K = 1/8 Eq. 5-21
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious negative-sequence
currents resulting from
• System unbalances under heavy load conditions
• Transformation errors of current transformers (CTs) during three-phase faults
• Fault inception and switch-off transients during three-phase faults
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on how the test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection:
Iop = 0.2917 x Iinjected; three-phase injection, opposite rotation: Iop = Iinjected).
Figure 5-133: Negative sequence IOC1 logic

SETTING
SETTING

5 NEG SEQ IOC1 FUNCTION:

Enabled=1
SETTING
NEG SEQ IOC1
PICKUP DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEG SEQ IOC1
NEG SEQ IOC1 PICKUP: NEG SEQ IOC1 PKP
RESET DELAY:
SETTING NEG SEQ IOC1 DPO
AND RUN tPKP
tRST NEG SEQ IOC1 OP
NEG SEQ IOC1 BLOCK: I_2 - K I_1 PICKUP

Off=0

SETTING

NEG SEQ IOC1 SOURCE:

I_2 827058A6.CDR

5.7.8 Voltage elements

5.7.8.1 Menu
SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
 VOLTAGE ELEMENTS  PHASE See below
   UNDERVOLTAGE1

 PHASE
  UNDERVOLTAGE3

 PHASE See page 5-255


  OVERVOLTAGE1

 PHASE
  OVERVOLTAGE3

5-252 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

 NEUTRAL OV1 See page 5-256


 

 NEUTRAL OV3
 

 AUXILIARY UV1 See page 5-257


 

 AUXILIARY UV3
 

 AUXILIARY OV1 See page 5-258


 

 AUXILIARY OV3
 

These protection elements can be used for a variety of applications, such as


• Undervoltage protection — For voltage sensitive loads, such as induction motors, a drop in voltage increases the
drawn current, which can cause dangerous overheating in the motor. The undervoltage protection feature can be
used to either cause a trip or generate an alarm when the voltage drops below a specified voltage setting for a
specified time delay.
• Permissive functions — The undervoltage feature can be used to block the functioning of external devices by
operating an output relay when the voltage falls below the specified voltage setting. The undervoltage feature can


also be used to block the functioning of other elements through the block feature of those elements.
Source transfer schemes — In the event of an undervoltage, a transfer signal can be generated to transfer a load
5
from its normal source to a standby or emergency power source.
The undervoltage elements can be programmed to have a definite time delay characteristic. The definite time curve
operates when the voltage drops below the pickup level for a specified period of time. The time delay is adjustable from 0
to 600.00 seconds in steps of 0.01. The undervoltage elements can also be programmed to have an inverse time delay
characteristic.
The undervoltage delay setting defines the family of curves shown as follows.

Eq. 5-22

where
T = operating time
D = undervoltage delay setting (D = 0.00 operates instantaneously)
V = secondary voltage applied to the relay
Vpickup = pickup level

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-253


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-134: Inverse time undervoltage curves

Time (seconds)

% of voltage pickup
842788A1.CDR

At 0% of pickup, the operating time equals the PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE DELAY setting.

5.7.8.2 Phase undervoltage (ANSI 27P, IEC PTUV)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  VOLTAGE ELEMENTS  PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE1(3)
 PHASE PHASE UV1 Range: Disabled, Enabled

5  UNDERVOLTAGE1 FUNCTION: Disabled

PHASE UV1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

PHASE UV1 MODE: Range: Phase to Ground, Phase to Phase


 Phase to Ground

PHASE UV1 Range: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

PHASE UV1 Range: Definite Time, Inverse Time


 CURVE: Definite Time

PHASE UV1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 1.00 s

PHASE UV1 MINIMUM Range: 0.000 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 VOLTAGE: 0.100 pu

PHASE UV1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PHASE UV1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

PHASE UV1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

This element is used to give a time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied fundamental voltage (phase-to-
ground or phase-to-phase for wye VT connection, or phase-to-phase for delta VT connection) or as a definite time
element. The element resets instantaneously if the applied voltage exceeds the dropout voltage. The delay setting selects
the minimum operating time of the phase undervoltage. The minimum voltage setting selects the operating voltage below
which the element is blocked (a setting of “0” allows a dead source to be considered a fault condition).

5-254 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

Figure 5-135: Phase undervoltage1 logic


SETTING
SETTING PHASE UV1
PHASE UV1 PICKUP:
FUNCTION: PHASE UV1
Enabled = 1 CURVE:
PHASE UV1
SETTING DELAY: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
PHASE UV1 AND RUN VAG or VAB < PICKUP PHASE UV1 A PKP
BLOCK: t PHASE UV1 A DPO
Off = 0 PHASE UV1 A OP
V
SETTING
SETTING AND RUN VBG or VBC< PICKUP PHASE UV1 B PKP
PHASE UV1
t PHASE UV1 B DPO
PHASE UV1 SOURCE: MINIMUM VOLTAGE:
PHASE UV1 B OP
VAG or VAB < Minimum
Source VT = Delta V

}
VBG or VBC < Minimum
VAB AND RUN VCG or VCA< PICKUP PHASE UV1 C PKP
VCG or VCA < Minimum
VBC t PHASE UV1 C DPO
VCA PHASE UV1 C OP
Source VT = Wye V
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING OR PHASE UV1 PKP

PHASE UV1 MODE:

Phase to Ground Phase to Phase FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


VAG VAB OR PHASE UV1 OP
VBG VBC
VCG VCA
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND PHASE UV1 DPO

827039AC.CDR

5.7.8.3 Phase overvoltage (ANSI 59P, IEC PTOV)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  VOLTAGE ELEMENTS  PHASE OVERVOLTAGE1
 PHASE PHASE OV1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
 OVERVOLTAGE1  FUNCTION: Disabled 5
PHASE OV1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

PHASE OV1 Range: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 PICKUP: 1.000 pu

PHASE OV1 PICKUP Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 1.00 s

PHASE OV1 RESET Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 1.00 s

PHASE OV1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic Operand


 Off

PHASE OV1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

PHASE OV1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

There are three phase overvoltage elements available. A phase overvoltage element is used as an instantaneous element
with no intentional time delay or as a definite time element. The input voltage is the phase-to-phase voltage, either
measured directly from delta-connected VTs or as calculated from phase-to-ground (wye) connected VTs. The figure
shows specific voltages to be used for each phase.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-255


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-136: Phase overvoltage logic


SETTINGS
PHASE OV1 PICKUP
SETTING DELAY:
SETTING
PHASE OV1 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PHASE OV1 PHASE OV1 RESET
FUNCTION: PHASE OV1 A PKP
PICKUP: DELAY:
Enabled = 1 PHASE OV1 A DPO
RUN tPKP
VAB ≥ PICKUP PHASE OV1 A OP
tRST
PHASE OV1 B PKP
SETTING AND RUN tPKP PHASE OV1 B DPO
PHASE OV1 VBC ≥ PICKUP
BLOCK: PHASE OV1 B OP
tRST
RUN PHASE OV1 C PKP
Off = 0
VCA ≥ PICKUP tPKP PHASE OV1 C DPO
PHASE OV1 C OP
tRST
SETTING
PHASE OV1
SOURCE: FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Source VT = Delta OR PHASE OV1 OP
VAB
VBC
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
VCA
AND PHASE OV1 DPO
Source VT = Wye

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR PHASE OV1 PKP
827066A8.CDR

If the source VT is wye-connected, then the phase overvoltage pickup condition is V > x Pickup for VAB, VBC, and
VCA.

5.7.8.4 Neutral overvoltage (ANSI 59N, IEC PTOV)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  VOLTAGE ELEMENTS  NEUTRAL OV1(3)
5  NEUTRAL OV1
 NEUTRAL OV1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
 FUNCTION: Disabled

NEUTRAL OV1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP: Range: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 0.300 pu

NEUTRAL OV1 CURVE: Range: Definite Time, FlexCurve A, FlexCurve B,


 Definite Time FlexCurve C

NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP: Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 1.00 s

NEUTRAL OV1 RESET: Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 1.00 s

NEUTRAL OV1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

NEUTRAL OV1 TARGET: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 Self-reset

NEUTRAL OV1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

There are three neutral overvoltage elements available. The neutral overvoltage element can be used to detect
asymmetrical system voltage condition due to a ground fault or to the loss of one or two phases of the source. The
element responds to the system neutral voltage (3V_0), calculated from the phase voltages. The nominal secondary
voltage of the phase voltage channels entered under SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  AC INPUTS  VOLTAGE BANK  PHASE
VT SECONDARY is the p.u. base used when setting the pickup level.
The neutral overvoltage element can provide a time-delayed operating characteristic versus the applied voltage (initialized
from FlexCurves A, B, or C) or be used as a definite time element. The NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP DELAY setting applies only if the
NEUTRAL OV1 CURVE setting is “Definite Time.” The source assigned to this element must be configured for a phase VT.

5-256 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS

VT errors and normal voltage unbalance must be considered when setting this element. This function requires the VTs to
be wye-connected.
Figure 5-137: Neutral overvoltage1 logic

SETTING
NEUTRAL OV1
FUNCTION:
SETTING SETTING
Enabled=1
NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP
NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP: DELAY :
SETTING
AND RUN NEUTRAL OV1 RESET
DELAY :
NEUTRAL OV1 BLOCK:
NEUTRAL OV1 CURVE :
Off=0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
3V_0< Pickup tPKP
t NEUTRAL OV1 OP
SETTING tRST
NEUTRAL OV1 DPO
NEUTRAL OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE: NEUTRAL OV1 PKP
ZERO SEQ VOLT (V_0)
827848A3.CDR

5.7.8.5 Auxiliary undervoltage (ANSI 27X, IEC PTUV)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  VOLTAGE ELEMENTS  AUXILIARY UV1(3)
 AUXILIARY UV1 AUX UV1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

AUX UV1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

 AUX UV1 PICKUP:


0.700 pu
Range: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001 5
AUX UV1 CURVE: Range: Definite Time, Inverse Time
 Definite Time

AUX UV1 DELAY: Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 1.00 s

AUX UV1 MINIMUM: Range: 0.000 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 VOLTAGE: 0.100 pu

AUX UV1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AUX UV1 TARGET: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 Self-reset

AUX UV1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

The F35 contains one auxiliary undervoltage element for each VT bank. This element monitors undervoltage conditions of
the auxiliary voltage.
The AUX UV1 PICKUP selects the voltage level at which the time undervoltage element starts timing. The nominal secondary
voltage of the auxiliary voltage channel entered under SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  AC INPUTS  VOLTAGE BANK X5 
AUXILIARY VT X5 SECONDARY is the per-unit base used when setting the pickup level.
The AUX UV1 DELAY setting selects the minimum operating time of the auxiliary undervoltage element.
Both AUX UV1 PICKUP and AUX UV1 DELAY settings establish the operating curve of the undervoltage element. The auxiliary
undervoltage element can be programmed to use either definite time delay or inverse time delay characteristics. The
operating characteristics and equations for both definite and inverse time delay are as for the phase undervoltage
element.
The element resets instantaneously. The minimum voltage setting selects the operating voltage below which the element
is blocked.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-257


GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-138: Auxiliary undervoltage logic


SETTING
AUX UV1 SETTING
FUNCTION:
AUX UV1 PICKUP:
Enabled=1

AUX UV1 CURVE:


SETTING

AUX UV1 BLOCK: AUX UV1 DELAY:


FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Off=0 AND RUN Vx < Pickup AUX UV1 PKP
AUX UV1 DPO
SETTING
SETTING t AUX UV1 OP
AUX UV1 MINIMUM
AUX UV1 SIGNAL VOLTAGE:
SOURCE:
AUX VOLT Vx Vx < Minimum
V

827849A3.CDR

5.7.8.6 Auxiliary overvoltage (ANSI 59X, IEC PTOV)


SETTINGS  GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6)  VOLTAGE ELEMENTS  AUXILIARY OV1(3)
 AUXILIARY OV1 AUX OV1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

AUX OV1 SIGNAL Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

AUX OV1 PICKUP: Range: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 0.300 pu

5  AUX OV1 PICKUP


DELAY: 1.00 s
Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01

AUX OV1 RESET Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 1.00 s

AUX OV1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AUX OV1 TARGET: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 Self-reset

AUX OV1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

The F35 contains one auxiliary overvoltage element for each VT bank. This element is intended for monitoring overvoltage
conditions of the auxiliary voltage. The nominal secondary voltage of the auxiliary voltage channel entered under SYSTEM
SETUP  AC INPUTS  VOLTAGE BANK X5  AUXILIARY VT X5 SECONDARY is the per-unit (pu) base used when setting the
pickup level.

5-258 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

Figure 5-139: Auxiliary overvoltage logic


SETTING
AUX OV1
FUNCTION:
SETTING
Enabled=1
AUX OV1 PICKUP: SETTING
SETTING
AND RUN AUX OV1 PICKUP
DELAY :
AUX OV1 BLOCK:
AUX OV1 RESET
Off=0 DELAY :
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Vx < Pickup tPKP
SETTING tRST AUX OV1 OP
AUX OV1 DPO
AUX OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE: AUX OV1 PKP
AUXILIARY VOLT (Vx)
827836A3.CDR

5.8 Control elements


5.8.1 Overview
Control elements are used for control rather than protection. See the Introduction to Elements section at the beginning of
this chapter for information.

5.8.2 Trip bus 5


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  TRIP BUS  TRIP BUS 1(6)
 TRIP BUS 1 TRIP BUS 1 Range: Enabled, Disabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

TRIP BUS 1 PICKUP Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

TRIP BUS 1 RESET Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 DELAY: 0.00 s

TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 1: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 16: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

TRIP BUS 1 Range: Enabled, Disabled


 LATCHING: Disabled

TRIP BUS 1 RESET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

TRIP BUS 1: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

TRIP BUS 1 Range: Enabled, Disabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The trip bus element allows aggregating outputs of protection and control elements without using FlexLogic and assigning
them a simple and effective manner. Each trip bus can be assigned for either trip or alarm actions. Simple trip conditioning
such as latch, delay, and seal-in delay are available.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-259


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

The easiest way to assign element outputs to a trip bus is through the EnerVista software under Settings > Protection
Summary. Navigate to a specific protection or control protection element and check the bus box by hovering over the
blank check box and selecting an option that displays. Once the required element is selected for a specific bus, a list of
element operate-type operands are displayed and can be assigned to a trip bus. If more than one operate-type operand is
required, it can be assigned directly from the trip bus menu.
Figure 5-140: Trip bus fields in the protection summary

5 The following settings are available.


TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK — The trip bus output is blocked when the operand assigned to this setting is asserted.
TRIP BUS 1 PICKUP DELAY — This setting specifies a time delay to produce an output depending on how output is used.
TRIP BUS 1 RESET DELAY — This setting specifies a time delay to reset an output command. Set the time delay long enough
to allow the breaker or contactor to perform a required action.
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 1 to TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 16 — These settings select a FlexLogic operand to be assigned as an input to the trip
bus.
TRIP BUS 1 LATCHING — This setting enables or disables latching of the trip bus output. This is typically used when lockout is
required or user acknowledgement of the relay response is required.
TRIP BUS 1 RESET — The trip bus output is reset when the operand assigned to this setting is asserted. Note that the RESET OP
operand is pre-wired to the reset gate of the latch, As such, a reset command from the front panel interface or via
communications resets the trip bus output.

5-260 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

Figure 5-141: Trip bus logic


SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 1
SETTINGS
= Off
TRIP BUS 1 PICKUP
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 2
DELAY
= Off Non-volatile,
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
*** OR set-dominant
DELAY
AND S TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 16 TRIP BUS 1 OP
Latch
= Off TRST
R

SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FUNCTION
TRIP BUS 1 PKP
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK AND
= Off

SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1
LATCHING
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
= Off
OR

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESET OP 842023A1.CDR

5.8.3 Setting groups 5


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUPS
 SETTING GROUPS SETTING GROUPS Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Enabled

SETTING GROUPS BLK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

GROUP 2 ACTIVATE ON: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

GROUP 6 ACTIVATE ON: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

GROUP 1 NAME: Range: up to 16 alphanumeric characters




GROUP 6 NAME: Range: up to 16 alphanumeric characters

SETTING GROUP Range: Disabled, Enabled
 EVENTS: Disabled

The setting groups menu controls the activation and deactivation of up to six possible groups of settings in the GROUPED
ELEMENTS settings menu. The active setting group can be indicated on the front display of the UR by configuring User-
Programmable LEDs to display the state of the SETTING GROUP ACT FlexLogic operands.
SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION — When Enabled, allows setting groups other than group 1 (the default active group) to be
activated. The default setting group is forced active while the SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION setting is Disabled.
SETTING GROUPS BLK — Prevents the active setting group from changing when the selected FlexLogic operand is "On." This
can be useful in applications where it is undesirable to change the settings under certain conditions, such as during a
control sequence.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-261


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

GROUP 2 ACTIVATE ON to GROUP 6 ACTIVATE ON — Selects a FlexLogic operand which, when set, makes the particular setting
group active for use by any grouped element. A priority scheme ensures that only one group is active at a given time — the
highest-numbered group that is activated by its ACTIVATE ON parameter takes priority over the lower-numbered groups.
There is no activate on setting for group 1 (the default active group), because group 1 automatically becomes active if no
other group is active.
SETTING GROUP 1 NAME to SETTING GROUP 6 NAME — Allows the user to assign a name to each of the six settings groups.
Once programmed, this name appears on the second line of the GROUPED ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUP 1(6) menu display.
The relay can be set up via a FlexLogic equation to receive requests to activate or de-activate a particular non-default
settings group. The following FlexLogic equation (see the following figure) illustrates requests via remote communications
(for example, VIRTUAL INPUT 1 ON) or from a local contact input (for example, CONTACT IP 1 ON) to initiate the use of a
particular settings group, and requests from several overcurrent pickup measuring elements to inhibit the use of the
particular settings group. The assigned VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 operand is used to control the “On” state of a particular settings
group.
Figure 5-142: Example of FlexLogic control of a setting group

1 VIRT IP 1 ON (VI1)
OR (2)
2 CONT IP 1 ON (H5A)

3 OR (2)
AND (3) = VIRT OP 1 (VO1)
4 PHASE TOC1 PKP

5 NOT

6 PHASE TOC2 PKP

7 NOT

5 8 AND (3)

9 = VIRT OP 1 (VO1)

10 END
842789A1.CDR

A setting group selection can also be made by the IEC 61850 MMS service SelectActiveSG to the control block @Master/
LLN0.SGCB. The priority scheme mentioned makes active the highest numbered group selected by SelectActiveSG or the
GROUP ACTIVATE ON settings. The SelectActiveSG selection has a default value of 1, so until a higher SelectActiveSG
selection is received, the GROUP ACTIVATE ON settings control the active group.
The most recent SelectActiveSG selection is preserved while the UR is powered down or reset.
If it becomes necessary to cancel the SelectActiveSG selection without using a SelectActiveSG service request, change the
SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION setting to Disabled. This resets the SelectActiveSG selection to 1.

5.8.4 Selector switch


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  SELECTOR SWITCH  SELECTOR SWITCH 1(2)
 SELECTOR SWITCH 1 SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION: Range: Disabled, Enabled
  Disabled

SELECTOR 1 FULL Range: 1 to 7 in steps of 1


 RANGE: 7

SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: Range: 3.0 to 60.0 s in steps of 0.1


 5.0 s

SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

5-262 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP Range: Time-out, Acknowledge


 MODE: Time-out

SELECTOR 1 ACK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SELECTOR 1 3BIT A1: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SELECTOR 1 3BIT A2: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SELECTOR 1 3BIT Range: Time-out, Acknowledge


 MODE: Time-out

SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP Range: Restore, Synchronize, Sync/Restore


 MODE: Restore

SELECTOR 1 TARGETS: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 Self-reset

SELECTOR 1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

The selector switch element is intended to replace a mechanical selector switch. Typical applications include setting group
control or control of multiple logic sub-circuits in user-programmable logic.
The element provides for two control inputs. The step-up control allows stepping through selector position one step at a 5
time with each pulse of the control input, such as a user-programmable pushbutton. The three-bit control input allows
setting the selector to the position defined by a three-bit word.
The element allows pre-selecting a new position without applying it. The pre-selected position gets applied either after
time-out or upon acknowledgement via separate inputs (user setting). The selector position is stored in non-volatile
memory. Upon power-up, either the previous position is restored or the relay synchronizes to the current three-bit word
(user setting). Basic alarm functionality alerts the user under abnormal conditions; for example, the three-bit control input
being out of range.
A selector switch runs every two power cycles.
SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE — This setting defines the upper position of the selector. When stepping up through available
positions of the selector, the upper position wraps up to the lower position (position 1). When using a direct three-bit control
word for programming the selector to a desired position, the change would take place only if the control word is within the
range of 1 to the SELECTOR FULL RANGE. If the control word is outside the range, an alarm is established by setting the
SELECTOR ALARM FlexLogic operand for three seconds.
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT — This setting defines the time-out period for the selector. This value is used by the relay in the
following two ways. When the SELECTOR STEP-UP MODE is “Time-out,” the setting specifies the required period of inactivity
of the control input after which the pre-selected position is automatically applied. When the SELECTOR STEP-UP MODE is
“Acknowledge,” the setting specifies the period of time for the acknowledging input to appear. The timer is re-started by
any activity of the control input. The acknowledging input must come before the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT timer expires;
otherwise, the change does not take place and an alarm is set.
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP — This setting specifies a control input for the selector switch. The switch is shifted to a new position at
each rising edge of this signal. The position changes incrementally, wrapping up from the last (SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE) to
the first (position 1). Consecutive pulses of this control operand must not occur faster than every 50 ms. After each rising
edge of the assigned operand, the time-out timer is restarted and the SELECTOR SWITCH 1: POS Z CHNG INITIATED target
message is displayed, where Z the pre-selected position. The message is displayed for the time specified by the FLASH
MESSAGE TIME setting. The pre-selected position is applied after the selector times out (“Time-out” mode), or when the

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-263


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

acknowledging signal appears before the element times out (“Acknowledge” mode). When the new position is applied, the
relay displays the SELECTOR SWITCH 1: POSITION Z IN USE message. Typically, a user-programmable pushbutton is
configured as the stepping up control input.
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE — This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to “Time-out,” the selector
changes its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and does not
require any explicit confirmation of the intent to change the selector's position. When set to “Acknowledge,” the selector
changes its position only after the intent is confirmed through a separate acknowledging signal. If the acknowledging
signal does not appear within a pre-defined period of time, the selector does not accept the change and an alarm is
established by setting the SELECTOR STP ALARM output FlexLogic operand for three seconds.
SELECTOR 1 ACK — This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the stepping up control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned operand. This setting is active only under “Acknowledge” mode of
operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT setting after the last
activity of the control input. A user-programmable pushbutton is typically configured as the acknowledging input.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0, A1, and A2 — These settings specify a three-bit control input of the selector. The three-bit control word
pre-selects the position using the following encoding convention:
A2 A1 A0 Position
0 0 0 rest
0 0 1 1
0 1 0 2
0 1 1 3
1 0 0 4
1 0 1 5

5 1
1
1
1
0
1
6
7

The “rest” position (0, 0, 0) does not generate an action and is intended for situations when the device generating the three-
bit control word is having a problem. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is “Time-out,” the pre-selected position is applied in
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT seconds after the last activity of the three-bit input. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is “Acknowledge,”
the pre-selected position is applied on the rising edge of the SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK acknowledging input.
The stepping up control input (SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP) and the three-bit control inputs (SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0 through A2) lock-out
mutually: once the stepping up sequence is initiated, the three-bit control input is inactive; once the three-bit control
sequence is initiated, the stepping up input is inactive.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE — This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to “Time-out,” the selector changes
its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and does not require
explicit confirmation to change the selector position. When set to “Acknowledge,” the selector changes its position only
after confirmation via a separate acknowledging signal. If the acknowledging signal does not appear within a pre-defined
period of time, the selector rejects the change and an alarm established by invoking the SELECTOR BIT ALARM FlexLogic
operand for three seconds.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK — This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the three-bit control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned FlexLogic operand. This setting is active only under the
“Acknowledge” mode of operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR TIME-
OUT setting after the last activity of the three-bit control inputs. Note that the stepping up control input and three-bit
control input have independent acknowledging signals (SELECTOR 1 ACK and SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK, accordingly).
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE — This setting specifies the element behavior on power up of the relay.
When set to “Restore,” the last position of the selector (stored in the non-volatile memory) is restored after powering up the
relay. If the position restored from memory is out of range, position 0 (no output operand selected) is applied and an alarm
is set (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).

5-264 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

When set to “Synchronize,” the selector switch acts as follows. For two power cycles, the selector applies position 0 to the
switch and activates SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM. After two power cycles expire, the selector synchronizes to the position
dictated by the three-bit control input. This operation does not wait for time-out or the acknowledging input. When the
synchronization attempt is unsuccessful (that is, the three-bit input is not available (0,0,0) or out of range), then the selector
switch output is set to position 0 (no output operand selected) and an alarm is established (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
The operation of “Synch/Restore” mode is similar to the “Synchronize” mode. The only difference is that after an
unsuccessful synchronization attempt, the switch attempts to restore the position stored in the relay memory. The “Synch/
Restore” mode is useful for applications where the selector switch is employed to change the setting group in redundant
(two relay) protection schemes.
SELECTOR 1 EVENTS — If enabled, the following events are logged:

Event name Description


SELECTOR 1 POS Z Selector 1 changed its position to Z
SELECTOR 1 STP ALARM The selector position pre-selected via the stepping up control input has not been confirmed before the
time out
SELECTOR 1 BIT ALARM The selector position pre-selected via the three-bit control input has not been confirmed before the time
out

The following figures illustrate the operation of the selector switch. In these diagrams, “T” represents a time-out setting.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-265


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-143: Time-out mode

TIME OUT MODE OF OPERATION

pre-existing changed to 4 with changed to 1 with changed to 2 with a changed to 7 with


position 2 a pushbutton a 3-bit input pushbutton a 3-bit input

STEP-UP

T T

3BIT A0

3BIT A1

3BIT A2
T T

POS 1

POS 2

5 POS 3

POS 4

POS 5

POS 6

POS 7

BIT 0

BIT 1

BIT 2

STP ALARM

BIT ALARM

ALARM
842737A1.CDR

5-266 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

Figure 5-144: Acknowledge mode

ACKNOWLEDGE MODE OF OPERATION

pre-existing changed to 4 with changed to 1 with changed to 2 with


position 2 a pushbutton a 3-bit input a pushbutton

STEP-UP

ACK

3BIT A0

3BIT A1

3BIT A2

3BIT ACK

POS 1

POS 2

POS 3
5
POS 4

POS 5

POS 6

POS 7

BIT 0

BIT 1

BIT 2

STP ALARM

BIT ALARM

ALARM
842736A1.CDR

Application example
Consider an application where the selector switch is used to control setting groups 1 through 4 in the relay. The setting
groups are to be controlled from both user-programmable pushbutton 1 and from an external device via contact inputs 1
through 3. The active setting group is to be available as an encoded three-bit word to the external device and SCADA via
output contacts 1 through 3. The pre-selected setting group is to be applied automatically after five seconds of inactivity
of the control inputs. When the relay powers up, it is to synchronize the setting group to the three-bit control input.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-267


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Make the following changes to setting group control in the SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  SETTING GROUPS menu:
SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION: “Enabled”
SETTING GROUPS BLK: “Off”
GROUP 2 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 2"
GROUP 3 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 3"
GROUP 4 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 4"
GROUP 5 ACTIVATE ON: “Off”
GROUP 6 ACTIVATE ON: “Off”
Make the following changes to selector switch element in the SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  SELECTOR SWITCH 
SELECTOR SWITCH 1 menu to assign control to user programmable pushbutton 1 and contact inputs 1 through 3:
SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION: “Enabled”
SELECTOR 1 FULL-RANGE: “4”
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE: “Time-out”
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: “5.0 s”
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
SELECTOR 1 ACK: “Off”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0: “CONT IP 1 ON”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A1: “CONT IP 2 ON”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A2: “CONT IP 3 ON”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE: “Time-out”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: “Off”
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE: “Synchronize”
Now, assign the contact output operation (assume the H6E module) to the selector switch element by making the following
changes in the SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUTS menu:
5 OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 0"
OUTPUT H2 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 1"
OUTPUT H3 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 2"
Finally, assign configure user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS  PRODUCT
SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS  USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: “Self-reset”
PUSHBUTTON 1 DROP-OUT TIME: “0.10 s”
The figure shows the logic for the selector switch.

5-268 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

Figure 5-145: Selector switch logic


SETTINGS
SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE:

SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE:

SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE:

SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: ACTUAL VALUE


SETTINGS
SELECTOR 1 POSITION
SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION: SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE:
Enabled = 1 RUN
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: FLEXLOGIC™ OPERANDS
Off = 0 step up SELECTOR 1 POS 1
2
SELECTOR 1 ACK: 1 SELECTOR 1 POS 2
3
Off = 0 acknowledge SELECTOR 1 POS 3
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0: 4
SELECTOR 1 POS 4
three-bit control input
Off = 0 SELECTOR 1 POS 5
ON
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A1: 7 5
SELECTOR 1 POS 6
Off = 0 6
SELECTOR 1 POS 7
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A2:
Off = 0 FLEXLOGIC™ OPERANDS
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK:
SELECTOR 1 STP ALARM
Off = 0 3-bit acknowledge
SELECTOR 1 BIT ALARM
3-bit position out

OR
SELECTOR 1 ALARM
SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM
SELECTOR 1 BIT 0
SELECTOR 1 BIT 1
SELECTOR 1 BIT 2
842012A2.CDR
5
5.8.5 Underfrequency (ANSI 81U)
SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  UNDERFREQUENCY  UNDERFREQUENCY 1(6)
 UNDERFREQUENCY 1 UNDFREQ 1 FUNCTION: Range: Disabled, Enabled
  Disabled

UNDERFREQ 1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

UNDERFREQ 1 SOURCE: Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6


 SRC 1

UNDERFREQ 1 MIN Range: 0.10 to 1.25 pu in steps of 0.01


 VOLT/AMP: 0.10 pu

UNDERFREQ 1 PICKUP: Range: 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01


 59.50 Hz

UNDERFREQ 1 PICKUP Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 2.000 s

UNDERFREQ 1 RESET Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY : 2.000 s

UNDERFREQ 1 TARGET: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 Self-reset

UNDERFREQ 1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

There are six identical underfrequency elements, numbered 1 through 6.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-269


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

The steady-state frequency of a power system is a certain indicator of the existing balance between the generated power
and the load. Whenever this balance is disrupted through the loss of an important generating unit or the isolation of part
of the system from the rest of the system, the effect is a reduction in frequency. If the control systems of the system
generators do not respond fast enough, the system can collapse. A reliable method to quickly restore the balance between
load and generation is to automatically disconnect selected loads, based on the actual system frequency. This technique,
called “load-shedding,” maintains system integrity and minimize widespread outages. After the frequency returns to
normal, the load can be restored automatically or manually.
UNDERFREQ 1 SOURCE — This setting is used to select the source for the signal to be measured. The element first checks for
a live phase voltage available from the selected source. If voltage is not available, the element attempts to use a phase
current. If neither voltage nor current is available, the element does not operate, as it does not measure a parameter
below the minimum voltage/current setting.
UNDERFREQ 1 MIN VOLT/AMP — Selects the minimum per unit voltage or current level required to allow the underfrequency
element to operate. This threshold is used to prevent an incorrect operation because there is no signal to measure.
UNDERFREQ 1 PICKUP — Selects the level at which the underfrequency element is to pickup. For example, if the system
frequency is 60 Hz and the load shedding is required at 59.5 Hz, the setting is 59.50 Hz.
Figure 5-146: Underfrequency logic
SETTING

UNDERFREQ 1 FUNCTION:

Enabled=1

SETTING SETTING SETTING


UNDERFREQ 1 UNDERFREQ 1
UNDERFREQ 1 BLOCK: PICKUP : PICKUP DELAY :
AND RUN FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Off = 0 UNDERFREQ 1
UNDERFREQ 1 PKP
RESET DELAY :

5
SETTING UNDERFREQ 1 DPO
SETTING tPKP
UNDERFREQ 1 0 < f < PICKUP tRST UNDERFREQ 1 OP
UNDERFREQ 1 SOURCE: ACTUAL VALUES MIN VOLT / AMP:
Level < Min
VOLT / AMP 827079A9.CDR
Frequency

5.8.6 Autoreclose (ANSI 79)


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  AUTORECLOSE  AUTORECLOSE 1(6)
 AUTORECLOSE 1 AR1 FUNCTION: Range: Disabled, Enabled
  Disabled

AR1 INITIATE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 MAX NUMBER OF Range: 1, 2, 3, 4


 SHOTS: 1

AR1 REDUCE MAX TO 1: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 REDUCE MAX TO 2: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 REDUCE MAX TO 3: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 MANUAL CLOSE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 MNL RST FRM LO: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 RESET LOCKOUT IF Range: Off, On


 BREAKER CLOSED: Off

5-270 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

AR1 RESET LOCKOUT ON Range: Off, On


 MANUAL CLOSE: Off

AR1 BKR CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 BKR OPEN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 BLK TIME UPON Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01


 MNL CLS: 10.000 s

AR1 DEAD TIME 1: Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01


 1.000 s

AR1 DEAD TIME 2: Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01


 2.000 s

AR1 DEAD TIME 3: Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01


 3.000 s

AR1 DEAD TIME 4: Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01


 4.000 s

AR1 ADD DELAY 1: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

AR1 DELAY 1: Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01


 0.000 s

AR1 ADD DELAY 2: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

 AR1 DELAY 2:
0.000 s
Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01 5
AR1 RESET LOCKOUT Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01
 DELAY: 60.000

AR1 RESET TIME: Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01


 60.000 s

AR1 INCOMPLETE SEQ Range: 0.00 to 655.35 s in steps of 0.01


 TIME: 5.000 s

AR1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

The F35 is provided with this optional feature, specified as an option at the time of ordering. Using the order
code for your device, see the order codes in chapter 2 for details.

The maximum number of autoreclosure elements available is equal to the number of installed CT banks.
The autoreclosure feature is intended for use with transmission and distribution lines, in three-pole tripping schemes for
single breaker applications. Up to four selectable reclosures "shots" are possible prior to locking out. Each shot has an
independently settable dead time. The protection settings can be changed between shots if required, using FlexLogic.
Logic inputs are available for disabling or blocking the scheme.
Faceplate panel LEDs indicate the state of the autoreclose scheme as follows:
• Reclose Enabled — The scheme is enabled and can reclose if initiated
• Reclose Disabled — The scheme is disabled
• Reclose In Progress — An autoreclosure has been initiated but the breaker has not yet been signaled to close
• Reclose Locked Out — The scheme has generated the maximum number of breaker closures allowed and, as the fault
persists, does not close the breaker again; known as "Lockout." The scheme can also be sent in "Lockout" when the
incomplete sequence timer times out or when a block signal occurs while in "reclose in progress." The scheme must be
reset from Lockout in order to perform reclose for further faults.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-271


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

The reclosure scheme is considered enabled when all of the following conditions are true:
• The AR1 FUNCTION is set to “Enabled”
• The scheme is not in the "Lockout" state
• The "Block" input is not asserted
• The AR1 BLK TIME UPON MNL CLS timer is not active
The autoreclose scheme is initiated by a trip signal from any selected protection feature operand. The scheme is initiated
provided the circuit breaker is in the closed state before protection operation.
The reclose-in-progress (RIP) is set when a reclosing cycle begins following a reclose initiate signal. Once the cycle is
successfully initiated, the RIP signal seals-in and the scheme continues through its sequence until one of the following
conditions is satisfied:
• The close signal is issued when the dead timer times out, or
• The scheme goes to lockout
While RIP is active, the scheme checks that the breaker is open and the shot number is below the limit, and then begins
measuring the dead time.
Each of the four possible shots has an independently settable dead time. Two additional timers can be used to increase the
initial set dead times 1 to 4 by a delay equal to AR1 DELAY 1 or AR1 DELAY 2 or the sum of these two delays depending on the
selected settings. This offers enhanced setting flexibility using FlexLogic operands to turn the two additional timers “on”
and “off.” These operands can possibly include AR1 SHOT CNT =n, SETTING GROUP ACT 1, and so on. The autoreclose provides
up to maximum 4 selectable shots. Maximum number of shots can be dynamically modified through the settings AR1
REDUCE MAX TO 1 (2, 3), using the appropriate FlexLogic operand.
Scheme lockout blocks all phases of the reclosing cycle, preventing automatic reclosure, if any of the following occurs:
• The maximum shot number was reached
5 • A "Block" input is in effect (for instance, Breaker Failure or bus differential protection operated)
• The "Incomplete Sequence" timer times out
The recloser is latched in the Lockout state until a "reset from lockout" signal is asserted, either from a manual close of the
breaker or from a manual reset command (local or remote). The reset from lockout can be accomplished by operator
command, by manually closing the breaker, or whenever the breaker has been closed and stays closed for a preset time.
After the dead time elapses, the scheme issues the close signal. The close signal is latched until the breaker closes or the
scheme goes to Lockout.
A reset timer output resets the recloser following a successful reclosure sequence. The reset time is based on the breaker
"reclaim time," which is the minimum time required between successive reclose sequences.

5.8.6.1 Settings
AR1 INITIATE — Selects the FlexLogic operand that initiates the scheme, typically the trip signal from protection.
AR1 BLOCK — Selects the FlexLogic operand that blocks the autoreclosure initiate (it can be from the breaker failure, bus
differential protection, and so on).
AR1 MAX NUMBER OF SHOTS — Specifies the number of reclosures that can be attempted before reclosure goes to “Lockout”
because the fault is permanent.
AR1 REDUCE MAX TO 1(3) — Selects the FlexLogic operand that changes the maximum number of shots from the initial
setting to 1, 2, or 3, respectively.
AR1 MANUAL CLOSE — Selects the logic input set when the breaker is manually closed.
AR1 MNL RST FRM LO — Selects the FlexLogic operand that resets the autoreclosure from Lockout condition. Typically this is
a manual reset from lockout, local or remote.
AR1 RESET LOCKOUT IF BREAKER CLOSED — This setting allows the autoreclose scheme to reset from Lockout if the breaker
has been manually closed and stays closed for a preset time. In order for this setting to be effective, disable the next
setting (AR1 RESET LOCKOUT ON MANUAL CLOSE).

5-272 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

AR1 RESET LOCKOUT ON MANUAL CLOSE — This setting allows the autoreclose scheme to reset from Lockout when the
breaker is manually closed regardless if the breaker remains closed or not. This setting overrides the previous setting (AR1
RESET LOCKOUT IF BREAKER CLOSED).
AR1 BLK TIME UPON MNL CLS — The autoreclose scheme can be disabled for a programmable time delay after the
associated circuit breaker is manually closed. This prevents reclosing onto a fault after a manual close. This delay must be
longer than the slowest expected trip from any protection not blocked after manual closing. If no overcurrent trips occur
after a manual close and this time expires, the autoreclose scheme is enabled.
AR1 DEAD TIME 1 to AR1 DEAD TIME 4 — These are the intentional delays before first, second, third, and fourth breaker
automatic reclosures (1st, 2nd, and 3rd shots), respectively. Set them longer than the estimated deionizing time following a
three pole trip.
AR1 ADD DELAY 1 — This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that introduces an additional delay (Delay 1) to the initial set
Dead Time (1 to 4). When this setting is “Off,” Delay 1 is by-passed.
AR1 DELAY 1 — This setting establishes the extent of the additional dead time Delay 1.
AR1 ADD DELAY 2 — This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that introduces an additional delay (Delay 2) to the initial set
Dead Time (1 to 4). When this setting is “Off”, Delay 2 is by-passed.
AR1 DELAY 2 — This setting establishes the extent of the additional dead time Delay 2.
AR1 RESET LOCKOUT DELAY — This setting establishes how long the breaker stays closed after a manual close command, in
order for the autorecloser to reset from Lockout.
AR1 RESET TIME — A reset timer output resets the recloser following a successful reclosure sequence. The setting is based
on the breaker "reclaim time," which is the minimum time required between successive reclose sequences.
AR1 INCOMPLETE SEQ TIME — This timer defines the maximum time interval allowed for a single reclose shot. It is started
whenever a reclosure is initiated and is active when the scheme is in the "reclose-in-progress" state. If all conditions
allowing a breaker closure are not satisfied when this time expires, the scheme goes to Lockout.
5
This timer must be set to a delay less than the reset timer.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-273


5

5-274
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AR1 BLK FROM MAN CLS
CONTROL ELEMENTS

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Enabled
AR1 ENABLED (Default)
SETTING

AR1 FUNCTION: FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


Disabled
AR1 DISABLED (Default)
Enable=1

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND SETTING


SETTING
AR1 RIP
AR1 BLOCK: Shot cnt = 3 AR1 DEAD TIME 4:
In progress
Off = 0 (Default)
AND O
AND
SETTING SETTING
SETTING SETTING
AR1 BLK TIME UPON SETTING
AR1 MANUAL CLOSE: MNL CLOSE : AR1 ADD DELAY 1: AR1 DELAY 1:
Shot cnt = 2 AR1 DEAD TIME 3:
Off = 0 O Off = 0
AND O
From AND
LO Sheet 2 O
SETTING OR
AND
AR1 INITIATE: SETTING AND
OR
Off = 0 AR1 DEAD TIME 2:
Shot cnt = 1

SETTING AND SETTING SETTING


OR O
AR1 BKR CLOSED: AR1 ADD DELAY 2: AR1 DELAY 2:
Off = 0 SETTING Off = 0
AND O
Shot cnt = 0 AR1 DEAD TIME 1:
AND Close
AND OR
SETTING
AND O AND
AR1 BKR OPEN:

Off = 0

AR Initiate

Bkr Is Closed
Shot cnt = Max

AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


AR1 LO
AND
Locked out
Figure 5-147: Autorecloser logic (Sheet 1 of 2)

SETTING (Default)
To sheet 2

SETTING
AR1 INCOMPLETE SEQ
SETTING AR1 RESET LOCKOUT TIME:
AR1 RESET LOCKOUT IF DELAY:
OR LO
BREAKER CLOSED: OR
AND LO
O
On=1 0 AND

SETTING
AR1 RESET LOCKOUT ON
MANUAL CLOSE:
AND OR
On=1 AND

SETTING
Reset From LO
AR1 MNL RST FROM LO:
827081AE.CDR
Off = 0

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS
ACTUAL VALUE
AUTORECLOSE 1
SHOT COUNT: 0(1,2,3,4) To
Sheet 1
CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

S
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch AR 1 CLOSE
SHOT COUNTER
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR R
Shot cnt = 4 AR 1 SHOT CNT = 4
Close Increment
shot Shot cnt = 3 AR 1 SHOT CNT = 3

Bkr is Closed counter Shot cnt = 2 AR 1 SHOT CNT = 2


Shot cnt = 1 AR 1 SHOT CNT = 1
To 100 ms Reset shot
AR Initiate SETTING OR counter Shot cnt = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Sheet 1
AND OR AR 1 SHOT CNT = 0
LO AR1 RESET TIME:

Reset from LO OR
AND O

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


SETTING
AR1 MAX NUMBER AND
OF SHOTS:

MAX = 1 AND
OR AND

MAX = 2 OR Shot Count = MAX


OR
AND
AND
MAX = 3
OR

MAX = 4
AND
Figure 5-148: Autorecloser logic (Sheet 2 of 2)

AND
SETTING

AR1 REDUCE MAX TO 1:

Off = 0

SETTING

AR1 REDUCE MAX TO 2:

Off = 0

SETTING

AR1 REDUCE MAX TO 3:

Off = 0
827082A7.CDR

5-275
CONTROL ELEMENTS

5
5

5-276
CONTROL ELEMENTS

BREAKER
STATUS

FAULT TRIP CONTACTS ARC CLOSE CONTACTS TRIP CONTACTS ARC


OCCURS COMMAND SEPARATE EXTINGUISHES COMMAND CLOSE COMMAND SEPARATE EXTINGUISHES

PROT TIME OPENING TIME CLOSING TIME PROT TIME OPENING TIME

BKR CLOSED

BKR OPEN

FAULT DURATION FAULT DURATION

AR GOES TO RESET FROM LOCKOUT


LOCKOUT: AR ENABLED
AR ENABLED AR INITIATE BKR OPEN CLOSED COMMAND BKR CLOSED AR INITIATE SHOT COUNT=MAX

RECLOSE IN PROGRESS RIP LOCKOUT

AUTO RECLOSE

DEAD TIME

INCOMPLETE SEQUENCE IS TIMING INCOMPL. SEQ. TIMING


Figure 5-149: Single shot autoreclosing sequence - permanent fault

RESET TIMER IS TIMING


827802A2.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS
CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

5.8.7 Digital elements


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  DIGITAL ELEMENTS  DIGITAL ELEMENT 1(48)
 DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

DIG ELEM 1 NAME: Range: up to 16 alphanumeric characters


 Dig Element 1

DIG ELEM 1 INPUT: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

DIG ELEM 1 PICKUP Range: 0.000 to 999999.999 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.000 s

DIG ELEM 1 RESET Range: 0.000 to 999999.999 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.000 s

DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 PICKUP LED: Enabled

DIG ELEM 1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

Digital elements run once per power system cycle.


As such they can easily fail to react to an input signal or a block signal with a duration less than one power system
5
cycle. This also means that digital element output can react up to one power system cycle later than the pickup
and reset delay settings indicate.
Do not use digital elements with transient signals, such as communications commands. Do not use digital
elements where random delays of up to one cycle cannot be tolerated, such as in high speed protection.
There are 48 identical digital elements available, numbered 1 to 48. A digital element can monitor any FlexLogic operand
and present a target message and/or enable events recording depending on the output operand state. The digital element
settings include a name to be referenced in any target message, a blocking input from any selected FlexLogic operand,
and a timer for pickup and reset delays for the output operand.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 INPUT — Selects a FlexLogic operand to be monitored by the digital element.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP DELAY — Sets the required time delay from element pickup to element operation. If a pickup delay
is not required, set to "0," To avoid nuisance alarms, set the delay greater than the operating time of the breaker.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 RESET DELAY — Sets the time delay to reset. If a reset delay is not required, set to “0.”
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP LED — This setting enables or disabled the digital element pickup LED. When set to “Disabled,” the
operation of the pickup LED is blocked.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-277


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-150: Digital element logic

SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
FUNCTION: SETTINGS
Enabled = 1 DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
SETTING PICKUP DELAY:
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
NAME: RESET DELAY:
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 DIG ELEM 01 DPO
AND RUN tPKP
INPUT: DIG ELEM 01 PKP
Off = 0 DIG ELEM 01 OP
INPUT = 1 tRST
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
BLOCK:
Off = 0 827042A2.VSD

Circuit monitoring applications


Some versions of the digital input modules include an active voltage monitor circuit connected across form-A contacts.
The voltage monitor circuit limits the trickle current through the output circuit (see technical specifications for form-A).
As long as the current through the voltage monitor is above a threshold (see technical specifications for form-A), the Cont
Op 1 VOn FlexLogic operand is set (for contact input 1—corresponding operands exist for each contact output). If the output
circuit has a high resistance or the DC current is interrupted, the trickle current drops below the threshold and the Cont Op 1
VOff FlexLogic operand is set. Consequently, the state of these operands can be used as indicators of the integrity of the
circuits in which form-A contacts are inserted.

5 Example 1: Breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring


In many applications it is desired to monitor the breaker trip circuit integrity so that problems can be detected before a trip
operation is required. The circuit is considered to be healthy when the voltage monitor connected across the trip output
contact detects a low level of current, well below the operating current of the breaker trip coil. If the circuit presents a high
resistance, the trickle current falls below the monitor threshold, and an alarm is declared.
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact that is open when the
breaker is open (see figure). To prevent unwanted alarms in this situation, the trip circuit monitoring logic must include the
breaker position.
Figure 5-151: Trip circuit example 1
UR-series device
with form-A contacts

H1a
I

H1b DC–

V DC+
H1c 52a Trip coil

I = current monitor
V = voltage monitor 827073A2.CDR

5-278 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

Assume the output contact H1 is a trip contact. Using the contact output settings, this output is given an ID name; for
example, “Cont Op 1." Assume a 52a breaker auxiliary contact is connected to contact input H7a to monitor breaker status.
Using the contact input settings, this input is given an ID name, for example, “Cont Ip 1," and is set “On” when the breaker is
closed. The settings to use digital element 1 to monitor the breaker trip circuit are indicated (EnerVista example shown).

Example 2: Breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring


If it is required to monitor the trip circuit continuously, independent of the breaker position (open or closed), a method to
maintain the monitoring current flow through the trip circuit when the breaker is open must be provided (as shown in the
following figure). This can be achieved by connecting a suitable resistor (see figure) across the auxiliary contact in the trip
circuit. In this case, it is not required to supervise the monitoring circuit with the breaker position – the BLOCK setting is
selected to “Off.” In this case, the settings are as follows (EnerVista example shown). 5

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-279


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-152: Trip circuit example 2


UR-series device
with form-A contacts

Values for resistor “R”


H1a
Power supply Resistance Power
I
24 V DC 1000 O 2W
H1b DC– 30 V DC 5000 O 2W
48 V DC 10000 O 2W
V DC+
110 V DC 25000 O 5W
H1c 52a Trip coil
125 V DC 25000 O 5W
R
250 V DC 50000 O 5W
Bypass
I = current monitor resistor
V = voltage monitor 827074A3.CDR

The wiring connection for two examples above is applicable to both form-A contacts with voltage monitoring and
solid-state contact with voltage monitoring.

5.8.8 Digital counters


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  DIGITAL COUNTERS  COUNTER 1(8)

5  COUNTER 1
  COUNTER 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
Range: Disabled, Enabled

COUNTER 1 NAME: Range: up to 12 alphanumeric characters


 Counter 1

COUNTER 1 UNITS: Range: up to six alphanumeric characters



COUNTER 1 PRESET: Range: –2,147,483,648 to +2,147,483,647
 0

COUNTER 1 COMPARE: Range: –2,147,483,648 to +2,147,483,647


 0

COUNTER 1 UP: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

COUNTER 1 DOWN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

COUNTER 1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CNT1 SET TO PRESET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

COUNTER 1 RESET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

COUNT1 FREEZE/RESET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

COUNT1 FREEZE/COUNT: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

There are eight identical digital counters, numbered from 1 to 8. A digital counter counts the number of state transitions
from Logic 0 to Logic 1. The counter is used to count operations such as the pickups of an element, the changes of state of
an external contact (for example, breaker auxiliary switch), or pulses from a watt-hour meter.

5-280 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

COUNTER 1 UNITS — Assigns a label to identify the unit of measure pertaining to the digital transitions to be counted. The
units label appears in the corresponding actual values status.
COUNTER 1 PRESET — Sets the count to a required preset value before counting operations begin, as in the case where a
substitute relay is to be installed in place of an in-service relay, or while the counter is running.
COUNTER 1 COMPARE — Sets the value to which the accumulated count value is compared. Three FlexLogic output
operands are provided to indicate if the present value is ‘more than (HI)’, ‘equal to (EQL)’, or ‘less than (LO)’ the set value.
COUNTER 1 UP — Selects the FlexLogic operand for incrementing the counter. If an enabled UP input is received when the
accumulated value is at the limit of +2,147,483,647 counts, the counter rolls over to –2,147,483,648.
COUNTER 1 DOWN — Selects the FlexLogic operand for decrementing the counter. If an enabled DOWN input is received
when the accumulated value is at the limit of –2,147,483,648 counts, the counter rolls over to +2,147,483,647.
COUNTER 1 BLOCK — Selects the FlexLogic operand for blocking the counting operation. All counter operands are blocked.
CNT1 SET TO PRESET — Selects the FlexLogic operand used to set the count to the preset value. The counter sets to the
preset value in the following situations:
• When the counter is enabled and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 1 (when the counter is enabled and
CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand is 0, the counter sets to 0)
• When the counter is running and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand changes the state from 0 to 1 (CNT1 SET TO PRESET
changing from 1 to 0 while the counter is running has no effect on the count)
• When a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 1
(when a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 0, the
counter sets to 0)
COUNTER 1 RESET — Selects the FlexLogic operand for setting the count to either “0” or the preset value depending on the
state of the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand.
COUNTER 1 FREEZE/RESET — Selects the FlexLogic operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value into a 5
separate register with the date and time of the operation, and resetting the count to “0.”
COUNTER 1 FREEZE/COUNT — Selects the FlexLogic operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value into a
separate register with the date and time of the operation, and continuing counting. The present accumulated value and
captured frozen value with the associated date/time stamp are available as actual values. If control power is interrupted,
the accumulated and frozen values are saved into non-volatile memory during the power-down operation.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-281


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-153: Digital counter logic

SETTING
COUNTER 1 FUNCTION:
SETTINGS
Enabled = 1
COUNTER 1 NAME:
SETTING AND COUNTER 1 UNITS:
COUNTER 1 PRESET:
COUNTER 1 UP:
RUN
Off = 0 SETTING
FLEXLOGIC
COUNTER 1 COMPARE: OPERANDS
SETTING
CALCULATE Count more than Comp. COUNTER 1 HI
COUNTER 1 DOWN: VALUE Count equal to Comp. COUNTER 1 EQL
Off = 0 Count less than Comp. COUNTER 1 LO

SETTING
COUNTER 1 BLOCK:
Off = 0 SET TO PRESET VALUE

SETTING SET TO ZERO


ACTUAL VALUE
CNT 1 SET TO PRESET: COUNTER 1 ACCUM:
Off = 0
AND

SETTING AND ACTUAL VALUES


COUNTER 1 RESET:
COUNTER 1 FROZEN:
Off = 0
OR STORE DATE & TIME Date & Time
SETTING
COUNT1 FREEZE/RESET:
Off = 0
OR
827065A2.VSD
SETTING
COUNT1 FREEZE/COUNT:

5 Off = 0

5.8.9 8-bit switches


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  8-BIT SWITCHES  8-BIT SWITCH 1(6)
 8-BIT 8BIT SWITCH 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
 SWITCH 1  FUNCTION: Disabled

8BIT SW 1 ARG A0: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

8BIT SW 1 ARG A1: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

8BIT SW 1 ARG A7: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

8BIT SW 1 ARG B0: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

8BIT SW 1 ARG B1: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

8BIT SW 1 ARG B7: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

8BIT SW 1 CONTROL: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

This feature allows switching between two input arguments defined by 8 bits each. The bits are specified by FlexLogic
operands. The feature could be viewed as an integrated two-position switch for 8 logic signals.
Typically this element is applied in conjunction with the Digitizer and 8-bit Comparator features.

5-282 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

The switch runs every half power cycle (every four protection passes).
8BIT SW 1 ARG A0 to 8BIT SW 1 ARG A7 — These settings specify FlexLogic operands that constitute the first (A) input of the
switch. These operands are routed to the output operands if the control input is in the "Off" position.
BIT SW 1 ARG B0 to 8BIT SW 1 ARG B7 — These settings specify FlexLogic operands that constitute the second (B) input of the
switch. These operands are routed to the output operands if the control input is in the "On" position.
8BIT SW 1 CONTROL — This setting specifies FlexLogic operands to control the routing between the A and B inputs of the
switch. If the control operand is in the "Off" state, the first (A) input is switched to the output. If the control operand is in the
"On" state, the second (B) input is switched to the output. The switching takes place instantaneously.
Figure 5-154: 8-bit switch logic
SETTING
8BIT SWITCH 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1 RUN

SETTINGS
8BIT SW 1 ARG A0:
Off = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
8BIT SW 1 ARG B0: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 0
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A1:
Off = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
8BIT SW 1 ARG B1: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 1
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A2:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND

5
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B2: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 2
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A3:
Off = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
8BIT SW 1 ARG B3: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 3
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A4:
Off = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
8BIT SW 1 ARG B4: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 4
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A5:
Off = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
8BIT SW 1 ARG B5: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 5
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A6:
Off = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
8BIT SW 1 ARG B6: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 6
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A7:
Off
Off = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
8BIT SW 1 ARG B7: 8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 7
On
Off = 0

SETTING
8BIT SW 1 CONTROL:
Off = 0
842017A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-283


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.8.10 Monitoring elements

5.8.10.1 Menu
SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS
 MONITORING  BREAKER 1 See below
 ELEMENTS   ARCING CURRENT

 BREAKER 6
  ARCING CURRENT

 BREAKER See page 5-291


  FLASHOVER 1

 BREAKER
  FLASHOVER 2

 BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 See page 5-296


 

 BREAKER RESTRIKE 3
 

 INCIPIENT FAULT 1 See page 5-298


 

5   INCIPIENT FAULT 6

 VT FUSE FAILURE 1 See page 5-300


 

 VT FUSE FAILURE 6
 

 THERMAL OVERLOAD See page 5-302


  PROTECTION

 BROKEN CONDUCTOR See page 5-305


 

5.8.10.2 Breaker arcing current


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS  BREAKER 1(6) ARCING CURRENT
 BREAKER 1 BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: Disabled, Enabled
 ARCING CURRENT  FUNCTION: Disabled

BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

BKR 1 ARC AMP INT-A: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR 1 ARC AMP INT-C: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.000 s

BKR 1 ARC AMP LIMIT: Range: 0 to 50000 kA2-cycle in steps of 1


 1000 kA2-cyc

5-284 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

BKR 1 INTERRUPTION Range: 0.0 to 100.0 kA in steps of 0.1


 RATING: 31.5 kA

BKR 1 CLR ARC AMPS: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR 1 ARC AMP BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

There is one breaker arcing current element available per CT bank, with a minimum of two elements. This element
calculates an estimate of the per-phase wear on the breaker contacts by measuring and integrating the current squared
passing through the breaker contacts as an arc. These per-phase values are added to accumulated totals for each phase
and compared to a programmed threshold value. When the threshold is exceeded in any phase, the relay can set an
output operand to “1.” The accumulated value for each phase can be displayed as an actual value.
The operation of the scheme is shown in the following logic diagram. The same output operand that is selected to operate
the output relay used to trip the breaker, indicating a tripping sequence has begun, is used to initiate this feature. A time
delay is introduced between initiation and the starting of integration to prevent integration of current flow through the
breaker before the contacts have parted. This interval includes the operating time of the output relay, any other auxiliary
relays, and the breaker mechanism. For maximum measurement accuracy, measure the interval between change-of-state
of the operand (from 0 to 1) and contact separation for the specific installation. Integration of the measured current
continues for 100 ms, which is expected to include the total arcing period.
The feature is programmed to perform fault duration calculations. Fault duration is defined as a time between operation of
the disturbance detector occurring before initiation of this feature, and reset of an internal low-set overcurrent function. 5
Correction is implemented to account for a non-zero reset time of the overcurrent function.
Breaker arcing currents and fault duration values are available under the ACTUAL VALUES  RECORDS  MAINTENANCE 
BREAKER 1(6) menus.
BKR 1 ARC AMP INT-A(C) — Select the same output operands that are configured to operate the output relays used to trip the
breaker. In three-pole tripping applications, configure the same operand to initiate arcing current calculations for poles A,
B, and C of the breaker. In single-pole tripping applications, configure per-pole tripping operands to initiate the calculations
for the poles that are actually tripped.
BKR 1 ARC AMP DELAY — This setting is used to program the delay interval between the time the tripping sequence is
initiated and the time the breaker contacts are expected to part, starting the integration of the measured current.
BKR 1 ARC AMP LIMIT — Selects the threshold value above which the output operand is set.
BKR 1 CLR ARC AMPS — Selects a FLexLogic Operand to clear the accumulated I2t values (kA2-cycle), reset fault duration
items (breaker operating time), clear ARCING AMPS (kA2-cycle) and AMP MAX (kA) values of the last event.
BKR 1 INTERUPTION RATING — This setting specifies the maximum symmetrical interruption rating of the circuit breaker.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-285


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-155: Arcing current measurement


Breaker
Contacts Arc
Initiate Part Extinguished

Total Area =
Breaker
Arcing
Current
(kA cycle)

Programmable
Start Delay 100 ms
Start Stop
Integration Integration
827792A1.CDR

5-286 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


SETTING

BREAKER 1 ARCING SETTING


AMP FUNCTION :
AND BREAKER 1 ARCING
Enabled = 1
AMP DELAY :
100ms
SETTING OR 0
AND 0
CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

BREAKER 1 ARCING AND


AMP BLOCK :
Off = 0

SETTING

AND BREAKER 1 ARCING


SETTINGS
AMP DELAY :
100ms
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP INIT - A: OR 0
0
Off = 0 AND

BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP INIT - B:
Off = 0
BREAKER 1 ARCING SETTING ACTUAL VALUES
AMP INIT - C :
AND BREAKER 1 ARCING BKR 1 AMP MAX FA
Off = 0 AMP DELAY: BKR 1 AMP MAX FB
100 ms
BKR 1 AMP MAX FC
OR 0 CALCULATE CALCULATE
0 SETTING
AND OR RUN Interruption Rating
Select greatest FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
value RUN
Imax > Interruption Rating BKR ARC 1 MAX OP

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


BKR ARC 1 MAX DPO
Calculate Imax

RUN

SETTING Integrate
BREAKER 1 ARCING Add to SETTING
AMP SOURCE : RUN Accumulator BREAKER 1 ARCING
2
IA IA - Cycle AMP LIMIT : FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Select
2 2
Figure 5-156: Breaker arcing current logic

IB Integrate IB - Cycle Highest KA * Cycle Limit BKR 1 ARC OP


2 Value
IC IC - Cycle BKR 1 ARC DPO
RUN
COMMAND

CLEAR BREAKER 1 Integrate ACTUAL VALUE


ARCING AMPS :
Set All To Zero BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP FA
NO = 0
BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP FB
YES = 1
OR BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP FC
SETTING BKR 1 OPERATING TIME FA
BKR 1 CLR ARC AMPS BKR 1 OPERATING TIME FB
Off=0
BKR 1 OPERATING TIME FC
BKR 1 OPERATING TIME .

ACTUAL VALUES
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FA
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FB
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FC
827071A5CDR

5-287
CONTROL ELEMENTS

5
CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS  BREAKER 1(6) ARCING CURRENT


 BREAKER 1 BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: Disabled, Enabled
 ARCING CURRENT  FUNCTION: Disabled

BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

BKR 1 ARC AMP INT-A: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR 1 ARC AMP INT-C: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.000 s

BKR 1 ARC AMP LIMIT: Range: 0 to 50000 kA2-cycle in steps of 1


 1000 kA2-cyc

BKR 1 INTERRUPTION Range: 0.0 to 100.0 kA in steps of 0.1


 RATING: 31.5 kA

BKR 1 CLR ARC AMPS: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR 1 ARC AMP BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset
5  BKR 1 ARC AMP Range: Disabled, Enabled
EVENTS: Disabled

There is one breaker arcing current element available per CT bank, with a minimum of two elements. This element
calculates an estimate of the per-phase wear on the breaker contacts by measuring and integrating the current squared
passing through the breaker contacts as an arc. These per-phase values are added to accumulated totals for each phase
and compared to a programmed threshold value. When the threshold is exceeded in any phase, the relay can set an
output operand to “1.” The accumulated value for each phase can be displayed as an actual value.
The operation of the scheme is shown in the following logic diagram. The same output operand that is selected to operate
the output relay used to trip the breaker, indicating a tripping sequence has begun, is used to initiate this feature. A time
delay is introduced between initiation and the starting of integration to prevent integration of current flow through the
breaker before the contacts have parted. This interval includes the operating time of the output relay, any other auxiliary
relays, and the breaker mechanism. For maximum measurement accuracy, measure the interval between change-of-state
of the operand (from 0 to 1) and contact separation for the specific installation. Integration of the measured current
continues for 100 ms, which is expected to include the total arcing period.
The feature is programmed to perform fault duration calculations. Fault duration is defined as a time between operation of
the disturbance detector occurring before initiation of this feature, and reset of an internal low-set overcurrent function.
Correction is implemented to account for a non-zero reset time of the overcurrent function.
Breaker arcing currents and fault duration values are available under the ACTUAL VALUES  RECORDS  MAINTENANCE 
BREAKER 1(6) menus.
BKR 1 ARC AMP INT-A(C) — Select the same output operands that are configured to operate the output relays used to trip the
breaker. In three-pole tripping applications, configure the same operand to initiate arcing current calculations for poles A,
B, and C of the breaker. In single-pole tripping applications, configure per-pole tripping operands to initiate the calculations
for the poles that are actually tripped.
BKR 1 ARC AMP DELAY — This setting is used to program the delay interval between the time the tripping sequence is
initiated and the time the breaker contacts are expected to part, starting the integration of the measured current.
BKR 1 ARC AMP LIMIT — Selects the threshold value above which the output operand is set.

5-288 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

BKR 1 CLR ARC AMPS — Selects a FLexLogic Operand to clear the accumulated I2t values (kA2-cycle), reset fault duration
items (breaker operating time), clear ARCING AMPS (kA2-cycle) and AMP MAX (kA) values of the last event.
BKR 1 INTERUPTION RATING — This setting specifies the maximum symmetrical interruption rating of the circuit breaker.

Figure 5-157: Arcing current measurement


Breaker
Contacts Arc
Initiate Part Extinguished

Total Area =
Breaker
Arcing
Current
(kA cycle)

Programmable
Start Delay 100 ms
Start Stop
Integration Integration
827792A1.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-289


5

5-290
SETTING

BREAKER 1 ARCING SETTING


AMP FUNCTION :
AND BREAKER 1 ARCING
Enabled = 1
AMP DELAY :
100ms
SETTING OR 0
CONTROL ELEMENTS

AND 0
BREAKER 1 ARCING AND
AMP BLOCK :
Off = 0

SETTING

AND BREAKER 1 ARCING


SETTINGS
AMP DELAY :
100ms
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP INIT - A: OR 0
0
Off = 0 AND

BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP INIT - B:
Off = 0
BREAKER 1 ARCING SETTING ACTUAL VALUES
AMP INIT - C :
AND BREAKER 1 ARCING BKR 1 AMP MAX FA
Off = 0 AMP DELAY: BKR 1 AMP MAX FB
100 ms
BKR 1 AMP MAX FC
OR 0 CALCULATE CALCULATE
0 SETTING
AND OR RUN Interruption Rating
Select greatest FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
value RUN
Imax > Interruption Rating BKR ARC 1 MAX OP
BKR ARC 1 MAX DPO
Calculate Imax

RUN

SETTING Integrate
BREAKER 1 ARCING Add to SETTING
AMP SOURCE : RUN Accumulator BREAKER 1 ARCING
IA IA 2 - Cycle AMP LIMIT : FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Select
2
Figure 5-158: Breaker arcing current logic

IB Integrate IB 2 - Cycle Highest KA * Cycle Limit BKR 1 ARC OP


IC IC 2 - Cycle Value BKR 1 ARC DPO
RUN
COMMAND

CLEAR BREAKER 1 Integrate ACTUAL VALUE


ARCING AMPS :
Set All To Zero BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP FA
NO = 0
BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP FB
YES = 1
OR BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP FC
SETTING BKR 1 OPERATING TIME FA
BKR 1 CLR ARC AMPS BKR 1 OPERATING TIME FB
Off=0
BKR 1 OPERATING TIME FC
BKR 1 OPERATING TIME .

ACTUAL VALUES
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FA
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FB
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FC
827071A5CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS
CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

Breaker flashover
SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS  BREAKER FLASHOVER 1(2)
 BREAKER BKR 1 FLSHOVR Range: Disabled, Enabled
 FLASHOVER 1  FUNCTION: Disabled

BKR 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 1 Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SRC: SRC 1

BKR 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 2 Range: None, SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC
 SRC: None 6

BKR 1 STATUS CLSD A: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR 1 STATUS CLSD C: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

BKR 1 FLSHOVR V PKP: Range: 0.004 to 1.500 pu in steps of 0.001


 0.850 pu

BKR 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V Range: 0 to 100000 V in steps of 1


 PKP: 1000 V

BKR 1 FLSHOVR AMP Range: 0.020 to 1.500 pu in steps of 0.001


 PKP: 0.600 pu

BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 DELAY: 0.100 s

BKR 1 FLSHOVR SPV A: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off 5

BKR 1 FLSHOVR SPV C: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

BKR 1 FLSHOVR BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR 1 FLSHOVR Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

BKR 1 FLSHOVR Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The detection of the breaker flashover is based on the following conditions:


• Breaker open,
• Voltage difference drop, and
• Measured flashover current through the breaker
Furthermore, the scheme is applicable for cases where either one or two sets of three-phase voltages are available across
the breaker.

Three VT breaker flashover application


When only one set of VTs is available across the breaker, set the BRK 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 2 SRC setting to “None.” To detect an
open breaker condition in this application, the scheme checks if the per-phase voltages were recovered (picked up), the
status of the breaker is open (contact input indicating the breaker status is off), and no flashover current is flowing. A
contact showing the breaker status must be provided to the relay. The voltage difference is not considered as a condition
for open breaker in this part of the logic.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-291


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Voltages must be present prior to flashover conditions. If the three VTs are placed after the breaker on the line (or
feeder), and the downstream breaker is open, the measured voltage is zero and the flashover element is not
initiated.
The flashover detection resets if the current drops back to zero, the breaker closes, or the selected FlexLogic operand for
supervision changes to high. Using supervision through the BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV A, BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV B, and BRK 1 FLSHOVR
SPV c settings is recommended by selecting a trip operand that does not allow the flashover element to pickup prior to the
trip.
The flashover detection can be used for external alarm, re-tripping the breaker, or energizing the lockout relay.
Consider the following configuration:

Bus
CTs Breaker
Line/Feeder

Bus VTs
842746A1.CDR

The source 1 (SRC1) phase currents are feeder CTs and phase voltages are bus VTs, and Contact Input 1 is set as Breaker
52a contact. The conditions prior to flashover detection are:

5 •

52a status = 0
VAg, VBg, or VCg is greater than the pickup setting
• IA, IB, IC = 0; no current flows through the breaker
• VA is greater than pickup (not applicable in this scheme)
The conditions at flashover detection are:
• 52a status = 0
• IA, IB, or IC is greater than the pickup current flowing through the breaker
• VA is greater than pickup (not applicable in this scheme)

Six VT breaker flashover application


The per-phase voltage difference approaches zero when the breaker is closed. This is well below any typical minimum
pickup voltage. Select the level of the BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP setting to be less than the voltage difference measured
across the breaker when the close or open breaker resistors are left in service. Prior to flashover, the voltage difference is
larger than BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP. This applies to either the difference between two live voltages per phase or when the
voltage from one side of the breaker has dropped to zero (line de-energized), at least one per-phase voltage is larger than
the BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP setting, and no current flows through the breaker poles. During breaker flashover, the per-phase
voltages from both sides of the breaker drops below the pickup value defined by the BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP setting, the
voltage difference drops below the pickup setting, and flashover current is detected. These flashover conditions initiate
FlexLogic pickup operands and start the BRK 1 FLSHOVR PKP DELAY timer.
This application does not require detection of breaker status via a 52a contact, as it uses a voltage difference larger than
the BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP setting. However, monitoring the breaker contact ensures scheme stability.

5-292 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

Consider the following configuration:

Bus
CTs Breaker
Line/Feeder

VTs

VTs
842745A1.CDR

The source 1 (SRC1) phase currents are CTs and phase voltages are bus VTs. The source 2 (SRC2) phase voltages are line
VTs. Contact input 1 is set as the breaker 52a contact (optional).
The conditions prior to flashover detection are:
• VA is greater than pickup
• IA, IB, IC = 0; no current flows through the breaker
• 52a status = 0 (optional)
The conditions at flashover detection are:
• VA is less than pickup
• VAg, VBg, or VCg is lower than the pickup setting
• IA, IB, or IC is greater than the pickup current flowing through the breaker
• 52a status = 0 (optional) 5
The element operates only when phase-to-ground voltages are connected to relay terminals. The flashover
element does not operate if delta voltages are applied.

Settings
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 1 SRC — This setting specifies a signal source used to provide three-phase voltages and three-phase
currents from one side of the current breaker. The source selected as a setting and must be configured with breaker phase
voltages and currents, even if only three VTs are available across the breaker.
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 2 SRC — This setting specifies a signal source used to provide another set of three phase voltages
whenever six VTs are available across the breaker.
BRK 1 STATUS CLSD A to BRK 1 STATUS CLSD C — These settings specify FlexLogic operands to indicate the open status of the
breaker. A separate FlexLogic operand can be selected to detect individual breaker pole status and provide flashover
detection. The recommended setting is 52a breaker contact or another operand defining the breaker poles open status.
BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP — This setting specifies a pickup level for the phase voltages from both sides of the breaker. If six VTs
are available, opening the breaker leads to two possible combinations – live voltages from only one side of the breaker, or
live voltages from both sides of the breaker. Either case sets the scheme for flashover detection upon detection of voltage
above the selected value. Set BRK FLSHOVR V PKP to 85 to 90% of the nominal voltage.
BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP — This setting specifies a pickup level for the phase voltage difference when two VTs per phase
are available across the breaker. The pickup voltage difference should be below the monitored voltage difference when
close or open breaker resistors are left in service. The setting is selected as primary volts difference between the sources.
BRK 1 FLSHOVR AMP PKP — This setting specifies the normal load current which can flow through the breaker. Depending on
the flashover protection application, the flashover current can vary from levels of the charging current when the line is de-
energized (all line breakers open), to well above the maximum line (feeder) load (line/feeder connected to load).

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-293


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV A to BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV C — These settings specify FlexLogic operands (per breaker pole) that supervise
the operation of the element per phase. Supervision can be provided by operation of other protection elements, breaker
failure, and close and trip commands. A six-cycle time delay applies after the selected FlexLogic operand resets.
BRK FLSHOVR PKP DELAY — This setting specifies the time delay to operate after a pickup condition is detected.

5-294 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

SETTINGS

BRK 1 FLSHOVR SUPV A:


0
FlexLogic operand: Off=0
6 cycle
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SUPV B: Phase B
logic
FlexLogic operand: Off=0

BRK 1 FLSHOVR SUPV C: Phase C


logic FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
FlexLogic operand: Off=0 BRK 1 FLSHOVR PKP A FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
BRK 1 FLSHOVR PKP B OR BRK 1 FLSHOVR PKP
SETTING
SETTING BRK 1 FLSHOVR PKP C BRK 1 FLSHOVR DPO
BREAKER FLASHOVER
FUNCTION: BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Enable=1
AND RUN BRK 1 FLSHOVR DPO A
Block: OFF=0
VA > PKP BRK 1 FLSHOVR DPO B
0 AND BRK 1 FLSHOVR DPO C
OR SET
5 cycle
dominant
Va > PKP Phase C logic

Phase B logic
RESET
SETTINGS
5 cycle
BRK 1 STATUS CLSD A:
0 OR
SET SETTING

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


RUN dominant
BRK 1 FLSHOVR PKP
FlexLogic operand: On=1
DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
BRK 1 STATUS CLSD B: Phase B tPKP
logic 0 BRK 1 FLSHOVR OP A
RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FlexLogic operand: On=1
Phase B logic BRK 1 FLSHOVR OP B OR BRK 1 FLSHOVR OP
BRK 1 STATUS CLSD C: Phase C RESET
logic OR Phase C logic BRK 1 FLSHOVR OP C
SETTINGS RUN
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 1 FlexLogic operand: On=1
SRC:
SRC 1, SRC 2, … , SRC 6 SETTING
Figure 5-159: Breaker flashover logic

VA
BRK 1 FLSHOVR AMP PKP:
VB
VC RUN
IA IA > PKP
IB
AND
IC

SETTINGS
SETTING
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 2
SRC: BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V
PKP:
SRC 1, SRC 2, … , SRC 6, none
RUN
Va DVA > PKP
DVA = | VA - Va |
Vb
Vc 842018A2.CDR

5-295
CONTROL ELEMENTS

5
CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.8.10.3 Breaker restrike


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS  BREAKER RESTRIKE 1(3)
 BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

BKR RESTRIKE 1 Range: FlexLogic operand


 BLOCK: Off

BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6


 SOURCE: SRC 1

BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 Range: 0.10 to 2.00 pu in steps of 0.01


 PICKUP: 0.50 pu

BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 RST DELAY: 0.100 s

BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 HF DETECT: Enabled

BKR RSTR 1 BKR OPEN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR RSTR 1 OPEN CMD: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BKR RSTR 1 CLS CMD: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset
5 BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
 EVENTS: Disabled

One breaker restrike element is provided for each DSP in the F35.
According to IEEE standard C37.100 entitled IEEE Standard Definitions for Power Switchgear, restrike is defined as “a
resumption of current between the contacts of a switching device during an opening operation after an interval of zero
current of ¼ cycle at normal frequency or longer.”
Figure 5-160: Typical restrike waveform and detection flag

10
8
6
4
current (amps)

2
0.01 0.03
0 time (ms)
0.02 0.05
–2
–4
–6
–8
OPERATE
–10
834764A1.CDR

The breaker restrike algorithm responds to a successful interruption of the phase current following a declaration of
capacitor bank offline as per the breaker pole indication. If a high-frequency or system frequency current with a
magnitude greater than the threshold is resumed at least ¼ of a cycle later than the phase current interruption, then a

5-296 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

breaker restrike condition is declared in the corresponding phase and the BRK RESTRIKE 1 OP operand asserts for a short
period of time. The user can add counters and other logic to facilitate the decision making process as to the appropriate
actions upon detecting a single restrike or a series of consecutive restrikes.
A restrike event (FlexLogic operand) is declared if all of the following hold:
• The current is initially interrupted
• The breaker status is open
• An elevated high frequency current condition occurs (if the BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 HF DETECT setting is Enabled, otherwise
the condition is bypassed), and
• The current subsequently drops out again
The algorithm is illustrated in the following state machine diagram.
Figure 5-161: Algorithm illustration of state machine to detect restrike

Breaker open
command or breaker
open state
Capacitor bank
offline
Breaker
close

Current
Capacitor bank
interruption
Breaker online
(overcurrent)
close

High-frequency
5
elevated current Breaker close
(if enabled)

Current
interruption
(overcurrent)

Restrike detected:
OP state asserted
834768A2.CDR

In this way, a distinction is made between a self-extinguishing restrike and permanent breaker failure condition. The latter
can be detected by the breaker failure function or a regular instantaneous overcurrent element. Also, a fast succession of
restrikes is picked up by breaker failure or instantaneous overcurrent protection.
The following settings are available for each element.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 FUNCTION — Enables and disables operation of the breaker restrike detection element.
BRK RSTR 1 BLOCK — Blocks operation of the breaker restrike detection element.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 SOURCE — Selects the source of the current for this element. This source must have a valid CT bank
assigned.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 PICKUP — Specifies the pickup level of the overcurrent detector in per-unit values of CT nominal
current.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 RESET DELAY — Specifies the reset delay for this element. When set to “0 ms,” then FlexLogic operand is
picked up for only 1/8th of the power cycle.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-297


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 HF DETECT — Enables/disables high-frequency (HF) pattern detection when breaker restrike occurs.
High-frequency pattern is typical for capacitor bank, cables, and long transmission lines applications.
BRK RSTR 1 BRK OPEN — Assigns a FlexLogic operand indicating the open position of the breaker. It must be logic “1” when
the breaker is open. It is important to assign either 52 contact with this setting or breaker close command with BRK RSTR 1
CLS CMD setting to give clear indication to the relay about breaker status.
BRK RSTR 1 OPEN CMD — Assigns a FlexLogic operand indicating a breaker open command. It must be logic “1” when the
breaker is opened, either manually or from protection logic.
BRK RSTR 1 CLS CMD — Assigns a FlexLogic operand indicating a breaker close command. It must be logic “1” when the
breaker is closed.
Figure 5-162: Breaker restrike logic
SETTING
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1
FUNCTION
= Enabled

SETTING AND SETTING


BKR RSTR 1 BLK BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 PICKUP
= Off BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 SETTING
HF DETECT BREAKER RESTRIKE 1
RUN RESET DELAY
SETTING 0
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 RUN Restrike detection logic
SOURCE ARMED TRST
Current interruption
= IA detection logic 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
= IB
Imag < 0.05 pu TRST BKR RESTRIKE 1 OP A
= IC
for t > ¼ cycle 0 BKR RESTRIKE 1 OP B
BKR RESTRIKE 1 OP C
SETTING RESET TRST
BKR RSTR 1 BKR OPEN
= Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND

5 SETTING
BKR RSTR 1 OPEN CMD
OR
OR BKR RESTRIKE 1 OP

= Off
AND

SETTING
BKR RSTR 1 CLS CMD
= Off 834012A2.CDR

5.8.10.4 Incipient fault detector


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS  INCIPIENT FAULT 1(6)
 INCIPIENT FAULT 1 INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

INCIPNT FLT 1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6


 SOURCE: SRC 1

INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: 0.10 to 10.00 pu in steps of 0.01


 PICKUP: 0.50 pu

INCIPNT FLT 1 MODE: Range: Number of counts, Counts per window


 Number of counts

INCIPIENT FLT 1 TRIP Range: 1 to 10 in steps of 1


 COUNTS NUMBER: 2

INCIPNT FLT 1 DETECT Range: 0.00 to 1000.00 s in steps of 0.01


 WINDOW: 10.00 s

INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 RESET DELAY: 0.100 s

INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

5-298 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

There are two incipient cable fault detection elements for each CT/VT module in the relay.
Before a permanent cable fault occurs, there are usually signs of degrading insulation manifesting itself as a short, mostly
half-cycle spikes asserting at the phase voltage peak. Due to shortness of such spikes, they are not usually detected by the
instantaneous protection of the feeder, which operates on the RMS or fundamental component of the phase current with a
relatively high pickup.
The number of detected incipient faults in each phase is counted and available in the ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS 
INCIPIENT FAULT menus. The counters can be reset with the COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS  CLEAR INCIPENT FAULT
COUNTERS command.

Changes to any of the incipient cable fault detector settings resets of the number of the incipient faults detected to
zero.
To provide a clear timing indication when the incipient fault occurred, the incipient fault event is time-stamped with
the time the fault actually occurred. However, the FlexLogic operand is asserted four cycles later, when the incipient
fault pattern is confirmed and therefore detected.
The figure illustrates a recorded field case of an incipient phase B fault. The top portion of the figure shows the raw A, B,
and C currents. The bottom portion shows the neutral current (blue) and reveals the fault period from under the load and
the superimposed phase B current (red). The superimposed current shows two fault current blips as the data slides through
the two-cycle memory window. During the actual fault, the neutral current and the superimposed phase B currents closely
correspond, confirming the incipient fault hypothesis and identifying the affected phase.
Figure 5-163: Illustration of the incipient fault detector algorithm

Incipient phase B fault PHASE CURRENTS


5
2.0
Current (amps)

1.0

Phase C
0 Phase A
Phase B
–0.5
0.62 0.64 0.66 0.68 0.70 0.72 0.74

CALCULATED NEUTRAL AND


2.0 IN (neutral current) SUPERIMPOSED PHASE B CURRENT
Current (amps)

1.0

–1.0
IFB
–2.0
0.62 0.64 0.66 0.68 0.7 0.72 0.74
832774A1.CDR

The following settings are available for each incipient cable fault detector.
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables operation of the incipient fault detection element.
INCIPNT FLT 1 BLOCK — Blocks operation of the incipient cable fault detector element. Assertion of the FlexLogic operand
assigned to this setting blocks operation.
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 SOURCE — Selects a current source for the incipient cable fault detector element. This source must be
assigned a valid CT bank.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-299


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

INCIPIENT FAULT 1 PICKUP — Specifies the pickup level of the overcurrent detector in per-unit values of the CT nominal
current.
INCIPNT FLT 1 MODE — There are two modes of operation available for the incipient cable fault detector element. In the
“Number of counts” mode, a trip is initiated only after the selected number of faults is detected. In the “Counts per window”
mode, a trip is initiated only after the selected number of faults is detected within the time specified by the INCIPNT FLT 1
DETECT WINDOW setting.
INCIPIENT FLT 1 TRIP COUNTS NUMBER — Selects the number of faults required to initiate a trip.
INCIPNT FLT 1 DETECT WINDOW — Specifies a time window for “Counts per window” mode of operation.
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 RESET DELAY — Specifies a reset time for the output after the trip is initiated.

Figure 5-164: Incipient cable fault detector logic


SETTING
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 FUNCTION
= Enabled SETTINGS
= Disabled INCIPNT FLT 1 MODE
INCIPIENT FLT 1 TRIP SETTINGS
AND COUNTS NUMBER
SETTING INCIPIENT FAULT 1
SETTING INCIPNT FLT 1 DETECT RESET DELAY
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 BLOCK
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 WINDOW FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
= OFF 0
PICKUP RUN INCIPNT FLT 1 OP A
RUN Detection logic TRST INCIPNT FLT 1 OP B
SETTING
0 INCIPNT FLT 1 OP C
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 SOURCE
INCIPNT FLT 1 OP
= IA TWINDOW TRST OR

= IB 0
= IC
Imag – Imag
´ > PICKUP TRST
= IN
where Imag
´ is 2 cycles old FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
INCIPNT FLT 1 PKP A
INCIPNT FLT 1 PKP B
INCIPNT FLT 1 PKP C
OR INCIPNT FLT 1 PKP

5 ACTUAL VALUES
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 PH A
FAULTS
INCIPIENT FAULT 1 PH B
FAULTS
COMMAND INCIPIENT FAULT 1 PH C
CLEAR INCIPIENT FAULT FAULTS
COUNTERS
RESET
= Yes
832028A1.CDR

5.8.10.5 VT fuse failure


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS  VT FUSE FAILURE 1(6)
 VT FUSE FAILURE 1 VT FUSE FAILURE 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

VT FUSE FAILURE 1 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 ALARM DELAY: 1.000 s

NEUTRAL WIRE OPEN 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 DETECTION: Disabled

NEUTRAL WIRE OPEN 1 Range: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 3 HARM PKP: 0.100 pu

Every signal source includes a fuse failure scheme.


The VT fuse failure detector is used to raise an alarm and/or block elements that operate incorrectly for a full or partial loss
of AC potential caused by one or more blown fuses. Some elements that can be blocked (via the BLOCK input) are distance,
voltage restrained overcurrent, and directional current.
There are two classes of fuse failure that occur:
• Class A — Loss of one or two phases
• Class B — Loss of all three phases

5-300 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

Different means of detection are required for each class. An indication of class A failures is a significant level of negative-
sequence voltage, whereas an indication of class B failures is when positive sequence current is present and there is an
insignificant amount of positive sequence voltage. Also, a rapid decrease in the phase voltages magnitude from a healthy
voltage level without disturbance in current can indicate VT fuse fail conditions. These noted indications of fuse failure can
also be present when faults are present on the system, so a means of detecting faults and inhibiting fuse failure
declarations during these events is provided.
Once the fuse failure condition is declared, it is sealed-in until the cause that generated it disappears.
An additional condition is introduced to inhibit a fuse failure declaration when the monitored circuit is de-energized;
positive-sequence voltage and current are both below threshold levels.
VT FUSE FAILURE 1 FUNCTION — Enables and disables the fuse failure feature for Source 1 VT Fuse Fail.
NEUTRAL WIRE OPEN 1 DETECTION — Enables and disables the VT neutral wire open detection function. When the VT is
connected in Delta, do not enable this function because there is no neutral wire for Delta connected VT.
NEUTRAL WIRE OPEN 1 3 HRAM PKP — Specifies the pickup level of 3rd harmonic of 3V0 signal for the NEUTRAL WIRE OPEN
DETECTION logic to pick up.
Base voltage for this element is PHASE VT SECONDARY setting in the case of WYE VTs and (PHASE VT SECONDARY)/ in case
of DELTA VTs. The setting is found under SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  AC INPUTS  VOLTAGE BANK  PHASE VT SECONDARY.
Figure 5-165: VT fuse fail logic
SETTING VA’, VB’ and VC’ are the
Function voltage magnitude of one OR
Enabled = 1 cycle before
AND
COMPARATORS FAULT
Run
|VA’|-|VA| > 0.2 pu
& |VA’| > 0.8 pu
Run

5
|VB’|-|VB| > 0.2 pu OR
SOURCE 1 & |VB’| > 0.8 pu SETTING
VA Run VT FUSE FAILURE 1
|VC’|-|VC| > 0.2 pu ALARM DELAY
VB & |VC’| > 0.8 pu FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
tPKP
VC Run SRC1 VT FF ALARM
0
V_2 V_2 > 0.1 pu OR

V_1 Run
I_1 V_1 < 0.05 pu
AND FUSE
Run
FAIL
I_1 > 0.075 pu
TIMER
Run 2 cycles SET
TIMER AND OR
V_1 < 0.80 pu 0
2 cycles
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Run AND
I_1 < 0.05 pu Latch SRC1 VT FUSE FAIL OP
20 cycles
SRC1 VT FUSE FAIL DPO
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SRC1 50DD OP
OPEN POLE OP
The OPEN POLE OP operand applies
to the C60, D60, L60, L90, and N60 AND
TIMER
OR 30 cycles RESET
AND 0
Reset-dominant

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND SRC1 VT FUSE FAIL VOL LOSS

TIMER
SETTING 5 cycles
AND
3 HARM PKP
0
AND Run FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING 3V_0 3rd Harm >setting OR SRC1 VT NEU WIRE OPEN
TIMER
Neutral Wire Open Detect
0
Enabled = 1
AND 20 cycles

SOURCE 1 FLEX-ANALOG
3V_0 (3rd Harmonic) SRC1 3V0 3nd Harmonic

842235A1.vsd

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-301


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.8.10.6 Thermal overload protection (ANSI 49)


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS  THERMAL OVERLOAD PROTECTION 
THERMAL PROTECTION 1(2)
 THERMAL THERMAL PROTECTION 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
 PROTECTION 1  FUNCTION: Disabled

THERMAL PROTECTION 1 Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6


 SOURCE: SRC1

THERMAL PROTECTION 1 Range: 0.20 to 3.00 pu in steps of 0.01


 BASE CURR: 0.80 pu

THERMAL PROTECTION 1 Range: 1.00 to 1.20 in steps of 0.05


 k FACTOR: 1.10

THERM PROT 1 TRIP Range: 0 to 1000 min. in steps of 1


 TIME CONST: 45 min

THERM PROT 1 RESET Range: 0 to 1000 min. in steps of 1


 TIME CONST: 45 min

THERM PROT 1 MINIM Range: 0 to 1000 min. in steps of 1


 RESET TIME: 20 min

THERM PROT 1 RESET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

THERM PROT 1 BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

5  THERMAL PROTECTION 1
TARGET: Self-reset
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled

THERMAL PROTECTION 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The thermal overload protection element corresponds to the IEC 255-8 standard and is used to detect thermal overload
conditions in protected power system elements. Choosing an appropriate time constant element can be used to protect
different elements of the power system. The cold curve characteristic is applied when the estimated Ip current is less than
10% of the base current. If Ip current is greater or equal than 10% than the base current, then the hot curve characteristic
is applied. Ip current is estimated with a fixed time constant for both cooling and heating that reaches to the final value in
two seconds on a step change (either step up or step down) signal.
The IEC255-8 cold curve is defined as follows:

Eq. 5-23

The IEC255-8 hot curve is defined as follows:

Eq. 5-24

where
top = time to operate
τop = thermal protection trip time constant
I = measured overload RMS current
Ip = measured load RMS current before overload occurs
k = IEC 255-8 k-factor applied to IB, defining maximum permissible current above nominal current
IB = protected element base (nominal) current
To ensure element accuracy for high overcurrent conditions, the maximum value of I/(k x IB) is limited to 8, even when
realistically it is exceeding this value.

5-302 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

The reset time of the thermal overload protection element is also time delayed using following formula:

Eq. 5-25

where
τrst = thermal protection trip time constant
Tmin = a minimum reset time setting
Figure 5-166: IEC 255-8 sample operate and reset curves
100

Tmin = 10

10

τrst = 30
τop = 30

5
t (min)

0.1

0.01
0.1 1 10 100
I / Ipkp
827724A1.CDR

The thermal overload protection element estimates accumulated thermal energy E using the following equations
calculated each power cycle. When current is greater than the pickup level, In > k × IB, element starts increasing the
thermal energy:

Eq. 5-26

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-303


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

When current is less than the dropout level, In > 0.97 × k × IB, the element starts decreasing the thermal energy:

Eq. 5-27

where
∆t is the power cycle duration
n is the power cycle index
top(In) is the trip time calculated at index n as per the IEC255-8 cold curve or hot curve equations
trst(In) is the reset time calculated at index n as per the reset time equation
In is the measured overload RMS current at index n
En is the accumulated energy at index n
En – 1 is the accumulated energy at index n – 1
The thermal overload protection element removes the THERMAL PROT 1 OP output operand when E < 0.05. In case of
emergency, the thermal memory and THERMAL PROT 1 OP output operand can be reset using THERM PROT 1 RESET setting. All
calculations are performed per phase. If the accumulated energy reaches value 1 in any phase, the thermal overload
protection element operates and only resets when energy is less than 0.05 in all three phases.
Table 5-34: Typical time constants
Protected equipment Time constant Minimum reset time
Capacitor bank 10 minutes 30 minutes
Overhead line 10 minutes 20 minutes
Air-core reactor 40 minutes 30 minutes
Busbar 60 minutes 20 minutes
5 Underground cable 20 to 60 minutes 60 minutes

The figure shows the logic for the thermal overload protection element.
Figure 5-167: Thermal overload protection logic
SETTINGS
Function
Enabled = 1
Block AND
Off = 0

SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


SETTING Base Current AND THERMAL PROT 1 PKP
Source K Factor
IA RMS IA > k × Ib SETTING
IB RMS IB > k × Ib OR Trip Time Constant
IC RMS IC > k × Ib RUN

LOAD CURRENT ESTIMATION E > 0.1 S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND


IApn
Latch THERMAL PROT 1 OP
IBpn
R
ICpn
Reset-dominant

SETTINGS
Reset Time Constant
Minimum Reset Time
RUN

E < 0.1

SETTING
Reset
Off = 0 Reset E to 0
827013A3.CDR

5-304 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

5.8.10.7 Broken conductor detection


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  MONITORING ELEMENTS  BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1(6)
 BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6


 SOURCE: SRC 1

BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Range: 20.0% to 100.0% in steps of 0.1%


 I2/I1 RATIO: 20%

BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Range: 0.05 to 1.00 pu in steps of 0.01


 I1 MIN: 0.10 pu

BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Range: 0.05 to 5.00 pu in steps of 0.01


 I1 MAX: 1.50 pu

BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001


 PKP DELAY: 20.000 s

BROKEN CONDCT 1 BLK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The broken conductor function detects a transmission line broken conductor condition or a single-pole breaker
malfunction condition by checking the phase current input signals and the I_2 / I_1 ratio. The intent is to detect a single-
phase broken conductor only. As such, two-phase or three-phase broken conductors cannot be detected.
5
To distinguish between single-phase disappearance and system disturbance in all three phases (such as load change and
switching), the broken conductor element monitors the change in all three phase currents at the present instance and at
four cycles previous. It also monitors changes in the I_2 / I_1 ratio, I_1 minimum, and I_1 maximum.
Do not use the broken conductor function to respond to fault transients and single-pole tripping/reclosing conditions.
Therefore, program the time delay to a sufficient length to ensure coordination with the breaker dead time of the recloser
function.
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the broken conductor function.
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 SOURCE — Selects a signal source used to provide three-phase current inputs to this function.
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 I2/I1 RATIO — This setting specifies the ratio of negative-sequence current to positive-sequence
current. When one phase conductor is broken, the I_2 / I_1 ratio with a balanced remaining two phases is 50%. So
normally you this setting below 50% (for example, to 30%).
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 I1 MIN — This setting specifies the minimum positive-sequence current supervision level. Ensure this
setting is programmed to a sufficient level to prevent I_2 / I_1 from erratic pickup due to a low I_1 signal. However, do not
set this setting too high, since the broken conductor condition cannot be detected under light load conditions when I_1 is
less than the value specified by this setting.
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 I1 MAX — This setting specifies the maximum I_1 level allowed for the broken conductor function to
operate. When I_1 exceeds this setting, this it is considered a fault. In order for this function to not respond to any fault
conditions, set this setting to less than the maximum load current.
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 PKP DELAY — This setting specifies the pickup time delay for this function to operate after assertion
of the broken conductor pickup FlexLogic operand.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-305


5

5-306
CONTROL ELEMENTS

SETTINGS
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
BROKEN CONDCT 1 BLK: AND
SETTINGS
Off = 0
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1
I1 MAX:

BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1
SETTING I2/I1 RATIO:
SETTINGS
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1 Run
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1
SOURCE: I1 MIN:
|I1 | < I1 MAX SETTING
I2 Run |I2| / |I1| > RATIO
BROKEN CONDUCTOR 1
I1 |I1 > I1 MIN I1 MAX:
Ia |Ia| < I1 MIN FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
tPKP
|Ib| < I1 MIN AND BROKEN CONDUCT 1 OP
Ib AND
0
Ic |Ic| < I1 MIN
|Ia’| - |Ia| > 0.05 pu
Ic
|Ib’| - |Ib| > 0.05 pu 2 cyc
AND OR
|Ic’| - |Ic| > 0.05 pu
0 OR
Where I’ is four cycles old
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BROKEN CONDUCT 1 PKP
AND
Figure 5-168: Broken conductor detection logic

One phase current


loss detection 832030A1.cdr

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS
CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

5.8.11 Cold load pickup


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  COLD LOAD PICKUP  COLD LOAD PICKUP 1(6)
 COLD LOAD PICKUP 1 COLD LOAD 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

COLD LOAD 1 PICKUP Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
 SOURCE: SRC 1

COLD LOAD 1 INIT: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

COLD LOAD 1 BLK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

OUTAGE TIME BEFORE Range: 0 to 1000 s in steps of 1


 COLD LOAD1: 1000 s

ON-LOAD TIME BEFORE Range: 0.000 to 1000 000.000 s in steps of 0.001


 RESET1: 100.000

Cold load is the restoration of current into the system after being off. A cold load condition can be caused by a prolonged
outage of the load, by opening of the circuit breaker, or by a loss of supply even if the breaker remains closed. Upon the
return of the source, the circuit experiences inrush current into connected transformers, accelerating currents into motors,
and simultaneous demand from many other loads because the normal load diversity has been lost.
This feature can be used to change protection element settings when (by changing to another settings group) a cold load
condition is expected to occur. During the cold load condition, the current level can be above the pickup setting of some
protection elements, so this feature can be used to prevent the tripping that is otherwise caused by the normal settings.
Without historical data on a particular feeder, some utilities assume an initial cold load current of about 500% of normal
load, decaying to 300% after 1 second, 200% after 2 seconds, and 150% after 3 seconds.
5
Figure 5-169: Typical cold load pickup characteristics
500
Current (% of normal)

400

300
NORMAL TRIP SETTING
200
X
PICKUP PICKUP
100
OUTAGE
0
-1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
time (seconds)
LOAD ENERGIZED 832760A1.CDR

There are two methods to initiate operation of this feature.


The first initiation method is automatic response to a loss of the source to the feeder, by detecting that all phase currents
have declined to zero for some time. When zero current on all phases has been detected, a timer starts. This timer is set to
an interval after which it is expected the normal load diversity has been lost, so setting groups are not changed for short
duration outages. After the delay interval, the output operand is set.
The second initiation method is automatic response to an event that sets an operand, such as an operator-initiated virtual
input. This second method of initiation sets the output operand immediately.
Both initiating inputs can be inhibited by a blocking input. Once cold load pickup is in operation, the output operand
remains set until at least one phase of the load has returned to a level above 2% of CT nominal for the interval
programmed by the ON-LOAD TIME BEFORE RESET setting has expired. The reset delay interval is intended to be set to a
period until the feeder load has decayed to normal levels, after which other features can be used to switch setting groups.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-307


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Figure 5-170: Cold load pickup logic

SETTING
COLD LOAD PICKUP
AND
FUNCTION:
Enabled

SETTING
AND
COLD LOAD PICKUP 1
BLK:
Off

SETTING OR

COLD LOAD PICKUP


SOURCE:
RUN
SETTING
IA IA < 2% NOMINAL CT OUTAGE TIME BEFORE
COLD LOAD 1:
RUN
IB IB < 2% NOMINAL CT AND 1000

RUN FLEXLOGIC-OPERAND
IC IC < 2% NOMINAL CT
OR CLD LOAD OP1

SETTING
COLD LOAD PICKUP 1
AND SETTING
INIT: RUN
IA > 2% NOMINAL CT ON-LOAD TIME BEFORE
Off
RESET 1:
RUN
OR 100
IB > 2% NOMINAL CT
RUN
IC > 2% NOMINAL CT
827064A6.CDR

5 5.8.12 PID regulator


SETTINGS  CONTROL ELEMENTS  PID REGULATOR  PID 1(4) REGULATOR
 PID 1 PID 1 Range: Enabled, Disabled
 REGULATOR  FUNCTION: Disabled

PID 1 SAMPLE TIME: Range: 0.05 to 30.00 s in steps of 0.01


 0.05 s

PID 1 PROCESS Range: Off, any FlexAnalog parameter


 SIGNAL: Off

PID 1 SETPOINT Range: -99999.99 to 99999.99 in steps of 0.01


 SIGNAL: 0.00

PID 1 TRACKING SIGNAL: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog parameter


 Off

PID 1 PROPORTIONAL Range: 0.01 to 100.00 in steps of 0.01


 GAIN: 1.00

PID 1 SETPOINT Range: 0.01 to 1.00 in steps of 0.01


 WEIGHTING: 1.00

PID 1 INTEG. TIME Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 CONST.: 1.00 sec

PID 1 ANTIWINDUP: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Disabled

PID 1 AW TIME CONST.: Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 1.00 sec

PID 1 DERIV. TIME Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01


 CONST.: 1.00 s

5-308 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS

PID 1 DERIVATIVE Range: 1 to 20 in steps of 1


 LIMIT: 10

PID 1 MAX: Range: -10000 to 10000 in steps of 1


 10

PID 1 MIN: Range: -10000 to 10000 in steps of 1


 10

PID 1 Tmin: Range: 100 to 1000 ms in steps of 1


 500 ms

PID 1 DEAD TIME: Range: 1 to 20 s in steps of 1


 1.00 sec

PID 1 BLK: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

PID 1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled


 TARGET: Self-reset

PID 1 Range: Enabled, Disabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The F35 is provided with this optional feature, specified as an option at the time of ordering. Using the order
code for your device, see the order codes in chapter 2 for details.

The figure shows a general form of a PID regulator in the s domain.


Figure 5-171: PID block diagram
5
+ p
b K
+
+
sKTd d +
y -1 u
1+sTd/N
+
-
+ e K + 1 i
r
Ti s
+

1
Tt

+ -
w
832031A1.cdr

where
y is the process signal
r is the setpoint signal
w is the tracking signal
u is the regulator output
K is the proportional gain
b is the setpoint weighting
Td is the derivative time constant

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-309


CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

N is the derivative limit


Ti is the integral time constant
Tt is the anti-windup time constant
s is the domain
In discrete form, the equations for the regulator are

Eq. 5-28

where
TS is the sampling time
AW is a flag which enables anti-windup
The incremental form of this equation is:

Eq. 5-29

where

Eq. 5-30

The figure shows the PID regulator logic.


Figure 5-172: PID regulator logic

SETTING SETTING
u>0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FUNCTION: DEAD TIME:
AND PID 1 LOWER
Enabled = 1 Tdead
u > Tmin AND
|u| ms
SETTING AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BLOCKED: AND PID 1 RAISE
Off = 0 SETTING u<0

Ts, K, b,
SETTING Ti, Tt, Td, N
Run FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
ANTIWINDUP: u
PID 1 DELTA OUT
Enabled = 1 AW

PID
SETTING
PROCESS SIGNAL: SETTING
SETPOINT SIGNAL: max, min ACTUAL VALUE
u
TRACKING SIGNAL: Out=MAX(min,MIN(max,u)) PID 1 OUT

ACTUAL VALUE
SETPOINT
832029A1.cdr

5-310 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS

5.9 Inputs/outputs
5.9.1 Contact inputs
SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  CONTACT INPUTS
 CONTACT INPUTS

 CONTACT INPUT H5a


 

CONTACT INPUT H5a ID: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric


 Cont Ip 1 characters

CONTACT INPUT H5a Range: 0.0 to 16.0 ms in steps of 0.5


 DEBNCE TIME: 6.0 ms

CONTACT INPUT H5a Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

 CONTACT INPUT xxx
 

 CONTACT INPUT
  THRESHOLDS

Ips H5a,H5c,H6a,H6c Range: 17, 33, 84, 166 Vdc


 THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc

Ips H7a,H7c,H8a,H8c Range: 17, 33, 84, 166 Vdc


5
 THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc

Ips xxx,xxx,xxx,xxx Range: 17, 33, 84, 166 Vdc
 THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc

A contact inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with connections to hard-wired contacts. Wet and dry contacts
are supported.
The contact inputs menu contains configuration settings for each contact input as well as voltage thresholds for each
group of four contact inputs. Upon startup, the relay processor determines (from an assessment of the installed modules)
which contact inputs are available and then display settings for only those inputs.
An alphanumeric ID can be assigned to a contact input for diagnostic, setting, and event recording purposes. The CONTACT
IP X On (Logic 1) FlexLogic operand corresponds to contact input “X” being closed, while CONTACT IP X Off corresponds to
contact input “X” being open. The CONTACT INPUT DEBNCE TIME defines the time required for the contact to overcome
‘contact bouncing’ conditions. As this time differs for different contact types and manufacturers, set it as a maximum
contact debounce time (per manufacturer specifications) plus some margin to ensure proper operation. If CONTACT INPUT
EVENTS is set to “Enabled,” every change in the contact input state triggers an event.
A raw status is scanned for all Contact Inputs synchronously at the constant rate of 0.5 ms as shown in the following
figure. The DC input voltage is compared to a user-settable threshold. A new contact input state must be maintained for a
user-settable debounce time in order for the F35 to validate the new contact state. In the following figure, the debounce
time is set at 2.5 ms; thus the 6th sample in a row validates the change of state (mark no. 1 in the diagram). Once validated
(de-bounced), the contact input asserts a corresponding FlexLogic operand and logs an event as per user setting.
A time stamp of the first sample in the sequence that validates the new state is used when logging the change of the
contact input into the Event Recorder (mark no. 2 in the figure).

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-311


INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Protection and control elements, as well as FlexLogic equations and timers, are executed eight times in a power system
cycle. The protection pass duration is controlled by the frequency tracking mechanism. The FlexLogic operand reflecting
the debounced state of the contact is updated at the protection pass following the validation (marks no. 3 and 4 on the
figure that follows). The update is performed at the beginning of the protection pass so all protection and control functions,
as well as FlexLogic equations, are fed with the updated states of the contact inputs.
The FlexLogic operand response time to the contact input change is equal to the debounce time setting plus up to one
protection pass (variable and depending on system frequency if frequency tracking enabled). If the change of state occurs
just after a protection pass, the recognition is delayed until the subsequent protection pass; that is, by the entire duration
of the protection pass. If the change occurs just prior to a protection pass, the state is recognized immediately. Statistically
a delay of half the protection pass is expected. Owing to the 0.5 ms scan rate, the time resolution for the input contact is
below 1 ms.
For example, eight protection passes per cycle on a 60 Hz system correspond to a protection pass every 2.1 ms. With a
contact debounce time setting of 3.0 ms, the FlexLogic operand-assert time limits are: 3.0 + 0.0 = 3.0 ms and 3.0 + 2.1 = 5.1
ms. These time limits depend on how soon the protection pass runs after the debouncing time.
Regardless of the contact debounce time setting, the contact input event is time-stamped with a 1 s accuracy using the
time of the first scan corresponding to the new state (mark no. 2 shown). Therefore, the time stamp reflects a change in the
DC voltage across the contact input terminals that was not accidental as it was subsequently validated using the
debounce timer. Keep in mind that the associated FlexLogic operand is asserted/de-asserted later, after validating the
change.
The debounce algorithm is symmetrical: the same procedure and debounce time are used to filter the LOW-HIGH (marks
no.1, 2, 3, and 4 in the figure) and HIGH-LOW (marks no. 5, 6, 7, and 8) transitions.
Figure 5-173: Input contact debouncing mechanism and time stamp sample timing

5
VOLTAGE
INPUT

USER-PROGRAMMABLE THRESHOLD

6
2 1 3 5
Time stamp of the first
TM
Time stamp of the first At this time, the The FlexLogic scan corresponding to the
At this time, the new
scan corresponding to new (HIGH) operand is going to new validated state is
(LOW) contact state is
the new validated state is contact state is be asserted at this logged in the SOE record
validated
logged in the SOE record validated protection pass

7
RAW CONTACT

The FlexLogicTM
operand is going to be
STATE

de-asserted at this
protection pass
DEBOUNCE TIME
(user setting)

4
The FlexLogicTM operand
DEBOUNCE TIME
The FlexLogicTM operand changes reflecting the
SCAN TIME (user setting)
changes reflecting the validated contact state
FLEXLOGICTM

(0.5 msec) validated contact state


OPERAND

PROTECTION PASS
(8 times a cycle controlled by the
frequency tracking mechanism)
842709A1.cdr

Contact inputs are isolated in groups of four to allow connection of wet contacts from different voltage sources for each
group. The CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLDS determine the minimum voltage required to detect a closed contact input. This
value is selected according to the following criteria: 17 for 24 V sources, 33 for 48 V sources, 84 for 110 to 125 V sources
and 166 for 250 V sources.
For example, to use contact input H5a as a status input from the breaker 52b contact to seal-in the trip relay and record it
in the Event Records menu, make the following settings changes:

5-312 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS

CONTACT INPUT H5a ID: "Breaker Closed (52b)"


CONTACT INPUT H5a EVENTS: "Enabled"
Note that the 52b contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is closed.

5.9.2 Virtual inputs


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  VIRTUAL INPUTS  VIRTUAL INPUT 1(64)
 VIRTUAL INPUT 1 VIRTUAL INPUT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

VIRTUAL INPUT 1 ID: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters


 Virt Ip 1

VIRTUAL INPUT 1 Range: Self-Reset, Latched


 TYPE: Latched

VIRTUAL INPUT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

The virtual inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with UR-series internal logic signals. Virtual inputs include
signals generated by the local user interface. The virtual outputs are outputs of FlexLogic equations used to customize the
device. Virtual outputs can also serve as virtual inputs to FlexLogic equations.
There are 64 virtual inputs that can be individually programmed to respond to input signals from the keypad (via the
COMMANDS menu) and communications protocols. All virtual input operands are defaulted to “Off” (logic 0) unless the
appropriate input signal is received.
If the VIRTUAL INPUT x FUNCTION is to “Disabled,” the input is forced to off (logic 0) regardless of any attempt to alter the
input. If set to “Enabled,” the input operates as shown on the logic diagram and generates output FlexLogic operands in
response to received input signals and the applied settings.
5
There are two types of operation: self-reset and latched. If VIRTUAL INPUT x type is “Self-Reset,” when the input signal
transits from off to on, the output operand is set to on for only one evaluation of the FlexLogic equations and then return to
off. If set to “Latched,” the virtual input sets the state of the output operand to the same state as the most recent received
input.
The self-reset operating mode generates the output operand for a single evaluation of the FlexLogic equations. If the
operand is to be used anywhere other than internally in a FlexLogic equation, it likely needs to be lengthened in time. A
FlexLogic timer with a delayed reset can perform this function.
Figure 5-174: Virtual inputs logic

SETTING
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled=1 S
AND
Latch
“Virtual Input 1 to ON = 1”
SETTING
“Virtual Input 1 to OFF = 0” R VIRTUAL INPUT 1 ID:
AND
SETTING (Flexlogic Operand)
OR
Virt Ip 1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
TYPE:
Latched AND
Self - Reset 827080A3.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-313


INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.9.3 Contact outputs

5.9.3.1 Digital outputs


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUT H1
 CONTACT OUTPUT H1 CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
  Cont Op 1

OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

CONTACT OUTPUT H1 Range: Disabled, Enabled


 EVENTS: Enabled

A contact inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with connections to hard-wired contacts. Wet and dry contacts
are supported.
Upon startup of the relay, the main processor determines from an assessment of the modules installed in the chassis
which contact outputs are available and then presents the settings for only these outputs. Where the contact input is non-
latching, the settings are as shown.
An ID can be assigned to each contact output. The signal that can OPERATE a contact output can be any FlexLogic
operand (virtual output, element state, contact input, or virtual input). An additional FlexLogic operand can be used to
SEAL-IN the relay. Any change of state of a contact output can be logged as an Event if programmed to do so.
For example, the trip circuit current is monitored by providing a current threshold detector in series with some Form-A
5 contacts (see the trip circuit example in the Digital Elements section). The monitor sets a flag (see the specifications for
Form-A). The name of the FlexLogic operand set by the monitor, consists of the output relay designation, followed by the
name of the flag; for example, Cont OP 1 IOn.
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact used to interrupt current
flow after the breaker has tripped, to prevent damage to the less robust initiating contact. This can be done by monitoring
an auxiliary contact on the breaker which opens when the breaker has tripped, but this scheme is subject to incorrect
operation caused by differences in timing between breaker auxiliary contact change-of-state and interruption of current in
the trip circuit. The most dependable protection of the initiating contact is provided by directly measuring current in the
tripping circuit, and using this parameter to control resetting of the initiating relay. This scheme is often called trip seal-in.
This can be realized using the Cont OP 1 IOn FlexLogic operand to seal-in the contact output as follows:
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID: “Cont Op 1"
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: any suitable FlexLogic operand
OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN: “Cont Op 1 IOn”
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 EVENTS: “Enabled”

Figure 5-175: Contact input/output module type 6A contact 1 logic


SETTING
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 OPERATE
= On FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR Cont Op 1 Closed
Cont Op 1 Ion
Cont Op 1 Von
Cont Op 1 Voff
SETTING
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN AND H1a
= On

H1b

H1c

859743A1.vsd

5-314 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS

5.9.3.2 Latching outputs


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUT H1a
 CONTACT OUTPUT H1a OUTPUT H1a ID Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
  L-Cont Op 1

OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

OUTPUT H1a RESET: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

OUTPUT H1a TYPE: Range: Operate-dominant, Reset-dominant


 Operate-dominant

OUTPUT H1a EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled


 Disabled

The latching output contacts are mechanically bi-stable and controlled by two separate (open and close) coils. As such
they retain their position even if the relay is not powered up. The relay recognizes all latching output contact cards and
populates the setting menu accordingly. On power up, the relay reads positions of the latching contacts from the hardware
before executing any other functions of the relay (such as protection and control features or FlexLogic).
The latching output modules, either as part of the relay or as individual modules, are shipped from the factory with all
latching contacts open. It is highly recommended to double-check the programming and positions of the latching contacts
when replacing a module.
Since the relay asserts the output contact and reads back its position, it is possible to incorporate self-monitoring
capabilities for the latching outputs. If any latching outputs exhibits a discrepancy, the LATCHING OUTPUT ERROR self-test
error is declared. The error is signaled by the LATCHING OUT ERROR FlexLogic operand, event, and target message.
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE — This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to operate the ‘close coil’ of the contact. The relay seals- 5
in this input to safely close the contact. Once the contact is closed and the RESET input is logic 0 (off), any activity of the
OPERATE input, such as subsequent chattering, does not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and RESET inputs active
(logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1a TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a RESET — This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to operate the ‘trip coil’ of the contact. The relay seals-in
this input to safely open the contact. Once the contact is opened and the OPERATE input is logic 0 (off), any activity of the
RESET input, such as subsequent chattering, does not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and RESET inputs active (logic
1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1a TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a TYPE — This setting specifies the contact response under conflicting control inputs; that is, when both the
OPERATE and RESET signals are applied. With both control inputs applied simultaneously, the contact closes if set to
“Operate-dominant” and opens if set to “Reset-dominant.”
Figure 5-176: Contact input/output module type 4L contact 1 logic

SETTING
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a Non-volatile,
OPERATE = On Set-dominant
AND S
SETTING OR Latch On
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a TYPE Close
= Operate-dominant R
H1b
= Reset-dominant
Non-volatile,
SETTING OR Set-dominant
H1a
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a RESET AND S
= On Open
Latch
R

FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Cont Op 1 Closed

859744A1.vsd

Application example 1
A latching output contact H1a is to be controlled from two user-programmable pushbuttons (buttons number 1 and 2). The
following settings are applied.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-315


INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  CONTACT
OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
OUTPUT H1a RESET: “PUSHBUTTON 2 ON”
Program the pushbuttons by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP  USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS
 USER PUSHBUTTON 1 and USER PUSHBUTTON 2 menus:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: “Self-reset”
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: “0.00 s”
PUSHBUTTON 2 FUNCTION: “Self-reset”
PUSHBTN 2 DROP-OUT TIME: “0.00 s”

Application example 2
A relay, having two latching contacts H1a and H1c, is to be programmed. The H1a contact is to be a Type-a contact, while
the H1c contact is to be a Type-b contact (Type-a means closed after exercising the operate input; Type-b means closed
after exercising the reset input). The relay is to be controlled from virtual outputs: VO1 to operate and VO2 to reset.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  CONTACT
OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: “VO1”
OUTPUT H1a RESET: “VO2”
OUTPUT H1c OPERATE: “VO2”
OUTPUT H1c RESET: “VO1”
Since the two physical contacts in this example are mechanically separated and have individual control inputs, they do not
operate at exactly the same time. A discrepancy in the range of a fraction of a maximum operating time can occur.
5 Therefore, a pair of contacts programmed to be a multi-contact relay do not guarantee any specific sequence of operation
(such as make before break). If required, the sequence of operation must be programmed explicitly by delaying some of the
control inputs as shown in the next application example.

Application example 3
A make before break functionality must be added to the preceding example. An overlap of 20 ms is required to implement
this functionality.
Write the following FlexLogic equation (EnerVista example shown).

Set both timers (Timer 1 and Timer 2) to 20 ms pickup and 0 ms dropout.


Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  CONTACT
OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: “VO1”
OUTPUT H1a RESET: “VO4”
OUTPUT H1c OPERATE: “VO2”
OUTPUT H1c RESET: “VO3”

5-316 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS

Application example 4
A latching contact H1a is to be controlled from a single virtual output VO1. The contact is to remain closed as long as VO1
is high, and is to remain opened when VO1 is low. Program the relay as follows.
Write the following FlexLogic equation (EnerVista example shown).

Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  CONTACT
OUTPUTS  CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: “VO1”
OUTPUT H1a RESET: “VO2”

5.9.4 Virtual outputs


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  VIRTUAL OUTPUTS  VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1(96)
 VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
  VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 ID
Virt Op 1
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
5
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
 EVENTS: Disabled

The virtual inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with UR-series internal logic signals. Virtual inputs include
signals generated by the local user interface. The virtual outputs are outputs of FlexLogic equations used to customize the
device. Virtual outputs can also serve as virtual inputs to FlexLogic equations.
There are 96 virtual outputs that can be assigned using FlexLogic. If not assigned, the output is forced to ‘OFF’ (Logic 0). An
ID also can be assigned to each virtual output. Virtual outputs are resolved in each pass through the evaluation of the
FlexLogic equations. Any change of state of a virtual output can be logged as an event if programmed to do so.
For example, if Virtual Output 1 is the trip signal from FlexLogic and the trip relay is used to signal events, the settings is
programmed as follows:
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 ID: "Trip"
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 EVENTS: "Disabled"

5.9.5 Resetting

5.9.5.1 Enhanced and basic front panels


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  RESETTING
 RESETTING RESET OPERAND: Range: FlexLogic operand
  Off

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-317


INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.9.5.2 Graphical front panel


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  RESETTING
 RESETTING RESET OPERAND: Range: FlexLogic operand
  Off

RESET ANNUNCIATOR: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

Some events can be programmed to latch the front panel LED event indicators, target messages, and/or graphical front
panel annunciator windows. Once set, the latching mechanism holds the latched indicators, messages, or windows in the
set state after the initiating condition has cleared until a RESET command is received to return these latches (not including
FlexLogic latches) to the reset state where the initiating condition has cleared. The RESET command can be sent from the
front panel RESET button, a remote device via a communications channel, or any selected operand. The Modbus execute
function 05h with operation code 1 command is also available to perform the same function as the front panel RESET key.
RESET OPERAND — The three sources of RESET commands each activates the RESET OP FlexLogic operand. Each individual
source of a RESET command also activates its individual operand RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON), RESET OP (COMMS), or RESET OP
(OPERAND) to identify the source of the command. Each of these three operands generates an event in the event record
when activated. The RESET OPERAND setting here selects the operand that activates the RESET OP (OPERAND) operand.
RESET ANNUNCIATOR — Used to select a FlexLogic operand that when activated acknowledges/resets all annunciator
windows on the graphical front panel. The other methods to acknowledge/reset annunciator windows include:
• On the displayed page, press the RESET pushbutton with none of the annunciator windows selected to acknowledge/
reset all annunciator windows on that page
• To acknowledge/reset a specific annunciator window, use the Up, Down, Left and Right pushbuttons to select the
window, and press the RESET or ENTER pushbutton
5 • All annunciator windows can be reset remotely by programming a Virtual Input (for example Virtual Input 1) as the
input to the RESET ANNUNCIATOR setting. Then the Modbus execute function 05h with operation code 1000h command
(or function 10h with address 400h) is used to set the state of Virtual Input 1.
For the RESET ANNUNCIATOR setting, the RESET ANCTR OP FlexLogic operand is activated by the two sources of RESET
command, operand source and manual source. Each individual source of a RESET ANNUNCIATOR command also activates
its individual operand RESET OP (OPRD) or RESET ANCTR OP (MNUL) to identify the source of the command. Each of these two
operands generates an event in the event record when activated. The setting here selects the operand that activates the
RESET ANCTR OP (OPRD) operand. The RESET pushbutton on the front panel or the reset command from the software
activates the RESET ANCTR OP (MNUL) operand.

5.9.6 Direct inputs and outputs

5.9.6.1 Direct inputs


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  DIRECT INPUTS  DIRECT INPUT 1(32)
 DIRECT INPUT 1 DIRECT INPUT 1 Range: up to 12 alphanumeric characters
  NAME: Dir Ip 1

DIRECT INPUT 1 Range: 0 to 16


 DEVICE ID: 0

DIRECT INPUT 1 Range: 0 to 32


 BIT NUMBER: 0

DIRECT INPUT 1 Range: On, Off, Latest/On, Latest/Off


 DEFAULT: Off

DIRECT INPUT 1 Range: Enabled, Disabled


 EVENTS: Disabled

These settings specify how the direct input information is processed.


DIRECT INPUT 1 NAME — This setting allows the user to assign a descriptive name to the direct input.

5-318 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS

DIRECT INPUT 1 DEVICE ID — Represents the source of direct input 1. The specified direct input is driven by the device
identified here.
DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER — The bit number to extract the state for direct input 1. Direct Input 1 is driven by the bit
identified as DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER. This corresponds to the direct output number of the sending device.
DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE — Represents the state of the direct input when the associated direct device is offline. The
following choices are available:
• On — Defaults the input to Logic 1
• Off — Defaults the input to Logic 0
• Latest/On — Freezes the input in case of lost communications. When the latest state is not known, such as after relay
power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input defaults to Logic 1. When communication resumes,
the input becomes fully operational.
• Latest/Off — Freezes the input in case of lost communications. When the latest state is not known, such as after relay
power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input defaults to Logic 0. When communication resumes,
the input becomes fully operational.

5.9.6.2 Direct outputs


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  DIRECT OUTPUTS  DIRECT OUTPUT 1(32)
 DIRECT OUTPUT 1 DIRECT OUT 1 NAME: Range: up to 12 alphanumeric characters
  Dir Out 1

DIRECT OUT 1 OPERAND: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

DIRECT OUTPUT 1 Range: Enabled, Disabled


 EVENTS: Disabled 5
DIRECT OUT 1 NAME — This setting allows the user to assign a descriptive name to the direct output.
DIR OUT 1 OPERAND — This sets the FlexLogic operand that determines the state of this direct output.

5.9.6.3 Application examples


The examples introduced in the earlier Direct Inputs and Outputs section (part of the Product Setup section) are continued
here to illustrate usage of the direct inputs and outputs.

Example 1: Extending input/output capabilities of a UR relay


Consider an application that requires additional quantities of contact inputs or output contacts or lines of programmable
logic that exceed the capabilities of a single UR-series chassis. The problem is solved by adding an extra UR-series IED,
such as the C30, to satisfy the additional inputs/outputs and programmable logic requirements. The figure shows that two
IEDs are connected via single-channel digital communication cards.
Figure 5-177: Input and output extension via direct inputs and outputs

TX1
UR IED 1
RX1

TX1
UR IED 2
RX1

842711A1.CDR

Assume that contact input 1 from UR IED 2 is to be used by UR IED 1. The following settings are applied (Direct Input 5 and
bit number 12 are used, as an example).
UR IED 1:

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-319


INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

DIRECT INPUT 5 DEVICE ID = “2”


DIRECT INPUT 5 BIT NUMBER = “12”
UR IED 2:
DIRECT OUT 12 OPERAND = “Cont Ip 1 On”
The Cont Ip 1 On operand of UR IED 2 is now available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 5 ON.

Example 2: Interlocking busbar protection


A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme can be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3 and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown in the figure.
Figure 5-178: Sample interlocking busbar protection scheme

UR IED 1 BLOCK

UR IED 2 UR IED 3 UR IED 4

842712A1.CDR

5 Assume that Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 is used by Devices 2, 3, and 4 to block Device 1. If not blocked, Device 1
trips the bus upon detecting a fault and applying a short coordination time delay.
The following settings are applied (assume Bit 3 is used by all 3 devices to send the blocking signal and Direct Inputs 7, 8,
and 9 are used by the receiving device to monitor the three blocking signals).
UR IED 2:
DIRECT OUT 3 OPERAND: "PHASE IOC1 OP"
UR IED 3:
DIRECT OUT 3 OPERAND: "PHASE IOC1 OP"
UR IED 4:
DIRECT OUT 3 OPERAND: "PHASE IOC1 OP"
UR IED 1:
DIRECT INPUT 7 DEVICE ID: "2"
DIRECT INPUT 7 BIT NUMBER: "3"
DIRECT INPUT 7 DEFAULT STATE: select "On" for security, select "Off" for dependability

DIRECT INPUT 8 DEVICE ID: "3"


DIRECT INPUT 8 BIT NUMBER: "3"
DIRECT INPUT 8 DEFAULT STATE: select "On" for security, select "Off" for dependability

DIRECT INPUT 9 DEVICE ID: "4"


DIRECT INPUT 9 BIT NUMBER: "3"
DIRECT INPUT 9 DEFAULT STATE: select "On" for security, select "Off" for dependability
Now the three blocking signals are available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 7 ON, DIRECT INPUT 8 ON, and DIRECT INPUT 9 ON. Upon
losing communications or a device, the scheme is inclined to block (if any default state is set to “On”), or to trip the bus on
any overcurrent condition (all default states set to “Off”).

5-320 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS

Example 3: Pilot-aided schemes


Consider a three-terminal line protection application shown in the following figure.
Figure 5-179: Three-terminal line application

UR IED 1 UR IED 2

UR IED 3 842713A1.CDR

Assume the Hybrid Permissive Overreaching Transfer Trip (Hybrid POTT) scheme is applied using the architecture shown as
follows. The scheme output operand HYB POTT TX1 is used to key the permission.
Figure 5-180: Single-channel open-loop configuration

TX1 RX1 RX2


UR IED 1 UR IED 2
RX1 TX1 TX2

5
RX1
UR IED 3
TX1
842714A1.CDR

In this architecture, Devices 1 and 3 do not communicate directly. Therefore, Device 2 must act as a ‘bridge’. The following
settings are applied:
UR IEC 1:
DIRECT OUT 2 OPERAND: "HYB POTT TX1"
DIRECT INPUT 5 DEVICE ID: "2"
DIRECT INPUT 5 BIT NUMBER: "2" (this is a message from IED 2)
DIRECT INPUT 6 DEVICE ID: "2"
DIRECT INPUT 6 BIT NUMBER: "4" (effectively, this is a message from IED 3)
UR IED 3:
DIRECT OUT 2 OPERAND: "HYB POTT TX1"
DIRECT INPUT 5 DEVICE ID: "2"
DIRECT INPUT 5 BIT NUMBER: "2" (this is a message from IED 2)
DIRECT INPUT 6 DEVICE ID: "2"
DIRECT INPUT 6 BIT NUMBER: "3" (effectively, this is a message from IED 1)
UR IED 2:
DIRECT INPUT 5 DEVICE ID: "1"
DIRECT INPUT 5 BIT NUMBER: "2"
DIRECT INPUT 6 DEVICE ID: "3"
DIRECT INPUT 6 BIT NUMBER: "2"

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-321


INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

DIRECT OUT 2 OPERAND: "HYB POTT TX1"


DIRECT OUT 3 OPERAND: "DIRECT INPUT 5" (forward a message from 1 to 3)
DIRECT OUT 4 OPERAND: "DIRECT INPUT 6" (forward a message from 3 to 1)
The figure shows the signal flow among the three IEDs.
Figure 5-181: Signal flow for direct input and output

UR IED 1 UR IED 2
DIRECT OUT 2 = HYB POTT TX1 DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 5 DIRECT OUT 2 = HYB POTT TX1
DIRECT INPUT 6 DIRECT OUT 4 = DIRECT INPUT 6
DIRECT OUT 3 = DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 6

UR IED 3 DIRECT INPUT 5


DIRECT INPUT 6
DIRECT OUT 2 = HYB POTT TX1
842717A1.CDR

In three-terminal applications, both the remote terminals must grant permission to trip. Therefore, at each terminal, direct
inputs 5 and 6 are ANDed in FlexLogic and the resulting operand configured as the permission to trip (HYB POTT RX1
5 setting).

5.9.7 Teleprotection

5.9.7.1 Overview
The relay provides 16 teleprotection inputs on communications channel 1 (numbered 1-1 through 1-16) and 16
teleprotection inputs on communications channel 2 (on two-terminals two-channel and three-terminal systems only,
numbered 2-1 through 2-16). The remote relay connected to channels 1 and 2 of the local relay is programmed by
assigning FlexLogic operands to be sent via the selected communications channel. This allows the user to create
distributed protection and control schemes via dedicated communications channels. Some examples are directional
comparison pilot schemes and direct transfer tripping. Note that failures of communications channels affect
teleprotection functionality. The teleprotection function must be enabled to utilize the inputs.

5.9.7.2 Teleprotection inputs


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  TELEPROTECTION  TELEPROT INPUTS
 TELEPROT INPUTS TELEPROT INPUT 1-1 Range: Off, On, Latest/Off, Latest/On
  DEFAULT: Off

TELEPROT INPUT 1-16 Range: Off, On, Latest/Off, Latest/On
 DEFAULT: Off

TELEPROT INPUT 2-1 Range: Off, On, Latest/Off, Latest/On


 DEFAULT: Off

TELEPROT INPUT 2-16 Range: Off, On, Latest/Off, Latest/On
 DEFAULT: Off

5-322 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS

Setting the TELEPROT INPUT ~~ DEFAULT setting to “On” defaults the input to logic 1 when the channel fails. A value of “Off”
defaults the input to logic 0 when the channel fails.
The “Latest/On” and “Latest/Off” values freeze the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is not known,
such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, then the input defaults to logic 1 for “Latest/
On” and logic 0 for “Latest/Off.”

5.9.7.3 Teleprotection outputs


SETTINGS  INPUTS/OUTPUTS  TELEPROTECTION  TELEPROT OUTPUTS
 TELEPROT OUTPUTS TELEPROT OUTPUT 1-1: Range: FlexLogic operand
  Off

TELEPROT OUTPUT 1-16: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

TELEPROT OUTPUT 2-1: Range: FlexLogic operand


 Off

TELEPROT OUTPUT 2-16: Range: FlexLogic operand
 Off

As the following figure demonstrates, processing of the teleprotection inputs/outputs is dependent on the number of
communication channels and terminals. On two-terminal two-channel systems, they are processed continuously on each
channel and mapped separately per channel. Therefore, to achieve redundancy, the user must assign the same operand
on both channels (teleprotection outputs at the sending end or corresponding teleprotection inputs at the receiving end).
On three-terminal two-channel systems, redundancy is achieved by programming signal re-transmittal in the case of
channel failure between any pair of relays.
5
Figure 5-182: Teleprotection input/output processing
UR-1 UR-2
ACTUAL VALUES SETTING
CHANNEL 1 STATUS: TELEPROT INPUT 1-1
DEFAULT:
SETTING (same for 1-2...1-16)
TELEPROT OUTPUT 1-1:
(same for 1-2...1-16) On FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Fail
Off (Flexlogic Operand) Off TELEPRO INPUT 1-1 On
OK OR
(same for 1-2...1-16)

SETTING ACTUAL VALUES


TELEPROT INPUT 1-1 CHANNEL 1 STATUS:
DEFAULT:
Communication channel #1
(same for 1-2...1-16) (Teleprotection I/O Enabled) SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND TELEPROT OUTPUT 1-1:
On (same for 1-2...1-16)
TELEPRO INPUT 1-1 On Fail
OR Off Off (Flexlogic Operand)
(same for 1-2...1-16) OK

UR-2 or UR-3
ACTUAL VALUES SETTING
CHANNEL 2 STATUS: TELEPROT INPUT 2-1
DEFAULT:
SETTING (same for 2-2...2-16)
TELEPROT OUTPUT 2-1:
(same for 1-2...1-16) On FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Fail
Off TELEPRO INPUT 2-1 On
Off (Flexlogic Operand) OK OR
(same for 2-2...2-16)

SETTING ACTUAL VALUES


TELEPROT INPUT 2-1 CHANNEL 2 STATUS:
Communication channel #2
DEFAULT:
(same for 1-2...1-16) (On 3-terminal system or 2-terminal SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
with redundant channel)
TELEPROT OUTPUT 2-1:
On (same for 2-2...2-16)
TELEPRO INPUT 2-1 On Fail
Off
(same for 1-2...1-16) OR OK Off (Flexlogic Operand)

842750A2.CDR

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-323


TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.10 Transducer inputs/outputs


5.10.1 DCmA inputs
SETTINGS  TRANSDUCER I/O  DCMA INPUTS  DCMA INPUT H1(W8)
 DCMA INPUT H1 DCMA INPUT H1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

DCMA INPUT H1 ID: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters


 DCMA Ip 1

DCMA INPUT H1 Range: six alphanumeric characters


 UNITS: A

DCMA INPUT H1 Range: 0 to –1 mA, 0 to +1 mA, –1 to +1 mA, 0 to 5


 RANGE: 0 to -1 mA mA, 0 to 10mA, 0 to 20 mA, 4 to 20 m

DCMA INPUT H1 MIN Range: –9999.999 to +9999.999 in steps of 0.001


 VALUE: 0.000

DCMA INPUT H1 MAX Range: –9999.999 to +9999.999 in steps of 0.001


 VALUE: 0.000

The F35 is provided with optional DCmA capability. This feature is specified as an option at the time of
ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

5 Hardware and software are provided to receive signals from external transducers and to convert these signals into a
digital format for use as required. The relay accepts inputs in the range of –1 to +20 mA DC, suitable for use with most
common transducer output ranges; all inputs are assumed to be linear over the complete range. Hardware details are
contained in chapter 3.
Before the DCmA input signal can be used, the value of the signal measured by the relay must be converted to the range
and quantity of the external transducer primary input parameter, such as DC voltage or temperature. The relay simplifies
this process by internally scaling the output from the external transducer and displaying the actual primary parameter.
DCmA input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. Configure the individual channels with the
settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay automatically generates configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8
inclusive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are generated automatically for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel
of a type 5F transducer module installed in slot H.
The function of the channel can be “Enabled” or “Disabled.” If “Disabled,” no actual values are created for the channel. An
alphanumeric “ID” is assigned to each channel; this ID is included in the channel actual value, along with the programmed
units associated with the parameter measured by the transducer, such as volts, °C, megawatts, and so on. This ID is also
used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. The DCMA
INPUT H1 RANGE setting specifies the mA DC range of the transducer connected to the input channel.
The DCMA INPUT H1 MIN VALUE and DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE settings are used to program the span of the transducer in
primary units. For example, a temperature transducer might have a span from 0 to 250 °C; in this case the DCMA INPUT H1
MIN VALUE value is “0” and the DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE value is “250.” Another example is a watts transducer with a span
from –20 to +180 MW; in this case the DCMA INPUT H1 MIN VALUE value is “–20” and the DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE value is
“180.” Intermediate values between the minimum and maximum values are scaled linearly.

5-324 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS

5.10.2 RTD inputs


SETTINGS  TRANSDUCER I/O  RTD INPUTS  RTD INPUT H1(W8)
 RTD INPUT H1 RTD INPUT H1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
  FUNCTION: Disabled

RTD INPUT H1 ID: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters


 RTD Ip 1

RTD INPUT H1 TYPE: Range: 100Ω Nickel, 10Ω Copper, 100Ω Platinum,
 100Ω Platinum 120Ω Nickel

Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external resistance temperature detectors and convert these
signals into a digital format for use as required. These channels are intended to be connected to any of the RTD types in
common use. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
RTD input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with
the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay automatically generates configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8
inclusive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel
of a type 5C transducer module installed in the first available slot.
The function of the channel can be either “Enabled” or “Disabled.” If “Disabled,” there is not an actual value created for the
channel. An alphanumeric ID is assigned to the channel; this ID is included in the channel actual values. It is also used to
reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. Selecting the type of
RTD connected to the channel configures the channel.
5
Actions based on RTD overtemperature, such as trips or alarms, are done in conjunction with the FlexElements feature. In
FlexElements, the operate level is scaled to a base of 100°C. For example, a trip level of 150°C is achieved by setting the
operate level at 1.5 pu. FlexElement operands are available to FlexLogic for further interlocking or to operate an output
contact directly.
See the following table for reference temperature values for each RTD type.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-325


TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

Table 5-35: RTD temperature vs. resistance


Temperature Resistance (in ohms)
°C °F 100 Ω Pt 120 Ω Ni 100 Ω Ni 10 Ω Cu
(DIN 43760)
–50 –58 80.31 86.17 71.81 7.10
–40 –40 84.27 92.76 77.30 7.49
–30 –22 88.22 99.41 82.84 7.88
–20 –4 92.16 106.15 88.45 8.26
–10 14 96.09 113.00 94.17 8.65
0 32 100.00 120.00 100.00 9.04
10 50 103.90 127.17 105.97 9.42
20 68 107.79 134.52 112.10 9.81
30 86 111.67 142.06 118.38 10.19
40 104 115.54 149.79 124.82 10.58
50 122 119.39 157.74 131.45 10.97
60 140 123.24 165.90 138.25 11.35
70 158 127.07 174.25 145.20 11.74
80 176 130.89 182.84 152.37 12.12
90 194 134.70 191.64 159.70 12.51
100 212 138.50 200.64 167.20 12.90
110 230 142.29 209.85 174.87 13.28
120 248 146.06 219.29 182.75 13.67
5 130 266 149.82 228.96 190.80 14.06
140 284 153.58 238.85 199.04 14.44
150 302 157.32 248.95 207.45 14.83
160 320 161.04 259.30 216.08 15.22
170 338 164.76 269.91 224.92 15.61
180 356 168.47 280.77 233.97 16.00
190 374 172.46 291.96 243.30 16.39
200 392 175.84 303.46 252.88 16.78
210 410 179.51 315.31 262.76 17.17
220 428 183.17 327.54 272.94 17.56
230 446 186.82 340.14 283.45 17.95
240 464 190.45 353.14 294.28 18.34
250 482 194.08 366.53 305.44 18.73

5.10.3 DCmA outputs


SETTINGS  TRANSDUCER I/O  DCMA OUTPUTS  DCMA OUTPUT H1(W8)
 DCMA OUTPUT H1 DCMA OUTPUT H1 Range: Off, any analog actual value parameter
  SOURCE: Off

DCMA OUTPUT H1 Range: –1 to 1 mA, 0 to 1 mA, 4 to 20 mA


 RANGE: –1 to 1 mA

DCMA OUTPUT H1 Range: –90.000 to 90.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 MIN VAL: 0.000 pu

DCMA OUTPUT H1 Range: –90.000 to 90.000 pu in steps of 0.001


 MAX VAL: 1.000 pu

5-326 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS

Hardware and software is provided to generate DCmA signals that allow interfacing with external equipment. Hardware
details are contained in chapter 3. The DCmA output channels are arranged in a manner similar to transducer input or CT
and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with the settings as follows.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up, the
relay automatically generates configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same manner used
for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is used as
the channel number.
Both the output range and a signal driving a given output are user-programmable via the following settings menu (an
example for channel M5 is shown).
The relay checks the driving signal (x in equations below) for the minimum and maximum limits, and subsequently re-
scales so the limits defined as MIN VAL and MAX VAL match the output range of the hardware defined as RANGE. The
following equation is applied:

Eq. 5-31

where
x is a driving signal specified by the SOURCE setting
Imin and Imax are defined by the RANGE setting
k is a scaling constant calculated as:

Eq. 5-32

The feature is intentionally inhibited if the MAX VAL and MIN VAL settings are entered incorrectly, for example when MAX VAL
5
– MIN VAL < 0.1 pu. The resulting characteristic is illustrated in the following figure.
Figure 5-183: DCmA output characteristic

Imax
OUTPUT CURRENT

Imin
DRIVING SIGNAL
842739A1.CDR MIN VAL MAX VAL

Settings

DCMA OUTPUT H1 SOURCE — This setting specifies an internal analog value to drive the analog output. Actual values
(FlexAnalog parameters) such as power, current amplitude, voltage amplitude, power factor, etc. can be configured as
sources driving DCmA outputs. See Appendix A for a list of FlexAnalog parameters.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-327


TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

DCMA OUTPUT H1 RANGE — This setting allows selection of the output range. Each DCmA channel can be set independently
to work with different ranges. The three most commonly used output ranges are available.
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MIN VAL — This setting allows setting the minimum limit for the signal that drives the output. This setting
is used to control the mapping between an internal analog value and the output current. The setting is entered in per-unit
values. The base units are defined in the same manner as the FlexElement base units.
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MAX VAL — This setting allows setting the maximum limit for the signal that drives the output. This setting
is used to control the mapping between an internal analog value and the output current. The setting is entered in per-unit
values. The base units are defined in the same manner as the FlexElement base units.

The DCMA OUTPUT H1 MIN VAL and DCMA OUTPUT H1 MAX VAL settings are ignored for power factor base units (i.e. if
the DCMA OUTPUT H1 SOURCE is set to FlexAnalog value based on power factor measurement).

Three application examples follow.

Example: Power monitoring


A three phase active power on a 13.8 kV system measured via UR-series relay source 1 is to be monitored by the DCmA H1
output of the range of –1 to 1 mA. The following settings are applied on the relay: CT ratio = 1200:5, VT secondary 115, VT
connection is delta, and VT ratio = 120. The nominal current is 800 A primary and the nominal power factor is 0.90. The
power is to be monitored in both importing and exporting directions and allow for 20% overload compared to the nominal.
The nominal three-phase power is:

Eq. 5-33

The three-phase power with 20% overload margin is:


5
Eq. 5-34

The base unit for power (refer to the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:

Eq. 5-35

The minimum and maximum power values to be monitored (in pu) are:

Eq. 5-36

The following settings are entered:


DCMA OUTPUT H1 SOURCE: “SRC 1 P”
DCMA OUTPUT H1 RANGE: “–1 to 1 mA”
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MIN VAl: “–1.247 pu”
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MAX VAL: “1.247 pu”
With the above settings, the output will represent the power with the scale of 1 mA per 20.65 MW. The worst-case error for
this application can be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
• ±0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or ±0.005 x (1-(-1)) x 20.65 MW = ±0.207 MW
• ±1% of reading error for the active power at power factor of 0.9
For example at the reading of 20 MW, the worst-case error is 0.01  20 MW + 0.207 MW = 0.407 MW.

Example: Current monitoring


The phase A current (true RMS value) is to be monitored via the H2 current output working with the range from 4 to 20 mA.
The CT ratio is 5000:5 and the maximum load current is 4200 A. The current is to be monitored from 0 A upwards, allowing
for 50% overload.

5-328 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS

The phase current with the 50% overload margin is:

Eq. 5-37

The base unit for current (see the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:

Eq. 5-38

The minimum and maximum power values to be monitored (in pu) are:

Eq. 5-39

The following settings are entered:


DCMA OUTPUT H2 SOURCE: “SRC 1 Ia RMS”
DCMA OUTPUT H2 RANGE: “4 to 20 mA”
DCMA OUTPUT H2 MIN VAL: “0.000 pu”
DCMA OUTPUT H2 MAX VAL: “1.260 pu”
The worst-case error for this application can be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
• ±0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or ±0.005 x (20 - 4) x 6.3 kA = ±0.504 kA
• ±0.25% of reading or ±0.1% of rated (whichever is greater) for currents between 0.1 and 2.0 of nominal
For example, at the reading of 4.2 kA, the worst-case error is max(0.0025  4.2 kA, 0.001  5 kA) + 0.504 kA = 0.515 kA.

Example: Voltage monitoring


A positive-sequence voltage on a 400 kV system measured via source 2 is to be monitored by the DCmA H3 output with a
range of 0 to 1 mA. The VT secondary setting is 66.4 V, the VT ratio setting is 6024, and the VT connection setting is “Delta.” 5
The voltage is to be monitored in the range from 70% to 110% of nominal.
The minimum and maximum positive-sequence voltages to be monitored are:

Eq. 5-40

The base unit for voltage (see the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:

Eq. 5-41

The minimum and maximum voltage values to be monitored (in pu) are:

Eq. 5-42

The following settings are entered:


DCMA OUTPUT H3 SOURCE: “SRC 2 V_1 mag”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 RANGE: “0 to 1 mA”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 MIN VAL: “0.404 pu”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 MAX VAL: “0.635 pu”
The limit settings differ from the expected 0.7 pu and 1.1 pu because the relay calculates the positive-sequence quantities
scaled to the phase-to-ground voltages, even if the VTs are connected in “Delta” (see the Metering Conventions section in
chapter 6), while at the same time the VT nominal voltage is 1 pu for the settings. Consequently the settings required in this
example differ from naturally expected by the factor of .
The worst-case error for this application could be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
• ±0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or ± 0.005 x (1-0) x 254.03 kV = ±1.27 kV
• ±0.5% of reading
For example, under nominal conditions, the positive-sequence reads 230.94 kV and the worst-case error is
0.005  230.94 kV + 1.27 kV = 2.42 kV.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-329


TESTING CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5.11 Testing
5.11.1 Test mode function
SETTINGS  TESTING  TEST MODE FUNCTION
 TESTING TEST MODE Range: Disabled, Isolated, Forcible
  FUNCTION: Disabled

The F35 provides a test facility to verify the functionality of contact inputs and outputs, some communication functions
and the Phasor Measurement Unit (PMU, where applicable), using simulated conditions. It is accessible in the software and
graphical front panel.
The TEST MODE FUNCTION can be in one of three states: Disabled, Isolated, or Forcible. In UR 7.7 and later, as outlined in the
Simulation section that follows, the UR test mode and GOOSE simulation mode are Isolated, and they no longer depend on
the UR TEST MODE FUNCTION.
The Disabled mode is intended for normal in service operation; the relay protection, control, and communication function
is normal. Test features are disabled, except channel tests and Phasor Measurement Unit tests remain usable when
provided.
The Isolated mode is intended to allow the relay to be quickly placed in a state where the relay cannot negatively impact
the power system or other parts of the substation automation system. This is to allow changing settings, loading new
firmware, changing hardware modules, and changing communication connections. As far as practical all relay output
signals are blocked. Contact outputs are de-energized, latching outputs are frozen. Commands to HardFiber Bricks are
blocked. GOOSE transmissions have their "simulation" flag (also known as "test" flag) set, which results in the messages not

5 being accepted by compliant receiving devices that do not have a "Sim" data attribute set. The quality attribute of values
that can be output via IEC 61850 MMS services are set to "invalid," which results in the values not being used for
operational purposes by compliant receiving devices. Direct I/O channel tests and PMU tests are usable on applicable
models.
The Forcible mode is intended for testing involving forcing relay operation by test signal injection and verifying correct
relay output. This mode is also for tests to verify the relay outputs (both contact and communications) have the intended
impact on specific power system devices or on specific other substation automation devices. Contact outputs can be
selectively enabled or forced as described in the following two sections. Shared outputs to Bricks have their test mode flag
raised, which results in their value only being accepted by relays also in forcible mode. GOOSE transmissions have the
"simulation" flag set, which results in these only being accepted by other devices that have their "Sim" data attribute set.
The "Sim" data attribute in the relay is set, so that if GOOSE messages are received with the "simulation" flag set, these are
used in place of the normal messages. The quality attribute of values that are output via IEC 61850 MMS services are set to
"valid" + "test," which signals that the values are not to be used for operational purposes.
Otherwise, the UR remains fully operational while in the Forcible test mode, allowing for various testing procedures. In
particular, the protection and control elements, and FlexLogic function normally. Other than the IEC 61850 protocol,
communications based inputs and outputs remain fully operational. The test procedure must take this into account. Direct
I/O channel tests and PMU tests are usable on applicable models.
The test mode can be selected through the front panel, EnerVista UR Setup software, or IEC 61850 control to LLN0.Mod.
LLN0.Mod.ctlVal "on" selects Disabled, "test/blocked" selects Isolated, and "test" selects Forcible. The TEST MODE FUNCTION
setting can only be changed by a direct user command. Following a restart, power up, settings upload, or firmware
upgrade, the test mode remains at the last programmed value. This allows a UR that has been placed in isolated mode to
remain isolated during testing and maintenance activities.

5.11.2 Test mode forcing


SETTINGS  TESTING  TEST MODE FORCING
 TESTING TEST MODE FORCING: Range: FlexLogic operand
  On

5-330 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS TESTING

When in Forcible mode, the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING setting dictates further response of the F35 to
testing conditions, as described in the following two sections.
The test mode state is indicated on the relay front panel by a combination of the Test Mode LED indicator, the In-Service
LED indicator, and by the critical fail relay, as shown in the following table.
Table 5-36: Test mode operation
TEST MODE In-service Test mode Critical fail TEST MODE Contact input and output behavior
FUNCTION LED LED relay FORCING
Disabled Unaffected Off Normal No effect Normal
Isolated Off On De-energized No effect Contact outputs disabled
Forcible Off Flashing De-energized Off Normal
On Controlled by forcing features

On restart, the TEST MODE FORCING setting and the force contact input and force contact output settings revert to
their default states.

5.11.3 Force contact inputs


SETTINGS  TESTING  FORCE CONTACT INPUTS
 FORCE CONTACT FORCE Cont Ip 1 Range: Normal, Open, Closed
 INPUTS  : Normal

FORCE Cont Ip 2 Range: Normal, Open, Closed


 : Normal 5

FORCE Cont Ip xx Range: Normal, Open, Closed
 : Normal

The force contact inputs feature provides a method of performing checks on the function of all contact inputs.
While in Forcible test mode, the relay contact inputs can be pre-programmed to respond in the following ways:
• If set to “Normal,” the input remains fully operational. It is controlled by the voltage across its input terminals and can
be turned on and off by external circuitry. Select this value if a given input must be operational during the test. This
includes, for example, an input initiating the test, or being a part of a user pre-programmed test sequence.
• If set to “Open,” the input is forced to report as opened (Logic 0) while the operand selected by TEST MODE FORCING
setting is On, regardless of the voltage across the input terminals. While the selected operand is Off, the input behaves
as it does when in service.
• If set to “Closed,” the input is forced to report as closed (Logic 1) while the operand selected by TEST MODE FORCING
setting is On regardless of the voltage across the input terminals. While the selected operand is Off, the input behaves
as it does when in service.

On restart, the TEST MODE FORCING setting and the force contact input and force contact output settings revert to
their default states.

5.11.4 Force contact outputs


SETTINGS  TESTING  FORCE CONTACT OUTPUTS
 FORCE CONTACT FORCE Cont Op 1 Range: Normal, Energized, De-energized, Freeze
 OUTPUTS  : Normal

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-331


SIMULATION CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

FORCE Cont Op 2 Range: Normal, Energized, De-energized, Freeze


 : Normal

FORCE Cont Op xx Range: Normal, Energized, De-energized, Freeze
 : Normal

The force contact outputs feature provides a method of performing checks on the function of all contact outputs.
While in Forcible test mode, the relay contact outputs can be pre-programmed to respond in the following ways:
• If set to “Normal,” the contact output remains fully operational. It operates when its control operand is logic 1 and
resets when its control operand is logic 0.
• If set to “Energized,” the output closes and remains closed while the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING
setting is On, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact. While the selected
operand is Off, the output behaves as it does when in service.
• If set to “De-energized,” the output opens and remains opened while the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING
setting is On, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact. While the selected
operand is Off, the output behaves as it does when in service.
• If set to “Freeze,” the output retains its position at the instant before the TEST MODE FUNCTION was Forcible and the
operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING setting was On, regardless of later changes in the status of the operand
configured to control the output contact. While the selected operand is Off, the output behaves as it does when in
service.

On restart, the TEST MODE FORCING setting and the force contact input and force contact output settings revert to
their default states.

5
5.12 Simulation
5.12.1 GOOSE
SETTINGS  SIMULATION  GOOSE
 GOOSE Tx GOOSE SIM MODE: Range: Enabled, Disabled
  Disabled

SIM q.VALIDITY: Range: NONE, GOOD, INVALID, QUESTIONABLE


 NONE

SIM q.TEST: Range: NONE, TRUE, FALSE


 NONE

ACCEPT SIM GOOSE & SV: Range: Enabled, Disabled


 Disabled

Prior to UR 7.7, when the UR TEST MODE FUNCTION is set to "Isolated" or "Forcible," the sim bit in the header of all
transmitted GOOSE messages is set to "TRUE," so that the UR plays the simulator role during the testing and
commissioning phases. The "Sim" data attribute in the relay is set (<MasterLD>/LPHD1.Sim.stVal = TRUE), so that if GOOSE
messages are received with the "simulation" flag set, these are used in place of the normal messages. The quality attribute
values that are transmitted via GOOSE services are set to "valid" + "test."
In UR 7.7 and later, the UR test mode and GOOSE simulation mode are isolated. The sim bit in the transmitted GOOSE
messages and the relay "Sim" attribute (<MasterLD>/LPHD1.Sim.stVal) are controlled via new Modbus settings and MMS
control requests. They no longer depend on the UR TEST MODE FUNCTION.
When the F35 is set to IEC 61850 Edition 2, the settings display in the software and front panel. When using IEC 61850
Edition 1, the settings display in the software and are read-only.

5-332 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS SIMULATION

Tx GOOSE SIM MODE — When set to Disabled, the sim bit in all transmitted GOOSE messages are set to FALSE. When set to
Enabled, the sim bit in all transmitted GOOSE messages are set to TRUE. This setting also is accessible from IEC 61850
client control to <MasterLD>/LPHD1.TxGoSim.
SIM q.VALIDITY — This setting simulates the validity bits of the quality attribute values included in all transmitted GOOSE
messages. This setting is used when Tx GOOSE SIM MODE is set to Enabled. When this setting is set to None, the q.Validity
bits are set based on the logical node behavior value. When set to any other value, the q.Validity bits of quality attributes
included in all transmitted GOOSE messages are set to the selected value.
SIM q.TEST — This setting simulates the Test bit of the quality attribute values included in all transmitted GOOSE messages.
This setting is used when Tx GOOSE SIM MODE is set to Enabled. When this setting is set to None, the q.Test bit is set based
on the relay TEST MODE FUNCTION. When set to any other value, the q.Test bit of quality attributes included in all
transmitted GOOSE messages is set to the selected value.
ACCEPT SIM GOOSE & SV — When set to Disabled, the relay "Sim" attribute (<MasterLD>/LPHD1.Sim.stVal) is set to False and
the GOOSE messages received with simulation flag set are ignored. When set to Enabled, the relay "Sim" attribute
(<MasterLD>/LPHD1.Sim.stVal) is set to True, so that if GOOSE messages are received with the "simulation" flag set, these
are used in place of the normal messages. This setting also is accessible from IEC 61850 client control to <MasterLD>/
LPHD1.Sim.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 5-333


SIMULATION CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS

5-334 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 6: Actual values

Actual values

This chapter outlines viewing of data on the front panel and in the software.

6.1 Actual Values menu

 ACTUAL VALUES  Access in EnerVista


 FRONT PANEL   See page 6-3

 ACTUAL VALUES  CONTACT INPUTS See page 6-5
 STATUS  

 VIRTUAL INPUTS See page 6-5


  

 RxGOOSE BOOLEANS See page 6-5


 

 RxGOOSE DPS See page 6-5


 

 TELEPROTECTION See page 6-6


  INPUTS

 CONTACT OUTPUTS See page 6-6


 

 VIRTUAL OUTPUTS See page 6-6


 

 AUTORECLOSE See page 6-7


 

 RxGOOSE STATUS See page 6-7


 

 RxGOOSE See page 6-7


  STATISTICS

 DIGITAL COUNTERS See page 6-8


 

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-1


ACTUAL VALUES MENU CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

 SELECTOR SWITCHES See page 6-8


 

 FLEX STATES See page 6-8


 

 ETHERNET See page 6-8


 

 REAL TIME CLOCK See page 6-9


  SYNCHRONIZING

 DIRECT INPUTS See page 6-9


 

 DIRECT DEVICES See page 6-10


  STATUS

 EGD PROTOCOL See page 6-10


  STATUS

 TELEPROT CH TESTS See page 6-11


 

 INCIPIENT FAULT See page 6-11


 

 COMM STATUS See page 6-12


  REMAINING CONNECT

 PRP See page 6-12


 

 TxGOOSE STATUS See page 6-13


 

 PROTOCOL See page 6-13


  

 ACTUAL VALUES  SOURCE SRC 1 See page 6-17



6  METERING 

 SOURCE SRC 2
  

 SOURCE SRC 3
 

 SOURCE SRC 4
 

 SOURCE SRC 5
 

 SOURCE SRC 6
 

 TRACKING FREQUENCY See page 6-23


 

 FLEXELEMENTS See page 6-23


 

 RxGOOSE Analogs See page 6-23


 

 WATTMETRIC See page 6-24


  GROUND FAULT 1

6-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES FRONT PANEL

 WATTMETRIC
  GROUND FAULT 5

 TRANSDUCER I/O See page 6-24


  DCMA INPUTS

 TRANSDUCER I/O See page 6-24


   RTD INPUTS

 ACTUAL VALUES  FAULT REPORT See page 6-24


 RECORDS  

 EVENT RECORDS See page 6-25


  

 OSCILLOGRAPHY See page 6-27


 

 DATA LOGGER See page 6-27


 

 MAINTENANCE See page 6-28


  

 ACTUAL VALUES  MODEL INFORMATION See page 6-29


 PRODUCT INFO  

 FIRMWARE REVISIONS See page 6-29


 

For status reporting, ‘On’ represents Logic 1 and ‘Off’ represents Logic 0.

6.2 Front panel


6.2.1 Enhanced and basic front panels
The front panel can be viewed and used in the EnerVista software, for example to view an error message displayed on the 6
front panel.
To view the front panel in EnerVista software:
1. Click Actual Values > Front Panel.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-3


FRONT PANEL CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

Figure 6-1: Front panel use in the software (C60 shown)

6.2.2 Graphical front panel


The graphical front panel is a hardware option.

6 Annunciator alarms can be acknowledged and reset, and LEDs and pushbuttons can be viewed.
To view alarms for the graphical front panel in EnerVista:
1. Access Actual Values > Graphical Panel > Annunciator Panel. Alarms are listed, allowing remote acknowledgement/
reset.
2. Click the Acknowledge or Reset button for an alarm.
Figure 6-2: Annunciator alarms displayed in the software)

To view LEDs and pushbuttons on the graphical front panel in EnerVista:


1. Access Actual Values > Graphical Panel > LEDs or Pushbuttons. The window displays.

6-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS

6.3 Status
6.3.1 Contact inputs
ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  CONTACT INPUTS
 CONTACT INPUTS Cont Ip 1 Range: On, Off
  Off

Cont Ip xx Range: On, Off
 Off

The present status of the contact inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
input. For example, ‘Cont Ip 1’ refers to the contact input in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the contact input.

6.3.2 Virtual inputs


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  VIRTUAL INPUTS
 VIRTUAL INPUTS Virt Ip 1 Range: On, Off
  Off

Virt Ip 64 Range: On, Off
 Off

The present status of the 64 virtual inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
input. For example, ‘Virt Ip 1’ refers to the virtual input in terms of the default name. The second line of the display indicates
the logic state of the virtual input.

6
6.3.3 RxGOOSE boolean inputs
ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  RxGOOSE BOOLEANS
 RxGOOSE BOOLEANS RxGOOSE BOOLEAN 1 Range: On, Off
  STATUS: Off

RxGOOSE BOOLEAN 256 Range: On, Off
 STATUS: Off

The F35 is provided with optional IEC 61850 capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time
of ordering. See the Order Codes section of chapter 2 for details.

6.3.4 RxGOOSE DPS inputs


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  RxGOOSE DPS
 RxGOOSE DPS RxGOOSE DPS 1 Range: On, Off, Intermediate, Bad
  Status: Intermediate

RxGOOSE DPS 16 Range: On, Off, Intermediate, Bad
 Status: Intermediate

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-5


STATUS CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

The F35 is provided with optional IEC 61850 capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time
of ordering. See the Order Codes section of chapter 2 for details.

6.3.5 Teleprotection inputs


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  TELEPROTECTION INPUTS
 TELEPROTECTION TELEPROTECTION Range: On, Off
 INPUTS  INPUT 1-1: Off

TELEPROTECTION Range: On, Off
 INPUT 1-16: Off

TELEPROTECTION Range: On, Off


 INPUT 2-1: Off

TELEPROTECTION Range: On, Off
 INPUT 2-16: Off

The present state of teleprotection inputs from communication channels 1 and 2 are shown here. The state displayed is
that of corresponding remote output unless the channel is declared failed.

6.3.6 Contact outputs


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  CONTACT OUTPUTS
 CONTACT OUTPUTS Cont Op 1 Range: On, Off, VOff, VOn, IOn, IOff
  Off

6  Cont Op xx
Off
Range: On, Off, VOff, VOn, IOn, IOff

The present state of the contact outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
output. For example, ‘Cont Op 1’ refers to the contact output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of
the display indicates the logic state of the contact output.
For form-A contact outputs, the state of the voltage and current detectors is displayed as Off, VOff, IOff, On, IOn, and VOn.
For form-C contact outputs, the state is displayed as Off or On.

6.3.7 Virtual outputs


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
 VIRTUAL OUTPUTS Virt Op 1 Range: On, Off
  Off

Virt Op 96 Range: On, Off
 Off

The present state of up to 96 virtual outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
output. For example, ‘Virt Op 1’ refers to the virtual output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the virtual output, as calculated by the FlexLogic equation for that output.

6-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS

6.3.8 Autoreclose
ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  AUTORECLOSE  AUTORECLOSE 1(6)
 AUTORECLOSE 1 AUTORECLOSE 1 Range: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4
  SHOT COUNT: 0

This menu displays the reclosure shot count.

6.3.9 RxGOOSE status


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  RxGOOSE STATUS
 RxGOOSE All RxGOOSE Online: Range: Yes, No
 STATUS  Yes

RxGOOSE 1 Status: Range: Online, Offline


 Offline

RxGOOSE 64 Status: Range: Online, Offline
 Offline

The F35 is provided with optional IEC 61850 capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time
of ordering. See the Order Codes section of chapter 2 for details.

The All RxGOOSE Online actual value does not consider RxGOOSE that are not configured or are not used by any RxGOOSE
Input.

6.3.10 RxGOOSE statistics


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  RxGOOSE STATISTICS  RxGOOSE 1(64)
 RxGOOSE 1
 RxGOOSE 1 Range: 0 up to 4,294,967,295 6
 stNum: 0

RxGOOSE 1 Range: 0 up to 4,294,967,295


 sqNum: 0

R-RxGOOSE 1 Range: On, Off


 IGMP: Off

The F35 is provided with optional IEC 61850 capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time
of ordering. See the Order Codes section of chapter 2 for details.

stNum — State number. The most recently received value in GOOSE message field stNum. The publisher increments stNum
each time that the state of one or more of the GOOSE message members is sent with a revised value.
sqNum — Sequence number. The most recently received value in GOOSE message field sqNum. The publisher sets sqNum
to zero each time the state of one or more of the GOOSE message members is sent with a new value, and it increments it
whenever a GOOSE message is resent without any member value change.
IGMP — Multicast (SSM and ASM) modes of R-GOOSE reception require that the F35 device subscribe to a multicast group
over the Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) enabled network. R-RxGOOSE## IGMP status On indicates that IGMP
negotiation with a network device (for example a router) was successful. In the case where setting R-RxGOOSE1 DST IP is
configured to a multicast address and this status indicates Off, R-GOOSE reception cannot be successful, and therefore
communication network diagnosis needs to be carried out. This status is relevant to R-GOOSE reception when configured
for SSM or ASM reception modes. It is not relevant for GOOSE or for R-GOOSE in unicast reception mode.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-7


STATUS CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

6.3.11 Digital counters


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  DIGITAL COUNTERS  DIGITAL COUNTERS Counter 1(8)
 DIGITAL COUNTERS Counter 1 ACCUM:
 Counter 1  0

Counter 1 FROZEN:
 0

Counter 1 FROZEN: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 1970/01/01 00:00:00

Counter 1 MICROS: Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1


 0

The present status of the eight digital counters displays here. The status of each counter, with the user-defined counter
name, includes the accumulated and frozen counts (the count units label also appears). Also included, is the date and time
stamp for the frozen count. The COUNTER 1 MICROS value refers to the microsecond portion of the time stamp.

6.3.12 Selector switches


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  SELECTOR SWITCHES
 SELECTOR SWITCHES SELECTOR SWITCH 1 Range: Current Position / 7
  POSITION: 0/7

SELECTOR SWITCH 2 Range: Current Position / 7


 POSITION: 0/7

The display shows both the current position and the full range. The current position only (an integer from 0 through 7) is the
actual value.

6.3.13 FlexStates
6 ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  FLEX STATES
 FLEX STATES PARAM 1: Off Range: On, Off
  Off

PARAM 256: Off Range: On, Off
 Off

There are 256 FlexStateTM bits available. The second line value indicates the state of the given FlexState bit.

6.3.14 Ethernet
ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  ETHERNET
 ETHERNET ETHERNET PRI LINK Range: Fail, OK
  STATUS: Fail

ETHERNET SEC LINK Range: Fail, OK


 STATUS: Fail

ETHERNET TER LINK Range: Fail, OK


 STATUS: Fail

These values indicate the status of the first, second, and third Ethernet links.

6-8 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS

6.3.15 Real time clock synchronizing


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  REAL TIME CLOCK SYNCHRONIZING
 REAL TIME CLOCK RTC SYNC SOURCE: Range: see below
 SYNCHRONIZING  None

GRANDMASTER ID: Range: any 8 octet value


 0X0000000000000000

ACCURACY: Range: 0 to 999,999,999 ns


 999999999 ns

PORT 1 PTP STATE: Range: Disabled, No Signal, Calibrating, Synch’d (No


 No Signal Pdelay), Synchronized

PORT 2 PTP STATE: Range: Disabled, No Signal, Calibrating, Synch’d (No


 No Signal Pdelay), Synchronized

PORT 3 PTP STATE: Range: Disabled, No Signal, Calibrating, Synch’d (No


 No Signal Pdelay), Synchronized

PTP - IRIG-B DELTA: Range: -500,000,000 to +500,000,000 ns


 500000000 ns

This item displays in the software when the product includes an IEEE 1588 software option.

RTC SYNC SOURCE actual value is the time synchronizing source the relay is using at present. Possible sources are: Port 1
PTP Clock, Port 2 PTP Clock, Port 3 PTP Clock, IRIG-B, SNTP1, SNTP2, and None. An actual value displays when the relay
includes the IEEE 1588 software option.
The GRANDMASTER ID is the grandmasterIdentity code being received from the present PTP grandmaster, if any. When the
relay is not using any PTP grandmaster, this actual value is zero. The grandmasterIdentity code is specified by PTP to be
globally unique, so one can always know which clock is grandmaster in a system with multiple grandmaster-capable
clocks.
ACCURACY is the estimated maximum time error at present in the RTC, considering the quality information imbedded in the
6
received time signal. The value 999,999,999 indicates that the magnitude of the estimated error is one second or more, or
that the error cannot be estimated.
PORT 1…3 PTP STATE is the present state of the port’s PTP clock. The PTP clock state is:
• Disabled is the port’s function setting is Disabled
• No Signal if enabled but no signal from an active master has been found and selected
• Calibrating if an active master has been selected but lock is not at present established
• Synch’d (No Pdelay) if the port is synchronized, but the peer delay mechanism is non-operational
• Synchronized if synchronized
PTP - IRIG-B DELTA is the time difference, measured in nanoseconds, between the fractional seconds portion of the time
being received via PTP and that being received via IRIG-B. A positive value indicates that PTP time is fast compared to IRIG-
B time.

6.3.16 Direct inputs


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  DIRECT INPUTS
 DIRECT INPUTS AVERATE MSG RETURN
  TIME CH1: 0 ms

UNRETURNED MSG
 COUNT CH1: 0

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-9


STATUS CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

CRC FAIL COUNT


 CH1: 0

AVERAGE MSG RETURN


 TIME CH2: 0 ms

UNRETURNED MSG
 COUNT CH2: 0

CRC FAIL COUNT


 CH2: 0

DIRECT INPUT 1:
 On

DIRECT INPUT 32:
 On

The AVERAGE MSG RETURN TIME is the time taken for direct output messages to return to the sender in a direct input/output
ring configuration (this value is not applicable for non-ring configurations). This is a rolling average calculated for the last
ten messages. There are two return times for dual-channel communications modules.
The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the direct output messages that do not
make the trip around the communications ring. The CRC FAIL COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the
direct output messages that have been received but fail the CRC check. High values for either of these counts can indicate
on a problem with wiring, the communication channel, or one or more relays. The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT and CRC FAIL
COUNT values can be cleared using the CLEAR DIRECT I/O COUNTERS command.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 to DIRECT INPUT (32) values represent the state of each direct input.

6.3.17 Direct devices status


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  DIRECT DEVICES STATUS
 DIRECT DEVICES DIRECT DEVICE 1 Range: Offline, Online

6  STATUS STATUS: Offline

DIRECT DEVICE 16 Range: Offline, Online
 STATUS: Offline

These actual values represent the state of direct devices 1 through 16.

6.3.18 EGD protocol status

6.3.18.1 Fast exchange


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  EGD PROTOCOL STATUS  PRODUCER STATUS  FAST EXCHANGE 1
 FAST EXCHANGE 1 FAST EXCHANGE 1
  SIGNATURE: 0

FAST EXCHANGE 1
 DATA LENGTH: 0

These values provide information for debugging an Ethernet Global Data (EGD) network. The EGD signature and packet size
for the fast EGD exchange display.

6-10 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS

6.3.18.2 Slow exchange


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  EGD PROTOCOL STATUS  PRODUCER STATUS  SLOW EXCHANGE 1(2)
 SLOW EXCHANGE 1 SLOW EXCHANGE 1
  SIGNATURE: 0

SLOW EXCHANGE 1
 DATA LENGTH: 0

These values provide information for debugging an EGD network. The EGD signature and packet size for the slow EGD
exchanges display.

6.3.19 Teleprotection channel tests


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  TELEPROT CH TESTS
 TELEPROT CH TESTS CHANNEL 1 Range: n/a, FAIL, OK
  STATUS: n/a

CHANNEL 1 LOST Range: 1 to 65535 in steps of 1


 PACKETS: 1

CHANNEL 2 Range: n/a, FAIL, OK


 STATUS: n/a

CHANNEL 2 LOST Range: 1 to 65535 in steps of 1


 PACKETS: 1

VALIDITY OF CHANNEL Range: n/a, FAIL, OK


 CONFIGURATION: FAIL

The status information for two channels is shown here.


CHANNEL 1 STATUS — This represents the receiver status of each channel. If the value is “OK,” teleprotection is enabled and
data is being received from the remote terminal; If the value is “FAIL,” teleprotection enabled and data is not being received
from the remote terminal. If “n/a,” teleprotection is disabled.
CHANNEL 1 LOST PACKETS — Data is transmitted to the remote terminals in data packets at a rate of two packets per cycle. 6
The number of lost packets represents data packets lost in transmission; this count can be reset to 0 through the
COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS menu.
VALIDITY OF CHANNEL CONFIGURATION — This value displays the current state of the communications channel identification
check, and hence validity. If a remote relay ID does not match the programmed ID at the local relay, the “FAIL” message
displays. The “N/A” value appears if the local relay ID is set to a default value of “0,” the channel is failed, or if the
teleprotection inputs/outputs are not enabled.

6.3.20 Incipient fault detector


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  INCIPIENT FAULT  INCIPIENT FAULT 1(6)
 INCIPIENT FAULT 1 INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
  PH A FAULTS: 0

INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 PH B FAULTS: 0

INCIPIENT FAULT 1 Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


 PH C FAULTS: 0

The number of detected incipient faults for each incipient fault element are displayed here for each phase. These values
can be reset to zero with the COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS  CLEAR INCIPENT FAULT COUNTERS command.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-11


STATUS CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

6.3.21 Remaining connection status


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  COMM STATUS REMAINING CONNECT
 COMM STATUS MMS TCP(max 5) Range: 0 to 5
 REMAINING CONNECT  5

MODBUS TCP (max 4) Range: 0 to 4


 4

DNP TCP(max 2) Range: 0 to 2


 2

IEC-104 TCP(max 2) Range: 0 to 2


 2

SFTP (max 4) Range: 0 to 4


 4

These values specify the remaining number of TCP connections still available for each protocol. The display depends on the
options applicable to your device. Each time a connection is used, the remaining number of connections decrements.
When released, the remaining number of connections increments. If no connection is made over the specific protocol, the
number equals the maximum number available for the specific protocol.
For example, the maximum number of Modbus TCP connections is 4. Once an EnerVista session is opened on a computer
connected to the UR over Ethernet, the Modbus TCP status shows 3. If the EnerVista application is closed, the Modbus TCP
status shows 4.
For the graphical front panel, the remaining connections refer to TCP connections only.
MMS TCP — The number of IEC 61850 connections remaining.

6.3.22 Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)


The Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) defines a redundancy protocol for high availability in substation automation
networks.

6 ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  PRP STATUS


 PRP STATUS Total Rx Port A: Range: 0 to 4G, blank if PRP disabled
  0

Total Rx Port B: Range: 0 to 4G, blank if PRP disabled


 0

Mismatches Port A: Range: 0 to 4G, blank if PRP disabled


 0

Mismatches Port B: Range: 0 to 4G, blank if PRP disabled


 0

Total Errors: Range: 0 to 4G, blank if PRP disabled


 0

The F35 is provided with optional PRP capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time of
ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.

Total Received Port A is a counter for total messages received (either from DANPs or from SANs) on Port A.
Total Received Port B is a counter for total messages received (either from DANPs or from SANs) on Port B.
Total Errors is a counter for total messages received with an error (bad port code, frame length too short).
Mismatches Port A is a counter for total messages received with an error on Port A (PRP frame, but port received through
and LAN ID in the frame do not match).

6-12 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES METERING

Mismatches Port B is a counter for total messages received with an error on Port B (PRP frame, but port received through
and LAN ID in the frame do not match).

6.3.23 TxGOOSE status


ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  TxGOOSE STATUS
 TxGOOSE STATUS R-TxGOOSE 1 Range: On, Off
  ARP: Off

R-TxGOOSE 16 Range: On, Off
 ARP: Off

The F35 is provided with optional IEC 61850 capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time
of ordering. See the Order Codes section of chapter 2 for details.

This status is relevant to R-GOOSE reception when configured for SSM or ASM reception modes. It is not relevant for GOOSE
or for R-GOOSE in unicast reception mode.
ARP — The unicast mode of R-GOOSE transmission requires Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) for the resolution of the
network layer address into the MAC layer address. R-TxGOOSE## ARP status On indicates that ARP responses are being
received and the destination MAC address for R-GOOSE transmissions has been obtained. This status remains Off if
TxGOOSE## is not configured for R-GOOSE. It also remains Off if setting R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is set to a multicast address. In
the case where setting R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is configured with a unicast address and this status indicates Off, TxGOOSE##
transmission will be off, and therefore communication network diagnosis needs to be carried out.
This status is only applicable for R-GOOSE transmission with setting R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP set to a unicast IP address. It is not
applicable for GOOSE or for R-GOOSE when setting R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is multicast.

6.3.24 Protocol
ACTUAL VALUES  STATUS  PROTOCOL 6
 PROTOCOL IEC61850 EDITION: Range: Edition1, Edition2
  Edition2

The F35 is provided with optional IEC 61850 capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time
of ordering. See the Order Codes section of chapter 2 for details.

Displays the IEC 61850 edition currently being used, as set under Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Protocol
> IEC61850 SCL Edition. This value displays only on the front panel.

6.4 Metering
6.4.1 Metering conventions

6.4.1.1 UR convention for measuring power and energy


The figure illustrates the conventions established for use in UR devices.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-13


METERING CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

Figure 6-3: Flow direction of signed values for watts and VARs

PER IEEE CONVENTIONS


Generator
Parameters as seen by
G the UR-series relays

Voltage +Q
VCG
Watts = Positive IC
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Vars = Positive
PF = Lag IA
VAG –P +P
Current IB IA
PF = Lag PF = Lead
UR-SERIES IED
VBG
–Q
M LOAD –Θ1°
Inductive Resistive S=VI

Generator
G

VCG +Q
Voltage
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Watts = Positive IA
Vars = Negative IC
PF = Lead VAG –P +P
IA
Current
PF = Lag PF = Lead
IB
UR-SERIES IED
VBG –Q

S=VI
LOAD
–Θ2°
Resistive

Inductive Resistive
M LOAD

VCG +Q

Voltage PF = Lead PF = Lag


IB
IA
Watts = Negative
Vars = Negative VAG –P +P

6 PF = Lag

Current IC
IA
PF = Lag PF = Lead
VBG
–Q
UR-SERIES IED
G S=VI
–Θ3°
Generator
Resistive
LOAD

+Q
VCG
Voltage IB
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Watts = Negative IA
Vars = Positive VAG –P +P
PF = Lead
IA IC

Current PF = Lag PF = Lead


VBG
UR-SERIES IED –Q
G S=VI
–Θ4°
Generator 827239AC.CDR

6.4.1.2 UR convention for measuring phase angles


All phasors calculated by URs and used for protection, control and metering functions are rotating phasors that maintain
the correct phase angle relationships with each other at all times.
For display and oscillography purposes, all phasor angles in a given relay are referred to an AC input channel pre-selected
by the SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  POWER SYSTEM  FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting. This setting defines a
particular AC signal source to be used as the reference.

6-14 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES METERING

The relay first determines if any “Phase VT” bank is indicated in the source. If it is, voltage channel VA of that bank is used
as the angle reference. Otherwise, the relay determines if any “Aux VT” bank is indicated; if it is, the auxiliary voltage
channel of that bank is used as the angle reference. If neither of the two conditions is satisfied, then two more steps of this
hierarchical procedure to determine the reference signal include “Phase CT” bank and “Ground CT” bank.
If the AC signal pre-selected by the relay upon configuration is not measurable, the phase angles are not referenced. The
phase angles are assigned as positive in the leading direction, and are presented as negative in the lagging direction, to
more closely align with power system metering conventions. The figure illustrates this.
Figure 6-4: UR phase angle measurement convention
-270o

-225o -315o

positive
angle
direction

-180o 0o
UR phase angle
reference

-135o -45o

-90o
827845A1.CDR

6.4.1.3 UR convention for measuring symmetrical components


The URs calculate voltage symmetrical components for the power system phase A line-to-neutral voltage, and
symmetrical components of the currents for the power system phase A current. Owing to the above definition, phase 6
angle relations between the symmetrical currents and voltages stay the same irrespective of the connection of instrument
transformers. This is important for setting directional protection elements that use symmetrical voltages.
For display and oscillography purposes the phase angles of symmetrical components are referenced to a common
reference as described in the previous sub-section.

WYE-connected instrument transformers


• ABC phase rotation: • ACB phase rotation:

The above equations apply to currents as well.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-15


METERING CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

DELTA-connected instrument transformers


• ABC phase rotation: • ACB phase rotation:

The zero-sequence voltage is not measurable under the Delta connection of instrument transformers and is defaulted to
zero. The table below shows an example of symmetrical components calculations for the ABC phase rotation.
Table 6-1: Symmetrical components calculation example
SYSTEM VOLTAGES, sec. V * VT conn. relay INPUTS, sec. V SYMM. COMP, sec. V
VAG VBG VCG VAB VBC VCA F5ac F6ac F7ac V0 V1 V2
13.9 76.2 79.7 84.9 138.3 85.4 WYE 13.9 76.2 79.7 19.5 56.5 23.3
0° –125° –250° –313° –97° –241° 0° –125° –250° –192° –7° –187°
UNKNOWN (only V1 and V2 84.9 138.3 85.4 DELTA 84.9 138.3 85.4 N/A 56.5 23.3
can be determined) 0° –144° –288° 0° –144° –288° –54° –234°

* The power system voltages are phase-referenced – for simplicity – to VAG and VAB, respectively. This, however, is a
relative matter. It is important to remember that the F35 displays are always referenced as specified under SETTINGS 
SYSTEM SETUP  POWER SYSTEM  FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE.
The example above is illustrated in the following figure.
Figure 6-5: Measurement convention for symmetrical components
System voltages Symmetrical
components
UR-series phase
angle reference

6
UR-series phase
angle reference

1
A

Wye VTs

C
B
0
2
UR
an -s
gl eri
e es
re p
fe ha
re s
nc e
e
U 1
A an R-s
gl eri
e es
re p
fe ha
re s
Delta VTs nc e
e

C
B
2
827844A1.CDR

6-16 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES METERING

6.4.2 Sources

6.4.2.1 Menu
ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1
 SOURCE SRC 1  PHASE CURRENT See below
   SRC 1

 GROUND CURRENT See page 6-18


  SRC 1

 PHASE VOLTAGE See page 6-18


  SRC 1

 AUXILIARY VOLTAGE See page 6-19


  SRC 1

 POWER See page 6-19


  SRC 1

 ENERGY See page 6-20


  SRC 1

 DEMAND See page 6-20


  SRC 1

 FREQUENCY See page 6-21


  SRC 1

 CURRENT HARMONICS See page 6-22


  SRC 1

 VOLTAGE HARMONICS See page 6-22


  SRC 1

This menu displays the metered values available for each source.
Metered values presented for each source depend on the phase and auxiliary VTs and phase and ground CTs assignments
for this particular source. For example, if no phase VT is assigned to this source, then any voltage, energy, and power 6
values are unavailable.

6.4.2.2 Phase current metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  PHASE CURRENT
 PHASE CURRENT SRC 1 RMS Ia: 0.000
 SRC 1  b: 0.000 c: 0.000 A

SRC 1 RMS Ia:


 0.000 A

SRC 1 RMS Ib:


 0.000 A

SRC 1 RMS Ic:


 0.000 A

SRC 1 RMS In:


 0.000 A

SRC 1 PHASOR Ia:


 0.000 A 0.0°

SRC 1 PHASOR Ib:


 0.000 A 0.0°

SRC 1 PHASOR Ic:


 0.000 A 0.0°

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-17


METERING CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

SRC 1 PHASOR In:


 0.000 A 0.0°

SRC 1 ZERO SEQ I0:


 0.000 A 0.0°

SRC 1 POS SEQ I1:


 0.000 A 0.0°

SRC 1 NEG SEQ I2:


 0.000 A 0.0°

The metered phase current values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text gets replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES).

6.4.2.3 Ground current metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  GROUND CURRENT
 GROUND CURRENT SRC 1 RMS Ig:
 SRC 1  0.000 A

SRC 1 PHASOR Ig:


 0.000 A 0.0°

SRC 1 PHASOR Igd:


 0.000 A 0.0°

The metered ground current values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by
the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES).

6.4.2.4 Phase voltage metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  PHASE VOLTAGE
 PHASE VOLTAGE SRC 1 RMS Vag:
 SRC 1  0.00 V
6  SRC 1 RMS Vbg:
0.00 V

SRC 1 RMS Vcg:


 0.00 V

SRC 1 PHASOR Vag:


 0.000 V 0.0°

SRC 1 PHASOR Vbg:


 0.000 V 0.0°

SRC 1 PHASOR Vcg:


 0.000 V 0.0°

SRC 1 RMS Vab:


 0.00 V

SRC 1 RMS Vbc:


 0.00 V

SRC 1 RMS Vca:


 0.00 V

SRC 1 PHASOR Vab:


 0.000 V 0.0°

SRC 1 PHASOR Vbc:


 0.000 V 0.0°

6-18 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES METERING

SRC 1 PHASOR Vca:


 0.000 V 0.0°

SRC 1 ZERO SEQ V0:


 0.000 V 0.0°

SRC 1 POS SEQ V1:


 0.000 V 0.0°

SRC 1 NEG SEQ V2:


 0.000 V 0.0°

The metered phase voltage values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by
the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES).

6.4.2.5 Auxiliary voltage metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  AUXILIARY VOLTAGE
 AUXILIARY VOLTAGE SRC 1 RMS Vx:
 SRC 1  0.00 V

SRC 1 PHASOR Vx:


 0.000 V 0.0°

The metered auxiliary voltage values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by
the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES).

6.4.2.6 Power metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  POWER
 POWER SRC 1 REAL POWER
 SRC 1  3: 0.000 W

SRC 1 REAL POWER


 a: 0.000 W

 SRC 1 REAL POWER 6


b: 0.000 W

SRC 1 REAL POWER


 c: 0.000 W

SRC 1 REACTIVE PWR


 3: 0.000 var

SRC 1 REACTIVE PWR


 a: 0.000 var

SRC 1 REACTIVE PWR


 b: 0.000 var

SRC 1 REACTIVE PWR


 c: 0.000 var

SRC 1 APPARENT PWR


 3: 0.000 VA

SRC 1 APPARENT PWR


 a: 0.000 VA

SRC 1 APPARENT PWR


 b: 0.000 VA

SRC 1 APPARENT PWR


 c: 0.000 VA

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-19


METERING CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

SRC 1 POWER FACTOR


 3: 1.000

SRC 1 POWER FACTOR


 a: 1.000

SRC 1 POWER FACTOR


 b: 1.000

SRC 1 POWER FACTOR


 c: 1.000

This menu displays metered values for real, reactive, and apparent power, as well as power factor. The "SRC 1" text is
replaced by the name programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL
SOURCES).
When VTs are configured in wye, the F35 calculates power in each phase and three-phase power is measured as
S = VA x ÎA + VB x ÎB + VC x ÎC Eq. 6-1
When VTs are configured in delta, the F35 does not calculate power in each phase and three-phase power is measured as
S = VAB x ÎA + VCB x ÎC Eq. 6-2
where
S is the apparent power
VA, VB, VC, IA, IB, IC are phase voltage and phase current phasors
VAB and VCB are phase-to-phase voltage phasors
Î is the conjugate of I

6.4.2.7 Energy metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  ENERGY
 ENERGY SRC 1 POS WATTHOUR:
 SRC 1  0.000 Wh
6  SRC 1 NEG WATTHOUR:
0.000 Wh

SRC 1 POS VARHOUR:


 0.000 varh

SRC 1 NEG VARHOUR:


 0.000 varh

This menu displays metered values for real and reactive energy. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by
the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES). Because energy values are
accumulated, record them and then reset them immediately prior to changing CT or VT characteristics.

6.4.2.8 Demand metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  DEMAND
 DEMAND SRC 1 DMD IA:
 SRC 1  0.000 A

SRC 1 DMD IA MAX:


 0.000 A

SRC 1 DMD IA DATE:


 2001/07/31 16:30:07

SRC 1 DMD IB:


 0.000 A

6-20 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES METERING

SRC 1 DMD IB MAX:


 0.000 A

SRC 1 DMD IB DATE:


 2001/07/31 16:30:07

SRC 1 DMD IC:


 0.000 A

SRC 1 DMD IC MAX:


 0.000 A

SRC 1 DMD IC DATE:


 2001/07/31 16:30:07

SRC 1 DMD W:
 0.000 W

SRC 1 DMD W MAX:


 0.000 W

SRC 1 DMD W DATE:


 2001/07/31 16:30:07

SRC 1 DMD VAR:


 0.000 var

SRC 1 DMD VAR MAX:


 0.000 var

SRC 1 DMD VAR DATE:


 2001/07/31 16:30:07

SRC 1 DMD VA:


 0.000 VA

SRC 1 DMD VA MAX:


 0.000 VA

SRC 1 DMD VA DATE:


 2001/07/31 16:30:07
6
This menu displays metered values for current and power demand. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed
by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES).
The relay measures (absolute values only) the source demand on each phase and average three phase demand for real,
reactive, and apparent power. These parameters can be monitored to reduce supplier demand penalties or for statistical
metering purposes. Demand calculations are based on the measurement type selected in the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP
 DEMAND menu. For each quantity, the relay displays the demand over the most recent demand time interval, the
maximum demand since the last maximum demand reset, and the time and date stamp of this maximum demand value.
Maximum demand quantities can be reset to zero with the CLEAR RECORDS  CLEAR DEMAND RECORDS command.

6.4.2.9 Frequency metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  FREQUENCY
 FREQUENCY SRC 1 FREQUENCY:
 SRC 1  0.00 Hz

The metered frequency values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by the
user for the associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES).
SOURCE FREQUENCY is measured via software-implemented zero-crossing detection of an AC signal. The signal is either a
Clarke transformation of three-phase voltages or currents, auxiliary voltage, or ground current as per source configuration
(see the SYSTEM SETUP  POWER SYSTEM settings). The signal used for frequency estimation is low-pass filtered. The final
frequency measurement is passed through a validation filter that eliminates false readings due to signal distortions and
transients.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-21


METERING CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

6.4.2.10 Current harmonics and THD metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  CURRENT HARMONICS
 CURRENT HARMONICS SRC 1 THD Ia: 0.0
 SRC 1  Ib: 0.0 Ic: 0.0%

SRC 1 2ND Ia: 0.0


 Ib: 0.0 Ic: 0.0%

SRC 1 3RD Ia: 0.0


 Ib: 0.0 Ic: 0.0%

SRC 1 25TH Ia: 0.0
 Ib: 0.0 Ic: 0.0%

This menu displays metered current harmonics values. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name was programmed for the
associated source (see SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES). Current harmonics are measured for each source
for the total harmonic distortion (THD) and 2nd to 25th harmonics per phase.

6.4.2.11 Voltage harmonics and THD metering


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  SOURCE SRC 1  VOLTAGE HARMONICS
 VOLTAGE HARMONICS SRC 1 THD Va: 0.0
 SRC 1  Vb: 0.0 Vc: 0.0%

SRC 1 2ND Va: 0.0


 Vb: 0.0 Vc: 0.0%

SRC 1 3RD Va: 0.0


 Vb: 0.0 Vc: 0.0%

SRC 1 25TH Va: 0.0
 Vb: 0.0 Vc: 0.0%

6 This menu displays metered voltage harmonics values. The “SRC 1” text is replaced by the programmed name for the
associated source (see the SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  SIGNAL SOURCES menu).
To extract the 2nd to 25th voltage harmonics, each harmonic is computed on a per-phase basis, where:
N = 64 is the number of samples per cycle
0 = 2f is the angular frequency based on the system frequency (50 or 60 Hz)
k = 1, 2,..., N – 1 is the index over one cycle for the Fast Fourier Transform (FFT)
m is the last sample number for the sliding window
h = 1, 2,..., 25 is the harmonic number
The short-time Fourier transform is applied to the unfiltered signal:

Eq. 6-3

The harmonics are a percentage of the fundamental signal obtained as a ratio of harmonic amplitude to fundamental
amplitude multiplied by 100%. The total harmonic distortion (THD) is the ratio of the total harmonic content to the
fundamental:

Eq. 6-4

6-22 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES METERING

Voltage harmonics are calculated only for Wye connected phase VTs. Ensure that the SYSTEM SETUP  AC INPUTS
 VOLTAGE BANK F5  PHASE VT XX CONNECTION setting is “Wye” to enable voltage harmonics metering.

6.4.3 Tracking frequency


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  TRACKING FREQUENCY
 TRACKING FREQUENCY TRACKING FREQUENCY:
  60.00 Hz

The tracking frequency displays here. The frequency is tracked based on the selection of the reference source with the
FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting in the SETTINGS  SYSTEM SETUP  POWER SYSTEM menu. See the Power
System section of chapter 5 for details.

6.4.4 FlexElements
ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  FLEXELEMENTS  FLEXELEMENT 1(16)
 FLEXELEMENT 1 FLEXELEMENT 1
  OpSig: 0.000

The operating signals for the FlexElements are displayed in pu values using the following definitions of the base units.
Table 6-2: FlexElement base units
Base unit Description
BREAKER ACC ARCING AMPS BASE = 2000 kA2  cycle
(Brk X Acc Arc Amp A, B, and C)
BREAKER ARCING AMPS BASE = 1 kA2  cycle
(Brk X Arc Amp A, B, and C)
DCmA BASE = maximum value of the DCMA INPUT MAX setting for the two transducers configured

FAULT LOCATION
under the +IN and –IN inputs.
BASE = Line Length as specified in Fault Report
6
FREQUENCY fBASE = 1 Hz
PHASE ANGLE BASE = 360 degrees (see the UR angle referencing convention)
POWER FACTOR PFBASE = 1.00
RTDs BASE = 100°C
SOURCE CURRENT IBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
SOURCE ENERGY EBASE = 10000 MWh or MVAh, respectively
(Positive and Negative Watthours,
Positive and Negative Varhours)
SOURCE POWER PBASE = maximum value of VBASE  IBASE for the +IN and –IN inputs
SOURCE THD & HARMONICS BASE = 1%
SOURCE VOLTAGE VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs

6.4.5 RxGOOSE analogs


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  RxGOOSE Analogs
 RxGOOSE RxGOOSE Analog 1
 Analogs  0.000

RxGOOSE Analog 32
 0.000

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-23


RECORDS CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

The F35 is provided with optional GOOSE communications capability. This feature is specified as a software
option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section of chapter 2 for details.

The RxGOOSE Analog values display in this menu. The RxGOOSE Analog values are received via IEC 61850 GOOSE
messages sent from other devices.

6.4.6 Wattmetric ground fault


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  WATTMETRIC GROUND FAULT 1(5)
 WATTMETRIC WATT GND FLT 1:
 GROUND FAULT 1  0.000 W

This menu displays the wattmetric zero-sequence directional element operating power values.

6.4.7 Transducer inputs/outputs


ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  TRANSDUCER I/O DCMA INPUTS  DCMA INPUT xx
 DCMA INPUT xx DCMA INPUT xx
  0.000 mA

Actual values for each DCmA input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed channel ID
and the bottom line as the value followed by the programmed units.
ACTUAL VALUES  METERING  TRANSDUCER I/O RTD INPUTS  RTD INPUT xx
 RTD INPUT xx RTD INPUT xx
  -50 °C

Actual values for each RTD input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed channel ID
and the bottom line as the value.
6
6.5 Records
6.5.1 Fault reports
ACTUAL VALUES  RECORDS  FAULT REPORTS  FAULT REPORT 1(15)
NO FAULTS TO REPORT

or
 FAULT REPORT 1 FAULT 1 Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4, SRC 5, SRC 6
  LINE ID: SRC 1

FAULT 1 DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD


 2000/08/11

FAULT 1 TIME: Range: HH:MM:SS.ssssss


 00:00:00.000000

FAULT 1 TYPE: Range: not available if the source VTs are in the
 ABG “Delta” configuration

FAULT 1 LOCATION Range: not available if the source VTs are in the
 00.0 km “Delta” configuration

6-24 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS

FAULT 1 RECLOSE Range: where applicable


 SHOT: 0

FAULT 1 LOOP Range: 0 to 327.67 Ohms


 RESIST: 0.00 Ohms

FAULT 1 LOOP Range: -327.67 to 327.67 Ohms


 REACT: 0.00 Ohms

The latest 15 fault reports can be stored. The most recent fault location calculation (when applicable) is displayed in this
menu, along with the date and time stamp of the event which triggered the calculation. See the SETTINGS  PRODUCT
SETUP  FAULT REPORTS menu for assigning the source and trigger for fault calculations. See the COMMANDS  CLEAR
RECORDS menu for manual clearing of the fault reports and to the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  CLEAR RELAY RECORDS
menu for automated clearing of the fault reports.
The FAULT 1 LOOP RESISTANCE and REACTANCE are expressed in secondary ohms, which are calculated as per the following
equation.
Zloop = Vloop / Iloop Eq. 6-5
The table defines the loop voltage and current.
Table 6-3: Quantities used to calculate fault loop impedances
Fault type Vloop Iloop
AG VA IA + (Z0/Z1-1)*I0 + Z0M/Z1*IG/3
BG VB IB + (Z0/Z1-1)*I0 + Z0M/Z1*IG/3
CG VC IC + (Z0/Z1-1)*I0 + Z0M/Z1*IG/3
AB, ABG VA – VB IA - IB
BC, BCG VB – VC IB - IC
CA, CAG VC – VA IC - IA
ABC Average of AB, BC, CA loop impedances

Where VA, VB, VC are phase voltage phasors in secondary volts; IA, IB, IC are current phasors in secondary amps, I0 is the
zero sequence current phasors in secondary amps; and IG is the ground current from the parallel line scaled to the source
phase CT in secondary amps. Z0/Z1 is the zero sequence impedance to positive sequence impedance ratio, and Z0M/Z1 is
6
mutual zero sequence impedance to positive sequence impedance ratio.

VTs of the FAULT REPORT 1 SOURCE must be connected in Wye or VT SUBSTITUTION must be set correctly for the Delta
connected VT to display the loop impedance and fault resistance for single phase-to-ground faults.
For the application of partially parallel circuits and in the case of single phase-to-ground faults, the reported fault
resistance and fault loop impedance may not be accurate even the compensation method is applied.

6.5.2 Event records

6.5.2.1 Enhanced and standard records


ACTUAL VALUES  RECORDS  EVENT RECORDS
 EVENT RECORDS EVENT: XXX
  XXX
 Date and time stamps

EVENT: 3 EVENT 3
 POWER ON   DATE: 2000/07/14

EVENT: 2 EVENT 3
 POWER OFF  TIME: 14:53:00.03405

EVENT: 1
 EVENTS CLEARED

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-25


RECORDS CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

The event records menu shows the contextual data associated with up to the last 1024 events, listed in chronological
order from most recent to oldest. When all 1024 event records have been filled, the oldest record is removed as a new
record is added. Each event record shows the event identifier/sequence number, cause, and date/time stamp associated
with the event trigger. See the COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing event records.
Only major output operands generate events, not every operand. Elements that assert output per phase, for example, log
operating phase output only without asserting the common three-phase operand event.
See also the system log (syslog) information in the previous chapter.
The event records are viewable in the software and in a web browser. The figure shows the event records in the software.
Figure 6-6: Event records viewed in EnerVista software

6
To view events in a web browser:
1. Enter the IP address of the device.
To download an oscillography waveform:
1. Click the arrow icon in the Data column.

6.5.2.2 Graphical front panel


To display the event records page, press the Home pushbutton then the Event Record Tab pushbutton.
The newest event is always at the top.
Up and Down pushbuttons move the event selector up and down. When the selector is at the bottom of the display, the
Down pushbutton also scrolls the page, and similarly when the active selector is at the top of the display the Up
pushbutton scroll the page.
A selected event is highlighted in yellow and becomes active by pressing the Up or Down pushbutton.
There are two event markers, one green, the other cyan. To mark some an event, use the Up and Down pushbuttons to
select it (highlight in yellow), then press the green or cyan Mark Event Tab pushbutton. The mark color hides the selector
until the selector is moved. A field at the top of the page shows the interval between the two marks.

6-26 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS

Figure 6-7: Event record

6.5.3 Oscillography

6.5.3.1 Enhanced and basic front panels


ACTUAL VALUES  RECORDS  OSCILLOGRAPHY
 OSCILLOGRAPHY FORCE TRIGGER? Range: No, Yes
  No

NUMBER OF TRIGGERS:
 0

AVAILABLE RECORDS:
 0

CYCLES PER RECORD:


 0
6
LAST CLEARED DATE:
 2000/07/14 15:40:16

This menu allows the user to view the number of triggers involved and number of oscillography traces available. The cycles
per record value is calculated to account for the fixed amount of data storage for oscillography. See the Oscillography
section of chapter 5 for details.
A trigger can be forced here at any time by setting “Yes” to the FORCE TRIGGER? command. See the COMMANDS  CLEAR
RECORDS menu for information on clearing the oscillography records.
To view a waveform:
2. Access Actual Values > Records > Oscillography in the EnerVista software.
3. In the window that opens, select the record number. The highest number is the most recent record (Newest Record
Number).
4. Click the Read button to get the waveform. When available, waveforms are displayed graphically, and otherwise error
messages display.
5. In the waveform window that opens, you can save the file, for example with the CFG extension.

6.5.4 Data logger


ACTUAL VALUES  RECORDS  DATA LOGGER
 DATA LOGGER OLDEST SAMPLE TIME:
  2000/01/14 13:45:51

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-27


RECORDS CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

NEWEST SAMPLE TIME:


 2000/01/14 15:21:19

The OLDEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time at which the oldest available samples were taken. It is static until the log gets
full, at which time it starts counting at the defined sampling rate.
The NEWEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time the most recent samples were taken. It counts up at the defined sampling
rate. If the data logger channels are defined, then both values are static.
See the COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing data logger records.

6.5.5 Breaker maintenance


ACTUAL VALUES  RECORDS  MAINTENANCE  BREAKER 1(6)
 BREAKER 1 BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP
  A: 0.00 kA2-cyc

BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP


 B: 0.00 kA2-cyc

BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP


 C: 0.00 kA2-cyc

BKR 1 OPERATING TIME


 A: 0 ms

BKR 1 OPERATING TIME


 B: 0 ms

BKR 1 OPERATING TIME


 C: 0 ms

BKR 1 OPERATING
 TIME: 0 ms

BKR 1 ARCING AMP A:


 0.00 kA2-cyc
6  BKR 1 ARCING AMP B:
0.00 kA2-cyc

BKR 1 ARCING AMP C:


 0.00 kA2-cyc

BKR 1 AMP MAX A:


 0.00 kA

BKR 1 AMP MAX B:


 0.00 kA

BKR 1 AMP MAX C:


 0.00 kA

There is an identical menu for each of the breakers.


The BKR 1 ACC ARCING AMP values are in units of kA2-cycles. See the COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing
breaker arcing current records.
The BREAKER OPERATING TIME is defined as the slowest operating time of breaker poles that were initiated to open.
All of the values are stored in non-volatile memory and retained with power cycling.

6-28 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES PRODUCT INFORMATION

6.6 Product information


6.6.1 Model information
ACTUAL VALUES  PRODUCT INFO  MODEL INFORMATION
 MODEL INFORMATION ORDER CODE LINE 1: Range: standard GE order code format
  F35-A00-AAA-A0A-A0A-

ORDER CODE LINE 2: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters


 A0A-A0A-A0A

ORDER CODE LINE 3: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters



ORDER CODE LINE 4: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters

SERIAL NUMBER: Range: standard GE serial number format

ETHERNET MAC ADDRESS Range: standard Ethernet MAC address format
 000000000000

MANUFACTURING DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS



OPERATING TIME: Range: operating time in HH:MM:SS
 0:00:00

CT/ VT ADVANCED DIAG Range: Yes, No


 ACTIVE: No

LAST SETTING CHANGE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 1970/01/01 23:11:19

The order code, serial number, Ethernet MAC address, date and time of manufacture, and operating time are shown here.
The rear panel on the device contains similar information. The information is read-only in the software and modifiable on 6
the front panel. For example, the order code can be corrected using the front panel.
ETHERNET MAC ADDRESS — UR devices with firmware 7.0x and above have three Ethernet ports that can be used on three
networks. The MAC address displays for port 1. The MAC address for port 2 is one higher. The MAC address for port 3 is one
higher than port 2. In redundant mode, the MAC addresses for ports 2 and 3 are the same as port 2.

6.6.2 Firmware revisions

6.6.2.1 Enhanced and basic front panels


ACTUAL VALUES  PRODUCT INFO  FIRMWARE REVISIONS
 FIRMWARE REVISIONS F35 Relay Range: 0.00 to 655.35
  REVISION: 7.6x Revision number of the application firmware.

MODIFICATION FILE Range: 0 to 65535 (ID of the MOD FILE)


 NUMBER: 0 Value is 0 for each standard firmware release.

BOOT PROGRAM Range: 0.00 to 655.35


 REVISION: 7.01 Revision number of the boot program firmware.

FRONT PANEL PROGRAM Range: 0.00 to 655.35


 REVISION: 2.01 Revision number of front panel program firmware.

COMPILE DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 2016/09/15 04:55:16 Date and time when product firmware was built.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 6-29


PRODUCT INFORMATION CHAPTER 6: ACTUAL VALUES

BOOT DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 2013/09/15 16:41:32 Date and time when the boot program was built.

FPGA PROGRAM Range: 0.00 to 655.35


 REVISION: 02.02 Revision number for FPGA.

FPGA DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 2016/09/15 16:41:32 Date and time when the FPGA was built.

The shown data is illustrative only. A modification file number of 0 indicates that, currently, no modifications have been
installed.

6.6.2.2 Graphical front panel


ACTUAL VALUES  PRODUCT INFO  FIRMWARE REVISIONS
 FIRMWARE REVISIONS F35 Relay Range: 0.00 to 655.35
  REVISION: 7.6x Revision number of the application firmware.

MODIFICATION FILE Range: 0 to 65535 (ID of the MOD FILE)


 NUMBER: 0 Value is 0 for each standard firmware release.

BOOT PROGRAM Range: 0.00 to 655.35


 REVISION: 7.01 Revision number of the boot program firmware.

COMPILE DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 2017/06/15 04:55:16 Date and time when product firmware was built.

BOOT DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 2016/09/15 16:41:32 Date and time when the boot program was built.

GFP PROGRAM Range: 0.00 to 655.35


 REVISION: 7.60 Revision number of front panel program firmware.

GFP COMPILE DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 2017/03/03 12:58:00 Date/time when graphical front panel firmware built.

GFP BOOT PROGRAM Range: 0.00 to 655.35


 REVISION: 1.00 Revision number of panel boot program firmware.
6 GFP BOOT COMP. DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS
 2017/03/03 12:58:00 Date/time when panel boot program was built.

FPGA PROGRAM Range: 0.00 to 655.35


 REVISION: 02.02 Revision number for FPGA.

FPGA DATE: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS


 2016/09/15 16:41:32 Date and time when the FPGA was built.

The shown data is illustrative only. A modification file number of 0 indicates that, currently, no modifications have been
installed. The date format reflects the format specified for the clock and can vary from that shown here.

6-30 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 7: Commands and targets

Commands and targets

This chapter outlines the Commands and Targets menus and self-tests/error messages. Commands related to the IEC
61850 protocol are outlined in the IEC 61850 section of the Settings chapter. Log/error messages for IEC 61850 are
outlined in the UR Family Communications Guide.

7.1 Commands menu

COMMANDS


 COMMANDS
  VIRTUAL INPUTS

 COMMANDS
  CLEAR RECORDS

 COMMANDS
  SET DATE AND TIME

 COMMANDS
  RELAY MAINTENANCE

 COMMANDS
  SECURITY

The commands menu contains relay directives intended for operations personnel. All commands can be protected from
unauthorized access via the command password; see the Security section of chapter 5 for details. The following flash
message appears after successfully command entry.
COMMAND
EXECUTED

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7-1


COMMANDS MENU CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS

7.1.1 Virtual inputs


COMMANDS  VIRTUAL INPUTS
 COMMANDS Virt Ip 1 Range: Off, On
 VIRTUAL INPUTS  Off

Virt Ip 2 Range: Off, On


 Off

Virt Ip 64 Range: Off, On
 Off

The states of up to 64 virtual inputs are changed here. The first line of the display indicates the ID of the virtual input. The
second line indicates the current or selected status of the virtual input. This status is a state off (logic 0) or on (logic 1).

7.1.2 Clear records


COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS
 COMMANDS CLEAR FAULT REPORTS? Range: No, Yes
 CLEAR RECORDS  No

CLEAR EVENT RECORDS? Range: No, Yes


 No

CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY? Range: No, Yes


 No

CLEAR DATA LOGGER? Range: No, Yes


 No

CLEAR BREAKER 1 Range: No, Yes


 ARCING AMPS? No

CLEAR BREAKER 2 Range: No, Yes


 ARCING AMPS? No

CLEAR DEMAND Range: No, Yes


 RECORDS? No

CLEAR ENERGY? Range: No, Yes


 No
7  CLEAR UNAUTHORIZED
ACCESS? No
Range: No, Yes

CLEAR DIRECT I/O Range: No, Yes.


 COUNTERS? No Valid only for units with Direct Input/Output module.

CLEAR TELEPROTECT Range: No, Yes


 COUNTERS? No

CLEAR INCIPIENT Range: No, Yes


 FAULT COUNTERS? No

 CLEAR IEC61850 See below


  XWSI OPCNT

 CLEAR IEC61850 See below


  XCBR OPCNT

CLEAR ALL RELAY Range: No, Yes


 RECORDS? No

7-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS COMMANDS MENU

This menu contains commands for clearing historical data such as the event records. Data is cleared by changing a
command setting to “Yes” and pressing the ENTER key. After clearing data, the command setting automatically reverts to
“No.”
COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS  CLEAR IEC61850 XWSI OPCNT
 CLEAR IEC61850 CLEAR XSWI 1 Range: No, Yes
 XWSI OPCNT  OpCnt? No

CLEAR XSWI 24 Range: No, Yes
 OpCnt? No

COMMANDS  CLEAR RECORDS  CLEAR IEC61850 XCBR OPCNT


 CLEAR IEC61850 CLEAR XCBR 1 Range: No, Yes
 XCBR OPCNT  OpCnt? No

CLEAR XCBR 8 Range: No, Yes
 OpCnt? No

The Clear XSWI commands clear the disconnect operation counters for each phase and the three-phase counter. Similarly,
the Clear XCBR commands clear the circuit breaker operation counters for each phase and the three-phase counter.

7.1.3 Set date and time


COMMANDS  SET DATE AND TIME
 COMMANDS SET DATE AND TIME: Range: YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS
 SET DATE AND TIME  2000/01/14 13:47:03

The date and time can be entered on the front panel keypad. The time setting is based on the 24-hour clock. The complete
date, as a minimum, must be entered to allow execution of this command. The new time and date take effect when the
ENTER key is pressed.
The clock also can be synchronized to the local computer time among several UR devices. Use the Synchronize Devices
entry in the Online Window area of the EnerVista software. (Click the button at the top of the window that opens.)
When the relay is synchronizing to an external time source such as PTP, IRIG-B, or SNTP, the manually entered time or the
manually synchronized time is over-written.
The timescale of the entered time is local time, including daylight savings time where and when applicable.
7
7.1.4 Relay maintenance
COMMANDS  RELAY MAINTENANCE
 COMMANDS PERFORM LAMP TEST? Range: No, Yes
 RELAY MAINTENANCE  No

PERFORM LCD TEST? Range: Off, Red, Green, Blue, White & Text Pattern,
 Off Black & Text Pattern, TV Test Pattern

PERFORM PUSHBUTTON Range: No, Yes


 TEST? No

UPDATE ORDER CODE? Range: No, Yes


 No

REBOOT RELAY? Range: No, Yes


 No

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7-3


COMMANDS MENU CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS

SERVICE COMMAND Range: 0, 101, 20511


 0

SAVE VOLATILE DATA? Range: No, Yes


 No

This menu contains commands for relay maintenance purposes. Commands for the lamp test and order code are
activated by changing a command setting to “Yes” and pressing the ENTER key. The command setting then automatically
reverts to “No.” The service command is activated by entering a numerical code and pressing the ENTER key.
Not all commands display in the software; use the front panel when required.
PERFORM LAMP TEST — Turns on all front panel LEDs and display pixels for a short duration.
PERFORM LCD TEST — This command detects either stuck-ON or stuck-OFF pixels (dead pixels) in the display screen on the
graphical front panel. RED/GREEN/BLUE is to display the solid background color in the whole screen. WHITE & TEXT
PATTERN shows the white background and black texts. BLACK & TEXT PATTERN shows the black background and white
texts. TV TEST PATTERN displays a standard television test pattern (SMPTE color bars). The test screen can be canceled by
pressing any pushbutton or after 30 seconds of inactivity.
PERFORM PUSHBUTTON TEST — This command tests the pushbuttons on the graphical front panel. During testing, press the
corresponding pushbutton according to the prompt text. A failure message is given if the expected action is not detected
in one minute. Holding the ESCAPE button for five seconds to interrupt the test sequence. The designated function of a
specific pushbutton is bypassed in the test.
UPDATE ORDER CODE — Use this command to read and update the order code, for example when hardware modules have
been changed inside the relay. It causes the relay to scan the backplane for the modules and update the order code to
match. All settings are defaulted with an update. When an update occurs, the following message displays and the relay
restarts.

UPDATING...
PLEASE WAIT

There is no impact if there have been no changes to the hardware modules. When an update does not occur, the ORDER
CODE NOT UPDATED message displays.
REBOOT RELAY — Restarts the relay so that changes to configuration settings can take effect. In most cases, if changes are
made to the configuration settings these changes do not take effect unless the relay is rebooted.

With the CyberSentry option, the Administrator and Operator roles can initiate the Reboot Relay command.

7 SERVICE COMMAND — Performs specific F35 service actions. Presently, there are two service actions available. Code "20511"
returns all settings to their factory default value and restarts the relay (then you re-enter IP address, restart, set unit to
"Programmed"). Code “101” is used to clear factory diagnostic information stored in the non-volatile memory. If a code
other than these two is entered, the command is ignored and no action is taken. Various self-checking diagnostics are
performed in the background while the F35 is running, and diagnostic information is stored on the non-volatile memory
from time to time based on the self-checking result. Although the diagnostic information is cleared before the F35 is
shipped from the factory, the user can want to clear the diagnostic information for themselves under certain
circumstances. For example, you clear diagnostic information after replacement of hardware. Once the diagnostic
information is cleared, all self-checking variables are reset to their initial state and diagnostics restart from scratch.
SAVE VOLATILE DATA — Saves this data to compact flash memory prior to shutdown. This allows the saved data to be as
recent as possible instead of relying on the periodic timer to save the data.

7.1.5 Security
COMMANDS  SECURITY
 SECURITY ADMINISTRATOR Range: Yes, No
  LOGOFF: No

7-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS TARGETS

ENGINEER Range: Yes, No


 LOGOFF: No

OPERATOR Range: Yes, No


 LOGOFF: No

CLEAR SECURITY DATA: Range: Yes, No


 No

With the CyberSentry option, this setting is available to enable or disable the following commands.
ADMINISTRATOR LOGOFF — Selecting ‘Yes’ allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an administrator session.
ENGINEER LOGOFF — Selecting ‘Yes’ allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an engineer session.
OPERATOR LOGOFF — Selecting ‘Yes’ allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an operator session.
CLEAR SECURITY DATA — Selecting ‘Yes’ allows the Supervisor to forcefully clear all the security logs and clears all the
operands associated with the self-tests.

7.2 Targets

TARGETS


PHASE TOC4 Displayed only if targets for this element are active.
 OP: A B - Example shown.

DIGITAL ELEMENT 48: Displayed only if targets for this element are active.
 LATCHED Example shown.


A target enables the EnerVista UR Setup software to monitor automatically and display the status of any active target
messages of all the devices inserted into that site.
Each F35 element with a TARGET setting has a target message that when activated by its element is displayed in sequence
with any other currently active target messages in the TARGETS menu. In the example shown, the Phase TOC4 and Digital
Element 48 target settings are active and so have their targets displayed. The down arrow below the two elements
indicates that there can be other active elements beyond these two. 7
For more information, see the description of target messages in the next section, and the Introduction to Elements section
in the Settings chapter for instructions on TARGET setting.
When no targets are active, the display reads NO ACTIVE TARGETS.

7.2.1 Target messages


When there are no active targets, the first target to become active causes the display to immediately default to that
message. If there are active targets and the user is navigating through other messages, and when the default message
timer times out (i.e. the keypad has not been used for a determined period of time), the display again defaults back to the
target message.
The range of variables for the target messages is described below. Phase information is included if applicable. If a target
message status changes, the status with the highest priority displays.
Table 7-1: Target message priority status
Priority Active status Description
1 OP element operated and still picked up

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7-5


TARGETS CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS

Priority Active status Description


2 PKP element picked up and timed out
3 LATCHED element had operated but has dropped out

If a self test error is detected, a message appears indicating the cause of the error. For example UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED
indicates that the minimal relay settings have not been programmed.

7.2.2 Relay self-tests

7.2.2.1 Description
The relay performs a number of self-test diagnostic checks to ensure device integrity. The two types of self-tests (major
and minor) are listed in the following tables. When either type of error occurs, the Trouble LED Indicator turns on and a
target message displays. All errors record an event in the event recorder. Latched errors can be cleared by pressing the
RESET key, providing the condition is no longer present.
Major self-test errors also result in the following:
• The critical fail relay on the power supply module de-energizes
• All other output relays de-energize and are prevented from further operation
• The front panel In Service LED indicator turns off
• A RELAY OUT OF SERVICE event is recorded
To view error messages in EnerVista software:
1. Access Actual Values > Records > Event Records.

Messages display on the front panel with one or two lines of text. An example is as follows. In the tables that follow,
messages are grouped using the first line of text. For example, MAINTENANCE ALERT, then a row for 4L Discrepancy, then a
row for Bad IRIG-B Signal.

MAINTENANCE ALERT:
4L Discrepancy

MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Bad IRIG-B Signal

7 7.2.2.2 Major self-test error messages


The major self-test errors are outlined in this section.
Table 7-2: Major self-test errors
Error Latched? Description Test frequency Action
DIAGNOSTIC FAILURE ___:
Self Test Error No Internal recovery failure Upon recovery Extract a Service Report through UR
detected Setup software. Contact technical
support and supply details of the
failure code on the display.
EQUIPMENT MISMATCH:
2nd line detail No The number or type of On power up. Check all modules against the order
installed hardware modules Afterwards, the code, ensure they are inserted
does not match the order backplane is properly, and cycle control power. If a
code stored in the F35. An checked for missing module has intentionally been added
example is when a basic front cards every five or removed, refresh the order code
panel is installed and the seconds under Device Setup. If the problem
order code on the F35 persists, contact the factory.
expects a graphical front
panel.

7-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS TARGETS

Error Latched? Description Test frequency Action


FLEXLOGIC ERROR:
2nd line detail No A FlexLogic equation is Event driven, Finish all equation editing and use self
incorrect performed whenever tests to debug any errors.
FlexLogic equations
are modified
RAM FILESYSTEM FAIL:
Self-Test Error Yes The relay failed to create the On relay startup Contact factory service
RAM file system
SYSTEM FAILURE ___:
2nd line detail Yes Relay system failure detected Continuous Extract a Service Report through UR
Setup software. Contact technical
support and supply details of the
failure code on the display.
SYSTEM FAILURE:
Card F8L Yes This is an indication that the The recommendation is to replace this
DSP module has failed. The DSP. Extract a Service Report through
slot and DSP type are UR Setup software and provide it to GE
indicated in the message. customer service.
TO INSTALL SETTINGS:
CHECK LOG AND REBOOT Yes Certain settings require a A new CID is sent Restart relay
reboot to be applied, for and it includes
example DNP settings, IEC changes in settings
104 settings. After a CID file that require a reboot
was send to the relay, a to be
manual reboot of the relay is applied
required to apply those
settings that require a
reboot
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED:
Check Settings No The PRODUCT SETUP  On power up and Program all settings and then set
INSTALLATION  RELAY whenever the PRODUCT SETUP  INSTALLATION
SETTINGS setting indicates PRODUCT SETUP  RELAY SETTINGS to “Programmed”
the F35 is not programmed  INSTALLATION
 RELAY SETTINGS
setting is altered

7.2.2.3 Minor self-test error messages


Most of the minor self-test errors can be disabled. See the settings in the User-programmable Self-tests section in chapter
5. 7
Table 7-3: Minor self-test errors
Error Latched? Description Test frequency Action
DIAGNOSTIC ALARM COP:
Self-test Error Yes This is a preliminary warning Extract a Service Report through UR
that transient errors were Setup software and provide it to GE
detected in the coprocessor. customer service
The relay remains operational
but some elements can
operate slightly delayed.
DIAGNOSTIC ALARM DSP:
Card F8L Yes This is a preliminary warning Extract a Service Report through UR
that there is something wrong Setup software and provide it to GE
with a DSP. The slot and DSP customer service
type is indicated in the
message.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7-7


TARGETS CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS

Error Latched? Description Test frequency Action


DIAGNOSTICS FAILURE Yes This is a warning that there is Extract a Service Report through UR
something wrong with the Setup software and provide it to GE
DSP/coprocessor subsystem. customer service
The source of the problem is
unknown as there are
multiple contributors.
DIRECT DEVICE OFF:
COMM Path Incomplete No A direct device is configured Every second Check direct input and output
but not connected configuration and wiring
DOS PARTITION ALARM:
SELF-TEST ERROR There is a problem with the On relay power-up Contact the factory
Compact Flash memory in the and afterwards once
CPU module every 24 hours
LOW ON MEMORY:
with 2nd line detail Yes The relay periodically checks Every five seconds Contact the factory
the amount of free RAM
memory available and the
amount of free stack
available for each task
against pre-defined
thresholds. The second line of
the self-test indicates which
of the tests failed. It asserts
this self-test if those tests fail.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
4L Discrepancy No A discrepancy has been Upon initiation of a Verify the state of the output contact
detected between the actual contact output state and contact the factory if the problem
and desired state of a change persists
latching contact output of an
installed type “4L” module
Bad IRIG-B Signal No A bad IRIG-B input signal has Monitored whenever Ensure the following:
been detected an IRIG-B signal is - The IRIG-B cable is properly
received connected.
- Proper cable functionality (that is,
check for physical damage or perform
a continuity test).
- The IRIG-B receiver is functioning.
- Check the input signal level (it can be
less than specification).
If none of these apply, then contact the
factory.
7 Bad PTP Signal No No PTP enabled port has Activated when no Ensure the following:
good PTP signal input acceptable signal is - The Ethernet cable(s) are properly
being received connected.
- At least one PTP grandmaster-
capable clock is functioning.
- If strict PP is enabled, that entire
network is PP compliant.
- The network is delivering PTP
messages to the relay.
Direct Ring Break No Direct input and output Every second Check direct input and output
settings are configured for a configuration and wiring
ring, but the connection is not
in a ring
FIRST ETHERNET FAIL Yes A link loss detection on an Check the connection
SECOND ETHERNET FAIL Ethernet port. The link loss is
THIRD ETHERNET FAIL due to unplugging the cable
or the switch port being
down.

7-8 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS TARGETS

Error Latched? Description Test frequency Action


Front Panel Trouble No The graphical front panel is Every second Contact the factory
not responsive for more than
five seconds. The relay is still
protecting, and the main CPU
is not affected by this self-
test.
GFP Version Mismatch No The graphical front panel Whenever Perform a UR firmware upgrade with
firmware revision is not connection is the graphical front panel connected to
synchronized with that of the established between the CPU module in the relay. It can be
CPU module in the relay the graphical front done using any communication
panel and the CPU interface (Ethernet or USB). This
module in the relay synchronizes the graphical firmware
revision with that of the relay. If trouble
persists, contact the factory.
GGIO Ind xxx oscill No A data item in a configurable Upon scanning of The “xxx” text denotes the data item
GOOSE data set is oscillating each configurable that has been detected as oscillating.
GOOSE data set Evaluate all logic pertaining to this
item.
Oscillatory GOOSE No A data item in a configurable Upon scanning of Evaluate all logic pertaining to this item
GOOSE data set is oscillating each configurable
GOOSE data set
Replace Battery Yes The battery is weak or not Every five seconds. Replace the battery as outlined in the
functioning. It powers the real The error message Maintenance chapter. To minimize the
time clock. This message displays after 60 disruption until battery replacement,
displays as Battery Fail in the seconds if the temporarily disable the battery fail
event records. When the problem persists. function under Settings > Product
battery weakness reaches a Setup > User-Programmable Self
critical level, the message Tests.
displays persistently on the
front panel and no front panel
key navigation is possible.
Setting Changed No Any device settings were On any setting Verify that the setting change was
changed over any available changes, when new legitimate and essential for proper
interface settings were written functioning of the protection and
to device control system
SFP MODULE x FAIL No A faulty small form-factor The web page "SFP Transceiver
pluggable port (SFP) or Information" described in the previous
unplugging of the SFP row applies for this self test as well. The
generates this self test "SFP Module Fail" has higher priority
message and it suppresses the "Ethernet Fail"
target message. The "SFP MODULE FAIL
FUNCTION" setting enables/disables
this self test. The target for this self test
is priority-based, with the third one 7
being the highest priority. For example,
if all three SFP modules fail, then the
third SFP target is activated. If the third
SFP module failure resolves, then the
second SFP target is activated.
SNTP Failure No The SNTP server is not Every 10 to 60 Check that Ethernet cable(s) are
responding seconds properly connected. Check that
configuration for the SNTP server
corresponds to the actual server
settings. Check connectivity to the
server (ping the server IP address).
Check that UR settings for both SNTP
servers are configured with different IP
addresses and port numbers.
PROTOTYPE FIRMWARE:
Self Test Error Seen until the build is tagged Seen on startup and Update firmware to either of these
as being 'release candidate' then continuous builds
or 'gold' build

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7-9


TARGETS CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS

Error Latched? Description Test frequency Action


RRTD COMM FAIL:
Self Test Error No Communications with remote Runs only if "Com2 Check COM2 port settings, check
RTD unit (RRTD) or GPM-F Usage" is set to RRTD RS485 cables
failed for longer than 10 or RRTD&GPM-F.
seconds Checked every five
seconds.
RxGOOSE FAIL:
Missing messages No One or more RxGOOSE The self-test is Check GOOSE setup
messages are not being activated when no
received message is received
within the expected
time interval, which
is the time-to-live
time in the previous
message. This time
can be from
milliseconds to
minutes.
RxGOOSE OFFLINE:
COMM Path Incomplete No One or more RxGOOSE Event driven. The test Check GOOSE setup
messages are not responding is performed when a
device programmed
to receive GOOSE
messages stops
receiving. This can be
from 1 to 60
seconds, depending
on GOOSE packets.
SETTINGS SAVE ERROR:
Contact Factory Yes The relay failed to store the When a setting is Contact the factory
settings to the flash memory changed
STORAGE MEDIA ALARM:
Self Test Error No The CPU module fails to read On power up. Contact the factory
from or write to the Compact Afterwards, every
Flash (CF) card inside the time the CPU
module. The CF card stores accesses the CF card
certain non-volatile data, for reading or writing
such as event records,
oscillography and datalogger
records, fault report values,
and non-volatile actual
7 values. Settings are not stored
in CF and hence are
unaffected by this self-test.
SYSTEM EXCEPTION:
Press RESET key Yes Abnormal restart from Event driven Contact the factory
modules being removed or
inserted while the F35 is
powered-up, when there is an
abnormal DC supply, or as a
result of internal relay failure.
TEMP MONITOR:
OVER TEMPERATURE Yes The ambient temperature is Every hour Remove the F35 from service and
greater than the maximum install in a location that meets
operating temperature operating temperature standards
(+80°C)
UNIT NOT CALIBRATED:
with 2nd line DSP slot number Yes DSP module is not calibrated On relay startup The respective DSP module has to be
detail or calibration data is out of replaced, contact factory service
range

7-10 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS TARGETS

Error Latched? Description Test frequency Action


VOLTAGE MONITOR:
with 2nd line detail Yes The relay detected a problem Every five seconds Contact GE customer service
with the internal voltage rails
Power Supply 12V Low for longer than 25 seconds
Power Supply 12V High
Power Supply 5V Low
Power Supply 5V High
WRONG TRANSCEIVER:
Self Test Error Yes The type of SFP does not A web page "SFP Transceiver
match the CPU type. The SFP Information" is provided. This page
is a silver device that plugs displays the type of the SFP in it. This
into the rear of the CPU data is to be used with the CPU type to
module. know the cause of the problem.

T-type CPU = All ports support


fiber SFPs only
U-type CPU = Maintenance
port needs RJ45 SFP and the
other two ports fiber SFPs
V-type CPU = All ports support
RJ45 SFPs only

The consequence of an
incorrect SFP can range from
damage to the F35 to no
power information for the F35
on its web page (enter IP
address in a web browser,
then click the SFP
Transceiver Information —
only the type of SFP displays
and not power data).

7.2.2.4 HardFiber major self-test error messages


In addition to those provided by the standard UR-series devices, the UR devices implement HardFiber self-tests. These are
listed here. Any abnormal diagnostic condition indicated by the LEDs or the critical failure relay also results in a self-test
message, so troubleshooting is described here. For other relays, such at the B95Plus, see that product’s instruction manual.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7-11


TARGETS CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS

Table 7-4: HardFiber major self-test errors


Error Description Severity Action
EQUIPMENT MISMATCH The number or type of installed Protection is not Check all modules against the order code. Ensure
hardware modules does not available and all they are inserted properly, and cycle the control
match the order code stored in contact outputs and power. If a module has intentionally been added
the CPU. The standard UR-series shared outputs are de- or removed use the Update Order Code
Equipment Mismatch self-test is asserted command to notify the relay that the current
extended to cover the possible module configuration is correct.
presence of a Process Card.
MODULE FAILURE UR-series device module Protection is not Contact the factory and supply the failure code
hardware failure detected available and all noted in the display. Text in the message
contact outputs and identifies the failed module (for example, H81). If
shared outputs are de- operated on a Process Card failure, the Module
asserted Fail self-test seals-in (latches) till the UR-series
device is restarted.
PROCESS BUS FAILURE Mission critical data is not Protection is not First rectify any Process Bus Trouble and Brick
available via the process bus. An available and all Trouble self-test errors. Check the actual value of
AC quantity is considered critical contact outputs and the operand referenced by the Process Bus
if both AC bank origins and the shared outputs are de- Failure Operand setting, and if “On,” determine
crosschecking settings are other asserted the cause and rectify.
than None. This self-test is also
initiated by an AC input If the problem persists with the foregoing all clear,
discrepancy being detected. See the cause must be an AC input discrepancy,
the description in the which is typically the result of problems in the
Crosschecking setting in the input signals to the Bricks, or faults in the Brick
HardFiber manual for further input conditioning hardware. If the error was
information. In addition, this self- annunciated the first time significant signal was
test can be initiated by user logic encountered, suspect the former cause and
responding to loss of critical check the copper connections external to the
contact input/output or other Brick. Where multiple UR-series devices have
data using the Process Bus self-test errors, look for common causes.
Failure Operand user-
programmable self-test setting. To further isolate AC input discrepancy errors, put
This setting is located in the the relay in test-isolated mode, then one by one,
Settings > Product Setup > temporally change an AC bank Crosschecking
User-Programmable Self Test setting to None, until the Process Bus Failure
menu. clears. Once the problem AC bank has been
identified, the values from each of the two Bricks
can be examined individually by temporarily
mapping each to an AC bank with a single origin.

7-12 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS TARGETS

7.2.2.5 HardFiber minor self-test error messages

Table 7-5: HardFiber minor self-test errors


Error Description Severity Action
BRICK TROUBLE Brick internal self-testing has This self-test error does Check the Brick environment for over/under
detected trouble internal to the not directly inhibit temperatures and the voltage of its power
Brick protection. However, source. If the ambient temperature and supply
some or all of the voltage are within Brick specifications, consult
affected Brick inputs/ the factory. Troubles resulting from a Brick output
outputs may not be failing to respond to an output command can
available to the UR only be detected while the command is active,
device. and so in this case the target is latched. A latched
target can be unlatched by pressing the front
panel reset key if the command has ended,
however the output can still be non-functional.
PROCESS BUS TROUBLE Communications problems with This self-test error does Check the field unit actual values. An indication of
one or more Bricks. The text of not directly inhibit equipment mismatch means that messages are
the message identifies the protection. However, being received from a Brick, but there is a
affected field units. This self-test the affected Brick discrepancy between the settings and the actual
is initiated by low received signal inputs/outputs may Brick serial number, order code, and/or core
levels at either the Brick or not be available to the number.
Process Card end, and by the UR device.
sustained failure to receive poll Check that the correct core on the correct Brick is
responses from the proper Brick. patched through to the correct Process Card
port, and that the field unit settings are correct.
An indication of communications loss means that
no messages are being received.

Check that the patching is correct, and that the


Brick has power. If that is not the problem, use a
professional optical fiber connector cleaning kit
to clean both sides of all optical fiber connections
from the Process Card through to the affected
Brick. If the problem continues after cleaning,
consult the factory.
RTD TROUBLE:
Self Test Error The Brick is reporting that the Not latched Check field RTD settings and connections
sensed RTD field connection
does not match that of an RTD or
the reported DC input value is
outside of the RTD temperature
range, greater than 250°C (likely
open sensor circuit fault) or less
than -50°C (likely shorted sensor 7
fault).
TDR TROUBLE:
Self Test Error The Brick is reporting that the Not latched Check field transducer settings and connections
sensed transducer field
connection does not match that
of a transducer, or the reported
DC input value is outside of the
set transducer input range, or
the minimum value setting is
equal to the maximum value
setting.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7-13


TARGETS CHAPTER 7: COMMANDS AND TARGETS

7-14 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 8: Commissioning

Commissioning

This chapter outlines how to test frequency timing.

8.1 Testing
8.1.1 Testing underfrequency elements
Underfrequency and overfrequency protection requires techniques with subtle testing implications. Whereas most
protection is designed to detect changes from normal to fault conditions that occur virtually instantaneously, power
system inertia requires frequency protection to pick up while the frequency is changing slowly. Frequency measurement is
inherently sensitive to noise, making high precision in combination with high speed challenging for both relays and test
equipment.
Injection to a particular F35 frequency element must be to its configured source and to the channels that the source uses
for frequency measurement. For frequency measurement, a source uses the first quantity configured in the following
order:
1. Phase voltages
2. Auxiliary voltage
3. Phase currents
4. Ground current
For example, if auxiliary voltage and phase currents are configured, the source uses the auxiliary voltage, not the phase
voltages or any of the currents.
When phase voltages or phase currents are used, the source applies a filter that rejects the zero-sequence component. As
such, the same signal must not be injected to all three phases, or the injected signal is completely filtered out. For an
underfrequency element using phase quantities, the phase A signal must be above the MIN VOLT/AMP setting value.
Therefore, either inject into phase A only, or inject a balanced three-phase signal.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 8-1


TESTING CHAPTER 8: COMMISSIONING

Figure 8-1: Typical underfrequency element test timing

Frequency Injection frequency

Source frequency

Tracking frequency

Pickup
frequency

Relay conditioning time

Source frequency calculation delay

Time
Underfrequency element detection time

Underfrequency element pickup


set “pickup delay”

Underfrequency element operate


831771A1.CDR

The static accuracy of the frequency threshold is determined by slowly adjusting the frequency of the injected signal about
the set pickup. If the F35 frequency metering feature is used to determine the injected frequency, verify the metering
accuracy by checking it against a known standard (for example, the power system).
To accurately measure the time delay of a frequency element, a test emulating realistic power system dynamics is
required. Let the injected frequency ramp smoothly through the set threshold, with the ramp starting frequency sufficiently
outside the threshold so that the relay becomes conditioned to the trend before operation. For typical interconnected
power systems, the recommended testing ramp rate is 0.20 Hz/s.
The required delay time is the interval from the point the frequency crosses the set threshold to the point that the element
operates. Some test sets can measure only the time from the ramp start to element operation, necessitating the
subtraction of the pre-threshold ramp time from the reading. For example, with a ramp rate of 0.20 Hz/s, start the ramp
0.20 Hz before the threshold and subtract 1 second from the test set time reading of ramp start to relay operation.
Note that the F35 event records only show the “pickup delay” component, a definite time timer. This is exclusive of the time
taken by the frequency responding component to pickup.
F35 oscillography can be used to measure the time between the calculated source frequency crossing the threshold and
8 element operation; however, this method omits the delay in the calculated source frequency. The security features of the
source frequency measurement algorithm result in the calculated frequency being delayed by two to four cycles (or longer
with noise on the input). In addition, oscillography resolution is 0.004 Hz, which at 0.20 Hz/s corresponds to a delay of 20
ms. Do not use the tracking frequency in timing measurements, as its algorithm involves phase locking, which purposely
sets its frequency high or low to allow the F35 sample clock to catch-up or wait as necessary to reach synchronism with
the power system.

8-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 9: Theory of operation

Theory of operation

This chapter outlines advanced information on operation.

9.1 Fault locator


9.1.1 Fault type determination
Fault type determination is required for calculation of fault location. The algorithm uses the angle between the negative
and positive sequence components of the relay currents. To improve accuracy and speed of operation, the fault
components of the currents are used; that is, the pre-fault phasors are subtracted from the measured current phasors. In
addition to the angle relationships, certain extra checks are performed on magnitudes of the negative and zero-sequence
currents.
The single-ended fault location method assumes that the fault components of the currents supplied from the local (A) and
remote (B) systems are in phase. The figure shows an equivalent system for fault location.
Figure 9-1: Equivalent system for fault location

distance to fault
Remote
Local bus bus
ZA IA mZ (1-m)Z IB ZB

IF

EA VF RF EB
VA VB

842780A2.CDR

The following equations hold true for this equivalent system.

Eq. 9-1

where

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 9-1


FAULT LOCATOR CHAPTER 9: THEORY OF OPERATION

m = sought pu distance to fault


Z = positive sequence impedance of the line
IF = fault current flowing through the fault point
The fault network during a fault can be decomposed into a pre-fault and a pure-fault network. Therefore, the fault current
IF is calculated as follows by using the current division rule in the pure-fault network.

Eq. 9-2

where
d is the current distribution factor, which is a complex value
Substituting the second equation into the first equation and multiplying both sides by the complex conjugate of IAF,

Eq. 9-3

where
* denotes complex conjugate
Assuming the system is homogeneous, d is then a real number. The fault resistance does not have any imaginary part. The
preceding equation solved for the unknown m yields the following fault location algorithm:

Eq. 9-4

where
Im( ) stands for the imaginary part of a complex number
Depending on the fault type, appropriate voltage and current signals are selected from the phase quantities before
applying the preceding equation (the superscripts denote phases, the subscripts denote stations).
For AG faults:

Eq. 9-5

For BG faults:

Eq. 9-6

For CG faults:

Eq. 9-7

For AB and ABG faults:

Eq. 9-8

For BC and BCG faults:

9 Eq. 9-9

For CA and CAG faults:

Eq. 9-10

9-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 9: THEORY OF OPERATION FAULT LOCATOR

where K0 is the zero sequence compensation factor (for the first six equations)
Z0M is the mutual zero sequence impedance
I0M = IG/3 and IG is the ground current of the adjacent line. The I0M compensation term is applied for the entirely parallel
line.
For ABC faults, all three AB, BC, and CA loops are analyzed and the final result is selected based upon consistency of the
results.
The element calculates the distance to the fault (with m in miles or kilometers) and the phases involved in the fault.
The relay allows locating faults from delta-connected VTs. If the FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting is set to “None,”
and the VTs are connected in wye, the fault location is performed based on the actual phase to ground voltages. If the VTs
are connected in delta, fault location is suspended.
If the FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting value is “V0” and the VTs are connected in a wye configuration, the fault
location is performed based on the actual phase to ground voltages. If the VTs are connected in a delta configuration, fault
location is performed based on the delta voltages and externally supplied neutral voltage:

Eq. 9-11

If the FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting value is “I0” and the VTs are connected in a wye configuration, the fault
location is performed based on the actual phase to ground voltages. If the VTs are connected in a delta configuration, fault
location is performed based on the delta voltages and zero-sequence voltage approximated based on the zero-sequence
current:

Eq. 9-12

where ZSYS0 is the equivalent zero-sequence impedance behind the relay as entered under the fault report setting menu.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 9-3


FAULT LOCATOR CHAPTER 9: THEORY OF OPERATION

Figure 9-2: Fault locator scheme

SETTINGS
FAULT REPORT 1 Z1
MAG:
FAULT REPORT 1 Z1
ANGLE:
FAULT REPORT 1 Z0
MAG:
FAULT REPORT 1 Z0
ANGLE:
FAULT REPORT 1
LENGTH UNITS:
FAULT REPORT 1
LENGTH:

SETTING FAULT REPORT 1 VT


SUBSTITUTION:
FAULT REPORT
TRIG: FAULT REP 1
SYSTEM Z0 MAG:
Off=0
FAULT REP 1
SYSTEM Z0 ANGLE:
SETTINGS
AND RUN
FAULT REPORT
SOURCE: ACTUAL VALUES
0 FAULT REPORT #
SRC X 50DD OP
3 SEC
IA DATE
IB TIME
IC FAULT TYPE
FAULT
3I_0 LOCATOR 1 FAULT LOCATION
VA or VAB FAULT LOOP RESISTANCE
VB or VBC FAULT LOOP REACTANCE
VC or VCA FAULT# RECLOSE SHOT
Vn or V_0

SHOT # FROM
AUTO RECLOSURE
859748A1.CDR

9-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Chapter 10: Maintenance

Maintenance

This chapter outlines monitoring, maintenance, repair, storage, and disposal of the hardware and software.

10.1 Monitoring
Devices and data can be monitored.

10.1.1 Devices with Site Targets


To view an overview of devices:
1. Access the Site Targets item in the Online Window area, below the list of devices. It can take a few minutes for all
devices to be read.
2. Acknowledge any messages for unaccessible devices. The Site Targets window opens when done.
Figure 10-1: Site Targets window

10.1.2 Data with Modbus Analyzer


Use the Modbus Analyzer under Maintenance > Modbus Analyzer to monitor the values of the UR device. Use the Modbus
memory map addresses outlined in the UR Family Communications Guide for the entries.
The upper part of the window displays values. The lower part of the window is for factory service use.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-1


MONITORING CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

The first row in the figure shows that Contact Output 1 operation is being monitored. Its Modbus address is CAFA. The
actual value read from the device is 0, which means that it is off.
The second row in the figure shows the Contact Output 1 Name. It has a Modbus address of CAF0 and a default value of
"Cont Op 1." None of Selection column settings render this value because they present the information based on
numbering systems.
Figure 10-2: Modbus Analyzer used to monitor actual values on a UR

Address (HEX) — Modbus address in hexadecimal. See the Modbus memory map in the UR Family Communications Guide
or in the web interface (enter IP address of UR device in a web browser).
Modbus Type
Actual Value — To read the data in the UR device
Setting — To read a setting in the UR device
Coil — To read a command in the UR device
# of — Element, input, or output to read. An example is 1 for Contact Output 1.
Selection (examples demonstrate various ways to represent 0)
Hex — A decimal numbering system based on 16 possible values, from 0 to 9 and A to F. An example is 0x0000.
Char — A single unicode character, such as C. An example is 0.
Int — A 32-bit number, either positive or negative. An example is 0.
UInt — Unsigned 32-bit integer, which means that it cannot be negative but can be twice as large as a signed integer. An
example is 0.
Long — A 64-bit number, either positive or negative. An example is 0.
ULong — Unsigned 64-bit number, which means that it cannot be negative but can be twice as large as a signed 64-bit
number. An example is 0.
Float — A numbering system with no fixed number of digits before or after the decimal point. An example is 0.000000.
Binary — A numbering system using 0 and 1. An example is 0000-0000-0000-0000.

Entries are not saved when closing the window.

10

10-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE GENERAL MAINTENANCE

10.2 General maintenance


The F35 requires minimal maintenance. As a microprocessor-based relay, its characteristics do not change over time.
Expected service life is 20 years for UR devices manufactured June 2014 or later when applied in a controlled indoor
environment and electrical conditions within specification.
While the F35 performs continual self-tests, it is recommended that maintenance be scheduled with other system
maintenance. This maintenance can involve in-service, out-of-service, or unscheduled maintenance.

10.2.1 In-service maintenance


1. Visual verification of the analog values integrity, such as voltage and current (in comparison to other devices on the
corresponding system).
2. Visual verification of active alarms, relay display messages, and LED indications.
3. LED test.
4. Visual inspection for any damage, corrosion, dust, or loose wires.
5. Event recorder file download with further events analysis.

10.2.2 Out-of-service maintenance


1. Check wiring connections for firmness.
2. Analog values (currents, voltages, RTDs, analog inputs) injection test and metering accuracy verification. Calibrated
test equipment is required.
3. Protection elements setting verification (analog values injection or visual verification of setting file entries against
relay settings schedule).
4. Contact inputs and outputs verification. This test can be conducted by direct change of state forcing or as part of the
system functional testing.
5. Visual inspection for any damage, corrosion, or dust.
6. Event recorder file download with further events analysis.
7. LED Test and pushbutton continuity check.

To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored in a de-energized
state once per year, for one hour continuously.

10.2.3 Unscheduled maintenance (system interruption)


View the event recorder and oscillography or fault report for correct operation of inputs, outputs, and elements.

10.3 Retrieve files


Data, oscillography, log, events, routing, ARP, and other files can be transferred using the EnerVista software to a computer
or to a USB flash drive when using the graphical front panel. These files can be requested by technical support staff.
To retrieve a file using EnerVista software:
1. If the CyberSentry option is enabled, log in to the EnerVista software using the Administrator role.
2. In the Online Window area of EnerVista, access Maintenance > Retrieve File. The window opens.
3. Note the destination folder to which the file is to be saved at the top and change it if required. You can copy the path
or open the folder for convenience at this time.
4. Select the file to download from the UR device. 10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-3


RETRIEVE FILES CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

5. Click the Read File button. The file is saved to the destination folder. The EnerVista window remains open to download
additional files.

To retrieve a file using a USB drive:


1. Insert the USB drive into the bottom USB port on the graphical front panel. The page displays on the front panel.
2. Using the Up or Down pushbuttons on the front panel, select the file.
3. Press the COPY pushbutton. The files are copied from the F35 to the USB drive.

Do not unplug the USB drive while copying is in progress, else the USB drive can be compromised.

4. When done, to exit unplug the USB drive or press the ESCAPE pushbutton.

10.3.1 CyberSentry security event files


CyberSentry security events are available in the following two files: SECURITY_EVENTS.CSV and SETTING_CHANGES.LOG.

10.3.1.1 Security events file


The figure shows the content for the SECURITY_EVENTS.CSV file.
Figure 10-3: Security events file

Time — Local time.


Activity — The actual security event.
1 = Authentication Failed
2 = User Lockout
3 = FW Upgrade
4 = FW Lock
5 = Settings Lock
6 = Settings Change, this can fill the entire event log. Hence it is supported by the already existing
SETTINGS_CHANGE.LOG file. This event is not required.
7 = Clear Oscillography command
8 = Clear Data Logger command
9 = Clear Demand Records command
10 = Clear Energy command
11 = Reset Unauthorized Access
12 = Clear Teleprotection Counters
13 = Clear All Records
14 = Role Log out
15 = Role Log in
10 Change Method — Format code F229 for the settings control change method.

10-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE CONVERT DEVICE SETTINGS

0 = None
1 = Keypad
2 = Front port
3 = COM1 (not used)
4 = COM2 (RS485)
5 = Ethernet

10.3.1.2 Setting changes file


The SETTING_CHANGES.LOG file stores all the setting changes. A total of 1024 events are stored in a circular buffer in non-
volatile memory.
Figure 10-4: Setting changes file

10.4 Convert device settings


Settings files can be upgraded or downgraded to other firmware versions. For example, version 7.4 settings can be
upgraded to version 7.6.
Settings are reset to factory default upon conversion. For a graphical front panel, for example when upgrading from
version 7.6 to 7.7, single-line diagrams and cells configured for the Metering Editor are defaulted, while other graphical
front panel settings are retained.
When converting a settings file from version 7.20 or earlier to 7.70 or later, any IEC 61850 settings are defaulted, and
Edition 2 is used.
When converting a settings file from version since 7.30 inclusive to 7.70 or later, any IEC 61850 settings are converted and
Edition 2 is used.
To convert settings:
1. If not already in the Offline Window area, right-click the online device in the EnerVista software and select the Add
Device to Offline Window option. This copies the settings to the Offline Window area. Any message about file repair
usually means that settings were missing in the original file and have been added with default values to the new file.
2. Make a copy of the settings file in the Offline Window area by right-clicking the file and selecting Duplicate Device. A
copy of the file is made and the file name start with "Copy of." Optionally rename the file by right-clicking it and
selecting the Rename Device option.
3. Convert the settings by right-clicking one of the files in the Offline Window and selecting the Convert Device Settings
option.
If the option does not display, click the Admin > User Management menu item and enable the Update Info check box
for the user. Save.
Or if the option does not display, click the Admin > User Management menu item and enable the Enable Security
check box. Save. Select the Admin > User Login menu item. Enter "Administrator" for the user and enter the password.
(Contact GE Grid Solutions if you do not know the default password.)
10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-5


CONVERT DEVICE SETTINGS CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

GE recommends converting settings in firmware steps, for example when converting from 6.0 to 7.4x, convert first to
7.0 then 7.4 in order to follow embedded conversion rules and keep settings.
The settings convert and a report generates.
Figure 10-5: Upgrade settings

4. Review the conversion report. The values of all settings that have been defaulted during conversion are not listed in
the conversion report; to find the value of a setting before conversion, inspect the device backup file made before
conversion.
In the example shown here, settings have been reset to factory defaults and several settings are new in firmware
version 7.6 under Settings > System Setup > Switches and Breakers.
Figure 10-6: Conversion report

5. Change settings in the new file, for example by looking at the original file.
6. Write the converted file to the device, for example by dragging and dropping from the Offline Window to the Online
Window.
7. Check settings and operation.

10

10-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE COPY SETTINGS TO OTHER DEVICE

10.5 Copy settings to other device


Settings from one F35 device can be copied to another F35 device for rapid deployment. The order codes and IEC 61850
edition must match. See the Settings File section at the beginning of the Interfaces chapter for a list of settings not
deployed.
To apply settings to another device:
1. Right-click the device in the Online window and select the Add Device to Offline Window option. A window opens.
2. Check the file path and name the file, then click the Receive button. An example is to save the files in
D:\Users\Public\Public Documents\GE Power Management\URPC\Data\ and to name the source device
F35_Deployment. At the prompt, confirm the action. The settings are saved in .cid, .icd, and .urs files, and the entry
displays in the Offline window area.
3. Right-click the device in the Offline window area and select the Duplicate Device option. The device is copied with a
prefix of "Copy of." Multiple duplicates results in files being named "Copy of Copy of" for example, which can be
avoided by deleting the folder copies from the path shown on mouse-over.
4. Right-click the copied device and rename it.
5. Right-click the copied device and select the Edit Device Properties option. Make the changes for the new device.
6. Send the file to new device by dragging and dropping it into the Online Window area. Or right-click and select the
Write Settings to Device option.
7. Update the remaining settings, such as IP address.

10.6 Compare settings


Settings are comparable against default values and between two UR devices.
Some of the IEC 61850 settings use floating point data, which guarantees accurate representation of real numbers up to
seven digits. Numbers with more than seven digits are approximated within a certain precision. This can result in
differences between what is entered and what is saved, and for example results in differences shown on a settings
comparison report.
When comparing two settings files with the graphical front panel, all graphical front panel features are compared except
for the single-line diagrams.

10.6.1 Compare against defaults


To compare settings against default values:
1. Right-click the device in the Offline Window area and select Compare Settings With Defaults. The file generates and
the number of differences displays.
2. To save the report, click File > Save As, select the TXT, PDF, or CSV format from the drop-down list, and enter a name
for the file.
In the figure, the first entry (red) is from the device, while the second (green) is the default value.
Figure 10-7: Device settings compared with default values

10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-7


BACK UP AND RESTORE SETTINGS CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

10.6.2 Compare two devices


Preferences are set under File > Preferences as follows:
• Comparison Report: Sequential File 1, File 2 Layout — When disabled (default), the report shows only what differs, as
shown in the previous figure. When enabled, the report indicates differences by device.
Figure 10-8: Device settings compared between two devices, displayed sequentially

There are two ways to compare devices: devices in the Offline area or between Online and Offline devices.
To compare settings of two devices in the Offline Window area:
1. Right-click a first device in the Offline Window area and select Compare Two Devices.
2. In the window that opens, select a second device and click the Receive button. The file generates and the number of
differences displays.
3. To save the report, click File > Save As, select the TXT, PDF, or CSV format from the drop-down list, and enter a name
for the file.

To compare settings between Online and Offline devices:


1. Right-click a device in the Online Window area and select Compare with Device.
2. In the window that opens, enter a path/file name at the bottom o f the window.
3. Select the second device.
4. Click the OK button. The file generates, and the differences are highlighted in red, which is for the first device.

10.7 Back up and restore settings


Back up a copy of the in-service settings for each commissioned UR device, so as to revert to the commissioned settings
after inadvertent, unauthorized, or temporary setting changes are made, after the settings defaulted due to firmware
upgrade, or when the device has to be replaced. This section describes how to backup settings to a file and how to use
that file to restore the settings to the original relay or to a replacement relay.
For reference, settings can saved with Online > Print Device Information and Online > Export Device Information. They
cannot be restored using these options.

10.7.1 Back up settings


The following file types can be saved:
• URS — UR settings file — When the IEC 61850 option is not present
• IID — Instantiated IED capability description file — Actual settings on UR
• ICD — IED Capability Description file — Default settings on UR
• CID — Configured IED description file — Settings sent to the UR (may or may not contain the present settings)

10 UR device settings can be saved in a backup URS file using the EnerVista UR Setup software. The URS file is the standard
UR settings file. For an introduction to settings files in the URS format, see the beginning of the Interfaces chapter.

10-8 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE BACK UP AND RESTORE SETTINGS

When the IEC 61850 option is present, the settings can be saved alternatively in a backup IID file either using the EnerVista
UR Setup software in online mode or by using any of the supported file transfer protocols. The IID file is one of several IEC
61850 Substation Configuration Language (SCL) file types; see the IEC 61850 chapter in the UR Series Communications
Guide for an introduction to SCL.
"TBD" displays when a setting in a modeled element is configured with a non-modeled operand. For example, Phase IOC is
modeled in a firmware release, while the LED operands are not modeled. If the block setting of the Phase IOC is configured
with LED operands, its displays as TBD in IID and CID files, the web interface, or in an MMS client.
The options that display in the EnerVista software when right-clicking depend on device options.
Preferences are set in the File > Preferences > IEC 61850 menu. There are two options as follows:
• Preserve custom attributes when importing SCD/CID files — Applies to the Add Device to Offline Window option.
When enabled, the IID file also is to be copied to the computer. The IID file that is retrieved from the relay is therefore
assumed to be in synchronization with the resulting .urs file, and in fact in this situation the IID file on the computer is
a copy of the IID file that was read from the online device. When disabled, the IID file on the computer is to be left
unchanged. The location of the IID file is C:\ProgramData\GE Power Management\urpc\Offline, for example.
• Do not update IID file when updating SCL files — When enabled (default), an IID file is not to be created on the
computer and if one is already present there, it is neither removed nor updated. Have this option enabled when you
want to keep the IID file from the UR device instead of from another tool. The location of the file is C:\ProgramData\GE
Power Management\urpc\Offline, for example.
An Environment backup stores a list of sites and devices in the Online and Offline Window areas. Settings files are not
contained within the environment file. If a settings file is moved, renamed, or deleted after the backup, it is removed from
the Offline Window during the restore.

To save a settings file in the URS format in EnerVista Online Window:


1. In EnerVista, connect to the device in the Online Window area.
2. Right-click the device name in the Online Window area and select Add Device to Offline Window. A window opens.
3. Select or enter a file name and location, and click the Receive button. A .urs file is created in the Offline Window area.

To create a new settings file in the URS format in EnerVista Offline Window:
1. In EnerVista, right-click in the Offline Window area and select New Device. A window opens.
2. Change the file name at the end of the Path field, keeping the .urs extension.
3. From the Associate File with Device drop-down list, select the UR device. Other fields complete automatically.
Otherwise, when you do not select a device from the drop-down list, all fields need to be completed manually and
only devices that match the entered order code and version display in the list.
4. The Serial # Lock field is the serial number of the intended device. It ensures that the settings file is sent only to the
specific relay that matches the serial number.
5. Click the OK button to create the .urs file in the Offline Window area.

To save settings in the IID format in EnerVista Online Window:


1. In EnerVista, connect to the device in the Online Window area.
2. Right-click the device name in the Online Window area and select Read IID File. The option is not present when the
device does not have the IEC 61850 option. A window opens when successful.
3. Select or enter a file name and location, and click the Receive button. A .iid file is created.

To save settings in the IID format in EnerVista Offline Window:


1. In EnerVista, right-click the device in the Offline Window area.
2. Select the Create IID File option for firmware below 7.3. The option is not always available. Select the Save As option
for firmware 7.3 and later, and select the IID option from drop-down list. 10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-9


BACK UP AND RESTORE SETTINGS CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

No file is generated. The IID file on the computer is copied to the location specified.
3. If the Do not update IID file when updating SCL files preference is enabled under File > Preferences > IEC 61850,
then a message displays to that effect. This means that there is no IID file available on the computer to be copied, so
a new one is generated.

To save settings in the IID format using TFTP:


1. On a computer on the same subnetwork as the UR device, open a command window.
2. Enter
TFTP <IP address> GET ur.iid <destination>
where
<IP address> is the IP address of the UR device
ur.iid is the internal name of the IID file in the UR device
<destination> is the path and file name of the IID file. If omitted, the file is saved as ur.iid in the command window
default directory.
An example is
TFTP 192.168.1.101 GET ur.iid Feeder1.iid

To save settings in the ICD format in EnerVista Online Window:


1. In EnerVista, right-click the device in the Online Window area.
2. Select the Read ICD File option. A window opens.
3. Enter a path/name for the file, and click the Save button.

To save settings in the ICD format in EnerVista Offline Window:


1. In EnerVista, right-click the device in the Offline Window area.
2. Select the Create ICD File option. Or select the Save As option, and select the ICD option from drop-down list.
You can be prompted to specify if the file is for firmware version 7.12 or later.
The file is saved to the location specified.

To save settings in the CID format in EnerVista Online Window:


1. In EnerVista, right-click the device in the Online Window area.
2. Select the Read ICD File option. A window opens.
3. Enter a path/name for the file, and click the Save button.

To save settings in the CID format in EnerVista Offline Window:


1. In EnerVista, right-click the device in the Offline Window area.
2. Select the Save As option, which displays for firmware 7.3 and later, and select the CID option from the drop-down list.
The file is copied from the computer to the location specified.

To save list of sites and devices with an Environment backup:


1. In EnerVista, click File > Environment > Backup. A window opens.
2. Name and save the .ENV file.

10

10-10 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE BACK UP AND RESTORE SETTINGS

10.7.2 Restore settings


UR device settings can be restored to the values they were at when a URS backup file was created using the EnerVista UR
Setup software. When the IEC 61850 option is present, the settings can alternatively be to the values they were at when an
IID type backup was created either using the EnerVista UR Setup software in online mode or by using any of the supported
file transfer protocols. Note that TFTP cannot be used here, as TFTP "put" mode is disabled for security reasons.
To restore completely, a few settings need to be entered manually either via EnerVista UR Setup or via the UR device front
panel. If the restore operation is to be via Ethernet, first the UR device must have its IP address settings entered via the
front panel. These are located at SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  NETWORK 1(3) and SETTINGS 
PRODUCT SETUP  COMMUNICATIONS  IPv4 ROUTE TABLE 1(6)  DEFAULT IPv4 ROUTE  GATEWAY ADDRESS.
When importing a file, it cannot have a blank numeric value. All numeric values must be non-blank, otherwise the file is
rejected.
URS and IID procedures are outlined here.
To restore settings from a URS file:
1. In EnerVista, connect to the device in the Online Window area.
2. Right-click the .urs file in the Offline Window area and select Add Device from File to locate a file, and/or drag-and-
drop the file from the Offline Window area to the device in the Online Window area.
Figure 10-9: Restoring a URS settings file

3. Two prompts are possible, first that the URS file does not include the complete IEC 61850 configuration and that it
needs to be recreated if you continue. This means that the URS file is from UR version 7.30 or higher, has the IEC 61850
software option in the order code, but any IEC 61850 content will be compromised and will need to be configured.
Second, a message can display that the URS file is part of a device folder and to use the device’s CID file. This means
that the URS file is from UR version 7.3 or higher, has the IEC 61850 software option in the order code, and is part of the
device folder. The user is trying to add a URS file from inside a device’s folder. Instead, the user needs to use the CID file
from the device folder.
These messages display because the roles of the protection engineer and network engineer can be separate. The
former can require a URS file, while the latter can require stored Modbus settings and protection schemes. 10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-11


BACK UP AND RESTORE SETTINGS CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

4. Manually copy the remaining settings, outlined as follows.

To restore settings from an IID file using EnerVista software:


1. In Windows, make a copy the IID file with a cid extension.
2. Connect to the device in the Online Window area.
3. In the Offline Window area, right-click Devices and select Import Devices from SCD.
Figure 10-10: Importing an SCD or CID file

4. Navigate to and select the file with .cid extension. When prompted, enter a file name to give to an intermediate URS
file. The URS file is added to the Offline Window area.
5. Drag the imported file in the Offline Window to the device in the Online Window. Note that the RELAY SETTINGS value
also is written to a device, and the accepting relay is put into "Programmed" or "Not Programmed" mode as
configured in the offline file.
6. Manually copy the remaining settings, outlined as follows.

To restore settings from an IID using SFTP:


1. In Windows, make a copy the IID file with a cid extension.
2. On a computer on the same subnetwork as the UR device, open a SFTP client application, such as WinSCP. Note that
TFTP cannot be used here.
3. Use the device's IP address as the host name.
4. If the device has the CyberSentry option, use the User Name of "Administrator" or "Engineer", and the password
programmed for the selected role. The default password is "ChangeMe1#" (without quotation marks).
5. If the device does not have the CyberSentry option, use the User Name of "Setting", and the password programmed for
the Setting role. The default password is "ChangeMe1#" (without quotation marks).
6. Upload the backup file copy with the CID extension. WinSCP uses drag-and-drop or copy-and-paste for this.
7. Manually copy the remaining settings, outlined as follows.

To manually copy remaining settings:


1. Settings listed in section 4.1.2 Settings Files are not transferred to the UR device with settings files. Enter them
manually either via the front panel or via EnerVista UR Setup software. The values that these settings had at the time
the backup was created are contained within the backup file, accessed through EnerVista UR Setup software.

To restore the list of sites and devices from an Environment backup:


1. In EnerVista, click File > Environment > Restore. A window opens.
2. Select the .ENV file to restore.
10

10-12 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE UPGRADE SOFTWARE

10.8 Upgrade software


In general, the latest releases of the EnerVista software can be used with all firmware versions. For example, EnerVista
software released for UR 7.4 can be used to access multiple UR devices that have version 7.4x, 7.2x, and 6.0x firmware
installed.
Existing installations do not need to be uninstalled before upgrade.
You can also downgrade the software; use the same procedure.
To upgrade the EnerVista software:
1. If a beta version of the EnerVista UR Setup software is installed, uninstall it, for example using the Windows Control
Panel.
2. For Windows 10, disconnect any USB cable to the F35, else the UR USB drivers do no install correctly.
3. Download the latest EnerVista software and/or firmware from
http://www.gegridsolutions.com/app/ViewFiles.aspx?prod=urfamily&type=7
4. Double-click the file and complete the wizard. The software installs.
5. Access the software and check the version number under Help > About. If the new version does not display, try
uninstalling the software and reinstalling the new versions.
6. For Windows 10, to finish installing the UR USB driver, open Device Manager > Ports, then plug in the USB cable (to
connect the relay and computer). A new port starting with "GE Virtual Serial Port" is available. If available, click the OK
button to complete the installation.
If not available, uninstall the existing GE USB driver in the Device Manager > Ports. (Right-click and "Uninstall.")
When complete, unplug and re-plug the USB cable connecting the UR device. The "GE Virtual Serial Port" driver is now
available.
A message can display about a version not being supported. An example is when upgrading from version 7.12K to 7.4x.
The 7.12K entry is removed from the Offline Window area.
A message can display in the EnerVista software upon launch that "a device from the environment was not recognized."
This means that a device is online and its firmware version conflicts with the software version. In the example shown, a
C60 with firmware version 7.5x is online, but the software version is 7.3x. Updating removed incompatible files and
changed the device to version 7.3x, after which you need to make the order codes consistent as outlined next.
Figure 10-11: Mismatch in order code between software and device

To make the order codes consistent:


1. In EnerVista, click the Device Setup button. The window opens.
2. Expand the entry for the UR device.
3.
4.
Click the Read Order Code button. The order code and version of the device are populated to the software.
Click the OK button to save the change.
10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-13


UPGRADE FIRMWARE CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

10.9 Upgrade firmware


If upgrading both EnerVista software and F35 firmware, upgrade the software first.
The firmware of the F35 device can be upgraded, locally or remotely, using the EnerVista software.
Upgrades are possible for the same release (such as 7.01 to 7.02) and from one firmware version to another (such as 7.2 to
7.3). When upgrading to another firmware version, check the release notes on the GE Multilin website for compatibility.
If you are upgrading from version 7.0 or 7.1 to 7.2 or later, some CPU modules require a new boot version. Update this first.
Address equipment mismatch error before upgrade. For example, if you have a basic front panel attached and the order
code in the device is for a graphical front panel, the upgrade only works with a graphical front panel.
You can also downgrade firmware; use the same procedure.
To upgrade the firmware using EnerVista software:
1. If required, download the boot file and/or firmware from
http://www.gegridsolutions.com/app/ViewFiles.aspx?prod=urfamily&type=7
The firmware and boot files are .bin files.
2. Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Security and ensure that the Remote Setting Authorized and Local Setting
Authorized settings are "ON." On the front panel of the device, the path is SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  SECURITY 
DUAL PERMISSION SECURITY ACCESS.
If using CyberSentry security, also ensure that the relay and firmware are not locked under the Settings > Product
Setup > Security > Supervisory settings. A Supervisor role is required for these settings.
3. In EnerVista, back up the device settings by right-clicking the device and selecting Add Device to Offline Window. In
the window that displays, select an existing file to overwrite, or enter a name for a new settings file and optionally a
location for the new file. Click the Receive button to start the backup.
If an "Incompatible device order codes or versions" message displays, it means that you are trying to overwrite a file
for another product. You access the Convert Device Settings option by right-clicking the file in the Offline Window
area at the lower left. GE recommends converting settings in firmware steps, for example when converting from 6.0 to
7.4x, convert first to 7.0 then 7.4 in order to follow embedded conversion rules and keep settings. Note that the values
of all settings that have been defaulted during conversion are not listed in the conversion report; to find the value of a
setting before conversion, inspect the device backups made before conversion.
4. In EnerVista, navigate to Maintenance > Update Firmware.
First select the boot file if applicable, locating the .bin file, and proceed. Restart the device, the EnerVista software, and
refresh the order code in EnerVista under the Device Setup button.
To update the firmware, click Maintenance > Update Firmware, select the firmware update by locating the .bin file,
and proceed with the update.
When asked if upgrading over the Internet, the difference is the flash memory buffer size each time the software
sends data to the relay. Yes means that the flash memory buffer size is 256 bytes. No means that it is 1024 bytes,
which is faster.
If a warning message displays about the firmware not being supported by the EnerVista software, it means that the
firmware is a later version than the software. Upgrade the software to the same or later version as the firmware, then
try again.
If an "Unable to put relay in flash mode" message displays, set the Settings > Product Setup > Security > Dual
Permission Security Access > Remote Setting Authorized and Local Setting Authorized settings to "ON" and try
again.
When the update is finished, the relay restarts automatically. The upgrade process takes about 20 minutes when
using a graphical front panel because of writing to the front panel.
5. Restart the EnerVista software, and refresh the order code in EnerVista under the Device Setup button.
6. Verify the boot and firmware version while the device is starting up or in EnerVista under Actual Values > Product Info
> Firmware Revisions. The boot revision is not the same as the firmware revision, and the firmware revision reflects
10 7.
the UR release, for example firmware revision 7.40 is UR release 7.40.
Set the device to "programmed" under Settings > Product Setup > Installation. A self-test error displays on the device

10-14 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE REPLACE FRONT PANEL

until this is done.


8. If you changed the Remote Setting Authorized, the Local Setting Authorized settings, or relay lock settings, return
them to their previous settings.
9. To apply any previously saved settings, right-click the saved settings file in the Offline Window area and select Write
to Device. Optionally convert the saved settings to the new firmware version before writing to the device by right-
clicking and selecting Convert Device Settings.

The field-programmable gate array (FPGA) can be upgraded under Maintenance > Update FPGA when the device
is connected via serial cable and the firmware revision is 7.0 or higher.
Modbus addresses assigned to firmware modules, features, settings, and corresponding data items (that is, default
values, minimum/maximum values, data type, and item size) can change slightly from version to version of
firmware. The addresses are rearranged when new features are added or existing features are enhanced or
modified. The EEPROM DATA ERROR message displayed after upgrading/downgrading the firmware is a resettable,
self-test message intended to inform users that the Modbus addresses have changed with the upgraded firmware.
This message does not signal any problems when appearing after firmware upgrades.

10.10 Replace front panel


This section outlines how to install a graphical front panel.
A graphical front panel with a seven-inch (17.8 cm) color display and USB port is available for horizontal units. When
purchased separately as a retrofit for an existing relay, there is one kit for an enhanced front panel replacement and
another kit for the basic front panel replacement, with mounting brackets differing between the two kits. A kit includes the
graphical front panel, mounting brackets, and screws. The graphical front panel requires CPU module type W or module
type T, U, or V (newer type that has two connector slots on the front of the module--the second is difficult to see), upgrades
of software and firmware, then a settings update to recognize the graphical front panel.
The graphical front panel can replace a basic front panel on newer models where the hinges are not riveted to the chassis.
It cannot replace a basic front panel where the hinges are riveted onto the chassis; both front panel and chassis require
replacement. See the photo of the riveted hinges later in this section.
The following procedures are outlined:
• Remove front panel
• Install graphical front panel
• Replace CPU module
• Upgrade software and firmware, then update setting

Withdraw or insert a module only when control power has been removed from the unit, and be
sure to insert only the correct module type into a slot, else personal injury, damage to the unit or
connected equipment, or undesired operation can result.

To avoid damage to the equipment, use proper electrostatic discharge protection (for example, a
static strap) when coming in contact with modules while the relay is energized.
The following procedure can be used for the Rev. 1 and Rev. 2 enhanced front panels, with Rev. 1 is documented here. The
Rev. 2 enhanced horizontal front panel introduced starting November 2017 uses a screw to close it and internal hinge
screws as per the graphical front panel.
To remove an enhanced or basic front panel:
1. In the EnerVista software or on the front panel, access Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Network and
record the IP address and subnet mask of the port(s) being used. Record the gateway address under Default IPv4
Route.
2.
3.
Turn off power to the unit. Hot-swapping of the front panel is not supported.
For an enhanced front panel, loosen the thumb screw and open slightly the front panel.
10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-15


REPLACE FRONT PANEL CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

For a basic front panel, lift up the black plastic latch on the right side of the front panel and open slightly the front
panel.
Figure 10-12: Loosen thumb screw on enhanced front panel to open

Figure 10-13: Lift latch on basic front panel to open

4. With a Phillips screwdriver, unscrew and remove the mounting bracket on the right side of the unit. The bracket for the
enhanced front panel looks similar to that for the graphical front panel, but they are not the same.

10

10-16 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE REPLACE FRONT PANEL

Figure 10-14: Remove enhanced front panel mounting bracket on right side

Figure 10-15: Remove basic front panel mounting bracket on right side

5. Open the front panel. Unplug or unscrew the grey ground cable from the front panel. Unplug the RJ45 connector from
the CPU module in the second slot on the left.

10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-17


REPLACE FRONT PANEL CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

Figure 10-16: Disconnected ground cable and CPU connector

6. Unscrew and remove the mounting bracket with the front panel from the left side.
Figure 10-17: Unscrew enhanced front panel mounting bracket on left side

Figure 10-18: Unscrew basic front panel mounting bracket on left side

10

10-18 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE REPLACE FRONT PANEL

(note riveted hinges with red arrows - cannot replace this front panel)

The front panel has been removed.

To install the graphical front panel:


1. With power to the unit off, screw the left mounting bracket to the outside of the relay. The power supply module can
remain in the first slot.
Figure 10-19: Attach mounting bracket to relay on left side (no power supply module in first slot)

2. Screw the right mounting bracket to the right side of the relay. 10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-19


REPLACE FRONT PANEL CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

Figure 10-20: Attach mounting bracket to relay on right side

3. Attach the graphical front panel hinge to the left mounting bracket using the nuts provided.
Figure 10-21: Attach to left mounting bracket inside relay

4. Close the front panel without tightening the screw to the mounting bracket.
5. Optionally remove the protective plastic film on the graphical front panel. It is normally peeled off, but also can be left
on.
The graphical front panel has been installed but not connected.

10

10-20 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE REPLACE FRONT PANEL

To replace the CPU module:


1. With power to the unit off, at the back of the CPU module in the second slot, disconnect any cables. Remove the silver
SFP connector(s) from the CPU module, and keep it handy. Then remove the CPU module by sliding the module out
from the front of the relay. (See the next section for instructions.)
Figure 10-22: Remove silver SFP connector (shown here under LK1 label)

2. At the front of the relay, insert the new CPU module in the second slot. The new CPU has two connection slots on the
front. Ensure that the RS485 connector and the black cover plate are not on the back of the CPU module before sliding
the module into the front of the relay.
Figure 10-23: Rear of a CPU module before insertion without RS485 connector or cover plate

10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-21


REPLACE FRONT PANEL CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

3. Once the module is in place, connect the graphical front panel to the CPU module (ground and upper connector) and
close the front panel. There are two connections possible on the front of the CPU module: upper for the graphical front
panel and lower for the enhanced and basic front panels. The upper connection is black with holes, similar to the
cover, so it is difficult to see.
Figure 10-24: Connect graphical front panel to top connection on CPU module

4. Tighten the embedded screw on the right side of the graphical front panel to the mounting bracket.
Figure 10-25: Screw to attach graphical front panel to mounting bracket

5. At the back of the CPU module, attach the new black cover plate to the back of the relay, then connect the new RS485
connector.

10 6.
Insert the silver SFP connector(s) at the back of the CPU module, then connect any Ethernet connection(s).
Power up the relay. If the graphical front panel does not power up immediately, disconnect power, open the front

10-22 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE REPLACE MODULE

panel, then check that the graphical front panel is plugged into the upper connection, not the lower silver connection
on the CPU module.

To upgrade software and firmware.


1. Upgrade the EnerVista software as outlined in this chapter.
2. Input the IP address and subnet mask of the relay on the front panel under Settings > Product Setup >
Communications > Network, and input the gateway address under Default IPv4 Route.
3. Upgrade the firmware in the EnerVista software as outlined in this chapter, for example under Maintenance > Update
Firmware.
If you see error messages after the upgrade, disconnect power to the relay and shut down the software, then start
both again. If you see a flashing message about front panel communications trouble, check the connection of the
graphical front panel to the CPU module.
4. In the EnerVista software, click the Device Setup button and refresh the order code for the device.
5. Set the relay to Programmed mode under Settings > Product Setup > Installation.
6. Update the EnerVista software to recognize the graphical front panel under Maintenance > Change Front Panel. This
setting does not display for units already with a graphical front panel.
If an equipment mismatch error displays on the front panel, it can mean that the order code on the device needs to be
updated to the new front panel.

10.11 Replace module


This section outlines how to replace a module.

Withdraw or insert a module only when control power has been removed from the unit, and be
sure to insert only the correct module type into a slot, else personal injury, damage to the unit or
connected equipment, or undesired operation can result.

To avoid damage to the equipment, use proper electrostatic discharge protection (for example, a
static strap) when coming in contact with modules while the relay is energized.
The relay, being modular in design, allows for the withdrawal and insertion of modules. Replace modules only with like
modules in their original factory configured slots.
Two procedures follow: replace a module with the same module, and upgrade a module.
To replace a module with the same module:
1. Open the enhanced front panel to the left once the thumb screw has been removed. This allows for easy access of the
modules for withdrawal. The new wide-angle hinge assembly in the enhanced front panel opens completely and
allows easy access to all modules in the F35.

10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-23


REPLACE MODULE CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

Figure 10-26: Modules inside relay with front cover open (enhanced front panel)

The basic front panel can be opened to the left once the black plastic sliding latch on the right side has been pushed
up, as shown below.
Figure 10-27: Removing module (basic front panel)

2. With power to the unit off, disconnect individually the connections at the front and back of the module before
removing the module from the chassis.
For any Process Card/process bus module in slot H for use with a HardFiber Brick, also remove the two screws at the
back that attach the module to the chassis.
3. To properly remove a module, pull simultaneously the ejector/inserter clips, located at the top and bottom of the
module. Record the original location of the module to ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the
correct slot. While modules with current input provide automatic shorting of external CT circuits, for CT/VT modules it
is recommended to short/isolate external circuits accordingly for maximum safety.
4. To properly insert a module, ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot position. The ejector/
inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as the module
is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage the clips
simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is fully inserted.

When adding a module (versus replacing a module), check that settings have not changed. Depending on the
module, settings can reset to default values.

10

10-24 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE BATTERY

The new CT/VT modules can only be used with new CPUs; similarly, old CT/VT modules can only be used with old
CPUs. In the event that there is a mismatch between the CPU and CT/VT module, the relay does not function and a
DSP ERROR or HARDWARE MISMATCH error displays.
An upgrade example is replacing the CPU module with a more recent one, such as swapping 9G/9H/9N with 9T/9U/9V/9W.
A power supply module upgrade does not affect an order code.
To upgrade a module:
1. Back up settings by sending the device to the Offline Window area. Convert the settings to the new order code by
right-clicking in the Offline Window area. Replace the module as outlined in the previous procedure. In the Online
Window area, reset all settings to factory defaults and read the new order code from the device using Commands >
Relay Maintenance > Update Order Code. Send the saved settings from the Offline Window area to the online device.
Refresh the order code in the Device Setup window and set the device to "Programmed" under Settings > Product
Setup > Installation.

10.12 Battery
A battery powers the real time clock on startup of the device.
When required, the battery can be replaced. The battery type is 3 V cylindrical.
The power supply module contains the battery. The power supply modules were upgraded in 2014 to SH/SL from RH/RL,
but the order code when purchasing a UR with redundant power supply remained as RH/RL so that customers can
continue to use the same order codes. The order code can read RH or RL, while the module inside the unit reads SH or SL.
The order code for replacement redundant power supply modules was changed to SH/SL.

10.12.1 Replace battery


When required, the battery can be replaced. The power supply module contains the battery.

To avoid injury, ensure that the unit has been powered off for a minimum of three minutes before
replacing the battery.
Risk of fire if battery is replaced with incorrect type or polarity.
To replace the battery:
1. Turn off the power to the unit.
2. Wait a minimum of three minutes to ensure that there is no power to the battery.
3. As outlined in the previous section, open the unit by sliding up the plastic latch on the right side of the front panel
(basic front panel) or unscrewing the panel (enhanced front panel).
4. For the basic front panel, it needs to be removed in order to access the power supply module, which is typically in the
first slot on the left side and blocked by the hinge of the front panel. To remove the front panel, unscrew the bracket on
the left side of the unit.
5. Remove the power supply module by simultaneously pulling the ejector clips at the top and bottom of the module and
sliding it out.
6. Unscrew all four screws (not three) that attach the metal cover to the module. The fourth screw is at the back end of
the module, on the opposite side from the clips, beside the white electronics part (see figure).
7. Slide the metal cover away from the clips about 0.5 cm (1/8 inch) and remove the cover.
8. Unclip the black plastic holder that keeps the battery in place. The plastic clips into the socket at the bottom on both
sides—pull the plastic away from the battery. Use a flat-head screwdriver if you cannot unclip the plastic with your
fingers.
9. Replace the battery with the identical make and model. For example, do not use a rechargeable battery. Observe the
+ and - polarity of the battery and replace it with the same polarity as marked on the battery holder. 10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-25


BATTERY CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

Figure 10-28: Battery location on power supply module

10. Reinstall the battery holder and the metal cover, and reinsert the power supply module into the unit.
11. Power on the unit.
12. Dispose of the old battery as outlined in the next section.

10.12.2 Dispose of battery

10.12.2.1 EN Battery disposal


This product contains a battery that cannot be disposed of as unsorted municipal waste in the European Union. See the
product documentation for specific battery information. The battery is marked with this symbol, which may include
lettering to indicate cadmium (Cd), lead (Pb), or mercury (Hg). For proper recycling return the battery to your supplier or to a
designated collection point. For more information see: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.2 CS Nakládání s bateriemi


Tento produkt obsahuje baterie, které nemohou být zneškodněny v Evropské unii jako netříděný komunální odpadu. Viz
dokumentace k produktu pro informace pro konkrétní baterie. Baterie je označena tímto symbolem, který může zahrnovat
i uvedena písmena, kadmium (Cd), olovo (Pb), nebo rtuť (Hg). Pro správnou recyklaci baterií vraťte svémudodavateli nebo
na určeném sběrném místě. Pro více informací viz: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.3 DA Batteri affald


Dette produkt indeholder et batteri som ikke kan bortskaffes sammen med almindeligt husholdningsaffald i Europa. Se
produktinformation for specifikke informationer om batteriet. Batteriet er forsynet med indgraveret symboler for hvad
batteriet indeholder: kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb) og kviksølv (Hg). Europæiske brugere af elektrisk udstyr skal aflevere kasserede
produkter til genbrug eller til leverandøren. Yderligere oplysninger findes på webstedet www.recyclethis.info.

10

10-26 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE BATTERY

10.12.2.4 DE Entsorgung von Batterien


Dieses Produkt beinhaltet eine Batterie, die nicht als unsortierter städtischer Abfall in der europäischen Union entsorgt
werden darf. Beachten Sie die spezifischen Batterie-informationen in der Produktdokumentation. Die Batterie ist mit
diesem Symbol gekennzeichnet, welches auch Hinweise auf möglicherweise enthaltene Stoffe wie Kadmium (Cd), Blei (Pb)
oder Quecksilber (Hektogramm) darstellt. Für die korrekte Wiederverwertung bringen Sie diese Batterie zu Ihrem lokalen
Lieferanten zurück oder entsorgen Sie das Produkt an den gekennzeichneten Sammelstellen. Weitere Informationen
hierzu finden Sie auf der folgenden Website: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.5 EL Απόρριψη μπαταριών


Αυτό το προϊόν περιέχει μια μπαταρία που δεν πρέπει να απορρίπτεται σε δημόσια συστήματα απόρριψης στην
Ευρωπαϊκή Κοινότητα. ∆είτε την τεκμηρίωση του προϊόντος για συγκεκριμένες πληροφορίες που αφορούν τη μπαταρία.
Η μπαταρία είναι φέρει σήμανση με αυτό το σύμβολο, το οποίο μπορεί να περιλαμβάνει γράμματα για να δηλώσουν το
κάδμιο (Cd), τον μόλυβδο (Pb), ή τον υδράργυρο (Hg). Για την κατάλληλη ανακύκλωση επιστρέψτε την μπαταρία στον
προμηθευτή σας ή σε καθορισμένο σημείο συλλογής. Για περισσότερες πληροφορίες δείτε: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.6 ES Eliminacion de baterias


Este producto contiene una batería que no se pueda eliminar como basura normal sin clasificar en la Unión Europea.
Examine la documentación del producto para la información específica de la batería. La batería se marca con este
símbolo, que puede incluir siglas para indicar el cadmio (Cd), el plomo (Pb), o el mercurio (Hg ). Para el reciclaje apropiado,
devuelva este producto a su distribuidor ó deshágase de él en los puntos de reciclaje designados. Para mas información :
wwwrecyclethis.info.

10.12.2.7 ET Patareide kõrvaldamine


Käesolev toode sisaldab patareisid, mida Euroopa Liidus ei tohi kõrvaldada sorteerimata olmejäätmetena. Andmeid
patareide kohta vaadake toote dokumentatsioonist. Patareid on märgistatud käesoleva sümboliga, millel võib olla
kaadmiumi (Cd), pliid (Pb) või elavhõbedat (Hg) tähistavad tähed. Nõuetekohaseks ringlusse võtmiseks tagastage patarei
tarnijale või kindlaksmääratud vastuvõtupunkti. Lisainformatsiooni saab Internetist aadressil: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.8 FI Paristoje ja akkujen hävittäminen


Tuote sisältää pariston, jota ei saa hävittää Euroopan Unionin alueella talousjätteen mukana. Tarkista tuoteselosteesta
tuotteen tiedot. Paristo on merkitty tällä symbolilla ja saattaa sisältää cadmiumia (Cd), lyijyä (Pb) tai elohopeaa (Hg). Oikean
kierrätystavan varmistamiseksi palauta tuote paikalliselle jälleenmyyjälle tai palauta se paristojen keräyspisteeseen.
Lisätietoja sivuilla www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.9 FR Élimination des piles


Ce produit contient une batterie qui ne peuvent être éliminés comme déchets municipaux non triés dans l'Union
européenne. Voir la documentation du produit au niveau des renseignements sur la pile. La batterie est marqué de ce
symbole, qui comprennent les indications cadmium (Cd), plomb (Pb), ou mercure (Hg). Pour le recyclage, retourner la
batterie à votre fournisseur ou à un point de collecte. Pour plus d'informations, voir: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.10 HU Akkumulátor hulladék kezelése


Ezen termék akkumulátort tartalmaz, amely az Európai Unión belül csak a kijelölt módon és helyen dobható ki. A terméken
illetve a mellékelt ismertetőn olvasható a kadmium (Cd), ólom (Pb) vagy higany (Hg) tartalomra utaló betűjelzés. A hulladék
akkumulátor leadható a termék forgalmazójánál új akkumulátor vásárlásakor, vagy a kijelölt elektronikai
hulladékudvarokban. További információ a www.recyclethis.info oldalon.

10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-27


BATTERY CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

10.12.2.11 IT Smaltimento batterie


Questo prodotto contiene una batteria che non può essere smaltita nei comuni contenitori per lo smaltimento rifiuti, nell'
Unione Europea. Controllate la documentazione del prodotto per le informazioni specifiche sulla batteria. La batteria è
contrassegnata con questo simbolo e può includere alcuni caratteri ad indicare la presenza di cadmio (Cd), piombo (Pb)
oppure mercurio (Hg). Per il corretto smaltimento, potete restituirli al vostro fornitore locale, oppure rivolgervi e consegnarli
presso i centri di raccolta preposti. Per maggiori informazioni vedere: ww.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.12 LT Baterijų šalinimas


Šios įrangos sudėtyje yra baterijų, kurias draudžiama šalinti Europos Sąjungos viešose nerūšiuotų atliekų šalinimo
sistemose. Informaciją apie baterijas galite rasti įrangos techninėje dokumentacijoje. Baterijos žymimos šiuo simboliu,
papildomai gali būti nurodoma kad baterijų sudėtyje yra kadmio (Cd), švino (Pb) ar gyvsidabrio (Hg). Eksploatavimui
nebetinkamas baterijas pristatykite į tam skirtas surinkimo vietas arba grąžinkite jas tiesioginiam tiekėjui, kad jos būtų
tinkamai utilizuotos. Daugiau informacijos rasite šioje interneto svetainėje: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.13 LV Bateriju likvidēšana


Šis produkts satur bateriju vai akumulatoru, kuru nedrīkst izmest Eiropas Savienībā esošajās sadzīves atkritumu sistēmās.
Sk. produkta dokumentācijā, kur ir norādīta konkrēta informācija par bateriju vai akumulatoru. Baterijas vai akumulatora
marķējumā ir šis simbols, kas var ietvert burtus, kuri norāda kadmiju (Cd), svinu (Pb) vai dzīvsudrabu (Hg). Pēc
ekspluatācijas laika beigām baterijas vai akumulatori jānodod piegādātājam vai specializētā bateriju savākšanas vietā.
Sīkāku informāciju var iegūt vietnē: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.14 NL Verwijderen van baterijen


Dit product bevat een batterij welke niet kan verwijdert worden via de gemeentelijke huisvuilscheiding in de Europese
Gemeenschap. Gelieve de product documentatie te controleren voor specifieke batterij informatie. De batterijen met deze
label kunnen volgende indictaies bevatten cadium (Cd), lood (Pb) of kwik (Hg). Voor correcte vorm van kringloop, geef je de
producten terug aan jou locale leverancier of geef het af aan een gespecialiseerde verzamelpunt. Meer informatie vindt u
op de volgende website: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.15 NO Retur av batteri


Dette produkt inneholder et batteri som ikke kan kastes med usortert kommunalt søppel i den Europeiske Unionen. Se
produktdokumentasjonen for spesifikk batteriinformasjon. Batteriet er merket med dette symbolet som kan inkludere
symboler for å indikere at kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb), eller kvikksølv (Hg) forekommer. Returner batteriet til leverandøren din
eller til et dedikert oppsamlingspunkt for korrekt gjenvinning. For mer informasjon se: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.16 PL Pozbywanie się zużytych baterii


Ten produkt zawiera baterie, które w Unii Europejskiej mogą być usuwane tylko jako posegregowane odpady komunalne.
Dokładne informacje dotyczące użytych baterii znajdują się w dokumentacji produktu. Baterie oznaczone tym symbolem
mogą zawierać dodatkowe oznaczenia literowe wskazujące na zawartość kadmu (Cd), ołowiu (Pb) lub rtęci (Hg). Dla
zapewnienia właściwej utylizacji, należy zwrócić baterie do dostawcy albo do wyznaczonego punktu zbiórki. Więcej
informacji można znaleźć na stronie internetowej www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.17 PT Eliminação de Baterias


Este produto contêm uma bateria que não pode ser considerado lixo municipal na União Europeia. Consulte a
documentação do produto para obter informação específica da bateria. A bateria é identificada por meio de este símbolo,
que pode incluir a rotulação para indicar o cádmio (Cd), chumbo (Pb), ou o mercúrio (hg). Para uma reciclagem apropriada
envie a bateria para o seu fornecedor ou para um ponto de recolha designado. Para mais informação veja:
www.recyclethis.info.

10

10-28 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE CLEAR FILES AND DATA AFTER UNINSTALL

10.12.2.18 RU Утилизация батарей


Согласно европейской директиве об отходах электрического и электронного оборудования, продукты, содержащие
батареи, нельзя утилизировать как обычные отходы на территории ЕС. Более подробную информацию вы найдете в
документации к продукту. На этом символе могут присутствовать буквы, которые означают, что батарея собержит
кадмий (Cd), свинец (Pb) или ртуть (Hg). Для надлежащей утилизации по окончании срока эксплуатации пользователь
должен возвратить батареи локальному поставщику или сдать в специальный пункт приема. Подробности можно
найти на веб-сайте: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.19 SK Zaobchádzanie s batériami


Tento produkt obsahuje batériu, s ktorou sa v Európskej únii nesmie nakladať ako s netriedeným komunálnym odpadom.
Dokumentácia k produktu obsahuje špecifické informácie o batérii. Batéria je označená týmto symbolom, ktorý môže
obsahovať písmená na označenie kadmia (Cd), olova (Pb), alebo ortuti (Hg). Na správnu recykláciu vráťte batériu vášmu
lokálnemu dodávateľovi alebo na určené zberné miesto. Pre viac informácii pozrite: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.20 SL Odlaganje baterij


Ta izdelek vsebuje baterijo, ki je v Evropski uniji ni dovoljeno odstranjevati kot nesortiran komunalni odpadek. Za posebne
informacije o bateriji glejte dokumentacijo izdelka. Baterija je označena s tem simbolom, ki lahko vključuje napise, ki
označujejo kadmij (Cd), svinec (Pb) ali živo srebro (Hg). Za ustrezno recikliranje baterijo vrnite dobavitelju ali jo odstranite na
določenem zbirališču. Za več informacij obiščite spletno stran: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.21 SV Kassering av batteri


Denna produkt innehåller ett batteri som inte får kastas i allmänna sophanteringssytem inom den europeiska unionen. Se
produktdokumentationen för specifik batteriinformation. Batteriet är märkt med denna symbol, vilket kan innebära att det
innehåller kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb) eller kvicksilver (Hg). För korrekt återvinning skall batteriet returneras till leverantören eller
till en därför avsedd deponering. För mer information, se: www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.22 TR Pil Geri Dönüşümü


Bu ürün Avrupa Birliği genel atık sistemlerine atılmaması gereken pil içermektedir. Daha detaylı pil bilgisi için ürünün
kataloğunu inceleyiniz. Bu sembolle işaretlenmiş piller Kadmiyum(Cd), Kurşun(Pb) ya da Civa(Hg) içerebilir. Doğru geri
dönüşüm için ürünü yerel tedarikçinize geri veriniz ya da özel işaretlenmiş toplama noktlarına atınız. Daha fazla bilgi için:
www.recyclethis.info.

10.12.2.23 Global contacts


North America 905-294-6222
Latin America +55 11 3614 1700
Europe, Middle East, Africa +(34) 94 485 88 00
Asia +86-21-2401-3208
India +91 80 41314617

From GE Part Number 1604-0021-A1, GE Publication Number GEK-113574.

10.13 Clear files and data after uninstall


The unit can be decommissioned by turning off power to the unit and disconnecting the wires to it.
To clear files and settings in the UR:
1. On the UR front panel, navigate to COMMANDS  RELAY MAINTENANCE  SERVICE COMMAND, enter the value 20511,
and press the ENTER key. The relay restarts and clears the UR.
2. Clear the flash memory using the SETTINGS  PRODUCT SETUP  CLEAR RELAY RECORDS command.
10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-29


REPAIRS CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

To clear files and settings on the computer:


1. Uninstall the EnerVista UR Setup software.
2. Find and delete the following UR files:
– .URS, .CID, and .ICD settings
– .EVT event records
– .CFG and .DAT COMTRADE

10.14 Repairs
The battery and modules inside the case can be replaced without return of the device to the factory. The firmware and
software can be upgraded without return of the device to the factory.
Fuses in the power supply module are not field-replaceable.
Files can be requested for use by technical support staff, for example the Service Report (click the icon in the software or
connect a USB drive to the graphical front panel) or under Maintenance > Retrieve File, as outlined elsewhere in this
document.
For issues not solved by troubleshooting, the process to return the device to the factory for repair is as follows:
• Contact a GE Grid Solutions Technical Support Center. Contact information is found in the first chapter.
• Obtain a Return Materials Authorization (RMA) number from the Technical Support Center.
• Verify that the RMA and Commercial Invoice received have the correct information.
• Tightly pack the unit in a box with bubble wrap, foam material, or styrofoam inserts or packaging peanuts to cushion
the item(s). You may also use double boxing whereby you place the box in a larger box that contains at least 5 cm of
cushioning material.
• Ship the unit by courier or freight forwarder, along with the Commercial Invoice and RMA, to the factory.

GE GRID SOLUTIONS
650 MARKLAND STREET
MARKHAM, ONTARIO
CANADA L6C 0M1
ATTN: SERVICE DEPT.
RMA# : ______________

Customers are responsible for shipping costs to the factory, regardless of whether the unit is under warranty.
• Fax a copy of the shipping information to the GE Grid Solutions service department in Canada at +1 905 927 5098.
Use the detailed return procedure outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/support/ret_proc.htm
The current warranty and return information are outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm

10.15 Storage
Store the unit indoors in a cool, dry place. If possible, store in the original packaging. Follow the storage temperature range
outlined in the Specifications.

10

10-30 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE DISPOSAL

To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored in a de-energized
state once per year, for one hour continuously.

10.16 Disposal
Other than the battery, there are no special requirements for disposal of the unit at the end its service life. For customers
located in the European Union, dispose of the battery as outlined earlier. To prevent non-intended use of the unit, remove
the modules, dismantle the unit, and recycle the metal when possible.

10

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 10-31


DISPOSAL CHAPTER 10: MAINTENANCE

10

10-32 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Appendix A: FlexAnalog operands

Appendices
FlexAnalog operands

This appendix outlines FlexAnalog parameters.

A.1 FlexAnalog items


A FlexAnalog parameter is an analog parameter.
FlexAnalog items specific to your device are viewable in a web browser. Enter the IP address of the UR, access the Device
Information Menu option, then the FlexAnalog Parameter Listing option. Entries displayed online depend on order code.
Table A-1: F35 FlexAnalog data items
Address FlexAnalog name Units Description
5824 Field RTD 1 Value --- Field RTD 1 value
5825 Field RTD 2 Value --- Field RTD 2 value
5826 Field RTD 3 Value --- Field RTD 3 value
5827 Field RTD 4 Value --- Field RTD 4 value
5828 Field RTD 5 Value --- Field RTD 5 value
5829 Field RTD 6 Value --- Field RTD 6 value
5830 Field RTD 7 Value --- Field RTD 7 value
5831 Field RTD 8 Value --- Field RTD 8 value
5832 Field TDR 1 Value --- Field TDR 1 value
5834 Field TDR 2 Value --- Field TDR 2 value
5836 Field TDR 3 Value --- Field TDR 3 value
5838 Field TDR 4 Value --- Field TDR 4 value
5840 Field TDR 5 Value --- Field TDR 5 value
5842 Field TDR 6 Value --- Field TDR 6 value
5844 Field TDR 7 Value --- Field TDR 7 value
5846 Field TDR 8 Value --- Field TDR 8 value
6144 SRC 1 Ia RMS Amps Source 1 phase A current RMS
6146 SRC 1 Ib RMS Amps Source 1 phase B current RMS
6148 SRC 1 Ic RMS Amps Source 1 phase C current RMS
6150 SRC 1 In RMS Amps Source 1 neutral current RMS
6152 SRC 1 Ia Mag Amps Source 1 phase A current magnitude

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-1


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


6154 SRC 1 Ia Angle Degrees Source 1 phase A current angle
A 6155 SRC 1 Ib Mag Amps Source 1 phase B current magnitude
6157 SRC 1 Ib Angle Degrees Source 1 phase B current angle
6158 SRC 1 Ic Mag Amps Source 1 phase C current magnitude
6160 SRC 1 Ic Angle Degrees Source 1 phase C current angle
6161 SRC 1 In Mag Amps Source 1 neutral current magnitude
6163 SRC 1 In Angle Degrees Source 1 neutral current angle
6164 SRC 1 Ig RMS Amps Source 1 ground current RMS
6166 SRC 1 Ig Mag Amps Source 1 ground current magnitude
6168 SRC 1 Ig Angle Degrees Source 1 ground current angle
6169 SRC 1 I_0 Mag Amps Source 1 zero-sequence current magnitude
6171 SRC 1 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 1 zero-sequence current angle
6172 SRC 1 I_1 Mag Amps Source 1 positive-sequence current magnitude
6174 SRC 1 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 1 positive-sequence current angle
6175 SRC 1 I_2 Mag Amps Source 1 negative-sequence current magnitude
6177 SRC 1 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 1 negative-sequence current angle
6178 SRC 1 Igd Mag Amps Source 1 differential ground current magnitude
6180 SRC 1 Igd Angle Degrees Source 1 differential ground current angle
6208 SRC 2 Ia RMS Amps Source 2 phase A current RMS
6210 SRC 2 Ib RMS Amps Source 2 phase B current RMS
6212 SRC 2 Ic RMS Amps Source 2 phase C current RMS
6214 SRC 2 In RMS Amps Source 2 neutral current RMS
6216 SRC 2 Ia Mag Amps Source 2 phase A current magnitude
6218 SRC 2 Ia Angle Degrees Source 2 phase A current angle
6219 SRC 2 Ib Mag Amps Source 2 phase B current magnitude
6221 SRC 2 Ib Angle Degrees Source 2 phase B current angle
6222 SRC 2 Ic Mag Amps Source 2 phase C current magnitude
6224 SRC 2 Ic Angle Degrees Source 2 phase C current angle
6225 SRC 2 In Mag Amps Source 2 neutral current magnitude
6227 SRC 2 In Angle Degrees Source 2 neutral current angle
6228 SRC 2 Ig RMS Amps Source 2 ground current RMS
6230 SRC 2 Ig Mag Amps Source 2 ground current magnitude
6232 SRC 2 Ig Angle Degrees Source 2 ground current angle
6233 SRC 2 I_0 Mag Amps Source 2 zero-sequence current magnitude
6235 SRC 2 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 2 zero-sequence current angle
6236 SRC 2 I_1 Mag Amps Source 2 positive-sequence current magnitude
6238 SRC 2 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 2 positive-sequence current angle
6239 SRC 2 I_2 Mag Amps Source 2 negative-sequence current magnitude
6241 SRC 2 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 2 negative-sequence current angle
6242 SRC 2 Igd Mag Amps Source 2 differential ground current magnitude
6244 SRC 2 Igd Angle Degrees Source 2 differential ground current angle
6272 SRC 3 Ia RMS Amps Source 3 phase A current RMS
6274 SRC 3 Ib RMS Amps Source 3 phase B current RMS
6276 SRC 3 Ic RMS Amps Source 3 phase C current RMS
6278 SRC 3 In RMS Amps Source 3 neutral current RMS
6280 SRC 3 Ia Mag Amps Source 3 phase A current magnitude
6282 SRC 3 Ia Angle Degrees Source 3 phase A current angle

A-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
6283 SRC 3 Ib Mag Amps Source 3 phase B current magnitude
6285 SRC 3 Ib Angle Degrees Source 3 phase B current angle
6286 SRC 3 Ic Mag Amps Source 3 phase C current magnitude
6288 SRC 3 Ic Angle Degrees Source 3 phase C current angle
6289 SRC 3 In Mag Amps Source 3 neutral current magnitude
6291 SRC 3 In Angle Degrees Source 3 neutral current angle
6292 SRC 3 Ig RMS Amps Source 3 ground current RMS
6294 SRC 3 Ig Mag Amps Source 3 ground current magnitude
6296 SRC 3 Ig Angle Degrees Source 3 ground current angle
6297 SRC 3 I_0 Mag Amps Source 3 zero-sequence current magnitude
6299 SRC 3 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 3 zero-sequence current angle
6300 SRC 3 I_1 Mag Amps Source 3 positive-sequence current magnitude
6302 SRC 3 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 3 positive-sequence current angle
6303 SRC 3 I_2 Mag Amps Source 3 negative-sequence current magnitude
6305 SRC 3 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 3 negative-sequence current angle
6306 SRC 3 Igd Mag Amps Source 3 differential ground current magnitude
6308 SRC 3 Igd Angle Degrees Source 3 differential ground current angle
6336 SRC 4 Ia RMS Amps Source 4 phase A current RMS
6338 SRC 4 Ib RMS Amps Source 4 phase B current RMS
6340 SRC 4 Ic RMS Amps Source 4 phase C current RMS
6342 SRC 4 In RMS Amps Source 4 neutral current RMS
6344 SRC 4 Ia Mag Amps Source 4 phase A current magnitude
6346 SRC 4 Ia Angle Degrees Source 4 phase A current angle
6347 SRC 4 Ib Mag Amps Source 4 phase B current magnitude
6349 SRC 4 Ib Angle Degrees Source 4 phase B current angle
6350 SRC 4 Ic Mag Amps Source 4 phase C current magnitude
6352 SRC 4 Ic Angle Degrees Source 4 phase C current angle
6353 SRC 4 In Mag Amps Source 4 neutral current magnitude
6355 SRC 4 In Angle Degrees Source 4 neutral current angle
6356 SRC 4 Ig RMS Amps Source 4 ground current RMS
6358 SRC 4 Ig Mag Amps Source 4 ground current magnitude
6360 SRC 4 Ig Angle Degrees Source 4 ground current angle
6361 SRC 4 I_0 Mag Amps Source 4 zero-sequence current magnitude
6363 SRC 4 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 4 zero-sequence current angle
6364 SRC 4 I_1 Mag Amps Source 4 positive-sequence current magnitude
6366 SRC 4 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 4 positive-sequence current angle
6367 SRC 4 I_2 Mag Amps Source 4 negative-sequence current magnitude
6369 SRC 4 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 4 negative-sequence current angle
6370 SRC 4 Igd Mag Amps Source 4 differential ground current magnitude
6372 SRC 4 Igd Angle Degrees Source 4 differential ground current angle
6400 SRC 5 Ia RMS Amps Source 5 phase A current RMS
6402 SRC 5 Ib RMS Amps Source 5 phase B current RMS
6404 SRC 5 Ic RMS Amps Source 5 phase C current RMS
6406 SRC 5 In RMS Amps Source 5 neutral current RMS
6408 SRC 5 Ia Mag Amps Source 5 phase A current magnitude
6410 SRC 5 Ia Angle Degrees Source 5 phase A current angle
6411 SRC 5 Ib Mag Amps Source 5 phase B current magnitude

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-3


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


6413 SRC 5 Ib Angle Degrees Source 5 phase B current angle
A 6414 SRC 5 Ic Mag Amps Source 5 phase C current magnitude
6416 SRC 5 Ic Angle Degrees Source 5 phase C current angle
6417 SRC 5 In Mag Amps Source 5 neutral current magnitude
6419 SRC 5 In Angle Degrees Source 5 neutral current angle
6420 SRC 5 Ig RMS Amps Source 5 ground current RMS
6422 SRC 5 Ig Mag Amps Source 5 ground current magnitude
6424 SRC 5 Ig Angle Degrees Source 5 ground current angle
6425 SRC 5 I_0 Mag Amps Source 5 zero-sequence current magnitude
6427 SRC 5 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 5 zero-sequence current angle
6428 SRC 5 I_1 Mag Amps Source 5 positive-sequence current magnitude
6430 SRC 5 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 5 positive-sequence current angle
6431 SRC 5 I_2 Mag Amps Source 5 negative-sequence current magnitude
6433 SRC 5 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 5 negative-sequence current angle
6434 SRC 5 Igd Mag Amps Source 5 differential ground current magnitude
6436 SRC 5 Igd Angle Degrees Source 5 differential ground current angle
6464 SRC 6 Ia RMS Amps Source 6 phase A current RMS
6466 SRC 6 Ib RMS Amps Source 6 phase B current RMS
6468 SRC 6 Ic RMS Amps Source 6 phase C current RMS
6470 SRC 6 In RMS Amps Source 6 neutral current RMS
6472 SRC 6 Ia Mag Amps Source 6 phase A current magnitude
6474 SRC 6 Ia Angle Degrees Source 6 phase A current angle
6475 SRC 6 Ib Mag Amps Source 6 phase B current magnitude
6477 SRC 6 Ib Angle Degrees Source 6 phase B current angle
6478 SRC 6 Ic Mag Amps Source 6 phase C current magnitude
6480 SRC 6 Ic Angle Degrees Source 6 phase C current angle
6481 SRC 6 In Mag Amps Source 6 neutral current magnitude
6483 SRC 6 In Angle Degrees Source 6 neutral current angle
6484 SRC 6 Ig RMS Amps Source 6 ground current RMS
6486 SRC 6 Ig Mag Amps Source 6 ground current magnitude
6488 SRC 6 Ig Angle Degrees Source 6 ground current angle
6489 SRC 6 I_0 Mag Amps Source 6 zero-sequence current magnitude
6491 SRC 6 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 6 zero-sequence current angle
6492 SRC 6 I_1 Mag Amps Source 6 positive-sequence current magnitude
6494 SRC 6 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 6 positive-sequence current angle
6495 SRC 6 I_2 Mag Amps Source 6 negative-sequence current magnitude
6497 SRC 6 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 6 negative-sequence current angle
6498 SRC 6 Igd Mag Amps Source 6 differential ground current magnitude
6500 SRC 6 Igd Angle Degrees Source 6 differential ground current angle
6656 SRC 1 Vag RMS Volts Source 1 phase AG voltage RMS
6658 SRC 1 Vbg RMS Volts Source 1 phase BG voltage RMS
6660 SRC 1 Vcg RMS Volts Source 1 phase CG voltage RMS
6662 SRC 1 Vag Mag Volts Source 1 phase AG voltage magnitude
6664 SRC 1 Vag Angle Degrees Source 1 phase AG voltage angle
6665 SRC 1 Vbg Mag Volts Source 1 phase BG voltage magnitude
6667 SRC 1 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 1 phase BG voltage angle
6668 SRC 1 Vcg Mag Volts Source 1 phase CG voltage magnitude

A-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
6670 SRC 1 Vcg Angle Degrees Source 1 phase CG voltage angle
6671 SRC 1 Vab RMS Volts Source 1 phase AB voltage RMS
6673 SRC 1 Vbc RMS Volts Source 1 phase BC voltage RMS
6675 SRC 1 Vca RMS Volts Source 1 phase CA voltage RMS
6677 SRC 1 Vab Mag Volts Source 1 phase AB voltage magnitude
6679 SRC 1 Vab Angle Degrees Source 1 phase AB voltage angle
6680 SRC 1 Vbc Mag Volts Source 1 phase BC voltage magnitude
6682 SRC 1 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 1 phase BC voltage angle
6683 SRC 1 Vca Mag Volts Source 1 phase CA voltage magnitude
6685 SRC 1 Vca Angle Degrees Source 1 phase CA voltage angle
6686 SRC 1 Vx RMS Volts Source 1 auxiliary voltage RMS
6688 SRC 1 Vx Mag Volts Source 1 auxiliary voltage magnitude
6690 SRC 1 Vx Angle Degrees Source 1 auxiliary voltage angle
6691 SRC 1 V_0 Mag Volts Source 1 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
6693 SRC 1 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 1 zero-sequence voltage angle
6694 SRC 1 V_1 Mag Volts Source 1 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
6696 SRC 1 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 1 positive-sequence voltage angle
6697 SRC 1 V_2 Mag Volts Source 1 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
6699 SRC 1 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 1 negative-sequence voltage angle
6720 SRC 2 Vag RMS Volts Source 2 phase AG voltage RMS
6722 SRC 2 Vbg RMS Volts Source 2 phase BG voltage RMS
6724 SRC 2 Vcg RMS Volts Source 2 phase CG voltage RMS
6726 SRC 2 Vag Mag Volts Source 2 phase AG voltage magnitude
6728 SRC 2 Vag Angle Degrees Source 2 phase AG voltage angle
6729 SRC 2 Vbg Mag Volts Source 2 phase BG voltage magnitude
6731 SRC 2 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 2 phase BG voltage angle
6732 SRC 2 Vcg Mag Volts Source 2 phase CG voltage magnitude
6734 SRC 2 Vcg Angle Degrees Source 2 phase CG voltage angle
6735 SRC 2 Vab RMS Volts Source 2 phase AB voltage RMS
6737 SRC 2 Vbc RMS Volts Source 2 phase BC voltage RMS
6739 SRC 2 Vca RMS Volts Source 2 phase CA voltage RMS
6741 SRC 2 Vab Mag Volts Source 2 phase AB voltage magnitude
6743 SRC 2 Vab Angle Degrees Source 2 phase AB voltage angle
6744 SRC 2 Vbc Mag Volts Source 2 phase BC voltage magnitude
6746 SRC 2 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 2 phase BC voltage angle
6747 SRC 2 Vca Mag Volts Source 2 phase CA voltage magnitude
6749 SRC 2 Vca Angle Degrees Source 2 phase CA voltage angle
6750 SRC 2 Vx RMS Volts Source 2 auxiliary voltage RMS
6752 SRC 2 Vx Mag Volts Source 2 auxiliary voltage magnitude
6754 SRC 2 Vx Angle Degrees Source 2 auxiliary voltage angle
6755 SRC 2 V_0 Mag Volts Source 2 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
6757 SRC 2 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 2 zero-sequence voltage angle
6758 SRC 2 V_1 Mag Volts Source 2 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
6760 SRC 2 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 2 positive-sequence voltage angle
6761 SRC 2 V_2 Mag Volts Source 2 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
6763 SRC 2 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 2 negative-sequence voltage angle
6784 SRC 3 Vag RMS Volts Source 3 phase AG voltage RMS

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-5


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


6786 SRC 3 Vbg RMS Volts Source 3 phase BG voltage RMS
A 6788 SRC 3 Vcg RMS Volts Source 3 phase CG voltage RMS
6790 SRC 3 Vag Mag Volts Source 3 phase AG voltage magnitude
6792 SRC 3 Vag Angle Degrees Source 3 phase AG voltage angle
6793 SRC 3 Vbg Mag Volts Source 3 phase BG voltage magnitude
6795 SRC 3 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 3 phase BG voltage angle
6796 SRC 3 Vcg Mag Volts Source 3 phase CG voltage magnitude
6798 SRC 3 Vcg Angle Degrees Source 3 phase CG voltage angle
6799 SRC 3 Vab RMS Volts Source 3 phase AB voltage RMS
6801 SRC 3 Vbc RMS Volts Source 3 phase BC voltage RMS
6803 SRC 3 Vca RMS Volts Source 3 phase CA voltage RMS
6805 SRC 3 Vab Mag Volts Source 3 phase AB voltage magnitude
6807 SRC 3 Vab Angle Degrees Source 3 phase AB voltage angle
6808 SRC 3 Vbc Mag Volts Source 3 phase BC voltage magnitude
6810 SRC 3 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 3 phase BC voltage angle
6811 SRC 3 Vca Mag Volts Source 3 phase CA voltage magnitude
6813 SRC 3 Vca Angle Degrees Source 3 phase CA voltage angle
6814 SRC 3 Vx RMS Volts Source 3 auxiliary voltage RMS
6816 SRC 3 Vx Mag Volts Source 3 auxiliary voltage magnitude
6818 SRC 3 Vx Angle Degrees Source 3 auxiliary voltage angle
6819 SRC 3 V_0 Mag Volts Source 3 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
6821 SRC 3 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 3 zero-sequence voltage angle
6822 SRC 3 V_1 Mag Volts Source 3 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
6824 SRC 3 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 3 positive-sequence voltage angle
6825 SRC 3 V_2 Mag Volts Source 3 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
6827 SRC 3 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 3 negative-sequence voltage angle
6848 SRC 4 Vag RMS Volts Source 4 phase AG voltage RMS
6850 SRC 4 Vbg RMS Volts Source 4 phase BG voltage RMS
6852 SRC 4 Vcg RMS Volts Source 4 phase CG voltage RMS
6854 SRC 4 Vag Mag Volts Source 4 phase AG voltage magnitude
6856 SRC 4 Vag Angle Degrees Source 4 phase AG voltage angle
6857 SRC 4 Vbg Mag Volts Source 4 phase BG voltage magnitude
6859 SRC 4 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 4 phase BG voltage angle
6860 SRC 4 Vcg Mag Volts Source 4 phase CG voltage magnitude
6862 SRC 4 Vcg Angle Degrees Source 4 phase CG voltage angle
6863 SRC 4 Vab RMS Volts Source 4 phase AB voltage RMS
6865 SRC 4 Vbc RMS Volts Source 4 phase BC voltage RMS
6867 SRC 4 Vca RMS Volts Source 4 phase CA voltage RMS
6869 SRC 4 Vab Mag Volts Source 4 phase AB voltage magnitude
6871 SRC 4 Vab Angle Degrees Source 4 phase AB voltage angle
6872 SRC 4 Vbc Mag Volts Source 4 phase BC voltage magnitude
6874 SRC 4 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 4 phase BC voltage angle
6875 SRC 4 Vca Mag Volts Source 4 phase CA voltage magnitude
6877 SRC 4 Vca Angle Degrees Source 4 phase CA voltage angle
6878 SRC 4 Vx RMS Volts Source 4 auxiliary voltage RMS
6880 SRC 4 Vx Mag Volts Source 4 auxiliary voltage magnitude
6882 SRC 4 Vx Angle Degrees Source 4 auxiliary voltage angle

A-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
6883 SRC 4 V_0 Mag Volts Source 4 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
6885 SRC 4 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 4 zero-sequence voltage angle
6886 SRC 4 V_1 Mag Volts Source 4 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
6888 SRC 4 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 4 positive-sequence voltage angle
6889 SRC 4 V_2 Mag Volts Source 4 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
6891 SRC 4 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 4 negative-sequence voltage angle
6912 SRC 5 Vag RMS Volts Source 5 phase AG voltage RMS
6914 SRC 5 Vbg RMS Volts Source 5 phase BG voltage RMS
6916 SRC 5 Vcg RMS Volts Source 5 phase CG voltage RMS
6918 SRC 5 Vag Mag Volts Source 5 phase AG voltage magnitude
6920 SRC 5 Vag Angle Degrees Source 5 phase AG voltage angle
6921 SRC 5 Vbg Mag Volts Source 5 phase BG voltage magnitude
6923 SRC 5 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 5 phase BG voltage angle
6924 SRC 5 Vcg Mag Volts Source 5 phase CG voltage magnitude
6926 SRC 5 Vcg Angle Degrees Source 5 phase CG voltage angle
6927 SRC 5 Vab RMS Volts Source 5 phase AB voltage RMS
6929 SRC 5 Vbc RMS Volts Source 5 phase BC voltage RMS
6931 SRC 5 Vca RMS Volts Source 5 phase CA voltage RMS
6933 SRC 5 Vab Mag Volts Source 5 phase AB voltage magnitude
6935 SRC 5 Vab Angle Degrees Source 5 phase AB voltage angle
6936 SRC 5 Vbc Mag Volts Source 5 phase BC voltage magnitude
6938 SRC 5 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 5 phase BC voltage angle
6939 SRC 5 Vca Mag Volts Source 5 phase CA voltage magnitude
6941 SRC 5 Vca Angle Degrees Source 5 phase CA voltage angle
6942 SRC 5 Vx RMS Volts Source 5 auxiliary voltage RMS
6944 SRC 5 Vx Mag Volts Source 5 auxiliary voltage magnitude
6946 SRC 5 Vx Angle Degrees Source 5 auxiliary voltage angle
6947 SRC 5 V_0 Mag Volts Source 5 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
6949 SRC 5 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 5 zero-sequence voltage angle
6950 SRC 5 V_1 Mag Volts Source 5 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
6952 SRC 5 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 5 positive-sequence voltage angle
6953 SRC 5 V_2 Mag Volts Source 5 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
6955 SRC 5 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 5 negative-sequence voltage angle
6976 SRC 6 Vag RMS Volts Source 6 phase AG voltage RMS
6978 SRC 6 Vbg RMS Volts Source 6 phase BG voltage RMS
6980 SRC 6 Vcg RMS Volts Source 6 phase CG voltage RMS
6982 SRC 6 Vag Mag Volts Source 6 phase AG voltage magnitude
6984 SRC 6 Vag Angle Degrees Source 6 phase AG voltage angle
6985 SRC 6 Vbg Mag Volts Source 6 phase BG voltage magnitude
6987 SRC 6 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 6 phase BG voltage angle
6988 SRC 6 Vcg Mag Volts Source 6 phase CG voltage magnitude
6990 SRC 6 Vcg Angle Degrees Source 6 phase CG voltage angle
6991 SRC 6 Vab RMS Volts Source 6 phase AB voltage RMS
6993 SRC 6 Vbc RMS Volts Source 6 phase BC voltage RMS
6995 SRC 6 Vca RMS Volts Source 6 phase CA voltage RMS
6997 SRC 6 Vab Mag Volts Source 6 phase AB voltage magnitude
6999 SRC 6 Vab Angle Degrees Source 6 phase AB voltage angle

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-7


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


7000 SRC 6 Vbc Mag Volts Source 6 phase BC voltage magnitude
A 7002 SRC 6 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 6 phase BC voltage angle
7003 SRC 6 Vca Mag Volts Source 6 phase CA voltage magnitude
7005 SRC 6 Vca Angle Degrees Source 6 phase CA voltage angle
7006 SRC 6 Vx RMS Volts Source 6 auxiliary voltage RMS
7008 SRC 6 Vx Mag Volts Source 6 auxiliary voltage magnitude
7010 SRC 6 Vx Angle Degrees Source 6 auxiliary voltage angle
7011 SRC 6 V_0 Mag Volts Source 6 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
7013 SRC 6 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 6 zero-sequence voltage angle
7014 SRC 6 V_1 Mag Volts Source 6 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
7016 SRC 6 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 6 positive-sequence voltage angle
7017 SRC 6 V_2 Mag Volts Source 6 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
7019 SRC 6 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 6 negative-sequence voltage angle
7168 SRC 1 P Watts Source 1 three-phase real power
7170 SRC 1 Pa Watts Source 1 phase A real power
7172 SRC 1 Pb Watts Source 1 phase B real power
7174 SRC 1 Pc Watts Source 1 phase C real power
7176 SRC 1 Q Vars Source 1 three-phase reactive power
7178 SRC 1 Qa Vars Source 1 phase A reactive power
7180 SRC 1 Qb Vars Source 1 phase B reactive power
7182 SRC 1 Qc Vars Source 1 phase C reactive power
7184 SRC 1 S VA Source 1 three-phase apparent power
7186 SRC 1 Sa VA Source 1 phase A apparent power
7188 SRC 1 Sb VA Source 1 phase B apparent power
7190 SRC 1 Sc VA Source 1 phase C apparent power
7192 SRC 1 PF --- Source 1 three-phase power factor
7193 SRC 1 Phase A PF --- Source 1 phase A power factor
7194 SRC 1 Phase B PF --- Source 1 phase B power factor
7195 SRC 1 Phase C PF --- Source 1 phase C power factor
7200 SRC 2 P Watts Source 2 three-phase real power
7202 SRC 2 Pa Watts Source 2 phase A real power
7204 SRC 2 Pb Watts Source 2 phase B real power
7206 SRC 2 Pc Watts Source 2 phase C real power
7208 SRC 2 Q Vars Source 2 three-phase reactive power
7210 SRC 2 Qa Vars Source 2 phase A reactive power
7212 SRC 2 Qb Vars Source 2 phase B reactive power
7214 SRC 2 Qc Vars Source 2 phase C reactive power
7216 SRC 2 S VA Source 2 three-phase apparent power
7218 SRC 2 Sa VA Source 2 phase A apparent power
7220 SRC 2 Sb VA Source 2 phase B apparent power
7222 SRC 2 Sc VA Source 2 phase C apparent power
7224 SRC 2 PF --- Source 2 three-phase power factor
7225 SRC 2 Phase A PF --- Source 2 phase A power factor
7226 SRC 2 Phase B PF --- Source 2 phase B power factor
7227 SRC 2 Phase C PF --- Source 2 phase C power factor
7232 SRC 3 P Watts Source 3 three-phase real power
7234 SRC 3 Pa Watts Source 3 phase A real power

A-8 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
7236 SRC 3 Pb Watts Source 3 phase B real power
7238 SRC 3 Pc Watts Source 3 phase C real power
7240 SRC 3 Q Vars Source 3 three-phase reactive power
7242 SRC 3 Qa Vars Source 3 phase A reactive power
7244 SRC 3 Qb Vars Source 3 phase B reactive power
7246 SRC 3 Qc Vars Source 3 phase C reactive power
7248 SRC 3 S VA Source 3 three-phase apparent power
7250 SRC 3 Sa VA Source 3 phase A apparent power
7252 SRC 3 Sb VA Source 3 phase B apparent power
7254 SRC 3 Sc VA Source 3 phase C apparent power
7256 SRC 3 PF --- Source 3 three-phase power factor
7257 SRC 3 Phase A PF --- Source 3 phase A power factor
7258 SRC 3 Phase B PF --- Source 3 phase B power factor
7259 SRC 3 Phase C PF --- Source 3 phase C power factor
7264 SRC 4 P Watts Source 4 three-phase real power
7266 SRC 4 Pa Watts Source 4 phase A real power
7268 SRC 4 Pb Watts Source 4 phase B real power
7270 SRC 4 Pc Watts Source 4 phase C real power
7272 SRC 4 Q Vars Source 4 three-phase reactive power
7274 SRC 4 Qa Vars Source 4 phase A reactive power
7276 SRC 4 Qb Vars Source 4 phase B reactive power
7278 SRC 4 Qc Vars Source 4 phase C reactive power
7280 SRC 4 S VA Source 4 three-phase apparent power
7282 SRC 4 Sa VA Source 4 phase A apparent power
7284 SRC 4 Sb VA Source 4 phase B apparent power
7286 SRC 4 Sc VA Source 4 phase C apparent power
7288 SRC 4 PF --- Source 4 three-phase power factor
7289 SRC 4 Phase A PF --- Source 4 phase A power factor
7290 SRC 4 Phase B PF --- Source 4 phase B power factor
7291 SRC 4 Phase C PF --- Source 4 phase C power factor
7296 SRC 5 P Watts Source 5 three-phase real power
7298 SRC 5 Pa Watts Source 5 phase A real power
7300 SRC 5 Pb Watts Source 5 phase B real power
7302 SRC 5 Pc Watts Source 5 phase C real power
7304 SRC 5 Q Vars Source 5 three-phase reactive power
7306 SRC 5 Qa Vars Source 5 phase A reactive power
7308 SRC 5 Qb Vars Source 5 phase B reactive power
7310 SRC 5 Qc Vars Source 5 phase C reactive power
7312 SRC 5 S VA Source 5 three-phase apparent power
7314 SRC 5 Sa VA Source 5 phase A apparent power
7316 SRC 5 Sb VA Source 5 phase B apparent power
7318 SRC 5 Sc VA Source 5 phase C apparent power
7320 SRC 5 PF --- Source 5 three-phase power factor
7321 SRC 5 Phase A PF --- Source 5 phase A power factor
7322 SRC 5 Phase B PF --- Source 5 phase B power factor
7323 SRC 5 Phase C PF --- Source 5 phase C power factor
7328 SRC 6 P Watts Source 6 three-phase real power

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-9


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


7330 SRC 6 Pa Watts Source 6 phase A real power
A 7332 SRC 6 Pb Watts Source 6 phase B real power
7334 SRC 6 Pc Watts Source 6 phase C real power
7336 SRC 6 Q Vars Source 6 three-phase reactive power
7338 SRC 6 Qa Vars Source 6 phase A reactive power
7340 SRC 6 Qb Vars Source 6 phase B reactive power
7342 SRC 6 Qc Vars Source 6 phase C reactive power
7344 SRC 6 S VA Source 6 three-phase apparent power
7346 SRC 6 Sa VA Source 6 phase A apparent power
7348 SRC 6 Sb VA Source 6 phase B apparent power
7350 SRC 6 Sc VA Source 6 phase C apparent power
7352 SRC 6 PF --- Source 6 three-phase power factor
7353 SRC 6 Phase A PF --- Source 6 phase A power factor
7354 SRC 6 Phase B PF --- Source 6 phase B power factor
7355 SRC 6 Phase C PF --- Source 6 phase C power factor
7424 SRC 1 Pos Watthour kWh Source 1 positive Watthour
7426 SRC 1 Neg Watthour Wh Source 1 negative Watthour
7428 SRC 1 Pos varh varh Source 1 positive varhour
7430 SRC 1 Neg varh varh Source 1 negative varhour
7440 SRC 2 Pos Watthour kWh Source 2 positive Watthour
7442 SRC 2 Neg Watthour Wh Source 2 negative Watthour
7444 SRC 2 Pos varh varh Source 2 positive varhour
7446 SRC 2 Neg varh varh Source 2 negative varhour
7456 SRC 3 Pos Watthour kWh Source 3 positive Watthour
7458 SRC 3 Neg Watthour kWh Source 3 negative Watthour
7460 SRC 3 Pos varh varh Source 3 positive varhour
7462 SRC 3 Neg varh varh Source 3 negative varhour
7472 SRC 4 Pos Watthour Wh Source 4 positive Watthour
7474 SRC 4 Neg Watthour Wh Source 4 negative Watthour
7476 SRC 4 Pos varh varh Source 4 positive varhour
7478 SRC 4 Neg varh varh Source 4 negative varhour
7488 SRC 5 Pos Watthour Wh Source 5 positive Watthour
7490 SRC 5 Neg Watthour Wh Source 5 negative Watthour
7492 SRC 5 Pos varh varh Source 5 positive varhour
7494 SRC 5 Neg varh varh Source 5 negative varhour
7504 SRC 6 Pos Watthour Wh Source 6 positive Watthour
7506 SRC 6 Neg Watthour Wh Source 6 negative Watthour
7508 SRC 6 Pos varh varh Source 6 positive varhour
7510 SRC 6 Neg varh varh Source 6 negative varhour
7552 SRC 1 Frequency Hz Source 1 frequency
7554 SRC 2 Frequency Hz Source 2 frequency
7556 SRC 3 Frequency Hz Source 3 frequency
7558 SRC 4 Frequency Hz Source 4 frequency
7560 SRC 5 Frequency Hz Source 5 frequency
7562 SRC 6 Frequency Hz Source 6 frequency
7680 SRC 1 Demand Ia Amps Source 1 phase A current demand
7682 SRC 1 Demand Ib Amps Source 1 phase B current demand

A-10 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
7684 SRC 1 Demand Ic Amps Source 1 phase C current demand
7686 SRC 1 Demand Watt Watts Source 1 real power demand
7688 SRC 1 Demand var Vars Source 1 reactive power demand
7690 SRC 1 Demand VA VA Source 1 apparent power demand
7696 SRC 2 Demand Ia Amps Source 2 phase A current demand
7698 SRC 2 Demand Ib Amps Source 2 phase B current demand
7700 SRC 2 Demand Ic Amps Source 2 phase C current demand
7702 SRC 2 Demand Watt Watts Source 2 real power demand
7704 SRC 2 Demand var Vars Source 2 reactive power demand
7706 SRC 2 Demand VA VA Source 2 apparent power demand
7712 SRC 3 Demand Ia Amps Source 3 phase A current demand
7714 SRC 3 Demand Ib Amps Source 3 phase B current demand
7716 SRC 3 Demand Ic Amps Source 3 phase C current demand
7718 SRC 3 Demand Watt Watts Source 3 real power demand
7720 SRC 3 Demand var Vars Source 3 reactive power demand
7722 SRC 3 Demand VA VA Source 3 apparent power demand
7728 SRC 4 Demand Ia Amps Source 4 phase A current demand
7730 SRC 4 Demand Ib Amps Source 4 phase B current demand
7732 SRC 4 Demand Ic Amps Source 4 phase C current demand
7734 SRC 4 Demand Watt Watts Source 4 real power demand
7736 SRC 4 Demand var Vars Source 4 reactive power demand
7738 SRC 4 Demand VA VA Source 4 apparent power demand
7744 SRC 5 Demand Ia Amps Source 5 phase A current demand
7746 SRC 5 Demand Ib Amps Source 5 phase B current demand
7748 SRC 5 Demand Ic Amps Source 5 phase C current demand
7750 SRC 5 Demand Watt Watts Source 5 real power demand
7752 SRC 5 Demand var Vars Source 5 reactive power demand
7754 SRC 5 Demand VA VA Source 5 apparent power demand
7760 SRC 6 Demand Ia Amps Source 6 phase A current demand
7762 SRC 6 Demand Ib Amps Source 6 phase B current demand
7764 SRC 6 Demand Ic Amps Source 6 phase C current demand
7766 SRC 6 Demand Watt Watts Source 6 real power demand
7768 SRC 6 Demand var Vars Source 6 reactive power demand
7770 SRC 6 Demand VA VA Source 6 apparent power demand
8064 SRC 1 Va THD % Source 1 phase A voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8065 SRC 1 Va Harm[2] % Source 1 phase A voltage second harmonic
8066 SRC 1 Va Harm[3] % Source 1 phase A voltage third harmonic
8067 SRC 1 Va Harm[4] % Source 1 phase A voltage fourth harmonic
8068 SRC 1 Va Harm[5] % Source 1 phase A voltage fifth harmonic
8069 SRC 1 Va Harm[6] % Source 1 phase A voltage sixth harmonic
8070 SRC 1 Va Harm[7] % Source 1 phase A voltage seventh harmonic
8071 SRC 1 Va Harm[8] % Source 1 phase A voltage eighth harmonic
8072 SRC 1 Va Harm[9] % Source 1 phase A voltage ninth harmonic
8073 SRC 1 Va Harm[10] % Source 1 phase A voltage tenth harmonic
8074 SRC 1 Va Harm[11] % Source 1 phase A voltage eleventh harmonic
8075 SRC 1 Va Harm[12] % Source 1 phase A voltage twelfth harmonic
8076 SRC 1 Va Harm[13] % Source 1 phase A voltage thirteenth harmonic

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-11


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


8077 SRC 1 Va Harm[14] % Source 1 phase A voltage fourteenth harmonic
A 8078 SRC 1 Va Harm[15] % Source 1 phase A voltage fifteenth harmonic
8079 SRC 1 Va Harm[16] % Source 1 phase A voltage sixteenth harmonic
8080 SRC 1 Va Harm[17] % Source 1 phase A voltage seventeenth harmonic
8081 SRC 1 Va Harm[18] % Source 1 phase A voltage eighteenth harmonic
8082 SRC 1 Va Harm[19] % Source 1 phase A voltage nineteenth harmonic
8083 SRC 1 Va Harm[20] % Source 1 phase A voltage twentieth harmonic
8084 SRC 1 Va Harm[21] % Source 1 phase A voltage twenty-first harmonic
8085 SRC 1 Va Harm[22] % Source 1 phase A voltage twenty-second harmonic
8086 SRC 1 Va Harm[23] % Source 1 phase A voltage twenty-third harmonic
8087 SRC 1 Va Harm[24] % Source 1 phase A voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8088 SRC 1 Va Harm[25] % Source 1 phase A voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8089 SRC 1 Vb THD % Source 1 phase B voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8090 SRC 1 Vb Harm[2] % Source 1 phase B voltage second harmonic
8091 SRC 1 Vb Harm[3] % Source 1 phase B voltage third harmonic
8092 SRC 1 Vb Harm[4] % Source 1 phase B voltage fourth harmonic
8093 SRC 1 Vb Harm[5] % Source 1 phase B voltage fifth harmonic
8094 SRC 1 Vb Harm[6] % Source 1 phase B voltage sixth harmonic
8095 SRC 1 Vb Harm[7] % Source 1 phase B voltage seventh harmonic
8096 SRC 1 Vb Harm[8] % Source 1 phase B voltage eighth harmonic
8097 SRC 1 Vb Harm[9] % Source 1 phase B voltage ninth harmonic
8098 SRC 1 Vb Harm[10] % Source 1 phase B voltage tenth harmonic
8099 SRC 1 Vb Harm[11] % Source 1 phase B voltage eleventh harmonic
8100 SRC 1 Vb Harm[12] % Source 1 phase B voltage twelfth harmonic
8101 SRC 1 Vb Harm[13] % Source 1 phase B voltage thirteenth harmonic
8102 SRC 1 Vb Harm[14] % Source 1 phase B voltage fourteenth harmonic
8103 SRC 1 Vb Harm[15] % Source 1 phase B voltage fifteenth harmonic
8104 SRC 1 Vb Harm[16] % Source 1 phase B voltage sixteenth harmonic
8105 SRC 1 Vb Harm[17] % Source 1 phase B voltage seventeenth harmonic
8106 SRC 1 Vb Harm[18] % Source 1 phase B voltage eighteenth harmonic
8107 SRC 1 Vb Harm[19] % Source 1 phase B voltage nineteenth harmonic
8108 SRC 1 Vb Harm[20] % Source 1 phase B voltage twentieth harmonic
8109 SRC 1 Vb Harm[21] % Source 1 phase B voltage twenty-first harmonic
8110 SRC 1 Vb Harm[22] % Source 1 phase B voltage twenty-second harmonic
8111 SRC 1 Vb Harm[23] % Source 1 phase B voltage twenty-third harmonic
8112 SRC 1 Vb Harm[24] % Source 1 phase B voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8113 SRC 1 Vb Harm[25] % Source 1 phase B voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8114 SRC 1 Vc THD % Source 1 phase C voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8115 SRC 1 Vc Harm[2] % Source 1 phase C voltage second harmonic
8116 SRC 1 Vc Harm[3] % Source 1 phase C voltage third harmonic
8117 SRC 1 Vc Harm[4] % Source 1 phase C voltage fourth harmonic
8118 SRC 1 Vc Harm[5] % Source 1 phase C voltage fifth harmonic
8119 SRC 1 Vc Harm[6] % Source 1 phase C voltage sixth harmonic
8120 SRC 1 Vc Harm[7] % Source 1 phase C voltage seventh harmonic
8121 SRC 1 Vc Harm[8] % Source 1 phase C voltage eighth harmonic
8122 SRC 1 Vc Harm[9] % Source 1 phase C voltage ninth harmonic
8123 SRC 1 Vc Harm[10] % Source 1 phase C voltage tenth harmonic

A-12 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
8124 SRC 1 Vc Harm[11] % Source 1 phase C voltage eleventh harmonic
8125 SRC 1 Vc Harm[12] % Source 1 phase C voltage twelfth harmonic
8126 SRC 1 Vc Harm[13] % Source 1 phase C voltage thirteenth harmonic
8127 SRC 1 Vc Harm[14] % Source 1 phase C voltage fourteenth harmonic
8128 SRC 1 Vc Harm[15] % Source 1 phase C voltage fifteenth harmonic
8129 SRC 1 Vc Harm[16] % Source 1 phase C voltage sixteenth harmonic
8130 SRC 1 Vc Harm[17] % Source 1 phase C voltage seventeenth harmonic
8131 SRC 1 Vc Harm[18] % Source 1 phase C voltage eighteenth harmonic
8132 SRC 1 Vc Harm[19] % Source 1 phase C voltage nineteenth harmonic
8133 SRC 1 Vc Harm[20] % Source 1 phase C voltage twentieth harmonic
8134 SRC 1 Vc Harm[21] % Source 1 phase C voltage twenty-first harmonic
8135 SRC 1 Vc Harm[22] % Source 1 phase C voltage twenty-second harmonic
8136 SRC 1 Vc Harm[23] % Source 1 phase C voltage twenty-third harmonic
8137 SRC 1 Vc Harm[24] % Source 1 phase C voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8138 SRC 1 Vc Harm[25] % Source 1 phase C voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8139 SRC 2 Va THD % Source 2 phase A voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8140 SRC 2 Va Harm[2] % Source 2 phase A voltage second harmonic
8141 SRC 2 Va Harm[3] % Source 2 phase A voltage third harmonic
8142 SRC 2 Va Harm[4] % Source 2 phase A voltage fourth harmonic
8143 SRC 2 Va Harm[5] % Source 2 phase A voltage fifth harmonic
8144 SRC 2 Va Harm[6] % Source 2 phase A voltage sixth harmonic
8145 SRC 2 Va Harm[7] % Source 2 phase A voltage seventh harmonic
8146 SRC 2 Va Harm[8] % Source 2 phase A voltage eighth harmonic
8147 SRC 2 Va Harm[9] % Source 2 phase A voltage ninth harmonic
8148 SRC 2 Va Harm[10] % Source 2 phase A voltage tenth harmonic
8149 SRC 2 Va Harm[11] % Source 2 phase A voltage eleventh harmonic
8150 SRC 2 Va Harm[12] % Source 2 phase A voltage twelfth harmonic
8151 SRC 2 Va Harm[13] % Source 2 phase A voltage thirteenth harmonic
8152 SRC 2 Va Harm[14] % Source 2 phase A voltage fourteenth harmonic
8153 SRC 2 Va Harm[15] % Source 2 phase A voltage fifteenth harmonic
8154 SRC 2 Va Harm[16] % Source 2 phase A voltage sixteenth harmonic
8155 SRC 2 Va Harm[17] % Source 2 phase A voltage seventeenth harmonic
8156 SRC 2 Va Harm[18] % Source 2 phase A voltage eighteenth harmonic
8157 SRC 2 Va Harm[19] % Source 2 phase A voltage nineteenth harmonic
8158 SRC 2 Va Harm[20] % Source 2 phase A voltage twentieth harmonic
8159 SRC 2 Va Harm[21] % Source 2 phase A voltage twenty-first harmonic
8160 SRC 2 Va Harm[22] % Source 2 phase A voltage twenty-second harmonic
8161 SRC 2 Va Harm[23] % Source 2 phase A voltage twenty-third harmonic
8162 SRC 2 Va Harm[24] % Source 2 phase A voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8163 SRC 2 Va Harm[25] % Source 2 phase A voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8164 SRC 2 Vb THD % Source 2 phase B voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8165 SRC 2 Vb Harm[2] % Source 2 phase B voltage second harmonic
8166 SRC 2 Vb Harm[3] % Source 2 phase B voltage third harmonic
8167 SRC 2 Vb Harm[4] % Source 2 phase B voltage fourth harmonic
8168 SRC 2 Vb Harm[5] % Source 2 phase B voltage fifth harmonic
8169 SRC 2 Vb Harm[6] % Source 2 phase B voltage sixth harmonic
8170 SRC 2 Vb Harm[7] % Source 2 phase B voltage seventh harmonic

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-13


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


8171 SRC 2 Vb Harm[8] % Source 2 phase B voltage eighth harmonic
A 8172 SRC 2 Vb Harm[9] % Source 2 phase B voltage ninth harmonic
8173 SRC 2 Vb Harm[10] % Source 2 phase B voltage tenth harmonic
8174 SRC 2 Vb Harm[11] % Source 2 phase B voltage eleventh harmonic
8175 SRC 2 Vb Harm[12] % Source 2 phase B voltage twelfth harmonic
8176 SRC 2 Vb Harm[13] % Source 2 phase B voltage thirteenth harmonic
8177 SRC 2 Vb Harm[14] % Source 2 phase B voltage fourteenth harmonic
8178 SRC 2 Vb Harm[15] % Source 2 phase B voltage fifteenth harmonic
8179 SRC 2 Vb Harm[16] % Source 2 phase B voltage sixteenth harmonic
8180 SRC 2 Vb Harm[17] % Source 2 phase B voltage seventeenth harmonic
8181 SRC 2 Vb Harm[18 % Source 2 phase B voltage eighteenth harmonic
8182 SRC 2 Vb Harm[19] % Source 2 phase B voltage nineteenth harmonic
8183 SRC 2 Vb Harm[20] % Source 2 phase B voltage twentieth harmonic
8184 SRC 2 Vb Harm[21 % Source 2 phase B voltage twenty-first harmonic
8185 SRC 2 Vb Harm[22] % Source 2 phase B voltage twenty-second harmonic
8186 SRC 2 Vb Harm[23] % Source 2 phase B voltage twenty-third harmonic
8187 SRC 2 Vb Harm[24] % Source 2 phase B voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8188 SRC 2 Vb Harm[25] % Source 2 phase B voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8189 SRC 2 Vc THD % Source 2 phase C voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8190 SRC 2 Vc Harm[2] % Source 2 phase C voltage second harmonic
8191 SRC 2 Vc Harm[3] % Source 2 phase C voltage third harmonic
8192 SRC 2 Vc Harm[4] % Source 2 phase C voltage fourth harmonic
8193 SRC 2 Vc Harm[5] % Source 2 phase C voltage fifth harmonic
8194 SRC 2 Vc Harm[6] % Source 2 phase C voltage sixth harmonic
8195 SRC 2 Vc Harm[7] % Source 2 phase C voltage seventh harmonic
8196 SRC 2 Vc Harm[8] % Source 2 phase C voltage eighth harmonic
8197 SRC 2 Vc Harm[9] % Source 2 phase C voltage ninth harmonic
8198 SRC 2 Vc Harm[10] % Source 2 phase C voltage tenth harmonic
8199 SRC 2 Vc Harm[11] % Source 2 phase C voltage eleventh harmonic
8200 SRC 2 Vc Harm[12] % Source 2 phase C voltage twelfth harmonic
8201 SRC 2 Vc Harm[13] % Source 2 phase C voltage thirteenth harmonic
8202 SRC 2 Vc Harm[14] % Source 2 phase C voltage fourteenth harmonic
8203 SRC 2 Vc Harm[15] % Source 2 phase C voltage fifteenth harmonic
8204 SRC 2 Vc Harm[16] % Source 2 phase C voltage sixteenth harmonic
8205 SRC 2 Vc Harm[17] % Source 2 phase C voltage seventeenth harmonic
8206 SRC 2 Vc Harm[18] % Source 2 phase C voltage eighteenth harmonic
8207 SRC 2 Vc Harm[19] % Source 2 phase C voltage nineteenth harmonic
8208 SRC 2 Vc Harm[20] % Source 2 phase C voltage twentieth harmonic
8209 SRC 2 Vc Harm[21] % Source 2 phase C voltage twenty-first harmonic
8210 SRC 2 Vc Harm[22] % Source 2 phase C voltage twenty-second harmonic
8211 SRC 2 Vc Harm[23] % Source 2 phase C voltage twenty-third harmonic
8212 SRC 2 Vc Harm[24] % Source 2 phase C voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8213 SRC 2 Vc Harm[25] % Source 2 phase C voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8214 SRC 3 Va THD % Source 3 phase A voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8215 SRC 3 Va Harm[2] % Source 3 phase A voltage second harmonic
8216 SRC 3 Va Harm[3] % Source 3 phase A voltage third harmonic
8217 SRC 3 Va Harm[4] % Source 3 phase A voltage fourth harmonic

A-14 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
8218 SRC 3 Va Harm[5] % Source 3 phase A voltage fifth harmonic
8219 SRC 3 Va Harm[6] % Source 3 phase A voltage sixth harmonic
8220 SRC 3 Va Harm[7] % Source 3 phase A voltage seventh harmonic
8221 SRC 3 Va Harm[8] % Source 3 phase A voltage eighth harmonic
8222 SRC 3 Va Harm[9] % Source 3 phase A voltage ninth harmonic
8223 SRC 3 Va Harm[10] % Source 3 phase A voltage tenth harmonic
8224 SRC 3 Va Harm[11] % Source 3 phase A voltage eleventh harmonic
8225 SRC 3 Va Harm[12] % Source 3 phase A voltage twelfth harmonic
8226 SRC 3 Va Harm[13] % Source 3 phase A voltage thirteenth harmonic
8227 SRC 3 Va Harm[14] % Source 3 phase A voltage fourteenth harmonic
8228 SRC 3 Va Harm[15] % Source 3 phase A voltage fifteenth harmonic
8229 SRC 3 Va Harm[16] % Source 3 phase A voltage sixteenth harmonic
8230 SRC 3 Va Harm[17] % Source 3 phase A voltage seventeenth harmonic
8231 SRC 3 Va Harm[18] % Source 3 phase A voltage eighteenth harmonic
8232 SRC 3 Va Harm[19] % Source 3 phase A voltage nineteenth harmonic
8233 SRC 3 Va Harm[20] % Source 3 phase A voltage twentieth harmonic
8234 SRC 3 Va Harm[21] % Source 3 phase A voltage twenty-first harmonic
8235 SRC 3 Va Harm[22] % Source 3 phase A voltage twenty-second harmonic
8236 SRC 3 Va Harm[23] % Source 3 phase A voltage twenty-third harmonic
8237 SRC 3 Va Harm[24] % Source 3 phase A voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8238 SRC 3 Va Harm[25] % Source 3 phase A voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8239 SRC 3 Vb THD % Source 3 phase B voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8240 SRC 3 Vb Harm[2] % Source 3 phase B voltage second harmonic
8241 SRC 3 Vb Harm[3] % Source 3 phase B voltage third harmonic
8242 SRC 3 Vb Harm[4] % Source 3 phase B voltage fourth harmonic
8243 SRC 3 Vb Harm[5] % Source 3 phase B voltage fifth harmonic
8244 SRC 3 Vb Harm[6] % Source 3 phase B voltage sixth harmonic
8245 SRC 3 Vb Harm[7] % Source 3 phase B voltage seventh harmonic
8246 SRC 3 Vb Harm[8] % Source 3 phase B voltage eighth harmonic
8247 SRC 3 Vb Harm[9] % Source 3 phase B voltage ninth harmonic
8248 SRC 3 Vb Harm[10] % Source 3 phase B voltage tenth harmonic
8249 SRC 3 Vb Harm[11] % Source 3 phase B voltage eleventh harmonic
8250 SRC 3 Vb Harm[12] % Source 3 phase B voltage twelfth harmonic
8251 SRC 3 Vb Harm[13] % Source 3 phase B voltage thirteenth harmonic
8252 SRC 3 Vb Harm[14] % Source 3 phase B voltage fourteenth harmonic
8253 SRC 3 Vb Harm[15] % Source 3 phase B voltage fifteenth harmonic
8254 SRC 3 Vb Harm[16] % Source 3 phase B voltage sixteenth harmonic
8255 SRC 3 Vb Harm[17] % Source 3 phase B voltage seventeenth harmonic
8256 SRC 3 Vb Harm[18] % Source 3 phase B voltage eighteenth harmonic
8257 SRC 3 Vb Harm[19] % Source 3 phase B voltage nineteenth harmonic
8258 SRC 3 Vb Harm[20] % Source 3 phase B voltage twentieth harmonic
8259 SRC 3 Vb Harm[21] % Source 3 phase B voltage twenty-first harmonic
8260 SRC 3 Vb Harm[22] % Source 3 phase B voltage twenty-second harmonic
8261 SRC 3 Vb Harm[23] % Source 3 phase B voltage twenty-third harmonic
8262 SRC 3 Vb Harm[24] % Source 3 phase B voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8263 SRC 3 Vb Harm[25] % Source 3 phase B voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8264 SRC 3 Vc THD % Source 3 phase C voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-15


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


8265 SRC 3 Vc Harm[2] % Source 3 phase C voltage second harmonic
A 8266 SRC 3 Vc Harm[3] % Source 3 phase C voltage third harmonic
8267 SRC 3 Vc Harm[4] % Source 3 phase C voltage fourth harmonic
8268 SRC 3 Vc Harm[5] % Source 3 phase C voltage fifth harmonic
8269 SRC 3 Vc Harm[6] % Source 3 phase C voltage sixth harmonic
8270 SRC 3 Vc Harm[7] % Source 3 phase C voltage seventh harmonic
8271 SRC 3 Vc Harm[8] % Source 3 phase C voltage eighth harmonic
8272 SRC 3 Vc Harm[9] % Source 3 phase C voltage ninth harmonic
8273 SRC 3 Vc Harm[10] % Source 3 phase C voltage tenth harmonic
8274 SRC 3 Vc Harm[11] % Source 3 phase C voltage eleventh harmonic
8275 SRC 3 Vc Harm[12] % Source 3 phase C voltage twelfth harmonic
8276 SRC 3 Vc Harm[13] % Source 3 phase C voltage thirteenth harmonic
8277 SRC 3 Vc Harm[14] % Source 3 phase C voltage fourteenth harmonic
8278 SRC 3 Vc Harm[15] % Source 3 phase C voltage fifteenth harmonic
8279 SRC 3 Vc Harm[16] % Source 3 phase C voltage sixteenth harmonic
8280 SRC 3 Vc Harm[17] % Source 3 phase C voltage seventeenth harmonic
8281 SRC 3 Vc Harm[18] % Source 3 phase C voltage eighteenth harmonic
8282 SRC 3 Vc Harm[19] % Source 3 phase C voltage nineteenth harmonic
8283 SRC 3 Vc Harm[20] % Source 3 phase C voltage twentieth harmonic
8284 SRC 3 Vc Harm[21] % Source 3 phase C voltage twenty-first harmonic
8285 SRC 3 Vc Harm[22] % Source 3 phase C voltage twenty-second harmonic
8286 SRC 3 Vc Harm[23] % Source 3 phase C voltage twenty-third harmonic
8287 SRC 3 Vc Harm[24] % Source 3 phase C voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8288 SRC 3 Vc Harm[25] % Source 3 phase C voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8289 SRC 4 Va THD % Source 4 phase A voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8290 SRC 4 Va Harm[2] % Source 4 phase A voltage second harmonic
8291 SRC 4 Va Harm[3] % Source 4 phase A voltage third harmonic
8292 SRC 4 Va Harm[4] % Source 4 phase A voltage fourth harmonic
8293 SRC 4 Va Harm[5] % Source 4 phase A voltage fifth harmonic
8294 SRC 4 Va Harm[6] % Source 4 phase A voltage sixth harmonic
8295 SRC 4 Va Harm[7] % Source 4 phase A voltage seventh harmonic
8296 SRC 4 Va Harm[8] % Source 4 phase A voltage eighth harmonic
8297 SRC 4 Va Harm[9] % Source 4 phase A voltage ninth harmonic
8298 SRC 4 Va Harm[10] % Source 4 phase A voltage tenth harmonic
8299 SRC 4 Va Harm[11] % Source 4 phase A voltage eleventh harmonic
8300 SRC 4 Va Harm[12] % Source 4 phase A voltage twelfth harmonic
8301 SRC 4 Va Harm[13] % Source 4 phase A voltage thirteenth harmonic
8302 SRC 4 Va Harm[14] % Source 4 phase A voltage fourteenth harmonic
8303 SRC 4 Va Harm[15] % Source 4 phase A voltage fifteenth harmonic
8304 SRC 4 Va Harm[16] % Source 4 phase A voltage sixteenth harmonic
8305 SRC 4 Va Harm[17] % Source 4 phase A voltage seventeenth harmonic
8306 SRC 4 Va Harm[18] % Source 4 phase A voltage eighteenth harmonic
8307 SRC 4 Va Harm[19] % Source 4 phase A voltage nineteenth harmonic
8308 SRC 4 Va Harm[20] % Source 4 phase A voltage twentieth harmonic
8309 SRC 4 Va Harm[21] % Source 4 phase A voltage twenty-first harmonic
8310 SRC 4 Va Harm[22] % Source 4 phase A voltage twenty-second harmonic
8311 SRC 4 Va Harm[23] % Source 4 phase A voltage twenty-third harmonic

A-16 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
8312 SRC 4 Va Harm[24] % Source 4 phase A voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8313 SRC 4 Va Harm[25] % Source 4 phase A voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8314 SRC 4 Vb THD % Source 4 phase B voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8315 SRC 4 Vb Harm[2] % Source 4 phase B voltage second harmonic
8316 SRC 4 Vb Harm[3] % Source 4 phase B voltage third harmonic
8317 SRC 4 Vb Harm[4] % Source 4 phase B voltage fourth harmonic
8318 SRC 4 Vb Harm[5] % Source 4 phase B voltage fifth harmonic
8319 SRC 4 Vb Harm[6] % Source 4 phase B voltage sixth harmonic
8320 SRC 4 Vb Harm[7] % Source 4 phase B voltage seventh harmonic
8321 SRC 4 Vb Harm[8] % Source 4 phase B voltage eighth harmonic
8322 SRC 4 Vb Harm[9] % Source 4 phase B voltage ninth harmonic
8323 SRC 4 Vb Harm[10] % Source 4 phase B voltage tenth harmonic
8324 SRC 4 Vb Harm[11] % Source 4 phase B voltage eleventh harmonic
8325 SRC 4 Vb Harm[12] % Source 4 phase B voltage twelfth harmonic
8326 SRC 4 Vb Harm[13] % Source 4 phase B voltage thirteenth harmonic
8327 SRC 4 Vb Harm[14] % Source 4 phase B voltage fourteenth harmonic
8328 SRC 4 Vb Harm[15] % Source 4 phase B voltage fifteenth harmonic
8329 SRC 4 Vb Harm[16] % Source 4 phase B voltage sixteenth harmonic
8330 SRC 4 Vb Harm[17] % Source 4 phase B voltage seventeenth harmonic
8331 SRC 4 Vb Harm[18] % Source 4 phase B voltage eighteenth harmonic
8332 SRC 4 Vb Harm[19] % Source 4 phase B voltage nineteenth harmonic
8333 SRC 4 Vb Harm[20] % Source 4 phase B voltage twentieth harmonic
8334 SRC 4 Vb Harm[21] % Source 4 phase B voltage twenty-first harmonic
8335 SRC 4 Vb Harm[22] % Source 4 phase B voltage twenty-second harmonic
8336 SRC 4 Vb Harm[23] % Source 4 phase B voltage twenty-third harmonic
8337 SRC 4 Vb Harm[24] % Source 4 phase B voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8338 SRC 4 Vb Harm[25] % Source 4 phase B voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8339 SRC 4 Vc THD % Source 4 phase C voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8340 SRC 4 Vc Harm[2] % Source 4 phase C voltage second harmonic
8341 SRC 4 Vc Harm[3] % Source 4 phase C voltage third harmonic
8342 SRC 4 Vc Harm[4] % Source 4 phase C voltage fourth harmonic
8343 SRC 4 Vc Harm[5] % Source 4 phase C voltage fifth harmonic
8344 SRC 4 Vc Harm[6] % Source 4 phase C voltage sixth harmonic
8345 SRC 4 Vc Harm[7] % Source 4 phase C voltage seventh harmonic
8346 SRC 4 Vc Harm[8] % Source 4 phase C voltage eighth harmonic
8347 SRC 4 Vc Harm[9] % Source 4 phase C voltage ninth harmonic
8348 SRC 4 Vc Harm[10] % Source 4 phase C voltage tenth harmonic
8349 SRC 4 Vc Harm[11] % Source 4 phase C voltage eleventh harmonic
8350 SRC 4 Vc Harm[12] % Source 4 phase C voltage twelfth harmonic
8351 SRC 4 Vc Harm[13] % Source 4 phase C voltage thirteenth harmonic
8352 SRC 4 Vc Harm[14] % Source 4 phase C voltage fourteenth harmonic
8353 SRC 4 Vc Harm[15] % Source 4 phase C voltage fifteenth harmonic
8354 SRC 4 Vc Harm[16] % Source 4 phase C voltage sixteenth harmonic
8355 SRC 4 Vc Harm[17] % Source 4 phase C voltage seventeenth harmonic
8356 SRC 4 Vc Harm[18] % Source 4 phase C voltage eighteenth harmonic
8357 SRC 4 Vc Harm[19] % Source 4 phase C voltage nineteenth harmonic
8358 SRC 4 Vc Harm[20] % Source 4 phase C voltage twentieth harmonic

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-17


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


8359 SRC 4 Vc Harm[21] % Source 4 phase C voltage twenty-first harmonic
A 8360 SRC 4 Vc Harm[22] % Source 4 phase C voltage twenty-second harmonic
8361 SRC 4 Vc Harm[23] % Source 4 phase C voltage twenty-third harmonic
8362 SRC 4 Vc Harm[24] % Source 4 phase C voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8363 SRC 4 Vc Harm[25] % Source 4 phase C voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8364 SRC 5 Va THD % Source 5 phase A voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8365 SRC 5 Va Harm[2] % Source 5 phase A voltage second harmonic
8366 SRC 5 Va Harm[3] % Source 5 phase A voltage third harmonic
8367 SRC 5 Va Harm[4] % Source 5 phase A voltage fourth harmonic
8368 SRC 5 Va Harm[5] % Source 5 phase A voltage fifth harmonic
8369 SRC 5 Va Harm[6] % Source 5 phase A voltage sixth harmonic
8370 SRC 5 Va Harm[7] % Source 5 phase A voltage seventh harmonic
8371 SRC 5 Va Harm[8] % Source 5 phase A voltage eighth harmonic
8372 SRC 5 Va Harm[9] % Source 5 phase A voltage ninth harmonic
8373 SRC 5 Va Harm[10] % Source 5 phase A voltage tenth harmonic
8374 SRC 5 Va Harm[11] % Source 5 phase A voltage eleventh harmonic
8375 SRC 5 Va Harm[12] % Source 5 phase A voltage twelfth harmonic
8376 SRC 5 Va Harm[13] % Source 5 phase A voltage thirteenth harmonic
8377 SRC 5 Va Harm[14] % Source 5 phase A voltage fourteenth harmonic
8378 SRC 5 Va Harm[15] % Source 5 phase A voltage fifteenth harmonic
8379 SRC 5 Va Harm[16] % Source 5 phase A voltage sixteenth harmonic
8380 SRC 5 Va Harm[17] % Source 5 phase A voltage seventeenth harmonic
8381 SRC 5 Va Harm[18] % Source 5 phase A voltage eighteenth harmonic
8382 SRC 5 Va Harm[19] % Source 5 phase A voltage nineteenth harmonic
8383 SRC 5 Va Harm[20] % Source 5 phase A voltage twentieth harmonic
8384 SRC 5 Va Harm[21] % Source 5 phase A voltage twenty-first harmonic
8385 SRC 5 Va Harm[22] % Source 5 phase A voltage twenty-second harmonic
8386 SRC 5 Va Harm[23] % Source 5 phase A voltage twenty-third harmonic
8387 SRC 5 Va Harm[24] % Source 5 phase A voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8388 SRC 5 Va Harm[25] % Source 5 phase A voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8389 SRC 5 Vb THD % Source 5 phase B voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8390 SRC 5 Vb Harm[2] % Source 5 phase B voltage second harmonic
8391 SRC 5 Vb Harm[3] % Source 5 phase B voltage third harmonic
8392 SRC 5 Vb Harm[4] % Source 5 phase B voltage fourth harmonic
8393 SRC 5 Vb Harm[5] % Source 5 phase B voltage fifth harmonic
8394 SRC 5 Vb Harm[6] % Source 5 phase B voltage sixth harmonic
8395 SRC 5 Vb Harm[7] % Source 5 phase B voltage seventh harmonic
8396 SRC 5 Vb Harm[8] % Source 5 phase B voltage eighth harmonic
8397 SRC 5 Vb Harm[9] % Source 5 phase B voltage ninth harmonic
8398 SRC 5 Vb Harm[10] % Source 5 phase B voltage tenth harmonic
8399 SRC 5 Vb Harm[11] % Source 5 phase B voltage eleventh harmonic
8400 SRC 5 Vb Harm[12] % Source 5 phase B voltage twelfth harmonic
8401 SRC 5 Vb Harm[13] % Source 5 phase B voltage thirteenth harmonic
8402 SRC 5 Vb Harm[14] % Source 5 phase B voltage fourteenth harmonic
8403 SRC 5 Vb Harm[15] % Source 5 phase B voltage fifteenth harmonic
8404 SRC 5 Vb Harm[16] % Source 5 phase B voltage sixteenth harmonic
8405 SRC 5 Vb Harm[17] % Source 5 phase B voltage seventeenth harmonic

A-18 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
8406 SRC 5 Vb Harm[18] % Source 5 phase B voltage eighteenth harmonic
8407 SRC 5 Vb Harm[19] % Source 5 phase B voltage nineteenth harmonic
8408 SRC 5 Vb Harm[20] % Source 5 phase B voltage twentieth harmonic
8409 SRC 5 Vb Harm[21] % Source 5 phase B voltage twenty-first harmonic
8410 SRC 5 Vb Harm[22] % Source 5 phase B voltage twenty-second harmonic
8411 SRC 5 Vb Harm[23] % Source 5 phase B voltage twenty-third harmonic
8412 SRC 5 Vb Harm[24] % Source 5 phase B voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8413 SRC 5 Vb Harm[25] % Source 5 phase B voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8414 SRC 5 Vc THD % Source 5 phase C voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8415 SRC 5 Vc Harm[2] % Source 5 phase C voltage second harmonic
8416 SRC 5 Vc Harm[3] % Source 5 phase C voltage third harmonic
8417 SRC 5 Vc Harm[4] % Source 5 phase C voltage fourth harmonic
8418 SRC 5 Vc Harm[5] % Source 5 phase C voltage fifth harmonic
8419 SRC 5 Vc Harm[6] % Source 5 phase C voltage sixth harmonic
8420 SRC 5 Vc Harm[7] % Source 5 phase C voltage seventh harmonic
8421 SRC 5 Vc Harm[8] % Source 5 phase C voltage eighth harmonic
8422 SRC 5 Vc Harm[9] % Source 5 phase C voltage ninth harmonic
8423 SRC 5 Vc Harm[10] % Source 5 phase C voltage tenth harmonic
8424 SRC 5 Vc Harm[11] % Source 5 phase C voltage eleventh harmonic
8425 SRC 5 Vc Harm[12] % Source 5 phase C voltage twelfth harmonic
8426 SRC 5 Vc Harm[13] % Source 5 phase C voltage thirteenth harmonic
8427 SRC 5 Vc Harm[14] % Source 5 phase C voltage fourteenth harmonic
8428 SRC 5 Vc Harm[15] % Source 5 phase C voltage fifteenth harmonic
8429 SRC 5 Vc Harm[16] % Source 5 phase C voltage sixteenth harmonic
8430 SRC 5 Vc Harm[17] % Source 5 phase C voltage seventeenth harmonic
8431 SRC 5 Vc Harm[18] % Source 5 phase C voltage eighteenth harmonic
8432 SRC 5 Vc Harm[19] % Source 5 phase C voltage nineteenth harmonic
8433 SRC 5 Vc Harm[20] % Source 5 phase C voltage twentieth harmonic
8434 SRC 5 Vc Harm[21] % Source 5 phase C voltage twenty-first harmonic
8435 SRC 5 Vc Harm[22] % Source 5 phase C voltage twenty-second harmonic
8436 SRC 5 Vc Harm[23] % Source 5 phase C voltage twenty-third harmonic
8437 SRC 5 Vc Harm[24] % Source 5 phase C voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8438 SRC 5 Vc Harm[25] % Source 5 phase C voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8439 SRC 6 Va THD % Source 6 phase A voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8440 SRC 6 Va Harm[2] % Source 6 phase A voltage second harmonic
8441 SRC 6 Va Harm[3] % Source 6 phase A voltage third harmonic
8442 SRC 6 Va Harm[4] % Source 6 phase A voltage fourth harmonic
8443 SRC 6 Va Harm[5] % Source 6 phase A voltage fifth harmonic
8444 SRC 6 Va Harm[6] % Source 6 phase A voltage sixth harmonic
8445 SRC 6 Va Harm[7] % Source 6 phase A voltage seventh harmonic
8446 SRC 6 Va Harm[8] % Source 6 phase A voltage eighth harmonic
8447 SRC 6 Va Harm[9] % Source 6 phase A voltage ninth harmonic
8448 SRC 6 Va Harm[10] % Source 6 phase A voltage tenth harmonic
8449 SRC 6 Va Harm[11] % Source 6 phase A voltage eleventh harmonic
8450 SRC 6 Va Harm[12] % Source 6 phase A voltage twelfth harmonic
8451 SRC 6 Va Harm[13] % Source 6 phase A voltage thirteenth harmonic
8452 SRC 6 Va Harm[14] % Source 6 phase A voltage fourteenth harmonic

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-19


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


8453 SRC 6 Va Harm[15] % Source 6 phase A voltage fifteenth harmonic
A 8454 SRC 6 Va Harm[16] % Source 6 phase A voltage sixteenth harmonic
8455 SRC 6 Va Harm[17] % Source 6 phase A voltage seventeenth harmonic
8456 SRC 6 Va Harm[18] % Source 6 phase A voltage eighteenth harmonic
8457 SRC 6 Va Harm[19] % Source 6 phase A voltage nineteenth harmonic
8458 SRC 6 Va Harm[20] % Source 6 phase A voltage twentieth harmonic
8459 SRC 6 Va Harm[21] % Source 6 phase A voltage twenty-first harmonic
8460 SRC 6 Va Harm[22] % Source 6 phase A voltage twenty-second harmonic
8461 SRC 6 Va Harm[23] % Source 6 phase A voltage twenty-third harmonic
8462 SRC 6 Va Harm[24] % Source 6 phase A voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8463 SRC 6 Va Harm[25] % Source 6 phase A voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8464 SRC 6 Vb THD % Source 6 phase B voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8465 SRC 6 Vb Harm[2] % Source 6 phase B voltage second harmonic
8466 SRC 6 Vb Harm[3] % Source 6 phase B voltage third harmonic
8467 SRC 6 Vb Harm[4] % Source 6 phase B voltage fourth harmonic
8468 SRC 6 Vb Harm[5] % Source 6 phase B voltage fifth harmonic
8469 SRC 6 Vb Harm[6] % Source 6 phase B voltage sixth harmonic
8470 SRC 6 Vb Harm[7] % Source 6 phase B voltage seventh harmonic
8471 SRC 6 Vb Harm[8] % Source 6 phase B voltage eighth harmonic
8472 SRC 6 Vb Harm[9] % Source 6 phase B voltage ninth harmonic
8473 SRC 6 Vb Harm[10] % Source 6 phase B voltage tenth harmonic
8474 SRC 6 Vb Harm[11] % Source 6 phase B voltage eleventh harmonic
8475 SRC 6 Vb Harm[12] % Source 6 phase B voltage twelfth harmonic
8476 SRC 6 Vb Harm[13] % Source 6 phase B voltage thirteenth harmonic
8477 SRC 6 Vb Harm[14] % Source 6 phase B voltage fourteenth harmonic
8478 SRC 6 Vb Harm[15] % Source 6 phase B voltage fifteenth harmonic
8479 SRC 6 Vb Harm[16] % Source 6 phase B voltage sixteenth harmonic
8480 SRC 6 Vb Harm[17] % Source 6 phase B voltage seventeenth harmonic
8481 SRC 6 Vb Harm[18] % Source 6 phase B voltage eighteenth harmonic
8482 SRC 6 Vb Harm[19] % Source 6 phase B voltage nineteenth harmonic
8483 SRC 6 Vb Harm[20] % Source 6 phase B voltage twentieth harmonic
8484 SRC 6 Vb Harm[21] % Source 6 phase B voltage twenty-first harmonic
8485 SRC 6 Vb Harm[22] % Source 6 phase B voltage twenty-second harmonic
8486 SRC 6 Vb Harm[23] % Source 6 phase B voltage twenty-third harmonic
8487 SRC 6 Vb Harm[24] % Source 6 phase B voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8488 SRC 6 Vb Harm[25] % Source 6 phase B voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8489 SRC 6 Vc THD % Source 6 phase C voltage total harmonic distortion (THD)
8490 SRC 6 Vc Harm[2] % Source 6 phase C voltage second harmonic
8491 SRC 6 Vc Harm[3] % Source 6 phase C voltage third harmonic
8492 SRC 6 Vc Harm[4] % Source 6 phase C voltage fourth harmonic
8493 SRC 6 Vc Harm[5] % Source 6 phase C voltage fifth harmonic
8494 SRC 6 Vc Harm[6] % Source 6 phase C voltage sixth harmonic
8495 SRC 6 Vc Harm[7] % Source 6 phase C voltage seventh harmonic
8496 SRC 6 Vc Harm[8] % Source 6 phase C voltage eighth harmonic
8497 SRC 6 Vc Harm[9] % Source 6 phase C voltage ninth harmonic
8498 SRC 6 Vc Harm[10] % Source 6 phase C voltage tenth harmonic
8499 SRC 6 Vc Harm[11] % Source 6 phase C voltage eleventh harmonic

A-20 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
8500 SRC 6 Vc Harm[12] % Source 6 phase C voltage twelfth harmonic
8501 SRC 6 Vc Harm[13] % Source 6 phase C voltage thirteenth harmonic
8502 SRC 6 Vc Harm[14] % Source 6 phase C voltage fourteenth harmonic
8503 SRC 6 Vc Harm[15] % Source 6 phase C voltage fifteenth harmonic
8504 SRC 6 Vc Harm[16] % Source 6 phase C voltage sixteenth harmonic
8505 SRC 6 Vc Harm[17] % Source 6 phase C voltage seventeenth harmonic
8506 SRC 6 Vc Harm[18] % Source 6 phase C voltage eighteenth harmonic
8507 SRC 6 Vc Harm[19] % Source 6 phase C voltage nineteenth harmonic
8508 SRC 6 Vc Harm[20] % Source 6 phase C voltage twentieth harmonic
8509 SRC 6 Vc Harm[21] % Source 6 phase C voltage twenty-first harmonic
8510 SRC 6 Vc Harm[22] % Source 6 phase C voltage twenty-second harmonic
8511 SRC 6 Vc Harm[23] % Source 6 phase C voltage twenty-third harmonic
8512 SRC 6 Vc Harm[24] % Source 6 phase C voltage twenty-fourth harmonic
8513 SRC 6 Vc Harm[25] % Source 6 phase C voltage twenty-fifth harmonic
8692 Brk 3 Arc Amp A kA2-cyc Breaker 3 arcing amp phase A
8694 Brk 3 Arc Amp B kA2-cyc Breaker 3 arcing amp phase B
8696 Brk 3 Arc Amp C kA2-cyc Breaker 3 arcing amp phase C
8698 Brk 3 Op Time A ms Breaker 3 operating time phase A
8699 Brk 3 Op Time B ms Breaker 3 operating time phase B
8700 Brk 3 Op Time C ms Breaker 3 operating time phase C
8701 Brk 3 Op Time ms Breaker 3 operating time
8702 Brk 4 Arc Amp A kA2-cyc Breaker 4 arcing amp phase A
8704 Brk 4 Arc Amp B kA2-cyc Breaker 4 arcing amp phase B
8706 Brk 4 Arc Amp C kA2-cyc Breaker 4 arcing amp phase C
8708 Brk 4 Op Time A ms Breaker 4 operating time phase A
8709 Brk 4 Op Time B ms Breaker 4 operating time phase B
8710 Brk 4 Op Time C ms Breaker 4 operating time phase C
8711 Brk 4 Op Time ms Breaker 4 operating time
9024 Prefault Ia Mag [1] Amps Fault 1 pre-fault phase A current magnitude
9026 Prefault Ia Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 pre-fault phase A current angle
9027 Prefault Ib Mag [1] Amps Fault 1 pre-fault phase B current magnitude
9029 Prefault Ib Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 pre-fault phase B current angle
9030 Prefault Ic Mag [1] Amps Fault 1 pre-fault phase C current magnitude
9032 Prefault Ic Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 pre-fault phase C current angle
9033 Prefault Va Mag [1] Volts Fault 1 pre-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9035 Prefault Va Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 pre-fault phase A voltage angle
9036 Prefault Vb Mag [1] Volts Fault 1 pre-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9038 Prefault Vb Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 pre-fault phase B voltage angle
9039 Prefault Vc Mag [1] Volts Fault 1 pre-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9041 Prefault Vc Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 pre-fault phase C voltage angle
9042 Fault Ia Mag [1] Amps Fault 1 post-fault phase A current magnitude
9044 Fault Ia Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 post-fault phase A current angle
9045 Fault Ib Mag [1] Amps Fault 1 post-fault phase B current magnitude
9047 Fault Ib Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 post-fault phase B current angle
9048 Fault Ic Mag [1 Amps Fault 1 post-fault phase C current magnitude
9050 Fault Ic Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 post-fault phase C current angle
9051 Fault Va Mag [1] Volts Fault 1 post-fault phase A voltage magnitude

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-21


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


9053 Fault Va Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 post-fault phase A voltage angle
A 9054 Fault Vb Mag [1] Volts Fault 1 post-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9056 Fault Vb Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 post-fault phase B voltage angle
9057 Fault Vc Mag [1] Volts Fault 1 post-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9059 Fault Vc Ang [1] Degrees Fault 1 post-fault phase C voltage angle
9060 Fault Type [1] --- Fault 1 type
9061 Fault Location [1] --- Fault 1 location
9062 Prefault Ia Mag [2] Amps Fault 2 pre-fault phase A current magnitude
9064 Prefault Ia Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 pre-fault phase A current angle
9065 Prefault Ib Mag [2] Amps Fault 2 pre-fault phase B current magnitude
9067 Prefault Ib Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 pre-fault phase B current angle
9068 Prefault Ic Mag [2] Amps Fault 2 pre-fault phase C current magnitude
9070 Prefault Ic Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 pre-fault phase C current angle
9071 Prefault Va Mag [2] Volts Fault 2 pre-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9073 Prefault Va Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 pre-fault phase A voltage angle
9074 Prefault Vb Mag [2] Volts Fault 2 pre-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9076 Prefault Vb Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 pre-fault phase B voltage angle
9077 Prefault Vc Mag [2] Volts Fault 2 pre-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9079 Prefault Vc Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 pre-fault phase C voltage angle
9080 Fault Ia Mag [2] Amps Fault 2 post-fault phase A current magnitude
9082 Fault Ia Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 post-fault phase A current angle
9083 Fault Ib Mag [2] Amps Fault 2 post-fault phase B current magnitude
9085 Fault Ib Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 post-fault phase B current angle
9086 Fault Ic Mag [2] Amps Fault 2 post-fault phase C current magnitude
9088 Fault Ic Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 post-fault phase C current angle
9089 Fault Va Mag [2] Volts Fault 2 post-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9091 Fault Va Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 post-fault phase A voltage angle
9092 Fault Vb Mag [2] Volts Fault 2 post-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9094 Fault Vb Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 post-fault phase B voltage angle
9095 Fault Vc Mag [2] Volts Fault 2 post-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9097 Fault Vc Ang [2] Degrees Fault 2 post-fault phase C voltage angle
9098 Fault Type [2] --- Fault 2 type
9099 Fault Location [2] --- Fault 2 location
9100 Prefault Ia Mag [3] Amps Fault 3 pre-fault phase A current magnitude
9102 Prefault Ia Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 pre-fault phase A current angle
9103 Prefault Ib Mag [3] Amps Fault 3 pre-fault phase B current magnitude
9105 Prefault Ib Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 pre-fault phase B current angle
9106 Prefault Ic Mag [3] Amps Fault 3 pre-fault phase C current magnitude
9108 Prefault Ic Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 pre-fault phase C current angle
9109 Prefault Va Mag [3] Volts Fault 3 pre-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9111 Prefault Va Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 pre-fault phase A voltage angle
9112 Prefault Vb Mag [3] Volts Fault 3 pre-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9114 Prefault Vb Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 pre-fault phase B voltage angle
9115 Prefault Vc Mag [3] Volts Fault 3 pre-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9117 Prefault Vc Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 pre-fault phase C voltage angle
9118 Fault Ia Mag [3] Amps Fault 3 post-fault phase A current magnitude
9120 Fault Ia Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 post-fault phase A current angle

A-22 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
9121 Fault Ib Mag [3] Amps Fault 3 post-fault phase B current magnitude
9123 Fault Ib Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 post-fault phase B current angle
9124 Fault Ic Mag [3] Amps Fault 3 post-fault phase C current magnitude
9126 Fault Ic Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 post-fault phase C current angle
9127 Fault Va Mag [3] Volts Fault 3 post-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9129 Fault Va Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 post-fault phase A voltage angle
9130 Fault Vb Mag [3] Volts Fault 3 post-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9132 Fault Vb Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 post-fault phase B voltage angle
9133 Fault Vc Mag [3] Volts Fault 3 post-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9135 Fault Vc Ang [3] Degrees Fault 3 post-fault phase C voltage angle
9136 Fault Type [3] --- Fault 3 type
9137 Fault Location [3] --- Fault 3 location
9138 Prefault Ia Mag [4] Amps Fault 4 pre-fault phase A current magnitude
9140 Prefault Ia Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 pre-fault phase A current angle
9141 Prefault Ib Mag [4] Amps Fault 4 pre-fault phase B current magnitude
9143 Prefault Ib Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 pre-fault phase B current angle
9144 Prefault Ic Mag [4] Amps Fault 4 pre-fault phase C current magnitude
9146 Prefault Ic Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 pre-fault phase C current angle
9147 Prefault Va Mag [4] Volts Fault 4 pre-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9149 Prefault Va Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 pre-fault phase A voltage angle
9150 Prefault Vb Mag [4] Volts Fault 4 pre-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9152 Prefault Vb Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 pre-fault phase B voltage angle
9153 Prefault Vc Mag [4] Volts Fault 4 pre-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9155 Prefault Vc Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 pre-fault phase C voltage angle
9156 Fault Ia Mag [4] Amps Fault 4 post-fault phase A current magnitude
9158 Fault Ia Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 post-fault phase A current angle
9159 Fault Ib Mag [4] Amps Fault 4 post-fault phase B current magnitude
9161 Fault Ib Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 post-fault phase B current angle
9162 Fault Ic Mag [4] Amps Fault 4 post-fault phase C current magnitude
9164 Fault Ic Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 post-fault phase C current angle
9165 Fault Va Mag [4] Volts Fault 4 post-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9167 Fault Va Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 post-fault phase A voltage angle
9168 Fault Vb Mag [4] Volts Fault 4 post-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9170 Fault Vb Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 post-fault phase B voltage angle
9171 Fault Vc Mag [4] Volts Fault 4 post-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9173 Fault Vc Ang [4] Degrees Fault 4 post-fault phase C voltage angle
9174 Fault Type [4] --- Fault 4 type
9175 Fault Location [4] --- Fault 4 location
9176 Prefault Ia Mag [5] Amps Fault 5 pre-fault phase A current magnitude
9178 Prefault Ia Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 pre-fault phase A current angle
9179 Prefault Ib Mag [5] Amps Fault 5 pre-fault phase B current magnitude
9181 Prefault Ib Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 pre-fault phase B current angle
9182 Prefault Ic Mag [5] Amps Fault 5 pre-fault phase C current magnitude
9184 Prefault Ic Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 pre-fault phase C current angle
9185 Prefault Va Mag [5] Volts Fault 5 pre-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9187 Prefault Va Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 pre-fault phase A voltage angle
9188 Prefault Vb Mag [5] Volts Fault 5 pre-fault phase B voltage magnitude

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-23


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


9190 Prefault Vb Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 pre-fault phase B voltage angle
A 9191 Prefault Vc Mag [5] Volts Fault 5 pre-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9193 Prefault Vc Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 pre-fault phase C voltage angle
9194 Fault Ia Mag [5] Amps Fault 5 post-fault phase A current magnitude
9196 Fault Ia Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 post-fault phase A current angle
9197 Fault Ib Mag [5] Amps Fault 5 post-fault phase B current magnitude
9199 Fault Ib Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 post-fault phase B current angle
9200 Fault Ic Mag [5] Amps Fault 5 post-fault phase C current magnitude
9202 Fault Ic Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 post-fault phase C current angle
9203 Fault Va Mag [5] Volts Fault 5 post-fault phase A voltage magnitude
9205 Fault Va Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 post-fault phase A voltage angle
9206 Fault Vb Mag [5] Volts Fault 5 post-fault phase B voltage magnitude
9208 Fault Vb Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 post-fault phase B voltage angle
9209 Fault Vc Mag [5] Volts Fault 5 post-fault phase C voltage magnitude
9211 Fault Vc Ang [5] Degrees Fault 5 post-fault phase C voltage angle
9212 Fault Type [5] --- Fault 5 type
9213 Fault Location [5] --- Fault 5 location
10240 SRC 1 Ia THD % Source 1 phase A current total harmonic distortion
10241 SRC 1 Ia Harm[2] % Source 1 phase A current second harmonic
10242 SRC 1 Ia Harm[3] % Source 1 phase A current third harmonic
10243 SRC 1 Ia Harm[4] % Source 1 phase A current fourth harmonic
10244 SRC 1 Ia Harm[5] % Source 1 phase A current fifth harmonic
10245 SRC 1 Ia Harm[6] % Source 1 phase A current sixth harmonic
10246 SRC 1 Ia Harm[7] % Source 1 phase A current seventh harmonic
10247 SRC 1 Ia Harm[8] % Source 1 phase A current eighth harmonic
10248 SRC 1 Ia Harm[9] % Source 1 phase A current ninth harmonic
10249 SRC 1 Ia Harm[10] % Source 1 phase A current tenth harmonic
10250 SRC 1 Ia Harm[11] % Source 1 phase A current eleventh harmonic
10251 SRC 1 Ia Harm[12] % Source 1 phase A current twelfth harmonic
10252 SRC 1 Ia Harm[13] % Source 1 phase A current thirteenth harmonic
10253 SRC 1 Ia Harm[14] % Source 1 phase A current fourteenth harmonic
10254 SRC 1 Ia Harm[15] % Source 1 phase A current fifteenth harmonic
10255 SRC 1 Ia Harm[16] % Source 1 phase A current sixteenth harmonic
10256 SRC 1 Ia Harm[17] % Source 1 phase A current seventeenth harmonic
10257 SRC 1 Ia Harm[18] % Source 1 phase A current eighteenth harmonic
10258 SRC 1 Ia Harm[19] % Source 1 phase A current nineteenth harmonic
10259 SRC 1 Ia Harm[20] % Source 1 phase A current twentieth harmonic
10260 SRC 1 Ia Harm[21] % Source 1 phase A current twenty-first harmonic
10261 SRC 1 Ia Harm[22] % Source 1 phase A current twenty-second harmonic
10262 SRC 1 Ia Harm[23] % Source 1 phase A current twenty-third harmonic
10263 SRC 1 Ia Harm[24] % Source 1 phase A current twenty-fourth harmonic
10264 SRC 1 Ia Harm[25] % Source 1 phase A current twenty-fifth harmonic
10273 SRC 1 Ib THD % Source 1 phase B current total harmonic distortion
10274 SRC 1 Ib Harm[2] % Source 1 phase B current second harmonic
10275 SRC 1 Ib Harm[3] % Source 1 phase B current third harmonic
10276 SRC 1 Ib Harm[4] % Source 1 phase B current fourth harmonic
10277 SRC 1 Ib Harm[5] % Source 1 phase B current fifth harmonic

A-24 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
10278 SRC 1 Ib Harm[6] % Source 1 phase B current sixth harmonic
10279 SRC 1 Ib Harm[7] % Source 1 phase B current seventh harmonic
10280 SRC 1 Ib Harm[8] % Source 1 phase B current eighth harmonic
10281 SRC 1 Ib Harm[9] % Source 1 phase B current ninth harmonic
10282 SRC 1 Ib Harm[10] % Source 1 phase B current tenth harmonic
10283 SRC 1 Ib Harm[11] % Source 1 phase B current eleventh harmonic
10284 SRC 1 Ib Harm[12] % Source 1 phase B current twelfth harmonic
10285 SRC 1 Ib Harm[13] % Source 1 phase B current thirteenth harmonic
10286 SRC 1 Ib Harm[14] % Source 1 phase B current fourteenth harmonic
10287 SRC 1 Ib Harm[15] % Source 1 phase B current fifteenth harmonic
10288 SRC 1 Ib Harm[16] % Source 1 phase B current sixteenth harmonic
10289 SRC 1 Ib Harm[17] % Source 1 phase B current seventeenth harmonic
10290 SRC 1 Ib Harm[18] % Source 1 phase B current eighteenth harmonic
10291 SRC 1 Ib Harm[19] % Source 1 phase B current nineteenth harmonic
10292 SRC 1 Ib Harm[20] % Source 1 phase B current twentieth harmonic
10293 SRC 1 Ib Harm[21] % Source 1 phase B current twenty-first harmonic
10294 SRC 1 Ib Harm[22] % Source 1 phase B current twenty-second harmonic
10295 SRC 1 Ib Harm[23] % Source 1 phase B current twenty-third harmonic
10296 SRC 1 Ib Harm[24] % Source 1 phase B current twenty-fourth harmonic
10297 SRC 1 Ib Harm[25] % Source 1 phase B current twenty-fifth harmonic
10306 SRC 1 Ic THD % Source 1 phase C current total harmonic distortion
10307 SRC 1 Ic Harm[2] % Source 1 phase C current second harmonic
10308 SRC 1 Ic Harm[3] % Source 1 phase C current third harmonic
10309 SRC 1 Ic Harm[4] % Source 1 phase C current fourth harmonic
10310 SRC 1 Ic Harm[5] % Source 1 phase C current fifth harmonic
10311 SRC 1 Ic Harm[6] % Source 1 phase C current sixth harmonic
10312 SRC 1 Ic Harm[7] % Source 1 phase C current seventh harmonic
10313 SRC 1 Ic Harm[8] % Source 1 phase C current eighth harmonic
10314 SRC 1 Ic Harm[9] % Source 1 phase C current ninth harmonic
10315 SRC 1 Ic Harm[10] % Source 1 phase C current tenth harmonic
10316 SRC 1 Ic Harm[11] % Source 1 phase C current eleventh harmonic
10317 SRC 1 Ic Harm[12] % Source 1 phase C current twelfth harmonic
10318 SRC 1 Ic Harm[13] % Source 1 phase C current thirteenth harmonic
10319 SRC 1 Ic Harm[14] % Source 1 phase C current fourteenth harmonic
10320 SRC 1 Ic Harm[15] % Source 1 phase C current fifteenth harmonic
10321 SRC 1 Ic Harm[16] % Source 1 phase C current sixteenth harmonic
10322 SRC 1 Ic Harm[17] % Source 1 phase C current seventeenth harmonic
10323 SRC 1 Ic Harm[18] % Source 1 phase C current eighteenth harmonic
10324 SRC 1 Ic Harm[19] % Source 1 phase C current nineteenth harmonic
10325 SRC 1 Ic Harm[20] % Source 1 phase C current twentieth harmonic
10326 SRC 1 Ic Harm[21] % Source 1 phase C current twenty-first harmonic
10327 SRC 1 Ic Harm[22] % Source 1 phase C current twenty-second harmonic
10328 SRC 1 Ic Harm[23] % Source 1 phase C current twenty-third harmonic
10329 SRC 1 Ic Harm[24] % Source 1 phase C current twenty-fourth harmonic
10330 SRC 1 Ic Harm[25] % Source 1 phase C current twenty-fifth harmonic
10339 SRC 2 Ia THD % Source 2 phase A current total harmonic distortion
10340 SRC 2 Ia Harm[2] % Source 2 phase A current second harmonic

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-25


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


10341 SRC 2 Ia Harm[3] % Source 2 phase A current third harmonic
A 10342 SRC 2 Ia Harm[4] % Source 2 phase A current fourth harmonic
10343 SRC 2 Ia Harm[5] % Source 2 phase A current fifth harmonic
10344 SRC 2 Ia Harm[6] % Source 2 phase A current sixth harmonic
10345 SRC 2 Ia Harm[7] % Source 2 phase A current seventh harmonic
10346 SRC 2 Ia Harm[8] % Source 2 phase A current eighth harmonic
10347 SRC 2 Ia Harm[9] % Source 2 phase A current ninth harmonic
10348 SRC 2 Ia Harm[10] % Source 2 phase A current tenth harmonic
10349 SRC 2 Ia Harm[11] % Source 2 phase A current eleventh harmonic
10350 SRC 2 Ia Harm[12] % Source 2 phase A current twelfth harmonic
10351 SRC 2 Ia Harm[13] % Source 2 phase A current thirteenth harmonic
10352 SRC 2 Ia Harm[14] % Source 2 phase A current fourteenth harmonic
10353 SRC 2 Ia Harm[15] % Source 2 phase A current fifteenth harmonic
10354 SRC 2 Ia Harm[16] % Source 2 phase A current sixteenth harmonic
10355 SRC 2 Ia Harm[17] % Source 2 phase A current seventeenth harmonic
10356 SRC 2 Ia Harm[18] % Source 2 phase A current eighteenth harmonic
10357 SRC 2 Ia Harm[19] % Source 2 phase A current nineteenth harmonic
10358 SRC 2 Ia Harm[20] % Source 2 phase A current twentieth harmonic
10359 SRC 2 Ia Harm[21] % Source 2 phase A current twenty-first harmonic
10360 SRC 2 Ia Harm[22] % Source 2 phase A current twenty-second harmonic
10361 SRC 2 Ia Harm[23] % Source 2 phase A current twenty-third harmonic
10362 SRC 2 Ia Harm[24] % Source 2 phase A current twenty-fourth harmonic
10363 SRC 2 Ia Harm[25] % Source 2 phase A current twenty-fifth harmonic
10372 SRC 2 Ib THD % Source 2 phase B current total harmonic distortion
10373 SRC 2 Ib Harm[2] % Source 2 phase B current second harmonic
10374 SRC 2 Ib Harm[3] % Source 2 phase B current third harmonic
10375 SRC 2 Ib Harm[4] % Source 2 phase B current fourth harmonic
10376 SRC 2 Ib Harm[5] % Source 2 phase B current fifth harmonic
10377 SRC 2 Ib Harm[6] % Source 2 phase B current sixth harmonic
10378 SRC 2 Ib Harm[7] % Source 2 phase B current seventh harmonic
10379 SRC 2 Ib Harm[8] % Source 2 phase B current eighth harmonic
10380 SRC 2 Ib Harm[9] % Source 2 phase B current ninth harmonic
10381 SRC 2 Ib Harm[10] % Source 2 phase B current tenth harmonic
10382 SRC 2 Ib Harm[11] % Source 2 phase B current eleventh harmonic
10383 SRC 2 Ib Harm[12] % Source 2 phase B current twelfth harmonic
10384 SRC 2 Ib Harm[13] % Source 2 phase B current thirteenth harmonic
10385 SRC 2 Ib Harm[14] % Source 2 phase B current fourteenth harmonic
10386 SRC 2 Ib Harm[15] % Source 2 phase B current fifteenth harmonic
10387 SRC 2 Ib Harm[16] % Source 2 phase B current sixteenth harmonic
10388 SRC 2 Ib Harm[17] % Source 2 phase B current seventeenth harmonic
10389 SRC 2 Ib Harm[18] % Source 2 phase B current eighteenth harmonic
10390 SRC 2 Ib Harm[19] % Source 2 phase B current nineteenth harmonic
10391 SRC 2 Ib Harm[20] % Source 2 phase B current twentieth harmonic
10392 SRC 2 Ib Harm[21] % Source 2 phase B current twenty-first harmonic
10393 SRC 2 Ib Harm[22] % Source 2 phase B current twenty-second harmonic
10394 SRC 2 Ib Harm[23] % Source 2 phase B current twenty-third harmonic
10395 SRC 2 Ib Harm[24] % Source 2 phase B current twenty-fourth harmonic

A-26 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
10396 SRC 2 Ib Harm[25] % Source 2 phase B current twenty-fifth harmonic
10405 SRC 2 Ic THD % Source 2 phase C current total harmonic distortion
10406 SRC 2 Ic Harm[2] % Source 2 phase C current second harmonic
10407 SRC 2 Ic Harm[3] % Source 2 phase C current third harmonic
10408 SRC 2 Ic Harm[4] % Source 2 phase C current fourth harmonic
10409 SRC 2 Ic Harm[5] % Source 2 phase C current fifth harmonic
10410 SRC 2 Ic Harm[6] % Source 2 phase C current sixth harmonic
10411 SRC 2 Ic Harm[7] % Source 2 phase C current seventh harmonic
10412 SRC 2 Ic Harm[8] % Source 2 phase C current eighth harmonic
10413 SRC 2 Ic Harm[9] % Source 2 phase C current ninth harmonic
10414 SRC 2 Ic Harm[10] % Source 2 phase C current tenth harmonic
10415 SRC 2 Ic Harm[11] % Source 2 phase C current eleventh harmonic
10416 SRC 2 Ic Harm[12] % Source 2 phase C current twelfth harmonic
10417 SRC 2 Ic Harm[13] % Source 2 phase C current thirteenth harmonic
10418 SRC 2 Ic Harm[14] % Source 2 phase C current fourteenth harmonic
10419 SRC 2 Ic Harm[15] % Source 2 phase C current fifteenth harmonic
10420 SRC 2 Ic Harm[16] % Source 2 phase C current sixteenth harmonic
10421 SRC 2 Ic Harm[17] % Source 2 phase C current seventeenth harmonic
10422 SRC 2 Ic Harm[18] % Source 2 phase C current eighteenth harmonic
10423 SRC 2 Ic Harm[19] % Source 2 phase C current nineteenth harmonic
10424 SRC 2 Ic Harm[20] % Source 2 phase C current twentieth harmonic
10425 SRC 2 Ic Harm[21] % Source 2 phase C current twenty-first harmonic
10426 SRC 2 Ic Harm[22] % Source 2 phase C current twenty-second harmonic
10427 SRC 2 Ic Harm[23] % Source 2 phase C current twenty-third harmonic
10428 SRC 2 Ic Harm[24] % Source 2 phase C current twenty-fourth harmonic
10429 SRC 2 Ic Harm[25] % Source 2 phase C current twenty-fifth harmonic
10438 SRC 3 Ia THD % Source 3 phase A current total harmonic distortion
10439 SRC 3 Ia Harm[2] % Source 3 phase A current second harmonic
10440 SRC 3 Ia Harm[3] % Source 3 phase A current third harmonic
10441 SRC 3 Ia Harm[4] % Source 3 phase A current fourth harmonic
10442 SRC 3 Ia Harm[5] % Source 3 phase A current fifth harmonic
10443 SRC 3 Ia Harm[6] % Source 3 phase A current sixth harmonic
10444 SRC 3 Ia Harm[7] % Source 3 phase A current seventh harmonic
10445 SRC 3 Ia Harm[8] % Source 3 phase A current eighth harmonic
10446 SRC 3 Ia Harm[9] % Source 3 phase A current ninth harmonic
10447 SRC 3 Ia Harm[10] % Source 3 phase A current tenth harmonic
10448 SRC 3 Ia Harm[11] % Source 3 phase A current eleventh harmonic
10449 SRC 3 Ia Harm[12] % Source 3 phase A current twelfth harmonic
10450 SRC 3 Ia Harm[13] % Source 3 phase A current thirteenth harmonic
10451 SRC 3 Ia Harm[14] % Source 3 phase A current fourteenth harmonic
10452 SRC 3 Ia Harm[15] % Source 3 phase A current fifteenth harmonic
10453 SRC 3 Ia Harm[16] % Source 3 phase A current sixteenth harmonic
10454 SRC 3 Ia Harm[17] % Source 3 phase A current seventeenth harmonic
10455 SRC 3 Ia Harm[18] % Source 3 phase A current eighteenth harmonic
10456 SRC 3 Ia Harm[19] % Source 3 phase A current nineteenth harmonic
10457 SRC 3 Ia Harm[20] % Source 3 phase A current twentieth harmonic
10458 SRC 3 Ia Harm[21] % Source 3 phase A current twenty-first harmonic

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-27


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


10459 SRC 3 Ia Harm[22] % Source 3 phase A current twenty-second harmonic
A 10460 SRC 3 Ia Harm[23] % Source 3 phase A current twenty-third harmonic
10461 SRC 3 Ia Harm[24] % Source 3 phase A current twenty-fourth harmonic
10462 SRC 3 Ia Harm[25] % Source 3 phase A current twenty-fifth harmonic
10471 SRC 3 Ib THD % Source 3 phase B current total harmonic distortion
10472 SRC 3 Ib Harm[2] % Source 3 phase B current second harmonic
10473 SRC 3 Ib Harm[3] % Source 3 phase B current third harmonic
10474 SRC 3 Ib Harm[4] % Source 3 phase B current fourth harmonic
10475 SRC 3 Ib Harm[5] % Source 3 phase B current fifth harmonic
10476 SRC 3 Ib Harm[6] % Source 3 phase B current sixth harmonic
10477 SRC 3 Ib Harm[7] % Source 3 phase B current seventh harmonic
10478 SRC 3 Ib Harm[8] % Source 3 phase B current eighth harmonic
10479 SRC 3 Ib Harm[9] % Source 3 phase B current ninth harmonic
10480 SRC 3 Ib Harm[10] % Source 3 phase B current tenth harmonic
10481 SRC 3 Ib Harm[11] % Source 3 phase B current eleventh harmonic
10482 SRC 3 Ib Harm[12] % Source 3 phase B current twelfth harmonic
10483 SRC 3 Ib Harm[13] % Source 3 phase B current thirteenth harmonic
10484 SRC 3 Ib Harm[14] % Source 3 phase B current fourteenth harmonic
10485 SRC 3 Ib Harm[15] % Source 3 phase B current fifteenth harmonic
10486 SRC 3 Ib Harm[16] % Source 3 phase B current sixteenth harmonic
10487 SRC 3 Ib Harm[17] % Source 3 phase B current seventeenth harmonic
10488 SRC 3 Ib Harm[18] % Source 3 phase B current eighteenth harmonic
10489 SRC 3 Ib Harm[19] % Source 3 phase B current nineteenth harmonic
10490 SRC 3 Ib Harm[20] % Source 3 phase B current twentieth harmonic
10491 SRC 3 Ib Harm[21] % Source 3 phase B current twenty-first harmonic
10492 SRC 3 Ib Harm[22] % Source 3 phase B current twenty-second harmonic
10493 SRC 3 Ib Harm[23] % Source 3 phase B current twenty-third harmonic
10494 SRC 3 Ib Harm[24] % Source 3 phase B current twenty-fourth harmonic
10495 SRC 3 Ib Harm[25] % Source 3 phase B current twenty-fifth harmonic
10504 SRC 3 Ic THD % Source 3 phase C current total harmonic distortion
10505 SRC 3 Ic Harm[2] % Source 3 phase C current second harmonic
10506 SRC 3 Ic Harm[3] % Source 3 phase C current third harmonic
10507 SRC 3 Ic Harm[4] % Source 3 phase C current fourth harmonic
10508 SRC 3 Ic Harm[5] % Source 3 phase C current fifth harmonic
10509 SRC 3 Ic Harm[6] % Source 3 phase C current sixth harmonic
10510 SRC 3 Ic Harm[7] % Source 3 phase C current seventh harmonic
10511 SRC 3 Ic Harm[8] % Source 3 phase C current eighth harmonic
10512 SRC 3 Ic Harm[9] % Source 3 phase C current ninth harmonic
10513 SRC 3 Ic Harm[10] % Source 3 phase C current tenth harmonic
10514 SRC 3 Ic Harm[11] % Source 3 phase C current eleventh harmonic
10515 SRC 3 Ic Harm[12] % Source 3 phase C current twelfth harmonic
10516 SRC 3 Ic Harm[13] % Source 3 phase C current thirteenth harmonic
10517 SRC 3 Ic Harm[14] % Source 3 phase C current fourteenth harmonic
10518 SRC 3 Ic Harm[15] % Source 3 phase C current fifteenth harmonic
10519 SRC 3 Ic Harm[16] % Source 3 phase C current sixteenth harmonic
10520 SRC 3 Ic Harm[17] % Source 3 phase C current seventeenth harmonic
10521 SRC 3 Ic Harm[18] % Source 3 phase C current eighteenth harmonic

A-28 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
10522 SRC 3 Ic Harm[19] % Source 3 phase C current nineteenth harmonic
10523 SRC 3 Ic Harm[20] % Source 3 phase C current twentieth harmonic
10524 SRC 3 Ic Harm[21] % Source 3 phase C current twenty-first harmonic
10525 SRC 3 Ic Harm[22] % Source 3 phase C current twenty-second harmonic
10526 SRC 3 Ic Harm[23] % Source 3 phase C current twenty-third harmonic
10527 SRC 3 Ic Harm[24] % Source 3 phase C current twenty-fourth harmonic
10528 SRC 3 Ic Harm[25] % Source 3 phase C current twenty-fifth harmonic
10537 SRC 4 Ia THD % Source 4 phase A current total harmonic distortion
10538 SRC 4 Ia Harm[2] % Source 4 phase A current second harmonic
10539 SRC 4 Ia Harm[3] % Source 4 phase A current third harmonic
10540 SRC 4 Ia Harm[4] % Source 4 phase A current fourth harmonic
10541 SRC 4 Ia Harm[5] % Source 4 phase A current fifth harmonic
10542 SRC 4 Ia Harm[6] % Source 4 phase A current sixth harmonic
10543 SRC 4 Ia Harm[7] % Source 4 phase A current seventh harmonic
10544 SRC 4 Ia Harm[8] % Source 4 phase A current eighth harmonic
10545 SRC 4 Ia Harm[9] % Source 4 phase A current ninth harmonic
10546 SRC 4 Ia Harm[10] % Source 4 phase A current tenth harmonic
10547 SRC 4 Ia Harm[11] % Source 4 phase A current eleventh harmonic
10548 SRC 4 Ia Harm[12] % Source 4 phase A current twelfth harmonic
10549 SRC 4 Ia Harm[13] % Source 4 phase A current thirteenth harmonic
10550 SRC 4 Ia Harm[14] % Source 4 phase A current fourteenth harmonic
10551 SRC 4 Ia Harm[15] % Source 4 phase A current fifteenth harmonic
10552 SRC 4 Ia Harm[16] % Source 4 phase A current sixteenth harmonic
10553 SRC 4 Ia Harm[17] % Source 4 phase A current seventeenth harmonic
10554 SRC 4 Ia Harm[18] % Source 4 phase A current eighteenth harmonic
10555 SRC 4 Ia Harm[19] % Source 4 phase A current nineteenth harmonic
10556 SRC 4 Ia Harm[20] % Source 4 phase A current twentieth harmonic
10557 SRC 4 Ia Harm[21] % Source 4 phase A current twenty-first harmonic
10558 SRC 4 Ia Harm[22] % Source 4 phase A current twenty-second harmonic
10559 SRC 4 Ia Harm[23] % Source 4 phase A current twenty-third harmonic
10560 SRC 4 Ia Harm[24] % Source 4 phase A current twenty-fourth harmonic
10561 SRC 4 Ia Harm[25] % Source 4 phase A current twenty-fifth harmonic
10570 SRC 4 Ib THD % Source 4 phase B current total harmonic distortion
10571 SRC 4 Ib Harm[2] % Source 4 phase B current second harmonic
10572 SRC 4 Ib Harm[3] % Source 4 phase B current third harmonic
10573 SRC 4 Ib Harm[4] % Source 4 phase B current fourth harmonic
10574 SRC 4 Ib Harm[5] % Source 4 phase B current fifth harmonic
10575 SRC 4 Ib Harm[6] % Source 4 phase B current sixth harmonic
10576 SRC 4 Ib Harm[7] % Source 4 phase B current seventh harmonic
10577 SRC 4 Ib Harm[8] % Source 4 phase B current eighth harmonic
10578 SRC 4 Ib Harm[9] % Source 4 phase B current ninth harmonic
10579 SRC 4 Ib Harm[10] % Source 4 phase B current tenth harmonic
10580 SRC 4 Ib Harm[11] % Source 4 phase B current eleventh harmonic
10581 SRC 4 Ib Harm[12] % Source 4 phase B current twelfth harmonic
10582 SRC 4 Ib Harm[13] % Source 4 phase B current thirteenth harmonic
10583 SRC 4 Ib Harm[14] % Source 4 phase B current fourteenth harmonic
10584 SRC 4 Ib Harm[15] % Source 4 phase B current fifteenth harmonic

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-29


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


10585 SRC 4 Ib Harm[16] % Source 4 phase B current sixteenth harmonic
A 10586 SRC 4 Ib Harm[17] % Source 4 phase B current seventeenth harmonic
10587 SRC 4 Ib Harm[18] % Source 4 phase B current eighteenth harmonic
10588 SRC 4 Ib Harm[19] % Source 4 phase B current nineteenth harmonic
10589 SRC 4 Ib Harm[20] % Source 4 phase B current twentieth harmonic
10590 SRC 4 Ib Harm[21] % Source 4 phase B current twenty-first harmonic
10591 SRC 4 Ib Harm[22] % Source 4 phase B current twenty-second harmonic
10592 SRC 4 Ib Harm[23] % Source 4 phase B current twenty-third harmonic
10593 SRC 4 Ib Harm[24] % Source 4 phase B current twenty-fourth harmonic
10594 SRC 4 Ib Harm[25] % Source 4 phase B current twenty-fifth harmonic
10603 SRC 4 Ic THD % Source 4 phase C current total harmonic distortion
10604 SRC 4 Ic Harm[2] % Source 4 phase C current second harmonic
10605 SRC 4 Ic Harm[3] % Source 4 phase C current third harmonic
10606 SRC 4 Ic Harm[4] % Source 4 phase C current fourth harmonic
10607 SRC 4 Ic Harm[5] % Source 4 phase C current fifth harmonic
10608 SRC 4 Ic Harm[6] % Source 4 phase C current sixth harmonic
10609 SRC 4 Ic Harm[7] % Source 4 phase C current seventh harmonic
10610 SRC 4 Ic Harm[8] % Source 4 phase C current eighth harmonic
10611 SRC 4 Ic Harm[9] % Source 4 phase C current ninth harmonic
10612 SRC 4 Ic Harm[10] % Source 4 phase C current tenth harmonic
10613 SRC 4 Ic Harm[11] % Source 4 phase C current eleventh harmonic
10614 SRC 4 Ic Harm[12] % Source 4 phase C current twelfth harmonic
10615 SRC 4 Ic Harm[13] % Source 4 phase C current thirteenth harmonic
10616 SRC 4 Ic Harm[14] % Source 4 phase C current fourteenth harmonic
10617 SRC 4 Ic Harm[15] % Source 4 phase C current fifteenth harmonic
10618 SRC 4 Ic Harm[16] % Source 4 phase C current sixteenth harmonic
10619 SRC 4 Ic Harm[17] % Source 4 phase C current seventeenth harmonic
10620 SRC 4 Ic Harm[18] % Source 4 phase C current eighteenth harmonic
10621 SRC 4 Ic Harm[19] % Source 4 phase C current nineteenth harmonic
10622 SRC 4 Ic Harm[20] % Source 4 phase C current twentieth harmonic
10623 SRC 4 Ic Harm[21] % Source 4 phase C current twenty-first harmonic
10624 SRC 4 Ic Harm[22] % Source 4 phase C current twenty-second harmonic
10625 SRC 4 Ic Harm[23] % Source 4 phase C current twenty-third harmonic
10626 SRC 4 Ic Harm[24] % Source 4 phase C current twenty-fourth harmonic
10627 SRC 4 Ic Harm[25] % Source 4 phase C current twenty-fifth harmonic
10636 SRC 5 Ia THD % Source 5 phase A current total harmonic distortion
10637 SRC 5 Ia Harm[2] % Source 5 phase A current second harmonic
10638 SRC 5 Ia Harm[3] % Source 5 phase A current third harmonic
10639 SRC 5 Ia Harm[4] % Source 5 phase A current fourth harmonic
10640 SRC 5 Ia Harm[5] % Source 5 phase A current fifth harmonic
10641 SRC 5 Ia Harm[6] % Source 5 phase A current sixth harmonic
10642 SRC 5 Ia Harm[7] % Source 5 phase A current seventh harmonic
10643 SRC 5 Ia Harm[8] % Source 5 phase A current eighth harmonic
10644 SRC 5 Ia Harm[9] % Source 5 phase A current ninth harmonic
10645 SRC 5 Ia Harm[10] % Source 5 phase A current tenth harmonic
10646 SRC 5 Ia Harm[11] % Source 5 phase A current eleventh harmonic
10647 SRC 5 Ia Harm[12] % Source 5 phase A current twelfth harmonic

A-30 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
10648 SRC 5 Ia Harm[13] % Source 5 phase A current thirteenth harmonic
10649 SRC 5 Ia Harm[14] % Source 5 phase A current fourteenth harmonic
10650 SRC 5 Ia Harm[15] % Source 5 phase A current fifteenth harmonic
10651 SRC 5 Ia Harm[16] % Source 5 phase A current sixteenth harmonic
10652 SRC 5 Ia Harm[17] % Source 5 phase A current seventeenth harmonic
10653 SRC 5 Ia Harm[18] % Source 5 phase A current eighteenth harmonic
10654 SRC 5 Ia Harm[19] % Source 5 phase A current nineteenth harmonic
10655 SRC 5 Ia Harm[20] % Source 5 phase A current twentieth harmonic
10656 SRC 5 Ia Harm[21] % Source 5 phase A current twenty-first harmonic
10657 SRC 5 Ia Harm[22] % Source 5 phase A current twenty-second harmonic
10658 SRC 5 Ia Harm[23] % Source 5 phase A current twenty-third harmonic
10659 SRC 5 Ia Harm[24] % Source 5 phase A current twenty-fourth harmonic
10660 SRC 5 Ia Harm[25] % Source 5 phase A current twenty-fifth harmonic
10669 SRC 5 Ib THD % Source 5 phase B current total harmonic distortion
10670 SRC 5 Ib Harm[2] % Source 5 phase B current second harmonic
10671 SRC 5 Ib Harm[3] % Source 5 phase B current third harmonic
10672 SRC 5 Ib Harm[4] % Source 5 phase B current fourth harmonic
10673 SRC 5 Ib Harm[5] % Source 5 phase B current fifth harmonic
10674 SRC 5 Ib Harm[6] % Source 5 phase B current sixth harmonic
10675 SRC 5 Ib Harm[7] % Source 5 phase B current seventh harmonic
10676 SRC 5 Ib Harm[8] % Source 5 phase B current eighth harmonic
10677 SRC 5 Ib Harm[9] % Source 5 phase B current ninth harmonic
10678 SRC 5 Ib Harm[10] % Source 5 phase B current tenth harmonic
10679 SRC 5 Ib Harm[11] % Source 5 phase B current eleventh harmonic
10680 SRC 5 Ib Harm[12] % Source 5 phase B current twelfth harmonic
10681 SRC 5 Ib Harm[13] % Source 5 phase B current thirteenth harmonic
10682 SRC 5 Ib Harm[14] % Source 5 phase B current fourteenth harmonic
10683 SRC 5 Ib Harm[15] % Source 5 phase B current fifteenth harmonic
10684 SRC 5 Ib Harm[16] % Source 5 phase B current sixteenth harmonic
10685 SRC 5 Ib Harm[17] % Source 5 phase B current seventeenth harmonic
10686 SRC 5 Ib Harm[18] % Source 5 phase B current eighteenth harmonic
10687 SRC 5 Ib Harm[19] % Source 5 phase B current nineteenth harmonic
10688 SRC 5 Ib Harm[20] % Source 5 phase B current twentieth harmonic
10689 SRC 5 Ib Harm[21] % Source 5 phase B current twenty-first harmonic
10690 SRC 5 Ib Harm[22] % Source 5 phase B current twenty-second harmonic
10691 SRC 5 Ib Harm[23] % Source 5 phase B current twenty-third harmonic
10692 SRC 5 Ib Harm[24] % Source 5 phase B current twenty-fourth harmonic
10693 SRC 5 Ib Harm[25] % Source 5 phase B current twenty-fifth harmonic
10702 SRC 5 Ic THD % Source 5 phase C current total harmonic distortion
10703 SRC 5 Ic Harm[2] % Source 5 phase C current second harmonic
10704 SRC 5 Ic Harm[3] % Source 5 phase C current third harmonic
10705 SRC 5 Ic Harm[4] % Source 5 phase C current fourth harmonic
10706 SRC 5 Ic Harm[5] % Source 5 phase C current fifth harmonic
10707 SRC 5 Ic Harm[6] % Source 5 phase C current sixth harmonic
10708 SRC 5 Ic Harm[7] % Source 5 phase C current seventh harmonic
10709 SRC 5 Ic Harm[8] % Source 5 phase C current eighth harmonic
10710 SRC 5 Ic Harm[9] % Source 5 phase C current ninth harmonic

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-31


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


10711 SRC 5 Ic Harm[10] % Source 5 phase C current tenth harmonic
A 10712 SRC 5 Ic Harm[11] % Source 5 phase C current eleventh harmonic
10713 SRC 5 Ic Harm[12] % Source 5 phase C current twelfth harmonic
10714 SRC 5 Ic Harm[13] % Source 5 phase C current thirteenth harmonic
10715 SRC 5 Ic Harm[14] % Source 5 phase C current fourteenth harmonic
10716 SRC 5 Ic Harm[15] % Source 5 phase C current fifteenth harmonic
10717 SRC 5 Ic Harm[16] % Source 5 phase C current sixteenth harmonic
10718 SRC 5 Ic Harm[17] % Source 5 phase C current seventeenth harmonic
10719 SRC 5 Ic Harm[18] % Source 5 phase C current eighteenth harmonic
10720 SRC 5 Ic Harm[19] % Source 5 phase C current nineteenth harmonic
10721 SRC 5 Ic Harm[20] % Source 5 phase C current twentieth harmonic
10722 SRC 5 Ic Harm[21] % Source 5 phase C current twenty-first harmonic
10723 SRC 5 Ic Harm[22] % Source 5 phase C current twenty-second harmonic
10724 SRC 5 Ic Harm[23] % Source 5 phase C current twenty-third harmonic
10725 SRC 5 Ic Harm[24] % Source 5 phase C current twenty-fourth harmonic
10726 SRC 5 Ic Harm[25] % Source 5 phase C current twenty-fifth harmonic
10735 SRC 6 Ia THD % Source 6 phase A current total harmonic distortion
10736 SRC 6 Ia Harm[2] % Source 6 phase A current second harmonic
10737 SRC 6 Ia Harm[3] % Source 6 phase A current third harmonic
10738 SRC 6 Ia Harm[4] % Source 6 phase A current fourth harmonic
10739 SRC 6 Ia Harm[5] % Source 6 phase A current fifth harmonic
10740 SRC 6 Ia Harm[6] % Source 6 phase A current sixth harmonic
10741 SRC 6 Ia Harm[7] % Source 6 phase A current seventh harmonic
10742 SRC 6 Ia Harm[8] % Source 6 phase A current eighth harmonic
10743 SRC 6 Ia Harm[9] % Source 6 phase A current ninth harmonic
10744 SRC 6 Ia Harm[10] % Source 6 phase A current tenth harmonic
10745 SRC 6 Ia Harm[11] % Source 6 phase A current eleventh harmonic
10746 SRC 6 Ia Harm[12] % Source 6 phase A current twelfth harmonic
10747 SRC 6 Ia Harm[13] % Source 6 phase A current thirteenth harmonic
10748 SRC 6 Ia Harm[14] % Source 6 phase A current fourteenth harmonic
10749 SRC 6 Ia Harm[15] % Source 6 phase A current fifteenth harmonic
10750 SRC 6 Ia Harm[16] % Source 6 phase A current sixteenth harmonic
10751 SRC 6 Ia Harm[17] % Source 6 phase A current seventeenth harmonic
10752 SRC 6 Ia Harm[18] % Source 6 phase A current eighteenth harmonic
10753 SRC 6 Ia Harm[19] % Source 6 phase A current nineteenth harmonic
10754 SRC 6 Ia Harm[20] % Source 6 phase A current twentieth harmonic
10755 SRC 6 Ia Harm[21] % Source 6 phase A current twenty-first harmonic
10756 SRC 6 Ia Harm[22] % Source 6 phase A current twenty-second harmonic
10757 SRC 6 Ia Harm[23] % Source 6 phase A current twenty-third harmonic
10758 SRC 6 Ia Harm[24] % Source 6 phase A current twenty-fourth harmonic
10759 SRC 6 Ia Harm[25] % Source 6 phase A current twenty-fifth harmonic
10768 SRC 6 Ib THD % Source 6 phase B current total harmonic distortion
10769 SRC 6 Ib Harm[2] % Source 6 phase B current second harmonic
10770 SRC 6 Ib Harm[3] % Source 6 phase B current third harmonic
10771 SRC 6 Ib Harm[4] % Source 6 phase B current fourth harmonic
10772 SRC 6 Ib Harm[5] % Source 6 phase B current fifth harmonic
10773 SRC 6 Ib Harm[6] % Source 6 phase B current sixth harmonic

A-32 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
10774 SRC 6 Ib Harm[7] % Source 6 phase B current seventh harmonic
10775 SRC 6 Ib Harm[8] % Source 6 phase B current eighth harmonic
10776 SRC 6 Ib Harm[9] % Source 6 phase B current ninth harmonic
10777 SRC 6 Ib Harm[10] % Source 6 phase B current tenth harmonic
10778 SRC 6 Ib Harm[11] % Source 6 phase B current eleventh harmonic
10779 SRC 6 Ib Harm[12] % Source 6 phase B current twelfth harmonic
10780 SRC 6 Ib Harm[13] % Source 6 phase B current thirteenth harmonic
10781 SRC 6 Ib Harm[14] % Source 6 phase B current fourteenth harmonic
10782 SRC 6 Ib Harm[15] % Source 6 phase B current fifteenth harmonic
10783 SRC 6 Ib Harm[16] % Source 6 phase B current sixteenth harmonic
10784 SRC 6 Ib Harm[17] % Source 6 phase B current seventeenth harmonic
10785 SRC 6 Ib Harm[18] % Source 6 phase B current eighteenth harmonic
10786 SRC 6 Ib Harm[19] % Source 6 phase B current nineteenth harmonic
10787 SRC 6 Ib Harm[20] % Source 6 phase B current twentieth harmonic
10788 SRC 6 Ib Harm[21] % Source 6 phase B current twenty-first harmonic
10789 SRC 6 Ib Harm[22] % Source 6 phase B current twenty-second harmonic
10790 SRC 6 Ib Harm[23] % Source 6 phase B current twenty-third harmonic
10791 SRC 6 Ib Harm[24] % Source 6 phase B current twenty-fourth harmonic
10792 SRC 6 Ib Harm[25] % Source 6 phase B current twenty-fifth harmonic
10801 SRC 6 Ic THD % Source 6 phase C current total harmonic distortion
10802 SRC 6 Ic Harm[2] % Source 6 phase C current second harmonic
10803 SRC 6 Ic Harm[3] % Source 6 phase C current third harmonic
10804 SRC 6 Ic Harm[4] % Source 6 phase C current fourth harmonic
10805 SRC 6 Ic Harm[5] % Source 6 phase C current fifth harmonic
10806 SRC 6 Ic Harm[6] % Source 6 phase C current sixth harmonic
10807 SRC 6 Ic Harm[7] % Source 6 phase C current seventh harmonic
10808 SRC 6 Ic Harm[8] % Source 6 phase C current eighth harmonic
10809 SRC 6 Ic Harm[9] % Source 6 phase C current ninth harmonic
10810 SRC 6 Ic Harm[10] % Source 6 phase C current tenth harmonic
10811 SRC 6 Ic Harm[11] % Source 6 phase C current eleventh harmonic
10812 SRC 6 Ic Harm[12] % Source 6 phase C current twelfth harmonic
10813 SRC 6 Ic Harm[13] % Source 6 phase C current thirteenth harmonic
10814 SRC 6 Ic Harm[14] % Source 6 phase C current fourteenth harmonic
10815 SRC 6 Ic Harm[15] % Source 6 phase C current fifteenth harmonic
10816 SRC 6 Ic Harm[16] % Source 6 phase C current sixteenth harmonic
10817 SRC 6 Ic Harm[17] % Source 6 phase C current seventeenth harmonic
10818 SRC 6 Ic Harm[18] % Source 6 phase C current eighteenth harmonic
10819 SRC 6 Ic Harm[19] % Source 6 phase C current nineteenth harmonic
10820 SRC 6 Ic Harm[20] % Source 6 phase C current twentieth harmonic
10821 SRC 6 Ic Harm[21] % Source 6 phase C current twenty-first harmonic
10822 SRC 6 Ic Harm[22] % Source 6 phase C current twenty-second harmonic
10823 SRC 6 Ic Harm[23] % Source 6 phase C current twenty-third harmonic
10824 SRC 6 Ic Harm[24] % Source 6 phase C current twenty-fourth harmonic
10825 SRC 6 Ic Harm[25] % Source 6 phase C current twenty-fifth harmonic
12032 Brk 1 Acc Arc Amp A kA2-cyc Breaker 1 Acc arcing amp phase A
12034 Brk 1 Acc Arc Amp B kA2-cyc Breaker 1 Acc arcing amp phase B
12036 Brk 1 Acc Arc Amp C kA2-cyc Breaker 1 Acc arcing amp phase C

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-33


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


12038 Brk 1 Op Time A ms Breaker 1 operating time phase A
A 12039 Brk 1 Op Time B ms Breaker 1 operating time phase B
12040 Brk 1 Op Time C ms Breaker 1 operating time phase C
12041 Brk 1 Op Time ms Breaker 1 operating time
12042 Brk 1 Arc Amp A kA2-cyc Breaker 1 arcing amp phase A
12044 Brk 1 Arc Amp B kA2-cyc Breaker 1 arcing amp phase B
12046 Brk 1 Arc Amp C kA2-cyc Breaker 1 arcing amp phase C
12048 Brk 1 Amp Max A kA2-cyc Breaker 1 amp max phase A
12050 Brk 1 Amp Max B kA2-cyc Breaker 1 amp max phase B
12052 Brk 1 Amp Max C kA2-cyc Breaker 1 amp max phase C
12054 Brk 2 Acc Arc Amp A kA2-cyc Breaker 2 Acc arcing amp phase A
12056 Brk 2 Acc Arc Amp B kA2-cyc Breaker 2 Acc arcing amp phase B
12058 Brk 2 Acc Arc Amp C kA2-cyc Breaker 2 Acc arcing amp phase C
12060 Brk 2 Op Time A ms Breaker 2 operating time phase A
12061 Brk 2 Op Time B ms Breaker 2 operating time phase B
12062 Brk 2 Op Time C ms Breaker 2 operating time phase C
12063 Brk 2 Op Time ms Breaker 2 operating time
12064 Brk 2 Arc Amp A kA2-cyc Breaker 2 arcing amp phase A
12066 Brk 2 Arc Amp B kA2-cyc Breaker 2 arcing amp phase B
12068 Brk 2 Arc Amp C kA2-cyc Breaker 2 arcing amp phase C
12070 Brk 2 Amp Max A kA2-cyc Breaker 2 amp max phase A
12072 Brk 2 Amp Max B kA2-cyc Breaker 2 amp max phase B
12074 Brk 2 Amp Max C kA2-cyc Breaker 2 amp max phase C
12306 Oscill Num Triggers --- Oscillography number of triggers
13504 DCmA Ip 1 mA DCmA input 1 actual value
13506 DCmA Ip 2 mA DCmA input 2 actual value
13508 DCmA Ip 3 mA DCmA input 3 actual value
13510 DCmA Ip 4 mA DCmA input 4 actual value
13512 DCmA Ip 5 mA DCmA input 5 actual value
13514 DCmA Ip 6 mA DCmA input 6 actual value
13516 DCmA Ip 7 mA DCmA input 7 actual value
13518 DCmA Ip 8 mA DCmA input 8 actual value
13520 DCmA Ip 9 mA DCmA input 9 actual value
13522 DCmA Ip 10 mA DCmA input 10 actual value
13524 DCmA Ip 11 mA DCmA input 11 actual value
13526 DCmA Ip 12 mA DCmA input 12 actual value
13528 DCmA Ip 13 mA DCmA input 13 actual value
13530 DCmA Ip 14 mA DCmA input 14 actual value
13532 DCmA Ip 15 mA DCmA input 15 actual value
13534 DCmA Ip 16 mA DCmA input 16 actual value
13536 DCmA Ip 17 mA DCmA input 17 actual value
13538 DCmA Ip 18 mA DCmA input 18 actual value
13540 DCmA Ip 19 mA DCmA input 19 actual value
13542 DCmA Ip 20 mA DCmA input 20 actual value
13544 DCmA Ip 21 mA DCmA input 21 actual value
13546 DCmA Ip 22 mA DCmA input 22 actual value
13548 DCmA Ip 23 mA DCmA input 23 actual value

A-34 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
13550 DCmA Ip 24 mA DCmA input 24 actual value
13552 RTD Ip 1 --- RTD input 1 actual value
13553 RTD Ip 2 --- RTD input 2 actual value
13554 RTD Ip 3 --- RTD input 3 actual value
13555 RTD Ip 4 --- RTD input 4 actual value
13556 RTD Ip 5 --- RTD input 5 actual value
13557 RTD Ip 6 --- RTD input 6 actual value
13558 RTD Ip 7 --- RTD input 7 actual value
13559 RTD Ip 8 --- RTD input 8 actual value
13560 RTD Ip 9 --- RTD input 9 actual value
13561 RTD Ip 10 --- RTD input 10 actual value
13562 RTD Ip 11 --- RTD input 11 actual value
13563 RTD Ip 12 --- RTD input 12 actual value
13564 RTD Ip 13 --- RTD input 13 actual value
13565 RTD Ip 14 --- RTD input 14 actual value
13566 RTD Ip 15 --- RTD input 15 actual value
13567 RTD Ip 16 --- RTD input 16 actual value
13568 RTD Ip 17 --- RTD input 17 actual value
13569 RTD Ip 18 --- RTD input 18 actual value
13570 RTD Ip 19 --- RTD input 19 actual value
13571 RTD Ip 20 --- RTD input 20 actual value
13572 RTD Ip 21 --- RTD input 21 actual value
13573 RTD Ip 22 --- RTD input 22 actual value
13574 RTD Ip 23 --- RTD input 23 actual value
13575 RTD Ip 24 --- RTD input 24 actual value
13576 RTD Ip 25 --- RTD input 25 actual value
13577 RTD Ip 26 --- RTD input 26 actual value
13578 RTD Ip 27 --- RTD input 27 actual value
13579 RTD Ip 28 --- RTD input 28 actual value
13580 RTD Ip 29 --- RTD input 29 actual value
13581 RTD Ip 30 --- RTD input 30 actual value
13582 RTD Ip 31 --- RTD input 31 actual value
13583 RTD Ip 32 --- RTD input 32 actual value
13584 RTD Ip 33 --- RTD input 33 actual value
13585 RTD Ip 34 --- RTD input 34 actual value
13586 RTD Ip 35 --- RTD input 35 actual value
13587 RTD Ip 36 --- RTD input 36 actual value
13588 RTD Ip 37 --- RTD input 37 actual value
13589 RTD Ip 38 --- RTD input 38 actual value
13590 RTD Ip 39 --- RTD input 39 actual value
13591 RTD Ip 40 --- RTD input 40 actual value
13592 RTD Ip 41 --- RTD input 41 actual value
13593 RTD Ip 42 --- RTD input 42 actual value
13594 RTD Ip 43 --- RTD input 43 actual value
13595 RTD Ip 44 --- RTD input 44 actual value
13596 RTD Ip 45 --- RTD input 45 actual value
13597 RTD Ip 46 --- RTD input 46 actual value

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-35


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description


13598 RTD Ip 47 --- RTD input 47 actual value
A 13599 RTD Ip 48 --- RTD input 48 actual value
13600 Ohm Inputs 1 Value Ohms Ohm inputs 1 value
13601 Ohm Inputs 2 Value Ohms Ohm inputs 2 value
14189 PTP–IRIG-B Delta ns PTP time minus IRIG-B time
24432 Communications Group --- Groups communications group
24447 Active Setting Group --- Current setting group
32768 Tracking Frequency Hz Terminal tracking frequency
39168 FlexElement 1 Value --- FlexElement 1 actual value
39170 FlexElement 2 Value --- FlexElement 2 actual value
39172 FlexElement 3 Value --- FlexElement 3 actual value
39174 FlexElement 4 Value --- FlexElement 4 actual value
39176 FlexElement 5 Value --- FlexElement 5 actual value
39178 FlexElement 6 Value --- FlexElement 6 actual value
39180 FlexElement 7 Value --- FlexElement 7 actual value
39182 FlexElement 8 Value --- FlexElement 8 actual value
39184 FlexElement 9 Value --- FlexElement 9 actual value
39186 FlexElement 10 Value --- FlexElement 10 actual value
39188 FlexElement 11 Value --- FlexElement 11 actual value
39190 FlexElement 12 Value --- FlexElement 12 actual value
39192 FlexElement 13 Value --- FlexElement 13 actual value
39194 FlexElement 14 Value --- FlexElement 14 actual value
39196 FlexElement 15 Value --- FlexElement 15 actual value
39198 FlexElement 16 Value --- FlexElement 16 actual value
41138 V0 3rd Harmonic 1 Volts VTFF 1 V0 3rd Harmonic
41140 V0 3rd Harmonic 2 Volts VTFF 2 V0 3rd Harmonic
41142 V0 3rd Harmonic 3 Volts VTFF 3 V0 3rd Harmonic
41144 V0 3rd Harmonic 4 Volts VTFF 4 V0 3rd Harmonic
41146 V0 3rd Harmonic 5 Volts VTFF 5 V0 3rd Harmonic
41148 V0 3rd Harmonic 6 Volts VTFF 6 V0 3rd Harmonic
42336 PID 1 Out --- PID 1 out
42338 PID 1 Delta Out --- PID 1 delta out
42340 PID 1 Setpoint --- PID 1 setpoint
42342 PID 2 Out --- PID 2 out
42344 PID 2 Delta Out --- PID 2 delta out
42346 PID 2 Setpoint --- PID 2 setpoint
42348 PID 3 Out --- PID 3 out
42350 PID 3 Delta Out --- PID 3 delta out
42352 PID 3 Setpoint --- PID 3 setpoint
42354 PID 4 Out --- PID 4 out
42356 PID 4 Delta Out --- PID 4 delta out
42358 PID 4 Setpoint --- PID 4 setpoint
45584 RxGOOSE Analog 1 --- RxGOOSE analog input 1
45586 RxGOOSE Analog 2 --- RxGOOSE analog input 2
45588 RxGOOSE Analog 3 --- RxGOOSE analog input 3
45590 RxGOOSE Analog 4 --- RxGOOSE analog input 4
45592 RxGOOSE Analog 5 --- RxGOOSE analog input 5

A-36 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS FLEXANALOG ITEMS

Address FlexAnalog name Units Description

A
45594 RxGOOSE Analog 6 --- RxGOOSE analog input 6
45596 RxGOOSE Analog 7 --- RxGOOSE analog input 7
45598 RxGOOSE Analog 8 --- RxGOOSE analog input 8
45600 RxGOOSE Analog 9 --- RxGOOSE analog input 9
45602 RxGOOSE Analog 10 --- RxGOOSE analog input 10
45604 RxGOOSE Analog 11 --- RxGOOSE analog input 11
45606 RxGOOSE Analog 12 --- RxGOOSE analog input 12
45608 RxGOOSE Analog 13 --- RxGOOSE analog input 13
45610 RxGOOSE Analog 14 --- RxGOOSE analog input 14
45612 RxGOOSE Analog 15 --- RxGOOSE analog input 15
45614 RxGOOSE Analog 16 --- RxGOOSE analog input 16
45616 RxGOOSE Analog 17 --- RxGOOSE analog input 17
45618 RxGOOSE Analog 18 --- RxGOOSE analog input 18
45620 RxGOOSE Analog 19 --- RxGOOSE analog input 19
45622 RxGOOSE Analog 20 --- RxGOOSE analog input 20
45624 RxGOOSE Analog 21 --- RxGOOSE analog input 21
45626 RxGOOSE Analog 22 --- RxGOOSE analog input 22
45628 RxGOOSE Analog 23 --- RxGOOSE analog input 23
45630 RxGOOSE Analog 24 --- RxGOOSE analog input 24
45632 RxGOOSE Analog 25 --- RxGOOSE analog input 25
45634 RxGOOSE Analog 26 --- RxGOOSE analog input 26
45636 RxGOOSE Analog 27 --- RxGOOSE analog input 27
45638 RxGOOSE Analog 28 --- RxGOOSE analog input 28
45640 RxGOOSE Analog 29 --- RxGOOSE analog input 29
45642 RxGOOSE Analog 30 --- RxGOOSE analog input 30
45644 RxGOOSE Analog 31 --- RxGOOSE analog input 31
45646 RxGOOSE Analog 32 --- RxGOOSE analog input 32

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL A-37


FLEXANALOG ITEMS APPENDIX A: FLEXANALOG OPERANDS

A-38 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Appendix B: RADIUS server configuration

RADIUS server configuration

This appendix outlines how to set up a RADIUS server for user authentication.

B.1 RADIUS server configuration


The following procedure is an example of how to set up a simple RADIUS server. You install the RADIUS server software on
a separate computer. In this example, we use FreeRADIUS third-party software.
1. Download and install FreeRADIUS from www.freeradius.net as the RADIUS server. This is a Windows 32-bit installation
that is known to work. If you try another third-party tool and it does not work, use the FreeRADIUS software from
freeradius.net.
2. Open the radius.conf file in the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, locate the "bind_address" field, and enter your
RADIUS server IP address. An example is
bind_address = 10.14.61.109
Text editor software that supports direct editing and saving of UNIX text encodings and line breaks, such as EditPad
Lite, is needed for this editing.
3. In the users.conf file in the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, add the following text to configure a user "Tester" with
an Administrator role.
Tester User-Password == "testpw"
GE-PDC-USER-Role = Administrator,
4. In the clients.conf file in the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, add the following text to define the UR as a RADIUS
client, where the client IP address is 10.0.0.2, the subnet mask is 255.255.255.0, the shared secret specified here is also
configured on the UR device for successful authentication, and the shortname is a short, optional alias that can be
used in place of the IP address.
client 10.0.0.2/24 {
secret = testing123
shortname = private-network-1
}
5. In the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, create a file called dictionary.ge and add the following content.
# ##########################################################
# GE VSAs
############################################################

VENDOR GE 2910

# Management authorization

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL B-1


RADIUS SERVER CONFIGURATION APPENDIX B: RADIUS SERVER CONFIGURATION

BEGIN-VENDOR GE

# Role ID
ATTRIBUTE GE-UR-Role 1 integer

# GE-UR-ROLE values
VALUE GE-UR-Role Administrator 1
VALUE GE-UR-Role Supervisor 2
VALUE GE-UR-Role Engineer 3

B VALUE GE-UR-Role
VALUE GE-UR-Role
Operator
Observer
4
5

END-VENDOR GE
#############################################################
6. In the dictionary file in the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, add the following line.
$INCLUDE dictionary.ge
For example, the file can look like the following:
$INCLUDE ../shareéfreeradius/dictionary
$INCLUDE dictionary.ge
7. For the first start, run the RADIUS server in debug mode to ensure that there are no compiling errors.
<Path_to_Radius>/start_radiusd_debug.bat
8. Set up the RADIUS parameters on the UR as follows.
8.1. If logging in, select Device for the Authentication Type, and use Administrator for the User Name. The default
password is "ChangeMe1#".
8.2. Access Settings > Product Setup > Security. Configure the IP address and ports for the RADIUS server. Leave
the GE vendor ID field at the default of 2910. Update the RADIUS shared secret as specified in the clients.conf
file. Restart the relay for the IP address and port changes to take effect.
9. Verify operation. Log in to the UR software as follows. In the login window, select Server as the Authentication Type,
enter the user name entered (for example user name Tester and password "testpw"). Check that the RADIUS server log
file shows the access with an "Access-Accept" entry.
Recall that if you tried another third-party tool and it did not work, you can use the FreeRADIUS software from
freeradius.net.

B-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Appendix C: Command line interface

Command line interface

This appendix outlines command line access to the software.

C.1 Command line interface


SetupCLI is a command line interface to communicate with the EnerVista UR Setup software. Commands can be sent from
a DOS prompt or a Windows batch file.
The interface is installed with the EnerVista software. Its default location is similar to
C:\Program Files\EnerVista\Tools\SetupCLI
The EnerVista software needs to be installed on a computer to run the command line interface. The command line
interface does not provide a remote connection to a computer running the EnerVista software.
Items to note are as follows:
• Works with EnerVista UR Setup version 6.10 and later
• Available in English only
• The graphical user interface of the software is not available concurrently with the command line interface
• It does not support concurrent commands
• It has limited functionality with CyberSentry
• It does not interface with UR Engineer
• It does not work when EnerVista UR Setup security is enabled, meaning when login is required
Command syntax is as follows:
• Options enclosed in [ ] are optional
• Values enclosed in < > are replaced with your own values
• <Application> is replaced with the EnerVista software to receive the command. Use "URPC" for EnerVista UR Setup.
• <device> is the UR device name, as displayed in the Device Name field of the Device Setup window and listed in the
Online Window. Use quotes with spaces, such as "B30 Belfort".
• "-s" can be used with any command to suppress error messages
• All commands, their return codes, and error description are logged in the file
C:\ProgramData\EnerVista\Tools\SetupCLI\SetupCLI.log
• When the Supervisor account is enabled, the 'Lock Relay' setting must first be changed to No before the putsettings,
inservice, or reboot command can be used. This setting cannot be changed using the command line interface.
• Use quotes ("") to enclose any parameter containing a space

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL C-1


COMMAND LINE INTERFACE APPENDIX C: COMMAND LINE INTERFACE

• Commands, options, and parameters are case sensitive


• All commands have a return code of 0-255. 0 indicates success and 1-255 indicate different errors
• If SetupCLI is automated (in a batch file), make sure that only a single batch is running at a time. SetupCLI does not
support concurrent operations.

To run the command line interface:


1. In Windows, click the Start button, enter cmd, and press the Enter key. After prompting for permission, the Windows
command window opens.
2. Enter SetupCLI followed by the action to execute. An example of use is to enter "SetupCLI -h" to display help,
specifically the commands and explanations outlined here.
Figure C-1: Command line interface run in the command window
C

SetupCLI -h
Display help.
It displays the content outline here.

SetupCLI <Application> start [-c] [-s]


Launch application with name <Application>.
To start in client mode, which is the graphical user interface, include option '-c'. Before use, the software must be idle
without any windows open. Any activity or open windows can cause unexpected behavior. When in client mode, do not
use Launchpad's Site Management feature.
To suppress errors, include option -s.
Example: SetupCLI URPC start -c

SetupCLI <Application> exit [-s]


Exit application with name <Application>.
Example: SetupCLI URPC exit

SetupCLI <Application> login -d <device> [-A <authentication type>] [-a <account>] -w <password> [-s]
Authenticate with device <device> using password <password>.
For non-CyberSentry devices — Set <authentication type> to "traditional". Note that <authentication type> defaults to
"traditional" if not specified. Set <account> to "COMMANDS" or "SETTINGS". If not specified, the SETTINGS account is
used.
Example: SetupCLI URPC login -d "C30 Melbourne" -A traditional -a SETTINGS -w 1password1

C-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX C: COMMAND LINE INTERFACE COMMAND LINE INTERFACE

Example of a batch file that checks for an error (this batch file uses standard batch file operations to check the return
code (ERRORLEVEL) and jump to an error handler):
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC login -d demoDevice -a SETTINGS -w WrongPassword -A traditional
IF NOT ERRORLEVEL 0 GOTO FAILED
SetupCLI URPC putsettings -d demoDevice -f "example file.urs"
SetupCLI URPC inservice -d demoDevice
SetupCLI URPC reboot -d demoDevice
SetupCLI URPC exit
exit

:FAILED
echo Please try again C
exit

For CyberSentry devices with local authentication — Set <authentication type> to "local" . Set <account> to
"Supervisor", "Administrator", "Engineer", "Operator", or "Observer".
For CyberSentry devices with RADIUS authentication — Set <authentication type> to "radius". Set <account> to the
user's account on the RADIUS server.

SetupCLI <Application> logout -d <device> [-s]


Log out of device <device>.
Example: SetupCLI URPC logout -d C30

SetupCLI <Application> getsettings -d <device> -f <File> [-s]


Read settings from device <device> and save them to the .urs file <File>. The <File> must not already exist. The default
path to the output file is C:\Users\Public\Public Documents\GE Power Management\URPC\Data
Example: SetupCLI URPC getsettings -d C30 -f "C30 Markham.urs"
Example of a batch file to retrieve a settings file:
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC getsettings -d demoDevice -f C:\example.urs
SetupCLI URPC exit
Example of a batch file to retrieve a settings file from a relay that requires RADIUS authentication:
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC login -d demoDevice -a %1 -w %2 -A radius
SetupCLI URPC getsettings -d demoDevice -f "example file.urs"
SetupCLI URPC logout -d demoDevice
SetupCLI URPC exit
Although a user name and password could have been entered in this batch file, it would have created a security risk.
Batch files allow you to pass in runtime parameters and refer to them in your script as %1, %2, and so on. For example,
if this file is called example.bat, one calls it as follows: "example.bat MyUserName MyPassword"

SetupCLI <Application> putsettings -d <device> -f <File> [-s]


Write the settings file <File> to the device <device>.
For CyberSentry devices, putsettings is only supported for users with the "Administrator" role.
Example: SetupCLI URPC putsettings -d C30 -f "C30 Markham.urs"

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL C-3


COMMAND LINE INTERFACE APPENDIX C: COMMAND LINE INTERFACE

SetupCLI <Application> compare -f <File1> -r <File2> -o <OutputFile> [-s]


Compare settings files <File1> and <File2>, and save output to <OutputFile>.
Example: SetupCLI URPC compare -f may.urs -r september.urs -o compared.txt
Batch file example that retrieves a settings file, compares it with an existing settings file, and opens the resulting
comparison file:
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC getsettings -d demoDevice -f devicefile.urs
SetupCLI URPC compare -f existingfile.urs -r devicefile.urs -o output.txt

The output is similar to the following:


Comparing settings file aaa.urs : C:\Users\Public\Public Documents\GE Power Management\URPC\Data\ with bbb.urs
: C:\Users\Public\Public Documents\GE Power Management\URPC\Data\
C
# Setting Name (Group,Module,Item) Value

1 + Default Message Timeout (1,1,1) = 299 s


2 - Default Message Timeout (1,1,1) = 300 s
3 + Flash Message Time (1,1,1) = 0.9 s
4 - Flash Message Time (1,1,1) = 1.0 s

SetupCLI <Application> inservice -d <device> [-n] [-s]


Put the device in service. Include option -n to take the device out of service.
Example: SetupCLI URPC inservice -d C30

SetupCLI <Application> reboot -d <device> [-s]


Reboot the relay <device>. This is necessary after changing IEC 61850 settings and aggregator source settings.
Example: SetupCLI URPC reboot -d "C30_Instanbul"

SetupCLI <Application> adddevice -I <IP Address> -S <Slave Address> -P <Modbus Port>


Connect to a device using its IP address, slave address, and Modbus port. Show the device in the EnerVista interface
under the SetupCLI Site as DEV@SETUP_CLI.
EnerVista UR Setup 7.30 or higher supports this command.
Figure C-2: Device added using IP address

The device is named as DEV@SETUP_CLI, which is used as the device name required by the <device> parameter of other
SetupCLI commands.

C-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX C: COMMAND LINE INTERFACE COMMAND LINE INTERFACE

The device name DEV@SETUP_CLI is always assigned to the device that is connected most recently by performing
'adddevice' command. It means that the Application only keeps up to one device named as DEV@SETUP_CLI, the
'adddevice' command disconnects/deletes the device DEV@SETUP _CLI that was connected previously by performing
'adddevice' command.
The device name DEV@SETUP_CLI is never used to configure/connect to a device through the graphical user interface.
Example of a batch file using a device IP address to retrieve its settings file:
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC adddevice -I 192.168.140.113 -S 113 -P 502
SetupCLI URPC getsettings -d DEV@SETUP_CLI -f C:\example.urs
SetupCLI URPC exit
After connecting the device using IP address, the device name DEV@SETUP_CLI is used to identify this device in
'getsettings' command.
Example of a batch file using a device IP address to retrieve a settings file when RADIUS authentication is required: C
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC adddevice -I 192.168.140.113 -S 113 -P 502
SetupCLI URPC login -d DEV@SETUP_CLI -a %1 -w %2 -A radius
SetupCLI URPC getsettings -d DEV@SETUP_CLI -f "example file.urs"
SetupCLI URPC logout -d DEV@SETUP_CLI
SetupCLI URPC exit
DEV@SETUP_CLI has to be used as the device name in the commands followed by the 'adddevice' command.

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL C-5


COMMAND LINE INTERFACE APPENDIX C: COMMAND LINE INTERFACE

C-6 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Appendix D: Miscellaneous

Miscellaneous

This chapter provides the warranty and revision history.

D.1 Warranty
For products shipped as of 1 October 2013, GE Grid Solutions warrants most of its GE manufactured products for 10 years.
For warranty details including any limitations and disclaimers, see the Terms and Conditions at
http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm
For products shipped before 1 October 2013, the standard 24-month warranty applies.

D.2 Revision history


The tables outline the releases and revision history of this document.
Table D-1: Revision history (English)
Manual P/N F35 revision Release date ECO
1601-0106-A1 2.0x 24 December 1999 N/A
1601-0106-A2 2.2x 12 May 2000 URF-018
1601-0106-A3 2.2x 14 June 2000 URF-019
1601-0106-A3a 2.2x 28 June 2000 URF-019a
1601-0106-B1 2.4x 08 September 2000 URF-021
1601-0106-B2 2.4x 03 November 2000 URF-023
1601-0106-B3 2.6x 09 March 2001 URF-026
1601-0106-B4 2.8x 26 September 2001 URF-028
1601-0106-B5 2.9x 03 December 2001 URF-029
1601-0106-B6 2.6x 27 February 2004 URX-120
1601-0106-C1 3.0x 02 July 2002 URF-031
1601-0106-C2 3.1x 30 August 2002 URF-033
1601-0106-C3 3.0x 18 November 2002 URF-035
1601-0106-C4 3.1x 18 November 2002 URF-037
1601-0106-C5 3.0x 11 February 2003 URF-039

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL D-1


REVISION HISTORY APPENDIX D: MISCELLANEOUS

Manual P/N F35 revision Release date ECO


1601-0106-C6 3.1x 11 February 2003 URF-041
1601-0106-D1 3.2x 11 February 2003 URF-043
1601-0106-D2 3.2x 02 June 2003 URX-084
1601-0106-E1 3.3x 01 May 2003 URX-080
1601-0106-E2 3.3x 29 May 2003 URX-083
1601-0106-F1 3.4x 10 December 2003 URX-111
1601-0106-F2 3.4x 09 February 2004 URX-115
1601-0106-G1 4.0x 23 March 2004 URX-123
1601-0106-G2 4.0x 17 May 2004 URX-136
1601-0106-H1 4.2x 30 June 2004 URX-145
1601-0106-H2 4.2x 23 July 2004 URX-151
1601-0106-J1 4.4x 15 September 2004 URX-156
1601-0106-K1 4.6x 15 February 2005 URX-176
1601-0106-L1 4.8x 05 August 2005 URX-202
1601-0106-M1 4.9x 15 December 2005 URX-208

D 1601-0106-M2
1601-0106-N1
4.9x
5.0x
27 February 2006
31 March 2006
URX-214
URX-217
1601-0106-N2 5.0x 26 May 2006 URX-220
1601-0106-P1 5.2x 23 October 2006 URX-230
1601-0106-P2 5.2x 24 January 2007 URX-232
1601-0106-R1 5.4x 26 June 2007 URX-242
1601-0106-R2 5.4x 31 August 2007 URX-246
1601-0106-R3 5.4x 17 October 2007 URX-251
1601-0106-S1 5.5x 7 December 2007 URX-253
1601-0106-S2 5.5x 22 February 2008 URX-258
1601-0106-S3 5.5x 12 March 2008 URX-260
1601-0106-T1 5.6x 27 June 2008 08-0390
1601-0106-U1 5.7x 29 May 2009 09-0938
1601-0106-U2 5.7x 30 September 2009 09-1165
1601-0106-V1 5.8x 29 May 2010 09-1457
1601-0106-V2 5.8x 04 January 2011 11-2237
1601-0106-W1 5.9x 12 January 2011 11-2227
1601-0106-X1 6.0x 21 December 2011 11-2840
1601-0106-X2 6.0x 5 April 2012 12-3254
1601-0106-Y1 7.0x 30 September 2012 12-3529
1601-0106-Y2 7.0x 11 November 2012 12-3601
1601-0106-Z1 7.1x 30 March 2013 13-0126
1601-0106-AA1 7.2x 1 August 2013 13-0401
1601-0106-AB1 7.3x 7 November 2014 14-1408
1601-0106-AB2 7.3x 1 September 2015 15-2215
1601-0106-AC1 7.40x 8 December 2016 16-3319
1601-0106-AE1 7.41x 31 January 2017 17-3427
1601-0106-AE3 7.4x 28 April 2017 17-3561
1601-0106-AF1 7.6x 30 June 2017 17-3779
1601-0106-AF2 7.6x 31 October 2017 17-3935
1601-0106-AG1 7.7x 31 March 2018 18-4430
1601-0106-AG2 7.7x 4 May 2018 18-4517

D-2 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


APPENDIX D: MISCELLANEOUS REVISION HISTORY

Table D-2: Major changes for F35 manual version AG2 (English)
Page Description
--- General revision. Improved figure quality by using conditional text to switch between PDF and PNG figures.
--- Updated maximum number of Wattmetric Ground Fault elements for F35 from 4 to 5 in Settings and Actual Values chapters

Table D-3: Major changes for F35 manual version AG1 (English)
Page Description
--- General revision
2-8 Updated order codes from SH / SL to RH / RL for the redundant power supply for horizontal units. The power supply modules
were upgraded in 2014 to SH and SL, but the order codes when purchasing a UR remain as RH and RL so that customers do
not need to change order codes. The order codes for the power supply replacement modules are correct as SH and SL.
3-58 Added IP and subnet mask address rules to the Set IP Address in UR section
5-57 Added IEC 61850 Editions 1 and 2 section
5-150 Added support for a redundant SNTP server as a time source
5-214 Added GOOSE simulation operands to FlexLogic operands table
5-330 Added Settings > Simulation > GOOSE section
6-4 Added Actual Values > Graphical Panel > LEDs and Pushbuttons information D
6-13 Added Actual Values > Status > Protocol section

Table D-4: Major changes for F35 manual version AF2 (English)
Page Description
--- General revision
--- Added type W CPU module to order codes in chapter 2, installation chapter 3, Replace Front Panel section in chapter 10
--- Added Japanese and Polish languages and modules 6W and 6X to order codes in chapter 2. Module 6W allows 30 contact
inputs, and Module 6X allows 18 outputs.
3-17 Added contact input and contact output modules 6W and 6X to Table 3-3 Contact Input and Output Module Assignments and
to Figure 3-17 Contact Input and Output Module Wiring (Sheet 3 of 3)
5-300 Updated Thermal Overload Protection Logic diagram

Table D-5: Major changes for F35 manual version AF1 (English)
Page Description
--- General revision
--- Updated "faceplate" to "front panel" for consistency and to reflect web site
--- Added graphical front panel option to order codes and specifications in chapter 2, Interfaces chapter 4, Settings chapter 5,
Actual Values chapter 6
--- Added PEAP-GTC and PAP protocols for authenticating user logins when using a RADIUS server. Added to Settings > Product
Setup > Security > RADIUS Authentication Method and to Modbus memory map and F codes.
--- Updated Contact Inputs from 96 to 120 and Contact Outputs from 64 to 72 in Product Description in chapter 2 and FlexLogic
operands table in chapter 5
--- Updated Breaker Restrike number from 6 to 3 in specifications, FlexLogic operands table, settings, features per product table,
Modbus memory map
3-36 Updated RS422 and Fiber Interface Connection figure for the clock channels (from 7a and 7b to 1a and 1b)
3-67 Added Connect to a D400 Gateway section
4-43 Updated LED Labelling instructions for the new Front Panel Label Designer
4-50 Added Standard Front Panel section for labelling LEDs and pushbuttons
5-122 Updated User-programmable Pushbuttons section as per specifications
5-143 Added USB Port section to enable/disable the USB port on the graphical front panel
5-144 Updated Breakers section as per specifications
5-149 Updated Disconnect Switches section as per specifications

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL D-3


REVISION HISTORY APPENDIX D: MISCELLANEOUS

Page Description
10-5 Added Convert Device Settings section
10-7 Added Copy Settings to Other Device section
10-15 Added Replace Front Panel section for retrofit with the new graphical front panel

Table D-6: Major changes for F35 manual version AE3 (English)
Page Description
--- General revision
2- Updated order codes
10-5 Added Copy Settings to Other Device section

Table D-7: Major changes for F35 manual version AE1 (English)
Page Description
--- General revision
--- Added routable GOOSE content in chapters 2 and 5
3-36 Updated RS422 and Fiber Interface Connection figure for the clock channels (from 7a and 7b to 1a and 1b)
4- Added Engineer content
D 5- Updated IEC 61850 content
A- Updated FlexAnalog table for most UR products

Table D-8: Major changes for F35 manual version AC1 (English)
Page Description
--- General revision. Added online help and updated generic online help.
--- Deleted EAC logo from title page and deleted EAC certification from Approvals specifications because document not
translated into Russian
--- Updated Breaker Arcing Current content, including FlexLogic operands table, settings, logic diagram, actual values, Modbus
memory map
--- Updated Fault Report and Fault Location content, including settings, actual values, and theory of operation chapters
--- Added Voltage Transformer Fuse Failure (VTFF) element, including to product description table, FlexLogic operands table,
settings, FlexAnalog table, Features per Product table, Modbus memory map, and IMD content
--- Added Source Current THD and Harmonics content to specifications, actual values, Modbus memory map
--- Added Phase Overvoltage content to product description, specifications, FlexLogic operands table, settings, features per
product table, Modbus memory map, IMD table
--- Updated number of Breaker Restrike elements, increasing from three to six, in FlexLogic operands table, settings, features per
product table, Modbus memory map
--- Added Cold Load Pickup content to product description, FlexLogic operands table, settings, features per product table,
Modbus memory map, IMD table
--- Added Breaker Flashover content to product description, specifications, FlexLogic operands table, settings, features per
product table, Modbus memory map, IMD table
2- Updated several specifications, such as TOC, IOC, number of FlexLogic lines
4-30 Added FlexLogic Design and Monitoring using Engineer section to end of Interfaces chapter
5-38 Added PRT FUNCTION settings in Network section to enable/disable each Ethernet port
5-49 Updated IEC 61850 section
5-61 Added Support for Routable GOOSE section
5-169 Updated number of FlexLogic lines from 512 to 1024 in FlexLogic Equation Editor settings section
10-1 Added Monitoring section
10-2 Added Retrieve Files section
C- Added Command Line Interface appendix

D-4 F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


Glossary

F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Abbreviations

CPU Central Processing Unit


Abbreviations

A Ampere
AC Alternating Current CRC Cyclic Redundancy Code/Check
A/D Analog to Digital CRL Certificate Revocation List
AE Accidental Energization, Application Entity CRT, CRNT Current
AMP Ampere CSA Canadian Standards Association
ANG Angle CT Current Transformer
ANSI American National Standards Institute CVT Capacitive Voltage Transformer
AR Automatic Reclosure
ARP Address Resolution Protocol D/A Digital to Analog
ASDU Application-layer Service Data Unit DC (dc) Direct Current
ASYM Asymmetry DCE Data Communications Equipment
AUTO Automatic DCS Distributed Control System
AUX Auxiliary DD Disturbance Detector
AVG Average DFLT Default
AWG American Wire Gauge DGNST Diagnostics
DIFF Differential
BCS Best Clock Selector DIR Directional
BER Bit Error Rate DISCREP Discrepancy
BF Breaker Fail DIST Distance
BFI Breaker Failure Initiate DMD Demand
BKR Breaker DNP Distributed Network Protocol
BLK Block DPO Dropout
BLKG Blocking DPS Double-Point Status
BNC Bayonet Neill-Concelman DSP Digital Signal Processor
BPNT Breakpoint of a characteristic DST Daylight Savings Time
BRKR Breaker dt Rate of Change
DTT Direct Transfer Trip
CA Certificate Authority DUTT Direct Under-reaching Transfer Trip
CAP Capacitor
CC Coupling Capacitor EGD Ethernet Global Data
CCVT Coupling Capacitor Voltage Transformer ENCRMNT Encroachment
CFG Configure / Configurable EPRI Electric Power Research Institute
.CFG Filename extension for oscillography files .EVT Filename extension for event recorder files
CHK Check EXT Extension, External
CHNL Channel
CID Configured IED Description F Field
CLS Close FAIL Failure
CLSD Closed FD Fault Detector
CMND Command FDH Fault Detector high-set
CMPRSN Comparison FDL Fault Detector low-set
CO Contact Output FIR Finite Impulse Response
COM Communication FLA Full Load Current
COMM Communications FO Fiber Optic
COMP Compensated, Comparison FPGA Field-programmable Gate Array
CONN Connection FREQ Frequency
CONT Continuous, Contact FSK Frequency-Shift Keying
CO-ORD Coordination FTP File Transfer Protocol
FxE FlexElement™

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL i


ABBREVIATIONS

FWD Forward M2M Machine to Machine


mA MilliAmpere
G Generator MAG Magnitude
GCM Galois Counter Mode MAN Manual / Manually
GDOI Group Domain of Interpretation MAX Maximum
GE General Electric Mb Megabit
GFP Graphical Front Panel MIC Model Implementation Conformance
GND Ground MIN Minimum, Minutes
GNTR Generator MMI Man Machine Interface
GoCB GOOSE Control Block MMS Manufacturing Message Specification
GOOSE General Object Oriented Substation Event MRT Minimum Response Time
GPS Global Positioning System MSG Message
GSU Generator Step-Up MTA Maximum Torque Angle
MTR Motor
HARM Harmonic / Harmonics MVA MegaVolt-Ampere (total 3-phase)
HCT High Current Time MVA_A MegaVolt-Ampere (phase A)
HGF High-Impedance Ground Fault (CT) MVA_B MegaVolt-Ampere (phase B)
HIZ High-Impedance and Arcing Ground MVA_C MegaVolt-Ampere (phase C)
HMI Human-Machine Interface MVAR MegaVar (total 3-phase)
HTTP Hyper Text Transfer Protocol MVAR_A MegaVar (phase A)
HV High Voltage MVAR_B MegaVar (phase B)
HYB Hybrid MVAR_C MegaVar (phase C)
Hz Hertz MVARH MegaVar-Hour
MW MegaWatt (total 3-phase)
I Instantaneous MW_A MegaWatt (phase A)
I_0 Zero Sequence current MW_B MegaWatt (phase B)
I_1 Positive Sequence current MW_C MegaWatt (phase C)
I_2 Negative Sequence current MWH MegaWatt-Hour
IA Phase A current
IAB Phase A minus B current N Neutral
IB Phase B current N/A, n/a Not Applicable
IBC Phase B minus C current NEG Negative
IC Phase C current NMPLT Nameplate
ICA Phase C minus A current NOM Nominal
ICD IED Capability Description NTR Neutral
ID Identification
IED Intelligent Electronic Device O Over
IEC International Electrotechnical Commission OC, O/C Overcurrent
IEEE Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers OCSP Online Certificate Status Protocol
IG Ground (not residual) current OF Overload Factor
Igd Differential Ground current O/P, Op Output
IGMP Internet Group Management Protocol OP Operate
IID Instantiated IED Capability Description OPER Operate
IN CT Residual Current (3Io) or Input OPERATG Operating
INC SEQ Incomplete Sequence O/S Operating System
INIT Initiate OSI Open Systems Interconnect
INST Instantaneous OSB Out-of-Step Blocking
INV Inverse OUT Output
I/O Input/Output OV Overvoltage
IOC Instantaneous Overcurrent OVERFREQ Overfrequency
IOV Instantaneous Overvoltage OVLD Overload
IRC Inter-Relay Communication
IRIG Inter-Range Instrumentation Group P Phase
ISO International Standards Organization PC Phase Comparison, Personal Computer
IUV Instantaneous Undervoltage PCNT Percent
PF Power Factor (total 3-phase)
K0 Zero Sequence Current Compensation PF_A Power Factor (phase A)
kA kiloAmpere PF_B Power Factor (phase B)
KDC Key Distribution Center PF_C Power Factor (phase C)
kV kiloVolt PFLL Phase and Frequency Lock Loop
PHS Phase
LCD Liquid Crystal Display PICS Protocol Implementation & Conformance
LED Light Emitting Diode Statement
LEO Line End Open PKI Public Key Infrastructure
LFT BLD Left Blinder PKP Pickup
LOOP Loopback PLC Power Line Carrier
LPU Line Pickup POS Positive
LRA Locked-Rotor Current POTT Permissive Over-reaching Transfer Trip
LTC Load Tap-Changer PRESS Pressure
LV Low Voltage PRI Primary
PROT Protection
M Machine PRP Parallel Redundancy Protocol

ii F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


ABBREVIATIONS

PSEL Presentation Selector TRANSF Transfer


PTP Precision Time Protocol TSEL Transport Selector
pu Per Unit TUC Time Undercurrent
PUIB Pickup Current Block TUV Time Undervoltage
PUIT Pickup Current Trip TX (Tx) Transmit, Transmitter
PUSHBTN Pushbutton
PUTT Permissive Under-reaching Transfer Trip U Under
PWM Pulse Width Modulated UC Undercurrent
PWR Power UCA Utility Communications Architecture
UDP User Datagram Protocol
QUAD Quadrilateral UL Underwriters Laboratories
UNBAL Unbalance
R Rate, Reverse UR Universal Relay
RA Registration Authority URC Universal Recloser Control
RCA Reach Characteristic Angle .URS Filename extension for settings files
REF Reference UV Undervoltage
REM Remote
REV Reverse V/Hz Volts per hertz
R-GOOSE Routable GOOSE V_0 Zero Sequence voltage
RI Reclose Initiate V_1 Positive Sequence voltage
RIP Reclose In Progress V_2 Negative Sequence voltage
RGT BLD Right Blinder VA Phase A voltage
RMA Return Materials Authorization VAB Phase A to B voltage
RMS Root Mean Square VAG Phase A to Ground voltage
ROCOF Rate of Change of Frequency VARH Var-hour voltage
ROD Remote Open Detector VB Phase B voltage
RRTD Remote Resistance Temperature Detector VBA Phase B to A voltage
RST Reset VBG Phase B to Ground voltage
RSTR Restrained VC Phase C voltage
RTD Resistance Temperature Detector VCA Phase C to A voltage
RTU Remote Terminal Unit VCG Phase C to Ground voltage
RX (Rx) Receive, Receiver VF Variable Frequency
VIBR Vibration
s second VT Voltage Transformer
S Sensitive VTFF Voltage Transformer Fuse Failure
SAT CT Saturation VTLOS Voltage Transformer Loss Of Signal
SBO Select Before Operate
SCADA Supervisory Control and Data Acquisition WDG Winding
SCC Serial Communication Controller WH Watt-hour
SCD System Configuration Description w/ opt With Option
SCL Substation Configuration Language WGS World Geodetic System
SCEP Simple Certificate Enrollment Protocol WRT With Respect To
SEC Secondary
SEL Select / Selector / Selection X Reactance
SENS Sensitive XDUCER Transducer
SEQ Sequence XFMR Transformer
SFTP Secure Shell (SSH) File Transfer Protocol, Secure
File Transfer Protocol Z Impedance, Zone
SIR Source Impedance Ratio
SNTP Simple Network Time Protocol
SRC Source
SSB Single Side Band
SSEL Session Selector
STATS Statistics
SUPN Supervision
SUPV Supervise / Supervision
SV Supervision, Service
SYNC Synchrocheck
SYNCHCHK Synchrocheck

T Time, transformer
TC Thermal Capacity
TCP Transmission Control Protocol
TCU Thermal Capacity Used
TD MULT Time Dial Multiplier
TEMP Temperature
TFTP Trivial File Transfer Protocol
THD Total Harmonic Distortion
TMR Timer
TOC Time Overcurrent
TOV Time Overvoltage
TRANS Transient

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL iii


ABBREVIATIONS

iv F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


F35 Multiple Feeder Protection System

Index

Index

Administrator
Numerics add user account ............................................................................. 5-14
10BASE-F settings ...............................................................................5-45 command to force logoff ................................................................7-4
4L Discrepancy message .................................................................. 7-8 no automatic logout from front panel ................................... 5-21
7R module ................................................................................................3-41 role for CyberSentry ...........................................................................2-4
7S module ................................................................................................3-40 Alarm LEDs ............................................................................................5-163
8-bit switch Alarms
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-209 acknowledge ....................................................................4-33, 6-3, 6-4
settings ...............................................................................................5-282 add .............................................................................................. 4-34, 5-36
specifications ......................................................................................2-23 messages ................................................................................................7-6
overview ............................................................................................... 4-31
reset ...............................................................................................4-33, 6-4
AND gate explained ........................................................................... 4-82
A Annunciator editor ............................................................................. 4-34
AC current inputs ANSI device numbers ...........................................................................2-2
explained ..............................................................................................3-17 Apparent power
settings ...............................................................................................5-184 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-19
specifications ......................................................................................2-26 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-25
AC voltage input specifications ...................................................2-26 Application examples
Accents ......................................................................................................4-55 breaker trip circuit integrity .......................................................5-279
Access Violation message ..............................................................3-68 contact inputs ..................................................................................5-312
Acknowledge alarm ............................................................................. 6-4 direct inputs and outputs ...........................................................5-319
Activate relay .........................................................................................3-53 latching outputs ..............................................................................5-315
Active setting group ........................................................................5-230 Apply settings to other device ..................................................... 10-7
Actual values ............................................................................................ 6-1 Approvals ................................................................................................. 2-35
alarms for graphical front panel ................................................. 6-3 Architecture, relay ............................................................................5-206
display on graphical front panel ...................................4-34, 4-35 Arcing current ......................................................................5-284, 5-288
monitor with Modbus Analyzer ..................................................10-1 Audit list of port numbers ............................................................... 5-45
not activated graphical front panel .........................................4-52 Authentication by device or server ........................................... 5-16
Add Device from File option Automatic discovery of UR devices .......................................... 3-67
restore settings to online device ............................................10-11
Autoreclose
save to Offline Window ..................................................................3-72
actual values .........................................................................................6-7
Add Device to Offline Window preferences .........................10-9 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-209
Add module, check settings not defaulted ........................10-24 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-274
Add relay ...................................................................................................3-57 settings ...............................................................................................5-270
single shot sequence ....................................................................5-276

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL i


INDEX

Auxiliary overvoltage Breaker control


FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-209 control of two breakers ................................................................. 4-57
logic ......................................................................................................5-259 dual breaker logic ......................................................................... 5-192
settings ...............................................................................................5-258 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-211
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21 settings ............................................................................................... 5-189
Auxiliary undervoltage with IEC 61850 .................................................................... 5-90, 5-128
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-209 Breaker flashover
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-258 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-210
settings ...............................................................................................5-257 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-295
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-20 settings ............................................................................................... 5-291
Auxiliary voltage channel ............................................................... 3-17 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21
Auxiliary voltage metering ............................................................ 6-19 Breaker restrike
AWG wire size ....................................................................................... 3-47 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-210
CT/VT ...................................................................................................... 3-17 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-298
F485 converter .................................................................................. 3-55 settings ............................................................................................... 5-296
G.703 interface .................................................................................. 3-40 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21
module 7S ........................................................................................... 3-40 Breaker-and-a-half scheme ............................................................5-6
modules 6X, 6W ................................................................................ 3-21 Brick Trouble message ..................................................................... 7-13
modules 7E, 7F, 7G, 7Q, 75 .......................................................... 3-47 Brightness ................................................................................................ 5-26
modules 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, 74 ......................................................... 3-46 Broken conductor
modules 7T, 7W ................................................................................ 3-44 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-211
RS422 and fiber interface ............................................................ 3-46 settings ............................................................................................... 5-305

B C
Back up settings .......................................................... 5-59, 5-97, 10-8 C37.94 communications ..................................................... 3-48, 3-51
Bad IRIG-B Signal message ............................................................. 7-8 Cannot log in .............................................................................................2-4
Bad PTP Signal message ................................................................... 7-8 Caution symbol in Offline Window ............................................ 4-68
Banks ............................................................................................. 5-7, 5-184 CE certification ...................................................................................... 2-35
Basic front panel Certification ............................................................................................ 2-35
dimensions ............................................................................................. 3-2 Changes ...................................................................................................... D-1
FlexLogic ............................................................................................5-209 Channel
interface ............................................................................................... 4-15 banks ................................................................................................... 5-184
IP rating ................................................................................................ 2-33 tests ........................................................................................................ 6-11
keypad .................................................................................................. 4-37 Check Settings message ....................................................................7-7
labels ...................................................................................................... 4-47 Chinese limited to 10 character input ..................................... 5-27
LEDs ..........................................................................................4-39, 5-163 CID file, SCD file ................5-76, 5-77, 5-78, 5-114, 5-115, 5-116
navigation ........................................................................................... 4-49 CID files
order codes ............................................................................................ 2-7 create ......................................................................................... 5-59, 5-97
pushbuttons .....................................................................................5-166 explained .............................................................................................. 3-72
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23 import ..................................................................................... 3-72, 10-12
use, change setting ......................................................................... 4-51 import preferences .......................................................................... 10-9
Battery view ............................................................................................. 5-59, 5-97
disposal ..............................................................................................10-26 Circuit monitoring applications ................................................ 5-278
replace ................................................................................................10-25 Cleaning .................................................................................................... 2-35
Baud rate ................................................................................................. 5-42 Clear
Blinking alarm ....................................................................................... 4-33 files and records ............................................................................ 10-29
Block setting ............................................................................................. 5-5 LEDs ..................................................................................................... 5-317
Breaker arcing current relay records using IEC 61850 ................................................ 5-133
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-28 relay records using settings ........................................................ 5-40
clearing ........................................................................................ 5-41, 7-2 security logs ...........................................................................................7-4
FlexAnalogs ............................................................................ A-21, A-33
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-210
logic diagram .................................................................... 5-287, 5-290
measurement ................................................................... 5-286, 5-289
settings ................................................................................ 5-284, 5-288
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21

ii F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


INDEX

Clock Contact inputs


actual values ......................................................................................... 6-9 actual values .........................................................................................6-5
graphical front panel format .......................................................5-30 explained ............................................................................................5-311
IRIG-B ......................................................................................................3-36 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-215
PTP ........................................................................................................5-149 settings ...............................................................................................5-311
set .............................................................................................................. 7-3 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-26
settings ...............................................................................................5-148 thresholds ..........................................................................................5-311
synchronize several devices .....................................................5-149 wet and dry connections .............................................................. 3-26
Close Contact outputs
HTTP port ...........................................................................................5-138 actual values .........................................................................................6-6
IEC 60870-5-104 port ..................................................................5-140 explained ............................................................................................5-314
Modbus port ........................................................................................5-51 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-215
TFTP port ............................................................................................5-139 settings ...............................................................................................5-314
Web access port ............................................................................5-138 Control elements ...............................................................................5-259
Cold load pickup Control power
explained ...........................................................................................5-307 description ........................................................................................... 3-15
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-211 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-29
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-308 Control pushbuttons
settings ...............................................................................................5-307 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-209
COMM Path Incomplete message ................................... 7-8, 7-10 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-166
Comm status remaining connections .....................................6-12 settings ...............................................................................................5-165
Command line interface to software ......................................... C-1 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23
Command password .............................................................4-58, 5-10 Convert device settings ................................................................... 10-5
Commands Copy of Copy of .................................................................................... 10-7
control user accounts .....................................................................5-14 Copy settings for upgrading ......................................................... 10-5
menu ......................................................................................................... 7-1 Copy settings to other device ...................................................... 10-7
with IEC 61850 ................................................................................5-133 Counters
Commissioning ....................................................................................... 8-1 actual values .........................................................................................6-8
Communications settings ...............................................................................................5-280
10BASE-F ..............................................................................................5-45 CPU module diagram ....................................................................... 3-12
connecting to the UR ..........................................................3-65, 3-68 CPU, new types T, U, V ....................................................................10-15
DNP ..........................................................................................................5-52 CRC alarm ..............................................................................................5-180
EGD .......................................................................................................5-141 Critical failure relay specifications ............................................ 2-29
HTTP .....................................................................................................5-138 CSA certification .................................................................................. 2-35
IEC 60870-5-10 ...............................................................................5-142 CT bank settings ................................................................................5-184
IEC 60870-5-104 ............................................................................5-139 CT inputs ........................................................................... 3-16, 5-7, 5-184
inter-relay specifications ...............................................................2-31 CT wiring ................................................................................................... 3-17
Modbus registers ...........................................................................5-147 Current bank ........................................................................................5-184
Modbus settings ................................................................................5-51
Current demand ................................................................................5-158
modem ..................................................................................................3-66
Current metering actual values .................................................. 6-17
Protocol selection .............................................................................5-51
Curves
RS232 .........................................................................................3-33, 5-42
definite time .......................................................................5-236, 5-253
RS485 .........................................................................................3-35, 5-42
FlexCurves ..........................................................................5-199, 5-236
settings ......................................................................................5-45, 5-52
IAC .........................................................................................................5-234
specifications ..........................................................................2-30, 2-31
IEC .........................................................................................................5-233
timeout ..................................................................................................5-51
IEEE .......................................................................................................5-232
web server ........................................................................................5-138
inverse time undervoltage .........................................................5-253
Compare settings ................................................................................10-7
types .....................................................................................................5-231
Compliance .............................................................................................2-35
Cutout, panel ............................................................................................3-2
COMTRADE files, view ........................................................................4-79
CyberSentry
Conducted RFI specifications .......................................................2-34
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-209
Connect, unable to ..................................................................3-68, 5-45 installation ............................................................................... 3-71, 5-24
Connection timeout ............................................................................5-51 RS485 port limitation ...................................................................... 5-17
Connectors, LC and ST ......................................................................3-13 security commands ...........................................................................7-4
security overview ................................................................................2-4
software options .............................................................................. 2-32
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-32
system logs ......................................................................................... 5-25

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL iii


INDEX

Digital elements
D application example .................................................................... 5-279
D400 connection ................................................................................. 3-73 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-211
Dark graphical front panel ............................................................ 5-31 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-278
Data logger settings ............................................................................................... 5-277
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-27 Digital outputs
clearing ........................................................................................ 5-41, 7-2 see Contact outputs
settings ...............................................................................................5-157 Dimensions ................................................................................................3-2
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-24 Direct Device Off message ...............................................................7-8
Data, reading values ............................................................................ 6-1 Direct devices
Dataset member is empty message .........................5-68, 5-106 settings ............................................................................................... 5-318
Date status ..................................................................................................... 6-10
firmware ............................................................................................... 6-29 Direct I/O
last cleared oscillography date ................................................. 6-27 application example .................................................................... 5-319
last settings change ....................................................................... 6-29 configuration examples ............................................................. 5-176
manufacturing date ....................................................................... 6-29 settings ............................................................................................... 5-318
set .................................................................................... 5-29, 5-148, 7-3 Direct inputs
DCmA inputs .......................................................................................... 6-24 actual values .........................................................................................6-9
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-24 application example .................................................................... 5-319
FlexAnalogs ........................................................................................ A-34 clearing counters ................................................................................7-2
settings ...............................................................................................5-324 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-215
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-26 settings ............................................................................................... 5-318
DCmA outputs specifications ..................................................................................... 2-27
description .......................................................................................... 3-31 Direct outputs
settings ...............................................................................................5-326 application example .................................................................... 5-319
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-30 clearing counters ................................................................................7-2
Decommission ....................................................................................10-29 settings ............................................................................................... 5-319
Default password ............................................................................... 5-14 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-30
Default settings ........................................................................ 10-7, 10-8 Direct Ring Break message ..............................................................7-8
Default settings to factory default ............................................... 7-3 Disconnect switch
Definite time curve ............................................................ 5-236, 5-253 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-214
Delete files and records ....................................................5-40, 10-29 logic ..................................................................................................... 5-197
Demand metering settings ............................................................................................... 5-194
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-20 Discover button .................................................................................... 3-67
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-26 Disk space required ........................................................................... 3-55
Demand records, clearing .................................................... 5-41, 7-2 Display settings .................................................................................... 5-26
Demand, current ...............................................................................5-158 Disposal ................................................................................................. 10-31
Deploy relay .............................................................................................. 8-1 Dispose of battery ............................................................................ 10-26
Deploy settings ..................................................................................... 10-7 Disturbance detector
Device authentication ...................................................................... 5-16 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-213
Device Connectivity Report in Engineer ................................ 4-76 internal ............................................................................................... 5-187
Device information files ......................................................... 1-2, 4-76 DNP
connections remaining .................................................................. 6-12
Device overview .................................................................................. 10-1
select protocol ................................................................................... 5-51
Device setup .......................................................................................... 3-67
settings .................................................................................................. 5-52
Diagnostic Alarm COP message ................................................... 7-7
view Points List in web browser ................................................ 5-55
Diagnostic Alarm DSP message .................................................... 7-7
DOS Partition Alarm message ........................................................7-8
Diagnostic Failure message ............................................................ 7-6
Downgrade
Diagnostics Failure message .......................................................... 7-8 firmware ............................................................................................ 10-14
Dielectric strength .............................................................................. 3-15 software ............................................................................................. 10-13
Digital counters Download
actual values ......................................................................................... 6-8 files from relay ................................................................................... 10-3
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-211 settings to relay ................................................................................ 10-7
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-282 Drag and drop files ................................................................................4-3
settings ...............................................................................................5-280
Duplicate
device settings ................................................................................... 10-7
settings for upgrading ................................................................... 10-5

iv F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


INDEX

Dynamic switch Error messages .......................................................................................7-6


see 8-bit switch device not recognized ..................................................................10-13
in Engineer ........................................................................................... 4-69
Ethernet
E actual values .........................................................................................6-8
configuration ...................................................................................... 3-65
Edition 1 and 2 IEC 61850 ...............................................................5-57
port failure monitoring .................................................................. 5-38
EGD protocol
port settings ....................................................................................... 5-45
actual values .......................................................................................6-10
port, turn on or off ........................................................................... 5-45
settings ...............................................................................................5-141
ports on rear panel .......................................................................... 3-12
Eight-bit switch
Quick Connect ................................................................................... 3-70
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-209
Ethernet Global Data settings ...................................................5-141
settings ...............................................................................................5-282
Event cause indicators ..................................................................... 4-38
specifications ......................................................................................2-23
Event Cause LEDs ............................................................................... 4-40
Electrostatic discharge specifications .....................................2-34
Event recorder
Elements ..................................................................................................... 5-4
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-25
End of life ...............................................................................................10-31
clearing ........................................................................................5-41, 7-2
Energy metering
records explained ...............................................................................4-2
actual values .......................................................................................6-20
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-24
clearing ........................................................................................ 5-41, 7-2
system logs ......................................................................................... 5-25
specifications ......................................................................................2-25
via EnerVista software ......................................................................4-2
EnerVista UR setup view event records .......................................................................... 6-25
command line interface .................................................................. C-1
Events setting ...........................................................................................5-5
drag and drop files ............................................................................. 4-3
Export settings to file ........................................................................ 10-8
event recorder ...................................................................................... 4-2
firmware upgrade or downgrade ..........................................10-14
installation ...........................................................................................3-56
oscillography ........................................................................................ 4-2 F
requirements ......................................................................................3-55 F485 ............................................................................................................ 3-55
restart relay ........................................................................................... 5-1 Factory default reset .......................................................5-8, 5-22, 7-3
Engineer Far-End Fault Indication .................................................................. 5-46
command to force user logoff ...................................................... 7-4 Fast form-C relay specifications ................................................ 2-29
create logic diagram .......................................................................4-61 Fast transient testing specifications ........................................ 2-34
Error messages ..................................................................................4-69 Fault locator
toolbar ...................................................................................................4-80 logic diagram ........................................................................................9-4
Warning messages ..........................................................................4-70 operation .................................................................................................9-1
Enhanced front panel specifications ..................................................................................... 2-24
FlexLogic ............................................................................................5-209 Fault report
interface ................................................................................................4-15 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-24
IP rating .................................................................................................2-33 clearing ........................................................................................5-40, 7-2
keypad ...................................................................................................4-37 settings ...............................................................................................5-153
labels ......................................................................................................4-43 Features .......................................................................................................2-1
LEDs .........................................................................................4-38, 5-163 Fiber signal loss detection ............................................................. 5-46
navigation ............................................................................................4-49 File transfer by IEC 61850 ............................................................5-137
order codes ........................................................................................... 2-7 File transfer by TFTP ........................................................................5-139
pushbuttons .....................................................................................5-166 Files
Rev. 1 and 2 explained ..................................................................... 3-2 delete ...................................................................................................10-29
specifications ......................................................................................2-23 download from relay ...................................................................... 10-3
use, change setting .........................................................................4-51 drag and drop .......................................................................................4-3
Environment backup .........................................................................10-9 protect FlexLogic with password .................................................4-9
Equations protect with password ......................................................................4-7
definite time curve ......................................................... 5-236, 5-253 transfer from relay .......................................................................... 4-17
FlexCurves .........................................................................................5-236 transfer to relay .......................................................................4-1, 4-17
FlexLogic ............................................................................................5-224 Firmware not supported by EnerVista ..................................10-14
FlexLogic, protect ............................................................................... 4-9 Firmware revision ............................................................................... 6-29
IAC curves ..........................................................................................5-234
Firmware upgrade or downgrade ...........................................10-14
IEC curves ..........................................................................................5-233
Firmware version does not match EnerVista ...................10-13
IEEE curves ........................................................................................5-232
Equipment Mismatch message ......................................... 7-6, 7-12

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL v


INDEX

First Ethernet Fail Form-C


error message ...................................................................................... 7-8 actual values .........................................................................................6-6
set alarm .............................................................................................. 5-38 critical failure relay .......................................................................... 3-15
Flash memory .....................................................................................10-29 order codes ............................................................................................2-7
Flash memory data storage ......................................................... 3-16 outputs .................................................................................................. 3-19
Flash messages ................................................................................... 5-26 replacement modules .................................................................... 2-14
Flex State parameters specifications ..................................................................................... 2-29
actual values ......................................................................................... 6-8 FPGA
settings ...............................................................................................5-172 revision .................................................................................................. 6-29
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-22 upgrade ............................................................................................. 10-15
FlexAnalog parameters ......................................................................A-1 Frequency metering
FlexCurves actual values ...................................................................................... 6-21
equation .............................................................................................5-236 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-25
settings ...............................................................................................5-199 Frequency specifications ................................................................ 2-26
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-22 Frequency testing ..................................................................................8-1
table .....................................................................................................5-199 Frequency tracking ............................................................................ 6-23
FlexElements Frequency, nominal ........................................................................ 5-185
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-23 Front panel .................................................................................................3-2
direction .............................................................................................5-226 clear ..................................................................................................... 5-317
FlexAnalogs ........................................................................................ A-36 custom labels ..................................................................................... 4-43
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-211 dimensions .............................................................................................3-2
hysteresis ...........................................................................................5-226 install ................................................................................................... 10-15
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-226 interface ............................................................................................... 4-15
pickup ..................................................................................................5-226 keypad ................................................................................................... 4-37
settings ...............................................................................................5-224 labels ...................................................................................................... 4-43
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-22 language .............................................................................................. 5-26
FlexLogic LEDs ........................................................................................................ 4-38
create logic diagram with Engineer ........................................ 4-61 number of characters .................................................................... 4-17
edit with equation editor ............................................................5-224 password change ............................................................................ 4-58
equation editor ...............................................................................5-224 plastic protective film .................................................................. 10-20
equation example ..........................................................................5-262 pushbuttons .................................................................................... 5-166
error message ...................................................................................... 7-7 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-32
evaluation ..........................................................................................5-219 switch between enhanced and basic ..................................... 3-56
example ..............................................................................................5-219 trouble message ..................................................................................7-9
gate characteristics ......................................................................5-217 types ....................................................................................................... 4-15
lock equations ...................................................................................... 4-9 use ........................................................................................................... 4-15
lock equations to serial number ............................................... 4-11 use in EnerVista ........................................................................4-17, 6-3
operands ............................................................................................5-208 Function setting ......................................................................................5-5
operators ...........................................................................................5-217 Fuse failure .......................................................................................... 5-300
rules ......................................................................................................5-218 Fuse specifications ............................................................................. 2-28
security .................................................................................................... 4-9 Fuses not field-replaceable ........................................................ 10-30
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-22
status in single-line diagram of graphical front panel ... 4-31
timer settings ...................................................................................5-224
worksheet ..........................................................................................5-221
G
Force contact inputs .......................................................................5-331 G.703 .......................................................................................................... 3-40
wire size ................................................................................................ 3-40
Force contact outputs ...................................................................5-331
Gates, logic explained ...................................................................... 4-82
Foreign language
keyboard .............................................................................................. 4-55
Gateway address ................................................................................ 5-48
setting ................................................................................................... 5-26 GE type IAC curves .......................................................................... 5-234
Form-A relay Getting help ...............................................................................................1-2
actual values ......................................................................................... 6-6 GFP Version Mismatch message ...................................................7-9
high-impedance circuits .............................................................. 3-20 GGIO Ind Oscill message ....................................................................7-9
outputs .................................................................................................. 3-19
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-28

vi F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


INDEX

GOOSE
actual values .......................................................................................6-23 H
FlexAnalogs ........................................................................................ A-36 HardFiber
routable, explained ...........................................................5-66, 5-104 interface module described ........................................................ 3-18
settings ...................................................................................5-66, 5-104 order codes for compatible URs ..................................................2-7
simulation operands ....................................................................5-217 self-test errors ................................................................................... 7-11
simulation settings ........................................................................5-332 Harmonic content ............................................................................... 6-22
Graphical front panel .....................................................................10-15 Harmonics
actual value menu not activated ..............................................4-52 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-22
actual values, phasors ...................................................................4-56 FlexAnalogs ......................................................................................... A-11
alarm acknowledge, reset .........................................4-33, 6-3, 6-4 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-25
alarm setup .........................................................................................5-36 Heartbeat messages ...............................5-67, 5-70, 5-105, 5-108
annunciator editor ...........................................................................4-34 Help, getting ..............................................................................................1-2
date and time .....................................................................................5-30 Home page configuration .............................................................. 5-29
explained ..............................................................................................4-18 HTTP ..........................................................................................................5-138
FlexLogic ............................................................................................5-209 port, close ..........................................................................................5-138
Home page configuration ............................................................5-29
Humidity specifications ................................................................... 2-33
interface ................................................................................................4-17
Hysteresis ..............................................................................................5-226
IP rating .................................................................................................2-33
labels ......................................................................................................4-48
LEDs .........................................................................................4-42, 5-163
Metering Editor ..................................................................................4-35 I
navigation ............................................................................................4-50 IAC curves ..............................................................................................5-234
navigation keys ..................................................................................4-37 ICD file .................................... 5-76, 5-77, 5-78, 5-114, 5-115, 5-116
no display .............................................................................................5-31 IEC 60870-5-103 protocol
order codes ........................................................................................... 2-7 explained ............................................................................................5-142
phasor diagram .....................................................................4-56, 5-32 select protocol ................................................................................... 5-51
plastic protective film ..................................................................10-20 settings ...............................................................................................5-142
pushbutton testing ............................................................................ 7-3 IEC 60870-5-104 protocol
pushbuttons .....................................................................................5-166 connections remaining ................................................................. 6-12
pushbuttons 9 to 16 ........................................................................4-29 port, close ..........................................................................................5-140
settings ..................................................................................................5-28 select protocol ................................................................................... 5-51
settings, breaker ............................................................................5-190 settings ...............................................................................................5-139
settings, switch ...............................................................................5-196 IEC 61850 protocol
single-line diagrams ........................................................................4-20 Edition 1 and 2 support ................................................................. 5-57
specifications ..........................................................................2-30, 2-32 explained .................................................................................. 5-57, 5-95
time .........................................................................................................5-30 file transfer ........................................................................................5-137
USB port .............................................................................................5-147 heartbeat messages .............................5-67, 5-70, 5-105, 5-108
use, change setting .........................................................................4-52 IID file ..................................................................................................... 10-8
view LEDs and pushbuttons in software ................................. 6-4 settings in EnerVista ....................................................................... 5-56
Ground current metering ................................................................6-18 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-30
Ground IOC IEC CID files ................................................................................. 5-59, 5-97
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-211 IED setup .................................................................................................. 3-56
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-250 IEEE C37.94 communications .......................................... 3-48, 3-51
settings ...............................................................................................5-249 IEEE curves ............................................................................................5-232
specifications ......................................................................................2-19 IID file ..................................................................... 3-72, 5-59, 5-97, 10-8
Ground TOC import preferences .......................................................................... 10-9
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212 Import settings file .............................................................................. 3-72
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-249 Import settings from SCD or CID file ......................................10-12
settings ...............................................................................................5-248 In service indicator ................................................................................7-6
specifications ......................................................................................2-19
In Service LED ........................................................................................ 3-53
Group 1 switch after powerup ..................................................5-231
Incipient cable fault detector
Grouped elements ...........................................................................5-230 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-11
Guarantee ..................................................................................................D-1 clear counter .........................................................................................7-2
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-300
settings ...............................................................................................5-298
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-22

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL vii


INDEX

Incompatible device order codes or versions ..................10-14


Inputs K
AC current specifications ............................................................. 2-26 Keyboard .................................................................................................. 4-55
AC currents .......................................................................................5-184 Keypad ...................................................................................................... 4-37
AC voltage .........................................................................................5-184
AC voltage specifications ............................................................. 2-26
contact input specifications ....................................................... 2-26
contact inputs .................................................................. 5-311, 5-331
L
DCmA input specifications .......................................................... 2-26 Labels, front panel .................................................................. 4-43, 4-75
DCmA inputs ...................................................................................... 3-31 Lamp test ....................................................................................................7-3
direct input specifications ........................................................... 2-27 Language setting ................................................................................ 5-26
IRIG-B ..................................................................................................... 3-36 Laser module ......................................................................................... 3-39
IRIG-B specifications ...................................................................... 2-27 Latching outputs
RTD input specifications ............................................................... 2-27 application examples .................................................................. 5-315
RTD inputs ........................................................................................... 3-31 settings ............................................................................................... 5-315
virtual ...................................................................................................5-313 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-28
Installation ................................................................................................. 3-2 LC fiber .............................................................................................2-7, 3-12
activate relay ..................................................................................... 3-53 LC fiber connector .............................................................................. 3-13
add UR devices with auto discovery ....................................... 3-67 LED test
communications .............................................................................. 3-34 commands .............................................................................................7-3
CT inputs .............................................................................................. 3-17 FlexLogic operand ........................................................................ 5-216
front panel .........................................................................................10-15 settings ............................................................................................... 5-160
RS485 ..................................................................................................... 3-35 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23
set relay to Programmed ............................................................. 3-53 LEDs
settings ...............................................................................................5-182 clear ..................................................................................................... 5-317
Instantaneous overcurrent custom labels ..................................................................................... 4-43
see Phase, Ground, and Neutral IOCs explained .............................................................................................. 4-38
Interface In Service .............................................................................................. 3-53
front panel ........................................................................................... 4-15 power supply module ..................................................................... 3-16
software .................................................................................................. 4-1 settings ............................................................................................... 5-163
Internet access ...................................................................................5-138 Trouble .................................................................................................. 3-53
Inter-relay communication specifications ........................... 2-31 view in software for graphical front panel ..............................6-4
Inverse time undervoltage ..........................................................5-253 Link power budget .............................................................................. 2-31
IOC Load shedding ................................................................................... 5-270
see Phase, Ground, and Neutral IOCs Local access denied message ......................................... 4-59, 5-21
IP address Local access, explained ......................................................................5-8
enter in software .............................................................................. 5-45 Local Setting Authorization ........................................................ 10-14
enter on front panel ............................................................ 3-58, 4-37 Lockout from software .................................................................... 5-14
gateway ............................................................................................... 5-48 Log in with password ............................................................ 3-71, 5-10
rules ........................................................................................................ 3-58 Log in, multiple users cannot ..........................................................2-4
view ........................................................................................................ 5-45 Log out
IP address migration ......................................................................... 3-72 Administrator manually from front panel ............................. 5-21
IP rating .................................................................................................... 2-33 users forcefully .....................................................................................7-3
IP54 for enhanced front panel ...................................................... 3-2 Logic diagram
IRIG-B create ..................................................................................................... 4-61
connection on rear panel ............................................................. 3-12 explained .............................................................................................. 4-60
explained ............................................................................................. 3-36 Logic gates, FlexLogic ....................................................... 4-82, 5-218
port on rear panel ............................................................................ 3-12 Logs, system .......................................................................................... 5-25
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-27 Lost password ..........................................................................................5-8
ISO standards ........................................................................................ 2-35 Low on Memory message .................................................................7-8

J
Japanese limited to 10 character input ................................ 5-27

viii F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


INDEX

Modules
M add and check settings not defaulted .................................10-24
MAC address communications ............................................................................... 3-34
actual values .......................................................................................6-29 CT/VT .............................................................................................3-16, 5-7
examples ..............................................................................................5-43 order codes ......................................................................................... 2-14
RxGOOSE ................................................................................5-73, 5-111 power supply ...................................................................................... 3-15
settings for redundancy ................................................................5-46 replace ................................................................................................10-23
TxGOOSE ................................................................................5-69, 5-107 transducer I/O ................................................................................... 3-32
Maintenance Monitor
actual values .......................................................................................6-28 actual values ...................................................................................... 10-1
alert error message ........................................................................... 7-8 actual values with Metering Editor .......................................... 5-32
battery replacement ....................................................................10-25 devices .................................................................................................. 10-1
cleaning .................................................................................................2-35 use alarms ........................................................................................... 5-36
commands ............................................................................................. 7-3 Monitoring elements settings ....................................................5-284
module replacement ....................................................................10-23 Mounting .....................................................................................................3-2
upgrade or downgrade ...............................................................10-14
Manufacturing date ...........................................................................6-29
Maximum 6X, 6X wire size ..............................................................3-21 N
Maximum CT/VT wire size ...............................................................3-17 Nameplate, rear ......................................................................................3-1
Measurements of UR and panel cutout ................................... 3-2 NAND gate explained ....................................................................... 4-82
Media storage alarm message ....................................................7-10 Navigation keys ................................................................................... 4-37
Memory low message ......................................................................... 7-8 Negative sequence IOC
Memory requirements ......................................................................3-55 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
Menu navigation ..................................................................................4-49 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-252
Message about upgrade over Internet ................................10-14 settings ...............................................................................................5-251
Messages specifications ..................................................................................... 2-20
clear front panel .............................................................................5-317 Negative sequence TOC
error .......................................................................................................... 7-6 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
errors and warnings in Engineer ...............................................4-68 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-251
Metering settings ...............................................................................................5-250
conventions .............................................................................6-13, 6-14 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-19
demand specifications ...................................................................2-26 Network settings migration .......................................................... 3-72
editor in graphical front panel ....................................................4-35 Neutral IOC
frequency specifications ...............................................................2-25 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
power specifications .......................................................................2-25 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-243
THD specifications ............................................................................2-25 settings ...............................................................................................5-242
voltage specifications .....................................................................2-25 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-19
Microsoft Windows requirement ................................................3-55 Neutral overvoltage
Mimic diagrams ....................................................................................4-20 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
Missing messages, RxGOOSE fail ................................................7-10 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-257
MMS connections remaining ........................................................6-12 settings ...............................................................................................5-256
Modbus specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21
connections remaining ..................................................................6-12 Neutral TOC
Flex State parameters .................................................................5-172 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
Modbus Analyzer window ............................................................10-1 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-242
port, close .............................................................................................5-51 settings ...............................................................................................5-241
register entry ...................................................................................5-147 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-19
settings ..................................................................................................5-51 No connection ....................................................................................... 5-45
user map ............................................................................................5-147 Non-volatile data storage .............................................................. 3-16
Model information, view ..................................................................6-29 Non-volatile latches
Model number ......................................................................................... 3-1 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
Modem connection .............................................................................3-66 settings ...............................................................................................5-229
Modification file number .................................................................6-29 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23
Module 7R ................................................................................................3-41 NOR gate explained ........................................................................... 4-82
Module 7S .................................................................................................3-40 NOT gate explained ........................................................................... 4-82
Module Failure message .................................................................7-12

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL ix


INDEX

Parallel Redundancy Protocol


O actual values ...................................................................................... 6-12
Obtain list of port numbers ........................................................... 5-45 explained .............................................................................................. 5-47
One-shot settings .................................................................................................. 5-45
error compiling in Engineer ......................................................... 4-69 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-31
FlexLogic operators ......................................................................5-218 Parity .......................................................................................................... 5-42
Operating system Part numbering .......................................................................................2-7
language .............................................................................................. 3-56 Passwords
requirements ..................................................................................... 3-55 authentication by device or server .......................................... 5-16
Operating temperature ................................................................... 2-33 bypass authentication ................................................................... 5-23
Operating times ................................................................................... 2-19 change .................................................................................................. 4-58
Operator command to force logoff ............................................. 7-4 change after installation .............................................................. 3-71
OR gate explained .............................................................................. 4-82 change does not take relay out of service ..............................5-1
Order codes ............................................................................................... 2-7 command ................................................................................ 4-58, 5-10
update .......................................................................................... 3-66, 7-3 default ................................................................................................... 5-14
view as actual values ..................................................................... 6-29 explained .................................................................................................2-3
Oscillatory GOOSE maintenance message ............................. 7-9 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-216
lockout ....................................................................................... 4-59, 5-14
Oscillatory transient testing specifications .......................... 2-34
lost password ........................................................................................5-8
Oscillography
requirements .........................................................................................5-8
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-27
reset to factory defaults ...................................................................5-8
clearing ........................................................................................ 5-41, 7-2
rules ...........................................................................................................5-8
how to .................................................................................................5-155
settings ...................................................................................... 4-58, 5-10
settings ...............................................................................................5-155
settings templates ..............................................................................4-7
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-24
wrong entry ........................................................................................ 4-59
via EnerVista software ...................................................................... 4-2
Permissive functions ...................................................................... 5-253
view waveform in actual values window ............................. 6-27
view waveform in event record ................................................ 6-25
Per-unit quantity .....................................................................................5-4
Out of service ........................................................................................... 5-1 Phase angle metering ...................................................................... 6-14
Outputs Phase current metering .................................................................. 6-17
contact outputs ..............................................................................5-314 Phase IOC
control power specifications ...................................................... 2-29 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-212
critical failure relay specifications ........................................... 2-29 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-240
Fast form-C relay specifications ............................................... 2-29 settings ............................................................................................... 5-239
Form-A relay .......................................................................... 2-28, 3-19 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-19
Form-C relay ...................................................................................... 3-19 Phase overvoltage
Form-C relay specifications ........................................................ 2-29 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-213
latching output specifications ................................................... 2-28 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-256
latching outputs .............................................................................5-315 settings ............................................................................................... 5-255
virtual outputs .................................................................................5-317 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-20
Over Temperature message ........................................................ 7-10 Phase rotation .................................................................................... 5-185
Overcurrent curves Phase TOC
FlexCurves .........................................................................................5-236 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-213
IAC .........................................................................................................5-234 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-239
IEC .........................................................................................................5-233 settings ............................................................................................... 5-236
types ....................................................................................................5-231 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-19
Overfrequency Phase undervoltage
testing ...................................................................................................... 8-1 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-213
Overvoltage logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-255
auxiliary ..................................................................................2-21, 5-258 settings ............................................................................................... 5-254
neutral .....................................................................................2-21, 5-256 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-20
phase ........................................................................ 2-20, 5-213, 5-255 Phasor display graphical front panel .......................... 4-56, 5-32
PID regulator
FlexAnalogs .........................................................................................A-36
FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-212
P settings ............................................................................................... 5-308
Panel cutout .............................................................................................. 3-2 Ping test times out .............................................................................. 5-45
Plastic film on front panel ........................................................... 10-20
Points List, view DNP ......................................................................... 5-55

x F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


INDEX

Port Product information


Ethernet, turn on or off ...................................................................5-45 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-29
failure monitoring .............................................................................5-38 Device Connectivity Report in Engineer ................................ 4-76
HTTP, close ........................................................................................5-138 firmware revision ............................................................................. 6-29
IEC 60870-5-104, close ...............................................................5-140 Programmed mode ........................................................................... 3-53
Modbus, close .....................................................................................5-51 Protection elements .............................................................................5-4
on rear panel ......................................................................................3-12 Protection Summary interface ............................ 3-69, 4-4, 5-260
TFTP, close .........................................................................................5-139 Protocol selection ............................................................................... 5-51
USB ..........................................................................................................4-17 Prototype Firmware message ........................................................7-9
Port number PRP
combinations with protocols ......................................................5-51 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-12
connectivity report of those used .............................................4-76 explained .............................................................................................. 5-47
DNP ..........................................................................................................5-52 settings ................................................................................................. 5-45
HTTP .....................................................................................................5-138 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-31
IEC 60870-5-104 ............................................................................5-139 PTP
list of .......................................................................................................5-45 actual values for port state ............................................................6-9
Modbus ..................................................................................................5-51 clock settings ...................................................................................5-148
Modbus during installation ..........................................................3-66 port behavior ...................................................................................... 5-46
RADIUS ...................................................................................................5-19 settings ...............................................................................................5-149
SNTP .....................................................................................................5-151 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-30
system log ................................................................................5-19, 5-20 pu quantity .................................................................................................5-4
TFTP ......................................................................................................5-139 Pushbuttons
Power metering control FlexLogic ............................................................................5-209
specifications ......................................................................................2-25 control logic diagram ...................................................................5-166
values .....................................................................................................6-19 control settings ...............................................................................5-165
Power off, save data first ................................................................3-16 control specifications ..................................................................... 2-23
Power supply testing .......................................................................................................7-3
description ...........................................................................................3-15 user-programmable FlexLogic ................................................5-217
diagram .................................................................................................3-12 user-programmable logic diagrams .....................................5-171
LED on module ...................................................................................3-16 user-programmable settings ...................................................5-166
removal to replace battery .......................................................10-25 user-programmable specifications ......................................... 2-23
RH/RL vs SH/SL ...............................................................................10-25 view in software for graphical front panel ..............................6-4
specifications ......................................................................................2-27
wire size .................................................................................................3-16
Power system settings ...................................................................5-185
Precision Time Protocol
Q
actual values for port state ............................................................ 6-9 Quick Connect ........................................................................... 3-69, 3-70
clock settings ...................................................................................5-148
port behavior ......................................................................................5-46
settings ...............................................................................................5-149 R
specifications ......................................................................................2-30 RADIUS server
Preferences authentication ................................................................................... 5-16
comparing settings ..........................................................................10-7 explained ........................................................................................2-4, 2-6
Engineer ................................................................................................4-76 setup .........................................................................................................B-1
IEC 61850 ..................................................................................5-61, 5-99 RAM Filesystem Fail message .........................................................7-7
import file .............................................................................................10-9 RAM required ......................................................................................... 3-55
Preserve custom attributes importing SCD/CID files ......10-9 Reactive power
Press Reset Key message ...............................................................7-10 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-19
Print front panel labels .........................................................4-43, 4-75 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-25
Process bus Real power .............................................................................................. 6-19
error messages ..................................................................................7-11 Real power specifications .............................................................. 2-25
order codes for compatible URs .................................................. 2-7 Real-time clock
overview ................................................................................................3-18 actual values for synchronization ...............................................6-9
Process Bus Failure message .......................................................7-12 settings ...............................................................................................5-148
Process Bus Trouble message .....................................................7-13 Reboot relay
using EnerVista ....................................................................................5-1
using relay ..............................................................................................7-3
Recloser curves ...................................................................5-202, 5-236

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL xi


INDEX

Redundancy RTD inputs


power supply ...................................................................................10-25 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-24
PRP actual values ............................................................................ 6-12 FlexAnalogs ............................................................................... A-1, A-35
PRP explained .................................................................................... 5-47 settings ............................................................................................... 5-325
settings ................................................................................................. 5-45 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-27
SNTP .....................................................................................................5-151 RTD Trouble message ....................................................................... 7-13
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-31 Rules for passwords .............................................................................5-8
Relay architecture ............................................................................5-206 RxGOOSE
Relay maintenance ............................................................................... 7-3 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-23
Relay name ...........................................................................................5-182 FlexAnalogs .........................................................................................A-36
Release Notes .....................................................................................10-14 settings ................................................................................... 5-71, 5-109
Remote access of front panel in EnerVista ................. 4-17, 6-3 RxGOOSE Fail message ................................................................... 7-10
Remote access, explained ................................................................ 5-8 RxGOOSE Offline message ............................................................. 7-10
Remote Setting Authorization ...................................................10-14
Repair ....................................................................................1-2, 10-30, D-1
Replace battery ..................................................................................10-25 S
Replace Battery message ................................................................. 7-9 Save settings .............................................................................................4-1
Replace front panel .........................................................................10-15 Saving setting does not take relay out of service ...............5-1
Replacement modules .......................................................2-14, 10-23 SCADA protocol selection ............................................................... 5-51
Requirements for installation ...................................................... 3-55 SCD file
Reset alarm ............................................................................................... 6-4 import ................................................................................................. 10-12
Reset to factory defaults ....................................................... 5-8, 5-22 import preferences .......................................................................... 10-9
Resetting SCL compatible ......................................................................... 5-57, 5-95
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-217 SCL file import ...................5-76, 5-77, 5-78, 5-114, 5-115, 5-116
setting to clear LEDs and messages .....................................5-317 Edition 1 versus 2 ............................................................................. 5-57
to factory defaults .....................................................................5-8, 7-3 preferences ......................................................................................... 10-9
Restart relay Second Ethernet Fail
using EnerVista .................................................................................... 5-1 error message ......................................................................................7-8
using relay .............................................................................................. 7-3 set alarm .............................................................................................. 5-38
Restore settings ................................................................................... 10-8 Security
Revision history .......................................................................................D-1 commands .............................................................................................7-4
RF immunity specifications ........................................................... 2-34 delete files and records .............................................................. 10-29
RFI, conducted specifications ...................................................... 2-34 EnerVista and UR secure with SSH .............................................2-4
R-GOOSE description ..........................................................5-66, 5-104 failed authentication lockout ...................................................... 5-22
RH/RL power supply module ......................................................10-25 forceful user logout ............................................................................7-3
RJ-45 ................................................................................................. 2-7, 3-12 lock FlexLogic equations .................................................................4-9
RMS voltage specifications ........................................................... 2-25 lock settings ...........................................................................................4-5
Roles for login .......................................................................................... 2-4 password for settings template ...................................................4-7
Rolling demand ..................................................................................5-160 passwords for settings and commands .................... 4-58, 5-10
Routable GOOSE ....................................................................5-66, 5-104 RADIUS server for user authentication .....................................B-1
RRTD Comm Fail message ............................................................ 7-10 role-based user access ....................................................................2-4
RS232 settings .................................................................................................. 5-20
baud rate ............................................................................................. 5-42 software options ............................................................................... 2-32
configuration ..................................................................................... 3-69 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-32
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-30 system and event logs ................................................................... 5-25
wiring ..................................................................................................... 3-33 Security audit list of port numbers ............................................ 5-45
RS422 Selector switch
configuration ..................................................................................... 3-44 actual values .........................................................................................6-8
timing .................................................................................................... 3-45 application example .................................................................... 5-267
two-channel application .............................................................. 3-44 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-213
with fiber interface .......................................................................... 3-46 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-269
RS485 settings ............................................................................................... 5-262
description .......................................................................................... 3-35 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23
limitation with CyberSentry ......................................................... 5-17 timing .................................................................................................. 5-266
port on rear panel ............................................................................ 3-12
settings ................................................................................................. 5-42
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-30

xii F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


INDEX

Self-tests Signal sources


description ............................................................................................. 7-6 description ..............................................................................................5-6
error messages .................................................................................... 7-6 metering ............................................................................................... 6-17
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-217 settings ...............................................................................................5-186
user-programmable .....................................................................5-164 Simulation
Serial number ................................................................... 3-1, 4-11, 6-29 operands ............................................................................................5-217
Serial ports settings ...............................................................................................5-332
device setup with ..............................................................................3-64 Simulation bit .......................................................................................5-330
location ..................................................................................................4-15 Single-line diagram ...............................................................................2-2
settings ..................................................................................................5-42 create, explained .............................................................................. 4-20
specifications ......................................................................................2-30 save as separate file ....................................................................... 4-24
wiring ......................................................................................................3-46 Site Targets ............................................................................................. 10-1
Server authentication .......................................................................5-16 Size of UR and panel cutout .............................................................3-2
Service life expected ..........................................................................10-3 Smart defaults ....................................................................................5-155
Service Report ......................................................................................... 1-2 SNTP Failure message .........................................................................7-9
Setting Changed message ............................................................... 7-9 SNTP protocol
Setting groups .......................................................5-230, 5-231, 5-261 accuracy specifications ................................................................ 2-30
active setting group .....................................................................5-230 redundant source ..........................................................................5-151
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-213 settings ...............................................................................................5-151
troubleshooting ..............................................................................5-231 Software
Settings ........................................................................................................ 5-1 installation ........................................................................................... 3-56
back up ..........................................................................5-59, 5-97, 10-8 interface explained ............................................................................4-1
change ...................................................................................................4-51 language .............................................................................................. 5-27
change does not take relay out of service ............................. 5-1 system requirements ..................................................................... 3-55
compare ................................................................................................10-7 update or downgrade ..................................................................10-13
control user accounts .....................................................................5-14 Source frequency ................................................................................ 6-21
convert ...................................................................................................10-5 Source transfer schemes .............................................................5-253
default to factory defaults .............................................................. 7-3 Sources
edit ...........................................................................................................4-51 description ..............................................................................................5-6
export .....................................................................................................10-8 example of use ................................................................................5-188
import .....................................................................................................3-72 FlexAnalogs ............................................................................................A-1
lock ............................................................................................................ 4-5 metering ............................................................................................... 6-17
not updated automatically among computers ..................3-68 settings ...............................................................................................5-186
read from device with Modbus Analyzer ...............................10-1 Special characters .............................................................................. 4-55
restore ....................................................................................................10-8 Specifications ........................................................................................ 2-19
upgrade .................................................................................................10-5 ST fiber ..............................................................................................2-7, 3-12
write to device with Modbus Analyzer ....................................10-1 ST fiber connector .............................................................................. 3-13
Settings file ..................................................................................5-59, 5-97 Standards, certification ................................................................... 2-35
description ............................................................................................. 4-1 Status LEDs ................................................................................. 4-40, 4-42
import .....................................................................................................3-72
Stop blinking alarm ............................................................................ 4-33
takes relay out of service when loaded ................................... 4-2
Storage Media Alarm message .................................................. 7-10
traceability ...........................................................................................4-12
Storage temperature ........................................................................ 2-33
transfer with USB stick ...................................................................4-17
Storage, UR ...........................................................................................10-30
Settings password ...................................................................4-58, 5-10
Substation D400 .................................................................................. 3-73
Settings Save Error message ........................................................7-10
Support, technical ..................................................................................1-2
Settings templates
description ............................................................................................. 4-5
Surge immunity specifications .................................................... 2-34
edit ............................................................................................................. 4-6 Switch
enable ...................................................................................................... 4-5 actual values .........................................................................................6-8
password protection ......................................................................... 4-7 control with IEC 61850 ....................................................5-92, 5-130
remove ..................................................................................................... 4-9 IEC 61850 Edition 1 and 2 ............................................................ 5-57
view ........................................................................................................... 4-7 settings ................................................................................5-194, 5-262
SFP Synchronize
explained ..............................................................................................3-11 clock using time source ..............................................................5-148
module fail message ......................................................................... 7-9 clocks of UR devices to local computer ...............................5-149
photo ...................................................................................................10-21 files between offline and online ................................................ 4-68
SH/SL power supply module ......................................................10-25 Synchronize Devices setting for clocks ................................5-149
Signal loss detection for fiber .......................................................5-46 Syslog ......................................................................................................... 5-25

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL xiii


INDEX

System and device information ................................................. 4-76 Third Ethernet Fail


System Exception message .......................................................... 7-10 error message ......................................................................................7-8
System Failure message .................................................................... 7-7 set alarm .............................................................................................. 5-38
System frequency .............................................................................5-185 Tilda on front panel ............................................................................ 4-17
System logs ............................................................................................ 5-25 Time
System requirements ....................................................................... 3-55 actual values .................................................................6-9, 6-27, 6-28
System setup .......................................................................................5-184 FlexLogic timer settings ............................................................. 5-224
graphical front panel format ...................................................... 5-30
operating .............................................................................................. 6-29
overwritten by external source ....................................................7-3
T set .................................................................................... 5-29, 5-148, 7-3
Targets Time overcurrent
defined .................................................................................................. 4-19 see Phase, Neutral, and Ground TOCs
menu ......................................................................................................... 7-5 Timeout, connection .......................................................................... 5-51
messages ............................................................................................... 7-5
To Install Settings message .............................................................7-7
overview by device .......................................................................... 10-1
TOC
settings .................................................................................................... 5-5
ground ................................................................................................ 5-248
TBD .............................................................................................................. 10-9
neutral ................................................................................................ 5-241
TCP port number for web access ............................................5-138 phase .................................................................................................. 5-236
TDR Trouble message ...................................................................... 7-13 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-19
Technical support .................................................................................. 1-2 Toolbar ...................................................................................................... 4-80
files ................................................................................................. 1-2, 10-3 Torque for screws ....................................................... 2-35, 3-12, 3-21
Teleprotection Total harmonic distortion ...............................................................A-24
actual values ......................................................................................... 6-6
Traceability
clearing counters ................................................................................ 7-2
data ........................................................................................................ 4-13
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-214
overview ............................................................................................... 4-12
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-323
rules ........................................................................................................ 4-14
overview .............................................................................................5-322
view data .............................................................................................. 4-14
settings ................................................................. 5-181, 5-322, 5-323
Tracking frequency ............................................................................ 6-23
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-27
Transducer I/O
Temp Monitor message .................................................................. 7-10
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-24
Temperature
settings ............................................................................................... 5-324
FlexLogic monitor operand .......................................................5-217
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-27
operating and storage .................................................................. 2-33
wiring ..................................................................................................... 3-32
Test voltages ......................................................................................... 3-15
Transfer files to relay ......................................................................... 10-7
Testing
Transfer files with USB drive ......................................................... 4-17
force contact inputs .....................................................................5-331
Triangle in Offline Window ............................................................. 4-68
force contact outputs ..................................................................5-331
Trip bus
lamp test ................................................................................................. 7-3
FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-214
LEDs ........................................................................................................... 7-3
logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-261
over/underfrequency ........................................................................ 8-1
settings ............................................................................................... 5-259
pushbuttons .......................................................................................... 7-3
self-test error messages .................................................................. 7-6
Trip LEDs ................................................................................................ 5-163
settings ...............................................................................................5-330 Trouble indicator ....................................................................................7-6
TFTP Trouble LED ............................................................................................. 3-53
port, close ..........................................................................................5-139 Troubleshooting
put cannot be done ......................................................................5-139 access to device ............................................................................... 3-68
settings ...............................................................................................5-139 breaker not working .................................................................... 5-277
THD .............................................................................................................. A-24 connection ........................................................................................... 5-45
THD metering ........................................................................................ 6-22 dark graphical front panel ........................................................... 5-31
Engineer .................................................................................... 4-69, 4-70
THD metering specifications ........................................................ 2-25
error messages ....................................................................................7-6
The URS file is part of a device folder ....................................10-11
setting not working ...................................................................... 5-277
Thermal demand characteristic ...............................................5-159
unit not programmed error ...................................................... 5-182
Thermal overload protection
Turn off alarm ....................................................................................... 4-33
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-304
TxGOOSE
settings ...............................................................................................5-302
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-13
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-22
settings ................................................................................... 5-67, 5-105

xiv F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL


INDEX

User-programmable LEDs
U custom labels ..................................................................................... 4-43
UDP for TFTP ........................................................................................5-139 defaults ................................................................................................. 4-41
UL certification ......................................................................................2-35 settings ...............................................................................................5-163
Unable to connect to relay .................................................3-68, 5-45 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23
Unable to put relay in flash mode ...........................................10-14 User-programmable pushbuttons
Unauthorized access FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-217
commands ...........................................................................................5-41 graphical front panel buttons 9 to 16 .................................... 4-29
resetting .................................................................................................. 7-2 logic diagrams .................................................................................5-171
Underfrequency settings ...............................................................................................5-166
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-214 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-270 testing .......................................................................................................7-3
settings ...............................................................................................5-269 User-programmable self-test settings .................................5-164
specifications ......................................................................................2-21
testing ...................................................................................................... 8-1
Undervoltage V
auxiliary .................................................................................................2-20 VAR hour
characteristics .................................................................................5-253 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-20
phase .......................................................................................2-20, 5-254 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-25
settings ...............................................................................................5-254 Vibration testing specifications .................................................. 2-34
Uninstall .................................................................................................10-29 Virtual inputs
Unit Not Calibrated message .......................................................7-10 actual values .........................................................................................6-5
Unit not programmed ...........................................................5-182, 7-7 commands .............................................................................................7-2
Unpacking the relay ............................................................................. 3-1 explained ............................................................................................5-313
Unreturned messages alarm .....................................................5-181 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-215
Update SCL files prompt ..................................................................4-68 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-313
Update settings with Convert Device Settings ...................10-5 settings ...............................................................................................5-313
Updates Virtual outputs
device not recognized .................................................................10-13 actual values .........................................................................................6-6
firmware .............................................................................................10-14 explained ............................................................................................5-317
FPGA .....................................................................................................10-15 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-215
instruction manual ............................................................................. 3-1 settings ...............................................................................................5-317
order code .............................................................................................. 7-3 Voltage banks .....................................................................................5-184
single-line diagrams not retained .............................................4-24 Voltage deviation specifications ................................................ 2-34
software .............................................................................................10-13 Voltage elements ..............................................................................5-253
Upgrade device settings ..................................................................10-5 Voltage metering
Upgrade over Internet message ..............................................10-14 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-18
Upload settings to relay ...................................................................10-7 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-25
URS file does not include IEC 61850 configuration .......10-11 Voltage Monitor message .............................................................. 7-11
URS file is part of a device folder .............................................10-11 Voltage restraint characteristic ................................................5-237
URS settings file ................................................3-72, 5-59, 5-97, 10-8 VT fuse failure
USB port FlexAnalogs ......................................................................................... A-36
graphical front panel .......................................................4-17, 5-147 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-214
Quick Connect ....................................................................................3-70 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-301
specifications ......................................................................................2-30 settings ...............................................................................................5-300
User accounts VT inputs ............................................................... 3-16, 3-17, 5-7, 5-184
add ...........................................................................................................5-14 VT wiring ................................................................................................... 3-17
authentication by device or server ..........................................5-16 VTFF .............................................................................................. 5-300, A-36
multiple login limitation CyberSentry ........................................ 2-4
passwords for settings and commands ....................4-58, 5-10
permissions by role ............................................................................ 2-4 W
permissions, set .................................................................................5-14
Warning messages in Engineer .................................................. 4-70
User-definable displays
Warning symbol in Offline Window .......................................... 4-68
example ..............................................................................................5-174
Warning, firmware upload not supported ..........................10-14
invoking and scrolling ..................................................................5-173
settings ...............................................................................................5-173
Warranty .................................................................................................... D-1
specifications ......................................................................................2-23

F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL xv


INDEX

Watt-hour
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-20
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-25
Wattmetric zero-sequence directional
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-24
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-215
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-247
settings ...............................................................................................5-243
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-20
Waveform
view in actual values window .................................................... 6-27
view in event record ....................................................................... 6-25
Waveform files, view ......................................................................... 4-79
Web access port ...............................................................................5-138
Web server protocol ........................................................................5-138
Windows requirement ..................................................................... 3-55
Wire size
CT/VT ...................................................................................................... 3-17
F485 converter .................................................................................. 3-55
G.703 and fiber interface ............................................................. 3-47
G.703 interface .................................................................................. 3-40
module 7S ........................................................................................... 3-40
modules 6X, 6W ................................................................................ 3-21
modules 7E, 7F, 7G, 7Q, 75 .......................................................... 3-47
modules 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, 74 ......................................................... 3-46
modules 7T, 7W ................................................................................ 3-44
power supply module .................................................................... 3-16
RS422 and fiber interface ............................................................ 3-46
RS422 interface ................................................................................ 3-44
Wiring diagram .................................................................................... 3-14
Withdraw UR from operation ....................................................10-29
Wrong Transceiver message ....................................................... 7-11

X
XOR gate explained ........................................................................... 4-82

Y
Yellow caution icon in Offline Window ................................... 4-68

Z
Zero-sequence core balance ....................................................... 3-17

xvi F35 MULTIPLE FEEDER PROTECTION SYSTEM – INSTRUCTION MANUAL

You might also like